Wastewater Lift Station Example Operation Maintenance
Wastewater Lift Station Example Operation Maintenance
Wastewater Lift Station Example Operation Maintenance
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FOR:
BAY MEA DO W S
(SAN MATEO, CA)
DATE: October 13, 2014
REVISION: 0
Customer Name
Company Name
111 Company Address
City, State Zip Code
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
1. INTRODUCTION
1.01 ABOUT THIS DOCUMENT
1.02 CONTACT INFORMATION
1.03 ROMTEC UTILITIES LIMITED WARRANTY
3. MECHANICAL
3.01 SCOPE OF SUPPLY: PRODUCTS
3.02 WET WELL
3.02.1 WET WELL COMPONENT DRAWING(S)
3.02.2 WET WELL PRODUCTION DRAWING
3.02.3 WET WELL HATCH DRAWING
3.02.4 WET WELL RELATED DATA SHEETS
3.03 PUMPS
3.03.1 PUMP SPECIFICATIONS
3.03.2 PUMP DRAWINGS
3.03.3 PUMP PERFORMANCE CURVE
3.03.4 PUMP OPERATION & MAINTENANCE MANUAL
3.03.5 RECOMMENDED MAINTENANCE
3.03.6 PUMP RELATED DATA SHEETS
3.04 LEVEL SENSORS
3.04.1 PRIMARY LEVEL SENSOR
3.04.2 SECONDARY LEVEL SENSOR
3.05 VALVE VAULT
3.05.1 VALVE VAULT COMPONENT DRAWING(S)
3.05.2 VALVE VAULT PRODUCTION DRAWING(S)
3.05.3 VALVE VAULT HATCH DRAWING
3.05.4 VALVE VAULT RELATED DATA SHEETS
3.06 METER VAULT
3.06.1 METER VAULT COMPONENT DRAWING(S)
3.06.2 METER VAULT PRODUCTION DRAWING(S)
3.06.3 METER VAULT HATCH DRAWING
INDEX
4. ELECTRICAL
4.01 CONTROL PANEL DRAWING
4.02 ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
4.03 CONTROL PANEL DATA SHEETS
4.04 INSTRUCTIONS FOR CONDUIT ENTRY
4.05 GENERATOR
1. INTRODUCTION
This section contains the necessary information and procedures for the understanding
and use of this document by the client and other parties of interest.
1. Document Identification
The information in this document is the Operation & Maintenance Manual
(O&M) provided by Romtec Utilities, Inc., herein referred to as Romtec Utilities
for the project listed below:
Name (herein referred to as “the project”): Bay Meadows
Location (herein referred to as “the site”): San Mateo, California
Document Date: 10/13/2014
Revision #: 0
2. Document Description
This document contains all the as-built drawings, operation and maintenance
manuals, and manufacturer warranties for the associated mechanical and
electrical components of this project.
3. Document Delivery
The electronic copy of the Romtec Utilities Operation & Maintenance Manual
will be provided to the customer at start-up of the system.
Rev. 4/30/14
1.02 CONTACT INFORMATION
Wet Well:
Concrete:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Hatch:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Sealant:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Joint Tape:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
1.02 CONTACT INFORMATION
Pipe Boot:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Barrel Gasket:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Coupling:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Pumps:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Level Sensors:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
1.02 CONTACT INFORMATION
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Valve Vault:
Concrete:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Hatch:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Valves:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Coupling:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
1.02 CONTACT INFORMATION
Pressure Transducer:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Meter Vault:
Concrete:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Hatch:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Sealant:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Joint Tape:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
1.02 CONTACT INFORMATION
Pipe Boot:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Adapter:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Flow Tube:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Odor Control:
Concrete:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Blower:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
1.02 CONTACT INFORMATION
Generator:
Company Name
111 Company Address
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.co
m
Electrical:
Rev. 5-14-14
1.03 ROMTEC UTILITIES LIMITED WARRANTY
Rev. 5-14-14
1.03 ROMTEC UTILITIES LIMITED WARRANTY
Rev. 5-14-14
1.03 ROMTEC UTILITIES LIMITED WARRANTY
Rev. 5-14-14
1.03 ROMTEC UTILITIES LIMITED WARRANTY
Rev. 5-14-14
2. PERMITS & REPORTS
Keep all permits and reports in this section for the project. Engineer or contractor to
insert permits and reports related to this pump station. The Romtec Utilities start-up
reports will be sent after the start-up is complete. Please insert in this section when
received.
2.01 PERMITS
2.02 START-UP REPORTS
2.03 INSPECTION REPORTS
2.01 PERMITS
This section contains information pertaining to the mechanical design of this system.
There is both technical information and related drawings necessary for the system
construction.
QTY ITEM
1 INTERIOR COATING - TNEMEC 61
1 EXTERIOR COATING - TNEMEC 61
1 BASE ASSEMBLY
1 GROUT RING - 10ft - 45 DEG
1 BASE - WW - 10ft - RU FLAT BASE - NO GROUT- 6in UPLIFT COLLAR
3 ANCHOR KIT - DISCHARGE ELBOW
3 DISCHARGE ELBOW - 4in - 540 13 05
3 COUPLING - ROMAC - RFCA - 6in FBEC - SS HARDWARE
3 REDUCER - 316 SS - ECCENTRIC - 6in X 4in
3 GASKET - FLANGE - 4in X 1/8in
1 BARREL - 10ft DIA X 3ft H
1 BARREL - 10ft DIA X 4ft H
2 BARREL - 10ft DIA X 5ft H
1 TOP SLAB ASSEMBLY
1 HATCH - WW - 10ft H20 - TRIPLEX - 54800 - 46 X 109
1 TOP SLAB - WW - 10ft H20 - TRIPLEX
4 CABLE HANGER ASSEMBLY
1 DEFLECTOR PANEL ASSEMBLY - 4ft
1 GUILLOTINE CABLE ASSEMBLY - 14ft
1 HDPE - 24in X 24in X 1/2in - BLACK - cut from 4ft x 8ft
2 BRACKET - SS GUILLOTINE SET
1 HDPE - 4ft X 8ft X 1-2in - BLACK
8 ANGLE - 316SS 11GA FORMED (10ftww)
2 DISCHARGE PIPE SUPPORT - WALL BRACKET SET
3 DISCHARGE CLAMP - U-BOLT - 6in 316SS
3 DISCHARGE CLAMP BOLT - 1-2 X 1 SS BOLT, WASHER, FIBER LOCK NUT
1 DISCHARGE PIPE SUPPORT - BOLT KIT
1 SHIPPING CRATE
5 BARREL GASKET
1 HATCH KEY
3 BRACKET - UPPER GUIDE BAR - 2in SS
4 LIFTING CLUTCH - 8 TON
3 BOLT & NUT KIT - UPPER GUIDE BAR BRACKET - 3-8in
3 BOW SHACKLE - 3-8in - SS W-SCREW PIN
3 BOW SHACKLE - 1-2in - SS W-SCREW PIN
1 GRIP EYE UNIT
3 CORD GRIP - 1.25in - 1.49 DIA SS
3 LIFTING SLING - .125in SS CABLE - 3 @ 20ft
6 CHAIN - S5 9-32in 316SS 3 @ 2ft
3.01 ROMTEC UTILITIES SCOPE OF SUPPLY: PRODUCTS
3 GASKET - FLANGE - 6in X 1/8in
196 TAPECOAT - 6in X .65mils X LFT
217.5 SEALANT - 1in X 1in X 14.5ft CS-202
1 NEVER SIEZE - TUBE
4 FLOAT - NOLTA - MS1 - 20m
1 ULTRASONIC TRANSDUCER - XPS-15
1 BRACKET - TRANSDUCER - HANGING
1 HANGING BRACKET - 16in - SS
1 DISCHARGE PIPE BRACKET - 10ft WW - 6in PIPE
3 PUMP - FLYGT - NP3171 HT 452 30HP
7 PIPE - 316SS - 6in SCH40 (1 @ 82in)
33 PIPE - 316SS - 6in SCH40 (3 @ 11ft)
15 PIPE - 316SS - 6in SCH40 (2 @ 86in)
114 PIPE - 316SS - 2in SCH40 (6 @ 19ft)
4 KOR-N-SEAL - 8in CORE -1.70 THRU 4.80 PIPE
3 KOR-N-SEAL - 12in CORE - 6in PIPE
6 FLANGE - 316SS - 6in - 150# WELD NECK
3 ELBOW - 316SS - 6in - 90 DEG - SHORT
2 COUPLING - 4in SCH40 - SLP X SLIP
20 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 20ft TOTAL
1 JUNCTION BOX ASSEMBLY
1 BASE - VV - 444B X 30in TALL
1 HATCH - FLOODTIGHT - H20 - 24X30
1 TOP SLAB -VV - 444 - H20
21 SEALANT - .75in X .75in X 21ft CS-202
17 TAPECOAT - 6in X .65mils X LFT
1 ADALET ENCLOSURE - EXPLOSION PROOF
1 ADALET ENCLOSURE - LEVEL SENSING
1 JUNCTION BOX SUPPORT BRACKET
3 CONDUIT UNIONS - 1-1/2in
3 CABLE GLANDS FOR UNARMORED CABLES - 1-1/2inNPT, 1.16n - 1.5in
5 SEAL OFFS - 40% FILL - 1in NPT
2 PLASTIC BUSHING 1in
4 CABLE CONNECTORS NYLON 1/2in HUBS - .062 - .125
5 NIPPLE - GALV - 1in X 3in
1 CABLE CONNECTORS NYLON 1/2in HUBS - .250 - .375
4 SEALING LOCK NUT - 1in
5 LOCKNUT - 1-1/2in
QTY ITEM
1 REDUCER - CONCENTRIC - 12in X 6in - 150LB - 316SS
1 EXTERIOR COATING - TNEMEC 61
1 BASE - VV - 6ft X 8ft
2 RISER - VV - 6 x 8 - 1 FT
1 HATCH - VV - 687 - H20 - 44 X 68
1 TOP SLAB - 6 X 8 - H20
3.01 ROMTEC UTILITIES SCOPE OF SUPPLY: PRODUCTS
3 PIPE STAND - 6in - S89 FLG - NO BASE
3 PIPE STAND - 6in - S92 SAD - NO BASE
2 VALVE KEY BRACKET
1 VALVE KEY - SPECIAL SWIVEL
10 PIPE - 316SS - 2in SCH40
1 NIPPLE - BRASS - 1/2in X 2in
1 NIPPLE - 1-4in - BRASS - CLOSE
1 BUSHING - BRASS - 1-2in MALE X 1-4in FEMALE THD
1 VALVE - BALL - 1/2in BRASS - 1/4 TURN
3 MECHANICAL INDICATOR - 6in
1 CAM LOCK - 6in MIPTXM - 316SS
1 DUST CAP - 6in 316SS CAMLOCK
1 BACKFLOW ACTUATOR - 4in & 6in
1 VALVE - PLUG - 6in - WITH HANDWHEEL
3 VALVE - SWING CHECK - 6in - 506A
3 VALVE - PLUG - 6in - GEAR OP
6 COUPLING - ROMAC - RFCA - 6in FBEC - SS HARDWARE
6 KOR-N-SEAL - 12in CORE - 6in PIPE
1 FLANGE - 316SS - 6in - COMPANION W-6in TAP
2 SPOOL - FLG X PE - 6in X 26in - 316SS
1 SPOOL - FLG X PE - 6in X 36in - 316SS
1 SPOOL - FLG X FLG - 6in X 92.25in - 316SS
3 WYE - 316SS - 12in X 6in - FLG
3 ELBOW - 316SS - 6in - 45 DEG - FLG X FLG
2 ELBOW - 316SS - 6in - 90 DEG - FLG X FLG
3 GASKET - FLANGE - 12in X 1/8in
14 GASKET - FLANGE - 6in X 1/8in
130.5 SEALANT - 1in X 1in X 14.5ft CS-202
1 PRESSURE TRANSDUCER - ASHCROFT - 1/4in NPT
1 PRESSURE TRANSDUCER ISOLATOR
QTY ITEM
1 BASE - VV - 444B
4 RISER - VV - 444 - 1 FT
1 HATCH - FLOODTIGHT - H20 - 24X30
1 TOP SLAB -VV - 444 - H20
2 PIPE STAND - 12in - S92 SAD - NO BASE
1 PIPE - 316SS - 12in X 48 IN
1 FLOW TUBE - 12in - ABB WATER MASTER
2 MEGAFLANGE ADAPTER - 12in - SERIES2100
2 KOR-N-SEAL - 16in CORE - 12in PIPE
1 SPOOL - FLG X PE - 12in X 60in - SCH40 316SS
1 GASKET - FLANGE - 12in X 1/8in
105 SEALANT - .75in X .75in X 21ft CS-202
85 TAPECOAT - 6in X .65mils X LFT
3.01 ROMTEC UTILITIES SCOPE OF SUPPLY: PRODUCTS
1 NEVER SIEZE - TUBE
1 TRANSMITTER - ABB - IP68 RATED
1 SIGNAL CABLE - ABB - 100FT
GENERATOR
QTY ITEM
1 100KW DIESEL GENERATOR W/ 24 HOUR FUEL TANK
1 AUTOMATIC TRANSFER SWITCH
QTY ITEM
1 ENCLOSURE - INSULATED FIBERGLASS
1 BLOWER - EXPLOSION PROOF REGENERATIVE TYPE
2 NIPPLE - 316SS - 2in X 6in
2 NIPPLE - 316SS - 2in SCH40 X CLOSE
1 NIPPLE - 316SS - 2in SCH40 X 3.5in
2 NIPPLE - 316SS - 2in X CLOSE
1 BUSHING - 316SS - 2in FEMALE X 1in MALE THD
1 BUSHING - 316SS - 1in MALE THD X 1-8in FEMALE THD
2 HOSE FITTING - PUSH X MALE THD - 1-8in
1 HOSE - NYLON - 1-8in - 2ft
2 BUSHING - SS - 4inX2in
2 UNION - 316SS - 2in
2 FLANGE - PVC- 4in SCH40 - 150# - SOC
2 SPOOL - FLG X PE - 4in X 24in - 316SS - 4in FTHD X 4in FLG
4 ELBOW - 316SS - 2in - 90 DEG - - THREADED
1 TEE - 316SS - 2in - THREADED
2 GASKET - FLANGE - 4in X 1/8in
2 COUPLING - 4in SCH40 - SLP X SLIP
3 ELL; 4" PVC 90, SLIP X SLIP -SCH40
4 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 1 @ 48in
1 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 1 @ 12in
6 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 1 @ 72in
1 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 2 @ 6in
1 PRESSURE SWITCH
1 BASE - VAULT - PRECAST - 6ft6in X 10ft X 5ft10in - NO TOP SLAB
3 CAP - PVC - 4in SCH40
3 TEE - PVC - 4in SCH40 - SLIP
3 COUPLING - PVC - 4in SCH40 - 150# - SOC
5 ELBOW - PVC - 4in SCH40 - 90 DEG - SLIP X SLIP
3 4in PVC - SCH 40 X 24in
8 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH80 X 2 @ 48in
9 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH80 X 3 @ 36in
3.01 ROMTEC UTILITIES SCOPE OF SUPPLY: PRODUCTS
1 CROSS - PVC - 4in - SCH40
24 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 X 3 @ 96in - PERFORATED
3 CAP - THREADED - PVC - 4in - SCH40
QTY ITEM
1 Arc Armor Duplex PLC Control Panel w/VFD's and Flow Meter
1 Meltrics Generator Receptacle for connection to standby power.
1 Motorola ACE3600 PLC/RTU
3.02 WET WELL
This section contains information pertaining to the Wet Well. There is both technical
information and related drawings necessary for the Wet Well construction.
5'
2.5'
0
Company Name
Contact:
(555) 555-5555
File #: 000000
customername@companyname.com
John Doe
C1
SITE PLAN
Parts List
ITEM QTY STOCK NUMBER DESCRIPTION
INVERT ELEVATION - 89.32' 1 1 10-XXXX INTERIOR COATING - TNEMEC 61
INFLUENT SEWER (BY OTHERS) 2 1 10-XXXX EXTERIOR COATING - TNEMEC 61
15in HDPE DR11 3 1 10-XXXX BASE ASSEMBLY
3.1 1 10-5364 GROUT RING - 10ft - 45 DEG
8 3.2 1 10-XXXX BASE - WW - 10ft - RU FLAT BASE - NO GROUT- 6in UPLIFT
33 1/2 7'-0" COLLAR
15 3.3 3 31-6040 ANCHOR KIT - DISCHARGE ELBOW
18 3.4 3 31-6071 DISCHARGE ELBOW - 4in - 540 13 05
21 13.16 46" X 109" CLEAR 3.5 3 42-5247 COUPLING - ROMAC - RFCA - 6in FBEC - SS HARDWARE
HATCH OPENING
3.6 3 44-XXXX REDUCER - 316 SS - ECCENTRIC - 6in X 4in
13.17 3.7 3 47-6546 GASKET - FLANGE - 4in X 1/8in
VALVE VAULT REFERENCE
4 1 12-4613 BARREL - 10ft DIA X 3ft H
DRAWING ONLY: SEE VALVE
VAULT COMPONENT 25 5 1 12-4614 BARREL - 10ft DIA X 4ft H
30 1/8 20
DRAWING (SECTION 10) 24 6 2 12-5905 BARREL - 10ft DIA X 5ft H
FOR VALVE VAULT DETAILS 7 1 14-XXXX TOP SLAB ASSEMBLY
AND PARTS LIST 7.1 1 13-5380 HATCH - WW - 10ft H20 - TRIPLEX - 54800 - 46 X 109
20 ODOR CONTROL CONNECTION 7.2 1 14-5382 TOP SLAB - WW - 10ft H20 - TRIPLEX
30 1/8 16 FROM MULCH BED DRAIN: APPROX. 98.04' 7.3 4 18-6115 CABLE HANGER ASSEMBLY
20' TOTAL SUPPLY OF 4" PVC 8 1 15-4591 DEFLECTOR PANEL ASSEMBLY - 4ft
(BOTH CONNECTIONS) 8.1 1 15-5365 GUILLOTINE CABLE ASSEMBLY - 14ft
25 24 CORED HOLE TO BE BY OTHERS 8.2 1 15-6042 HDPE - 24in X 24in X 1/2in - BLACK - cut from 4ft x 8ft
18 IN THE FIELD (FIELD FIT TO CORRECT
8.3 2 15-6047 BRACKET - SS GUILLOTINE SET
21 ORIENTATION)
8.4 1 50-6045 HDPE - 4ft X 8ft X 1-2in - BLACK
17 1/2 8.5 8 50-6139 ANGLE - 316SS 11GA FORMED (10ftww)
6' X 8' VALVE VAULT ASSEMBLY 9 2 18-6009 DISCHARGE PIPE SUPPORT - WALL BRACKET SET
ODOR CONTROL CONNECTION 10 3 18-XXXX DISCHARGE CLAMP - U-BOLT - 6in 316SS
SEE SHEET M2 12 11 10 14 FROM BLOWER: APPROX. 100.08'
4'-0" 11 3 18-FAST DISCHARGE CLAMP BOLT - 1-2 X 1 SS BOLT, WASHER, FIBER
4'-0" 20' TOTAL SUPPLY OF
LOCK NUT
4" PVC (BOTH CONNECTIONS)
CORED HOLE TO BE BY OTHERS 12 1 18-FAST DISCHARGE PIPE SUPPORT - BOLT KIT
IN THE FIELD (FIELD FIT TO CORRECT 13 1 18-XXXX SHIPPING CRATE
26 ORIENTATION) 13.1 5 12-ROM BARREL GASKET
13.2 1 13-ROM HATCH KEY
13.3 3 18-6015 BRACKET - UPPER GUIDE BAR - 2in SS
THIS CONTAINS
ITEMS 26.1 - 26.17 13.4 4 18-6020 LIFTING CLUTCH - 8 TON
13.5 3 18-6031 BOLT & NUT KIT - UPPER GUIDE BAR BRACKET - 3-8in
13.6 3 32-5942 BOW SHACKLE - 3-8in - SS W-SCREW PIN
13.7 3 32-5943 BOW SHACKLE - 1-2in - SS W-SCREW PIN
NOTE: WET WELL TOP SLAB IS H-20 OCCASIONAL TRAFFIC RATED 13.8 1 32-6016 GRIP EYE UNIT
13.9 3 32-6064 CORD GRIP - 1.25in - 1.49 DIA SS
THIS CONTAINS VALVE VAULT REFERENCE 13.10 3 32-6354 LIFTING SLING - .125in SS CABLE - 3 @ 20ft
ITEMS 26.1 - 26.17 DRAWING ONLY: SEE VALVE 7.1 13.11 6 32-6600 CHAIN - S5 9-32in 316SS 3 @ 2ft
VAULT COMPONENT 13.12 3 47-6547 GASKET - FLANGE - 6in X 1/8in
26 DRAWING (SECTION 10) 13.13 196 51-5949 TAPECOAT - 6in X .65mils X LFT
FOR VALVE VALULT DETAILS 7 13.19
7.2 7.3 13.14 217.5 51-6081 SEALANT - 1in X 1in X 14.5ft CS-202
AND PARTS LIST
RIM & FINISHED GRADE 13.15 1 51-ROM NEVER SIEZE - TUBE
ELEVATION - 102.25' 13.16 4 60-4574 FLOAT - NOLTA - MS1 - 20m
7.2 13.17 1 60-5044 ULTRASONIC TRANSDUCER - XPS-15
13.18 1 62-4561 BRACKET - TRANSDUCER - HANGING
13.19 1 62-4564 HANGING BRACKET - 16in - SS
14 1 18-XXXX DISCHARGE PIPE BRACKET - 10ft WW - 6in PIPE
13.14 13.13 5 13.3 15 3 30-5500 PUMP - FLYGT - NP3171 HT 452 30HP
13.17
16 7 40-6049 PIPE - 316SS - 6in SCH40 (1 @ 82in)
16 22 17 33 40-6049 PIPE - 316SS - 6in SCH40 (3 @ 11ft)
16
DRAIN BACK TO WET WELL: 18 15 40-6049 PIPE - 316SS - 6in SCH40 (2 @ 86in)
ODOR CONTROL CONNECTION
3" PLAIN HOLE IN VAULT 23 FROM MULCH BED DRAIN: APPROX. 98.04' 19 114 40-6253 PIPE - 316SS - 2in SCH40 (6 @ 19ft)
(PROVIDED) 1 20' TOTAL SUPPLY OF 4" PVC 20 4 43-5186 KOR-N-SEAL - 8in CORE -1.70 THRU 4.80 PIPE
2" PEE TRAP ON VAULT END (BOTH CONNECTIONS) 21 3 43-6113 KOR-N-SEAL - 12in CORE - 6in PIPE
13.14 13.13 6 WITH CHECK VALVE AT END OF CORED HOLE TO BE BY OTHERS 22 6 44-6123 FLANGE - 316SS - 6in - 150# WELD NECK
PIPE IN WET WELL. 2 IN THE FIELD (FIELD FIT TO CORRECT
(BY OTHERS) NOT ROMTEC UTILITIES 17 23 3 46-XXXX ELBOW - 316SS - 6in - 90 DEG - SHORT
21 ORIENTATION)
19 24 2 48-4297 COUPLING - 4in SCH40 - SLP X SLIP
25 20 48-5464 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 20ft TOTAL
20'-0" 20 8 26 1 65-XXXX JUNCTION BOX ASSEMBLY
C.L. DISCHARGE
ELEVATION - 95.32' 26.1 1 20-4875 BASE - VV - 444B X 30in TALL
26.2 1 23-4713 HATCH - FLOODTIGHT - H20 - 24X30
26.3 1 24-4716 TOP SLAB -VV - 444 - H20
INVERT ELEVATION - 89.32'
26.4 21 51-5510 SEALANT - .75in X .75in X 21ft CS-202
12 11 10 14 INFLUENT SEWER (BY OTHERS)
26.5 17 51-5949 TAPECOAT - 6in X .65mils X LFT
15in HDPE DR11
13.14 13.13 6 26.6 1 61-4851 ADALET ENCLOSURE - EXPLOSION PROOF
26.7 1 61-4852 ADALET ENCLOSURE - LEVEL SENSING
26.8 1 62-XXXX JUNCTION BOX SUPPORT BRACKET
SENSOR AND ELEVATION TABLE
26.9 3 62-XXXX CONDUIT UNIONS - 1-1/2in
13.14 13.13 4 LEVEL ELEVATION DISTANCE BETWEEN POINTS SET POINT DESCRIPTION 13.16
26.10 3 62-XXXX CABLE GLANDS FOR UNARMORED CABLES - 1-1/2inNPT, 1.16n -
89.32 INVERT IN
1.5in
93.75 BACK UP PUMPS START
3.1 26.11 5 62-5528 SEAL OFFS - 40% FILL - 1in NPT
3.50 SENSOR SPACING 3.5
26.12 2 62-XXXX PLASTIC BUSHING 1in
3.2 90.25 BACK UP PUMPS STOP 26.13 4 62-XXXX CABLE CONNECTORS NYLON 1/2in HUBS - .062 - .125
0.25 SENSOR SPACING 26.14 5 62-XXXX NIPPLE - GALV - 1in X 3in
3.6 WELL FLOOR ELEVATION - 82.25'
90.00 BACK UP HL ALARM 26.15 1 62-XXXX CABLE CONNECTORS NYLON 1/2in HUBS - .250 - .375
89.75 HIGH LEVEL ALARM/LAG LAG 26.16 4 62-XXXX SEALING LOCK NUT - 1in
0.50 SENSOR SPACING 26.17 5 62-XXXX LOCKNUT - 1-1/2in
12.00
89.25 LAG PUMP START 3.4 10'-0" ALL MATERIALS SHOWN ON THIS SHEET WILL BE
15 13.6 13.9 13.10 13.11 13.8 13.7 SUPPLIED BY ROMTEC UTILITIES AND DELIVERED TO
0.50 SENSOR SPACING INSIDE DIAMETER THE SITE AFTER THE HOLE HAS BEEN EXCAVATED
AND SHORED. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL SUPPLY A
88.75 LEAD PUMP START CRANE OF SUFFICIENT SIZE TO LOWER ALL THE
M1
$FILENAME$
Contact:
Project #:
$USER$
$DATE$
$TIME$
CFile #:
10-14-11
3.02.4 WET WELL DATA SHEETS
APPLICATIONS
For self-sealing joints in: Manholes, Concrete Vaults, Septic Tanks, Concrete Pipe,
Box Culverts, Utility Vaults, Burial Vaults, and Vertical Panel Structures.
SEALING PROPERTIES
HYDROSTATIC STRENGTH
SPECIFICATIONS
1
P R O D U C T S P E C I F I C A T I O N S
PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
Spec Required* CS-202
Hydrocarbon blend content % by ASTM D4 (mod.) 50% min. 52%
weight
Inert mineral filler % by weight AASHTO T111 30% min. 35%
Volatile Matter % by weight ASTM D6 2% max. 1.2
Specific Gravity, 77°F ASTM D71 1.15-1.50 1.20
Ductility, 77°F ASTM D113 5.0 min. 12
Penetration, cone 77°F, 150 gm. 5 ASTM D217 50-100 60-65
sec.
Penetration, cone 32°F, 150 gm. 5 ASTM D217 40 mm 50-55
sec.
Flash Point, C.O.C., °F ASTM D92 350°F min. 425°F
Fire point, C.O.C., °F ASTM D92 375°F min. 450°F
IMMERSION TESTING
2
ROMTEC UTILITIES RECOMMENDATION FOR USE AS JOINT TAPE
PAVEMENT REPAIR
COATING
Protection for Concrete and Asphalt Surfaces
Surface Preparation
Tapecoat M860 should be applied over dry pavement
that is free of dirt, debris or other foreign matter.
Pavement cracks wider than 3/8” should be pre-filled
with hot or cold crack material prior to applying
Tapecoat M860 to assure longer protection of the crack
filling material against surface wear.
Option
If the application is taking place in extreme cold (below
32˚F/O˚C) a liquid primer will enhance the immediate
bond. TC Omniprime is the compatible primer for use
with this product.
FLEXIBLE PIPE-TO-
MANHOLE CONNECTORS
SPECIFICATION SHEET
Stainless Steel
Stainless Steel
Korband
Pipe Clamp
Install - Wedge Korband with Socket Install Wedge Korband with Standard Install Pipe Clamp(s)
Wrench & Torque Limiter Torque Wrench with T-Handle Torque Wrench
02/06
Flexible Pipe-to-Manhole Connectors
SPECIFICATION SHEET
PERFORMANCE
Test ASTM Method Test Requirements Kor-N-Seal ® I & II
Head Pressure C923 - 7.1 0° - 13 psi (30 ft) for 10 min. +13 psi for 10 min.
7° - 10 psi (23 ft) for 10 min. +10 psi for 10 min.
Deflection Test C923 - 7.2.2 7° in any direction Over 7° in any direction
Load Test C923 - 7.2.3 150 lbs/in. pipe dia. Over 150 lbs/in. pipe dia.
Performed on all standard sizes of Kor-N-Seal Connectors.
Accelerated Oven-Aging D573 70 ± 1°C for 7 days Decrease of 15%, max. of original 10.1% tensile decrease
tensile strength, decrease of 14.0% elongation decrease
20% max. of elongation
Compression Set D395, method B, at 70°C Decrease of 25%, max. 13% decrease
for 22 h of original deflection
Water Absorption D471, immerse 0.75 by 2-in. Increase of 10%, max. .8% increase
specimen in distilled of original by weight
water at 70°C for 48 h
INTERNAL KORBAND
Conforms to ASTM C923, ASTM A666, and A240
– Korband Assembly is manufactured of 300 series stainless steel.
– Toggle Expander is made of 300 series stainless steel.
– The 106/406 series Wedge Expander is made from reinforced nylon or 300 series stainless steel.
– The 206/306 series Wedge Expander is made from 300 series stainless steel.
05/06
Pipe-to-Manhole Connector Technical
Specification
Scope:
This specification describes the function of the NPC Kor-N-Seal pipe-to-manhole connector, its
principle of operation, and the component materials that constitute the Kor-N-Seal connector,
and their physical properties.
Product Application:
NPC Kor-N-Seal connectors are designed and manufactured to meet or exceed the requirements
of ASTM C-923 "Standard Specification for Resilient Connectors Between Reinforced Concrete
Manhole Structures, Pipes and Laterals". This specification requires the connector to provide a
watertight seal under the following conditions:
Principle of Operation:
The connector creates a watertight seal between the pipe and
manhole by first sealing to the inside of the cored or formed hole
in the manhole and then sealing to the outside of the pipe. See
illustration at right.
The seal at the outside of the pipe is created by the stainless steel
pipe clamp(s). The pipe clamp is located on the outside of the
connector. Once the pipe has been positioned in the connector the
diameter of the pipe clamp is decreased. This compresses the
connector against the outside wall of the pipe creating a watertight
seal at the pipe.
4. Tighten Wedge Expander using 1/2" [13 mm] socket with a preset torque limiter 10 – 24 12 91440-12
for each. For each size connector use torque limiter preset to proper torque. [254 – 610] [16]
(Fig. 4) Retorquing is not required prior to shipment.
Fig. 4
CAUTION: DO NOT USE IMPACT WRENCH.
Inner wall
Korband
Outer Wall
PIPE INSTALLATION:
1. Center pipe in Connector opening.
2. On maximum pipe O.D. installations, use a pipe lubricant on the outside barrel of the pipe and/or the inside
ridges of the Connector (under the Pipe Clamp area) to allow the pipe to slide into place more easily.
3. Position the Pipe Clamp in the Connector's Pipe Clamp groove with the screw at the top.
4. Tighten the Pipe Clamp screw to 60 inch pounds [7 Newton Meters] with a T-handle Torque Wrench, P/N 80090.
5. On minimum pipe O.D. installations, lift the rubber up underneath the Pipe Clamp screw so that the Connector
contacts the bottom surface of the pipe while the Pipe Clamp screw is being tightened. Application of pipe
lubrication on the underside of the clamp will also help assure that an even contraction of rubber is maintained
throughout the clamping area.
6. After the Pipe Clamp has been tightened down firmly, move the pipe horizontally and/or vertically to bring
it to grade.
CAUTION:
All capped stubs awaiting pipe installation at a later date must
be restrained. Assure that a proper backfill material is used in
adverse conditions. Prior to any critical usage, contact NPC
Customer service at 1-800-626-2180.
STAINLESS STEEL WEDGE
A B C
S106 Series
Hole Size Range Connector Dimensions
Connector Suggested Pipe Pipe Clamp
Inches Inches
P/N O.D. Range P/N
Inches A B C D
S406 Series
S406-10AWS 6.00 — 6.75 10.00 — 10.20 8.30 6.50 6 I-128
S406-10WS 7.50 — 8.20 10.00 — 10.20 8.30 8.50 6 I-180
S406-10.5AWS 6.00 — 6.75 10.50 — 10.70 8.80 6.50 6 I-128
S406-10.5WS 7.50 — 8.70 10.50 — 10.70 8.80 8.50 6 I-180
S406-11BWS 6.00 — 7.00 11.00 — 11.20 9.30 6.00 6 I-128
S406-11AWS 7.50 — 9.00 11.00 — 11.20 9.30 8.00 6 I-180
S406-12CWS 6.00 — 7.00 12.00 — 12.20 10.30 6.50 6 I-128
S406-12BWS 6.25 — 7.50 12.00 — 12.20 10.30 7.00 6 I-128
S406-12AWS 7.50 — 9.00 12.00 — 12.20 10.30 8.50 6 I-180
S406-12WS 9.00 — 10.20 12.00 — 12.20 10.30 10.00 6 I-180
Suggested pipe O.D. range comes from field experience. Refer to Recommended Pipe Installation Procedure.
08/06
CONNECTORS FOR SMALL DIAMETER PIPE
T-bolts and Nuts: High strength low alloy steel T-head bolt. National
coarse rolled thread and heavy hex nut. Steel meets AWWA C111
composition specifications. Stainless steel bolts and nuts avail-
able on request.
Use: Ductile Iron Pipe 3 - 24", cast iron pipe 3" - 24" (same OD's as
ductile iron) and IPS size STD steel pipe 3 - 12".
Not for use on PVC, HDPE pipe or
plain-end mechanical joint fittings.
To Order: Specify catalog number. Example: For a 12" RFCA Order: RFCA - 13.20 For applications on PVC, please
NOTE: 3" - 12" special Romac gasket works on both steel and D.I. ODs. contact your Romac representative.
LIST PRICE
NOM. GASKET GLAND CATALOG WEIGHT
PIPE RANGE LENGTH BOLTS NUMBER (lbs.)
Shopcoat Shopcoat Fusion Epoxy Fusion Epoxy
SIZE QTY: SIZE
w/Std. B&N w/304 SS B&N w/Std. B&N w/304SS B&N
3" 3.50-3.96 8.00" 4: 5/8" x 3" RFCA - 3.96 $145.45 $157.56 $165.10 $177.20 21
4" 4.50-4.80 9.00" 4: 3/4" x 3 1/2" RFCA -4.80 183.32 209.43 207.88 233.99 29
6" 6.63-6.90 9.25" 6: 3/4" x 4" RFCA - 6.90 233.85 273.01 267.10 306.26 40
8" 8.63-9.05 9.25" 6: 3/4" x 4" RFCA - 9.05 315.59 354.75 355.82 394.98 53
10" 10.75-11.10 10.25 8: 3/4" x 4" RFCA - 11.10 581.96 634.17 669.69 721.91 83
12" 12.75-13.20 10.25" 8: 3/4" x 4" RFCA - 13.20 632.13 684.34 739.86 792.07 110
14" 15.30 11.70" 10: 3/4" x 4 1/2" RFCA -15.30 882.79 947.37 1,020.54 1,085.12 170
16" 17.40 11.70" 12: 3/4" x 4 1/2" RFCA -17.40 1,225.93 1,302.91 1,410.23 1,487.21 200
18" 19.50 11.80" 12: 3/4" x 4 1/2" RFCA -19.50 1,346.63 1,423.60 1,546.13 1,623.10 217
20" 21.60 11.80 14: 3/4" x 4 1/2" RFCA - 21.60 1,521.19 1,611.94 1,772.94 1,863.69 256
24" 25.80 12.00" 16: 3/4" x 5" RFCA - 25.80 1,845.38 1,959.61 2,130.38 2,244.61 305
Some initial axial movement may occur in lug style restraints as the lugs seat. Movement is directly related to the size of the piping system
and the system pressure. In general terms movement of approximately 0.25" can be expected in restraints under 16”. For larger sizes,
movement of approximately 0.4” may be seen. If this is critical to your application please contact Romac Engineering for
additional information.
3-6
INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
Read installation instructions first before installing. Check parts to ensure that no damage has occurred during transit and that no
parts are missing. Also check the diameter of the pipe and the size marked on the coupling to ensure you have the proper size.
Step 5 • Place gasket over pipe with beveled edge toward Note:
the flange adapter. 90 ft-lbs. torque = 12" wrench w/90 lbs. force
Step 6 • Slide the RFCA on to For best results, wait 10 minutes and
the pipe. Position the pipe and 6 retighten bolts to proper torque.
flanged coupling against the
mating flange, inserting Step 10 • Hand tighten the restrainer bolts until the re-
flange gasket (14" and straining pads touch the
larger) between the flange
faces. Assemble the flange
surface of the pipe. 10
The bolts should
joint using flange bolts. be tightened in a
uniform criss-
7 cross pattern,
Step 7 • The pipe should until the
10/31/2007
PRECAUTIONS
1. Check flange to make sure the bolt holes match the RFCA.
2. Make sure a flange gasket is used between the mating flanges on sizes 14" and larger.
3. Check diameter of pipe to make sure you are using the correct size RFCA; also check gasket to make sure it is the
size you think it is.
4. Be sure to clean pipe of as much dirt and corrosion as possible in the area that the gasket will seal.
5. Lubricate both the gasket and the pipe end with soapy water or approved pipe lubricant per ANSI/AWWA C111/
A21.11.
6. Make sure no foreign materials lodge between gasket and pipe.
7. Avoid loose fitting wrenches, or wrenches too short to achieve proper torque.
8. Keep threads free of foreign material to allow proper tightening.
9. Take extra care to follow proper bolt tightening procedures and torque recommendations. Bolts are often not tightened
enough when a torque wrench is not used.
10. Be sure that the gland is centered around the pipe.
11. Pressure test for leaks before backfilling.
12. Backfill and compact carefully around pipe and fittings.
13. Some initial axial movement may occur in lug style restraints as the lugs seat. Movement is directly related
to the size of the piping system and the system pressure. In general terms movement of approximately
0.25" can be expected in restraints under 16”. For larger sizes, movement of approximately 0.4” may be seen. If
this is critical to your application please contact Romac Engineering for additional information.
3. To reassemble, follow installation procedures. Tighten the restraining bolts using a 5/8" hex wrench to 75-ft-lbs
minimum.
Pre-
Lubricated
Gasket
No gasket “roll” or “twist” dur- Elimination of Joint Kick Back, Pipe sizes to 144” can be accom-
ing coupling is another benefit of is caused by the rearward locking modated.
the unique lamell/rolling tube de- action of the serrations as the tube
sign, which reduces the insertion rolls forward
force required. Manual coupling of
up to 36” pipe is possible. Bell and Spigot protection under
deflection is accomplished by the
cushioning effect of the tube, as it
rests within the annular space.
INSTALLATION MATERIALS
Ensure Bell, Spigot and Gasket are free from loose debris or foreign mate- Tylox® SuperSeal™ gaskets* are avail-
rial. able in the following materials:
•Isoprene
Stretch the gasket around the spigot, with the nose against the step, and the Optional Materials
tube laying flat against the spigot. DO NOT LUBRICATE. •Nitrile (Oil Resistant)
•Isoprene / EPDM blend
(Green Book & C425)
•Neoprene (Oil and Ozone
Resistant)
SPECIFICATIONS
Align the spigot with the bell, and thrust the spigot home using suitable gaskets* are manufactured to meet
mechanical means. The homing process will cause the lubricated tube to the material requirements of the
“roll” over itself, above the compression section, allowing the pipe to slide following speci-fications:
forward.
•ASTM C361, C425, &
C443
•AASHTO M198.4
•CSA A257
•“Green Book”
Other specifications may be avail-
able as special order. Please consult
your Hamilton Kent agent for your
specific requirements.
Once fully homed, the compression section seals the total annular space; the
rolling tube comes to rest within the small annular space - acting as a cushion CONTACT US
against side loads, and the serrations act to resist pipe pull-out.
Customer Name
Company Name
111 Company Address
City, State Zip Code
(555) 555-5555
customername@companyname.com
Lit_TSS_0601_ER4
PRODUCT DATA SHEET
TNEME-LINER SERIES 61
PRODUCT PROFILE
COATING SYSTEM
SURFACE PREPARATION
STEEL Immersion Service: SSPC-SP10/NACE 2 Near-White Blast Cleaning obtaining a minimum angular anchor profile of 2.0 mils
(50 microns).
CONCRETE Allow new concrete to cure for 28 days. Abrasive blast referencing SSPC-SP13/NACE 6, ICRI-CSP3-5 Surface Preparation of
Concrete and Tnemec’s Surface Preparation and Application Guide.
ALL SURFACES Must be clean, dry and free of oil, grease and other contaminants.
TECHNICAL DATA
APPLICATION
Published technical data and instructions are subject to change without notice. The online catalog at www.tnemec.com
should be referenced for the most current technical data and instructions or you may contact your Tnemec representative Page 1 of 2
for current technical data and instructions.
PRODUCT DATA SHEET
| SERIES 61
COVERAGE RATES For JP-4, JP-5, JP-8
Aviation Gas, Jet A-1 Service
Dry Mils (Microns) Wet Mils (Microns) Sq Ft/Gal (m²/Gal)
Suggested 5.0 (125) 6.0 (150) 263 (24.4)
Minimum 4.0 (100) 5.0 (125) 329 (30.6)
Maximum 6.0 (150) 7.5 (190) 219 (20.4)
Allow for overspray and surface irregularities. Film thickness is rounded to the nearest 0.5 mil or 5 microns. Application of
coating below minimum or above maximum recommended dry film thicknesses may adversely affect coating
performance. †
MIXING Power mix contents of each container, making sure no pigment remains on the bottom. Pour a measured amount of Part
B into a clean container large enough to hold both components. Add an equal volume of Part A to Part B while under
agitation. Continue agitation until the two components are thoroughly mixed. Do not use mixed material beyond pot life
limits. Note: Both components must be above 60°F (16°C) prior to mixing. Mixing ratio is one to one by volume. A large
volume of material will set up quickly if not applied or reduced in volume. Caution: Do not reseal mixed material. An
explosion hazard may be created.
THINNING Use No. 2 Thinner. For air spray, thin up to 10% or 12 oz (354 mL) per gallon. For airless spray or brush, thin up to 5% or
6 oz (177 mL) per gallon. Note: A maximum of 6% or 7 oz (207 mL) per gallon of No. 2 Thinner may be used to comply
with VOC regulations.
POT LIFE 2 1/2 hours at 60°F (16°C) 1 1/2 hours at 77°F (25°C) 45 minutes at 100°F (38°C)
APPLICATION EQUIPMENT Air Spray
Atomizing
Gun Fluid Tip Air Cap Air Hose ID Mat’l Hose ID Pot Pressure
Pressure
3/8” or 1/2”
5/16” or 3/8” 60-90 psi 10-20 psi
DeVilbiss JGA E 765 or 704 (9.5 or 12.7
(7.9 or 9.5 mm) (4.1-6.2 bar) (0.7-1.4 bar)
mm)
Low temperatures or longer hoses require higher pot pressure.
Airless Spray
Tip Orifice Atomizing Pressure Mat’l Hose ID Manifold Filter
0.015”-0.021” 3000-3800 psi 1/4” or 3/8” 60 mesh
(380-535 microns) (207-262 bar) (6.4 or 9.5 mm) (250 microns)
Use appropriate tip/atomizing pressure for equipment, applicator technique and weather conditions.
Brush: Recommended for small areas only. Use high quality natural or synthetic bristle brushes. Note: Two or more coats
may be required to obtain recommended film thicknesses.
SURFACE TEMPERATURE Minimum 60°F (16°C) Maximum 135°F (57°C)
The surface should be dry and at least 5°F (3°C) above the dew point. Coating will not cure below minimum surface
temperature.
CLEANUP Flush and clean all equipment immediately after use with the recommended thinner, xylol or MEK.
WARRANTY & LIMITATION OF SELLER'S LIABILITY: Tnemec Company, Inc. warrants only that its coatings represented herein meet the formulation standards of Tnemec Company, Inc. THE
WARRANTY DESCRIBED IN THE ABOVE PARAGRAPH SHALL BE IN LIEU OF ANY OTHER WARRANTY, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO, ANY IMPLIED
WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THERE ARE NO WARRANTIES THAT EXTEND BEYOND THE DESCRIPTION ON THE FACE HEREOF. The
buyer's sole and exclusive remedy against Tnemec Company, Inc. shall be for replacement of the product in the event a defective condition of the product should be found to exist and the
exclusive remedy shall not have failed its essential purpose as long as Tnemec is willing to provide comparable replacement product to the buyer. NO OTHER REMEDY (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES FOR LOST PROFITS, LOST SALES, INJURY TO PERSON OR PROPERTY, ENVIRONMENTAL INJURIES OR ANY OTHER INCIDENTAL
OR CONSEQUENTIAL LOSS) SHALL BE AVAILABLE TO THE BUYER. Technical and application information herein is provided for the purpose of establishing a general profile of the coating and
proper coating application procedures. Test performance results were obtained in a controlled environment and Tnemec Company makes no claim that these tests or any other tests, accurately
represent all environments. As application, environmental and design factors can vary significantly, due care should be exercised in the selection and use of the coating.
PDS61 Page 2 of 2
APPROV
316SS BRACKETS FASTENED TO GUILLOTINE PANEL.
DATE
BRACKETS HOOK OVER HDPE DEFLECTOR PANEL.
REVISION HISTORY
A
DESCRIPTION
.50
6.24
24.00
48.00
REV
1
DETAIL A
1"
SCALE 1 / 2
SCALES ACCORDINGLY
IF NOT ONE INCH ON
THIS SHEET, ADJUST
VERIFY SCALE
DATE - 2-11-14
DRN - AD
DSN - AD
CKD - AD
0
316SS CABLE ATTACHED TO EYE BOLT
ON HATCH.
n8.00
1/2" HDPE
1/2" X 1-1/2" 316SS STUDS
SHEET
1 OF 1
© 2013 ROMTEC INC. ALL RIGHTS RESERVED. THESE
PLANS AND DRAWINGS MAY NOT BE REPRODUCED, JOB NUMBER
ADAPTED, OR FURTHER DISTRIBUTED, AND NO
COMPONENTS MAY BE CONSTRUCTED FROM THESE RMTC
PLANS, WITHOUT WRITTEN PERMISSION OF ROMTEC, INC. 0000
3.03 PUMPS
This section provides the information pertaining to the pumps for this project.
[f t] Head
145
140
135
130
125
120
115
110
105
100
95
90
85
80 75.5%
75
70
65
60
55
50
45
454 270mm
40
35 Note: Picture might not correspond to the current configuration.
30
25
General
Patented self cleaning sem i-open channel im peller, ideal f or pum ping in
- waste water applications. Possible to be upgraded with Guide-pin®
20
f or ev en better clogging resistance. Modular based design with high
15 adaptation grade.
10
5
Impeller
0
Im peller m aterial Grey cast iron
0 400 800 1200 [US g.p.m.] Outlet width 3 15/16 inch
Inlet diam eter 150 m m
Curve according to: ISO 9906 grade 2 annex 1 or 2 Im peller diam eter 270 m m
N um ber of blades 2
0 inch
Installation: P - Semi permanent, Wet
M otor
Motor # N 3171.181 25-17-4AA-W 30hp
Stator v ariant 1
42 1/4 (TO FURTHEST POINT) Frequency 60 H z
REF.LINE **31 1/2/33 1/2
R ated v oltage 460 V
6 1/2 9 1/2
N um ber of poles 4
50Â
° Phas es 3~
R ated power 30 hp
10" 8 3/4
R ated current 36 A
Starting current 231 A
R ated speed 1755 rpm
18 3/4
**3 3/8/5 5/16 Power f actor
REF.LINE **22 1/8/24 1/8 1/1 Load 0.87
9 7/8 4 9/16 3/4 Load 0.83
1/2 Load 0.73
Ef f ic iency
2"/3" GUIDE BARS
1/1 Load 89.0 %
3/4 Load 90.0 %
Ø4" 1/2 Load 90.5 %
STD. CLASS 125
39 1/4
C.I. FLANGE
(NOM. SIZE)
MIN LEVEL
Configuration
15 3/4
*10 1/4
11"
3 3/8
2"
Z Z
2 3/4
Dimensional drwg
by
Sors by
070621
Sc ale Reg n o
8 Re d u c e d s i z e o f d x f fi l e fo r SPAIX
07082S
2 o rs 5399
Rev . n o Rev is o
i n Dat e Che c k ed
NP, FP 3171 HT
DRAWI NG Ø4 " 6599600 8
6 1/29 1/2
°
50Â
10" 8 3/4
**3 3/8/5 5/16 18 3/4
Ø4"
STD. CLASS 125
39 1/4
C.I. FLANGE
(NOM. SIZE)
MIN LEVEL
15 3/4
*10 1/4
11"
3 3/8
2"
Z Z
2 3/4
Dimensional drwg
by Sors by 070621
Scale Reg no
8 Reduced size of dxf file for SPAIX 070822 Sors 5399
AUTOCAD NP, FP3171HT
Rev.no Revision Date Checked DRAWING Ø4" 6599600 8
[ft] Head
140
130
120
110
100 100 ft
90
80 75.5%
70
60
50
40 454 270mm
30
20
10
[%]0
Efficiency 71.3 %
70
Total efficiency
60
454 270mm64.5 %
50 454 270mm
40
30
20
10
0
[hp] Shaft power P2 454 270mm (P1)
30 Power input P1 454 270mm (P2)
24.3 hp
25
20 22 hp
15
10
5
0
[ft] NPSH-values 454 270mm
35
30
25
20
17.8 ft
15 621.5 US g.p.m.
0 200 400 600 800 1000 1200 1400 1600 [US g.p.m.]
Curve according to: ISO 9906 grade 2 annex 1 or 2
[ft] Head
148
144
140
136
132
128
124
120
116
112
108
104
100 100 ft
96
92
88
84
75.5%
80
76
72
68
64
60
56
52
48
44
454 270mm
40
36
32
28
1
24
20
16
12
8
4
621.5 US g.p.m.
0
0 200 400 600 800 1000 1200 1400 1600 [US g.p.m.]
Curve according to: ISO 9906 grade 2 annex 1 or 2
Indiv idual pump Total
Pumps
running Specific
/System Flow Head Shaft power Flow Head Shaft power Hyd eff. energy NPSHre
1 621 US g.p.m. 100 ft 22 hp 621 US g.p.m. 100 ft 22 hp 71.3 % 487 kWh/US MG 17.8 ft
895383/05
3171.091.181
CONTENTS
Safety ____________________________ 2 Electrical connections ________________ 12
Data plate interpretation _______________ 4 Connection of stator and motor leads _________ 13
Sensor connections _______________________ 18
Guarantee _________________________ 5
Operation ______________________________ 22
Product description ____________________ 5
Before starting ____________________________ 22
Introduction _______________________________ 5
Application ________________________________ 5 Care and Maintenance _________________ 23
Motor data ________________________________ 6 Service/Inspection _________________________ 23
Changing the coolant ______________________ 25
Design of the pump _________________ 8 Removing the impeller _____________________ 26
Transportation and storage ____________ 9 Installing and setting clearance ______________ 27
Installation _________________________ 9 Removing the impeller - dry installation _______ 28
Installing and setting clearance - dry installation 28
Handling equipment ________________________ 9
Safety precautions _________________________ 10 Fault tracing ___________________________ 30
Installation alternatives _____________________ 10 Service log ____________________________ 33
SAFETY
This manual contains basic information on the installa- Qualifications of personnel
tion, operating and maintenance and should be followed An authorized (certified) electrician and mechanic shall
carefully. It is essential that these instructions are carry out all work.
carefully read before installation or commissioning by
both the installation crew as well as those responsible
for operation or maintenance. The operating instruc- Safety regulations for the owner/operator
tions should always be readily available at the location All government regulations, local health and safety
of the unit. codes shall be complied with.
All dangers due to electricity must be avoided (for
details consult the regulations of your local electricity
supply company).
Identification of safety and warning symbols
Unilateral modification and spare parts manu-
General Danger: facturing
Non-observance given to safety Modifications or changes to the unit/installation should
instructions in this manual, which only be carried out after consulting with Flygt.
could cause danger to life have Original spare parts and accessories authorized by the
been specifically highlighted with manufacturer are essential for compliance. The use of
this general danger symbol. other parts can invalidate any claims for warranty or
compensation.
2
3171.091.181
— Only Ex-approved pumps may be used in an — This equipment must be installed in conformity
explosive or flammable environment. to prescriptions in international or national
rules ( IEC/EN 60079-14 ).
— Do not open the pump when an explosive gas
atmosphere may be present. — The maintenance operation must be made in
conformity to the international or national stan-
— Before starting work on the pump, make sure dards ( IEC/EN 60079-17).
that the pump and the control panel are iso-
lated from the power supply and can not be — The yield stress of fastener elements in the
energized. This applies to the control circuit as product must be in conformity with the value
well. specified in the table for “Material of fastener”
on the approval drawing or the parts specified
— All mechanical work on the explosion-proof in the part list for the product.
motor section must be performed by personnel
authorized by Flygt. — According to the ATEX directive the Ex-pump
must never run dry or snore. Permitted mini-
— Electrical connection on the explosion-proof mum water level, see dimensional drawing for
motor must be made by authorized personnel. the pump.
— Thermal contacts must be connected to protec- Dry running at service and inspection is only
tion circuit intended for that purpose according permitted outside the Ex area.
to the approval of the product. — The user must know about the risks due the
— The pump may be used only in accordance electric current and the chemical and physical
with the approved motor data stated on the characteristics of the gas and/or vapours
data plates. present in hazardous areas.
— Intrinsically safe circuits are normally required — Flygt disclaims all responsibility for work done
(Ex i) for the automatic level control system by by untrained, unauthorized personnel.
level regulator if mounted in zone 0.
GUARANTEE
ITT Flygt undertakes to remedy faults in products sold — that genuine Flygt parts are used.
by Flygt provided: Hence, the guarantee does not cover faults caused by
— that the fault is due to defects in design, deficient maintenance, improper installation, incorrectly
materials or workmanship; executed repair work or nomal wear and tear.
— that the faults are reported to Flygt or Flygt's repre- Flygt assumes no liability for either bodily injuries,
sentative during the guarantee period; material damages or economic losses beyond what is
— that the product is used only under condition stated above.
described in the Installation, Care and Mainte- Flygt guarantees that spare parts will be kept for 15
nance manual and in applications for which it is years after that the manufacture of this product has
intended; been discontinued.
— that the monitoring equipment incorporated in
the product is correctly connected and in use;
— that all service and repair work is done by a
work shop authorized by Flygt;
3
3171.091.181
4
3171.091.181
PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
Introduction Recycling
Local and/or private laws and regulations regarding recy-
Thank you for buying a submersible Flygt pump. In cling must be followed. If there are no laws or regulations,
this Installation, Care and Maintenance manual you or the product is not accepted by an authorized recycling
will find general information on how to install and company, the product or it’s parts can be returned to the
service the 3171 pump to give it a long and reliable nearest Flygt sales company or service workshop.
life.
Application Weights
This Installation, Care and Maintenance manual
Weight including connections, but without motor cable in
applies to a submersible Flygt pump. If you have
bought an Ex-approved pump (please see approval kg (lb).
plate on your pump or Parts List) special handling Pump type With cooling Without Discharge
instructions apply as described in this document. jacket cooling connection
The pump is intended to be used for; jacket
— pumping of waste water NP 3171 LT 410 (904) 381 (840) 98 (216)
— pumping of raw or clean water NP 3171 MT 319 (703) 290 (640) 54 (119)
— pumping of sludge NP 3171 HT 297 (639) 268 (595) 42 (93)
NP 3171 SH 346 (763) 326 (719) 42 (43)
Installation alternatives NS 3171 LT 460 (1014)
P = semi permanent wet well arrangement with NS 3171 MT 352 (776)
pump installed by means of twin guide bars with NS 3171 HT 317 (699)
automatic connection to discharge. NS 3171 SH 366 (807)
*)
S = transportable version with hose connection or NT 3171 LT 525 (1157) 101 (223)
*)
flange for connection to discharge pipeline. NT 3171 MT 406 (895) 89 (196)
*)
NT 3171 HT 366 (807) 87 (191)
T = permanent dry well or in-line arrangement with *)
NT 3171 SH 415 (915) 87 (191)
flange connection to suction and discharge
NZ 3171 LT 485 (1069)
pipework; vertical mounting.
NZ 3171 MT 384 (846)
Z = permanent dry well or in-line arrangement with NZ 3171 HT 357 (787)
flange connection to suction and discharge pipe- NZ 3171 SH 358 (789)
work; horizontal mounting.
5
3171.091.181
MOTOR DATA
50 Hz, 22.0 kW, 2925 r/min 50 Hz, 18.5 kW, 1460 r/min
3-phase, 2-pole 3-phase, 4-pole
50 Hz, 15.0 kW, 1460 r/min 50 Hz, 15.0 kW, 965 r/min
3-phase, 4-pole 3-phase, 6-pole
230 D 73 470
380 D 42 236
400 D 41 248
400 Y 42 272
415 D 39 232
440 D 38 249
500 D 33 210
660 Y 24 137
690 Y 24 144
6
3171.091.181
60 Hz, 35hp, (26 kW) 3525 r/min 60 Hz, 30 hp, (22.0 kW) 1755 r/min
3-phase, 2-pole 3-phase, 4-pole
7
3171.091.181
Bearings
The support bearing of the shaft is a double row ball Without cooling jacket
bearing.
The main bearing of the shaft is a double row angular
contact ball bearing.
30747b
Seal housing
30747a
8
3171.091.181
Shaft
The shaft is delivered with the
rotor as an integral part. Shaft
material; stainless steel.
Impeller
The pump is equipped with a N-impeller, a semi-
open two-vane impeller.
9
3171.091.181
INSTALLATION
Handling equipment WARNING! The end of the cable must not be sub-
merged. It must be above flood level, as water could
Always pay extra attention to safety aspects when penetrate through the cable into the junction box or the
working with lifting equipment. motor.
Lifting equipment is required for handling the pump. For automatic operation of the pump (level control),
The lifting chain and the schackle should be in stain- it is recommended that the level regulators should be
less steel and inspected every year. used at low voltage. The data sheet delivered with the
regulators gives the permissible voltage.
— Stay clear of suspended loads.
Local rules may specify otherwise.
Clean out all debris from the sump before the pump is
— Always lift the pump by its lifting lowered down and the station is started.
handle – never by the motor cable
or the hose.
— NOTE for Ex version page 3.
The minimum height between the lifting hook and the
— Minimum stop level should be
floor shall be sufficient to lift the pump out of the
according to the dimensional
sump.
drawing.
The lifting equipment shall be able to hoist the pump
straight up and down in the sump, preferably without
— The pump must never run dry.
the need for resetting the lifting hook.
Oversized lifting equipment could cause damage if the
pump should stick when being lifted.
Make sure that the lifting equipment is securely
anchored and in good condition.
Check that the lifting handle and chain are in good
condition.
To ensure proper installation, please see the dimen-
sions on the dimensional drawing.
10
3171.091.181
INSTALLATION
Safety precautions Level regulators or other control equipment for start,
In order to minimize the risk of accidents in connection stop and alarm.
with service and installation work, the following rules Cable holder for holding the cable and regulating the
should be followed: height of the level regulators.
1. Never work alone. Use a lifting harness, safety line Access frame (with covers) to which the upper guide
and a respirator as required. Do not ignore the risk bar bracket and cable holder can be attached.
of drowning.
2. Make sure there are no dangerous gases within the Discharge connection for connecting the pump to the
work area. discharge line. The discharge connection has a flange
which fits the pump casing flange and a bracket for
3. Check the explosion risk before welding or using attaching the guide equipment.
electric hand tools.
4. Before the pump is installed check that the cable Bushings for vibration damping between the guide
and cable entry have not been damaged during the bars and the discharge connection.
transportation. Instructions
5. Observe strict cleanliness. Do not ignore health - Provide a barrier around the pump pit, for example a
hazards. guardrail.
6. Bear in mind the risk of electrical accidents.
- Arrange for a cable between the sump and the
7. Make sure that the lifting equipment is in good electric control box. Make sure that the cables are
condition and comply to local ordinances. not sharply bent or pinched.
8. Provide a suitable barrier around the work area, e.
- Place the access frame in position.
a guard rail.
9. Make sure you have a clear path of retreat. - Align the frame so that it is horizontal and then grout
it in place.
10. Use safety helmet, safety goggles and protective
shoes. - Grout the anchor bolts in place. Be careful when
11. All personnel who work with sewage systems must aligning and positioning the discharge connection in
be vaccinated against diseases to which they may relation to the access frame.
be exposed. - Place the discharge connection in position and
12. A first-aid kit must be close at hand. tighten the nuts.
13. Note that special rules apply to installation in - Secure the guide bars in the bracket.
explosive athmosphere.
- Check that the guide bars are placed vertically by
Follow all health and safety rules and local
using a level or a plumb line.
codes and ordinances.
- Connect the discharge pipe to the discharge conn-
Installation alternatives ection.
P- installation - Bolt the cable holder to the access frame. Thread the
level regulator cables through the holes in the cable
holder and adjust the height of the level regulators.
- Protect bolts and nuts with corrosion preventive com-
pound.
- Lower the pump along the guide bars.
30747
- Fasten the lifting chain (stainless steel) on the
access frame and the cables on the cable holder.
In the P installation, the pump is installed on a station-
Make sure that the cables cannot be sucked into the
ary discharge connection and operates completely or
inlet of the pump. Support straps are required for
partially submerged in the pumped liquid.
deep install-ations.
In addition to the pump the following items are re-
quired: - Run the cables up to the electric control box.
- Clean out debris from the sump before starting up the
Guide bars consisting of two hot dip galvanized or station.
stainless steel pipes.
- The pump can be hoisted up along the guide bars for
Guidebar bracket for attaching the guide bars to the inspection without any connections having to be
access frame or the upper part of the sump. undone.
11
3171.091.181
INSTALLATION
Installation alternatives In the T- installation, the pump is installed in a
stationary position in a dry well next to the wet sump.
S- installation
In the Z- installation the pump is installed in a horizon-
tal position on a support stand and a bell-mouth is
connected to the inlet pipe.
The pump has a watertight motor and will therefore not
be damaged in the event of flooding.
The pump is equipped with a cooling jacket.
In addition to the pump, the following items are
required:
Support stand for anchoring the pump to a base.
In the S- installation, the pump is transportable and
intended to operate completely or partially submerged Shut-off valves to permit the pump to be removed for
in the pumped liquid. The pump is equipped with a service.
connection for hose or pipe, see "Parts list".
Level regulators or other control equipment for start,
The pump stands on a base stand.
stop and alarm.
WARNING! The risk of freezing is particularly great at
T- installation certain T or Z installations.
Instruction
Bolt the base stand to the concrete base by means of
the anchor bolts. Bolt the pump to the base stand and
the suction connection.
Connect the motor cable, suction line and discharge
line.
30750
ELECTRICAL CONNECTIONS
— Before starting work on the
pump, make sure that the pump NOTE for Ex version page 3.
and the control panel are isolated
from the power supply and cannot — All electrical equipment must be
be energized. earthed (grounded). This applies to
both pump equipment and any
— If the pump is equipped with monitoring equipment. Failure to
automatic level control, there is heed this warning may cause a
a risk of sudden restart. lethal accident. Make sure that the
— If persons are likely to come into earth (ground) lead is correctly
physical contact with the pump or connected by testing it.
pumped media (liquid), e.g on con-
struction sites and farms, the Check the data plate to determine which voltage supply
earthed (grounded) socket must is valid for your pump.
have an additional earth-(ground-) Check that the main voltage and frequency agree with
fault protection device (GFI) the specifications on the pump data plate.
connected.
If the pump can be connected to different voltages, the
All electrical work shall be carried out under the super- connected voltage is specified by a yellow sticker.
vision of an authorized electrician. Local codes and
Connect the motor cable to the starter equipment as
regulations shall be complied with.
illustrated in the wiring diagrams.
12
3171.091.181
When the pump is connected to the public mains it Connection of stator and motor leads
may cause flicker of incandescent lamps when start-
ing. In this case the supply authority should be notified - Check on the data plate which connection, Y, D or
before installing the pump. YD, is valid for the voltage supply. Then, depending
on voltage, arrange the connection on the terminal
board in accordance with Y, D or YD. See figure.
Leads that are not in use must be isolated. - Connect the motor cable to the connection block, U1,
V1, W1 and earth (ground). Connect the leads from
The cable should be replaced if the outer sheath is
the motor control circuit.
damaged. Contact a Flygt service shop.
Make sure that the cable does not have any sharp - If star-delta start is used, motor cables are connected
bends and is not pinched. as shown in the figure. Links (jumper strips) are not
used with star-delta start.
Under no circumstances may the starter equipment be
installed in the sump. - Make sure that the pump is correctly earthed (grounded).
WARNING! For safety reasons, the earth (ground) lead - Install the O-ring (33) and connection cover (32).
should be approx. 100 mm (4.0") longer than the phase
lead. If the motor cable is jerked loose by mistake, the - Tighten the screws and the gland nut so that the ca-
earth (ground) lead should be the last lead to come ble entry unit bottoms out.
loose from its terminal. This applies to both ends of the - Connect the motor cable to the starter equipment.
cable.
- Check the direction of rotation, see "Before starting".
The motor is convertible between different voltages as
stated on the data plate. This conversion is done on - If the direction of rotation is wrong, transpose two of
the terminal board or the contactor. the phase leads.
- Remember that the starting surge with the direct-on
line start can be up to six times higher than the rated
— Bear in mind the risk of electrical current. Make sure that the fuses and circuit breakers
shock and the risk of explosion if are of the proper amperage.
the electrical connections are not
correctly carried out. - The incorporated thermal contacts (motor protection
breaker) must be connected and in use. It shall be set
to the motor rated current as given on the dataplate.
When using a variable-frequency-drive (VFD) the
shielded cable (type NSSHÖU.../3E+St) should be
used in order to fulfil European CE requirements. Con-
tact your Flygt representative and ask your VFD-suppli-
er for electrical limitations. Also please see VFD-
recommendation Flygt article no. 893472.
32
30684
33
13
3171.091.181
CABLE CHART
SUBCAB® 7GX SUBCAB® 7GX
2 parallel cores connected together 2 parallel cores connected together
6-leads, Y 6-leads, D
3171 3171
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 L1 L2 L3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 L1 L2 L3
T1 T2 1 4 2 5 3 6 T1 T2 1 4 2 5 3 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 T1 T2 1 4 3 6 2 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 T1 T2 1 4 3 6 2 5
T16 T15 T2 T1
T16 T15 T2 T1 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
Bild 3 Bild 6
14
3171.091.181
CABLE CHART
SUBCAB® 4GX/SUBCAB® AWG, SUBCAB® 4GX/SUBCAB® AWG,
6-leads, Y 6-leads, D
3171 3171
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 L1 L2 L3 GC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 L1 L2 L3 GC
T1 T2 T1 T2
SUBCAB®
SUBCAB®
4Gx#
SUBCAB® 4Gx# SUBCAB® # AWG/4
7x# # AWG/4 7x# # AWG/7
# AWG/7
# AWG/3-2-1-GC
1 2 3 4 T1 T2 L1 L2 L3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 T1 T2 L1 L2 L3
GC GC
T16 T15 T2 T1
T16 T15 T2 T1 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
Bild 2 Bild 5
15
3171.091.181
CABLE CHART
SUBCAB® 4GX/SUBCAB® AWG, SUBCAB® 4GX/SUBCAB® AWG,
60 Hz only, 9-leads, 460 V, Y ser. 60 Hz only, 9-leads, 230 V, Y //
3171 3171
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 L1 L2 L3 GC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 L1 L2 L3 GC
T1 T2 T1 T2
SUBCAB® SUBCAB®
4Gx# 4Gx#
SUBCAB® # AWG/4 SUBCAB® # AWG/4
7x# # AWG/7 7x# # AWG/7
# AWG/3-2-1-GC # AWG/3-2-1-GC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 T1 T2 L1 L2 L3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 T1 T2 L1 L2 L3
GC GC
T16 T15 T2 T1 U1 U5 V1 V5 W1 W5
T16 T15 T2 T1 U1 U5 V1 V5 W1 W5
U1 U5 V1 V5 W1 W5 W2 V2 U2
U2
U1 U5 V1 V5 W1 W5 V2
W2
Bild 8 Bild 10
16
3171.091.181
CABLE CHART
SUBCAB® 7GX,
6-leads, Y/D
3171
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 L1 L2 L3 L1 L2 L3
T1 T2
SUBCAB® SUBCAB®
7x# 7Gx #+2G1.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 T1 T2 1 2 3 4 5 6
T16 T15 T2 T1 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
Bild 12
17
3171.091.181
CABLE CHART
SUBCAB® Screened, SUBCAB® Screened,
6-leads, Y 6-leads, D
3171 3171
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 L1 L2 L3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 L1 L2 L3
T1 T2 T3 T4 T1 T2 T3 T4
® ® Screened
SUBCAB Screened SUBCAB
7x1.5 SUBCAB ®
7x1.5 SUBCAB ®
1 2 3 4 T1 T2 T3 T4 L1 L2 L3
1 2 3 4 T1 T2 T3 T4 L1 L2 L3
T16 T15 T2 T1 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
T16 T15 T2 T1 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
Bild 203
Bild 202
18
3171.091.181
CABLE CHART
NSSHÖU ../3E+st, NSSHÖU ../3E+st,
6-leads, Y 6-leads, D
3171 3171
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 L1 L2 L3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 L1 L2 L3
T1 T2 3 T1 T2 3
1 2 3 4 T1 T2 3 L1 L2 L3 1 2 3 4 T1 T2 3 L1 L2 L3
U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2 U1 W2 V1 U2 W1 V2
19
3171.091.181
Thermal
contacts /
Thermistors
Optional
FLS10
20
3171.091.181
MiniCAS II
RESET
THERMAL
CONTACTS Circuits shown
de-energised
SENSOR
INPUT
PUMP
TERMINALS
LEAKAGE ALARM
LEAKAGE
PUMP CONTACTOR
21
3171.091.181
OPERATION
Before starting
- Check that the visible parts of the pump and
installation are undamaged and in good condition.
- Remove the fuses or open the circuit breaker and
check that the impeller can be rotated freely.
- Verify that the supply voltage matches the pump data
plate voltage rating.
- Conduct insulation integrity check.
- Conduct phase to phase resistance check.
- Check that the monitoring equipment works.
- Check the direction of rotation. The impeller shall
rotate clockwise, as viewed from above. When
started, the pump will jerk in the opposite direction to
the direction in which the impeller rotates. See figure.
In case of dry installation, check the direction of rota-
tion through the inlet elbow access cover. Transpose
two phase leads if the impeller rotates in the wrong
direction (3 ~).
22
3171.091.181
Inspection chamber Drain all liquid if any. Check Overload and other Check correct settings.
the resistance. protections
Normal value approx.1200 Ω,
alarm approx. 430 Ω.
Personnel safety Check guard rails, covers and
other protections.
O-rings Always replace the O-rings of
the filling plugs and at the
junction cover. Always grease Level regulators Check condition and function.
new O-rings.
Pump Major Service
Thermal contacts Check the resistance.
Normally closed circuit;
interval 0 – 1 Ω. Support and main Replace with new bearings.
bearing.
Thermistor Check the resistance 20 –
250 Ω , (measuring voltage Mechanical seal Replace with new seal units.
max 2 V DC). unit.
23
3171.091.181
If any indication of Actions The following points are important in connection with
alarm between in- work on the pump:
spections, please — Make sure that the pump cannot roll or fall over
see instructions and injure people or damage property.
below. — Check every year that the lifting equipment is in
good condition.
FLS10 Drain the fluid in the inspection
chamber. Fill with new coolant The pump is designed for use in liquids which can be a
if necessary. Check freezing healthrisk. In order to prevent injury to the eyes and
point (lower than –13° C (9° F )). skin, observe the following points when working on
Check the inspection chamber the pump:
again after one week of ope- — Make sure that the pump has been thoroughly
ration. If leakage has occured, cleaned.
drain the fluid and change the — Beware of the risk of infection.
mechanical seal unit and — Follow local safety regulations.
replace with new coolant.
— Always wear goggles and rubber gloves.
Thermistor/Thermal- Check coolant level. — Rinse the pump thoroughly with clean water before
starting work.
contact (pump with cooling jacket)
Check start and stop levels. — Rinse the components in water after dismantling.
— The coolant chamber may be under pressure. Hold a
Overload protection Check that the impeller can rag over the filling plug to prevent splatter.
rotate freely. Proceed as follows if fluids have splashed into your
eyes:
— Rinse your eyes immediately in running water
for 15 minutes. Hold your eyelids apart with your
fingers.
— Contact an eye specialist.
On your skin:
— Remove contaminated clothes.
— Wash your skin with soap and water.
— Seek medical attention, if required.
24
3171.091.181
30754
25
3171.091.181
1. 2.
30590
30591
Place the pump horizontally. Remove the guide pin Using a 12 mm hexagon bit adaptor (allen socket) with
(if mounted). Remove the flush valve cover and it's a 100 mm (4") extension (minimum length) turn the
O-ring. Insert a rod (wood or plastic) through the gland screw counter clockwise until the impeller breaks
hole and lock the impeller in place. Remove the free from the shaft.
impeller screw.
3. 4.
30592
5.
26
3171.091.181
1. 2.
(a)
31034
30595
5. 6.
B: + 1/8 turn
+ (45°)
1/8
turn
(45°)
A
76 Nm
30600B
27
3171.091.181
1. 2.
Make sure that the end of the shaft is clean and free
A
from burrs. Polish off any flaws with fine emery cloth.
Grease end of shaft, conical sleeve and the threads of
the gland screw and the impeller screw. Unscrew the Measure and note the
gland screw approximately 5 mm. distance A.
28
3171.091.181
3. 4.
B
Before assembling, check that the impeller screw is
Make sure that the O-ring is removed from the seal
clean and easy to screw into the shaft end (a). This to housing cover. Place the drive unit in the pump
prevent the shaft to rotate with the impeller screw. housing. Check the distance between the seal housing
Assemble the conical sleeve and the impeller onto cover and the pump housing with a feeler gauge.
the shaft. Fit the impeller screw with washer onto the Check diametrically at four points.
shaft and tighten to 76 Nm (57 ft lb). Note the largest measured distance, B. See fig.
5. 6.
C=A-B-0.5 mm
7. 8.
Fit a new greased O-ring
to the seal housing cov-
+ 1/8 turn er. Fit the drive unit to
(45°) the pump housing.
Adjust its position so
that the inspection hole
is on the same side as
the hole for the flush
187 Nm valve. Tighten the
(138 ft lb) screws in diagonally
opposite pairs.
76 Nm
29
3171.091.181
Yes
Can the pump be started a) Fault in level equipment (start level regulator).
manually?
Clean or replace.
b) Fault in control equipment.
No Check:
— that the thermal contacts have not opened.
— that all connections are intact.
— relay and contactor coils.
— that the control switch “Man/Auto” makes contact in
both positions.
No
Is the installation receiving Check:
voltage?
— that the main power switch is on.
— that there is control voltage to the starter equipment
Yes and its fuses are intact.
— that there is voltage in each phase of the supply line.
— that all fuses have continuity and are tight.
— that the overload protection is reset.
— that there is no break in the motor cable.
No
30
3171.091.181
Yes
Is the motor protection set Adjust.
too low?
(Check with data plate)
No
Yes
Is the impeller difficult to Clean the impeller.
rotate by hand? Clean out the sump.
WARNING: disconnect power
before checking the impeller Check that the impeller is properly trimmed.
If anything else is wrong, contact Flygt service shop.
No
No
Is the installation receiving full Check the motor fuses.
voltage on all three phases? Notify an electrician.
Yes
Yes
Have all the phase currents the Contact Flygt service shop.
same value, or are they too high?
No
Yes
Is the insulation between the Contact Flygt service shop.
phases and earth (ground) in
the stator defective?
Use insulation tester. With a
1000 V-DC megger, the insulation
between the phases and
between any phase and earth
(ground) should be > 5 MΩ
No
Yes
Is the density of the pumped Dilute the liquid.
liquid too high? (Max density Change the impeller or to a more suitable pump.
1100 kg/m3, 9.2 lb per US gal)
Contact Flygt.
No
Yes
Fault on overload protection?
Replace the overload protection.
No
31
3171.091.181
No
Is the pump able to empty the Check:
station to the stop level? — for leakage in pipe and/or discharge connection.
— that the impeller is not clogged.
Yes WARNING: disconnect power before checking the impeller.
— the non-return valve(s).
— that the pump has adequate capacity. Contact Flygt.
Yes
Fault in level sensing equipment? Clean the level regulators.
Check the functioning of level regulators.
No Check the contactor and control circuit.
Replace defective items.
Yes
Stop level set too low? Raise the stop level.
No
Yes
Does the contactor’s self- Check:
holding function break?
— contactor connections.
— the voltage in the control circuit in relation to the rated
No voltages on the coil.
— the functioning of stop level regulator.
— the voltage drop in the line at the starting surge makes the
contactor’s self-holding break.
Contact Flygt service shop.
32
3171.091.181
SERVICE LOG
Most recent Pump No. Hours of Remarks Sign.
service date operation
33
3.03.5 RECOMMENDED MAINTENANCE
1. Safety precautions
a. Always disconnect the power and perform proper lockout/tag out
procedures before servicing the unit.
2. Daily inspections
a. Check current – to be within the rated current. If ammeter fluctuation
is great, even though within the limits of the pump rating, foreign
matter may be clogging the pump. If the quantity of liquid discharged
falls suddenly, foreign matter may be blocking the suction inlet.
Document the current readings so there is a basis to compare to.
b. Check voltage – power supply voltage variation = within +- 10% of
the rated voltage. Document the voltage readings so there is a basis to
compare to.
c. Check for abnormal noise or vibration
d. Check and record pump runtime values if available.
e. Unusual readings or observations may indicate a problem requiring
immediate service.
3. Regular inspections
a. Monthly
i. Measure the insulation resistance. Insulation resistance value
should be more than 1 mega ohm (MΩ). If resistance starts to
fall rapidly even with an initial indication of over 1 mega ohm,
this may be an indication of trouble and repair work is required.
Document what the reading is so it can be compared to the last
reading.
ii. Make sure that the lifting equipment is in good condition and
show no signs of abnormal wear or corrosion.
Rev. 4/30/14
3.03.5 RECOMMENDED MAINTENANCE
Rev. 4/30/14
3.03.6 PUMP DATA SHEETS
V-28
Grip-Eye System
Section 10 Accessories Issued: 11/00 Supersedes: 11/98
The normal method of lowering and raising a CP pump in and out of a lift station is
by use of a chain or cable attached to the pump. The length of the chain or cable is
dependent on the depth of the station. The average length would probably be
between 18 to 20 ft. and in certain cases may be much longer. In many cases,
depending on the lifting device (usually a hoist), the operator may have to take a
second or third bite on the pump chain in order to lift the pump clear of the station.
An added accessory to the Flygt line is the pattented Flygt Grip-Eye System which
consists of 33 ft. of nylon line, a short length of high tensile strength stainless steel
chain and a forged “Grip-Eye” of wrought alloy steel.
1. Connect the small eye of the grip-eye to the end of the hoist cable.
2. Slip the end of the nylon line through the large eye of the grip-eye. The nylon
line simply acts as a guide for the grip-eye on its way down to the short
length of the pump lifting chain.
3. While keeping the nylon line (guide line) taut, proceed to lower the grip-eye
until it is well positioned over the pump lifting chain.
4. Release the tension on the nylon guide line. The lifting chain will now take
a position to become engaged in the grip-eye.
5. Gradually take up tension on the hoist cable and the grip-eye will make a
positive grip on the pump lifting chain. Continue hoisting until the pump is
clear of the station.
Caution: The Grip-Eyes may only be used with the corresponding special
Flygt Chain Sling Units.
This section provides the information pertaining to the level sensing for this project.
Level Measurement
Continuous level measurement — Ultrasonic transducers
■ Overview ■ Benefits
• Integral temperature compensation
• Low ringing effect reduces blanking distance
• Optional foam facing for dusty applications
• Self-cleaning and low-maintenance
• Chemically resistant
• Hermetically sealed
■ Application
The transducers can be fully immersed, are resistant to steam
and corrosive chemicals, and can be installed without flanges.
The XPS series offers versions for various measuring ranges up
to 40 m (130 ft) and up to a max. temperature of 95 °C
(203 °F).
The XCT series can be used in applications at higher tempera-
tures to measure level up to a distance of 12 m (40 ft) and at a
max. temperature of 95 °C (203 °F).
transducers use ultrasonic technology to measure level in
a wide range of liquids and solids. During operation, the Echomax transducers emit acoustic
pulses in a narrow beam. The level monitor measures the prop-
agation time between pulse emission and its reflection (echo) to
calculate the distance. 5
■ Technical specifications
Input XPS-10 (standard XPS-15 (standard XPS-30 XPS-40 XCT-8 (standard XCT-12
and F models) and F models) and sanitary
models)
Measuring range 0.3 ... 10 m Standard: 0.6 ... 30 m 0.9 ... 40 m 0.6 ... 8 m 0.6 ... 12 m
(1 ... 33 ft) 0.3 ... 15 m (2 ... 100 ft) (3 ... 130 ft) (2 ... 26 ft) (2 ... 40 ft)
(1 ... 50 ft)
Flanged:
0.45 ... 15 m
(1.5 ... 50 ft)
Output
Frequency 44 kHz 44 kHz 30 kHz 22 kHz 44 kHz 44 kHz
Beam angle 12° 6° 6° 6° 12° 6°
Environmental
Location Indoors/outdoors
Ambient Standard: -40 ... +95 °C (-40 ... +203 °F) Standard: -40 ... +145 °C
temperature F: -20 ... +95 °C (-4 ... +203 °F) -40 ... +145 °C (-40 ... +293 °F)
(-40 ... +293 °F)
Sanitary:
-40 ... +125 °C
(-40 ... +260 °F)
5
Pollution degree 4
Pressure 8 bar g (120 psi g) 8 bar g (120 psi g) 0.5 bar g 0.5 bar g Standard: 4 bar g (60 psi g):
Flanged: Flanged: 0.5 bar g (7.25 psi g) (7.25 psi g) -40 ... +138 °C (-40 ... +280 °F)
0.5 bar g (7.25 psi g) Flanged: 0.5 bar g Standard: 8 bar g (120 psi g):
(7.25 psi g) (7.25 psi g) -40 ... +95 °C (-40 ... +203 °F)
Flanged: 0.5 bar g (7.25 psi g)
Sanitary: XCT-8: 0.5 bar g (7.25 psi g)
Design
Weight 0.8 kg 1.3 kg (2.8 lbs) 4.3 kg 8 kg 0.8 kg 1.3 kg
(1.8 lbs) Flanged: 2 kg (9.5 lbs) (18 lbs) (1.7 lbs) (2.8 lbs)
(4.4 lbs)
Power supply Operation of transducer only with approved Siemens Milltronics controllers
Material Standard: PVDF Standard: PVDF Standard: PVDF PVDF Standard: PVDF
Flanged: PVDF with Flanged: PVDF with Flanged: PVDF with Options: DERAKANE flange; PTFE face
CPVC flange CPVC flange CPVC flange with universal PVDF flange
Option: PTFE face Option: PTFE face Option: PTFE face
with CPVC flange with CPVC flange with CPVC flange
Color Standard: blue Standard: blue blue blue white
F: gray F: gray
Process Standard: 1" NPT or Standard: 1" NPT or 1.5" universal thread (NPT or BSPT) 1" NPT or R 1" (BSPT), EN 10226
connection 1" BSPT 1" BSPT
F: 1" NPT F: 1" NPT
Degree of IP66/68 IP66/68 IP66/68 IP66/68 IP66/68 IP66/68
protection
Cable 2 wire twisted pair/braided and foil shielded 0.5 mm² (20 AWG) PVC jacket 2 wire twisted pair/braided and foil
shielded 0.5 mm² (20 AWG) silicone
jacket
Separation Max. 365 m (1200 ft)
Certificates and Standard: Standard: CE1), CSA, FM, CE1), CSA, FM, Standard: CE1), CSA, FM,
approvals CE1), CSA, FM, CE1), CSA, FM, ATEX II 2G 1D ATEX II 2G 1D CE1), CSA, FM, ATEX II 2GD
ATEX II 2GD ATEX II 2GD ATEX II 2GD
F: FM Class I, Div 1, F: FM Class I, Div 1, Sanitary: CE,
Groups A, B, C and Groups A, B, C and CTICK, CSAUS/C
D, Class II Div 1, D, Class II Div 1,
Groups E, F and G, Groups E, F and G,
Class III Class III
1) EMC certificate available on request.
5
6" ASME, 150 lb, flat faced D Channel bracket, wall mount 7ML1830-1BL
8" ASME, 150 lb, flat faced E Extended channel bracket, wall mount 7ML1830-1BM
DN 150, PN 10/16, Type A, flat faced J Channel bracket, floor mount 7ML1830-1BN
DN 200, PN 10/16, Type A, flat faced K
Extended channel bracket, floor mount 7ML1830-1BP
JIS10K 6B N
JIS10K 8B P Bridge channel bracket, floor mount 7ML1830-1BQ
(Note: Flange bolting patterns and facings dimen- (see Mounting Brackets on page 5/198 for more
sionally correspond to the applicable ASME B16.5 information)
or EN 1092-1, or JIS B 2220 standard.)
1" NPT locknut, plastic 7ML1830-1DS
Approvals
ATEX II 2GD, FM Class I Div. 2, SAA Class I 3 1" BSPT locknut, plastic 7ML1830-1DR
CSA Class I Div. 13) 4 Easy Aimer 2, with ¾" x 1" NPT PVC coupling 7ML1830-1AQ
1) Not available with flanged versions Easy Aimer 2, aluminum with M20 adapter and 7ML1830-1AX
2) 1" and 1½" BSPT aluminum couplings
Available with flanged versions only
3)
Available with mounting options 0 to 2 only
Easy Aimer 304 with stainless steel coupling 7ML1830-1AU
C) Subject to export regulations AL: N, ECCN: EAR99.
Easy Aimer 304, with M20 adapter and 1" and 7ML1830-1GN
1½" BSPT 304 SS couplings
C) Subject to export regulations AL: N, ECCN: EAR99.
black
white
B
shield
Coaxial Connection
Radiating face
A white
shield
Bonded flange Submergence shield
B
F
3 Terminal Direct*
black
shield
C
5
Sanitary white
3 Terminal Extension*
black
H
white
shield
Mounting
XPS and XCT ultrasonic transducer, dimensions, in mm (inch) Make particularly sure that the radiating face of the transducer is protected from damage.
Mount the transducer so that it is above the maximum material level by at least
the blanking value. On liquid applications, the transducer must be mounted so that
Version the axis of transmission is perpendicular to the liquid surface. On solids alications,
Dimension XPS-10 XPS-15 XPS-30 XPS-40 a Milltronics Easy Aimer should be used to facilitate aiming the transducer. Consider
the optional temperature sensor when mounting the transducer.
A 88 mm 121 mm 175 mm 206 mm
(3.464") (4.764") (6.890“) (8.110") Interconnection
Do not route cable openly or near high voltage or current runs, contactors and
B 122 mm 132 mm 198 mm 229 mm SCR control drives. For optimum isolation against electrical noise, run cable
(4.803") (5.197") (7.795") (9.016") separately in a grounded metal conduit. Seal all thread connections to prevent
C According to ASME, DIN and JIS n/a ingress of moisture.
Version
Dimension XCT-8 XCT-12
A 88 mm (3.464") 121 mm (4.764")
B 122 mm (4.803") 132 mm (5.197")
C According to ASME, DIN and JIS
E n/a n/a
F n/a n/a
G Sanitary version: n/a
119 mm (4.68")
H Sanitary version: n/a
122 mm (4.8")
J 28 mm (1.1") 28 mm (1.1")
This section contains information pertaining to the valve vault. There is both technical
information and related drawings necessary for the valve vault construction.
31
NOTE: VAULT TOP SLAB IS H-20 OCCASIONAL RATED
33 17
31 18
20 33
9 10
20
5
25 RIM ELEVATION - 102.25'
36 FINISHED GRADE
5 ELEVATION - 102.25'
33
28
6" PIPING
4 28 NOTE: ALL DIMENSIONS AND ELEVATIONS SHOWN
ARE NOMINAL DIMENSIONS. IT IS THE RESPONSIBILITY
OF THE ON-SITE CONTRACTOR OR ROMTEC UTILITIES
4 CUSTOMER (NOT ROMTEC UTILITIES) TO VERIFY THE
ACCURACY OF ANY CRITICAL DIMENSIONS OR ELEVATIONS
PRIOR TO SETTING OR INSTALLING ANY EQUIPMENT.
2
3
35 15 12 36 13 14
9'-3"
29 30 26 22 21 23
6' X 8' VALVE VAULT
24
6" PIPING AND VALVES
12" PUMPING PORT
FORCE MAIN
31 (BY OTHERS)
21 3/4 PIPE STANDS ARE
23
1 NOT SHOWN, BUT
24 THEY ARE INCLUDED.
ALL MATERIALS SHOWN ON THIS SHEET WILL BE
SUPPLIED BY ROMTEC UTILITIES AND DELIVERED TO
THE SITE AFTER THE HOLE HAS BEEN EXCAVATED
6.00
AND SHORED. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL SUPPLY A
CRANE OF SUFFICIENT SIZE TO LOWER ALL THE
DRAIN BACK TO WET WELL: CONCRETE PIECES INTO THE HOLE SAFELY. THE
3" PLAIN HOLE IN VAULT THE CONTRACTOR SHALL INSTALL THE WET WELL
(PROVIDED) (AND VALVE VAULT AND METERING VAULT IF
2" PEE TRAP ON VAULT END APPLICABLE). ROMTEC UTILITIES WILL PROVIDE A
WITH CHECK VALVE AT END OF REPRESENTATIVE FOR TECHNICAL ASSISTANCE ON
PIPE IN WET WELL. THE DAY OF INSTALLATION TO ANSWER ANY QUESTIONS
(BY OTHERS) NOT ROMTEC UTILITIES THAT MAY ARISE. THE CONTRACTOR IS RESPONSIBLE
PLANS AND DRAWINGS MAY NOT BE REPRODUCED, FOR ALL PLUMBING AND ELECTRICAL CONNECTIONS
ADAPTED, OR FURTHER DISTRIBUTED, AND NO AND INSTALLATION. ITEMS NOTED AS "BY OTHERS"
COMPONENTS MAY BE CONSTRUCTED FROM THESE WILL BE PROVIDED AND INSTALLED BY THE CONTRACTOR.
PLANS, WITHOUT WRITTEN PERMISSION OF ROMTEC, INC. ROMTEC UTILITIES WILL NOT INSTALL ANY OF THE M2
COMPONENTS SHOWN ON THIS PAGE. Contact:
Project #:
File #:
SYRACUSE CASTING WEST HAS COME EJ.
3.05.4 VALVE VAULT DATA SHEETS
Swing-Flex
Check Valve
INTRODUCTION 1
RECEIVING AND STORAGE 1
DESCRIPTION OF OPERATION 1
INSTALLATION 2
VALVE CONSTRUCTION 2
MAINTENANCE 2
TROUBLESHOOTING 3
DISASSEMBLY 3
RE-ASSEMBLY 3
BACKFLOW ACTUATOR (OPTIONAL) 4
MECHANICAL INDICATOR (OPTIONAL) 5
LIMIT SWITCH (OPTIONAL) 5
BOTTOM OIL DASHPOT (OPTIONAL) 6
PARTS AND SERVICE 7
WARRANTY 7
CAUTION
Item Description Material
The use of ring gaskets or excessive bolt
torque may damage valve flanges. 1 Body Ductile Iron – 250 psi
Cast Iron – 150 psi
Table 1. Flange Bolt Torques 2 Cover Ductile Iron – 250 psi
Cast Iron – 150 psi
3 Disc* Steel With Buna-N Facing
Valve Bolt Recom. Max.
4 Cover Seal* Buna-N or Non-Asbestos
Size Dia Torque Torque 5 Cover Bolt Alloy Steel
(in) (in) (ft-lbs) (ft-lbs)
*Recommended Spare Part
3 5/8 25 90 FIGURE 2. CHECK VALVE CONSTRUCTION
4 5/8 25 90
6 3/4 30 150
8 3/4 40 150 MAINTENANCE
10 7/8 45 205
The Swing Flex Check Valve requires no scheduled
12 7/8 65 205 lubrication or maintenance. For service or
14 1 80 300 inspection, the valve can be serviced without
16 1 80 300 removal from the line.
18 1 1/8 100 425
20 1 1/8 100 425 VALVE INSPECTION: If inspection of the valve is
24 1 1/4 150 600 required, follow the Disassembly Instructions given
30 1 1/4 160 600 on page 3.
36 1 1/2 300 900
42 1 1/2 300 900
48 1 1/2 300 1,000
TROUBLESHOOTING RE-ASSEMBLY
Several problems and solutions are presented below All parts must be cleaned. Gasket surfaces should
to assist you in troubleshooting the valve assembly be cleaned with a stiff wire brush in the direction of
in an efficient manner. the serrations or machine marks. Worn parts,
gaskets and seals should be replaced during
Leakage at Bottom Actuator: Remove line reassembly.
pressure and exercise actuator. If leak persists,
replace seals in actuator; see the Backflow 1. Lay disc (3) over seat with beaded seating
Actuator Seal Replacement Procedure on page 4. surface directed down.
Leakage at Cover or Flanges: Tighten bolts, 2. Lay cover gasket (4) and cover (2) over bolt holes
replace cover seal. and disc hinge.
Valve Leaks when Closed: Inspect disc for 3. Insert lubricated bolts (5) noting that the bolts in
damage and replace. Inspect metal seating the hinge area are longer than the other cover
surface and clean if necessary. bolts.
Valve Does not Open: Check for obstruction in 4. Cover bolts should be tightened to the following
valve or pipeline; see Disassembly procedure on specifications during assembly.
page 4. Operating pressure may be less than
cracking pressure. If less than 0.5 psig, review Table 2. Valve Cover Bolt Torques
application with factory.
Valve Size Torque (ft-lbs)
2”-2.5” 1/2" 75
DISASSEMBLY
3” 7/16" 50
The valve can be disassembled without removing it
4” 1/2" 75
from the pipeline. Or for convenience, the valve can
6” 5/8" 150
be removed from the line. All work on the valve
8” 5/8" 150
should be performed by a skilled mechanic with
10” 7/8" 250
proper tools and a power hoist for larger valves.
12”-20” 7/8” 250
Disassembly may be required to inspect the disc for
24” 1” 500
wear or the valve for deposits.
30” 1 1/8” 600
36” 1 1/4” 900
WARNING
42” 1 1/2" 1,400
The line must be drained before removing the
48” 1 1/2” 1,400
cover or pressure may be released causing
bodily harm.
2. Pry cover (2) loose and lift off valve body. 12” and
larger valves have tapped holes in cover for lifting
eyes.
WARNING
Remove of the bottom plug while under
pressure may cause bodily harm.
4. Insert the threaded end of the assembly into the FIGURE 3. BACKFLOW ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
valve boss. Slowly turn the assembly into the
Backflow Actuator Parts List
boss taking care not to cross-thread the bushing.
Continue turning the assembly into the valve for a Item Description Material
tight fit. 6 Bushing Lead-Free Brass
7 Rod Stainless Steel
BACKFLOW ACTUATOR SEAL REPLACEMENT: 8 Rod Wiper* Molythane
There are two parts (8 & 9) on the backflow actuator 9 O-Ring* Buna-N
that are subject to wear. To replace the seals, the 10 Handle Stainless Steel
pipeline must first be depressurized and drained. 11 Jam nut Brass
Next, remove the backflow assembly from the valve 12 Cap* Vinyl
by turning the brass bushing (6) counter-clockwise. *Recommended Spare Part
Disassemble the actuator as follows:
MECHANICAL INDICATOR (OPTIONAL) LIMIT SWITCH (OPTIONAL)
The mechanical indicator is an option that fits into The limit switch is used in conjunction with the
the cover and can easily be installed in the field by Mechanical Indicator. The standard limit switch is
going through the following steps. The mechanical MICROSWITCH Model Number 914CE20-3. The
indicator is used to visually indicate when the valve limit switch is SCADA (Supervisory Control and
is opened or closed. Data Acquisition) compatible for applications
requiring open/close indication.
1. Remove line pressure and drain valve.
NEMA Ratings: 1, 2, 4, 6, 6P, 12, 13
WARNING UL Ratings: 5 AMPS, 1/10 HP, 125 or 250 VAC,
Removal of the pipe plug while under SPDT
pressure may cause bodily harm.
Installation:
2. Score the coating around and remove the pipe
1. Attach limit switch assembly to indicator using
plug from the cover.
the supplied screws (34) and bracket (32).
3. Apply pipe joint compound to indicator body (21)
threads.
2. Position the assembly so that the switch trips
4. Insert the indicator body (21), without the indicator
when the valve is closed.
plate (27), into the valve cover and tighten. Make
sure that two of the tapped holes in the indicator
3. Connect wiring to either the normally open or
body (21) are aligned with the valve and pipeline.
normally closed contact as shown in the
This will ensure proper orientation of the indicator
schematic diagram.
plate.
5. Remove the two socket head screws (31) from the
indicator body (21).
6. Slide the indicator plate (27) over the indicator rod
(23) and spring (28).
7. Align the indicator plate (27) as shown on the
back of this card and secure with the 5mm socket
head screws (31).
8. Connect the spring (28) to the indicator plate (27)
notch.
1. Depressurize and drain the valve and pipeline. 3. Remove the pipe plug from the oil reservoir fill
port.
WARNING
Removal of the bottom plug in the valve 4. Add hydraulic fluid equal to Mobil #DTE 24 until
while under pressure may cause bodily harm. fluid is up to level indicated on the reservoir.
Replace pipe plug.
2. Score the coating around and remove the pipe
plug in the bottom boss of the valve. Apply 5. Recharge the reservoir with air pressure to a
Teflon thread sealant or tape to brass threads on minimum of 10 psi over the water line pressure.
the dashpot.
6. The grease level can not be checked but it is
3. Insert the threaded end of the assembly into the recommended that the grease fitting be charged
valve boss. Slowly turn the assembly into the with grease twice a year. Use a cartridge grease
boss taking care not to cross-thread the bushing. gun and pump grease into the fitting using two full
Continue turning the assembly into the valve for a strokes. An FDA approved grease such as
tight fit and so that the tank is upright. Lubriko #CW-606 should be used (Master
Lubricants Company, Philadelphia, PA)
4. Adjust the air pressure in the tank to be a
minimum of 50 psi over the line pressure. Set the DASHPOT SEAL REPLACEMENT: There are
flow control valve in the mid position (i.e. 1 turn several seals in the unit that may require
open). The dashpot rod should be extended and replacement.
hold the disc open about 1 inch. The water line
pressure will close the disc. 1. Depressurize and drain the valve and pipeline.
LIMITED WARRANTY
All products are warranted to be free of defects in material and workmanship for a period of one year from the date
of
shipment, subject to the limitations below.
If the purchaser believes a product is defective, the purchaser shall: (a) Notify the manufacturer, state the alleged
defect and request permission to return the product; (b) if permission is given, return the product with transportation
prepaid. If the product is accepted for return and found to be defective, the manufacturer will, at his discretion, either
repair or replace the product, f.o.b. factory, within 60 days of receipt, or refund the purchase price. Other than to
repair, replace or refund as described above, purchaser agrees that manufacturer shall not be liable for any loss,
costs, expenses or damages of any kind arising out of the product, its use, installation or replacement, labeling,
instructions, information or technical data of any kind, description of product use, sample or model, warnings or lack
of any of the foregoing. NO OTHER WARRANTIES, WRITTEN OR ORAL, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING
THE WARRANTIES OF FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND MERCHANTABILITY, ARE MADE OR
AUTHORIZED. NO AFFIRMATION OF FACT, PROMISE, DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT OF USE OR SAMPLE
OR MODEL SHALL CREATE ANY WARRANTY FROM MANUFACTURER, UNLESS SIGNED BY THE
PRESIDENT OF THE MANUFACTURER. These products are not manufactured, sold or intended for personal,
family or household purposes.
SL
LUDG
GEE Val-Matic’s quality of design and meticulous SL
SLUDGE
WELL
WE workmanship has set the standards by which WE
W ELL
all others are measured. Quality design fea-
tures such as the AWWA Ener•G® Ball Valve
with its energy efficient design, fusion bonded Proven Design
epoxy and adjustable resilient seating....Cam-
Centric® Plug Valves have more requested
features than any other eccentric plug Preferred Features
PRIMARY Butterfly Valves
®
valve....American-BFV
include a field replaceable seat without the PRIIMAR
PR RY
SETTLING SETT
SETT
TTLI
LING
LIN
NG
AE
ER T ON
N need for special tools....Tilted Disc® Check Advanced Technology AERATION
Valves with high strength and wear resistant
aluminum bronze trim as standard....Silent
Check Valves featuring combined
resilient/metal-to-metal seating and are
NSF/ANSI 61 & 372 Certified....Sure Seal
Cam-Centric®
CA
ATIO
ON
Foot Valves provided with a heavy duty stain-
STORM FLOW
Plug Valves CL
LARIF
less steel screened inlet....Swing-Flex® and
SURGE TA
TANK
Surgebuster® Check Valves designed with
an unrestricted full flow area....Swing Check
Valves with field adjustable closure versatili-
ty....Dual Disc® Check Valves utiliting stabi-
lized components to provide extended
life....Air Release, Air/Vacuum and
Combination Air Valves provided standard
with Type 316 stainless steel trim....VaultSafe®
family of products includes the FloodSafe®
FLOC
OCCULA
ATIO
TION
TI ETT
TTLI
LN
NGG Inflow Preventer, FrostSafe ® two-way SETTLING FLOCCULA
ATION
BA
BA damper and the VentSafe® vent pipe secu- BASIN
rity cage. These features coupled with our
attention to detail put Val-Matic Valves in a
class by themselves. All products are WQA
certified Lead-Free in accordance with
NSF/ANSI 372.
Friction
Center Line Adjustment
of Plug Shaft Closed
Stop
F
G
H
E
C
I
J Lower Bearing
Journal
A
I H
Grit Seal Thrust
Bearing
G Radial Bearing
2
Feature Benefits
Proven Design are protected from grit related wear by the Grit-
With installations worldwide, the Val-Matic Cam- Guard™ seals (Figures 1 & 2).
Centric® Plug Valve has proven itself as the preferred
valve for wastewater, industrial waste and process
applications. The Cam-Centric® Plug Valve is a ¼ turn
eccentric plug valve allowing cost effective, low torque
actuation for pump control, shut-off and throttling Grit-Guard Thrust
service. The valve’s eccentric action rotates the plug in Bearing
V-TYPE
PACKING
POP™
GLAND SHIMS WITH Figure 3. Robotic welding of nickel seat
FOLLOWER PULL TABS
GRIT-GUARD™ RADIAL
BEARING The valve seat is a welded overlay of 95% pure nickel
applied directly to the body on a machined surface
using a state-of-the-art robotic welding system for a
consistent, high quality weld (Figure 3).
THRUST
BEARING Advanced Technology
Incorporating the latest in valve technology assures a
high-quality valve that will provide long service. The
Figure 1. Upper Bearing Journal
design process utilized solid Modeling and Finite
Element Analysis (FEA) of the key structural compo-
replacement of the V-Type packing can be done with- nents. Flow and torque data was derived from flow
out removal of the gear, motor or cylinder actuator. tests, mathematical models and Computational Fluid
Dynamics (CFD). Manufacturing technology uses auto-
The Cam-Centric® bearing package consists of perma- mated process control in the foundry and ISO 9001
nently lubricated, T316 stainless steel radial bearings in controlled manufacturing processes. Every valve is
both the upper and lower journals. The upper thrust tested in accordance with AWWA C517 and MSS SP-
bearing is made of Teflon and the lower thrust 108 on automated hydraulic test rigs with gauges cali-
bearing is T316 stainless steel. The bearings brated per ISO standards.
3
Actuation
The Cam-Centric® Plug Valve is available with a wide nets are also available (see accessories on page 7). Val-
range of actuation options, from simple lever opera- Matic Engineering personnel work closely with cylin-
tion to advanced pump control systems. Options der and electric actuation manufacturers to assure
include 2" operator nuts, worm gears, chainwheels, actuator/valve compatibility. This assures the actuator
electric motor and cylinder actuation. A wide variety you specify will deliver the performance you expect
of accessories such as floor stands and extended bon- when utilized with a Cam-Centric® Plug Valve.
Direct Nut operated valve with memory stop: Val-Matic Worm Gears:
• Adjustable open memory stop for system balancing • Heavy Duty, totally enclosed and sealed
• Adjustable close stop • For above ground and buried service applications
• Adjustable friction collar • Bronze radial bearings and roller thrust bearings
• For use with lever accessories provide smooth operations and extended life
D
A
F C
MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION
COMPONENT STANDARD
Body (5600R, 5700R, 5800R, 5900R) Cast Iron ASTM A126, Class B
Body (5400, 5500, 5800HP, 5900HP) Ductile Iron ASTM A536, Grade 65-45-12
Plug (5600R, 5700R, 5800R, 5900R) Cast Iron ASTM A126, Class B, Buna-N Encapsulated, ASTM D2000
Ductile Iron ASTM A536,
Plug (5400, 5500, 5800HP, 5900HP)
Grade 65-45-12, Buna-N Encapsulated, ASTM D2000
Radial Shaft Bearings T316 Stainless Steel
Top Thrust Bearing Teflon
Bottom Thrust Bearing T316 Stainless Steel
Available Coatings Two-Part Epoxy, Fusion Bonded Epoxy, Glass Lining, Rubber Lining
Accessories
Space limitations and application specifics often require special accessories. In addition to those shown below,
Val-Matic offers a wide range of accessories to meet your application requirements.
Floor Stand with Ground Level Chainlever “T” Wrench Extended Bonnet
Extension Stem Position Indicator
OPEN
OPEN
OPEN
SEAT END
7
Flow Characteristics
100
INHERENT PUMP CONTROL FLOW
90
CHARACTERISTICS
80
To control pressure surges and provide good-
controllability, the flow characteristics of
PERCENT OF FULL OPEN CV
BUTTERFLY
70 valves should be considered.
Installations
Cam-Centric® Plug Valve with worm 3-Way Cam-Centric® Plug Valves with
gear actuator and chainwheel Cam-Centric® Plug Valve with
Val-Matic Swing-Flex® worm gear actuators
SL
LUDG
GEE Val-Matic’s quality of design and meticulous SL
SLUDGE
WELL
WE workmanship has set the standards by which WE
W ELL
all others are measured. Quality design fea-
tures such as the AWWA Ener•G® Ball Valve
with its energy efficient design, fusion bonded Proven Design
epoxy and adjustable resilient seating....Cam-
Centric® Plug Valves have more requested
features than any other eccentric plug Preferred Features
PRIMARY Butterfly Valves
®
valve....American-BFV
include a field replaceable seat without the PRIIMAR
PR RY
SETTLING SETT
SETT
TTLI
LING
LIN
NG
AE
ER T ON
N need for special tools....Tilted Disc® Check Advanced Technology AERATION
Valves with high strength and wear resistant
aluminum bronze trim as standard....Silent
Check Valves featuring combined
resilient/metal-to-metal seating and are
NSF/ANSI 61 & 372 Certified....Sure Seal
Cam-Centric®
CA
ATIO
ON
Foot Valves provided with a heavy duty stain-
STORM FLOW
Plug Valves CL
LARIF
less steel screened inlet....Swing-Flex® and
SURGE TA
TANK
Surgebuster® Check Valves designed with
an unrestricted full flow area....Swing Check
Valves with field adjustable closure versatili-
ty....Dual Disc® Check Valves utilizing stabi-
lized components to provide extended
life....Air Release, Air/Vacuum and
Combination Air Valves provided standard
with Type 316 stainless steel trim....VaultSafe®
family of products includes the FloodSafe®
FLOC
OCCULA
ATIO
TION
TI ETT
TTLI
LN
NGG Inflow Preventer, FrostSafe ® two-way SETTLING FLOCCULA
ATION
BA
BA damper and the VentSafe® vent pipe secu- BASIN
rity cage. These features coupled with our
attention to detail put Val-Matic Valves in a
class by themselves. All products are WQA
certified Lead-Free in accordance with
NSF/ANSI 372.
270
90
OPEN
J
+
_ 1/4
G
+
_ 1/4
S E AT E N D C
F
+
_ 1/4
3 5803R/8A02 175 175 8.00 6.00 7.50 0.75 2 5/8-11 0.75 4.50 7.78 4.75 9.66 9.00 12.5 5/8 4
4 5804R/8A02 175 175 9.00 7.50 9.00 0.75 0 5.56 9.31 4.75 11.19 9.00 12.5 5/8 8
6 5806R/8A02 175 175 10.50 9.50 11.00 0.75 4 3/4-10 1.25 7.06 11.06 4.75 12.94 9.00 12.5 3/4 8
8 5808R/8A02 175 175 11.50 11.75 13.50 0.88 4 3/4-10 1.25 8.75 12.62 4.75 14.50 9.00 12.5 3/4 8
5810R/8C02 100 175
10 13.00 14.25 16.00 1.00 4 7/8-9 1.25 10.44 16.25 4.75 19.00 7.88 20 7/8 12
5810R/8D02 175 175
5812R/8C02 100 175
12 14.00 17.00 19.00 1.25 4 7/8-9 1.25 12.25 17.68 4.75 20.44 7.88 20 7/8 12
5812R/8D02 175 175
DATE Revised 5-17-10
ANSI CLASS 125 CAM-CENTRIC® FLANGED PLUG VALVE WITH BURIED WORM GEAR ACTUATOR 5-15-97
DRWG. NO.
®
AL ATIC VALVE AND MANUFACTURING CORP. VM-5804R/BWGA
180
270
CLOSE
90
OPEN
SEAT
END STANDARD POSITION
UNLESS OTHERWISE
A C T U ATO R SPECIFIED.
PLUG STOP
ADJUSTMENT MOUNTING POSITIONS
SCREWS
CL OF VALVE K COLD WORKING PRESSURE
H
175 P.S.I.
CL OF ECCENTRIC HYDRO TEST PRESSURE
265 P.S.I.
SEATING SURFACE
OPEN
J
+
_ 1/4
G
+
_ 1/4
C
S E AT E N D
E NUMBER OF D
TAPPED HOLES
PER FLANGE. A _+ 1/8
SEE DRAWING NO. VM-5804RN-M FOR STANDARD MATERIALS OF CONSTRUCTION.
VALVE
SIZE
MODEL
NO.
PRESS. RATING P.S.I.
A B C D E E E F G H J K
BOLT NO. OF NO. OF
REVERSE DIRECT (Qty.) (Tap) (Deep) SIZE BOLTS TURNS
2 1 / 2 5825R/7A08 175 175 7.50 5.50 7.00 0.69 4 5/8-11 0.69 4.50 7.50 3.06 10.00 9.50 5/8 4 12.5
3 5803R/7A08 175 175 8.00 6.00 7.50 0.75 4 5/8-11 1.00 4.50 7.50 3.06 10.00 9.50 5/8 4 12.5
4 5804R/7A08 175 175 9.00 7.50 9.00 0.75 0 5.56 9.31 3.06 11.18 9.50 5/8 8 12.5
6 5806R/7A08 175 175 10.50 9.50 11.00 0.75 4 3/4-10 1.25 7.06 11.06 3.06 12.94 9.50 3/4 8 12.5
5808R/7A12 100 175 11.50
8 11.50 11.75 13.50 0.88 4 3/4-10 1.25 8.75 12.62 3.06 14.50 3/4 8 12.5
5808R/7B16 175 175 9.38
5810R/7C12 100 175 13.13
10 13.00 14.25 16.00 1.00 4 7/8-9 1.25 10.44 16.25 4.75 19.00 7/ 12 20
5810R/7D16 175 175 11.00 8
5812R/7C16 100 175 11.00
12 14.00 17.00 19.00 1.25 4 7/8-9 1.25 12.50 17.69 4.75 20.44 7/ 12 20
5812R/7D24 175 175 16.75 8
DATE Revised 7-6-12
ANSI CLASS 125 FLANGED CAM-CENTRIC® PLUG VALVE WITH WORM GEAR ACTUATOR 3-21-96
DRWG. NO.
®
AL ATIC VALVE AND MANUFACTURING CORP. VM-5804R/WGA
Manual No.
CCPV-OM2-3
Val-Matic®
Cam-Centric® Plug Valve
INTRODUCTION........................................ 2
RECEIVING AND STORAGE .................... 2
DESCRIPTION OF OPERATION............... 2
VALVE CONSTRUCTION .......................... 3
INSTALLATION.......................................... 4
MAINTENANCE ......................................... 7
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................... 9
DISASSEMBLY .......................................... 9
REASSEMBLY ......................................... 10
PARTS & SERVICE ................................. 11
WARRANTY............................................. 11
INTRODUCTION
The Cam-Centric Plug Valve has been designed to
give years of trouble-free operation. This manual will
provide you with the information to properly install and
maintain the valve to ensure a long service life. The
valve is an eccentric, resilient seated, quarter-turn plug
valve capable of handling many types of fluids
including fluids with suspended solids. The Size,
Cold Working Pressure (CWP), Actuator Rating, and
Model No. are stamped on the nameplate for
reference.
DESCRIPTION OF OPERATION
As shown in Figure 2, the valve consists of a body and
quarter-turn plug that is offset from the seat centerline.
2
VALVE CONSTRUCTION
The standard Cam-Centric® Plug Valve is constructed ITEM DESCRIPTION MATERIAL
of rugged cast iron with a welded nickel seat and
permanently lubricated bearings. See the specific 1 Body Cast Iron with Overlay
Materials List submitted for the order if other than Welded Nickel Seat
standard cast iron construction. The details of 2 Cover Cast Iron
3 Plug* Cast Iron with
construction are illustrated in Figure 3.
Resilient Facing
6 Bearings* 316 Stainless Steel
The body (1) is available with flanged or mechanical 7 V-Type Packing* Buna-N
joint ends for connection to the pipeline. The valve is 8 Cover Seal* Buna-N
designed to be serviced in-line by removing the cast 15 Cover Bolt Alloy Steel, Gr 5
cover (2). The quarter-turn plug (3) is guided by sleeve 18 Packing Follower Cast Iron
bearings (6) located in the cover and lower boss in the 19 Follower Bolt Alloy Steel, Gr. 5
body. Grit-Guard seals (21) are located at the bottom 21 Grit-Guard* Buna-N
of the bearings (6) to prevent abrasive material from 22 Thrust Bearing* Teflon
wearing the bearing. Leak-tight closure is made when 23 Thrust Bearing* 316 Stainless Steel
24 Key Carbon Steel
the rubber-coated plug (3) is rotated into the nickel
29 Shims 304 Stainless Steel
seat on the “SEAT END” of the body.
*RECOMMENDED SPARE PART
3
INSTALLATION
The installation of the valve is important for its proper
operation. The valve is capable of flow in either
direction but the maximum operating pressure can vary
with the location of the seat end. The words “SEAT
END” are marked on the valve flange. Actuators are
available for pressures up to the full rating in both
direct and reverse pressure orientations. Actuator
ratings will be indicated on the nameplate. Higher
operating pressures may require adjustment of the
closed position stop or a larger actuator; consult the FIGURE 4. HORIZONTAL PIPE WITH SOLIDS
factory.
4
FLANGED ENDS: Flanged valves should be mated Place lubricated gasket and retainer gland over pipe
with flat-faced pipe flanges equipped with resilient end prior to installing valve. Install valve socket over
gaskets. When ring gaskets are used, the bolt material pipe. Press gland and gasket toward valve until gasket
should be ASTM A307 Grade B of SAE Grade 2 is evenly set into valve socket.
Carbon Steel. Higher strength bolts may only be used
with full-face gaskets.
MECHANICAL JOINT ENDS: Clean ends of mating TABLE 3. MECHANICAL JOINT NUT TORQUES
pipe and valve sockets with soapy water (Figure 7).
5
DIRECT NUT OPERATED VALVES: 8” and smaller LEVER OPERATED VALVES: A wrench head and
valves may be equipped with a top-mounted nut for lever (Figure 10) are available for use over the 2” nut
direct quarter-turn operation. The nut is 2” square to fit for direct quarter-turn operation. Various lever lengths
most valve wrenches and is mounted directly to the are available for specific direct and reverse pressure
valve plug. To open the valve, slowly rotate the nut 90 conditions as shown in Table 4.
degrees in the counter-clockwise (CCW) direction. The
closed position is adjusted with a set screw and lock
WRENCH LENGTH, (Inches)
nut, see Figure 8. The open position can be adjusted
VALVE DIRECT PRES. REVERSE PRES.
by moving the bolt along the curved slot.
SIZE 100 psi 175 psi 50 psi 175 psi
2 1/2 22 22 22 22
3 22 22 22 22
4 22 22 22 22
6 44 * 44 *
8 44 * 44 *
*Worm gear recommended due to operating torque
TABLE 4. APPLICATION OF LEVERS
6
GEAR ACTUATOR ADJUSTMENT: The standard CLOSED POSITION ADJUSTMENT: The standard
gear actuator is provided with factory-set open and valve is factory-set to seal at the “Actuator Pressure
closed position stops. If the valve does not shut off Ratings” shown on the nameplate for direct and
tight, the stop bolt can be adjusted allowing the plug to reverse pressure directions (see Figure 2). Higher
rotate further into the seat. Loosen the locknut, and pressure applications may require adjustment of the
turn the closed stop bolt CCW 1 turn at a time (Figure closed position stop or a larger actuator; consult the
11). If the valve continues to leak after all of the factory.
adjustment is taken verify the orientation of the valve
during installation. If a tight shut-off can not be If the valve is found to leak in the closed position due
achieved, a larger gear actuator may be required for to wear, the plug can be adjusted by loosening the
the system operating pressure; consult the factory. closed position stop on the actuator and rotating the
plug further into the seat. Because of the eccentric
action of the valve, further rotation will provide
CAUTION: Adjust closed stop bolt for tight
additional interference between the rubber plug surface
shut-off only. Over adjustment
and the body seat. Valves that have been in service
may cause high operating torques
for several years may require inspection of the plug for
and damage to the plug.
damage or wear. See the Disassembly Instructions of
this manual.
MAINTENANCE
The Cam Centric® Plug Valve requires no scheduled
lubrication or maintenance other than regular
exercising and occasional inspection of the plug. The
exercising is achieved by fully opening and closing the
valve to verify smooth operation. If operation is
difficult, it may be necessary to flush sediment from the
valve by opening and closing the valve several times
under flowing conditions.
7
PACKING REPLACEMENT: To replace the packing GEAR ACTUATOR MAINTENANCE: A typical gear
(7), it is recommended that the line be drained and the actuator is shown in Figure 13 and consists of a worm
actuator removed. The valve can remain in the line. Te (3) mounted on an input shaft (9). The worm engages
replace the packing, first open the valve and drain the a worm wheel (2). When the worm is turned, it drives
line. Close the valve to hold it in position. For power the wheel through 90 of rotation. The rotation of the
actuators, turn off and lock out electrical and hydraulic valve plug is displayed by the top indicator (5). The
supplies before proceeding. open and closed positions of the segment gear are
controlled by an end position stop bolts (20). The
CAUTION: Drain line and close valve before stops can be adjusted by loosening the lock nut (21)
removing actuator or valve may and rotating the bolts. The gears are lubricated with
rotate suddenly. Take precautions EP2 grease in a cast iron housing (1). Other parts are
against exposure to toxic or listed in Table 5.
hazardous fluids in the line.
The gear box is factory lubricated and sealed. No
Remove the small round cover on actuator to expose regular maintenance is required. If difficult operation is
shaft and key. Remove actuator mounting bolts and lift observed, the cover (4) can be removed and the unit
actuator from valve taking care not to lose square key. inspected for wear. All moving parts should be coated
See Figure 12 and remove gland bolts (19) and lift with grease. The grease should have an even and
follower (18) from the valve shaft. Remove old packing smooth consistency. If needed, coat all moving parts
(7) with packing hook. Lubricate new packing with with an lithium-based EP-2 grease such as Shell
FDA grease and set in place one ring at a time taking Alvania #2 or equal. Buried units should be packed
care not to bend over the lips of the packing rings. 90% with grease.
Reinstall follower with 2 shims (29) per bolt (3 shims
for 12” and larger valves). With valve in the closed
position, place the actuator over valve and reinsert key
(24). Finally, reinstall cover on actuator indicating
“Closed”.
8
ITEM DESCRIPTION MATERIAL • Noisy Operation: Flow noise is normal. Loud flow
noise similar to hammering may be cavitation from
1 Housing Cast Iron dropping high pressures across valve; review
2 Wormwheel Ductile Iron application of valve. For gear actuator noise, inspect
3 Worm Steel grease; add new grease if there are uncoated
4 Cover Cast Iron
moving parts or grease has broken down into oil.
5 Indicator Cast Iron
6 O-Ring Buna-N
7 Roller Bearing Steel DISASSEMBLY
8 Shaft Bearing Bronze Disassembly may be required to inspect the plug for
9 Shaft Steel wear or remove debris and deposits from the valve.
10 Gasket Fiber Work on the valve should be performed by a skilled
11 Handwheel Steel or Iron mechanic with proper tools and a power hoist for large
12 Operating Nut Iron
valves. The valve can be disassembled without
13 Chainwheel Iron
14 Cover Bolt Steel removing the valve from the pipeline. Refer to Figure
15 Indicator Bolt Steel 14 for valve construction and parts.
16 Pipe Plug Steel
17 Pin Steel WARNING: Open valve and drain line before
18 Spirol Pin Steel removing cover bolts or pressure
19 Spring Pin Steel may be released causing injury.
20 Screw Steel Place plug in lowest position
21 Jam Nut Steel
before removing actuator or plug
22 Plug Steel
23 U-Cup Seal Buna-N may rotate suddenly and jam or
damage plug surface.
• Leaking Oil: Tighten actuator cover bolts. If leak 5. Thrust bearing assembly (23) and packing gland
persists, remove actuator cover, inspect grease, and (18) can be removed by removing all of the hex
replace actuator gasket. nuts (12).
9
REASSEMBLY
All parts must be cleaned and gasket surfaces should 3. Apply thin film of FDA silicone grease such as
be cleaned with a stiff wire brush in the direction of the Dow Corning #7 to plug rubber surface. Place
serrations or machine marks. Worn parts, gaskets and stainless steel thrust bearing (23) over lower end
seals should be replaced during reassembly. of plug, Teflon bearing (22) over the upper end.
Install grit seals (21) over the shafts of the plug.
1/2"-13 45 - 75
5/8"-11 100 - 150
3/4"-10 150 - 250
7/8"-9 200 - 350
1"-8 300 - 500
1 1/8"-7 450 - 700
1 1/4"-7 650 - 1000
1 1/2"-6 750 - 1100
FIGURE 14. PLUG VALVE PARTS 7. Apply power to actuator and cycle valve. Apply
pressure to valve and check for cover and shaft
leakage. Tighten bolts as necessary. Adjust
packing if necessary.
LIMITED WARRANTY
All products are warranted to be free of defects in material and workmanship for a period of one year from the date of shipment,
subject to the limitations below.
If the purchaser believes a product is defective, the purchaser shall: (a) Notify the manufacturer, state the alleged defect and
request permission to return the product; (b) if permission is given, return the product with transportation prepaid. If the product
is accepted for return and found to be defective, the manufacturer will, at his discretion, either repair or replace the product,
f.o.b. factory, within 60 days of receipt, or refund the purchase price. Other than to repair, replace or refund as described
above, purchaser agrees that manufacturer shall not be liable for any loss, costs, expenses or damages of any kind arising out
of the product, its use, installation or replacement, labeling, instructions, information or technical data of any kind, description of
product use, sample or model, warnings or lack of any of the foregoing. NO OTHER WARRANTIES, WRITTEN OR ORAL,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING THE WARRANTIES OF FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
MERCHANTABILITY, ARE MADE OR AUTHORIZED. NO AFFIRMATION OF FACT, PROMISE, DESCRIPTION OF
PRODUCT OF USE OR SAMPLE OR MODEL SHALL CREATE ANY WARRANTY FROM MANUFACTURER, UNLESS
SIGNED BY THE PRESIDENT OF THE MANUFACTURER. These products are not manufactured, sold or intended for
personal, family or household purposes.
T-bolts and Nuts: High strength low alloy steel T-head bolt. National
coarse rolled thread and heavy hex nut. Steel meets AWWA C111
composition specifications. Stainless steel bolts and nuts avail-
able on request.
Use: Ductile Iron Pipe 3 - 24", cast iron pipe 3" - 24" (same OD's as
ductile iron) and IPS size STD steel pipe 3 - 12".
Not for use on PVC, HDPE pipe or
plain-end mechanical joint fittings.
To Order: Specify catalog number. Example: For a 12" RFCA Order: RFCA - 13.20 For applications on PVC, please
NOTE: 3" - 12" special Romac gasket works on both steel and D.I. ODs. contact your Romac representative.
LIST PRICE
NOM. GASKET GLAND CATALOG WEIGHT
PIPE RANGE LENGTH BOLTS NUMBER (lbs.)
Shopcoat Shopcoat Fusion Epoxy Fusion Epoxy
SIZE QTY: SIZE
w/Std. B&N w/304 SS B&N w/Std. B&N w/304SS B&N
3" 3.50-3.96 8.00" 4: 5/8" x 3" RFCA - 3.96 $145.45 $157.56 $165.10 $177.20 21
4" 4.50-4.80 9.00" 4: 3/4" x 3 1/2" RFCA -4.80 183.32 209.43 207.88 233.99 29
6" 6.63-6.90 9.25" 6: 3/4" x 4" RFCA - 6.90 233.85 273.01 267.10 306.26 40
8" 8.63-9.05 9.25" 6: 3/4" x 4" RFCA - 9.05 315.59 354.75 355.82 394.98 53
10" 10.75-11.10 10.25 8: 3/4" x 4" RFCA - 11.10 581.96 634.17 669.69 721.91 83
12" 12.75-13.20 10.25" 8: 3/4" x 4" RFCA - 13.20 632.13 684.34 739.86 792.07 110
14" 15.30 11.70" 10: 3/4" x 4 1/2" RFCA -15.30 882.79 947.37 1,020.54 1,085.12 170
16" 17.40 11.70" 12: 3/4" x 4 1/2" RFCA -17.40 1,225.93 1,302.91 1,410.23 1,487.21 200
18" 19.50 11.80" 12: 3/4" x 4 1/2" RFCA -19.50 1,346.63 1,423.60 1,546.13 1,623.10 217
20" 21.60 11.80 14: 3/4" x 4 1/2" RFCA - 21.60 1,521.19 1,611.94 1,772.94 1,863.69 256
24" 25.80 12.00" 16: 3/4" x 5" RFCA - 25.80 1,845.38 1,959.61 2,130.38 2,244.61 305
Some initial axial movement may occur in lug style restraints as the lugs seat. Movement is directly related to the size of the piping system
and the system pressure. In general terms movement of approximately 0.25" can be expected in restraints under 16”. For larger sizes,
movement of approximately 0.4” may be seen. If this is critical to your application please contact Romac Engineering for
additional information.
3-6
ROMAC
INDUSTRIES,
INC.
INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
Read installation instructions first before installing. Check parts to ensure that no damage has occurred during transit and that no
parts are missing. Also check the diameter of the pipe and the size marked on the coupling to ensure you have the proper size.
Step 5 • Place gasket over pipe with beveled edge toward Note:
the flange adapter. 90 ft-lbs. torque = 12" wrench w/90 lbs. force
Step 6 • Slide the RFCA on to For best results, wait 10 minutes and
the pipe. Position the pipe and 6 retighten bolts to proper torque.
flanged coupling against the
mating flange, inserting Step 10 • Hand tighten the restrainer bolts until the re-
flange gasket (14" and straining pads touch the
larger) between the flange
faces. Assemble the flange
surface of the pipe. 10
The bolts should
joint using flange bolts. be tightened in a
uniform criss-
7 cross pattern,
Step 7 • The pipe should until the
10/31/2007
21919 20th Avenue SE • Suite 100 • Bothell, WA 98021 • Phone (425) 951-6200 • 1-800-426-9341 • Fax (425) 951-6201
ROMAC
INDUSTRIES,
INC.
INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
RFCA Restrained Flange Coupling Adapter
NOT FOR USE ON PVC PIPE OR PLAIN END MECHANICAL JOINT FITTINGS
PRECAUTIONS
1. Check flange to make sure the bolt holes match the RFCA.
2. Make sure a flange gasket is used between the mating flanges on sizes 14" and larger.
3. Check diameter of pipe to make sure you are using the correct size RFCA; also check gasket to make sure it is the
size you think it is.
4. Be sure to clean pipe of as much dirt and corrosion as possible in the area that the gasket will seal.
5. Lubricate both the gasket and the pipe end with soapy water or approved pipe lubricant per ANSI/AWWA C111/
A21.11.
6. Make sure no foreign materials lodge between gasket and pipe.
7. Avoid loose fitting wrenches, or wrenches too short to achieve proper torque.
8. Keep threads free of foreign material to allow proper tightening.
9. Take extra care to follow proper bolt tightening procedures and torque recommendations. Bolts are often not tightened
enough when a torque wrench is not used.
10. Be sure that the gland is centered around the pipe.
11. Pressure test for leaks before backfilling.
12. Backfill and compact carefully around pipe and fittings.
13. Some initial axial movement may occur in lug style restraints as the lugs seat. Movement is directly related
to the size of the piping system and the system pressure. In general terms movement of approximately
0.25" can be expected in restraints under 16”. For larger sizes, movement of approximately 0.4” may be seen. If
this is critical to your application please contact Romac Engineering for additional information.
3. To reassemble, follow installation procedures. Tighten the restraining bolts using a 5/8" hex wrench to 75-ft-lbs
minimum.
21919 20th Avenue SE • Suite 100 • Bothell, WA 98021 • Phone (425) 951-6200 • 1-800-426-9341 • Fax (425) 951-6201
KOR-N-SEAL® I & II
FLEXIBLE PIPE-TO-MANHOLE CONNECTORS
SPECIFICATION SHEET
Stainless Steel
Stainless Steel
Korband
Pipe Clamp
Install Kor-N-Seal I - Wedge Korband Install Kor-N-Seal II - Wedge Korband Install Pipe Clamp(s)
with Socket Wrench & Torque Limiter with Standard Torque Wrench with T-Handle Torque Wrench
www.npc.com
250 Elm Street • P.O. Box 301
Milford, NH 03055, U.S.A.
Tel: 603-673-8680 • 800-626-2180 • Fax: 603-673-7271
02/06
KOR-N-SEAL® I & II
Flexible Pipe-to-Manhole Connectors
SPECIFICATION SHEET
PERFORMANCE
Test ASTM Method Test Requirements Kor-N-Seal ® I & II
Head Pressure C923 - 7.1 0° - 13 psi (30 ft) for 10 min. +13 psi for 10 min.
7° - 10 psi (23 ft) for 10 min. +10 psi for 10 min.
Deflection Test C923 - 7.2.2 7° in any direction Over 7° in any direction
Load Test C923 - 7.2.3 150 lbs/in. pipe dia. Over 150 lbs/in. pipe dia.
Performed on all standard sizes of Kor-N-Seal Connectors.
Accelerated Oven-Aging D573 70 ± 1°C for 7 days Decrease of 15%, max. of original 10.1% tensile decrease
tensile strength, decrease of 14.0% elongation decrease
20% max. of elongation
Compression Set D395, method B, at 70°C Decrease of 25%, max. 13% decrease
for 22 h of original deflection
Water Absorption D471, immerse 0.75 by 2-in. Increase of 10%, max. .8% increase
specimen in distilled of original by weight
water at 70°C for 48 h
INTERNAL KORBAND
Conforms to ASTM C923, ASTM A666, and A240
– Korband Assembly is manufactured of 300 series stainless steel.
– Toggle Expander is made of 300 series stainless steel.
– The 106/406 series Wedge Expander is made from reinforced nylon or 300 series stainless steel.
– The 206/306 series Wedge Expander is made from 300 series stainless steel.
Product Application:
NPC Kor-N-Seal connectors are designed and manufactured to meet or exceed the requirements
of ASTM C-923 "Standard Specification for Resilient Connectors Between Reinforced Concrete
Manhole Structures, Pipes and Laterals". This specification requires the connector to provide a
watertight seal under the following conditions:
Principle of Operation:
The Kor-N-Seal connector creates a watertight seal between the
pipe and manhole by first sealing to the inside of the cored or
formed hole in the manhole and then sealing to the outside of the
pipe. See illustration at right.
The seal at the inside of the manhole is created by the stainless steel
Korband. The Korband is located inside of the end of the Kor-N-
Seal connector that fits into the manhole. Once the Kor-N-Seal
connector is located in the manhole, the diameter of the Korband is
increased. This compresses the Kor-N-Seal connector against the
inside wall of the hole in the manhole creating a watertight seal at
the manhole.
The seal at the outside of the pipe is created by the stainless steel
pipe clamp(s). The pipe clamp is located on the outside of the Kor-
N-Seal connector. Once the pipe has been positioned in the
connector the diameter of the pipe clamp is decreased. This
compresses the Kor-N-Seal connector against the outside wall of
the pipe creating a watertight seal at the pipe.
4. Tighten Wedge Expander using 1/2" [13 mm] socket with a preset torque limiter 10 – 24 12 91440-12
for each. For each size connector use torque limiter preset to proper torque. [254 – 610] [16]
(Fig. 4) Retorquing is not required prior to shipment.
Fig. 4
CAUTION: DO NOT USE IMPACT WRENCH.
Inner wall
Korband
Outer Wall
PIPE INSTALLATION:
1. Center pipe in Connector opening.
2. On maximum pipe O.D. installations, use a pipe lubricant on the outside barrel of the pipe and/or the inside
ridges of the Connector (under the Pipe Clamp area) to allow the pipe to slide into place more easily.
3. Position the Pipe Clamp in the Connector's Pipe Clamp groove with the screw at the top.
4. Tighten the Pipe Clamp screw to 60 inch pounds [7 Newton Meters] with a T-handle Torque Wrench, P/N 80090.
5. On minimum pipe O.D. installations, lift the rubber up underneath the Pipe Clamp screw so that the Connector
contacts the bottom surface of the pipe while the Pipe Clamp screw is being tightened. Application of pipe
lubrication on the underside of the clamp will also help assure that an even contraction of rubber is maintained
throughout the clamping area.
6. After the Pipe Clamp has been tightened down firmly, move the pipe horizontally and/or vertically to bring
it to grade.
www.npc.com
CAUTION:
All capped stubs awaiting pipe installation at a later date must
be restrained. Assure that a proper backfill material is used in 250 Elm Street • P.O. Box 301
adverse conditions. Prior to any critical usage, contact NPC
Customer service at 1-800-626-2180. Milford, NH 03055, U.S.A.
Tel: 603-673-8680 • 800-626-2180 • Fax: 603-673-7271
KOR-N-SEAL I –
STAINLESS STEEL WEDGE
Recommended Installation Procedure
D
A B C
www.npc.com
250 Elm Street • P.O. Box 301
Milford, NH 03055, U.S.A.
Tel: 603-673-8680 • 800-626-2180 • Fax: 603-673-7271 08/06
P R O D U C T S P E C I F I C A T I O N S
CS-202
Butyl Rubber Sealant
APPLICATIONS
For self-sealing joints in: Manholes, Concrete Vaults, Septic Tanks, Concrete Pipe,
Box Culverts, Utility Vaults, Burial Vaults, and Vertical Panel Structures.
SEALING PROPERTIES
HYDROSTATIC STRENGTH
SPECIFICATIONS
1
P.O. Box 176, New Carlisle OH, 45344 • 937.845.8776 or 800.332.7325
FAX 937-845-3587 • www.conseal.com
P R O D U C T S P E C I F I C A T I O N S
CS-202
Butyl Rubber Sealant
PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
Spec Required* CS-202
Hydrocarbon blend content % by ASTM D4 (mod.) 50% min. 52%
weight
Inert mineral filler % by weight AASHTO T111 30% min. 35%
Volatile Matter % by weight ASTM D6 2% max. 1.2
Specific Gravity, 77°F ASTM D71 1.15-1.50 1.20
Ductility, 77°F ASTM D113 5.0 min. 12
Penetration, cone 77°F, 150 gm. 5 ASTM D217 50-100 60-65
sec.
Penetration, cone 32°F, 150 gm. 5 ASTM D217 40 mm 50-55
sec.
Flash Point, C.O.C., °F ASTM D92 350°F min. 425°F
Fire point, C.O.C., °F ASTM D92 375°F min. 450°F
IMMERSION TESTING
2
P.O. Box 176, New Carlisle OH, 45344 • 937.845.8776 or 800.332.7325
FAX 937-845-3587 • www.conseal.com
PRODUCT DATA SHEET
TNEME-LINER SERIES 61
PRODUCT PROFILE
COATING SYSTEM
SURFACE PREPARATION
STEEL Immersion Service: SSPC-SP10/NACE 2 Near-White Blast Cleaning obtaining a minimum angular anchor profile of 2.0 mils
(50 microns).
CONCRETE Allow new concrete to cure for 28 days. Abrasive blast referencing SSPC-SP13/NACE 6, ICRI-CSP3-5 Surface Preparation of
Concrete and Tnemec’s Surface Preparation and Application Guide.
ALL SURFACES Must be clean, dry and free of oil, grease and other contaminants.
TECHNICAL DATA
APPLICATION
Published technical data and instructions are subject to change without notice. The online catalog at www.tnemec.com
© November 05, 2012 by Tnemec Co., Inc. should be referenced for the most current technical data and instructions or you may contact your Tnemec representative Page 1 of 2
for current technical data and instructions.
PRODUCT DATA SHEET
TNEME-LINER | SERIES 61
COVERAGE RATES For JP-4, JP-5, JP-8
Aviation Gas, Jet A-1 Service
Dry Mils (Microns) Wet Mils (Microns) Sq Ft/Gal (m²/Gal)
Suggested 5.0 (125) 6.0 (150) 263 (24.4)
Minimum 4.0 (100) 5.0 (125) 329 (30.6)
Maximum 6.0 (150) 7.5 (190) 219 (20.4)
Allow for overspray and surface irregularities. Film thickness is rounded to the nearest 0.5 mil or 5 microns. Application of
coating below minimum or above maximum recommended dry film thicknesses may adversely affect coating
performance. †
MIXING Power mix contents of each container, making sure no pigment remains on the bottom. Pour a measured amount of Part
B into a clean container large enough to hold both components. Add an equal volume of Part A to Part B while under
agitation. Continue agitation until the two components are thoroughly mixed. Do not use mixed material beyond pot life
limits. Note: Both components must be above 60°F (16°C) prior to mixing. Mixing ratio is one to one by volume. A large
volume of material will set up quickly if not applied or reduced in volume. Caution: Do not reseal mixed material. An
explosion hazard may be created.
THINNING Use No. 2 Thinner. For air spray, thin up to 10% or 12 oz (354 mL) per gallon. For airless spray or brush, thin up to 5% or
6 oz (177 mL) per gallon. Note: A maximum of 6% or 7 oz (207 mL) per gallon of No. 2 Thinner may be used to comply
with VOC regulations.
POT LIFE 2 1/2 hours at 60°F (16°C) 1 1/2 hours at 77°F (25°C) 45 minutes at 100°F (38°C)
APPLICATION EQUIPMENT Air Spray
Atomizing
Gun Fluid Tip Air Cap Air Hose ID Mat’l Hose ID Pot Pressure
Pressure
3/8” or 1/2”
5/16” or 3/8” 60-90 psi 10-20 psi
DeVilbiss JGA E 765 or 704 (9.5 or 12.7
(7.9 or 9.5 mm) (4.1-6.2 bar) (0.7-1.4 bar)
mm)
Low temperatures or longer hoses require higher pot pressure.
Airless Spray
Tip Orifice Atomizing Pressure Mat’l Hose ID Manifold Filter
0.015”-0.021” 3000-3800 psi 1/4” or 3/8” 60 mesh
(380-535 microns) (207-262 bar) (6.4 or 9.5 mm) (250 microns)
Use appropriate tip/atomizing pressure for equipment, applicator technique and weather conditions.
Brush: Recommended for small areas only. Use high quality natural or synthetic bristle brushes. Note: Two or more coats
may be required to obtain recommended film thicknesses.
SURFACE TEMPERATURE Minimum 60°F (16°C) Maximum 135°F (57°C)
The surface should be dry and at least 5°F (3°C) above the dew point. Coating will not cure below minimum surface
temperature.
CLEANUP Flush and clean all equipment immediately after use with the recommended thinner, xylol or MEK.
WARRANTY & LIMITATION OF SELLER'S LIABILITY: Tnemec Company, Inc. warrants only that its coatings represented herein meet the formulation standards of Tnemec Company, Inc. THE
WARRANTY DESCRIBED IN THE ABOVE PARAGRAPH SHALL BE IN LIEU OF ANY OTHER WARRANTY, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO, ANY IMPLIED
WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THERE ARE NO WARRANTIES THAT EXTEND BEYOND THE DESCRIPTION ON THE FACE HEREOF. The
buyer's sole and exclusive remedy against Tnemec Company, Inc. shall be for replacement of the product in the event a defective condition of the product should be found to exist and the
exclusive remedy shall not have failed its essential purpose as long as Tnemec is willing to provide comparable replacement product to the buyer. NO OTHER REMEDY (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES FOR LOST PROFITS, LOST SALES, INJURY TO PERSON OR PROPERTY, ENVIRONMENTAL INJURIES OR ANY OTHER INCIDENTAL
OR CONSEQUENTIAL LOSS) SHALL BE AVAILABLE TO THE BUYER. Technical and application information herein is provided for the purpose of establishing a general profile of the coating and
proper coating application procedures. Test performance results were obtained in a controlled environment and Tnemec Company makes no claim that these tests or any other tests, accurately
represent all environments. As application, environmental and design factors can vary significantly, due care should be exercised in the selection and use of the coating.
Tnemec Company Incorporated 6800 Corporate Drive Kansas City, Missouri 64120-1372 1-800-TNEMEC1 Fax: 1-816-483-3969 www.tnemec.com
© November 05, 2012 by Tnemec Co., Inc. PDS61 Page 2 of 2
Figure 420
BRASS BODY BALL VALVES
600
Up to 2”
500
Pressure (PSIG)
The contents of this publication are presented for information purposes only, and while effort has been made to ensure their accuracy, they are not to be construed as warranties or guarantees,
expressed or implied, regarding the products or services described herein or their use or applicability. All sales are governed by our terms and conditions, which are available on request. We
reserve the right to modify or improve the designs or specifications of our products at any time without notice. Always verify that you have the most recent product specifications or other
documentation prior to the installation of these products.
Model A4 Intrinsically Safe and Non-Incendive
Pressure Transmitter
APPLICATIONS: ENVIRONMENTAL SPECIFICATIONS
Temperature Limits:
Oil field equipment, upstream oil and Storage: –40 to +125°C (–40 to 257°F)
gas production, natural gas compression Process: –40 to +125°C (–40 to 257°F)
and transfer control, alternative energy Operating: –40 to +125°C (–40 to 257°F)
Compensated*:–20 to +85°C ( –4 to 185°F)
projects *Consult factory for other options
All specifications are subject to change without notice. Ashcroft Inc., 250 East Main Street, Stratford, CT 06614 USA
All sales subject to standard terms and conditions. Tel: 203-378-8281 • Fax: 203-385-0408
BULLETIN A4-1 © Ashcroft Inc. 2012 Rev. 07/12 email: info@ashcroft.com • www.ashcroft.com
Model A4 Intrinsically Safe and Non-Incendive
Rated Pressure Transmitter
DIMENSIONS dimensions in ( ) are mm
.50˝ .887˝
(13) (22.5)
4.45˝
(113)
3.065˝
(78) 4.78˝
(121)
3.065˝
1.06˝ (78) 1.06˝
(27) (27)
DIA. DIA.
.885˝ .675˝
1.06˝ (27) Hex.
(22) (17)
Common For All
Pressure Fittings
NOTE:
Refer to Ashcroft Model A2 for Heavy Industrial, non-hazardous rated configurations
and Ashcroft Model A2X for Explosion / Flame Proof applications.
How To Order
A 4 S A M 02 42 D1 60 # G X
Type Accuracy / Temp. EffectS Output Signal Electrical Termination Pressure Range Measurement Optional
Configuration (A) 0.25%/≤1.0% (–20°C to +85°C) (42) 4-20mA Integral Cable (Pigtail) Type X-Variations
(A4) (B) 0.50%/≤2.0% (–20°C to +85°C) (F2) 3 shielded cable(1) (1.5#) 1.5 psi(5),(6) (750#) 750 psi (G) Gauge (XCL)
(C) 1.00%/≤2.0% (–20°C to +85°C) (P1) (specify length)(1) (5#) 5 psi(5),(6) (1000#) 1000 psi Pressure Non-standard(7)
Hirschmann Style Form A (10#) 10 psi(5),(6) (1500#) 1500 psi Sensor calibration
Enclosure DIN 43650-A (15#) 15 psi(5) (2000#) 2000 psi (A) Absolute (XK8)
(S) Basic (DN) w/o mating conn.(1) (30#) 30 psi(5) (3000#) 3000 psi Pressure
(D0) with mate, no cable(1) 17-4PH SS Sensor
(W) Welded w/out Zero & Span (50#) 50 psi (5000#) 5000 psi Sensor
(D2) with mate, 3 cable(1) Material
Access Pressure Connection (60#) 60 psi (7500#) 7500 psi
(D1) with mate, (specify length)(1) (X6B)
(M01) ⁄8 NPT-M
1
(F04) 1⁄2 NPT-F (75#) 75 psi (10,000#) 10,000 psi(4)
(M02) ⁄4 NPT-M
1 4-Pin Bendix Style
(100#) 100 psi (0# & vac.) 0 psi/vac.(5),(6) Cleaned For
(MG4) G 1⁄2 M (B4) w/o mating conn.(2) Oxygen Service
(See electrical termination (F02) 1
⁄4 NPT-F (VM2) VCR inlet fitting (H1) with mate, no cable(2) (150#) 150 psi (15# & vac.) Vac./15 psi (5),(6)
(1)
Available with enclosure code (S)
(2)
Available with enclosure code (S, W)
NOTE: All A4 pressure transmitters include a 9 pt. NIST traceable calibration certificate (3)
Available with enclosure code (W)
All specifications are subject to change without notice. Ashcroft Inc., 250 East Main Street, Stratford, CT 06614 USA
All sales subject to standard terms and conditions. Tel: 203-378-8281 • Fax: 203-385-0408
BULLETIN A4-1 © Ashcroft Inc. 2012 Rev. 07/12 email: info@ashcroft.com • www.ashcroft.com
3.06 METER VAULT
This section contains information pertaining to the meter vault. There is both technical
information and related drawings necessary for the meter vault construction.
Telephone 602-264-6831
Phoenix, Arizona 85014
4550 North 12th Street
ITEM QTY STOCK NUMBER DESCRIPTION
http://www.cvlci.com
1 1 20-6221 BASE - VV - 444B
2 4 22-5245 RISER - VV - 444 - 1 FT
4'-0" 3 1 23-4713 HATCH - FLOODTIGHT - H20 - 24X30
4 1 24-4716 TOP SLAB -VV - 444 - H20
5 2 25-5158 PIPE STAND - 12in - S92 SAD - NO BASE
3'-6"
8 1 40-XXXX PIPE - 316SS - 12in X 48 IN
9 1 41-XXXX FLOW TUBE - 12in - ABB WATER MASTER
12
10 2 42-5271 MEGAFLANGE ADAPTER - 12in - SERIES2100
11 2 43-5193 KOR-N-SEAL - 16in CORE - 12in PIPE
11
10 9 10 8 11 8 12 1 45-5589 SPOOL - FLG X PE - 12in X 60in - SCH40 316SS
13 1 47-5267 GASKET - FLANGE - 12in X 1/8in
14 105 51-5510 SEALANT - .75in X .75in X 21ft CS-202
15 85 51-5949 TAPECOAT - 6in X .65mils X LFT
16 1 51-ROM NEVER SIEZE - TUBE
3'-6" 4'-0"
17 1 62-XXXX TRANSMITTER - ABB - IP68 RATED
18 1 62-XXXX SIGNAL CABLE - ABB - 100FT
61
69 5/8
2
6'-11"
18
1 17
13 9 10 8
12 10 11
11
C.L. DISCHARGE ELEVATION: 95.32'
M5
CVL Contact: ERIC LAURIN
CVL Project #: 1.01.0204801
CVL File #:
10-14-11
3.06.4 METER VAULT DATA SHEETS
CS-202
Butyl Rubber Sealant
APPLICATIONS
For self-sealing joints in: Manholes, Concrete Vaults, Septic Tanks, Concrete Pipe,
Box Culverts, Utility Vaults, Burial Vaults, and Vertical Panel Structures.
SEALING PROPERTIES
HYDROSTATIC STRENGTH
SPECIFICATIONS
1
P.O. Box 176, New Carlisle OH, 45344 • 937.845.8776 or 800.332.7325
FAX 937-845-3587 • www.conseal.com
P R O D U C T S P E C I F I C A T I O N S
CS-202
Butyl Rubber Sealant
PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
Spec Required* CS-202
Hydrocarbon blend content % by ASTM D4 (mod.) 50% min. 52%
weight
Inert mineral filler % by weight AASHTO T111 30% min. 35%
Volatile Matter % by weight ASTM D6 2% max. 1.2
Specific Gravity, 77°F ASTM D71 1.15-1.50 1.20
Ductility, 77°F ASTM D113 5.0 min. 12
Penetration, cone 77°F, 150 gm. 5 ASTM D217 50-100 60-65
sec.
Penetration, cone 32°F, 150 gm. 5 ASTM D217 40 mm 50-55
sec.
Flash Point, C.O.C., °F ASTM D92 350°F min. 425°F
Fire point, C.O.C., °F ASTM D92 375°F min. 450°F
IMMERSION TESTING
2
P.O. Box 176, New Carlisle OH, 45344 • 937.845.8776 or 800.332.7325
FAX 937-845-3587 • www.conseal.com
ROMTEC UTILITIES RECOMMENTATION FOR USE AS JOINT TAPE
TAPECOAT M860
®
Tapecoat® M860
- Applies easily in long lengths or short pieces
A pre-formed, cold-applied, self-adhering
- Cold-applied tape with quick release liner material that is impermeable to water and salt.
Surface Preparation
Tapecoat M860 should be applied over dry pavement
that is free of dirt, debris or other foreign matter.
Pavement cracks wider than 3/8” should be pre-filled
with hot or cold crack material prior to applying
Tapecoat M860 to assure longer protection of the crack
filling material against surface wear.
Option
If the application is taking place in extreme cold (below
32˚F/O˚C) a liquid primer will enhance the immediate
bond. TC Omniprime is the compatible primer for use
with this product.
PO Box 631, Evanston, IL 60204-0631 • 1527 Lyons St. Evanston, IL 60201-3551 USA
800/758-6041 847/866-8500 Fax: 800/332-8273 Fax: 847/866-8596 www.tapecoat.com
KOR-N-SEAL® I & II
FLEXIBLE PIPE-TO-MANHOLE CONNECTORS
SPECIFICATION SHEET
Stainless Steel
Stainless Steel
Korband
Pipe Clamp
Install Kor-N-Seal I - Wedge Korband Install Kor-N-Seal II - Wedge Korband Install Pipe Clamp(s)
with Socket Wrench & Torque Limiter with Standard Torque Wrench with T-Handle Torque Wrench
www.npc.com
250 Elm Street • P.O. Box 301
Milford, NH 03055, U.S.A.
Tel: 603-673-8680 • 800-626-2180 • Fax: 603-673-7271
02/06
KOR-N-SEAL® I & II
Flexible Pipe-to-Manhole Connectors
SPECIFICATION SHEET
PERFORMANCE
Test ASTM Method Test Requirements Kor-N-Seal ® I & II
Head Pressure C923 - 7.1 0° - 13 psi (30 ft) for 10 min. +13 psi for 10 min.
7° - 10 psi (23 ft) for 10 min. +10 psi for 10 min.
Deflection Test C923 - 7.2.2 7° in any direction Over 7° in any direction
Load Test C923 - 7.2.3 150 lbs/in. pipe dia. Over 150 lbs/in. pipe dia.
Performed on all standard sizes of Kor-N-Seal Connectors.
Accelerated Oven-Aging D573 70 ± 1°C for 7 days Decrease of 15%, max. of original 10.1% tensile decrease
tensile strength, decrease of 14.0% elongation decrease
20% max. of elongation
Compression Set D395, method B, at 70°C Decrease of 25%, max. 13% decrease
for 22 h of original deflection
Water Absorption D471, immerse 0.75 by 2-in. Increase of 10%, max. .8% increase
specimen in distilled of original by weight
water at 70°C for 48 h
INTERNAL KORBAND
Conforms to ASTM C923, ASTM A666, and A240
– Korband Assembly is manufactured of 300 series stainless steel.
– Toggle Expander is made of 300 series stainless steel.
– The 106/406 series Wedge Expander is made from reinforced nylon or 300 series stainless steel.
– The 206/306 series Wedge Expander is made from 300 series stainless steel.
Product Application:
NPC Kor-N-Seal connectors are designed and manufactured to meet or exceed the requirements
of ASTM C-923 "Standard Specification for Resilient Connectors Between Reinforced Concrete
Manhole Structures, Pipes and Laterals". This specification requires the connector to provide a
watertight seal under the following conditions:
Principle of Operation:
The Kor-N-Seal connector creates a watertight seal between the
pipe and manhole by first sealing to the inside of the cored or
formed hole in the manhole and then sealing to the outside of the
pipe. See illustration at right.
The seal at the inside of the manhole is created by the stainless steel
Korband. The Korband is located inside of the end of the Kor-N-
Seal connector that fits into the manhole. Once the Kor-N-Seal
connector is located in the manhole, the diameter of the Korband is
increased. This compresses the Kor-N-Seal connector against the
inside wall of the hole in the manhole creating a watertight seal at
the manhole.
The seal at the outside of the pipe is created by the stainless steel
pipe clamp(s). The pipe clamp is located on the outside of the Kor-
N-Seal connector. Once the pipe has been positioned in the
connector the diameter of the pipe clamp is decreased. This
compresses the Kor-N-Seal connector against the outside wall of
the pipe creating a watertight seal at the pipe.
4. Tighten Wedge Expander using 1/2" [13 mm] socket with a preset torque limiter 10 – 24 12 91440-12
for each. For each size connector use torque limiter preset to proper torque. [254 – 610] [16]
(Fig. 4) Retorquing is not required prior to shipment.
Fig. 4
CAUTION: DO NOT USE IMPACT WRENCH.
Inner wall
Korband
Outer Wall
PIPE INSTALLATION:
1. Center pipe in Connector opening.
2. On maximum pipe O.D. installations, use a pipe lubricant on the outside barrel of the pipe and/or the inside
ridges of the Connector (under the Pipe Clamp area) to allow the pipe to slide into place more easily.
3. Position the Pipe Clamp in the Connector's Pipe Clamp groove with the screw at the top.
4. Tighten the Pipe Clamp screw to 60 inch pounds [7 Newton Meters] with a T-handle Torque Wrench, P/N 80090.
5. On minimum pipe O.D. installations, lift the rubber up underneath the Pipe Clamp screw so that the Connector
contacts the bottom surface of the pipe while the Pipe Clamp screw is being tightened. Application of pipe
lubrication on the underside of the clamp will also help assure that an even contraction of rubber is maintained
throughout the clamping area.
6. After the Pipe Clamp has been tightened down firmly, move the pipe horizontally and/or vertically to bring
it to grade.
www.npc.com
CAUTION:
All capped stubs awaiting pipe installation at a later date must
be restrained. Assure that a proper backfill material is used in 250 Elm Street • P.O. Box 301
adverse conditions. Prior to any critical usage, contact NPC
Customer service at 1-800-626-2180. Milford, NH 03055, U.S.A.
Tel: 603-673-8680 • 800-626-2180 • Fax: 603-673-7271
KOR-N-SEAL I –
STAINLESS STEEL WEDGE
Recommended Installation Procedure
D
A B C
www.npc.com
250 Elm Street • P.O. Box 301
Milford, NH 03055, U.S.A.
Tel: 603-673-8680 • 800-626-2180 • Fax: 603-673-7271 08/06
Series 2100
MEGAFLANGE®
Restrained Flange Adapter
U.S. Patent Nos. 4627774 and 5071175
Features and Applications:
• For adapting and restraining a plain end of duc-
tile iron, PVC, or Steel pipe to a flange, conform-
ing to ANSI/AWWA C110/A21.10. Not for use
on plain end fittings.
• Fully Restrained
• Joint deflection up to 5°
All internal surfaces of the gasket ring (wetted parts) shall be lined with a
minimum of 15 mils of fusion bonded epoxy conforming to the applicable
requirements of ANSI/AWWA C213. Sealing gaskets shall be constructed of
EPDM. The coating and gaskets shall meet ANSI/NSF-61. Exterior surfaces
of the gasket ring shall be coated with a minimum of 6 mils of fusion
bonded epoxy conforming to the applicable requirements of ANSI/AWWA
C116/A21.16.
ØP ØK C ØF ØB ØG ØX
MEGAFLANGE ADVANTAGES
● Fully Restrained
● Time Saving and Field Adaptable
● Pipe can be cut to length at the job site
● Can be used on Ductile Iron, PVC, and Steel (See pressure Rating chart for details)
● Wedges securely grip the pipe much better than set screws
● Easy disassembly allows fast removal of valves, meters, or fittings for
replacement or repair
C900 PVC Pipe IPS PVC Pipe*
Ductile Iron Steel Pipe* DR14 DR18 DR25 DR32.5 SDR17 SDR21 SDR26
Pipe
Pipe Pressure Pressure Pressure Pressure Pressure Pressure Pressure Pressure Pressure
Size (PSI) (PSI) (PSI) (PSI) (PSI) (PSI) (PSI) (PSI) (PSI)
Series 2100 MEGAFLANGE comes with all the necessary seals and bolts, for a complete and total install.
MEGAFLANGE TESTING RESULTS
PVC TESTING
•Quick Burst Test
•DR18 tested to 755 PSI
•DR14 tested to 985 PSI
•Long Term Pressure Test
•On DR18 PVC pipe at 615 PSI for 1000 hours without failure
•Cyclic Pressure Test
•DR18 tested from 94 to 188 PSI for over 1,000,000 cycles
The Series 2100 MEGAFLANGE restrained flange adapter is comprised of two rings. The
first is the restraint ring which incorporates wedges around the circumference of the ring to
grip the pipe firmly and securely. The wedge style restraint offers enormous pullout strength
when compared to set screw restraints. The resiliency of the wedge style restraint allows
the Series 2100 to withstand severe moment loads.
The second ring is the gasket ring which separates the seals dedicated to each sealing
surface. This ring allows pipe to be cut to lengths in the field at a tolerance of 0.6 inch or
more. In addition, the gasket ring also enables the joint to deflect during assembly.
DEFLECTION
Traditional flanged joint connections require a tremendous amount of torque on the bolts
to achieve a good seal. The pipe layout must be precisely planed to avoid misalignment er-
rors due to deviations in appurtenances of pipe fabrication.
The Series 2100 MEGAFLANGE is a speedy, on-site fabrication tool which is generous in
its deflection limits, from 0.5º to 5º depending on pipe size. The deflection capabilities pro-
vided by the gasket ring allow offset of almost nineteen inches of an eighteen foot length of
pip through the eight inch size.
1. Identify the pipe. The MEGAFLANGE 2100 Flange Adapter, sizes 4 inch through 12 inch, is designed for
use on ductile iron pipe, PVC (C900 & IPS O.D. (ASTM D2241)) pipe, and steel pipe. Check to see if the spac-
ers under the screws are in place. If the pipe is ductile iron or C.I. O.D. PVC (C900) DO NOT REMOVE THE
SPACERS. If the pipe is steel or IPS O.D. PVC, REMOVE THE SPACERS (sizes 4 inch through 12 inch). The
3 inch size is designed for use on ductile iron, IPS O.D. PVC pipe. Sizes 30 inch and larger are designed for
ductile iron pipe only. There are no spacers on the 3 inch and the 14 inch and larger sizes.
2. Cut the pipe to the required 3. Lubricate and place the EBAA- 4. Place the O-ring into the groove
length. Clean the end of the pipe Seal™ Gasket on the clean of the 2100 gasket ring. (This
for a length approximately one pipe following the restraint ring. step has already been completed
foot using a wire brush if need- (USE A TRANSITION GASKET in all sizes except 30 inch and
ed, removing all excess paint IN PLACE OF THE EBAA-SEAL larger.) Place the gasket ring on
and foreign material. Also clean GASKET FOR STEEL AND IPS. the pipe with the O-ring facing
the opposing flange to be con- O.D. PVC PIPE.) the pipe end and the gasket
nected to the 2100. Place the recess facing the EBAA-Seal (or
2100 restraint ring on the clean transition) Gasket and restraint
pipe with the lip facing the plain ring.
end.
5. Bring the pipe and flanges 6. Insert and tighten all flange 7. Tighten the actuating screws in
together within the maximum bolts. Torque all flange bolts an an alternating manner until all
assembled deflection and maxi- alternating manner to the value wedges touch the pipe. Con-
mum allowable gap “L” to the listed in Table 1.1. Be sure to tinue tightening the nuts in an
flange face. Slide the gasket ring, make any necessary joint de- alternating pattern until all the
gasket and restraint ring until flection before tightening the torque-limiting nuts have been
contact is made with the oppos- actuating screws. Joint deflection twisted off.
ing flange. should not exceed the maximum Table 1.1 Flange Bolt Torques
allowable deflection. Be sure Nominal
Pipe Size
Bolt Torque
(ft-lbs.)
that deflection of the joint does 3 45 - 60
not cause the end of the pipe to 4-6 75 - 90
8 - 24 90 - 110
be separated from the opposing 30 - 48 110 - 130
flange more than the maximum
allowable gap “L”.
8. If removal is necessary, utilize the ⅝ inch
hex head provided. For reinstallation,
repeat steps 2 through 7, torquing the
actuating screws to 70 ft-lbs or until the
hex heads bottom out on the spacers or
gland.
Data sheet DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
One solution for all your needs MID and OIML R49 approved with R49 self-checking
— designed for use in all water and waste water applications, — Type-approved to accuracy Class 1 and Class 2 for any pipe
from sewage plants to distribution networks orientation and bidirectional flows
— Type P-approved continuous self-checking of the sensor
State-of-the-art technology and transmitter to ensure the highest accuracy and long
— revolutionary data storage enables transmitter interchange term performance
and commissioning without the need for re-configuration
— self-calibrating transmitter with ultra-low temperature Innovative sensors for all applications
coefficient for highest accuracy — optimized full-bore series for optimum turndown / low
pressure drop, irrigation applications
Versatile and simple configuration — full-bore series for general-purpose water metering
— 'Through-the-Glass' (TTG) configuration eliminating the applications
need to remove the cover — reduced-bore series for high turn down applications, for
— smart key based functionality example, leakage
— 'Easy Setup' function — buriable sensors eliminating the need for costly chamber
construction
VeriMaster in situ verification software option
— enables the customer to perform in situ verification of the HART, PROFIBUS DP and MODBUS
flowmeter system — Full system and PLC integration
As a world leader in process automation technology our Easy and quick commissioning
worldwide presence, comprehensive service and 'Fit-and-Flow' data storage inside WaterMaster eliminates the
application-oriented know-how make ABB a leading supplier of need to match sensor and transmitter in the field. On initial
flow measurement products. installation, the self-configuration sequence automatically
replicates into the transmitter all calibration factors, meter size
Introduction and serial numbers, as well as customer site-specific settings,
eliminating the potential for error.
Setting the standard for the Water Industry
The WaterMaster range, available in sizes 10 to 2400 mm Intuitive, convenient navigation
(3/8 to 96 in.), is designed specifically for use on the many The 'Easy Setup' function reliably guides unpracticed users
diverse applications encountered in the Water and Waste-water through the menu step by step. The smart key based
industry. The modular design concept offers flexibility, functionality makes handling a breeze – it's just like using a cell
cost-saving operation and reliability while providing a long phone. During configuration, the permissible range of each
service life and exceptionally low maintenance. parameter is indicated on the display and invalid entries are
Integration into ABB asset management systems and use of the rejected.
self-monitoring and diagnostic functions increase the plant
availability and reduce downtimes. Universal transmitter – powerful and flexible
The backlit display can be rotated easily without the need for
VeriMaster – the verification tool tools. The contrast is adjustable and the display
An easy-to-use utility, available through the infra red service port, fully-configurable. The character size, number of lines and
it uses the advanced self-calibration and diagnostic capability of display resolution (number of decimal points) can be set as
WaterMaster, coupled with fingerprinting technology, to required. In multiplex mode, several different display options can
determine the accuracy status of the WaterMaster flowmeter to be pre-configured and invoked one after the other.
within ±1 % of its original factory calibration. VeriMaster also The smart modular design of the transmitter unit enables easy
supports printing of calibration verification records for regulatory disassembly without the need to unscrew cables or unplug
compliance. connectors. HART is used as the standard communications
protocol. Optionally, the transmitter is available with PROFIBUS
DP or MODBUS communication.
Assured quality
WaterMaster is designed and manufactured in accordance with
international quality procedures (ISO 9001) and all flowmeters
are calibrated on nationally-traceable calibration rigs to provide
the end-user with complete assurance of both quality and
performance of the flowmeter.
Diagnostic functions
Using its diagnostic functions, the flowmeter monitors both its
own operability and the process. Limit values for the diagnostic
parameters can be set locally. When these limits are exceeded,
an alarm is tripped. In the event of an error,
diagnostic-dependent help text appears on the display and this
considerably simplifies and accelerates the troubleshooting
procedure.
In accordance with NAMUR NE107, alarms and warnings are
classified with the status of 'Maintenance Required', 'Check
Function', 'Failure' and 'Out of Specification'.
2 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 3
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
4 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Specification
WaterMaster specification to OIML R49 Class 1
WaterMaster Class 1
Specification
Typical Meter
Error (%)
Performance
±0.2 % ±0.9 mm/s
whichever is the greater
Around Q2 the
performance is
±0.7 mm/s
WaterMaster Class 2
Specification
Typical Meter
Performance
Error (%)
Although OIML R49 does not define the flow accuracy below Q1, WaterMaster continues to measure flow at lower flow rates down to
a cutoff velocity of ±5 mm/s (±0.2 in./s). The accuracy between cutoff and Q1 is typically ±0.9 mm/s (±0.04. in./s).
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 5
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
WaterMaster optimized full-bore meter (FEV) / full-bore meters (FEF, FEW) flow performance – gal/min
Standard Calibration 0.4 % Class 2 High Accuracy Calibration 0.2 % Class 1
NPS/NB (DN) Q4 Q3 Q0.4% Q2 Q1 Q0.2% Q2 Q1
3
/8 (10) 13.8 11 0.73 0.06 0.035 1.38 0.09 0.053
1
/2 (15) 34.7 27.7 1.85 0.14 0.09 3.48 0.22 0.14
3
/4 (20) 55 44 2.94 0.22 0.14 5.5 0.35 0.22
1 (25) 88 70.4 4.7 0.35 0.22 8.8 0.57 0.35
1 1/4 (32) 137.6 110 7.3 0.57 0.35 13.2 0.88 0.57
1 1/2 (40) 220 176 18.5 0.89 0.56 26.4 1.41 0.88
2 (50) 347 277 18.5 1.41 0.88 34.7 2.22 1.39
2 1/2 (65) 550 440 29.4 2.24 1.40 55.0 3.52 2.20
3 (80) 881 704 47.0 3.58 2.24 70.4 5.64 3.52
4 (100) 1,376 1,101 73.4 5.59 3.49 110 8.81 5.50
5 (125) 1,376 1,101 73.4 5.59 3.49 110 8.81 5.50
6 (150) 3,467 2,774 185 14.1 8.81 277 22.2 13.9
8 (200) 5,504 4,403 294 22.4 14.0 440 35.2 22.0
10 (250) 8,806 7,045 470 35.8 22.4 704 56.4 35.2
12 (300) 13,759 11,007 734 55.9 34.9 1,101 88.1 55.0
14 (350) 22,014 17,611 1,174 89.5 55.9 1,761 141 88.1
16 (400) 22,014 17,611 1,174 89.5 55.9 1,761 141 88.1
18 (450) 34,673 27,738 1,849 141 88.1 2,774 222 139
20 (500) 34,673 27,738 1,849 141 88.1 2,774 222 139
24 (600) 55,036 44,029 2,935 224 140 4,403 352 220
27/28* (700) 88,057 70,446 7,045 451 282 7,045 704 440
29 (750) 88,057 70,446 7,045 451 282 7,045 704 440
30 (760) 88,057 70,446 7,045 451 282 7,045 704 440
32 (800) 88,057 70,446 7,045 451 282 7,045 704 440
36 (900) 137,590 110,072 11,007 704 440 11,007 1,100 688
39/40* (1000) 137,590 110,072 11,007 704 440 11,007 1,100 688
42 (1050) 137,590 110,072 11,007 704 440 11,007 1,100 688
44 (1100) 137,590 110,072 11,007 704 440 11,007 1,100 688
48 (1200) 220,143 176,115 17,611 1,127 704 17,611 1,761 1,101
52 (1350) 346,726 277,381 27,738 1,775 1,110 27,738 2,773 1,733
54 (1400) 346,726 277,381 27,738 1,775 1,110 27,738 2,773 1,733
60 (1500) 346,726 277,381 27,738 1,775 1,110 27,738 2,773 1,733
66 (1600) 346,726 277,381 27,738 1,775 1,110 27,738 2,773 1,733
68 (1650) 346,726 277,381 27,738 1,775 1,110 27,738 2,773 1,733
77 (1800) 550,358 440,287 44,029 2,818 1,761 44,029 4,403 2,752
77 (1950) 550,358 440,287 44,029 2,818 1,761 44,029 4,403 2,752
78 (2000) 550,358 440,287 44,029 2,818 1,761 44,029 4,403 2,752
78 (2000) 550,358 440,287 44,029 2,818 1,761 44,029 4,403 2,752
84 (2200) 880,573 704,459 70,446 4,509 2,818 70,446 7,045 4,403
96 (2400) 880,573 704,459 70,446 4,509 2,818 70,446 7,045 4,403
*Size is dependent on flange specification
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 7
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
8 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Non-wetted parts
Flange material
Housing material
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 9
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
*FEW, FEV, FET and FEF 700 (27/28 in. NB) only
Declaration of Conformance
Copies of CE certification will be available on request.
WaterMaster has OIML R49 Certificate of Conformity to accuracy
class 1 and 2 (FEV DN40 to 200 [11/2 to 8 in.NB]). Copies of accuracy
certification are available on request.
WaterMaster (FEV DN40 to 200 [11/2 to 8 in.NB]) has been type
examined under directive MID 2004/22/EC, Annex MI-001. Copies of
this certificate are available on request.
10 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Transmitter connections
Transmitter terminal connections overview
This section is intended to give an overview of installation of a flowmeter. For Installation requirements, technical information and
Health and safety precautions – refer to the User Guide OI/FET100–EN.
AC / DC Power Sensor
Supply Terminal Cable Terminal
Output
Connections Terminal
Backplane
Internal Earth
Internal Earth
(Alternative PE)
(Alternative PE)
External Earth
Power Cable Output Connections Output Connections Sensor Cable
M1 M2 D1/TFE D2 3 S2 E2 E1 S1
Brown Red Orange Yellow Green Blue Blue Violet Violet
(Sleeve) (Screen) (*Signal) (*Signal) Screen)
SCR
Screen
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 11
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Internal Earth
Screws**
**Can be used as a
Protective Earth (PE)
if required by
national standards
Brown
Blue
Green / Yellow
External Earth Screw
AC power via a suitable
2
isolator and fuse >4 mm (<10 AWG) Copper Wire
Transmitter Label
Internal Earth
Screws
Red
Black
Green / Yellow External Earth
12 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Configuration
DIP Switches
OFF
ON
SW3 SW2 SW1
Red Label on DC
DIP Switch Functions (and Low Voltage AC)
SW1 – Read-only / MID Protection Converter Module
SW2 – (Future Product)
SW3 – Internal Sensor Memory
Black Label on AC Converter Module
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 13
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Output connections
Frequency outputs Alarm outputs
PLC or Datalogger
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
52
62 Terminal connection IDs are COM DO3
HART- / PROFIBUS- / MODBUS-
variant dependent
Terminal connection IDs are COM DO1 DO2
HART- / PROFIBUS-variant
dependent
Alarm 1 Bell
PLC / Datalogger connections
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61 DC Supply
–
52
+
62
Note. Digital outputs DO1 and DO2 are polarity sensitive.
The common (negative) connection for these outputs is
COM DO1 DO2 DO3
designated 'COM'. and / or Horn
Alarm 2
Forward Flow Output (DO1)
Counter / Totalizer
DC
–
Supply
+
1 2 34 56
Note.
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
52
and / or 1 2 34 56 Normal alarm / logic output is from DO3 (terminal 61).
62
DO1 (41) and DO2 (51) can also be configured as
DO1 DO2
alarms if required but are then NOT available as
COM
Reverse Flow frequency / pulse outputs as shown in
Output (DO2) Electromechanical connections and
Counter / Totalizer Telemetry / Electronic counters connections,
opposite.
Electromechanical connections Bell and horn shown for example only. Any suitable
alarm device may be used (for example, lamp, siren,
buzzer etc.).
Forward Flow Output (DO1)
Counter / Totalizer
– +
1 2 34 56
Alarm 1
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61 and / or Timer Switch DC Supply
52 – +
–
+
62 1 2 34 56
Reverse Flow R
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
COM DO1 DO2 Output (DO2) 52 Alarm 2
62
Counter / Totalizer
and / or
Relay
COM DO1 DO2
14 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
24 V
Typically PLC
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61 1k
+
52 Fwd +
62 1W + –
DC Supply Refer to IM/WMP for HART-Protocol
DO1 Rev + – communication details
COM DO2
Current output (4 to 20 mA) – HART (FEX100) variant
+
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
52
62 DC Supply PROFIBUS / MODBUS RS485
– A1 / B1 – In
COM DO1 DO2 A2 / B2 – Out
Note. Note. A typical DVM probe can access (fit) the PCB's test
WaterMaster digital outputs are NPN optocoupled holes.
transistors used as switches.
Maximum allowed voltage at collector is 30 V DC
4 to 20 mA
Maximum allowed current across transistor is
IC+*
220 mA. IC–*
Not Used
Frequency
31 32 O/P1
XX Outputs
COM
41 O/P2
42
51 O/P3 Alarm Output
61
Not Used
VR
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 15
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
HART protocol
Operational Engineer Operate
Configuration Directly on the Device Level
Software Asset Vision Basic (+ HART -DTM)
System integration
WaterMaster can be integrated into control systems and
configuration devices using any Frame application, such as ABB
AssetVision or similar third-party applications. ABB Device Type
Managers (DTMs) for WaterMaster provide a unified structure for
accessing device parameters, configuring and operating the
devices and diagnosing problems. FDT (Field Device Tool)
technology standardizes the communication and configuration
interface between all field devices and host systems.
16 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Master
5
Line D R
Terminator Pull
Pull
Up
D0
Balanced Pair Line
D1
Pull
Common Down
D R R
D
Slave 1 Slave n Up to 31 slaves
For example, WaterMaster FEX100–MOD
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 17
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Supports
Grounding
The flowmeter sensor must be cross-bonded to the upstream
and downstream pipes and fluid. For technical reasons, this
potential should be identical to the potential of the metering
fluid. For plastic or insulated lined pipelines, the fluid is grounded
by installing a minimum of 1 earthing rings. When there are stray
potentials present in the pipeline, an earthing ring is
recommended on both ends of the meter sensor.
The flange seals must be made from a compatible material for
the fluid and fluid temperatures if required.
70 / 130 °C
(158 / 266 °F)
Max.
– 20 °C
(– 4 °F)
Fluid contact rings Min.
Seals must not extend into the flow area since possible
turbulence could influence the device accuracy.
Fit Gaskets
18 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
The pipeline may not exert any unallowable forces and torques Electrode axis
on the device, such as vibration. Electrode axis should be horizontal if at all possible or no more
than 45° from horizontal.
45 ° Max.
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 19
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Transmitter dimensions
Integral transmitter Remote transmitter
200 (7.9)
205 (8.0)
179 (7.0)
118 (4.6)
71 (2.8)
Sensor dimensions
FEW – DN10 to 125 (3/8 to 5 in. NB)
Dimensions in mm (in.)
Ø104
89 (4.1)
(7.91)
(3.5)
210
(3.1)
78
E F
G
A
L
20 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
3
DN10 to 125 ( /8 to 5 in. NB) (FEW) dimensions / weights
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 21
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
104.5 98 77.8
(4.11) (3.86) (3.06)
(7.91)
Ø104 89
201
(4.1) (3.5)
(3.1)
78
E F
G
22 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 23
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
77.8 104.5 98
(3.06) (4.11) (3.86)
89 104
(3.5) (4.1)
(7.91)
201
(3.1)
78
E F
G
A
L (1.0D)
L (1.3D)
24 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 25
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
77.8 104.5 98
(3.06) (4.11) (3.86)
89 104
(3.5) (4.1)
(7.91)
201
(3.1)
78
E F
G
A
L (1.0D)
L (1.3D)
26 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 27
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
77.8 104.5 98
(3.06) (4.11) (3.86)
89 Ø104
(7.91)
201
(3.5) (4.1)
(3.1)
78
F
E
G
X D
X
L
WaterMaster integral / remote FEV – DN40 to 200 (11/2 to 8 in.) cast iron sensor dimensions / weights
28 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
1
DN40 to 200 (1 /2 to 8 in. NB) (FEV) dimensions / weights
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 29
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
77.8 104.5 98
(3.06) (4.11) (3.86)
89 Ø104
(7.91)
201
(3.5) (4.1)
(3.1)
78
F
E
G
X D
X
L
DN40 to 200 (11/2 to 8 in.) (FER) cast iron sensor dimensions / weights
30 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 31
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
Ø104
(4.1)
86 (3.4)
X
A
32 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
DN350 to 600 (14 to 24 in. NB) (FER) remote sensor dimensions / weights
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 33
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
Ø104
(4.1)
86 (3.4)
X
*Base
A
34 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
DN Process connection type D L C G A X Approx. weight in kg (lb)
DN250 ASME B16.5 CLASS 150 405 (15.94) 450 (17.72) 215 (8.46) 301 (11.85) 300 (11.81) 250 (9.84) 88 (194)
(10 in.) ASME B16.5 CLASS 300 445 (17.52) 490 (19.29)
EN1092 -1 PN10 395 (15.55) 450 (17.72)
EN1092 – 1 PN16 405 (15.94)
EN1092 – 1 PN25 425 (16.73) 490 (19.29)
EN1092 – 1 PN40 450 (17.72)
JIS 5K 385 (15.16) 450 (17.72)
JIS 10K 400 (15.75)
AS4087 PN14, PN16 405 (15.94)
AS2129 TABLE C D
AS2129 TABLE E
AS4087 PN21 430 (16.93)
AS2129 TABLE F
DN300 ASME B16.5 CLASS 150 485 (19.09) 500 (19.69) 231 (9.09) 317 (12.48) 352 (13.86) 300 (11.81) 128 (282)
(12 in.) ASME B16.5 CLASS 300 520 (20.47) 540 (21.26)
EN1092 – 1 PN10 445 (17.52) 500 (19.69)
EN1092 – 1 PN16 460 (18.11) 500 (19.69)
EN1092 – 1 PN25 485 (19.09) 540 (21.26)
EN1092 – 1 PN40 515 (20.28) 540 (21.26)
JIS 5K 430 (16.93) 500 (19.69)
JIS 10K 445 (17.52) 500 (19.69)
AS4087 PN14, PN16 455 (17.91) 500 (19.69)
AS2129 TABLE TABLE C D 455 (17.91) 500 (19.69)
AS2129 TABLE E 455 (17.91) 500 (19.69)
AS4087 PN21 490 (19.29) 500 (19.69)
AS2129 TABLE F 490 (19.29) 500 (19.69)
DN350 ASME B16.5 CLASS 150 535 (21.06) 550 (21.65) 257.5 (10.14) 346 (13.62) 376 (14.80) 350 (13.78) 100 (220)
(14 in.) ASME B16.5 CLASS 300 585 (23.03) 570 (22.44)
EN1092 – 1 PN10 505 (19.88) 550 (21.65)
EN1092 – 1 PN16 520 (20.47) 550 (21.65)
EN1092 – 1 PN25 555 (21.85) 570 (22.44)
EN1092 – 1 PN40 580 (22.83) 570 (22.44)
JIS 5K 480 (18.90) 550 (21.65)
JIS 7.5K 530 (20.87) 550 (21.65)
JIS 10K 490 (19.29) 550 (21.65)
AS4087 PN14, PN16 525 (20.67) 550 (21.65)
AS2129 TABLE C D E 525 (20.67) 550 (21.65)
AS4087 PN21 550 (21.65) 550 (21.65)
AS2129 TABLE F 550 (21.65) 550 (21.65)
AS4087 PN35 550 (21.65) 570 (22.44)
AS2129 TABLE H 550 (21.65) 570 (22.44)
DN375 AS4087 PN14, PN16 550 (21.65) 550 (21.65) 257.5 (10.14) 346 (13.62) 376 (14.80) 350 (13.78) 115 (253)
(15 in.) AS2129 TABLE C 550 (21.65) 550 (21.65)
AS4087 PN35 580 (22.83) 570 (22.44)
DN400 ASME B16.5 CLASS 150 600 (23.62) 600 (23.62) 285 (11.22) 371 (14.61) 420 (16.54) 400 (15.75) 115 (253)
(16 in.) ASME B16.5 CLASS 300 650 (25.59) 620 (24.41)
EN1092 – 1 PN10 565 (22.24) 600 (23.62)
EN1092 – 1 PN16 580 (22.83) 600 (23.62)
EN1092 – 1 PN25 620 (24.41) 620 (24.41)
EN1092 – 1 PN40 660 (25.98) 620 (24.41)
JIS 5K 540 (21.26) 600 (23.62)
JIS 7.5K 582 (22.91) 600 (23.62)
JIS 10K 560 (22.05) 600 (23.62)
AS4087 PN14, PN16 580 (22.83) 600 (23.62)
AS2129 TABLE C D E 580 (22.83) 600 (23.62)
AS4087 PN21 610 (24.02) 600 (23.62)
AS2129 TABLE F 610 (24.02) 600 (23.62)
AS4087 PN35 610 (24.02) 620 (24.41)
AS2129 TABLE H 610 (24.02) 620 (24.41)
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 35
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
Ø104
(4.1)
86 (3.4)
X *Base
A
36 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Dimensions in mm (in.)
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 37
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Options
Product coding field number 1 … 5 6 7…9 10 11 12 13 14, 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
Flowmeter system, full bore, remote mount FEF12
X XXX X X X X XX X X X X X X X X X X X X
Full bore sensor only, for use with WaterMaster transmitter / remote FEF18
Design
Non-hazardous areas 1
Hazardous areas (DN700 [27 in. NB]) 5
Bore diameter
DN250 (10 in.) 250
DN300 (12 in.) 300
DN350 (14 in.) 350
DN375 (15 in.) 375
DN400 (16 in.) 400
DN450 (18 in.) 450
DN500 (20 in.) 500
DN600 (24 in.) 600
Others 999
Liner material
Elastomer – DN250 to 600 (10 to 24 in. NB) K
Hard rubber – DN250 to 600 (10 to 24 in. NB) H
Other Z
Electrode design
Standard 1
Others 9
Measuring electrodes material
Stainless steel 316 S
Hastelloy® C-22 C
Super-austenitic steel (DN250 to 600 [10 to 24 in. NB]) U
Others Z
Grounding accessories
Standard 1
One potential equalizing ring (stainless steel) 3
Two potential equalizing rings (stainless steel) 4
Others 9
Process connection type (refer to pages 35 to 33)
Flanges ASME B16.5 class 150
A1
Flanges ASME B16.5 class 300
A3
Flanges AWWA C207 class B
C1
Flanges AWWA C207 class D
C2
Flanges AS 4087 PN21
E0
Flanges AS 4087 PN16
E1
Flanges AS 4087 PN14
E2
Flanges AS 2129 Table F
E3
Flanges AS 2129 Table E
E4
Flanges AS 2129 Table D
E5
Flanges AS 2129 Table C
E6
Flanges AS 2129 Table H
E7
Flanges AS 4087 PN35
E8
Flanges JIS G5527 7.5K
J0
Flanges JIS B2220 10K
J1
Flanges JIS B2220 5K
J2
Flanges ISO / EN PN6
S0
Flanges ISO / EN PN10
S1
Flanges ISO / EN PN16
S2
Flanges ISO / EN PN25
S3
Flanges ISO / EN PN40
S4
Others
Z9
Note. DN80 to 200 (3 to 10 in. NB) available only with PN16
Process connection material
Carbon steel flanges B
Others Z
Usage certifications
Standard 1
Calibration type
Class 2 calibration – standard accuracy 0.4 % A
Class 1 calibration – high accuracy 0.2 % B
Extended range, class 1 calibration – high accuracy 0.2 % N
Extended range, class 2 calibration – standard accuracy 0.4 % P
Continued on next page …
DS/WM–EN Rev. U 43
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Options
Product coding field number 1 … 5 6 7…9 10 11 12 13 14, 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
Flowmeter system, full bore, remote mount FEF12
X XXX X X X X XX X X X X X X X X X X X X
Full bore sensor only, for use with WaterMaster transmitter / remote FEF18
Temperature range installation / ambient temperature range
Standard design / –20 … 60 °C (–4 … 140 °F) 1
Nameplate
Adhesive A
Signal cable length and type*
Without signal cable 0
5 m (15 ft.) cable 1
10 m (30 ft.) cable 2
20 m (60 ft.) cable 3
30 m (100 ft.) cable 4
50 m (165 ft.) cable 5
80 m (260 ft.) cable 6
100 m (325 ft.) cable 7
150 m (490 ft.) cable 8
Special Length > 150 m (> 490 ft.) (and / or armored cable) 9
Explosion protection certification
General purpose (non-Ex design) A
Protection class transmitter / protection class sensor
IP67 (NEMA 4X) / IP68 (NEMA 6P) – cable not fitted and not potted 2
IP67 (NEMA 4X) / IP68 (NEMA 6P) – cable fitted and potted 3
Cable conduits**
M20 x 1.5 (plastic) A
NPT 1/2 in. (blanked when cable not fitted) B
M20 SWA (armored) D
M20 SWA sensor, M20 x 1.5 (plastic) power / output F
Without Y
Power supply
Without 0
100... 230 V AC (50 Hz) 1
24 V AC or 24 V DC (50 Hz) 2
100... 230 V AC (60 Hz) 3
24 V AC or 24 V DC (60 Hz) 4
Input and output signal type
HART + 20 mA + pulse + contact output A
PROFIBUS DP RS485 physical layer + pulse + contact output (general-purpose design only) G
MODBUS RTU RS485 physical layer + pulse + contact output (general-purpose design only) M
Without Y
Configuration type / diagnostics type
Without 0
Factory defaults / standard diagnostics 1
Options***
Accessories
Configuration lead AC
Documentation language
German M1 Chinese M6
Italian M2 Swedish M7
Spanish M3 Finnish M8
French M4 Portuguese MA
English M5 (default) Danish MF
Norwegian MN
Verification type
Without fingerprint V0
VeriMaster V3
Potable water approvals
WRAS cold water approval CWA
NSF 61 meter approval CWC
DVGW CWD
ACS CWF
WRAS 60 °C (140 °F) water approval CWK
Without CWY
Power supply frequency (sensor FEF 18 only)
50 Hz F5
60 Hz F6
Number of testpoints
1 Point T1
3 Points T3
*Size is dependent on flange specification
**The type of signal cable supplied (standard or armored) depends on the type of cable conduit (variant digit number 24) ordered – for FM or FMC Approved versions, NPT only permitted.
***Add codes for options.
44 DS/WM–EN Rev. U
Contact us
USA
Tel: +1 215 674 6000
Fax: +1 215 674 7183
www.abb.com
Software
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Housing material
Carbon steel (sizes DN40 to 200 [11/2 to 8 NB]
and DN700 to 2200 [28 to 84 NB])
Plastic (sizes DN250 to 600 [10 to 24 NB])
Aluminium (FEW, sizes DN10 to DN32 [3/8 to 11/4 NB])
(FEW, sizes DN350 to DN400 [14 to 16 NB])
Carbon steel (FEW, sizes DN450 to DN600 [18 to 24 NB])
12 DS/WM–EN Rev. I
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
DS/WM–EN Rev. I 13
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Sensor dimensions
A B
Max. Max.
14 DS/WM–EN Rev. I
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
A Max. B Max.
A Max. B Max.
DS/WM–EN Rev. I 15
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
A B
Max. Max.
A B
Max. Max.
DN450 to DN600
16 DS/WM–EN Rev. I
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Transmitter dimensions
Integral transmitter
Dimensions in mm (in)
200 (7.9 )
118 (4.6)
Remote transmitter
Dimensions in mm (in)
98 (3.8) R3.2 (0.12)
205 (8.0)
179 (7.0)
71 (2.8)
DS/WM–EN Rev. I 17
WaterMaster
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Electrical connections
Fuse F1 (AC)
N/L2
L/L1
Internal Earth Screws –
can be used as a
Protective Earth (PE) if
L/L1 N/L2 PE required by national
standards
OR
AC or DC power via a
suitable isolator and fuse
18 DS/WM–EN Rev. I
3.07 ODOR CONTROL
This section provides the information pertaining to the odor control system for this
project.
http://www.cvlci.com
Parts List
IRRIGATION WATER LINE ITEM QTY STOCK NUMBER DESCRIPTION
(SEE SHT L.3.01 & L.3.02) 1 1 20-XXXX BASE - VAULT - PRECAST - 6ft6in X 10ft X 5ft10in - NO
BY OTHERS TOP SLAB
2 3 48-4832 CAP - PVC - 4in SCH40
11'-0" 3 3 48-XXXX TEE - PVC - 4in SCH40 - SLIP
4 3 48-XXXX COUPLING - PVC - 4in SCH40 - 150# - SOC
5 5 48-6266 ELBOW - PVC - 4in SCH40 - 90 DEG - SLIP X SLIP
10'-0"
6 3 48-XXXX 4in PVC - SCH 40 X 24in
6" 7 8 48-5464 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH80 X 2 @ 48in
8 9 48-5464 PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH80 X 3 @ 36in
9 1 48-4926 CROSS - PVC - 4in - SCH40
10 24 48-XXXX PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 X 3 @ 96in - PERFORATED
1'-2" 11 3 48-XXXX CAP - THREADED - PVC - 4in - SCH40
6
12 2 43-6113 KOR-N-SEAL - 6" CORE - 4" PIPE
7
3 6" CORED HOLE
2'-1" 5 12
2 11 10
6'-6" 7'-6"
3
6 4' PVC PIPE AIR INTAKE
2'-1" 2 11 10 ELEVATION: 100.08'
9
6"
6.00 5
11 5
10 4" PVC PIPE
DRAIN TO
WET WELL
COMPOST MEDIA
6"
BY OTHERS
11
6"
3'-0"
F.G. - 102.25'
10-14-11
Telephone 602-264-6831
Phoenix, Arizona 85014
4550 North 12th Street
http://www.cvlci.com
Parts List
ITEM QTY STOCK NUMBER DESCRIPTION
24 9 10
22 1 1 10-XXXX ENCLOSURE - INSULATED FIBERGLASS
2 1 30-5500 BLOWER - EXPLOSION PROOF REGENERATIVE TYPE
19
3 2 40-XXXX NIPPLE - 316SS - 2in X 6in
4 2 40-4111 NIPPLE - 316SS - 2in SCH40 X CLOSE
5 1 40-6458 NIPPLE - 316SS - 2in SCH40 X 3.5in
18
6 2 40-XXXX NIPPLE - 316SS - 2in X CLOSE
7 1 40-XXXX BUSHING - 316SS - 2in FEMALE X 1in MALE THD
21
8 1 40-XXXX BUSHING - 316SS - 1in MALE THD X 1-8in FEMALE THD
5 12 9 2 40-XXXX HOSE FITTING - PUSH X MALE THD - 1-8in
10 1 40-XXXX HOSE - NYLONE - 1-8in - 2ft
2 6 11 2 42-4928 BUSHING - SS - 4inX2in
14 12 2 42-XXXX UNION - 316SS - 2in
13 2 44-XXXX FLANGE - PVC- 4in SCH40 - 150# - SOC
4'-0" 14 2 45-XXXX SPOOL - FLG X PE - 4in X 24in - 316SS - 4in FTHD X 4in FLG
15 15 4 46-XXXX ELBOW - 316SS - 2in - 90 DEG - - THREADED
16 1 46-XXXX TEE - 316SS - 2in - THREADED
17 2 47-6546 GASKET - FLANGE - 4in X 1/8in
6 18 2 48-XXXX COUPLING - 4in SCH40 - SLP X SLIP
19 3 48-5460 ELL; 4" PVC 90, SLIP X SLIP -SCH40
3 12 3 15 7
20 4 48-XXXX PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 1 @ 48in
5 21 1 48-XXXX PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 1 @ 12in
22 6 48-XXXX PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 1 @ 72in
16 23 1 48-XXXX PIPE - 4in PVC - SCH40 - 2 @ 6in
4 24 1 62-XXXX PRESSURE SWITCH
8
14
9
6'-0"
20
3'-0"
6'-0"
2 7 5 16 4 8 9
3 12
3 NOTE: ALL DIMENSIONS AND ELEVATIONS SHOWN
4'-0" ARE NOMINAL DIMENSIONS. IT IS THE RESPONSIBILITY
15 OF THE ON-SITE CONTRACTOR OR ROMTEC UTILITIES
15 CUSTOMER (NOT ROMTEC UTILITIES) TO VERIFY THE
3'-0" ACCURACY OF ANY CRITICAL DIMENSIONS OR ELEVATIONS
11 PRIOR TO SETTING OR INSTALLING ANY EQUIPMENT.
15 15
11 11
4"
2.00
14 14
23
19 19
18 21 19
CL DISCHARGE ELEVATION - 100.08'
19
4in PVC FITTINGS WILL NOT BE INSTALLED. THE 4in PVC PIPE AND
PLANS AND DRAWINGS MAY NOT BE REPRODUCED,
ADAPTED, OR FURTHER DISTRIBUTED, AND NO FITTING ARE TO BE FIELD FIT. ROMTEC UTILITIES WILL SUPPLY
COMPONENTS MAY BE CONSTRUCTED FROM THESE
PLANS, WITHOUT WRITTEN PERMISSION OF ROMTEC, INC. THE FITTINGS AND PIPE. THE PIPE WILL NOT BE CUT TO LENGTH. M4
CVL Contact: ERIC LAURIN
CVL Project #: 1.01.0204801
CVL File #:
10-14-11
SUBMITTAL PACKAGE
Romtec Utilities
3897 - Bay Meadows #436
Big Mouth Cabinet- Hinged w/ Lift Assistance
SIGNATURE DATE
PHONE/EMAIL:_______________________________________________________________
ITEMS LIST
ITEM QTY PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION NOTES SHIPPED
LOOSE
1 2 30357 PLASTIC GRAB HANDLE MOLDED POLYPROPYLENE -
3 6'-0"
3'-11 4 "
3 5'-9"
2'-10 4 "
3
5'-5 4 "
1'-0" 5
6 4
B 2 4'-0" B
3'-0" 95°
63° 2
80° 1
0'-11 2 "
1
2'-11 2 "
- - - - SHELTER WORKS
2616 South Third Street, St. Louis, MO 63118
A - - - - Phone: (800)794-8037 Fax: (314) 664-9301 A
www.shelterworks.com
REV. DESCRIPTION DATE APPROVED
ORDER #:
CUSTOMER: Romtec Utilities 3897
RATINGS: INTERIOR & PLAN VIEWS PROPRIETARY TO SHELTER WORKS PROJECT: Bay Meadows #436 SIZE:
20 PSF SNOW LOAD This document is confidential and proprietary to Shelter Works and
90 MPH WIND LOAD MODEL: 3897 Assembly cannot be used, disclosed, copied, or duplicated in any manner
without the prior written consent of Shelter Works
TITLE: Big Mouth Cabinet- Hinged w/ Lift Assistance B
500 LBS APPROX. WEIGHT SCALE: SHEET:
PLOT SCALE: 1:48 BY: MP DATE: 07/29/2014 2007 Switzer Industries, Inc, dba Shelter Works. All Rights Reserved.
1:48 DWG #: 3897 Assembly 1 OF 3
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
INTERIOR COLOR: WHITE EXTERIOR COLOR: POLAR WHITE
3897 ITEMS LIST
SHIPPED
ITEM QTY PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION NOTES
LOOSE
1 2 30357 PLASTIC GRAB HANDLE MOLDED POLYPROPYLENE -
2 2 281140 5" ROUND VENT 304 STAINLESS STEEL -
3 2 12065A63 RUBBER DRAW DOWN LATCH W/ NYLON STRIKE -
4 1 1658A867 CONTINUOUS PIANO HINGE TYPE 304 SS -
5 2 AC-10150 GAS SPRING LIFT ASSISTANCE -
6 - X119HT GASKET SPONGE RUBBER -
7 1 CS-102B SEALANT 14'-6" PER ROLL X
SHELTER WORKS ASSUMES NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR ACTUAL FOUNDATION DESIGN AND
CONSTRUCTION. THE SITE CONTRACTOR IS TO VERIFY THE FINAL DIMENSIONS BASED UPON
ACTUAL SITE CONDITIONS AND REQUIREMENTS. CONCRETE SLAB SHALL BE TRUE AND LEVEL TO
A TOLERANCE OF NOT MORE THAN 3/16" WHERE THE BUILDING IS TO ATTACH. ALL PAVED OR
GRADED SURFACES SURROUNDING THE SHELTER SHALL BE PITCHED TO PROMOTE PROPER
DRAINAGE OF PRECIPITATION. SOME ITEMS MAY SHIP LOOSE FOR SHIPPING EFFICIENCY.
SHEET:
2 OF 3
Building Summary Electrical Summary
Order # 3897 Conduit None
Width 4' Termination Point -
Length 6' Wiring -
Height 4' •Conduit shall be run at the top of the walls with conduit drops to
Wall Foam - (-) individual electrical devices.
•All wiring will be done by a licensed electrician in compliance with
Wall Wood - A B C D
the NEC.
Roof Foam - (-) •Short lengths of code-compliant, flexible conduit shall be
Roof Wood - permitted when necessary.
Door Wood -
Resin Type General Purpose
Interior Color White Special Notes
Exterior Color Polar White -
Fastener Spacing -
Floor -
Gasket CS-102B
Pre-Drill Base Flange -
Roof Truss -
Approximate Weight 500 LBS
SHEET:
3 OF 3
FIBERGLASS REINFORCED
POLYMER (FRP)
FRP
PROPERTY PANEL
Tensile Strength (psi) similar to ASTM D638
Average 12,458
Standard Deviation 1,806
Tensile Elongation (%) similar to ASTM D638
Average 1.35
Standard Deviation 0.22
Tensile Modulus (psi) similar to ASTM D638
Average 1,277,218
Standard Deviation 98,158
Flexural Strength (psi) similar to ASTM D790
Average 20,386
Standard Deviation 1,182
Flexural Modulus (psi) similar to ASTM D790
Average 920,271
Standard Deviation 39,102
Izod Impact ((ft‐lbs)/in) similar to ASTM D256 Notched
Average 16.30
Standard Deviation 2.20
Izod Impact ((ft‐lbs)/in) similar to ASTM D256 Un‐Notched
Average 21.79
Standard Deviation 1.74
* Results not certified to ASTM
Fiberglass Laminate
Burning Characteristics (ASTM E48) < 150 Flame Spread
< 1000 Smoke Density
Foam Core
Burning Characteristics (ASTM E48) < 75 Flame Spread
< 450 Smoke Development
Manufactured by: Cook Composites
2616 S. 3rd St. www.shelterworks.com
St. Louis, MO 63118 (800) 794‐8037
Molded Grab Handle
30357
Specifications
• Strong light weight molded polypropylene
• 6.8" overall length
• Snap-shut panels conceal two mounting holes
• Mounting holes measure 5.5" C.C.
• 1.25 " hand clearance
• Textured black finish
5” Stainless Steel Vent
281140
Specifications
• Air flow: Straight-through
• Material: 304 Stainless steel
• Dimensions: 5” diameter
• Mounting: Drilled for (4) #6 screws
Rubber Draw Latch
12065A63
Draw latch stretches to fit the strike and "gives" a little to compensate for
misalignment. Rubber won't scratch painted surfaces and resists weather, oil,
chemicals, and dirt.
Specifications
• Length: 4 13/16”
• Width: 1 13/16”
• Height: 1 15/64”
• Reach distance: 1 11/16”
• Material: Synthetic rubber
• Color: Black
• Screws: Exposed, drilled for #10 screws
Stainless Steel Piano Hinge
1658A867
Specifications
• Mounting Type: Surface-Mounted
• Type: Piano Hinge
• Base Material: Stainless Steel
• Stainless Steel Material: 300 Series Stainless Steel
• Finish: Unfinished
• Open Width: 3”
• Knuckle Length: ½”
• Length: 6’
Gas Spring™
AC10150
Durable, long lasting design. Metal ends are constructed with heavy gauge steel and
is used in conjunction with metal safety clips. Teflon back up ring provides superior
seal stability. Body is made of heavy gauge steel with black heat cured paint. Shaft is
made of chromium plated steel.
Specifications:
• Force (lbs.): 150
• Ext. Length: 27.80”
• Stroke: 10.00”
• Comp Length: 17.80”
• Rod Diameter: 393”
• BBL Diameter:0.866”
SPONGE RUBBER
X119HT
.75” D‐Shaped Sponge Rubber
Made from a custom formulated sponge rubber compound
Recommended operating temp range: ‐40° to +212°F
Maximum compression of 50% recommended for max performance
Roll size: 500’
Uses standard bond adhesive
Width: .750”
Height: .530”
Length: 500’
2616 South Third St. www.ShelterWorks.com
St. Louis, MO 63118 800‐794‐8037
ConSeal - Bituman Blended Sealant
CS-102B
Butyl base gasket for sealing joints between the enclosure and concrete.
Specifications
• Provides permanently flexible watertight joints.
• Low to high temperature workability: 30°F to 120°F (-1°C to 48°C)
• Rugged service temperature: -30°F to +200°F (-34°C to +93°C)
• Excellent chemical and mechanical adhesion to clean and dry surfaces.
• Greater cohesive and adhesive strengths.
• Sealed Joints will not shrink, harden or oxidize upon aging.
• Controlled flow resistance for application ease.
• No priming normally necessary. When confronted with difficult installation
• conditions, such as wet concrete or temperatures below 40°F (4°C), priming
the concrete will improve the bonding action. Consult Concrete Sealants for the
proper primer to meet your application
Prepared on July 10, 2013
T3M Equipment
541-447-5660
541-950-6035 Cell
541-447-6101 Fax
t3m@crestviewcable.com
CP808
Romtec
Environmental / Chemical Processing Blowers
EN 808 & CP 808 Three-Phase
Sealed Regenerative Blower w/Explosion-proof Motor
23.56
598.4 18.5
470
ROTATION
DIRECTION
282.7
11.13
480.3
18.91
21.12
NOTE 1
537
6.75
171.5
298.7
11.74
IN OUT
22.4
0.88
3.58
90.9
8.75 7.38 3.55
.562 DIA.
222.3 187.5 14.3 90.2
(8) MTG. HOLES 7.09
8.60 8.50
217.4 215.9 1.25 180.1
Voltage - ROTRON motors are designed to handle a broad range of world voltages and power supply variations. Our dual voltage 3 phase motors are factory tested and
certified to operate on both: 208-230/415-460 VAC-3 ph-60 Hz and 190-208/380-415 VAC-3 ph-50 Hz. Our dual voltage 1 phase motors are factory tested and
certified to operate on both: 104-115/208-230 VAC-1 ph-60 Hz and 100-110/200-220 VAC-1 ph-50 Hz. All voltages above can handle a ±10% voltage fluctuation.
Special wound motors can be ordered for voltages outside our certified range.
Operating Temperatures - Maximum operating temperature: Motor winding temperature (winding rise plus ambient) should not exceed 140°C for Class F rated
motors or 120°C for Class B rated motors. Blower outlet air temperature should not exceed 140°C (air temperature rise plus inlet temperature). Performance
curve maximum pressure and suction points are based on a 40°C inlet and ambient temperature. Consult factory for inlet or ambient temperatures above 40°C.
Maximum Blower Amps - Corresponds to the performance point at which the motor or blower temperature rise with a 40°C inlet and/or ambient
temperature reaches the maximum operating temperature.
This document is for informational purposes only and should not be considered as a binding description of the products or their performance in all applications. The performance data on this page depicts
typical performance under controlled laboratory conditions. AMETEK is not responsible for blowers driven beyond factory specified speed, temperature, pressure, flow or without proper alignment. Actual
performance will vary depending on the operating environment and application. AMETEK products are not designed for and should not be used in medical life support applications. AMETEK reserves the
right to revise its products without notification. The above characteristics represent standard products. For product designed to meet specific applications, contact AMETEK Technical & Industrial Products
Sales department.
AMETEK TECHNICAL & INDUSTRIAL PRODUCTS D 25
75 North Street, Saugerties, NY 12477
USA: +1 215-256-6601 - Europe: +44 (0) 845 366 9664 - Asia: +86 21 5763 1258 ____
Customer Service Fax: +1 215.256.1338
www.ametektip.com
Environmental / Chemical Processing Blowers
EN 808 & CP 808 Three-Phase
Sealed Regenerative Blower w/Explosion-proof Motor
FEATURES
• Manufactured in the USA - ISO 9001 and NAFTA compliant
• UL & CSA approved motor with permanently sealed ball bearings for
explosive gas atmospheres Class I Group D minimum
• Sealed blower assembly
• Quiet operation within OSHA standards
MOTOR OPTIONS
• International voltage & frequency (Hz)
BLOWER OPTIONS
• Corrosion resistant surface treatments & sealing options
• Remote drive (motorless) models
ACCESSORIES
• Flowmeters reading in SCFM
• Filters & moisture separators
• Pressure gauges, vacuum gauges, & relief valves
mbar
mbar
60 150 60 150
40 100 40 100
20 50 20 50
0 0 0 0
0 40 80 120 160 200 240 280 320 360 400 440 0 40 80 120 160 200 240 280 320 360 400 440
Temp Rise °C
Temp Rise °C
50 50
0 0
Temperature curves are based on standard model Temperature curves are based on standard model
100 100
Temp Rise °C
Temp Rise °C
Blower Air
Blower Air
50 50
0 0
This document is for informational purposes only and should not be considered as a binding description of the products or their performance in all applications. The performance data on this page depicts
typical performance under controlled laboratory conditions. AMETEK is not responsible for blowers driven beyond factory specified speed, temperature, pressure, flow or without proper alignment. Actual
performance will vary depending on the operating environment and application. AMETEK products are not designed for and should not be used in medical life support applications. AMETEK reserves the
right to revise its products without notification. The above characteristics represent standard products. For product designed to meet specific applications, contact AMETEK Technical & Industrial Products
Sales department.
AMETEK TECHNICAL & INDUSTRIAL PRODUCTS D 26
75 North Street, Saugerties, NY 12477
USA: +1 215-256-6601 - Europe: +44 (0) 845 366 9664 - Asia: +86 21 5763 1258 ____
Customer Service Fax: +1 215.256.1338
www.ametektip.com
Explosion Proof Diaphragm Switch Pressure D1X, D2X Series
Features
Hermetically sealed
Explosion proof housing for hazardous location
Tamper proof setpoint adjustment
Ideal for pressure or vacuum
Applications
Pump & compressor monitoring
Hydraulic power units
Oil & gas
Food & beverage
Utility & power generation
Mining
General Specifications*
Accuracy: ± 0.5% of the adjustable range Approvals (cont.):
Switch: CSA (standard): All models are CSA approved for use in
Type: Single pole double throw (SPDT) Snap hazardous locations Class I, Groups B, C &
Action; single circuit D; Class II, Groups E, F, & G. CSA File No.
Rating: LR22354
10 amps @ 125/250 VAC; 3 amps @
480 VAC (Class A or H limit switch). ATEX (optional): EX models are ATEX marked as follows:
Consult sales drawing for ratings of 0081, ISSeP 08 ATEX024X
optional limit switches. II 2G D, Ex d IIC T6
Ex tD A21 IP65 T80°C
Wetted Parts: -40°C ≤ Tamb ≤ +75°C
Process Fitting: 303 stainless steel
Temperature Range:
Diaphragm: 17-7 PH stainless steel Operating: -65° to +165°F (-54° to +74°C)
Enclosure: Die-cast aluminum, anodized and painted Storage: -65° to +200°F (-54° to 93°C)
NC (Blue) NC (Blue)
C (Purple) C (Purple)
Normally Open Red Blue Yellow Orange NO (Blue)
NO (Blue)
V
NC (Yellow)
C (Brown)
NO (Orange)
V
1
Explosion Proof Diaphragm Switch D1X, D2X Series
Technical Drawing
3/4 (19.0) 6-17/32
NPT CONDUIT (166.0) ADJUSTING
CONNECTION 2-5/8 SCREWS 2.0
(66.7) 13/16 (REMOVE 45° (50.8)
(20.6) PLUGS
1-1/2 TO ADJUST) (TYP)
(38.1)
29/32 7/16
(23.0) (11.1) INTERNAL
GROUND SCREW
1 2
TERMINAL STRIP
CONDUIT
ADJUSTMENT
6 CONTACTS 2-25/32
(#6-32 SCREW) (70.6)
ø4-15/16
(125.0)
2.0
(50.8)
7/16 B
(11.1) (TYP)
11/32 (8.73)
27/32 MOUNTING HOLE 2-PL
(21.4)
1/2 NPT
PULL HOLE PLUG 1-1/2
PRESSURE PORT (38.1)
D1X D2X
Dimension in inches (mm)
Hermetically sealed; 10 amps @ 125/250 80SS .5 (.03) 76.6 (5.2) 3.9 (.3) 80 (5.4) 1.6 - 3.4 (.1 - .2) 160 (10.9)
-CC
VAC (not available on vacuum models) 150SS 1.5 (.10) 144 (9.8) 7.5 (.5) 150 (10.2) 2.3 - 6.0 (.2 - .4) 300 (20.4)
NOTES:
1 Consult Supplemental Guide for specific deadband values
2 Deadband values indicated when used with the “standard” limit switch
3211 Fruitland Avenue • Los Angeles, CA 90058 • 800-835-1060 • Fax: 323-589-3463 • www.barksdale.com
See Barksdale’s Standard Conditions of Sale • Specifications are subject to modification at any time • Bulletin #S0082-I • 10/11 • ©2011 • Printed in the U.S.A. 2
4. ELECTRICAL
This section includes all drawings, schematics, data sheets, and user manuals related
to the control panel and electrical components.
2: SHIELDED CABLES ARE #18GA. FOIL SHIELDED TYPE. 2 CONDUCTOR CABLE TO BE BELDEN #9318 OR EQUIVALENT,
3 CONDUCTOR CABLE TO BE BELDEN #9365 OR EQUIVALENT, AND 4 CONDUCTOR CABLE TO BE BELDEN #9368 OR
SHEET DRAWING DESCRIPTION EQUIVALENT UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED. NOTE: SHIELDS ARE ONLY CONNECTED AT THE SIGNAL SOURCE,
OTHER END OF THE SHIELD IS UNCONNECTED AND SHOULD BE CUTOFF.
1 MAIN SERVICE COMPARTMENT
2 PUMP 1 VFD
3 PUMP 2 VFD
4 PUMP 3 VFD
5 BLOWER MOTOR & CONTROL POWER DRAWING STANDARDS:
6 HYDRORANGER CONTROLLER - PLC & FLOW METER POWER
7 HOA'S - BACKUP LEVEL CONTROL - MINICAS RELAYS
WIRE COLOR STANDARD
8 MIXED MODULE I/O SLOT 1
USE COLOR SYM
9 MIXED MODULE I/O SLOT 2
POWER AC BLACK <BK>
10 ANALOG OUTPUT MODULE SLOT 3
CONTROL POWER (H) RED <RD>
11 DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULES SLOT 4 & 5 CONTROL POWER (N) WHITE <WH>
12 FIELD TERMINAL CONNECTIONS UPS CONTROL POWER (H) ORANGE <OR>
UPS CONTROL POWER (N) WHITE/ORANGE <WO>
DC POWER (+) BLUE <BL>
DC POWER (-) WHITE/BLUE <WB>
EXTERNAL POWER YELLOW <YL>
INTRINSICALLY SAFE WIRING BLUE/WHITE <BW>
GROUND GREEN <GN>
WIRE SPECS : -ALL WIRING TO BE: COPPER STRANDED, UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED.
-ALL WIRES SHALL BE NUMBERED AT BOTH ENDS OF EACH SEGMENT, I.E. TERMINATION POINTS.
-ALL TERMINALS SHALL BE LEGIBLY NUMBERED AND SHALL MATCH THE CONNECTED WIRE NUMBER AS PER DRAWING.
1 01 A (STANDARD)
SEQUENTIAL LETTER
PAGE NUMBER
480VAC 3 , 60HZ
MAIN INCOMING LINES
A B C
DTB3
#12 AWG BLK
L1
L1
L1
SURGE
CAPACITOR
524A 601A
HOFFMAN
ELECTRICAL INTERLOCK
MODEL NO A-EK
VOLTS AC 60 CYCLE
TBX1 1 TBX1 2
YEL GRN
LED
BLU
SE CABINET DOOR
VOLTAGE ALERT
SP-0252
VFD 1
#8 AWG BLK
MCB1 TB1
203A L1 MOTOR 203B
MAIN O/P T1
(1) (2)
SUPPLY M1/U
204A L2 MOTOR 204B
(3) (4) MAIN O/P T2
SUPPLY M2/V
205A L3 MOTOR 205B
(5) 60A (6) + MAIN O/P T3
RED
TBX2 6
HDL36060 SUPPLY M3/W
PUMP 1 CURRENT
TBX2 7 - EARTH
EARTH GND G
TBX
GND
PUMP 1
207A +24 FLYGHT
VDC 36.0A
11 30 HP
480 VAC
STOP
01
R1A P1 TBX1
TBX2 TBX2
RUN 209A FAULT to 804
210A 3
P1 RUN 1 2
02
TBX1
R1C 524A from 527A
4
ATV61HD22N4
214A RUNNING to 803
DI2 5
06
TBX2
AI1 R2C
1003A
4 13
TBX2
COM1
1005A 5
14 R6
REMOTE KEYPAD/DISPLAY
TBX2 TBX2
312A R1B
P2 RESET 8 10 DI1
05
P2 TBX1
R2A
ATV61HD22N4
314A RUNNING to 810
DI2 8
06
TBX2
1009A AI1 R2C
11
13
TBX2
1010A 12
COM1
14 R6
REMOTE KEYPAD/DISPLAY
TBX2 TBX2
412A R1B
P3 RESET 15 17 DI1
05
P3 TBX1
R2A
ATV61HD22N4
414A RUNNING to 818
DI2 11
06
TBX2
10013A AI1 R2C
18
13
TBX2
1014A 19
COM1
14 R6
REMOTE KEYPAD/DISPLAY
505A DTB4 1
TBX1 TBX1
506A DTB4 2 17 18
TBX1
BLOWER
STARTER 16
510B
507B 510A
517B
517A
15 12 13 14
507B 519A
520A
507B 522A
L N
POWER SUPPLY
VOLTAGE +24 VDC
524A +V -V
507B
TBX TBX
601A 524A
1 2
BLUE/WHITE
TBX2
TB7 LEAD START TB7
24VDC 207A FROM VFD1
1 633A 632A
00X 8 9
LIGHT BLUE
TBX2
BLUE/WHITE
212A TO VFD1
3
BLUE/WHITE 636A
TBX2
310A TO VFD2
9
638A 507C
TBX
TB1
24VDC 307A FROM VFD2
8 P1 AS1
00X 4
5 COM1
TBX2
312A 524A 640A
TO VFD2
10
601A 641A
XOO
TB2
TBX2
P2 AS2
4
410A TO VFD3
16
5 COM2
TBX2 524A 644A
24VDC 407A 15
FROM VFD3
00X
645A
TBX2
412A TO VFD3
17
601A
XOO
507C
TBX1
621B TO BLOWER TB3
16 STARTER
00X P3 AS3
4
5 COM3
524A 648A
00X
649A
TBX1 TBX1
1123A 623A
17 18
601A
524A
507C
LF1
L1 GND L2
ISLATROL LINE FILTER LF1
T CAT. NO.
R 120V N
A
N 733B
733A
S
D
TB6 RTU1
U 707A L2
1 L1 GND
C MOTOROLA CPU RTU1
E CAT. NO. ACE3600
708A
R 2 +V -V ANT
LPU1 ANTENNA
3 (+V) (-V)
I +V -V
N
P MOTOROLA BATTERY B1
U MODEL NO. V328
T
S
DIRECT WIRING TO FLOWTUBE
M1M2 D1 D2 3 S2 E2 E1 S1
FLOW METER FIT101
R 744A ABB FLOW METER FEV12 507C
E L1 L2
CAT. NO. FEV125200V1S4B1H1A3P2B3A1M5
L GND 31(-) 32 (+)
A
Y
S
746A
748A
HYDRORANGER NOTES:
524A 1. ROUTE SIGNAL CABLE IN GROUNDED METAL CONDUIT,
SEPARATE FROM OTHER CABLES.
TBX1 TBX1
4 5
214A
TBX1
209A -
3 TBX 27
+
TBX 26
TBX 27 -
+
TBX 26
TBX1 TBX1
314A -
7 8 TBX 27
+
TBX 26
TBX1
309A
6
TBX1 TBX1
414A
10 11
TBX1
409A
9
824A
UPPER
RIGHT
UPPER
RIGHT
LOWER LOWER
LEFT LEFT
TB5 TB5
11 12
TB5 TB5
1 2
TB5 TB5
3 4
TB5 TB5
5 6
TB5 TB5
7 8
TB5 TB5
9 10
TB7 1 2 SHLD
1(+) 2(-)
720A
UPPER
RIGHT
UPPER
RIGHT
TBX2
TBX2
TBX2
TBX2
10
TBX2
TBX2
TBX2
15
TBX2
14
TBX2
G
1128A
1104A to 606
1106B
1131A
1106A 1106C
524A
1133A
1109A to 611
1111B
1136A
1111A 1111C
524A
1139A
1114A to 617
1116B
1141A
1116A 1116C
524A
1119A to 621
1123A to 625
BLOWER OVERLOAD
BLOWER STARTER
P2 CURRENT
P3 CURRENT
P1 CURRENT
NEUTRAL
P2 SPEED
P3 SPEED
120VAC
P1 SPEED
P2 RESET
P3 RESET
P1 RESET
P1 P1 P2 P2 P3 P3
P2 RUN
P3 RUN
P1 RUN
FAULT RUNNING FAULT RUNNING FAULT RUNNING
PM
COM
COM
COM
+
-
-
+
+
-
-
+
-
TBX1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 TBX2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
LEVEL
CONTROL PANEL TERMINAL BLOCK CONNECTIONS
TRANSDUCER
CONNECTION
FIELD DEVICE CONNECTIONS
LEVEL FLOATS BLOWER PUMP 3 PUMP 2 PUMP 1
CONNECTIONS CONNECTIONS MAIN POWER CONNECTIONS
CONNECTIONS CONNECTIONS CONNECTIONS
1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5
4 5 6 7 8 9 1011
BILL OF MATERIAL
QUOTE # :
140708JG5 MODEL # : P5038
BY : JOB NAME : BAY MEADOWS LIFT STATION, SAN MATEO, CA.
WDB DESCRIPTION : 460/3/60 30HP 36FLA Triplex, VFDs - Arc Armor
NP.xlsm Page 1 of 4
PANEL PARTS LIST
NP.xlsm Page 2 of 4
PANEL PARTS LIST
2 TIMERS IDEC
2 2 GT3A-3AF20 120V 0-10 SEC/MIN/HR
3
3 ELAPSED TIME METERS CONTROL DYNAMICS
3 3 HMA470 120VAC 60HZ
1
1 GROUND FAULT INTERRUPTER HUBBELL
1 1 GF15WLA 15 AMP GFCI
1
1 HEATER HOFFMAN
1 1 DAH2001A HEATER 200W 120VAC
7
7 THERMOSTAT PFANNENBERG
1 1 FLZ 530 ADJ THERMOSTAT FOR COOLER
2
2 LEVEL TRANSMITTER SIEMENS
1 1 7ML5050-0AA11-1DA0 SITRANS LUT400 LEVEL TRANSMITTER
1 1 7ML1118-0CA30 ECHOMAX XPS-15 TRANSDUCER
1
1 RTU/PLC MOTOROLA (BY CUSTOMER)
1 1 F7574A ACE3600 CPU W/ RADIO
1 1 V056 CHASSIS
1 1 V261 DC POWER SUPPLY
1 1 V328 10AH BACKUP BATTERY
2 1 V245 16 DI, 4 DO, 4 AI COMBO MODULE
2 1 V508 8 POINT DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
1 1 V188 4 POINT ANALOG OUTPUT MODULE
1 1 V20 BLANK I/O MODULE (SLOT FILLER)
4 1 V253 20 CONDUCTOR I/O MODULE CABLE
2 1 V202 30 CONDUCTOR I/O MODULE CABLE
1
1 FLOW TRANSMITTER ABB (BY OTHERS)
1 1 SEE CUT SHEET IN QUOTE FILE
FLOW TRANSMITTER AC POWERED
3
3 CURRENT TRANSMITTER INGRAM PRODUCTS
3 3 FCS521-SP-420E CURRENT,SENS,LOOP,4-20mA TRANSMITTER INGRAM
1
1 POWER SUPPLY IDEC
1 1 PS5R-SF24 24VDC @ 5A
1
1 OUTSIDE ALARM LIGHT INGRAM
1 1 SBN120AC-R SUNLIGHT VISIBLE LED ALARM LIGHT - 120V RED
1
1 TERMINAL BLOCKS SQUARE D
134 1 9080GR6 TERMINAL WHITE
24 1 9080GM6B END BARRIERS
50 1 BAM-2 END CLAMP ENTRELEC
1
1 TERMINAL BLOCKS SQUARE D ( TELEMECHANIQUE IEC )
120 1 AB1ET3235U TERMINAL GRAY ( 6mm IEC ) ( THREE LEVEL )
2 1 AB1PS4 END BARRIER FOR AB1ET3235U
2
2 ENCLOSURE LIGHTS
2 2 TXFLEDDUCL18WH30 18" LED UNDER-CABINET LIGHT
3
3 MINICAS PUMP MONITOR RELAY FLYGT
3 3 14-407129 FLYGT MINICAS II PUMP MONITOR RELAY
3
NP.xlsm Page 3 of 4
PANEL PARTS LIST
NP.xlsm Page 4 of 4
Power Distribution Blocks
Class 9080—Type LB www.SquareD.com
For the most up-to-date information
Main Branch
Type d Price Type d Price Type d Price
(1) #18–1/0 (1) #18–1/0 LBC162101 $ 66.00 N/A ... LBC362101 $134.00 2
(1) #6–250 kcmil (1) #6–250 kcmil LBC163101 83.00 N/A ... LBC363101 155.00 3
(1) #14–2/0 (4) #14–4 LBC162104 66.00 LBC262104 $ 98.00 LBC362104 165.00 2
(1) #4–500 kcmil (6) #14–2 LBC163106 102.00 LBC263106 156.00 LBC363106 236.00 3
(2) #14–2/0 (6) #14–4 LBC163206 89.00 LBC263206 134.00 LBC363206 179.00 3
(2) #4–500 kcmil (8) #14–2/0 LBC165208 181.00 N/A ... LBC365208 395.00 5
(2) #4–500 kcmil (12) #14–2 LBC165212 189.00 N/A ... LBC365212 378.00 5
LBA161104 a Lugs suitable for use with 75°C conductors. (#) indicates number of conductors.
b Aluminum blocks will accept either Al or Cu conductors.
c Cu blocks will accept copper conductors only.
d CE Marked.
e Refer to catalog for dimensions.
Clear Plastic Covers (0.045 in. thick)
Note: There are no covers for miniature blocks.
Dimensions For LBA Type Type Price f Dim. A Dim. B
A3 LBA162..., LBC162 LB21 $ 7.50 1.062 2.750
LBA262..., LBC262 LB22 9.00 1.875 2.750
A1 A2 J Mounting Hole LBA362..., LBC362 g LB23 10.50 2.688 2.750
Diameter LBA163..., LBC163 LB31 8.30 1.782 3.813
LBA263..., LBC263 LB32 9.80 3.313 3.813
LBA363..., LBC363 LB33 11.30 4.844 3.813
LBA164... LB41 9.00 2.125 4.563
LBA264... LB42 10.50 4.000 4.563
G B LBA364... LB43 12.00 5.875 4.563
F LBA165..., LBC165 LB51 9.80 2.719 5.313
LBA265..., LBC265 LB52 11.30 5.656 5.313
LBA365..., LBC365 LB53 12.80 8.375 5.313
f Above covers must be ordered in multiples of 5 covers.
D E E D Above covers are supplied with two self tapping screws per cover.
g Will not work on a 9080LBA362106 block.
C Application Data
H
UL component recognized (File E60616 CCN XCFR2).
CSA certified (File LR70361).
Voltage Rating—Class B & C—600 V
Dimensions (Inches)
Blocks are rated based on NEC Table 310-16 using 75°C wire.
Type A1 A2 A3 B C D E F G H J Aluminum blocks are tin plated high conductive aluminum.
1 .76 1.40 2.03 2.29 1.62 .38 .64 .19 1.93 .32 .201 Copper blocks are tin plated high conductive copper.
Housing material:
2 1.13 1.94 2.75 2.88 1.78 .56 .81 .31 2.25 .24 .205
• Miniature Blocks are made from high impact thermoplastic rated at
3 1.94 3.47 5.00 4.00 2.61 .97 1.53 .31 3.38 .40 .203 125°C. max. &
4 2.28 4.16 6.04 4.75 2.92 1.14 1.88 .31 4.13 .51 .20 -40°C. min.
• Full Size Blocks are made from general purpose phenolic rated at
5 3.17 5.88 8.54 5.50 3.12 1.58 2.69 .38 4.75 .50 .265
150°C. max. & -40°C. min.
All blocks have a flammability rating of UL 94V-0.
New! Table 7.37: H-frame 150 A and J-frame 250 A Thermal-magnetic Circuit Breakers (600 Vac, 250 Vdc)
With Factory Sealed Trip Unit Suitable for Reverse Connectiona
Interrupting Rating (2nd Letter of Catalog Number)
Fixed AC
Current Magnetic D G J L
Rating @ Trip Cat. No.bc Terminal
40o C $ Price
Wire Range
Hold Trip 80% Rated 100% Rated 80% Rated 100% Rated 80% Rated 100% Rated 80% Rated 100% Rated
H-frame, 150A 2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
15 A 350 A 750 A H( )L26015(C) 580.00 696.00 846.00 1015.00 1039.00 1247.00 1576.00 1891.00
20 A 350 A 750 A H( )L26020(C) 580.00 696.00 846.00 1015.00 1039.00 1247.00 1576.00 1891.00
25 A 350 A 750 A H( )L26025(C) 580.00 696.00 846.00 1015.00 1039.00 1247.00 1576.00 1891.00
30 A 350 A 750 A H( )L26030(C) 580.00 696.00 846.00 1015.00 1039.00 1247.00 1576.00 1891.00
35 A 400 A 850 A H( )L26035(C) 580.00 696.00 846.00 1015.00 1039.00 1247.00 1576.00 1891.00
40 A 400 A 850 A H( )L26040(C) 580.00 696.00 846.00 1015.00 1039.00 1247.00 1576.00 1891.00
45 A 400 A 850 A H( )L26045(C) 580.00 696.00 846.00 1015.00 1039.00 1247.00 1576.00 1891.00
HD and HG 2P AL150HD
50 A 400 A 850 A H( )L26050(C) 580.00 696.00 846.00 1015.00 1039.00 1247.00 1576.00 1891.00
14–3/0 AWG
60 A 800 A 1450 A H( )L26060(C) 580.00 696.00 846.00 1015.00 1039.00 1247.00 1576.00 1891.00 Al or Cu
70 A 800 A 1450 A H( )L26070(C) 708.00 849.00 998.00 1198.00 1147.00 1377.00 1742.00 2091.00
80 A 800 A 1450 A H( )L26080(C) 708.00 849.00 998.00 1198.00 1147.00 1377.00 1742.00 2091.00
90 A 800 A 1450 A H( )L26090(C) 708.00 849.00 998.00 1198.00 1147.00 1377.00 1742.00 2091.00
100 A 900 A 1700 A H( )L26100(C) 708.00 849.00 998.00 1198.00 1147.00 1377.00 1742.00 2091.00
110 A 900 A 1700 A H( )L26110(C) 1381.00 1657.00 2039.00 2447.00 2966.00 3559.00 3689.00 4427.00
125 A 900 A 1700 A H( )L26125(C) 1381.00 1657.00 2039.00 2447.00 2966.00 3559.00 3689.00 4427.00
150 A 900 A 1700 A H( )L26150(C) 1381.00 1657.00 2039.00 2447.00 2966.00 3559.00 3689.00 4427.00
H-frame 150A 3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
15 A 350 A 750 A H( )L36015(C) 725.00 870.00 995.00 1194.00 1299.00 1559.00 1899.00 2279.00
20 A 350 A 750 A H( )L36020(C) 725.00 870.00 995.00 1194.00 1299.00 1559.00 1899.00 2279.00
25 A 350 A 750 A H( )L36025(C) 725.00 870.00 995.00 1194.00 1299.00 1559.00 1899.00 2279.00
30 A 350 A 750 A H( )L36030(C) 725.00 870.00 995.00 1194.00 1299.00 1559.00 1899.00 2279.00
35 A 400 A 850 A H( )L36035(C) 725.00 870.00 995.00 1194.00 1299.00 1559.00 1899.00 2279.00
40 A 400 A 850 A H( )L36040(C) 725.00 870.00 995.00 1194.00 1299.00 1559.00 1899.00 2279.00
45 A 400 A 850 A H( )L36045(C) 725.00 870.00 995.00 1194.00 1299.00 1559.00 1899.00 2279.00
50 A 400 A 850 A H( )L36050(C) 725.00 870.00 995.00 1194.00 1299.00 1559.00 1899.00 2279.00 AL150HD
14–3/0 AWG
60 A 800 A 1450 A H( )L36060(C) 725.00 870.00 995.00 1194.00 1299.00 1559.00 1899.00 2279.00 Al or Cu
70 A 800 A 1450 A H( )L36070(C) 885.00 1061.00 1134.00 1361.00 1399.00 1679.00 2099.00 2519.00
H-frame 80 A 800 A 1450 A H( )L36080(C) 885.00 1061.00 1134.00 1361.00 1399.00 1679.00 2099.00 2519.00
90 A 800 A 1450 A H( )L36090(C) 885.00 1061.00 1134.00 1361.00 1399.00 1679.00 2099.00 2519.00
100 A 900 A 1700 A H( )L36100(C) 885.00 1061.00 1134.00 1361.00 1399.00 1679.00 2099.00 2519.00
110 A 900 A 1700 A H( )L36110(C) 1733.00 2080.00 2399.00 2879.00 3449.00 4139.00 4499.00 5399.00
125 A 900 A 1700 A H( )L36125(C) 1733.00 2080.00 2399.00 2879.00 3449.00 4139.00 4499.00 5399.00
150 A 900 A 1700 A H( )L36150(C) 1733.00 2080.00 2399.00 2879.00 3449.00 4139.00 4499.00 5399.00
Interrupting Rating (2nd Letter of Catalog Number)
Adjustable AC
7
Current Magnetic D G J L
Rating @ Trip Cat. No.bc Terminal
40oC $ Price
Wire Range
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
Low High 80% Rated 100% Rated 80% Rated 100% Rated 80% Rated 100% Rated 80% Rated 100% Rated
J-frame 250A 2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
150 A 750 A 1500 A J( )L26150(C) 1450.00 1740.00 2141.00 2569.00 3114.00 3737.00 3874.00 4648.00 AL175JD
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
175 A 875 A 1750 A J( )L26175(C) 1450.00 1740.00 2141.00 2569.00 3114.00 3737.00 3874.00 4648.00 4–4/0 AWG Al or Cu
200 A 1000 A 2000 A J( )L26200(C) 1450.00 1740.00 2141.00 2569.00 3114.00 3737.00 3874.00 4648.00 AL250JD
225 A 1125 A 2250 A J( )L26225(C) 1450.00 1740.00 2141.00 2569.00 3114.00 3737.00 3874.00 4648.00 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil
250 A 1250 A 2500 A J( )L26250(C) 1992.00 2390.00 2834.00 3401.00 4150.00 4979.00 4796.00 5755.00 Al or Cu
J-frame 250A 3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
150 A 750 A 1500 A J( )L36150(C) 1820.00 2184.00 2519.00 3023.00 3621.00 4346.00 4724.00 5669.00 AL175JD
J-frame 175 A 875 A 1750 A J( )L36175(C) 1820.00 2184.00 2519.00 3023.00 3621.00 4346.00 4724.00 5669.00 4–4/0 AWG Al or Cu
200 A 1000 A 2000 A J( )L36200(C) 1820.00 2184.00 2519.00 3023.00 3621.00 4346.00 4724.00 5669.00 AL250JD
225 A 1125 A 2250 A J( )L36225(C) 1820.00 2184.00 2519.00 3023.00 3621.00 4346.00 4724.00 5669.00 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil
250 A 1250 A 2500 A J( )L36250(C) 2499.00 2999.00 3334.00 4001.00 4825.00 5790.00 5995.00 7194.00 Al or Cu
a See page 7-23 for circuit breakers with field interchangeable trip units.
b To complete catalog number, replace the blank with the appropriate rating (D, G, J, L).
c For 100% rated circuit breakers add a “C” in the 9th character place (for example, HDL26015C or JDL26150C).
Technical
Characteristics
As standards, specifications, and designs change from time to time, please ask for confirmation of the information given in this document.
Technical Characteristics
Circuit Breaker Type Standard
Specifications Door Mounted - Standard Black Handle
As standards, specifications, and designs change from time to time, please ask for confirmation of the information given in this document.
A selected range of Multi-9 circuit breakers rated 240 V are UL 489 Listed. Unlike UL 1077
Supplementary Protectors, these UL 489 circuit breakers can be used for branch circuit protection as
required by the National Electrical Code.
As shown in tables Table 5 and Table 6, the UL 489 Listed products are available in C and D curves.
They include devices ranging from 0.5 to 35 A.
08603
08603
1P 2P 3P
Standard Features
• Fast closing: Allows increased withstand to the high inrush currents of some loads.
• Trip-free mechanism: Contacts cannot be held in the I-ON position when the C60 circuit breaker is
tripped automatically.
• Positive indication of contact disconnect. Green mechanical indication on front face of circuit
breaker shows that all poles are open.
• C curve: Overcurrent protection for all application types. Magnetic release operates from 7 to 10
times ampere rating (7 to 14 for DC applications).
15
03/2008 © 2002–2008 Schneider Electric All Rights Reserved
Multi 9¥ System Catalog
Section 2—UL and CSA Rated Protection Devices
• D curve: Overcurrent protection for loads with high inrush currents (motors, transformers).
Magnetic release operates between 10 and 14 times ampere rating (no dc rating for D curve).
• Suitable for reverse feeding.
• Allows locking in O-OFF position using padlock attachment.
Connections
Three versions of field wiring connectors are available for the 240 Vac UL 489 Listed devices:
• Box lug, meeting UL 486A requirements
• Ring tongue terminal with 5 mm screw
• Ring Tongue terminals with Fingersafe (IP20) shrouds
The circuit breakers can be ordered with the following combinations of connectors:
• Line terminal box lug/load terminal box lug
• Line terminal ring tongue/load terminal ring tongue (for fingersafe version, add -F suffix to catalog
number)
• Line terminal box lug/load terminal ring tongue
Fingersafe
Ring
Tongue
Box Lug Ring Box Lug
Tongue
08603411
08603559
Ring Ring
Box Lug Tongue Tongue Fingersafe
Ring
Tongue
Standards
16
© 2002–2008 Schneider Electric All Rights Reserved 03/2008
Multi 9¥ System Catalog
Section 2—UL and CSA Rated Protection Devices
Catalog Numbers
Table 5: Catalog Numbers for C Curve, UL 489 Listed 240 Vac C60 Miniature Circuit
Breakers (Box Lug and Ring Tongue Terminal Combinations)
Rating 1P 2P 3P
Box/Box Ring/Ring1 Box/Ring Box/Box Ring/Ring1 Box/Ring Box/Box Ring/Ring1 Box/Ring
0.5 A 60100 60200 60300 60134 60234 60334 — — —
1A 60101 60201 60301 60135 60235 60335 60168 60268 60368
1.5 A 60102 60202 60302 60136 60236 60336 60169 60269 60369
2A 60103 60203 60303 60137 60237 60337 60170 60270 60370
3A 60104 60204 60304 60138 60238 60338 60171 60271 60371
4A 60105 60205 60305 60139 60239 60339 60172 60272 60372
5A 60106 60206 60306 60140 60240 60340 60173 60273 60373
6A 60107 60207 60307 60141 60241 60341 60174 60274 60374
7A 60108 60208 60308 60142 60242 60342 60175 60275 60375
8A 60109 60209 60309 60143 60243 60343 60176 60276 60376
10 A 60110 60210 60310 60144 60244 60344 60177 60277 60377
13 A 60111 60211 60311 60145 60245 60345 60178 60278 60378
15 A 60112 60212 60312 60146 60246 60346 60179 60279 60379
20 A 60113 60213 60313 60147 60247 60347 60180 60280 60380
25 A 60114 60214 60314 60148 60248 60348 60181 60281 60381
30 A 60115 60215 60315 60149 60249 60349 60182 60282 60382
35 A 60116 60216 60316 60150 60250 60350 60183 60283 60383
1
IP-20 Fingersafe ring tongue terminals may be ordered with an F suffix (example: 60210F)
Table 6: Catalog Numbers for D Curve, UL 489 Listed 240 Vac C60 Miniature Circuit
Breakers (Line/Load as Box Lug or Ring Tongue Terminals)
Rating 1P 2P 3P
Box/Box Ring/Ring1 Box/Ring Box/Box Ring/Ring1 Box/Ring Box/Box Ring/Ring1 Box/Ring
0.5 A 60117 60217 60317 60151 60251 60351 — — —
1A 60118 60218 60318 60152 60252 60352 60184 60284 60384
1.5 A 60119 60219 60319 60153 60253 60353 60185 60285 60385
2A 60120 60220 60320 60154 60254 60354 60186 60286 60386
3A 60121 60221 60321 60155 60255 60355 60187 60287 60387
4A 60122 60222 60322 60156 60256 60356 60188 60288 60388
5A 60123 60223 60323 60157 60257 60357 60189 60289 60389
6A 60124 60224 60324 60158 60258 60358 60190 60290 60390
7A 60125 60225 60325 60159 60259 60359 60191 60291 60391
8A 60126 60226 60326 60160 60260 60360 60192 60292 60392
10 A 60127 60227 60327 60161 60261 60361 60193 60293 60393
13 A 60128 60228 60328 60162 60262 60362 60194 60294 60394
15 A 60129 60229 60329 60163 60263 60363 60195 60295 60395
20 A 60130 60230 60330 60164 60264 60364 60196 60296 60396
25 A 60131 60231 60331 60165 60265 60365 60197 60297 60397
30 A 60132 60232 60332 60166 60266 60366 60198 60298 60398
35 A 60133 60233 60333 60167 60267 60367 60199 60299 60399
1
IP-20 Fingersafe ring tongue terminals may be ordered with an F suffix (example: 60210F)
NOTE: UL 489 Listed Multi 9 circuit breakers are calibrated at 25°C (77°F). Please refer to the rating
tables (page 80) for applications at temperatures greater than 25°C (77°F).
NOTE: The NEC requires that the continuous load applied to the circuit breaker shall not exceed 80%
of the circuit breaker ampere rating.
17
03/2008 © 2002–2008 Schneider Electric All Rights Reserved
Multi 9¥ System Catalog
Section 2—UL and CSA Rated Protection Devices
Table 7: Specifications for UL 489 Listed 480Y/277 Vac C60 Circuit Breakers
08603411
Benefits
Standard Features
• Fast closing: Allows increased withstand to the high inrush currents of some loads.
• Trip-free mechanism: Contacts cannot be held in the I-ON position when the circuit breaker is
tripped automatically.
• Positive indication of contact disconnect. Green mechanical indication on front face of device
shows that all poles are open.
• C curve: Overcurrent protection for all application types. Magnetic release operates from 7 to 10
times ampere rating. (7 to 14 for dc)
• D curve: Overcurrent protection for loads with high inrush currents (motors, transformers).
Magnetic release operates between 10 and 14 times ampere rating (no dc rating for D curve).
• Suitable for reverse feeding
• Allows locking in O-OFF position using padlock attachment.
18
© 2002–2008 Schneider Electric All Rights Reserved 03/2008
Multi 9¥ System Catalog
Section 2—UL and CSA Rated Protection Devices
Connections
Standards
• UL 489 Listed
• CSA C22.2 No. 5.1
• IEC 60947-2
• CE Marked
Catalog Numbers
Table 8: Catalog Numbers for UL 489 Listed 480Y/277 V C60 Miniature Circuit Breakers (AC)
19
03/2008 © 2002–2008 Schneider Electric All Rights Reserved
RFI Response #001
• Pilot Contacts 480V 2P+G 47-34042 49-34042 480V 2P+G 47-38042 49-38042
PFQ = 8 480V 2P+N+G 47-34046 49-34046 480V 2P+N+G 47-38046 49-38046
PF = 4 480V 3P+G 47-34043 49-34043 480V 3P+G 47-38043 49-38043
• Listings 480V 3P+N+G 47-34047 49-34047 480V 3P+N+G 47-38047 49-38047
UL*, CSA* 600V 2P+G 47-34142 49-34142 600V 2P+G 47-38142 49-38142
* Listings apply only to 300A & 400A
devices at 600V or less 600V 2P+N+G 47-34146 49-34146 600V 2P+N+G 47-38146 49-38146
600V 3P+G 47-34143 49-34143 600V 3P+G 47-38143 49-38143
600V 3P+N+G 47-34147 49-34147 600V 3P+N+G 47-38147 49-38147
Other voltage configurations are available – contact customer service at 800.433.7642.
** PFQ300 devices are differentiated from similarly rated PF300 devices in their smaller size, lighter weight and different pilot contacts.
Main Options
Receptacle / Cap (female) Inlet / Cap (male)
Receptacle
with no cap 400A / 600A 400A / 600A
Inlet with
no cap
For applications above 400A, please
With no cap Inlet # - 48 consult factory regarding NEC
recommended conductor sizing.
Part # Part #
Notes: • Metal caps are provided as Voltage Polarity Voltage Polarity
PF400 PF600 PF400 PF600
standard with male and female devices.
Standard Duty Plugs & Receptacles
• Heat shrink wrap is provided with each 277V 1P+N+G 49-44045 49-64045 277V 1P+N+G 49-48045 49-68045
inlet and receptacle to provide insulation 347V 1P+N+G 49-44145 49-64145 347V 1P+N+G 49-48145 49-68145
between terminals.
480V 2P+G 49-44042 49-64042 480V 2P+G 49-48042 49-68042
480V 2P+N+G 49-44046 49-64046 480V 2P+N+G 49-48046 49-68046
PF/PFQ devices are not 480V 3P+G 49-44043 49-64043 480V 3P+G 49-48043 49-68043
intended for connection or
disconnection under load.
480V 3P+N+G 49-44047 49-64047 480V 3P+N+G 49-48047 49-68047
To prevent live making or 600V 2P+G 49-44142 49-64142 600V 2P+G 49-48142 49-68142
breaking electrical interlock-
ing is required.
600V 2P+N+G 49-44146 49-64146 600V 2P+N+G 49-48146 49-68146
600V 3P+G 49-44143 49-64143 600V 3P+G 49-48143 49-68143
600V 3P+N+G 49-44147 49-64147 600V 3P+N+G 49-48147 49-68147
129
Full Voltage Starters—NEMA Rated
www.SquareD.com Class 8536
For the most up-to-date information
General Information
Type S magnetic starters are used for full-voltage starting and stopping of AC squirrel cage motors. Motor overload
protection is provided via melting alloy type thermal overload relays. Type S starters are available in NEMA Sizes 00
through 7, and are designed for operation at 600 Vac, 50 to 60 Hz.
14
Separate Controlb
200 10
2 45 230 15 SDO1c 674. SDG1c 773. SDW11c 1457. SDW21c 1457.
460 25
575 25
Separate Controlb
200 25
3 90 230 30 SEO1c 1092. SEG1c 1286. SEW11c 2253. SEW21c 2817.
460 50
575 50
Separate Controlb
200 40
4 135 230 50 SFO1c 2498. SFG1c 2900. SFW11c 4551. SFW21c 5690.
460 100
575 100
Separate Controlb
200 75
5 270 230 100 SGO1c 6101. SGG1c 6836. SGW11c 8924. … …
460 200
575 200
Separate Controlb
200 150
6 540 230 200 SHO2c 14504. SHG2c 19254. SHW2c 24002. … …
460 400
575 400
Separate Controlb
200 …
7 810 230 300 SJO2c 20837. SJG2c 25587. SJW2c 30335. … …
460 600
575 600
a Size 6 and 7 are rated NEMA 4 only.
b 120 Volt Polyphase starters are wired for separate control and must be ordered with Form S (i.e., 8502SCO2V02S).
c Coil voltage code must be specified to order this product. Refer to standard coil voltage codes shown below.
Coil Voltage Codes
Voltage
Code Price Adder
60 Hz 50 Hz
24d … V01 No Charge Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 14-21
120e 110 V02 No Charge Factory Modifications (Forms) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 14-109
208 … V08 No Charge
240 220 V03 No Charge Separate Enclosures (Class 9991) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 14-102
480 440 V06 No Charge Replacement Parts (Class 9998) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 14-118
600 550 V07 No Charge Type S Accessories (Class 9999) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 14-121
Specify Specify V99 $23.70
d 24 V coils are not available on Sizes 4–7. On Sizes 00-3, where 24 V coils
are available, Form S (separate control) must be specified (i.e., order as 8502SBO2V01S).
e 120 Volt Polyphase contactors are wired for separate control (i.e., order as 8502SCO2V02S). For additional information,
Note: For voltage codes used with control transformers, see page 14-110. reference Catalog #8502CT9701.
Form S (separate control) is used when a separate source of power is available for the control (coil) voltage.
Form S is supplied at no charge.
© 2003 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved CP1 Discount
9/8/03 Schedule 14-15
Altivar® 61 Drives
The leading edge!
This new generation of AC drives demonstrates the expertise
and know-how of Schneider Electric with respect to AC drives.
Exceptional flexibility, advanced functions and a high level of cus-
tomization...while always keeping the emphasis on simplicity. Open
to many communication networks, the Altivar 61 drive provides
ingenious solutions for all your HVAC fan and pump requirements.
A powerful fleet
I 1 to 900 HP
3-phase 380 to 480V
I 1 to 125 HP
3-phase 200 to 240V
I Integrated EMC level A filters
I Worldwide offer:
UL, CSA, CE, C-Tick, GOST,
UL1995 Plenum rated, SEMI-F47
Simply Smart!
Leverage ingenuity
and intelligence
Remarkable performance
for ease of use for fan and pump applications
I Under voltage ride-thru qualified to SEMI-
F47 standard
I Catch on the fly restart
I Up to 110% overcurrent
I Energy economizer motor algorithm to maximize
energy savings, or select two point or five point
Volts/Hz profile
I Three skip frequency bands
I Bump-less transfer from automatic to hand control
Expandable capabilities
The drive is equipped with a wealth of features, application functions,
inputs/outputs and communication capabilities. These can be further
extended by:
I input/output extension cards
I communication cards
I a Controller Inside programmable card
I a Multipump application card
4
Protection at all levels
I Of the Motor:
Thermal protection by PTC probe or integrated electronic thermal
overload, voltage and current surge limitation
I Of the Machine:
Power removal safety function (no unintended motor operation),
alarm management, external fault management
I Of the Drive:
Protection in the event of overheating, current limitation
using hardware and software, protection against
corrosive environments
I Of the Installation:
The intelligent design of the Altivar 61 drive power system
architecture optimizes the balance between inductance and
capacitance to achieve effective harmonic mitigation with 3%
equivalent impedance without requiring additional panel space.
This unique design minimizes dc bus ripple, reduces input
currents and lowers harmonic currents. This eliminates the
need to oversize power wiring, disconnect means, and short
circuit protection devices. This also improves the efficiency of
the drive and allows operation at higher ambient temperature
than other AC drives.
I Of the Environment:
Developed in accordance with the Eco-Design principle.
Materials used have been selected for their minimal impact on
the environment and conform to the RoHS directive (Restriction
of Hazardous Substances) that prohibits certain levels of
materials. Also, 88% of the parts used for the Altivar 61 drive are
recyclable, conforming to the directive WEEE (Waste Electrical
& Electronic Equipment).
Easy to control...
I Graphic screen with customizable display
I Plain text with six languages (English, Chinese, German, Spanish, French and Italian)
I Navigation wheel for easily “surfing” through the menus
I “Simply Start” menu for quick start-up and immediate benefit of the full
performance of the Altivar 61 drive
I Function keys for short-cuts, on-line help or configurable for some applications
I Continuous display of the operating parameters of the motor
I Hand/auto function key provides one button bumpless transfer between terminal strip control and control with
the keypad, or between communication network control and control with the keypad
5
Altivar® 61 Drives
Evolutionary design
Unrivalled basic equipment
With the many functions already integrated in the Altivar 61 drive,
you reduce the cost of solutions for your installation. The most
economical solution is offered without compromise!
Dialogue
The graphic terminal can be multipoint
connected to several drives. The Altivar 61 drive is also “Power Removal” function
available with a 7-segment display for ratings up to and Conforming to the machine standard EN 954-1
including 20 HP @230Vac and 100 HP @460Vac for the category 3 and the standard for electrical
most economical solution. installations IEC/EN 61508-1 SIL2, and certified
by a competent body (INERIS), it enables:
EMC mastered I easier machine certification
Incorporating level A conducted and radiated EMC filters, the I elimination of electromechanical relays
Altivar 61 drive simplifies installation and establishes conformity I reduced wiring and installation times
of the machine for CE marking, without additional costs.
I space savings in enclosures
8
Altivar® 61 Drives
Eco-Design:
thinking of the future
Within its sustainable development policy, The new generation of Altivar 61 drives benefits from an Eco-Design
Schneider Electric is committed to approach. The same importance has been given to the “environment”
environmental friendliness: criterion as that for other criteria, such as: performance, quality,
ergonomics...and this applies to each stage of the life cycle of the
“Our products safeguard life, make goods product* (manufacture, distribution, usage and end of life).
safer and optimize the consumption of
Exemplary end of life recovery ...
energy and natural resources.We are
actively involved in design, production, 88% of the parts used for the Altivar 61 drive are recyclable.
distribution and recycling processes that They enable the recuperation of energy (incineration with energy
are environmentally friendly. Protection of recuperation) or of material (recycling, composting) conforming to the
the environment forms an integral part of European directive WEEE (Waste Electrical & Electronic Equipment).
our strategic decision making.”
With Eco-Design
ISO 14 001 certified sites for their 88 %
manufacturing operations:
I Pacy-sur-Eure/France Without Eco-Design
I Houston TX/USA 61 % 70 %
I Mie/Japan Recovery rate
imposed by the
and certified for their Eco-Design cycles European directive
WEEE.
*For the complete “Product Environmental Profile” document relating to the entire range,
please contact Schneider Electric.
Analysis carried out using EIME (Environmental Information and Management Explorer)
software and based on international averages.
The green building design for buildings and building systems. More specifically, the
ASHRAE prescriptive strongly recommends that HVAC systems
movement is on! with total fan power greater than 5 hp have variable air volume fan
control and that individual variable air volume fans with motors
The Altivar 61 drive can help create green
greater than or equal to 15 hp have variable speed drives.
buildings. The U.S. Green Building Council®
(USGBC) developed and administered the For government buildings, government regulations such as the
LEED® (Leadership in Energy and Energy Policy Act of 2005 (EPAct) mandate energy monitoring and
Environmental Design) Green Building energy efficiency improvements. LEED certification alone has its
Rating System™, to define green buildings. benefits. In addition to saving energy costs, it also allows the
One of the prerequisites of the LEED-NC building owner to take advantage of state and local government
Energy and Atmosphere component is incentives and makes the building project more marketable to
meeting both the mandatory provisions and tenants who are seeking more energy-efficient/sustainable facilities.
prescriptive/performance requirements of
ASHRAE 90.1-2004. This standard sets The Altivar 61 drive can help create green buildings by providing
minimum requirements to promote the gains in energy efficiency, easier commissioning and monitoring of
principles of effective, energy-conserving the building, and by its Eco-Design.
11
Altivar® 61 Drives Electrical Specifications
Input Voltage 200 -15% to 240 +10%, 380 -15% to 480 +10%
Displacement Power Factor 98% through speed range
Input Frequency 50 Hz -5% to 60 Hz +5%
Drive Input Section Six pulse bridge rectifier
Three Phase, IGBT Inverter with Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) output
Drive Output Section
Maximum voltage equal to input voltage
Galvanic Isolation Galvanic isolation between power and control (inputs, outputs and power supplies)
Frequency Range of Power Converter 0.5 to 500 Hz
Torque/overtorque 110% of nominal motor torque for 60 s, minimum
Current (transient) 110% of controller rated current for 60 s, minimum
Selectable from 1 to 16 kHz, 12 kHz nominal rating for 1-60 hp @ 200/240 V, 1-100 hp @ 380/480 V.
Switching Frequency
Selectable: 2.5 to 8 kHz, 2.5 kHz nominal rating for 75-125 hp @ 200/240 V125-900 hp @ 380/480 V.
AI: 0 to +10 V, Impedance = 30 kOhms Used for Speed potentiometer, 1-10 kOhms
Speed Reference Inputs
AI2: Factory setting = 4 to 20mA, software configurable for current, (0-20mA, X-Y) or voltage
Analog Reference Resolution 0.1 for 100 Hz (11 bits)
I/O Sampling Time 2 ms +/- 0.5 ms on analog inputs & outputs, & logic inputs, 7 ms +/- 0.5 ms on relay outputs
Power Removal/Run Permissive Input 24Vdc input, for use to prohibit unitended equipment operation
Efficiency 98% at full load typical
Acceleration and Deceleration Ramps 0.1 to 999.9 seconds (definition in 0.1 s increments)
Skip Frequencies Three configurable skip frequency/jump frequency bands
Energy economizer (flux optimization) motor algorithm to maximize energy savings.
Motor Control Profiles (Automatically optimizes voltage based on load.) or select from 2 point or 5 point volts/hertz profile
or SLFV (sensorless flux vector)
Speed Range 1 to 100, open loop
Motor Protection Class 10 electronic overload protection or PTC probe
Simply Start menu, PID set-up menu, network set-up menu, Logic I/O & Analog I/O mapping and
Graphic Display Terminal status, Monitoring and self diagnostics with fault messages and status such as; Power on time,
elapsed time, motor run time, line voltage, motor current, ready to run, running, motor speed
Compliance RoHS and WEEE (Waste Electrical & Electronic Equipment compliant
UL, CSA, NOM 117, DNV, CE, C-Tick, GOST,
Codes and Standards
UL 1995 Plenum rated, SEMI-F47 certified for voltage dip ride-through
1-60 hp @ 200/240 V, 1-100 hp @ 380/480 V: 15gn for 11ms conforming to IEC/EN 600068-2-27
Shock Resistance 75-125 hp @ 200/240 V, 125-500 hp @ 380/480 V: 7gn for 11ms conforming to IEC/EN 600068-2-27
600-900 hp @ 380/480 V. 4gn for 11ms conforming to IEC/EN 600068-2-27
12
Altivar® 61 Drives Dimensions and Weights
With LCD Graphic Display Terminal
b Height
Frame
a Width b Height c Depth Weight with
Size
Type 1 Kit
b
mm In. mm In. mm In. kg. lbs. mm In.
1 130 5.12 230 9.06 175 6.89 3 6.61 357 14.05
2 155 6.10 260 10.24 187 7.36 4 8.82 387 15.23
3 175 6.89 295 11.61 187 7.36 5.5 12.13 422 16.61
a c
4 210 8.27 295 11.61 213 8.39 7 15.43 396 15.61
5 230 9.06 400 15.75 213 8.39 9 19.84 502 19.75
For a drive without a graphic display terminal, the depth is reduced by 26mm (1.02 in)
For a drive with one option card installed, the depth is increases 23mm (0.91 in)
For a drive with two option cards installed, the depth is increases 46mm (1.81 in)
b Height
Frame
a Width b Height c Depth Weight with
Size
Type 1 Kit
mm In. mm In. mm In. kg. lbs. mm In.
b
6 240 9.45 420 16.54 236 9.29 30 66.14 547 21.54
7 240 9.45 550 21.65 266 10.47 37 81.57 677 26.65
8 320 12.60 550 21.65 266 10.47 37 81.87 753 29.65
9 320 12.60 630 24.80 290 11.42 45 99.21 833 32.80
For a drive without a graphic display terminal, the depth is reduced by 26mm (1.02 in)
For a drive with one option card installed, the depth is increases 23mm (0.91 in) a c
For a drive with two option cards installed, the depth is increases 46mm (1.81 in)
b Height
Frame
a Width b Height c Depth Weight with
Size
Type 1 Kit
mm In. mm In. mm In. kg. lbs. mm In.
10 320 12.60 920 36.22 377 14.84 74 163 985 38.77
11 360 14.17 1022 40.24 377 14.84 80 176 1188 46.79
b
12 340 13.39 1190 46.85 377 14.84 110 242 1471 57.90
13 440 17.32 1190 46.85 377 14.84 140 309 1407 55.40
14 595 23.43 1190 46.85 377 14.84 215 474 1458 57.40
For a drive with one option card installed, the depth remains the same
For a drive with two option cards installed, the depth is increases 15mm (0.59 in)
a c
Frame
a Width b Height c Depth Weight
Size
mm In. mm In. mm In. kg. lbs.
15 890 35.04 1390 54.72 377 14.84 225 496
16 1120 44.09 1390 54.72 377 14.84 300 661
b
For a drive with one option card installed, the depth remains the same
For a drive with two option cards installed, the depth is increases 15mm (0.59 in)
a
c
13
Altivar® 61 Drives Selection guide
14
2354235 11/2008
Altivar 61
Variable speed drives for
synchronous and asynchronous motors
Programming Manual
Sofware V2.1
12/2009
1760649
www.schneider-electric.com
2354235 11/2008 1
Contents
1760649 12/2009 3
Before you begin
Read and understand these instructions before performing any procedure with this drive.
DANGER
HAZARDOUS VOLTAGE
• Read and understand the Installation Manual in full before installing or operating the ATV61 drive. Installation,
adjustment, repair, and maintenance must be performed by qualified personnel.
• The user is responsible for compliance with all international and national electrical standards in force concerning
protective grounding of all equipment.
• Many parts in this variable speed drive, including printed wiring boards, operate at line voltage. DO NOT TOUCH.
Use only electrically insulated tools.
• DO NOT touch unshielded components or terminal strip screw connections with voltage present.
• Install and close all the covers before applying power or starting and stopping the drive.
CAUTION
DAMAGED EQUIPMENT
Do not operate or install any drive that appears damaged.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
4 1760649 12/2009
Documentation structure
The following Altivar 61 technical documents are available on the Schneider Electric website (www.schneider-electric.com) as well as on
the CD-ROM supplied with the drive.
Installation Manual
This bulletin contains complete mounting and wiring instructions.
Programming Manual
This describes the functions, parameters and use of the drive terminal (integrated display terminal and graphic display terminal).
The communication functions are not described in this manual, but in the manual for the bus or network used.
• The drive parameters with specific information for use via a bus or communication network.
1760649 12/2009 5
Software enhancements
Since the Altivar ATV 61 was first launched, it has benefited from the addition of several new functions. The software version is now V2.1.
The old versions can be replaced by this new one without any modifications.
Although this documentation relates to version V2.1, it can still be used with earlier versions, as the updates merely involve the addition of
new values and parameters, and none of the parameters of the previous versions have been modified or removed.
The software version is indicated on the nameplate attached to the body of the drive.
6 1760649 12/2009
Software enhancements
1760649 12/2009 7
Steps for setting up the drive
INSTALLATION
v 1 Consult the Installation Manual
PROGRAMMING
Procedure applicable if the factory configuration, page 9, and use of the
[SIMPLY START] (SIM-) menu only are sufficient for the application.
b 4 Configure the
[SIMPLY START] (SIM-) menu
v 2-wire or 3-wire control
v Macro configuration
v Motor parameters
) Perform an auto-tuning operation
v Motor thermal current
v Acceleration and deceleration
ramps
v Speed variation range
Tips:
b 5 Start
• Before you start programming, complete
the user setting tables, page 246.
8 1760649 12/2009
Factory configuration
If the above values are compatible with the application, the drive can be used without changing the settings.
1760649 12/2009 9
Setup – Preliminary recommendations
DANGER
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before turning on and configuring the Altivar 61, check that the PWR (POWER REMOVAL) input is deactivated
(at state 0) in order to prevent unintended operation.
• Before turning on or on exiting the configuration menus, check that the inputs assigned to the run command are
deactivated (at state 0) since they can cause the motor to start immediately.
CAUTION
INCOMPATIBLE LINE VOLTAGE
Before turning on and configuring the drive, ensure that the line voltage is compatible with the supply voltage range shown
on the drive nameplate. The drive may be damaged if the line voltage is not compatible.
CAUTION
RISK OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
• Avoid operating the contactor frequently (premature ageing of the filter capacitors).
• Cycle times < 60 s may result in damage to the pre-charge resistor.
DANGER
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Check that changes made to the settings during operation do not present any danger.
• We recommend stopping the drive before making any changes.
10 1760649 12/2009
Setup – Preliminary recommendations
Starting
Important:
• In factory settings mode, the motor can only be supplied with power once the “forward”, “reverse” and “DC injection stop” commands
have been reset:
- On power-up or a manual fault reset or after a stop command
If they have not been reset, the drive will display “nSt” but will not start.
• If the automatic restart function has been configured ([Automatic restart] (Atr) parameter in the [1.8-FAULT MANAGEMENT] (FLt-)
menu, see page 191), these commands are taken into account without a reset being necessary.
CAUTION
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Motor thermal protection will not be provided by the drive if the motor current is less than 0.2 times the rated drive current.
Provide an alternative means of thermal protection.
CAUTION
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Motor thermal protection is no longer provided by the drive. Provide an alternative means of thermal protection on every
motor.
1760649 12/2009 11
Setup – Preliminary recommendations
Using motor with nominal voltage lower than drive supply voltage
• Configure [Vector Control 2pt] (UC2) = [Yes] (YES) ([1.4-MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-) menu, see page 69)
CAUTION
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• To protect a motor which has a nominal voltage lower than drive supply voltage, it is mandatory to use
[Vector Control 2pt] (UC2) function in order to limit maximal voltage of the motor lower than network voltage.
• Nevertheless, it is necessary to check that instantaneous voltage applied to the motor (link to DC bus voltage) are
compatible with characteristics of this one.
12 1760649 12/2009
Graphic display terminal
Although the graphic display terminal is optional for low-power drives, it is a standard component on high-power drives (see catalog).
The graphic display terminal can be disconnected and connected remotely (on the door of an enclosure for example) using the cables and
accessories available as options (see catalog).
1 Graphic display
2 Function keys
F1, F2, F3, F4,
see page 14.
7 ESC key: Aborts a value,
3 STOP/RESET a parameter or a menu to
button return to the previous selection
5 Navigation button:
• Press (ENT): - To save the current value
- To enter the selected menu or parameter
• Turn CW/ - To increment or decrement a value
CCW: - To go to the next or previous line
- To increase or decrease the reference if control
via the terminal is activated
Note: Buttons 3, 4, 5 and 6 can be used to control the drive directly, if control via the terminal is activated.
Disconnected terminal
When the terminal is disconnected, two LEDs become visible:
Green LED:
Red LED:
DC bus ON
Fault
HMI Modbus
1760649 12/2009 13
Graphic display terminal
3 1.3 SETTINGS
1.4 MOTOR CONTROL
1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG
F1 F2 F3 F4
1. Display line. Its content can be configured; the factory settings show:
• The drive state (see page 15)
• The active control channel:
- Term: Terminals
- HMI: Graphic display terminal
- MDB: Integrated Modbus
- CAN: Integrated CANopen
- NET: Communication card
- APP: Controller Inside card
• Frequency reference
• LOC/REM: “LOC” appears if the command and reference are set via the graphic display terminal; otherwise, “REM” appears.
This corresponds to the state selected by the [T/K] function key.
3. Menus, submenus, parameters, values, bar charts, etc., are displayed in drop-down window format on a maximum of 5 lines.
The line or value selected by the navigation button is displayed in reverse video.
4. Section displaying the functions assigned to the keys F1 to F4 and aligned with them, for example:
• Code F1 : Displays the code of the selected parameter, i.e., the code corresponding to the 7-segment display.
• << F2 : Navigate horizontally to the left, or go to previous menu/submenu or, for a value, go to the next digit up, displayed
in reverse video (see the example on page 16).
• >> F3 : Navigate horizontally to the right or go to next menu/submenu (going to the [2 ACCESS LEVEL] menu in this
example) or, for a value, go to the next digit down, displayed in reverse video (see the example on page 16).
• T/K F4 : Command and reference via the terminal, see page 120.
5. Indicates that there are no more levels below this display window.
Indicates that there are more levels below this display window.
6. Indicates that there are no more levels above this display window.
Indicates that there are more levels above this display window.
14 1760649 12/2009
Graphic display terminal
1760649 12/2009 15
Graphic display terminal
RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM When only one possible selection can be made, the selection made is indicated by
5 LANGUAGE Example: Only one language can be chosen.
English
Français
Deutsch
Español
Italiano
<< >> T/K
Chinese
Turkish
Russian
PARAMETER SELECTION When multiple selection is possible, the selections made are indicated by
1.3 SETTINGS Example: A number of parameters can be chosen to form the [USER MENU].
Ramp increment
Acceleration
Deceleration
Acceleration 2
Deceleration 2
Edit
>>
9.51 s 9.51 s
Min = 0.01 Max = 99.99 Min = 0.01 Max = 99.99
<< >> T/K << >> T/K
The << and >> arrows (keys F2 and F3) are used to select the digit to be modified, and the navigation button is rotated to increase or
decrease this number.
16 1760649 12/2009
Graphic display terminal
3 seconds
5 LANGUAGE
English Switches to [5 LANGUAGE] menu automatically.
Français
Deutsch
Select the language and press ENT.
Español
Italiano
Chinese
Turkish
Russian
ESC
1760649 12/2009 17
Graphic display terminal
ATV61HU22N4
2.2kW/3HP 380/480V
Config. n°1
10 seconds
ESC
18 1760649 12/2009
Graphic display terminal
RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM
1 DRIVE MENU 1.3 SETTINGS Acceleration
1.1 SIMPLY START ENT Ramp increment: 01 ENT
1.2 MONITORING Acceleration 9.51 s
1.3 SETTINGS
ESC
Deceleration: 9.67 s
ENT or
9.51 s
1.4 MOTOR CONTROL Acceleration 2: 12.58 s
1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG Deceleration 2: 13.45 s Min = 0.01 Max = 99.99
Code << >> T/K Code << >> T/K ESC << >> T/K
Note:
• To select a parameter:
- Turn the navigation button to scroll vertically.
• To modify a parameter:
- Use the << and >> keys (F2 and F3) to scroll horizontally and select the digit to be modified (the selected digit changes to white
on a black background).
- Turn the navigation button to modify the digit.
1760649 12/2009 19
Graphic display terminal
Quick navigation
In order to access this function you must first reassign the F4 key, which is assigned by default to control via the terminal (T/K) (see page 120).
If the “Quick” function is displayed above the F4 key, you can gain quick access to a parameter from any screen.
Example:
20 1760649 12/2009
Graphic display terminal
1760649 12/2009 21
Graphic display terminal
[1 DRIVE MENU]
22 1760649 12/2009
Integrated display terminal
Low-power Altivar 61 drives (see catalog) feature an integrated display terminal with a 7-segment 4-digit display. The graphic display
terminal described on the previous pages can also be connected to these drives as an option.
• Press and hold down (>2 s) or to scroll through the data quickly.
- 43.0: Display of the parameter selected in the SUP menu (default selection: motor frequency)
- CLI: Current limit
- CtL: Controlled stop on input phase loss
- dCb: DC injection braking in progress
- FLU: Motor fluxing in progress
- FRF: Drive at fallback speed
- FSt: Fast stop
- nLP: No line power (no line supply on L1, L2, L3)
- nSt: Freewheel stop
- Obr: Auto-adapted deceleration
- PrA: Power Removal function active (drive locked)
- rdY: Drive ready
- SOC: Controlled output cut in progress
- tUn: Auto-tuning in progress
- USA: Undervoltage alarm
1760649 12/2009 23
Integrated display terminal
Accessing menus
Power-up
ENT
ENT
ESC
SIM- SIMPLY START (page 32) Simplified menu for fast startup
ESC
ENT
ESC (page 38) Visualization of current, motor and input/output values
SUP- MONITORING
ESC
ENT
ESC
(page 47) Adjustment parameters, can be modified during
SEt- SETTINGS
ESC operation
ENT
ESC
(page 66) Motor parameters (motor nameplate, auto-tuning,
drC- MOTOR CONTROL
ESC switching frequency, control algorithms, etc.)
ENT
ESC
(page 79) I/O configuration (scaling, filtering, 2-wire control,
I-O- INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG
ESC 3-wire control, etc.)
ENT
ESC (page 108) Configuration of command and reference channels
CtL- COMMAND (graphic display terminal, terminals, bus, etc.)
Menus ESC
ENT
ESC
(page 121) Configuration of application functions (e.g., preset
FUn- APPLICATION FUNCT.
ESC speeds, PID, etc.)
ENT
ESC
ENT
ESC
ENT
ESC (page 220) Access to configuration files and return to factory
FCS- FACTORY SETTINGS
ESC settings
ENT
ESC
(page 223) Specific menu, set up by the user using the graphic
USr- USER MENU
ESC display terminal.
ENT
ESC
(page 224) Menu for the Controller Inside card, if present.
SPL- PROGRAMMABLE CARD
ESC
ENT
ESC
ENT
ESC
LAC-
(page 26)
ACCESS LEVEL
ESC
A dash appears after menu and submenu codes to differentiate them from parameter codes.
Examples: FUn- menu, ACC parameter.
The grayed-out menus may not be accessible depending on the control access (LAC) configuration.
24 1760649 12/2009
Integrated display terminal
Menu Parameter Value or assignment The display flashes when a value is stored.
SEt- ACC 15 0
ENT ENT
ESC ESC
ESC
1 flash (save)
dEC 26 0.
ENT
26 0.
(Next parameter)
All the menus are “drop-down scrolling” menus, which means that after the
last parameter, if you continue to press , you will return to the first parameter
ENT
Menu 1st and, conversely, you can switch from the first parameter to the last parameter
ESC by pressing .
nth
last
1760649 12/2009 25
[2. ACCESS LEVEL] (LAC-)
RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM
2 ACCESS LEVEL MAIN MENU 1. DRIVE MENU
Basic 1 DRIVE MENU 1.1 SIMPLY START
Standard 2 ACCESS LEVEL 1.2. MONITORING
Advanced 3 OPEN / SAVE AS 1.3. SETTINGS
Expert 4 PASSWORD 1.11. IDENTIFICATION
5 LANGUAGE 1.12. FACTORY SETTINGS
<< >> T/K Code << >> T/K Code << >> T/K
1.13 USER MENU
Standard
This is the factory-set level. Access to 6 menus only, and access to all
submenus in the [1. DRIVE MENU] menu.
A single function can be assigned to each input.
Expert
Access to all menus and submenus as for [Advanced] level, and access to
additional parameters.
Several functions can be assigned to each input.
26 1760649 12/2009
[2. ACCESS LEVEL] (LAC-)
Power-up
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ESC
COd-
ENT
ESC
LAC- Std
bAS • bAS: Limited access to SIM, SUP, SEt, FCS, USr, COd and LAC menus. A single function can be assigned to
each input.
Std • Std: Access to all menus on the integrated display terminal. A single function can be assigned to each input.
Adu • AdU: Access to all menus on the integrated display terminal. Several functions can be assigned to each input.
Epr • EPr: Access to all menus on the integrated display terminal and access to additional parameters. Several functions
can be assigned to each input.
1760649 12/2009 27
[2. ACCESS LEVEL] (LAC-)
Comparison of the menus that can be accessed on the graphic display terminal/
integrated display terminal
[5 LANGUAGE] -
Basic bAS
[1 DRIVE MENU] [1.1 SIMPLY START] SIM- (Simply start)
Advanced AdU
A single function can be assigned to each input. A single function can be assigned
to each input.
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] drC- (Motor control)
Expert EPr
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] I-O- (I/O configuration)
[1.10 DIAGNOSTICS] -
[1.14 PROGRAMMABLE CARD] (1) PLC- (Controller Inside card) (1)
[6 MONITORING CONFIG.] -
A single function can be assigned to each input. A single function can be assigned to
each input.
[7 DISPLAY CONFIG.] -
Several functions can be assigned to each input. Several functions can be assigned
to each input.
Expert parameters Expert parameters
Several functions can be assigned to each input. Several functions can be assigned
to each input.
28 1760649 12/2009
Structure of parameter tables
The parameter tables in the descriptions of the various menus can be used with both the graphic display terminal and the integrated display
terminal. They, therefore, contain information for these two terminals in accordance with the description below.
Example:
1. Name of menu on 4-digit 7-segment display 5. Name of menu on graphic display terminal
2. Submenu code on 4-digit 7-segment display 6. Name of submenu on graphic display terminal
3. Parameter code on 4-digit 7-segment display 7. Name of parameter on graphic display terminal
4. Parameter value on 4-digit 7-segment display 8. Value of parameter on graphic display terminal
Note:
• The text in square brackets [ ] indicates what you will see on the graphic display terminal.
• The factory settings correspond to [Macro configuration] (CFG) = [Pumps.Fans] (PnF). This is the macro configuration
set at the factory.
1760649 12/2009 29
Interdependence of parameter values
The configuration of certain parameters modifies the adjustment range of other parameters, in order to reduce the risk of errors. This may
result in the modification of a factory setting or a value you have already selected.
Example 1:
1. [Switching freq.] (SFr) page 75 set to 16 kHz.
2. [Sinus filter] (OFI), see page 75, set to [Yes] (YES) (and confirmed with “ENT”) limits [Switching freq.] (SFr) to 8 kHz.
If you set [Sinus filter] (OFI) to [No] (nO), [Switching freq.] (SFr) will no longer be limited but will remain at 8 kHz. If you require 16 kHz,
you must reset [Switching freq.] (SFr).
Example 2:
1. The factory setting of [Switching freq.] (SFr) page 75 remains unchanged at 2.5 kHz.
2. Setting [Sinus filter] (OFI) page 75 to [Yes] (YES) (and confirming with “ENT”) changes the factory setting of [Switching freq.]
(SFr) to 4 kHz.
3. If you set [Sinus filter] (OFI) to [No] (nO), [Switching freq.] (SFr) will remain at 4 kHz. If you require 2.5 kHz, you must reset
[Switching freq.] (SFr).
30 1760649 12/2009
Finding a parameter in this document
• With the integrated display terminal: Direct use of the parameter code index, page 249, to find the page giving details of the
displayed parameter.
• With the graphic display terminal: Select the required parameter and press F1 : [Code]. The parameter code is displayed instead
of its name while the key is held down.
Example: ACC
Then use the parameter code index, page 249, to find the page giving details of the displayed parameter.
1760649 12/2009 31
[1.1 SIMPLY START] (SIM-)
RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RUN Term +0.00 Hz REM
MAIN MENU 1 DRIVE MENU 1.1 SIMPLY START
ENT ENT
1 DRIVE MENU 1.1 SIMPLY START 2/3 wire control
2 ACCESS LEVEL 1.2 MONITORING Macro configuration
3 OPEN / SAVE AS 1.3 SETTINGS Customized macro
4 PASSWORD 1.4 MOTOR CONTROL Standard mot. freq
5 LANGUAGE 1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG Input phase loss
Code T/K Code << >> T/K Code << >> T/K
ENT
ENT
ESC
ESC
SUP-
ESC
LAC-
The [1.1-SIMPLY START] (SIM-) menu can be used for fast startup, which is sufficient for the majority of applications.
The parameters in this menu can only be modified when the drive is stopped and no run command is present, with the following exceptions:
• Auto-tuning, which causes the motor to start up
• The adjustment parameters on page 37
Note: The parameters of the [1.1 SIMPLY START] (SIM-) menu must be entered in the order in which they appear, as the later
ones are dependent on the first ones.
For example [2/3 wire control] (tCC) must be configured before any other parameters.
The [1.1 SIMPLY START] (SIM-) menu should be configured on its own or before the other drive configuration menus. If a modification
has previously been made to any of them, in particular in [1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-), some [1.1 SIMPLY START] (SIM-) parameters
may be changed, for example, the motor parameters, if a synchronous motor has been selected. Returning to the [1.1 SIMPLY START]
(SIM-) menu after modifying another drive configuration menu is unnecessary but does not pose any risk. Changes following modification
of another configuration menu are not described, to avoid unnecessary complication in this section.
Macro configuration
Macro configuration provides a means of speeding up the configuration of functions for a specific field of application.
5 macro configurations are available:
• Start/stop
• General use
• PID regulator
• Communication bus
• Pumps/fans (factory configuration)
32 1760649 12/2009
[1.1 SIMPLY START] (SIM-)
(1) To start up with integrated Modbus, [Modbus Address] (Add) must first be configured, page 215.
Note: These assignments are reinitialized every time the macro configuration changes.
Note:
• The factory settings in the parameter tables correspond to [Macro configuration] (CFG) = [Pumps.Fans] (PnF). This is the
macro configuration set at the factory.
1760649 12/2009 33
[1.1 SIMPLY START] (SIM-)
2C v [2 wire] (2C)
3C v [3 wire] (3C)
2-wire control: This is the input state (0 or 1) or edge (0 to 1 or 1 to 0), which controls running or stopping.
3-wire control (pulse control): A “forward” or “reverse” pulse is sufficient to command starting, a “stop” pulse is
sufficient to command stopping.
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
To change the assignment of [2/3 wire control] (tCC) press the “ENT” key for 2 s.
The following function will be returned to factory settings: [2 wire type] (tCt) page 80 as will all
functions which assign logic inputs.
The macro configuration selected will also be reset if it has been customized (loss of custom settings).
Check that this change is compatible with the wiring diagram used.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
To change the assignment of [Macro configuration] (CFG) press the “ENT” key for 2 s.
Check that the selected macro configuration is compatible with the wiring diagram used.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.
34 1760649 12/2009
[1.1 SIMPLY START] (SIM-)
This parameter is only accessible in this menu on ATV61H037M3 to HU75M3 drives (used with a single
phase supply).
The factory setting is 60 Hz, or preset to 72 Hz if [Standard mot. freq] (bFr) is set to 60 Hz.
The maximum value is limited by the following conditions:
• It must not exceed 10 times the value of [Rated motor freq.] (FrS)
• Values between 500 Hz and 1000 Hz are not possible for ATV61HpppY (500 to 690 V)
• Values between 500 Hz and 1,000 Hz are only possible in V/F control and for powers limited to 37 kW
(50 HP) for ATV61H ppp and 45 kW (60 HP) for ATV61Wppp. In this case, configure [Motor control type] (Ctt)
before [Max frequency] (tFr).
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual and on the drive nameplate.
1760649 12/2009 35
[1.1 SIMPLY START] (SIM-)
36 1760649 12/2009
[1.1 SIMPLY START] (SIM-)
Time to accelerate from 0 to the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS) (page 35). Make sure that this value is compatible
with the inertia being driven.
Time to decelerate from the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS) (page 35) to 0. Make sure that this value is compatible
with the inertia being driven.
Motor frequency at minimum reference, can be set between 0 and [High speed] (HSP).
Motor frequency at maximum reference, can be set between [Low speed] (LSP) and [Max frequency] (tFr).
The factory setting changes to 60 Hz if [Standard mot. freq] (bFr) = [60Hz NEMA] (60).
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual and on the drive nameplate.
1760649 12/2009 37
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-)
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ENT
ESC
SUP- MONITORING
ESC
ESC
SEt-
ESC
LAC-
38 1760649 12/2009
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-)
I/O
1760649 12/2009 39
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-)
Code T/K
40 1760649 12/2009
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-)
RUN Term +50.00 Hz REM [COMMUNICATION MAP] indicates the types of bus used for control or reference,
COMMUNICATION MAP the corresponding command and reference values, the status word, the words selected
Command Channel: Modbus in the [DISPLAY CONFIG] menu, etc.
Cmd value: ABCD Hex
The display format (hexadecimal or decimal) can be configured in the [DISPLAY
Active ref. channel: CANopen
CONFIG.] menu.
Frequency ref.: - 12.5 Hz
ETA status word: 2153 Hex
Code T/K
W3141: F230 Hex
W2050: F230 Hex
W4325: F230 Hex
W0894: F230 Hex
COM. SCANNER INPUT MAP RUN Term +50.00 Hz REM
COM SCAN OUTPUT MAP COM. SCANNER INPUT MAP
CMD. WORD IMAGE Com Scan In1 val.: 0
FREQ. REF. WORD MAP Com Scan In2 val.: 0
MODBUS NETWORK DIAG Com Scan In3 val.: 0
MODBUS HMI DIAG Com Scan In4 val.: 0
CANopen MAP Com Scan In5 val.: 0
RUN Term +50.00 Hz REM
PROG. CARD SCANNER Code T/K
COM SCAN OUTPUT MAP
Com Scan In6 val.: 0
Com Scan Out1 val.: 0
Com Scan In7 val.: 0
Com Scan Out2 val.: 0
Com Scan In8 val.: 0
Com Scan Out3 val.: 0
Com Scan Out4 val.: 0
Com Scan Out5 val.: 0
Code T/K
Com Scan Out6 val.: 0
Com Scan Out7 val.: 0
Com Scan Out8 val.: 0
Code T/K
1760649 12/2009 41
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-)
The state of the LEDs, the periodic data, the address, the speed, and the
format, etc,. is given for each bus.
RUN Term +50.00 Hz REM
COMMUNICATION MAP
Command Channel: Modbus LED off
Cmd value: ABCD Hex LED on
Active ref. channel: CANopen
Frequency ref.: - 12.5 Hz Communication via Modbus
ETA status word: 2153 Hex RUN Term +50.00 Hz REM
Code T/K MODBUS NETWORK DIAG
W3141 : F230 Hex COM LED :
W2050 : F230 Hex Mb NET frames nb.
W4325 : F230 Hex Mb NET CRC errors
W0894 : F230 Hex
COM. SCANNER INPUT MAP
COM SCAN OUTPUT MAP Code T/K
CMD. WORD IMAGE
FREQ. REF. WORD MAP Communication via the graphic display terminal
MODBUS NETWORK DIAG RUN Term +50.00 Hz REM
MODBUS HMI DIAG MODBUS HMI DIAG
CANopen MAP COM LED :
PROG. CARD SCANNER Mb HMI frames nb.
Mb HMI CRC errors
42 1760649 12/2009
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-)
Code T/K
1760649 12/2009 43
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-)
Name/Description
[Alarm groups] (ALGr) Current alarm group numbers
[HMI Frequency ref.] (LFr) in Hz. Frequency reference via the graphic display terminal (can be accessed if the function has been configured)
[Internal PID ref.] (rPI) as a process value. PID reference via graphic display terminal (can be accessed if the function has been
configured)
[Multiplying coeff.] (MFr) as a % (can be accessed if [Multiplier ref. -] (MA2,MA3) page 128 has been assigned)
[Frequency ref.] (FrH) in Hz
[Output frequency] (rFr) in Hz
[Measured output fr.] (MMF) in Hz: The measured motor speed is displayed if an encoder card has been inserted, otherwise 0 appears.
[Pulse in. work. freq.] (FqS) in Hz: Frequency of the "Pulse input" input used by the [FREQUENCY METER] (FqF-) function, page 205
[Motor current] (LCr) in A
[Motor speed] (SPd) in rpm
[Motor voltage] (UOP) in V
[Motor power] (OPr) as a % of the rated power
[Motor torque] (Otr) as a % of the rated torque
[Mains voltage] (ULn) in V. Line voltage from the point of view of the DC bus, motor running or stopped
[Motor thermal state] (tHr) as a %
[Drv. thermal state] (tHd) as a %
[DBR thermal state] (tHb) as a % (can only be accessed on high rating drives)
[Input Power] (IPr) in kW (electrical power consumed by the drive)
[Consumption] (IPHr) in Wh, kWh or MWh (accumulated electrical consumption of drive)
[Run time] (rtH) in seconds, minutes or hours (length of time the motor has been switched on)
[Power on time] (PtH) in seconds, minutes or hours (length of time the drive has been switched on)
[Proc. Operat. Time] (PEt) in hours (length of time the process has been switched on) This parameter can be initialized by the user if
the drive is replaced, in order to maintain a record of previous times.
[IGBT alarm counter] (tAC) in seconds (length of time the “IGBT temperature” alarm has been active)
[PID reference] (rPC) as a process value (can be accessed if the PID function has been configured)
[PID feedback] (rPF) as a process value (can be accessed if the PID function has been configured)
[PID error] (rPE) as a process value (can be accessed if the PID function has been configured)
[PID Output] (rPO) in Hz (can be accessed if the PID function has been configured)
[Date/Time] (CLO) Current date and time generated by the Controller Inside card (can be accessed if the card has been inserted)
[- - - - 2] (o02) Words generated by the Controller Inside card (can be accessed if the card has been inserted)
to
[- - - - 6] (o06)
[Config. active] (CnFS) Active configuration [Config. n°0, 1 or 2]
[Utilised param. set] (CFPS) [Set n°1, 2 or 3] (can be accessed if parameter switching has been enabled, see page 174)
[ALARMS] (ALr-) List of current alarms. If an alarm is present, a appears.
[OTHER STATUS] (SSt-) List of secondary states:
- [In motor fluxing] (FLX): In motor fluxing - [HSP attained] (FLA): High speed
- [PTC1 alarm] (PtC1): Probe alarm 1 attained
- [PTC2 alarm] (PtC2): Probe alarm 2 - [Set 1 active] (CFP1): Parameter set
- [LI6=PTC alarm] (PtC3): LI6 = PTC probe alarm 1 active
- [Fast stop in prog.] (FSt): Fast stop in progress - [Set 2 active] (CFP2): Parameter set
- [Current Th. attained] (CtA): Current threshold attained 2 active
([Current threshold] (Ctd) page 59) - [Set 3 active] (CFP3): Parameter set
- [Freq. Th. attained] (FtA): Frequency threshold attained 3 active
([Freq. threshold] (Ftd) page 59) - [In braking] (brS): Drive braking
- [Freq. Th. 2 attained] (F2A): 2nd frequency threshold attained - [DC bus loading] (dbL): DC bus
([Freq. threshold 2] (F2d) page 59) loading
- [Frequency ref. att.] (SrA): Frequency reference attained - [Forward] (MFrd): Motor running
- [Motor th. state att.] (tSA): Motor 1 thermal state attained forward
- [External fault alarm] (EtF): External fault alarm - [Reverse] (MrrS): Motor running in
- [Auto restart] (AUtO): Automatic restart in progress reverse
- [Remote] (FtL): Line mode control - [High torque alarm] (ttHA): Motor
- [Auto-tuning] (tUn): Performing auto-tuning torque greater than high threshold
- [Undervoltage] (USA): Undervoltage alarm [High torque thd.] (ttH) page 59.
- [Cnfg.1 act.] (CnF1): Configuration 1 active - [Low torque alarm] (ttLA): Motor
- [Cnfg.2 act.] (CnF2): Configuration 2 active torque less than low threshold [Low
torque thd.] (ttL) page 59.
- [Freq. meter Alarm] (FqLA):
Measured speed threshold attained:
[Pulse warning thd.] (FqL) page 59.
44 1760649 12/2009
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-)
LIS1
b State of logic inputs LI1 to LI8
Can be used to visualize the state of logic inputs LI1 to LI8
(display segment assignment: high = 1, low = 0)
State 1
State 0
LI1 LI2 LI3 LI4 LI5 LI6 LI7 LI8
Example above: LI1 and LI6 are at 1; LI2 to LI5, LI7 and LI8 are at 0.
LIS2
b State of logic inputs LI9 to LI14 and Power Removal
Can be used to visualize the state of logic inputs LI19to LI14 and PR (Power Removal)
(display segment assignment: high = 1, low = 0)
State 1
State 0
LI9 LI10 LI11 LI12 LI13 LI14 PR
Example above: LI9 and LI14 are at 1, LI10 to LI13 are at 0 and PR (Power Removal) is at 1.
AIA-
b Analog input functions
AI1A Can be used to display the functions assigned to each input. If no functions have been assigned, nO is
AI2A displayed. Use the and arrows to scroll through the functions. If a number of functions have been
AI3A assigned to the same input, check that they are compatible.
AI4A
1760649 12/2009 45
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-)
rPI Internal PID reference: PID reference via graphic display terminal (can be accessed if the function has as a process
been configured). value
MFr Multiplication coefficient (can be accessed if [Multiplier ref. -] (MA2,MA3) page 128 has been assigned) %
MMF The measured motor speed is displayed if an encoder card has been inserted, otherwise 0 appears. Hz
FqS Frequency of the "Pulse input" used by the [FREQUENCY METER] (FqF-) function, page 205 Hz
ULn Line voltage: Line voltage from the point of view of the DC bus, motor running or stopped. V
rtH Run time: Length of time the motor has been turned on seconds,
minutes or
PtH Power on time: Length of time the drive has been turned on hours
PEt Length of time the process has been turned on: in hours. This parameter can be initialized by the user hours
if the drive is replaced, in order to maintain a record of previous times.
tAC IGBT alarm counter: Length of time the “IGBT temperature” alarm has been active seconds
rPC PID reference: Can be accessed if the PID function has been configured as a process
value
rPF PID feedback: Can be accessed if the PID function has been configured
rPE PID error: Can be accessed if the PID function has been configured
rPO PID Output: Can be accessed if the PID function has been configured Hz
CLO- tIME, dAY: Current date and time generated by the Controller Inside card (can be accessed if the card has
been inserted)
o02 - - - - 2: Word generated by the Controller Inside card (can be accessed if the card has been inserted)
o03 - - - - 3: Word generated by the Controller Inside card (can be accessed if the card has been inserted)
o04 - - - - 4: Word generated by the Controller Inside card (can be accessed if the card has been inserted)
o05 - - - - 5: Word generated by the Controller Inside card (can be accessed if the card has been inserted)
o06 - - - - 6: Word generated by the Controller Inside card (can be accessed if the card has been inserted)
CnFS Config. active: CnF0, 1 or 2 (can be accessed if motor or configuration switching has been enabled,
see page 179)
CFPS Utilised param. set: CFP1, 2 or 3 (can be accessed if parameter switching has been enabled, see page 174)
46 1760649 12/2009
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ENT
ESC
SEt- SETTINGS
ESC
ESC
drC-
ESC
LAC-
1760649 12/2009 47
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
The adjustment parameters can be modified with the drive running or stopped.
DANGER
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Check that changes made to the settings during operation do not present any danger.
• We recommend stopping the drive before making any changes.
Time to accelerate from 0 to the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS) (page 64). Make sure that this value is compatible
with the inertia being driven.
Time to decelerate from the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS) (page 64) to 0. Make sure that this value is compatible
with the inertia being driven.
(1) Range 0.01 to 99.99 s or 0.1 to 999.9 s or 1 to 9,000 s according to [Ramp increment] (Inr).
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
48 1760649 12/2009
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
Motor frequency at minimum reference, can be set between 0 and [High speed] (HSP).
Motor frequency at maximum reference, can be set between [Low speed] (LSP) and [Max frequency] (tFr).
The factory setting changes to 60 Hz if [Standard mot. freq] (bFr) = [60 Hz NEMA] (60).
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual or on the drive nameplate.
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
1760649 12/2009 49
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
Adjusting the [K speed loop filter] (SFC), [Speed prop. gain] (SPG), and [Speed time
integral] (SIt) parameters
• The following parameters can only be accessed in vector control profiles: [Motor control type] (Ctt) page 67 = [SVC V] (UUC),
[Energy Sav.] (nLd) and [Sync. mot.] (SYn).
• [Speed prop. gain] (SIt) affects the passband and response time.
1 1 1
0 0 0
0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500
Time in ms Time in ms Time in ms
1 1 1
0 0 0
0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500
Time in ms Time in ms Time in ms
50 1760649 12/2009
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
- When set to 100 as described above the regulator is a “PI” type, without filtering of the speed reference.
- Settings between 0 and 100 will obtain an intermediate function between the settings below and those on the previous page.
• [Speed prop. gain] (SPG) affects the passband and response time.
1 1 1
0 0 0
0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500
Time in ms Time in ms Time in ms
1 1 1
0 0 0
0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500
Time in ms Time in ms Time in ms
1760649 12/2009 51
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
g See page 71
g See page 71
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual or on the drive nameplate.
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
52 1760649 12/2009
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
g Level of standstill DC injection current. This parameter can be accessed if [Auto DC injection] (AdC) page 135
is not [No] (nO). This parameter is forced to 0 if [Motor control type] (Ctt) page 67 = [Sync. mot.] (SYn).
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
Standstill injection time. This parameter can be accessed if [Auto DC injection] (AdC) page 135 is not [No]
g (nO) If [Motor control type] (Ctt) page 67 = [Sync. mot.] (SYn) this time corresponds to the zero speed
maintenance time.
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
I
YES x SdC1
SdC2
tdC1 t
I
Ct =0 SdC1
1
Run command
0
t
Speed
0
t
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual or on the drive nameplate.
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
1760649 12/2009 53
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
Adjustment range: It can vary between 1 and 16 kHz, but the minimum and maximum values, as well as the
factory setting, can be limited in accordance with the type of drive (ATV61H or W), the rating (power and
voltage) and the configuration of the [Sinus filter] (OFI) and [Motor surge limit.] (SUL) parameters, page 75.
Note: In the event of excessive temperature rise, the drive will automatically reduce the switching
frequency and reset it once the temperature returns to normal.
.
CAUTION
On ATV61p075N4 to U40N4 drives, if the RFI filters are disconnected (operation on an IT system), the
switching frequency of the drive must not exceed 4 kHz.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
Note: If the setting is less than 0.25 In, the drive may lock in [Output Phase Loss] (OPF) fault mode if
this has been enabled (see page 194). If it is less than the no-load motor current, the limitation no longer
has any effect.
.
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current, particularly in the case of permanent magnet synchronous
motors, which are susceptible to demagnetization.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
Note: If the setting is less than 0.25 In, the drive may lock in [Output Phase Loss] (OPF) fault mode
if this has been enabled (see page 194). If it is less than the no-load motor current, the limitation no
longer has any effect.
.
g
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current, particularly in the case of permanent magnet synchronous
motors, which are susceptible to demagnetization.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual or on the drive nameplate.
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
54 1760649 12/2009
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
If [Motor control type] (Ctt) = [Sync. mot.] (SYn) the factory setting is replaced by [Not cont.] (FnC).
In order to obtain rapid high torque on startup, magnetic flux needs to already have been established in the
motor.
• In [Continuous] (FCt) mode, the drive automatically builds up flux when it is powered up.
• In [Not cont.] (FnC) mode, fluxing occurs when the motor starts up.
The flux current is greater than nCr (configured rated motor current) when the flux is established and is then
adjusted to the motor magnetizing current...
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
If [Motor control type] (Ctt) page 67 = [Sync. mot.] (SYn), the [Motor fluxing] (FLU) parameter causes the
alignment of the rotor and not the fluxing.
Note: If [Low speed time out] (tLS) is not 0, [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133 is forced to [Ramp stop] (rMP)
(only if a ramp stop can be configured).
Adjustable restart threshold (offset) following a stop after prolonged operation at [Low speed] (LSP) + [Sleep
Offset Thres.] (SLE), in Hz. The motor restarts if the reference rises above (LSP + SLE) and if a run command
is still present.
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
1760649 12/2009 55
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
56 1760649 12/2009
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
to rating
(1) If a graphic display terminal is not in use, values greater than 9,999 will be displayed on the 4-digit display with a period mark after the
thousand digit, e.g. 15.65 for 15,650.
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
1760649 12/2009 57
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
(1) If a graphic display terminal is not in use, values greater than 9,999 will be displayed on the 4-digit display with a period mark after the
thousand digit, e.g. 15.65 for 15,650.
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
58 1760649 12/2009
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
Upper current threshold for [I attained] (CtA) function assigned to a relay or a logic output (see page 94).
Lower current threshold for [Low I Th.At.] (CtAL) function assigned to a relay or a logic output (see page 94).
High current threshold for [High tq. att.] (ttHA) function assigned to a relay or a logic output (see page 94), as
a % of the rated motor torque.
Low current threshold for [Low tq. att.] (ttLA) function assigned to a relay or a logic output (see page 94), as a
% of the rated motor torque.
g Speed threshold measured by the [FREQUENCY METER] (FqF-) function, page 205, assigned to a relay or a
logic output (see page 95).
Lower frequency threshold for [Low Frq. Th. Attain.] (FtAL) function assigned to a relay or a logic output
(see page 94).
Lower frequency threshold for [2Low F.Thld] (F2AL) function assigned to a relay or a logic output (see page 94).
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual or on the drive nameplate.
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
1760649 12/2009 59
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
Upper frequency reference threshold for [High Ref.] (rtAH) function assigned to a relay or a logic output
(see page 94).
Lower frequency reference threshold for [Low Ref.] (rtAL) function assigned to a relay or a logic output
(see page 94).
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual or on the drive nameplate.
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
60 1760649 12/2009
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
Skip frequency. This parameter prevents prolonged operation within an adjustable range around the regulated
frequency. This function can be used to prevent a critical speed, which would cause resonance, being reached.
Setting the function to 0 renders it inactive.
2nd skip frequency. This parameter prevents prolonged operation within an adjustable range around the
regulated frequency. This function can be used to prevent a critical speed, which would cause resonance,
being reached. Setting the function to 0 renders it inactive.
3rd skip frequency. This parameter prevents prolonged operation within an adjustable range around the
regulated frequency. This function can be used to prevent a critical speed, which would cause resonance,
being reached. Setting the function to 0 renders it inactive.
Parameter visible if at least one skip frequency [Skip Frequency] (JPF), [Skip Frequency 2] (JF2) or [3rd Skip
Frequency] (JF3) is different from 0.
Skip frequency range: between (JPF – JFH) and (JPF + JFH), for example.
This adjustment is common to all 3 frequencies (JPF, JF2 and JF3).
LUL M [Unld.Thr.0.Speed] 0 to
[Unld.Thr.Nom.Speed]
0%
(LUn)
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
1760649 12/2009 61
[1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-)
(1) Range 0.01 to 99.99 s or 0.1 to 999.9 s or 1 to 9,000 s according to [Ramp increment] (Inr).
These parameters only appear if the corresponding function has been selected in another menu. When the parameters can
g also be accessed and adjusted from within the configuration menu for the corresponding function, their description is detailed
in these menus, on the pages indicated, to aid programming.
62 1760649 12/2009
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ENT
ESC
drC- MOTOR CONTROL
ESC
ESC
I-O-
ESC
LAC-
1760649 12/2009 63
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
The parameters in the [1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-) menu can only be modified when the drive is stopped and no run command is
present, with the following exceptions:
• [Auto tuning] (tUn) page 66, which causes the motor to start up.
• Parameters containing the sign Tin the code column, which can be modified with the drive running or stopped.
The parameter cannot be accessed if [Motor control type] (Ctt) page 67 = [Sync. mot.] (SYn)
Rated motor frequency given on the nameplate.
The factory setting is 50 Hz, or preset to 60 Hz if [Standard mot. freq] (bFr) is set to 60 Hz.
The maximum value is limited to 500 Hz if [Motor control type] (Ctt) (page 67) is not V/F or if the drive rating is
higher than ATV61HD37p or ATV61WD45p or if the drive is an ATV61pppY (500 to 690 V).
Values between 500 Hz and 1000 Hz are only possible in V/F control and for powers limited to 37 kW (50 HP)
for the ATV61H ppp and 45 kW (60 HP) for ATV61Wppp. In this case, configure [Motor control type] (Ctt) before
[Rated motor freq.] (FrS).
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual and on the drive nameplate.
64 1760649 12/2009
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
The factory setting is 60 Hz, or preset to 72 Hz if [Standard mot. freq] (bFr) is set to 60 Hz.
The maximum value is limited by the following conditions:
• It must not exceed 10 times the value of de [Rated motor freq.] (FrS)
• It cannot exceed 500 Hz if the [Motor control type] (Ctt) (page 67) is not V/F or if the drive rating is higher
than ATV61HD37p or ATV61WD45p, or if the drive is an ATV61pppY (500 to 690 V).
Values between 500 Hz and 1000 Hz are only possible in V/F control and for powers limited to 37 kW (50 HP)
for the ATV61H ppp and 45 kW (60 HP) for ATV61Wppp. In this case, configure [Motor control type] (Ctt)
before [Max frequency] (tFr).
1760649 12/2009 65
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
If one or more of these parameters is modified after auto-tuning has been performed, [Auto tuning] (tUn) will
return to [No] (nO) and the procedure must be repeated.
• Auto-tuning is only performed if no stop command has been activated. If a “freewheel stop” or “fast stop”
function has been assigned to a logic input, this input must be set to 1 (active at 0).
• Auto-tuning takes priority over any run or prefluxing commands, which will be taken into account after the
auto-tuning sequence.
• If auto-tuning fails, the drive displays [No] (nO) and, depending on the configuration of [Autotune fault mgt]
(tnL) page 206, may switch to [Auto-tuning] (tnF) fault mode.
• Auto-tuning may last for 1 to 2 seconds. Do not interrupt the process. Wait for the display to change to
“[Done] (dOnE)” or “[No] (nO)”.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
66 1760649 12/2009
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
UUC v [SVC V] (UUC): Open-loop voltage flux vector control with automatic slip compensation according to the load.
It supports operation with a number of motors connected in parallel on the same drive (if the motors are
identical).
UF2 v [V/F 2pts] (UF2): Simple V/F profile without slip compensation. It supports operation with:
- Special motors (wound rotor, tapered rotor, etc.)
- A number of motors in parallel on the same drive
- High-speed motors
- Motors with a low power rating in comparison to that of the drive
Voltage
UnS
U0
Frequency
FrS
UF5 v [V/F 5pts] (UF5): 5-segment V/F profile: As V/F 2 pts profile but also supports the avoidance of resonance
(saturation).
Voltage
UnS
U5
The profile is defined
by the values of
U4 parameters UnS,
FrS, U0 to U5 and
U3 F0 to F5.
U1
U2
U0
Frequency
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 FrS
FrS > F5 > F4 > F3 > F2 > F1
SYn v [Sync. mot.] (SYn): For synchronous permanent magnet motors with sinusoidal electromotive force (EMF)
only. This selection is prohibited with ATV61ppppY (500 to 690 V).
This selection makes the asynchronous motor parameters inaccessible, and the synchronous motor
parameters accessible.
v [U/F Quad.] (UFq): Variable torque. For pump and fan applications.
UFq
v [Energy Sav.] (nLd): Energy saving. For applications that do not require high dynamics. This type of control
nLd is recommended when replacing an ATV38.
1760649 12/2009 67
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
Adjustment of the [U/F Quad.] (UFq) ratio. The parameter can be accessed if [Motor control type]
T (Ctt) = [U/F Quad.] (UFq).
It defines the magnetizing current at zero frequency, as a % of the rated magnetizing current.
Magnetizing current
100%
PFL
Frequency
0
FrS
F1 M [F1] 0 to 1,000 Hz 0
V/F profile setting. The parameter can be accessed if [Motor control type] (Ctt) = [V/F 5pts] (UF5)
F2 M [F2] 0 to 1,000 Hz 0
V/F profile setting. The parameter can be accessed if [Motor control type] (Ctt) = [V/F 5pts] (UF5)
F3 M [F3] 0 to 1,000 Hz 0
V/F profile setting. The parameter can be accessed if [Motor control type] (Ctt) = [V/F 5pts] (UF5)
68 1760649 12/2009
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
F4 M [F4] 0 to 1,000 Hz 0
V/F profile setting. The parameter can be accessed if [Motor control type] (Ctt) = [V/F 5pts] (UF5)
F5 M [F5] 0 to 1,000 Hz 0
V/F profile setting. The parameter can be accessed if [Motor control type] (Ctt) = [V/F 5pts] (UF5)
The parameter can be accessed if [Motor control type] (Ctt) is not [Sync. mot.] (SYn).
nO v [No] (nO): Function inactive
YES v [Yes] (YES): Function active.
Used in applications in which the motor rated speed and frequency need to be exceeded in order to optimize
operation at constant power, or when the maximum voltage of the motor needs to be limited to a value below
the line voltage.
The voltage/frequency profile must then be adapted in accordance with the motor's capabilities to operate at
maximum voltage UCP and maximum frequency FCP.
Motor voltage
Max. voltage UCP
Frequency
Rated motor freq. Freq. Const Power FCP
1760649 12/2009 69
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
(1) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual and on the drive nameplate.
Code Name/Description
rSMS M [R1rS]
Cold state stator resistance (per winding), in read-only mode. This is the drive factory setting or the result
of the auto-tuning operation, if it has been performed.
Value in milliohms (mΩ) up to 75 kW (100 HP), in hundredths of milliohms (mΩ/100) above 75 kW (100 HP).
On the integrated display unit: 0 to 9,999 then 10.00 to 65.53 (10,000 to 65,536).
70 1760649 12/2009
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
The parameter can be accessed if [Motor control type] (Ctt) is not [V/F 2pts] (UF2), [V/F 5pts] (UF5)
The parameter can be accessed if [Motor control type] (Ctt) is not [V/F 2pts] (UF2), [V/F 5pts] (UF5), [U/F Quad.]
(UFq) or [Sync. mot.] (SYn).
Adjusts the slip compensation around the value set by the rated motor speed.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
1760649 12/2009 71
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
Code Name/Description
If auto-tuning is performed or if one of the motor parameters on which auto-tuning depends is modified ([Rated motor volt.] (UnS),
[Rated motor freq.] (FrS), [Rated mot. current] (nCr), [Rated motor speed] (nSP), [Rated motor power] (nPr)), parameters Xyw return to their
factory settings.
Code Name/Description
IdM M [Idr]
Magnetizing current in A, calculated by the drive, in read-only mode.
LFM M [Lfr]
Leakage inductance in mH, calculated by the drive, in read-only mode.
trM M [T2r]
Rotor time constant in mS, calculated by the drive, in read-only mode.
PPn M [Pr]
Number of pairs of poles, calculated by the drive, in read-only mode.
rSA M [R1w]
Cold state stator resistance (per winding), modifiable value. In milliohms (mΩ) up to 75 kW (100 HP),
in hundredths of milliohms (mΩ/100) above 75 kW (100 HP). On the integrated display unit: 0 to 9,999
then 10.00 to 65.53 (10,000 to 65,536).
IdA M [Idw]
Magnetizing current in A, modifiable value.
LFA M [Lfw]
Leakage inductance in mH, modifiable value.
trA M [T2w]
Rotor time constant in mS, modifiable value.
72 1760649 12/2009
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
To be configured in accordance with the type of card and encoder used (1).
nO v [----] (nO): Card missing.
AAbb v [AABB] (AAbb): For signals A, A-, B, B-.
Ab v [AB] (Ab): For signals A, B.
A v [A] (A): For signal A. Value cannot be accessed if [Encoder usage] (EnU) page 74 = [Spd fdk reg.] (rEG).
PGI M [Number of pulses] 100 to 5,000 1,024
(1) The encoder parameters can only be accessed if the encoder card has been inserted, and the available selections will depend
on the type of encoder card used. The encoder configuration can also be accessed in the [1.5- INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I/O) menu.
1760649 12/2009 73
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
3. Set [Encoder type] (EnS) and [Number of pulses] (PGI) accordingly for the encoder used.
6. Set the motor rotating at stabilized speed ≈ 15% of the rated speed for at least 3 seconds, and use the [1.2-MONITORING] (SUP-)
menu to monitor its behavior.
7. If it trips on an [Encoder fault] (EnF), [Encoder check] (EnC) returns to [No] (nO).
- Check [Number of pulses] (PGI) and [Encoder type] (EnS).
- Check that the mechanical and electrical operation of the encoder, its power supply and connections are all correct.
- Reverse the direction of rotation of the motor ([Output Ph rotation] (PHr) parameter page 66) or the encoder signals.
8. Repeat the operations from 5 onwards until [Encoder check] (EnC) changes to [Done] (dOnE).
The parameter can be accessed if an encoder card has been inserted (1).
nO v [No] (nO): Function inactive
SEC v [Fdbk monit.] (SEC): The encoder provides speed feedback for monitoring only.
rEG v [Spd fdk reg.] (rEG): The encoder provides speed feedback for regulation and monitoring. If [Motor control
type] (Ctt) = [SVC U] (UUC) the encoder operates in speed feedback mode and enables static correction of
the speed to be performed. This configuration is not accessible for other [Motor control type] (Ctt) values.
PGr v [Speed ref.] (PGr): The encoder provides a reference.
(1) The encoder parameters can only be accessed if the encoder card has been inserted, and the available selections will depend
on the type of encoder card used. The encoder configuration can also be accessed in the [1.5- INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I/O) menu.
74 1760649 12/2009
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
CAUTION
If [Sinus filter] (OFI) = [Yes] (YES), [Max frequency] (tFr) must not exceed 100 Hz and [Motor control
type] (Ctt) page 67 must not be:
• [Sync. mot.] (SYn), irrespective of the drive rating
• [SVC V] (UUC) or [Energy Sav.] (nLd) at and above 55 kW (75 HP) for ATV61HpppM3X and at and
above 90 kW (120 HP) for ATV61HpppN4
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
Adjustment range: It can vary between 1 and 16 kHz, but the minimum and maximum values, as well as
the factory setting, can be limited in accordance with the type of drive (ATV61H or W), the rating (power and
voltage) and the configuration of the [Sinus filter] (OFI) parameter above and [Motor surge limit.] (SUL)
parameter page 76.
CAUTION
On ATV61p075N4 to U40N4 drives, if the RFI filters are disconnected (operation on an IT system), the
switching frequency of the drive must not exceed 4 kHz.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
CLI M [Current Limitation] (1) 0 to 1.1 or 1.2 In (2) 1.1 or 1.2 In (2)
Note: If the setting is less than 0.25 In, the drive may lock in [Output Phase Loss] (OPF) fault mode if
this has been enabled (see page 194). If it is less than the no-load motor current, the limitation no longer
has any effect.
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current, particularly in the case of permanent magnet synchronous
motors, which are susceptible to demagnetization.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual and on the drive nameplate.
1760649 12/2009 75
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
nO v [No] (nO): Fixed frequency. Factory setting at and above ATV61HD55M3X, ATV61HD90N4 and
ATV61HC11Y.
YES v [Yes] (YES): Frequency with random modulation. Factory setting up to ATV61HD45M3X, ATV61HD75N4 and
ATV61HD90Y.
Random frequency modulation prevents any resonance, which may occur at a fixed frequency.
This function limits motor overvoltages and is useful in the following applications:
- NEMA motors
- Japanese motors
- Spindle motors
- Rewound motors
nO v [No] (nO): Function inactive
YES v [Yes] (YES): Function active
This parameter is forced to [No] (nO) if a sinus filter is used.
This parameter can remain = [No] (nO) for 230/400 V motors used at 230 V, or if the length of cable between
the drive and the motor does not exceed:
- 4 m with unshielded cables
- 10 m with shielded cables
10 (μs)
SOP M [Volt surge limit. opt]
Optimization parameter for transient overvoltages at the motor terminals. Accessible if [Motor surge limit.]
(SUL) = [Yes] (YES).
Set to 6, 8, or 10 (μs), according to the following table.
The value of the “SOP” parameter corresponds to the attenuation time of the cable used. It is defined to prevent the superimposition
of voltage wave reflections resulting from long cable lengths. It limits overvoltages to twice the DC bus rated voltage.
The tables on the following page give examples of correspondence between the “SOP” parameter and the length of the cable between
the drive and the motor. For longer cable lengths, a sinus filter or a dV/dt protection filter must be used.
• For motors in parallel, the sum of all the cable lengths must be taken into consideration. Compare the length given in the line
corresponding to the power for one motor with that corresponding to the total power, and select the shorter length. Example:
Two 7.5 kW (10 HP) motors – take the lengths on the 15 kW (20 HP) line, which are shorter than those on the 7.5 kW (10 HP) line,
and divide by the number of motors to obtain the length per motor (with unshielded “GORSE” cable and SOP = 6, the result is 40/2
= 20 m maximum for each 7.5 kW (10 HP) motor).
In special cases (for example, different types of cable, different motor powers in parallel, different cable lengths in parallel, etc.),
we recommend using an oscilloscope to check the overvoltage values obtained at the motor terminals.
To retain the overall drive performance, do not increase the SOP value unnecessarily.
76 1760649 12/2009
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
Tables giving the correspondence between the SOP parameter and the cable length,
for 400 V line supply
Note: For 230/400 V used at 230 V, the [Motor surge limit.] (SUL) parameter can remain = [No] (nO).
1760649 12/2009 77
[1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-)
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
78 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ENT
ESC
ESC
CtL-
ESC
LAC-
1760649 12/2009 79
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
The parameters in the [1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-) menu can only be modified when the drive is stopped and no run command
is present.
2C v [2 wire] (2C)
3C v [3 wire] (3C)
2-wire control: This is the input state (0 or 1) or edge (0 to 1 or 1 to 0), which controls running or stopping.
3-wire control (pulse control): A “forward” or “reverse” pulse is sufficient to command starting, a “stop” pulse is
sufficient to command stopping.
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
To change the assignment of [2/3 wire control] (tCC) press the “ENT” key for 2 s.
It causes the following functions to return to factory setting: [2 wire type] (tCt) and [Reverse assign.]
(rrS) below, and all functions which assign logic inputs and analog inputs.
The macro configuration selected will also be reset if it has been customized (loss of custom settings).
It is advisable to configure this parameter before configuring the [1.6 COMMAND] (CtL-) and
[1.7 APPLICATION FUNCT.] (FUn-) menus.
Check that this change is compatible with the wiring diagram used.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.
LEL v [Level] (LEL): State 0 or 1 is taken into account for run (1) or stop (0).
trn v [Transition] (trn): A change of state (transition or edge) is necessary to initiate operation, in order to prevent
accidental restarts after a break in the power supply.
PFO v [Fwd priority] (PFO): State 0 or 1 is taken into account for run or stop, but the “forward” input always takes
priority over the “reverse” input.
80 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
This parameter is used to take account of the change of the logic input to state 1 with a delay that can
be adjusted between 0 and 200 milliseconds, in order to filter out possible interference. The change to
state 0 is taken into account without delay.
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Check that the delay set does not pose a risk or lead to undesired operation.
The relative order in which these inputs are taken into account may be modified according to the delay
values of the various logic inputs, and thus lead to unintended operation.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.
1760649 12/2009 81
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Reference
Reference
100% 100%
Current or Current or
voltage or voltage or
frequency frequency
input input
0% 0%
[Min value] [Max value] 20 mA or [Max value] [Min value] 20 mA or
(CrLx or (CrHx or 10 V or (CrHx or (CrLx or 10 V or
ULx or PIL) UHx or PFr) 30.00 kHz UHx or PFr) ULx or PIL) 30.00 kHz
For +/- bidirectional inputs, the min. and max. are relative to the absolute value, for example, +/- 2 to 8 V.
Reference
100%
Frequency
input
-30.00 [RP min 0% [RP max value] 30.00
kHz value] (PIL) (PFr) kHz
Reference Reference
100% 100%
Current Current
or or
voltage voltage
[Min value]
0% input 0% input
[Min value] [Max value] 20 mA [Max value] 20 mA
Range 0 V 100% or 10 V or 10 V
-100%
Range -100% V +100%
82 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
HSP
LSP
-100%
reference
0% +100%
LSP
HSP
LSP
-100%
reference
LSP +100%
HSP
-100% LSP
reference
0
LSP +100%
HSP
This parameter defines how the speed reference is taken into account, for analog inputs and Pulse
input only. In the case of the PID regulator, this is the PID output reference.
The limits are set by the [Low speed] (LSP) and [High speed] (HSP) parameters, page 37
1760649 12/2009 83
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
reference
100%
current
[Interm. point Y] or
voltage
0% input
[Min value] [Interm. [Max value] 20 mA
(0%) point X] (100%) or 10 V
Note: For [Interm. point X], 0% corresponds to [Min value] and 100% to [Max value]
reference
100%
- 100%
84 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
10U v [Voltage] (10U): Positive voltage input (negative values are considered as zero: the input is
unidirectional).
n10U v [Voltage +/-] (n10U): Positive and negative voltage input (the input is bidirectional).
UIL1 M [AI1 min value] 0 to 10.0 V 0V
Interference filtering.
1760649 12/2009 85
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Interference filtering.
86 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Interference filtering.
1760649 12/2009 87
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Interference filtering.
88 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Virtual input.
This parameter can also be accessed in the [PID REGULATOR] (PId-) submenu, page 151.
nO [Non] (nO): Not assigned (in this case, the virtual input does not appear in the analog input assignment
parameters for the functions)
Mdb v [Modbus] (Mdb): Integrated Modbus
CAn v [CANopen] (CAn): Integrated CANopen
nEt v [Com. card] (nEt): Communication card (if inserted)
APP v [C.Insid. card] (APP): Controller Inside card (if inserted)
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
If the equipment switches to forced local mode (see page 216), the virtual input remains frozen at the
last value transmitted.
Do not use the virtual input and forced local mode in the same configuration.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in death or serious injury.
1760649 12/2009 89
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Interference filtering.
90 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Reference
Reference
100% 100%
Frequency Frequency
input input
0 0
[Freq. min. [Freq. max. 300 kHz [Freq. max. [Freq. min. 300 kHz
value] value] value] value]
(EIL) (EFr) (EFr) (EIL)
Reference
100%
Frequency
[Freq. min. 0 [Freq. max. 300 kHz input
value] value]
(EIL) (EFr)
A reference can be obtained at zero frequency by assigning a negative value to the minimum value.
1760649 12/2009 91
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
The encoder configuration can also be accessed in the [1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-) menu.
92 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
The parameter can be accessed if [Encoder usage] (EnU) = [Speed ref.] (PGr).
EnC v [Encoder] (EnC): Use of an encoder.
PtG v [Freq. gen.] (PtG): Use of a frequency generator (unsigned reference).
EIL M [Freq. min. value] - 300 to 300 kHz 0
The parameter can be accessed if [Encoder usage] (EnU) = [Speed ref.] (PGr) and if [Reference type]
(PGA) = [Freq. gen.] (PtG).
Frequency corresponding to the minimum speed
The parameter can be accessed if [Encoder usage] (EnU) = [Speed ref.] (PGr) and if [Reference type]
(PGA) = [Freq. gen.] (PtG).
Frequency corresponding to the maximum speed
The parameter can be accessed if [Encoder usage] (EnU) = [Speed ref.] (PGr).
Interference filtering.
1760649 12/2009 93
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
94 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
1760649 12/2009 95
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes true.
The delay cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt) assignment, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes false.
The holding time cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt) assignment, and remains at 0.
Identical to R1 (see page 94) with the addition of (shown for information only as these selections can only
be configured in the [APPLICATION FUNCT.] (Fun-)) menu:
LLC v [Input cont.] (LLC): Line contactor control
OCC v [Output cont] (OCC): Output contactor control
dCO v [DC charging] (dCO): DC bus precharging contactor control
dAM v [Damper] (dAM): Damper control
r2d M [R2 Delay time] 0 to 60000 ms (1) 0
The delay cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [Output cont] (OCC), [DC charging] (dCO),
and [Input cont.] (LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes true.
The holding time cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [DC charging] (dCO) and [Input cont.] (LLC)
assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes false.
96 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Identical to R2
The delay cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [Output cont] (OCC), [DC charging] (dCO),
and [Input cont.] (LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes true.
The holding time cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [DC charging] (dCO) and [Input cont.] (LLC)
assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes false.
The delay cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [Output cont] (OCC), [DC charging] (dCO),
and [Input cont.] (LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes true.
The holding time cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [DC charging] (dCO) and [Input cont.]
(LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes false.
1760649 12/2009 97
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Identical to R1 (see page 94) with the addition of (shown for information only as these selections can only
be configured in the [APPLICATION FUNCT.] (Fun-)) menu:
LLC v [Input cont.] (LLC): Line contactor control
OCC v [Output cont] (OCC): Output contactor control
dCO v [[DC charging] (dCO): DC bus precharging contactor control
dAM v [Damper] (dAM): Damper control
LO1d M [LO1 delay time] 0 to 60000 ms (1) 0
The delay cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [Output cont] (OCC), [DC charging] (dCO),
and [Input cont.] (LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes true.
The holding time cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [DC charging] (dCO) and [Input cont.]
(LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes false.
Identical to LO1.
The delay cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [Output cont] (OCC), [DC charging] (dCO),
and [Input cont.] (LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes true.
The holding time cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [DC charging] (dCO) and [Input cont.] (LLC)
assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes false.
98 1760649 12/2009
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
The delay cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [Output cont] (OCC), [DC charging] (dCO),
and [Input cont.] (LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes true.
The holding time cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [DC charging] (dCO) and [Input cont.] (LLC)
assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes false.
The delay cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [Output cont] (OCC), [DC charging] (dCO),
and [Input cont.] (LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes true.
The holding time cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [DC charging] (dCO) and [Input cont.] (LLC)
assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information
becomes false.
1760649 12/2009 99
[1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-)
Identical to R1 (see page 94) with the addition of (shown for information only as these selections can only
be configured in the [1.7 APPLICATION FUNCT.] (Fun-) menu):
LLC v [Input cont.] (LLC): Line contactor control
OCC v [Output cont] (OCC): Output contactor control
dCO v [DC charging] (dCO): DC bus precharging contactor control
dAM v [Damper] (dAM): Damper control
dO1d M [DO1 delay time] 0 to 60000 ms (1) 0
The delay cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [Output cont] (OCC), [DC charging] (dCO), and [Input
cont.] (LLC) assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information becomes
true.
The holding time cannot be set for the [No drive flt] (FLt), [DC charging] (dCO) and [Input cont.] (LLC)
assignments, and remains at 0.
The change in state only takes effect once the configured time has elapsed, when the information becomes
false.
Parameter assigned
Parameter assigned
Outputs AO2 and AO3 configured as bipolar outputs (strongly recommended for signed parameters):
The [min Output] (UOLx) and [max Output] (UOHx) parameters are absolute values, although they function symmetrically. In the case of
bipolar outputs, always set the maximum value higher than the minimum value.
The [max Output] (UOHx) corresponds to the upper limit of the assigned parameter, and the [min Output] (UOLx) corresponds to an average
value between the upper and lower limits (0 for a signed and symmetrical parameter such as in the example below).
Assigned
parameter
Upper limit
- 10 V
Voltage
[Min Output] [Max Output] + 10 V output
(UOLx) (UOHx)
Lower limit
• The parameter [Scaling AOx min] (ASLx) modifies the lower limit: new value = lower limit + (range x ASLx). The value 0% (factory
setting) does not modify the lower limit.
• The [Scaling AOx max] (ASHx) parameter modifies the upper limit: new value = lower limit + (range x ASHx). The value 100% (factory
setting) does not modify the upper limit.
• [Scaling AOx min] (ASLx) must always be lower than [Scaling AOx max] (ASHx).
100%
New scale
ASHx
ASLx
Application example 1
The value of the signed motor torque at the AO2 output is to be transferred with +/- 10 V, with a range of -2 Tr to +2 Tr
The parameter [Sign. torque.] (Stq) varies between -3 and +3 times the rated torque, or a range of 6 times the rated torque.
[Scaling AO2 min] (ASL2) must modify the lower limit by 1x the rated torque, or 100/6 = 16.7% (new value = lower limit + (range x ASL2).
[Scaling AO2 max] (ASH2) must modify the upper limit by 1x the rated torque, or 100 - 100/6 = 83.3% (new value = lower limit + (range x
ASH2).
Application example 2
The value of the motor current at the AO2 output is to be transferred with 0 - 20 mA, with a range of 2 In motor, In motor being the equivalent
of a 0.8 In drive.
The parameter [I motor] (OCr) varies between 0 and 2 times the rated drive current, or a range of 2.5 times the rated drive current.
[Scaling AO2 min] (ASL2) must not modify the lower limit, which therefore remains at its factory setting of 0%.
[Scaling AO2 max] (ASH2) must modify the upper limit by 0.5x the rated motor torque, or 100 - 100/5 = 80% (new value = lower limit +
(range x ASH2).
Scaling of the lower limit of the assigned parameter, as a % of the maximum possible variation.
Scaling of the upper limit of the assigned parameter, as a % of the maximum possible variation.
Interference filtering. This parameter is forced to 0 if [AO1 assignment] (AO1) = [dO1] (dO1).
The parameter can be accessed if [AO2 Type] (AO2t) = [Voltage] (10U) or [Voltage +/-] (n10U)
The parameter can be accessed if [AO2 Type] (AO2t) = [Voltage] (10U) or [Voltage +/-] (n10U)
Scaling of the lower limit of the assigned parameter, as a % of the maximum possible variation.
Scaling of the upper limit of the assigned parameter, as a % of the maximum possible variation.
Interference filtering.
The parameter can be accessed if [AO3 Type] (AO3t) = [Voltage] (10U) or [Voltage +/-] (n10U)
The parameter can be accessed if [AO3 Type] (AO3t) = [Voltage] (10U) or [Voltage +/-] (n10U)
Scaling of the lower limit of the assigned parameter, as a % of the maximum possible variation.
Scaling of the upper limit of the assigned parameter, as a % of the maximum possible variation.
Interference filtering.
The following submenus group the alarms into 1 to 3 groups, each of which can be assigned to a relay or a logic output for remote signaling.
These groups can also be displayed on the graphic display terminal (see [6 MONITORING CONFIG.] menu) and viewed via the
[1.2 MONITORING] (SUP) menu.
When one or a number of alarms selected in a group occurs, this alarm group is activated.
A1C-
b [ALARM GRP1 DEFINITION]
Selection to be made from the following list:
PLA v [LI6=PTC al.] (PLA): LI6 = PTC probe alarms
P1A v [PTC1 alarm] (P1A): Probe alarm 1
P2A v [PTC2 alarm] (P2A): Probe alarm 2
EFA v [Ext. fault al] (EFA): External fault alarm
USA v [Under V. al.] (USA): Undervoltage alarm
CtA v [I attained] (CtA): The current is greater than [Current threshold] (Ctd) page 59.
CtAL v [Low I Thres. Attain.] (CtAL): The current is less than [Low I Threshold] (CtdL) page 59.
FtA v [Freq. Th. attain.] (FtA): The frequency is greater than [Freq. threshold] (Ftd) page 59.
FtAL v [Low Frq. Th. Attain.] (FtAL): The frequency is less than [Low Freq.Threshold] (FtdL) page 59.
F2A v [Freq. Th. 2 attain.] (F2A): The frequency is greater than [Freq. threshold 2] (F2d) page 59.
F2AL v [Fq. Low Th. 2 attain] (F2AL): The frequency is less than [2 Freq. Threshold] (F2dL) page 59.
SrA v [Freq.ref.att] (SrA): Frequency reference reached
tSA v [Th.mot. att.] (tSA): Motor 1 thermal state reached
tS2 v [Th.mot2 att.] (tS2): Motor 2 thermal state reached
tS3 v [Th.mot3 att] (tS3): Motor 3 thermal state reached
UPA v [Uvolt warn] (UPA): Undervoltage warning
FLA v [HSP attain.] (FLA): High speed reached
tHA v [Al. °C drv] (tHA): Drive overheating
PEE v [PID error al] (PEE): PID error alarm
PFA v [PID fdbk al.] (PFA): PID feedback alarm (greater than [Max fbk alarm] (PAH) page 152 or less than
[Min fbk alarm] (PAL) page 152)
PFAH v [PID high Alarm] (PFAH): PID feedback alarm (greater than [Max fbk alarm] (PAH) page 152).
PFAL v [PID low Alarm] (PFAL): PID feedback alarm (less than [Min fbk alarm] (PAL) page 152).
PISH v [Regulation Alarm] (PISH): PID regulator feedback supervision fault page 155.
AP2 v [AI2 Al. 4-20] (AP2): Alarm indicating absence of 4-20 mA signal on input AI2
AP3 v [AI3 Al. 4-20] (AP3): Alarm indicating absence of 4-20 mA signal on input AI3
AP4 v [AI4 Al. 4-20] (AP4): Alarm indicating absence of 4-20 mA signal on input AI4
SSA v [Lim T/I att.] (SSA): Torque limit alarm
tAd v [Th.drv.att.] (tAd): Drive thermal state reached
tJA v [IGBT alarm] (tJA): IGBT alarm
bOA v [Brake R. al.] (bOA): Braking resistor temperature alarm
APA v [Option alarm] (APA): Alarm generated by an option card.
UrA v [Regen. underV. al.] (UrA): Reserved.
rtAH v [High Reference Att.] (rtAH): The frequency reference is greater than [High Freq. Ref. Thr.] (rtd)
page 60.
rtAL v [Low Reference Att.] (rtAL): The frequency reference is less than [Low Freq. Ref. Thr.] (rtdL) page 60.
ULA v [Underload. Proc. Al.] (ULA): Process underload (see page 208)
OLA v [Overload. Proc. Al.] (OLA): Process overload (see page 210)
FSA v [Flow Limit. active] (FSA): Flow rate limiting active (see page 182)
Ern v [Emerg. Run] (Ern): Emergency run in progress (see page 201)
ttHA v [High torque alarm] (ttHA): Motor torque greater than high threshold [High torque thd.] (ttH) page 59
ttLA v [Low torque alarm] (ttLA): Motor torque less than low threshold [Low torque thd.] (ttL) page 59
FqLA v [Freq. meter Alarm] (FqLA): Measured speed threshold attained: [Pulse warning thd.] (FqL) page 59
See the multiple selection procedure on page 25 for the integrated display terminal, and page 16 for the graphic
display terminal.
A2C-
b [ALARM GRP2 DEFINITION]
Identical to [ALARM GRP1 DEFINITION] (A1C-)
A3C-
b [ALARM GRP3 DEFINITION]
Identical to [ALARM GRP1 DEFINITION] (A1C-)
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ESC
I-O-
ENT
ESC
CtL- COMMAND
ESC
ESC
FUn-
ESC
LAC-
The parameters in the [1.6 COMMAND] (CtL) menu can only be modified when the drive is stopped and no run command is present.
Command Reference
• Terminals: Logic inputs LI • Terminals: Analog inputs AI, frequency input, encoder
• Graphic display terminal • Graphic display terminal
• Integrated Modbus • Integrated Modbus
• Integrated CANopen • Integrated CANopen
• Communication card • Communication card
• Controller Inside card • Controller Inside card
• +/- speed via the terminals
• +/- speed via the graphic display terminal
• [I/O profile] (IO): Command and reference may be sent via different channels. This configuration both simplifies and extends use via
the communication interface.
Commands may be sent via the logic inputs on the terminals or via the communication bus.
When commands are sent via a bus, they are available on a word, which acts as virtual terminals containing only logic inputs.
Application functions can be assigned to the bits in this word. More than one function can be assigned to the same bit.
Note: Stop commands from the terminals remain active even if the terminals are not the active command channel.
Reference channel for [Not separ.] (SIM), [Separate] (SEP) and [I/O profile] (IO)
configurations, PID not configured
[Ref 1B switching]
279/
[Ref.1 H/>
0V nO
channel]
2H$ AI1
Note: Forced local is not
(FRA + SA2 + SA3 - dA2 - dA3) x MA2 x MA3
279
Key: Forced local
H2/
[Ref. 2
switching]
Parameter:
The black square represents
the factory setting assignment
References
Fr1, SA2, SA3, dA2, dA3, MA2, MA3:
• Terminals, graphic display terminal, integrated Modbus, integrated CANopen, communication card, Controller Inside card
Fr2:
• Terminals, graphic display terminal, integrated Modbus, integrated CANopen, communication card, Controller Inside card,
and +/-speed
Note: [Ref.1B channel] (Fr1b) and [Ref 1B switching] (rCb) must be configured in the [APPLICATION FUNCT.] (Fun-) menu.
Reference channel for [Not separ.] (SIM), [Separate] (SEP) and [I/O profile] (IO)
configurations, PID configured with PID references at the terminals
[Ref 1B switching]
279/
H/>
[Ref.1
channel] 0V nO
2H$ AI1 Note: Forced local is not
2H$> FRA AI2 active in [I/O profile].
FRA + SA2 + SA3 - dA2 - dA3
[High
LI Ramps (1)
speed]
HSP ACC DEC
Channel 1 FrH rFr
nO
[Ref.2 channel]
LSP AC2 DE2
2H%
Channel 2 [Low speed]
279
Key: H2/ Forced local
[Ref. 2 switching]
Parameter:
The black square represents the factory
setting assignment
References
Fr1:
• Terminals, graphic display terminal, integrated Modbus, integrated CANopen, communication card, Controller Inside card
Fr2:
• Terminals, graphic display terminal, integrated Modbus, integrated CANopen, communication card, Controller Inside card,
and +/- speed
(1) Ramps not active if the PID function is active in automatic mode.
Note: [Ref.1B channel] (Fr1b) and [Ref 1B switching] (rCb) must be configured in the [APPLICATION FUNCT.] (Fun-) menu.
279/
LI nO
AI1
AI2
LI
[Profile]
/4/2 279 Forced local
[Ref. 2 switching] H2/
nO
SIM
CMD Forward
Reverse
nO STOP
Key:
Parameter:
The black square represents
the factory setting assignment.
279/
LI nO
AI1
AI2
AI3
[Cmd channel 1]
AI4
/@$
LCC
(RUN/STOP
FWD/REV)
Graphic
display
terminal
LI
[Profile]
[Cmd switching] //; 279 Forced local
/4/2
SEP
nO
Forward
CMD
Reverse
STOP
nO
Graphic STOP YES
display
terminal
:;I
/@% (Stop Key
priority)
[Cmd channel 2]
Key:
Parameter:
The black rectangle represents the factory
setting assignment, except for [Profile].
Commands
Cd1, Cd2:
• Terminals, graphic display terminal, integrated Modbus, integrated CANopen, communication card, Controller Inside card
The command channels Cd1 and Cd2 are independent of the reference channels Fr1, Fr1b and Fr2.
[Cmd channel 1]
/@$
LI
[Profile]
[Cmd switching] //; 279 Forced local
/4/2
I/O
nO
Forward
CMD
Reverse
STOP
nO
Graphic STOP YES
display
terminal
:;I
/@% (Stop Key
priority)
[Cmd channel 2]
Key:
Parameter:
The black rectangle represents the factory
setting assignment, except for [Profile].
Commands
Cd1, Cd2:
• Terminals, graphic display terminal, integrated Modbus, integrated CANopen, communication card, Controller Inside card
If the active channel is the graphic display terminal, the functions and commands assigned to CDxx switchable internal bits are inactive.
Note:
• CD14 and CD15 can only be used for switching between 2 networks. They do not have equivalent logic inputs.
(1) If [2/3 wire control] (tCC) page 80 = [3 wire] (3C), LI2, C101, C201, C301, and C401 cannot be accessed.
[LI1] (LI1)
to Drive with or without option
[LI6] (LI6)
[LI7] (LI7)
to With VW3A3201 logic I/O card
[LI10] (LI10)
[LI11] (LI11)
to With VW3A3202 extended I/O card
[LI14] (LI14)
[C101] (C101)
to With integrated Modbus in [I/O profile] (IO) configuration
[C110] (C110)
[C111] (C111)
to With integrated Modbus regardless of configuration
[C115] (C115)
[C201] (C201)
to With integrated CANopen in [I/O profile] (IO) configuration
[C210] (C210)
[C211] (C211)
to With integrated CANopen regardless of configuration
[C215] (C215)
[C301] (C301)
to With a communication card in [I/O profile] (IO) configuration
[C310] (C310)
[C311] (C311)
to With a communication card regardless of configuration
[C315] (C315)
[C401] (C401)
to With Controller Inside card in [I/O profile] (IO) configuration
[C410] (C410)
[C411] (C411)
to With Controller Inside card regardless of configuration
[C415] (C415)
[CD00] (Cd00)
to In [I/O profile] (IO) configuration
[CD10] (Cd10)
[CD11] (Cd11)
to Regardless of configuration
[CD15] (Cd15)
Note: In [I/O profile] (IO) configuration, LI1 cannot be accessed and if [2/3 wire control] (tCC) page 80 = [3 wire] (3C), LI2, C101,
C201, C301, and C401 cannot be accessed either.
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Inactive communication channels are not monitored (no lock following malfunction in the event of a communication bus
failure). Make sure that the commands and functions assigned to bits C101 to C415 will not pose a risk in the event of the
failure of the associated communication bus.
nO v [No] (nO)
YES v [Yes] (YES)
Inhibition of movement in reverse direction, does not apply to direction requests sent by logic inputs.
- Reverse direction requests sent by logic inputs are taken into account.
- Reverse direction requests sent by the graphic display terminal are not taken into account.
- Reverse direction requests sent by the line are not taken into account.
- Any reverse speed reference originating from the PID, summing input, etc., is interpreted as a zero
reference (0 Hz).
nO v [No] (nO)
YES v [Yes] (YES): Gives priority to the STOP key on the graphic display terminal when the graphic display
terminal is not enabled as the command channel.
Press and hold down ENT for 2 seconds in order for any change in the assignment of [Stop Key priority]
(PSt) to be taken into account.
This will be a freewheel stop. If the active command channel is the graphic display terminal, the stop
will be performed according to the [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133 irrespective of the configuration of
[Stop Key priority] (PSt).
SE8 v [8 serie] (SE8): ATV38 interchangeability (see Migration Manual). The [8 serie] (SE8) configuration is used
to load, via PowerSuite, for example, an ATV38 drive configuration in an ATV61 that has already been set to
this configuration. This assignment cannot be accessed if a Controller Inside card has been inserted.
Note: Modifications to the configuration of the ATV61 must only be made using PowerSuite when
it is in this configuration, otherwise operation cannot be guaranteed.
The parameter can be accessed if [Profile] (CHCF) = [Separate] (SEP) or [I/O profile] (IO)
Cd1 v [ch1 active] (Cd1): [Cmd channel 1] (Cd1) active (no switching)
Cd2 v [ch2 active] (Cd2): [Cmd channel 2] (Cd2) active (no switching)
LI1 v [LI1] (LI1)
- :
- :
- v [...] (...): See the assignment conditions on page 116 (not CDOO to CD14).
If the assigned input or bit is at 0, channel [Cmd channel 1] (Cd1) is active.
If the assigned input or bit is at 1, channel [Cmd channel 2] (Cd2) is active.
nO v [No] (nO): Not assigned If [Profile] (CHCF) = [Not separ.] (SIM), command is at the terminals with
a zero reference. If [Profile] (CHCF) = [Separate] (SEP) or [I/O profile] (IO), the reference is zero.
AI1 v [AI1] (AI1): Analog input
AI2 v [AI2] (AI2): Analog input
AI3 v [AI3] (AI3): Analog input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
AI4 v [AI4] (AI4): Analog input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
UPdt v [+/- Speed] (UPdt): +/-Speed command
LCC v [HMI] (LCC): Graphic display terminal
Mdb v [Modbus] (Mdb): Integrated Modbus
CAn v [CANopen] (CAn): Integrated CANopen
nEt v [Com. card] (nEt): Communication card (if inserted)
APP v [Prog. card] (APP): Controller Inside card (if inserted)
PI v [RP] (PI): Frequency input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
PG v [Encoder] (PG): Encoder input, if encoder card has been inserted
Can be used to copy the current reference and/or the command by means of switching, in order to avoid
speed surges, for example.
If [Profile] (CHCF) page 117 = [Not separ.] (SIM) or [Separate] (SEP), copying will only be possible from
channel 1 to channel 2.
If [Profile] (CHCF) = [I/O profile] (IO), copying will be possible in both directions.
nO v [No] (nO): No copy
SP v [Reference] (SP): Copy reference
Cd v [Command] (Cd): Copy command
ALL v [Cmd + ref.] (ALL): Copy command and reference
- A reference or a command cannot be copied to a channel on the terminals.
- The reference copied is FrH (before ramp) unless the destination channel reference is set via +/- speed.
In this case, the reference copied is rFr (after ramp).
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Copying the command and/or reference can change the direction of rotation.
Check that this is safe.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.
As the graphic display terminal may be selected as the command and/or reference channel, its action modes can be configured.
The parameters on this page can only be accessed on the graphic display terminal, and not on the integrated display terminal.
Notes:
• The display terminal command/reference is only active if the command and/or reference channels from the terminal are active,
with the exception of [T/K] (command and reference via the display terminal), which takes priority over these channels. Press [T/K]
again or turn off the drive to revert control to the selected channel.
•Note: The channel selected by pressing [T/K] remains active after a return to factory settings, until [T/K] is pressed again or
the drive is turned off.
• Command and reference via the display terminal are impossible if the latter is connected to more than one drive.
• The JOG, preset speed and +/- speed functions can only be accessed if [Profile] (CHCF) = [Not separ.] (SIM).
• The preset PID reference functions can only be accessed if [Profile] (CHCF) = [Not separ.] (SIM) or [Separate] (SEP).
• The [T/K] function (command and reference via the display terminal) can be accessed regardless of the [Profile] (CHCF).
When the [T/K] function is assigned to a key and that function is active, this parameter defines the behavior at the moment when
control returns to the graphic display terminal.
v [Stop]: Stops the drive (although the controlled direction of operation and reference of the previous channel are copied (to be taken
into account on the next RUN command)).
v [Bumpless]: Does not stop the drive (the controlled direction of operation and the reference of the previous channel are copied).
ESC
CLI- [2nd CURRENT LIMIT.] 166
LAC- LLC- [LINE CONTACTOR COMMAND] 168
OCC- [OUTPUT CONTACTOR CMD] 170
dAM- [DAMPER MANAGEMENT] 172
MLP- [PARAM. SET SWITCHING] 174
MMC- [MULTIMOTORS/CONFIG.] 179
tnL- [AUTO TUNING BY LI] 179
nFS- [NO FLOW DETECTION] 181
FLL- [FLOW LIMITATION] 183
dCO- [DC BUS SUPPLY] 184
OIr- [REGEN CONNECTION] 185
The parameters in the [1.7 APPLICATION FUNCT.] (FUn-) menu can only be modified when the drive is stopped and there is no run
command, except for parameters with a T symbol in the code column, which can be modified with the drive running or stopped.
Each of the functions on the following pages can be assigned to one of the inputs or outputs.
A single input can activate several functions at the same time (reverse and 2nd ramp, for example). The user must therefore ensure
that these functions can be used at the same time. It is only possible to assign one input to several functions at [Advanced] (AdU) and
[Expert] (EPr) level.
Before assigning a command, reference or function to an input or output, the user must make sure that this input or output has
not already been assigned and that another input or output has not been assigned to an incompatible or undesirable function.
The drive factory setting or macro configurations automatically configure functions, which may prevent other functions being assigned.
It may be necessary to unconfigure one or more functions in order to be able to enable another. Check the compatibility table below.
Compatibility table
(1) Priority is given to the first of these two stop modes to be activated.
(2) Excluding special application with reference channel Fr2 (see diagrams on pages 110 and 111).
(3) Only the multiplier reference is incompatible with the PID regulator.
The function marked with the arrow takes priority over the other.
Note: This compatibility table does not affect commands that can be assigned to the keys of the graphic display terminal
(see page 120).
Incompatible functions
The following functions will be inaccessible or deactivated in the cases described below:
Automatic restart
This is only possible for control type [2/3 wire control] (tCC) = [2 wire] (2C) and [2 wire type] (tCt) = [Level] (LEL) or [Fwd priority] (PFO).
See page 80.
The SUP- monitoring menu (page 38) can be used to display the functions assigned to each input in order to check their compatibility.
When a function is assigned, a appears on the graphic display terminal, as illustrated in the example below:
If you attempt to assign a function that is incompatible with another function that has
already been assigned, an alarm message will appear:
With the graphic display terminal
When you assign a logic input, an analog input, a reference channel or a bit to
a function, pressing the HELP button will display the functions that may already
have been activated by this input, bit or channel.
When a logic input, an analog input, a reference channel or a bit that has already
been assigned is assigned to another function, the following screens appear:
With the graphic display terminal
ENT->Continue ESC->Cancel
If the access level permits this new assignment, pressing ENT confirms the assignment.
If the access level does not permit this new assignment, pressing ENT results in the following display.
The code for the first function, which is already assigned, is displayed flashing.
If the access level permits this new assignment, pressing ENT confirms the assignment.
If the access level does not permit this new assignment, pressing ENT has no effect, and the message continues to flash. It is only possible
to exit by pressing ESC.
SA2
SA3
dA2 A
dA3
MA2
MA3
• If SA2, SA3, dA2, dA3 are not assigned, they are set to 0.
• If MA2, MA3 are not assigned, they are set to 1.
• A is limited by the minimum LSP and maximum HSP parameters.
• For multiplication, the signal on MA2 or MA3 is interpreted as a %; 100% corresponds to the maximum value of the corresponding
input. If MA2 or MA3 is sent via the communication bus or graphic display terminal, an MFr multiplication variable
(see page 44) must be sent via the bus or graphic display terminal.
• Reversal of the direction of operation in the event of a negative result can be inhibited (see page 117).
[Ref 1B switching] (rCb) is forced to [ch1 active] (Fr1) if [Profile] (CHCF) = [Not separ.] (SIM) with
[Ref.1 channel] (Fr1) assigned via the terminals (analog inputs, encoder, pulse input); see page 117.
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
If the equipment switches to forced local mode (see page 216), the virtual input remains frozen at the
last value transmitted.
Do not use the virtual input and forced local mode in the same configuration.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in death or serious injury.
Selection of a reference to be subtracted from [Ref.1 channel] (Fr1) or [Ref.1B channel] (Fr1b).
• Possible assignments are identical to [Summing ref. 2] (SA2) above.
Selection of a reference to be subtracted from [Ref.1 channel] (Fr1) or [Ref.1B channel] (Fr1b).
• Possible assignments are identical to [Summing ref. 2] (SA2) above.
rPt- b [RAMP]
rPt M [Ramp type] [Linear] (LIn)
U ramps
f (Hz) f (Hz)
FrS FrS
Customized ramps
f (Hz) f (Hz) tA1: adjustable from 0 to 100%
FrS FrS
tA2: adjustable from 0 to (100% – tA1)
tA3: adjustable from 0 to 100%
tA4: adjustable from 0 to (100% – tA3)
0 0
t t
tA1 tA2 tA3 tA4
As a % of t1, where t1 = set ramp time
t1 t1
T
0.01 v [0.01]: Ramp up to 99.99 seconds
0.1 v [0.1]: Ramp up to 999.9 seconds
1 v [1]: Ramp up to 9,000 seconds
This parameter is valid for [Acceleration] (ACC), [Deceleration] (dEC), [Acceleration 2] (AC2) and
[Deceleration 2] (dE2).
T Time to accelerate from 0 to the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS) (page 64). Make sure that this value is compatible
with the inertia being driven.
T Time to decelerate from the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS) (page 64) to 0. Make sure that this value is compatible
with the inertia being driven.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) Range 0.01 to 99.99 s or 0.1 to 999.9 s or 1 to 9,000 s according to [Ramp increment] (Inr).
b [RAMP] (continued)
tA1 M [Begin Acc round] (1) 0 to 100% 10%
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
b [RAMP] (continued)
Frt M [Ramp 2 threshold] 0 to 500 or 1,000 Hz
according to rating
0 Hz
T Time to accelerate from 0 to the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS). Make sure that this value is compatible with the
inertia being driven.
The parameter can be accessed if [Ramp 2 threshold] (Frt) > 0 or if [Ramp switch ass.] (rPS) is assigned.
T Time to decelerate from [Rated motor freq.] (FrS) to 0. Make sure that this value is compatible with the
inertia being driven.
The parameter can be accessed if [Ramp 2 threshold] (Frt) > 0 or if [Ramp switch ass.] (rPS) is assigned.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) Range 0.01 to 99.99 s or 0.1 to 999.9 s or 1 to 9,000 s according to [Ramp increment] (Inr) page 129.
Activating this function automatically adapts the deceleration ramp, if this has been set at too low a
value for the inertia of the load, which can cause an overvoltage fault.
nO v [No] (nO): Function inactive
YES v [Yes] (YES): Function active, for applications that do not require strong deceleration.
The following selections appear depending on the rating of the drive and [Motor control type] (Ctt) page
67. They enable stronger deceleration to be obtained than with [Yes] (YES). Use comparative testing
to determine your selection.
When [Dec ramp adapt.] (brA) is configured on [High torq. x] (dYnx), the dynamic performances for
braking are improved by the addition of a current flow component. The aim is to increase the iron loss
and magnetic energy stored in the motor.
dYnA v [High torq. A] (dYnA): Addition of a constant current flow component.
dYnb v [High torq. B] (dYnb): Addition of a current flow component oscillating at 100 Hz.
dYnC v [High torq. C] (dYnC): Addition of a current flow component oscillating at 200 Hz but with a greater
amplitude.
[Dec ramp adapt.] (brA) is forced to [No] (nO) if [Braking balance] (bbA) page 78 = [Yes] (YES).
The function is incompatible with applications requiring:
- Positioning on a ramp
- The use of a braking resistor (the resistor would not operate correctly).
CAUTION
Do not use [High torq. A] (dYnA), [High torq. B] (dYnB) or [High torq. C] (dYnC) configurations if the
motor is a permanent magnet synchronous motor, as it will be demagnetized.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
T This parameter supports switching from a ramp stop or a fast stop to a freewheel stop below a low speed
threshold.
It can be accessed if [Type of stop] (Stt) = [Fast stop] (FSt) or [Ramp stop] (rMP).
v 0.0: Does not switch to freewheel stop
v 0.1 to 1000 Hz: Speed threshold below which the motor will switch to freewheel stop
Note: This function cannot be used with certain other functions. Follow the instructions on page 122.
v[No] (nO): Not assigned
nO
v [LI1] (LI1)
LI1 :
- :
- v [...] (...): See the assignment conditions on page 116.
-
The stop is activated when the input changes to 0 or the bit changes to 1(bit in [I/O profile] (IO) at 0).
If the input returns to state 1 and the run command is still active, the motor will only restart if [2/3 wire
control] (tCC) page 80 = [2 wire] (2C) and [2 wire type] (tCt) = [Level] (LEL) or [Fwd priority] (PFO).
If not, a new run command must be sent.
T The parameter can be accessed if [Type of stop] (Stt) = [Fast stop] (FSt) and if [Fast stop assign.] (FSt)
is not [No] (nO).
The ramp that is enabled (dEC or dE2) is then divided by this coefficient when stop requests are sent.
Value 0 corresponds to a minimum ramp time.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
Note: This function cannot be used with certain other functions. Follow the instructions on page 122.
v [No] (nO): Not assigned
nO
v [LI1] (LI1)
LI1 :
- :
- v [...] (...): See the assignment conditions on page 116.
-
DC injection braking is initiated when the assigned input or bit changes to state 1.
If the input returns to state 1 and the run command is still active, the motor will only restart if [2/3 wire control]
(tCC) page 80 = [2 wire] (2C) and [2 wire type] (tCt) = [Level] (LEL) or [Fwd priority] (PFO). If not, a new run
command must be sent.
IdC M [DC inject. level 1] (1) (3) 0.1 to 1.1 or 1.2 In (2)
according to rating
0.64 In (2)
T Level of DC injection braking current activated via logic input or selected as stop mode.
The parameter can be accessed if [Type of stop] (Stt) = [DC injection] (dCI) or if [DC injection assign.] (dCI)
is not [No] (nO).
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
T Maximum current injection time [DC inject. level 1] (IdC). After this time the injection current becomes
[DC inject. level 2] (IdC2).
The parameter can be accessed if [Type of stop] (Stt) = [DC injection] (dCI) or if [DC injection assign.] (dCI)
is not [No] (nO).
IdC2 M [DC inject. level 2] (1) (3) 0.1 In (2) to [DC inject.
level 1] (IdC)
0.5 In (2)
T Injection current activated by logic input or selected as stop mode, once period of time [DC injection time 1] (tdI)
has elapsed.
The parameter can be accessed if [Type of stop] (Stt) = [DC injection] (dCI) or if [DC injection assign.] (dCI)
is not [No] (nO).
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
T Maximum injection time [DC inject. level 2] (IdC2) for injection, selected as stop mode only.
The parameter can be accessed if [Type of stop] (Stt) = [DC injection] (dCI).
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual and on the drive nameplate.
(3) Warning: These settings are independent of the [AUTO DC INJECTION] (AdC-) function.
T Level of standstill DC injection current. The parameter can be accessed if [Auto DC injection] (AdC) is not
[No] (nO). This parameter is forced to 0 if [Motor control type] (Ctt) page 67 = [Sync. mot.] (SYn).
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
T Standstill injection time. The parameter can be accessed if [Auto DC injection] (AdC) is not [No] (nO).
If [Motor control type] (Ctt) page 67 = [Sync. mot.] (SYn) this time corresponds to the zero speed
maintenance time.
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual and on the drive nameplate.
T 2nd standstill injection time. The parameter can be accessed if [Auto DC injection] (AdC) = [Yes] (YES.)
tdC1 t
I
Ct SdC1
=0
t
1
Run command
0
t
Speed
0
t
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
JOG- b [JOG]
Note: This function cannot be used with certain other functions. Follow the instructions on page 122.
Pulse operation.
The JOG function is only active if the command channel and the reference channels are on the
terminals.
nO Selecting the assigned logic input or bit activates the function.
LI1 v [No] (nO): Not assigned
- v [LI1] (LI1) to [LI6] (LI6)
- v [LI7] (LI7) to [LI10] (LI10): If VW3A3201 logic I/O card has been inserted
C101 v [LI11] (LI11) to [LI14] (LI14): If VW3A3202 extended I/O card has been inserted
- v [C101] (C101) to [C115] (C115): With integrated Modbus in [I/O profile] (IO) configuration
- v [C201] (C201) to [C215] (C215): With integrated CANopen in [I/O profile] (IO) configuration
- v [C301] (C301) to [C315] (C315): With a communication card in [I/O profile] (IO) configuration
Cd00 v [C401] (C401) to [C415] (C415): With a Controller Inside card in [I/O profile] (IO) configuration
- v [CD00] (Cd00) to [CD13] (Cd13): In [I/O profile] (IO) configuration can be switched with possible logic inputs
v [CD14] (Cd14) to [CD15] (Cd15): In [I/O profile] (IO) configuration can be switched without logic inputs
The function is active when the assigned input or bit is at 1.
JGF reference
LI (JOG)
1
0
JGt
Forward
1
Reverse
1
T The parameter can be accessed if [JOG] (JOG) is not [No] (nO) or if a function key has been assigned to
JOG (see page 120).
Reference in jog operation
T The parameter can be accessed if [JOG] (JOG) is not [No] (nO) or if a function key has been assigned to
JOG (see page 120).
Anti-repeat delay between 2 consecutive jog operations.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
Preset speeds
2, 4 or 8 speeds can be preset, requiring 1, 2 or 3 logic inputs respectively.
T
SP3 M [Preset speed 3] (1) 15 Hz
T
SP4 M [Preset speed 4] (1) 20 Hz
T
SP5 M [Preset speed 5] (1) 25 Hz
T
SP6 M [Preset speed 6] (1) 30 Hz
T
SP7 M [Preset speed 7] (1) 35 Hz
T
SP8 M [Preset speed 8] (1) 50 Hz
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
+/- speed
Two types of operation are available.
1. Use of single-press buttons: Two logic inputs are required in addition to the operating direction(s).
The input assigned to the “+ speed” command increases the speed, the input assigned to the “- speed” command decreases the speed.
2. Use of double-press buttons: Only one logic input assigned to “+ speed” is required.
Description: 1 button pressed twice (2 steps) for each direction of rotation. A contact closes each time the button is pressed.
Example of wiring:
b d
a c
Motor frequency
LSP
0
LSP
Forward
2st press
b b
1st press
a a a a a a a
0
Reverse
2st press
d
1st press
c c c
0
Whichever type of operation is selected, the max. speed is set by [High speed] (HSP) (see page 37).
Note:
If the reference is switched via rFC (see page 118) from any one reference channel to another reference channel with “+/- speed”, the value
of reference rFr (after ramp) may be copied at the same time in accordance with the [Copy channel 1 --> 2] (COP) parameter, see page 119.
If the reference is switched via rFC (see page 118) from one reference channel to any other reference channel with “+/- speed”, the value
of reference rFr (after ramp) is always copied at the same time.
This prevents the speed being incorrectly reset to zero when switching takes place.
UPd- b [+/-Speed]
Function can be accessed if reference channel [Ref.2 channel] (Fr2) = [+/-Speed] (UPdt) see page 118.
Note: This function cannot be used with certain other functions. Follow the instructions on page 122.
Associated with the “+/- speed” function, this parameter can be used to save the reference:
• When the run commands disappear (saved to RAM)
• When the line supply or the run commands disappear (saved to EEPROM)
Therefore, the next time the drive starts up, the speed reference is the last reference saved.
nO v [No] (nO): No save (the next time the drive starts up, the speed reference is [Low speed] (LSP),
see page 37)
rAM v [RAM] (rAM): Save to RAM
EEP v [EEprom] (EEP): Save to EEPROM
[Acceleration 2] (AC2)
Motor frequency
[Deceleration 2] (dE2)
+ SrP%
Reference A
- SrP%
LSP
LSP
- SrP%
Reference A
+ SrP%
+speed
-speed
Direction of operation
Forward Forward
Reverse
T This parameter limits the variation range with +/- speed as a % of the reference. The ramps used in this
function are [Acceleration 2] (AC2) and [Deceleration 2] (dE2).
The parameter can be accessed if +/- speed is assigned.
Time to accelerate from 0 to the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS). Make sure that this value is compatible with the
T inertia being driven.
The parameter can be accessed if +/- speed is assigned.
Time to decelerate from the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS) to 0. Make sure that this value is compatible with the
T inertia being driven. The parameter can be accessed if +/- speed is assigned.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) Range 0.01 to 99.99 s or 0.1 to 999.9 s or 1 to 9,000 s according to [Ramp increment] (Inr) page 129.
Reference saving:
Saving a speed reference value using a logic input command lasting longer than 0.1 s.
• This function is used to control the speed of several drives alternately via a single analog reference and one logic input for each drive.
• It is also used to confirm a line reference (communication bus or network) on several drives via a logic input. This allows movements
to be synchronized by getting rid of variations when the reference is sent.
• The reference is acquired 100 ms after the rising edge of the request. A new reference is not then acquired until a new request is
made.
F: motor frequency
reference
t
0
Run command
t
0
LIx (saved)
0 t
100 ms 100 ms 100 ms
T
FnC v [Not cont.] (FnC): Non-continuous mode
FCt v [Continuous] (FCt): Continuous mode. This option is not possible if [Auto DC injection] (AdC) page 135
is [Yes] (YES) or if [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133 is [Freewheel] (nSt).
FnO v [No] (FnO): Function inactive
At and above ATV61HD55M3X, ATV61HD90N4 and ATV61HC11Y, if [Motor control type] (Ctt) page 67 =
[SVC V] (UUC) or [Energy Sav.] (nLd), this selection cannot be made and the factory setting is replaced by
[Not cont.] (FnC).
If [Motor control type] (Ctt) = [Sync. mot.] (SYn) the factory setting is replaced by [Not cont.] (FnC).
In order to obtain rapid high torque on startup, magnetic flux needs to already have been established in
the motor.
• In [Continuous] (FCt) mode, the drive automatically builds up flux when it is powered up.
• In [Not cont.] (FnC) mode, fluxing occurs when the motor starts up.
The flux current is greater than nCr (configured rated motor current) when the flux is established and is then
adjusted to the motor magnetizing current...
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
If [Motor control type] (Ctt) page 67 = [Sync. mot.] (SYn), the [Motor fluxing] (FLU) parameter causes the
alignment of the motor and not the fluxing.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
PID regulator
Block diagram
The function is activated by assigning an analog input to the PID feedback (measurement).
LI Restart error or
feedback threshold
Error (wake-up) Auto/
Pr2
inversion Manual
Pr4 Ramp Ramp
Internal PIC tLS PAU
reference PII rdG POH
nO nO rSL AC2
YES + +
rPI UPP rIG
- x(-1) rPG
A PrP YES 0 +
Reference A nO
rP2 POL B
Pages 111 rP3 Gains Pages
and 112 111 and
rP4
112
PIF
Parameter:
SP16 The black rectangle
represents the factory
setting assignment.
PID feedback:
The PID feedback must be assigned to one of the analog inputs AI1 to AI4, to the frequency input or the encoder, according to whether any
extension cards have been inserted.
PID reference:
The PID reference must be assigned to the following parameters:
• Preset references via logic inputs (rP2, rP3, rP4)
• In accordance with the configuration of [Act. internal PID ref.] (PII) pages 151:
- Internal reference (rPI) or
- Reference A (Fr1 or Fr1b, see page 111)
Combination table for preset PID references
A predictive speed reference can be used to initialize the speed on restarting the process.
The scaling parameters must not exceed a value of 32767. To simplify setup, we recommend that you use values as close as possible
to this maximum limit but remain within powers of 10 in respect of the actual values.
Example (see the graph below): Adjustment of the volume in a tank, between 6 m3 and 15 m3.
- Sensor used 4-20 mA, 4.5 m3 for 4 mA, 20 m3 for 20 mA, with the result that PIF1 = 4500 and PIF2 = 20000.
- Adjustment range 6 to 15 m3, with the result that PIP1 = 6000 (min. reference) and PIP2 = 15000 (max. reference).
- Example references:
- rP1 (internal reference) = 9,500
- rp2 (preset reference) = 6,500
- rP3 (preset reference) = 8,000
- rP4 (preset reference) = 11,200
The [DISPLAY CONFIG.] menu can be used to customize the name of the unit displayed and its format.
Adjustment range
(reference)
PIP2 (15000)
PIP1 (6000)
PID feedback
PIF1 PIF2
(4500) (20000)
Other parameters:
• rSL parameter:
Can be used to set the PID error threshold, above which the PID regulator will be reactivated (wake-up) after a stop due to the max.
time threshold being exceeded at low speed (tLS).
• Reversal of the direction of correction (PIC): If PIC = nO, the speed of the motor will increase when the error is positive, for example:
pressure control with a compressor. If PIC = YES, the speed of the motor will decrease when the error is positive, for example:
temperature control using a cooling fan.
• UPP parameter:
If PIC = nO, can be used to set the PID feedback threshold, above which the PID regulator will be reactivated (wake-up) after a stop
due to the max. time threshold being exceeded at low speed (tLS).
If PIC = YES, can be used to set the PID feedback threshold, below which the PID regulator will be reactivated (wake-up) after a stop
due to the max. time threshold being exceeded at low speed (tLS).
• An alarm on the PID feedback may be configured and indicated by a logic output.
• An alarm on the PID error may be configured and indicated by a logic output.
2. Perform a test in factory settings mode (in most cases, this will be sufficient).
To optimize the drive, adjust rPG or rIG gradually and independently and observe the effect on the PID feedback in relation to the
reference.
• Perform a test with a speed reference in Manual mode (without PID regulator) and with the drive on load for the speed range of the
system:
- In steady state, the speed must be stable and comply with the reference and the PID feedback signal must be stable.
- In transient state, the speed must follow the ramp and stabilize quickly, and the PID feedback must follow the speed.
If this is not the case, see the settings for the drive and/or sensor signal and wiring.
Stabilization time
Regulated
value rPG high
Overshoot
Reference Static error
Proportional
gain
rPG low
Rise time
time
rIG high
Reference
Integral
gain
rIG low
time
Reference
rPG and rIG correct
rdG increased
time
The oscillation frequency depends on the system kinematics.
rIG
rdG = =
nO v [No] (nO): Not assigned (function inactive) In this case, none of the function parameters can be accessed.
AI1 v [AI1] (AI1): Analog input
AI2 v [AI2] (AI2): Analog input
AI3 v [AI3] (AI3): Analog input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
AI4 v [AI4] (AI4): Analog input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
PI v [RP] (PI): Frequency input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
PG v [Encoder] (PG): Encoder input, if encoder card has been inserted
AIU1 v [Network AI] (AIU1): Virtual input via communication bus.
Note : If the equipment switches to forced local mode (see page 216), the virtual input remains
frozen at the last value transmitted.
The parameter can be accessed if [PID feedback ass.] (PIF) = [Network AI] (AIU1). This parameter can also
be accessed in the [1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-) menu.
nO v [No] (nO): Not assigned
Mdb v [Modbus] (Mdb): Integrated Modbus
CAn v [CANopen] (CAn): Integrated CANopen
nEt v [Com. card] (nEt): Communication card (if inserted)
APP v [Prog. card] (APP): Controller Inside card (if inserted)
PIF1 M [Min PID feedback] (1) 100
T Value for minimum feedback. Adjustment range from 0 to [Max PID feedback] (PIF2) - 1 (2).
T Value for maximum feedback Adjustment range from [Min PID feedback] (PIF1) + 1 to 32,767 (2).
T Minimum process value. Adjustment range between [Min PID feedback] (PIF1) and [Max PID feedback]
(PIP2) - 1 (2).
T Maximum process value Adjustment range between [Min PID reference] (PIP1) + 1 to [Max PID reference]
(PIF2) (2).
T Internal PID regulator reference This parameter can also be accessed in the [1.2 MONITORING]
(SUP-) menu.
Adjustment range between [Min PID reference] (PIP1) and [Max PID reference] (PIP2) (2).
T Proportional gain
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) If a graphic display terminal is not in use, values greater than 9,999 will be displayed on the 4-digit display with a period mark after the
thousand digit, e.g., 15.65 for 15,650.
T Integral gain
T Derivative gain
T PID acceleration/deceleration ramp, defined to go from [Min PID reference] (PIP1) to [Max PID reference]
(PIP2) and vice versa.
nO v [No] (nO)
YES v [Yes] (YES)
Reversal of the direction of correction (PIC):
If PIC = nO, the speed of the motor will increase when the error is positive. Example: pressure control with
a compressor.
If PIC = YES, the speed of the motor will decrease when the error is positive. Example: temperature control
using a cooling fan.
T to rating
Minimum value of regulator output in Hz
T Minimum regulator feedback monitoring threshold (alarm can be assigned to a relay or a logic output,
page 94).
Adjustment range from [Min PID feedback] (PIF1) to [Max PID feedback] (PIF2) (2).
T Maximum regulator feedback monitoring threshold (alarm can be assigned to a relay or a logic output,
page 94).
Adjustment range from [Min PID feedback] (PIF1) to [Max PID feedback] (PIF2) (2).
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) If a graphic display terminal is not in use, values greater than 9,999 will be displayed on the 4-digit display with a period mark after the
thousand digit, e.g., 15.65 for 15,650.
Time to accelerate from 0 to the [Rated motor freq.] (FrS). Make sure that this value is compatible with the
T inertia being driven.
Ramp AC2 is only active when the PID function is starting up and in the event of PID "wake-ups".
Manual speed input. The parameter can be accessed if [Auto/Manual assign.] (PAU) is not [No] (nO).
nO v [No] (nO): Not assigned (function inactive)
AI1 v [AI1] (AI1): Analog input
AI2 v [AI2] (AI2): Analog input
AI3 v [AI3] (AI3): Analog input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
AI4 v [AI4] (AI4): Analog input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
PI v [RP] (PI): Frequency input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
PG v [Encoder] (PG): Encoder input, if encoder card has been inserted
The preset speeds are active on the manual reference if they have been configured.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) Range 0.01 to 99.99 s or 0.1 to 999.9 s or 1 to 9000 s according to [Ramp increment] (Inr) page 129.
PID feedback
LPI + 2 %
LPI
LPI - 2 %
0
Motor frequency Fallback mode
defined by MPI
HSP
MPI = LFF
LFF
MPI = FSt
0 < tPI tPI
If, once maximum speed has been reached ([High speed] (HSP)), the PID feedback is lower than the supervision threshold [PID Threshold]
(LPI) -2%, a time delay tPI is launched. If at the end of this time delay the value of the PID feedback is still lower than the supervision
threshold [PID Threshold] (LPI) + 2%, the drive switches to fallback mode as defined by parameter MPI.
In all cases the drive reverts to PID regulation mode as soon as the PID feedback exceeds the supervision threshold [PID Threshold]
(LPI) +2%.
PID feedback
LPI + 2 %
LPI
LPI - 2 %
0
Motor frequency Fallback mode
defined by MPI
HSP
MPI = LFF
LFF
MPI = FSt
0 < tPI tPI
If, once maximum speed has been reached ([High speed] (HSP)), the PID feedback is higher than the supervision threshold [PID Threshold]
(LPI) +2%, a time delay tPI is launched. If at the end of this time delay the value of the PID feedback is still higher than the supervision
threshold [PID Threshold] (LPI) -2%, the drive switches to fallback mode as defined by parameter MPI.
In all cases the drive reverts to PID regulation mode as soon as the PID feedback undershoots the supervision threshold [PID Threshold]
(LPI) -2%.
T PID regulator feedback supervision threshold (alarm can be assigned to a relay or a logic output, page 94).
Adjustment range:
v [No] (nO): Function inactive (it will not be possible to access the other function parameters)
nO v between [Min PID feedback] (PIF1) and [Max PID feedback] (PIF2) (2).
-
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) If a graphic display terminal is not in use, values greater than 9,999 will be displayed on the 4-digit display with a period mark after the
thousand digit, e.g., 15.65 for 15,650.
(3) Because, in this case, the fault does not trigger a stop, it is essential to assign a relay or logic output to its indication.
Make sure that [2 preset PID ref.] (Pr2) has been assigned before assigning this function.
nO v [No] (nO): Function inactive
LI1 v [LI1] (LI1)
- :
- :
- v [...] (...): See the assignment conditions on page 116.
If the assigned input or bit is at 0, the function is inactive.
If the assigned input or bit is at 1, the function is active.
T The parameter can be accessed if [2 preset PID ref.] (Pr2) has been assigned.
Adjustment range between [Min PID reference] (PIP1) and [Max PID reference] (PIP2) (2).
T The parameter can be accessed if [2 preset PID ref.] (Pr2) and [4 preset PID ref.] (Pr4) have been assigned.
Adjustment range between [Min PID reference] (PIP1) and [Max PID reference] (PIP2) (2).
T The parameter can be accessed if [2 preset PID ref.] (Pr2) and [4 preset PID ref.] (Pr4) have been assigned.
Adjustment range between [Min PID reference] (PIP1) and [Max PID reference] (PIP2) (2).
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) If a graphic display terminal is not in use, values greater than 9,999 will be displayed on the 4-digit display with a period mark after the
thousand digit, e.g., 15.65 for 15,650.
Sleep/Wake-up
This function supplements the PID regulator, in order to avoid prolonged operation at excessively low speeds when neither useful nor
desirable.
• It stops the motor after a period of operation at reduced speed. This time and speed can be adjusted.
• It restarts the motor if the PID error or feedback exceeds an adjustable threshold.
Sleep:
Frequency
Following operation at a speed less than
Sleep [Low speed] (LSP) + [Sleep Offset Thres.] (SLE) for
a period of time greater than or equal to [Low speed
time out] (tLS), the motor is stopped on a ramp.
LSP + SLE
LSP
Time
0 tLS
Note: If [Low speed time out] (tLS) is not 0, [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133 is forced to [Ramp stop]
(rMP) (only if a ramp stop can be configured).
T Motor frequency at minimum reference, can be set between 0 and [High speed] (HSP) (see page 49).
T Adjustable restart threshold (offset) following a stop after prolonged operation at [Low speed] (LSP) + [Sleep
Offset Thres.] (SLE), in Hz. The motor restarts if the reference rises above (LSP + SLE) and if a run
command is still present.
If the “PID” and “Low speed operating time” tLS functions are configured at the same time, the PID regulator
may attempt to set a speed lower than LSP.
This results in unsatisfactory operation, which consists of starting, operating at low speed then stopping,
and so on…
Parameter rSL (restart error threshold) can be used to set a minimum PID error threshold for restarting after
a stop at prolonged LSP.
The function is inactive if the PID function has not been configured or if tLS = 0 or if rSL = 0.
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Check that unintended restarts will not present any danger.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) If a graphic display terminal is not in use, values greater than 9,999 will be displayed on the 4-digit display with a period mark after the
thousand digit, e.g., 15.65 for 15,650.
If the “PID” and “Low speed operating time” tLS functions are configured at the same time, the PID regulator
may attempt to set a speed lower than LSP.
This results in unsatisfactory operation, which consists of starting, operating at low speed then stopping,
and so on…
Parameter UPP (restart feedback threshold) can be used to set a PID feedback threshold for restarting after
a stop due to prolonged LSP. This threshold is minimum if [PID correct. reverse] (PIC) = [No] (nO) and
maximum if [PID correct. reverse] (PIC) = [Yes] (YES)
The function is inactive if the PID function has not been configured or if tLS = 0 or if UPP = [No] (nO) or if
rSL is active (not 0).
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Check that unintended restarts will not present any danger.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.
Adjustment range: [No] (nO) or between [Min PID feedback] (PIF1) and [Max PID feedback] (PIF2) (2).
(1) If a graphic display terminal is not in use, values greater than 9,999 will be displayed on the 4-digit display with a period mark after the
thousand digit, e.g., 15.65 for 15,650.
This function is only active when the motor frequency is less than [NoFlo.Freq.Thres.Ac.] (FFd).
This function is used in applications where zero flow cannot be detected by the sleep function alone. At periodic intervals (based on
time [No Flow Period Det.] (nFd)), it forces the drive’s frequency reference to [Low speed] (LSP) + [No Flow Offset] (LFd) in order to test
for zero flow.
Set the sleep function so that the drive switches to sleep mode when zero flow is detected ([No Flow Offset] (LFd) y [Sleep Offset
Thres.] (SLE) page 158).
The test can be carried out at underpressure or overpressure as appropriate for the type of installation.
PID error
Frequency
FFd
LSP + SLE
LSP + LFd
LSP t
nFd nFd
• If the request is no longer present (zero flow), the PID regulator error will not increase, and the speed will remain below the sleep
threshold, thereby inducing a stop.
.
PID feedback
Frequency
FFd
Sleep threshold LSP + SLE
LSP + LFd
LSP
t
nFd tLS
PID error
Frequency
LSP + LFd
FFd
LSP + SLE
LSP t
nFd nFd
• If the request is no longer present (zero flow), the PID regulator error increases (at overpressure), causing the drive to decelerate.
The absence of flow maintains the overpressure and the speed falls below the sleep threshold, causing the drive to stop.
.
PID feedback
Frequency
LSP + LFd
FFd
Sleep threshold LSP + SLE
LSP
tLS t
nFd
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
Torque limitation
There are two types of torque limitation:
• With a value that is fixed by a parameter
• With a value that is set by an analog input (AI, pulse or encoder)
If both types are enabled, the lowest value is taken into account. The two types of limitation can be configured or switched remotely using
a logic input or via the communication bus.
Limitation
value
[Analog limit. act.] (tLC) Lowest value
taken into account
[Yes]
Torque (YES)
limitation via [AI]
[AI.] (AI.) analog input,
RP or [LI]
[RP] (PI)
[Encoder] (PG) Encoder
[No]
(nO)
LI
The parameter cannot be accessed if [Torque limit. activ.] (tLA) = [No] (nO).
Selection of units for the [Motoring torque lim] (tLIM) and [Gen. torque lim] (tLIG) parameters
0.1 v [0.1%] (0.1): 0.1% unit
1 v [1%] (1): 1% unit
tLIM M [Motoring torque lim] (1) 0 to 300% 100%
T The parameter cannot be accessed if [Torque limit. activ.] (tLA) = [No] (nO)
Torque limitation in motor mode, as a whole % or in 0.1% increments of the rated torque in accordance with
the [Torque increment] (IntP) parameter.
T The parameter cannot be accessed if [Torque limit. activ.] (tLA) = [No] (nO)
Torque limitation in generator mode, as a whole % or in 0.1% increments of the rated torque in accordance
with the [Torque increment] (IntP) parameter.
If the function is assigned, the limitation varies between 0% and 300% of the rated torque on the basis of
the 0% to 100% signal applied to the assigned input.
Examples:
- 12 mA on a 4-20 mA input results in limitation to 150% of the rated torque.
- 2.5 V on a 10 V input results in 75% of the rated torque.
nO v [No] (nO): Not assigned (function inactive)
AI1 v [AI1] (AI1)
- to
AI4 [AI4] (AI4): Analog input, if VW3A3202 I/O card has been inserted
PI v [RP] (PI): Frequency input, if VW3A3202 I/O card has been inserted
PG v [Encoder] (PG): Encoder input, if encoder card has been inserted
AIU1 v [Network AI] (AIU1): Virtual input via communication bus, to be configured via [AI net. channel] (AIC1)
page 89
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
If the equipment switches to forced local mode (see page 216), the virtual input remains frozen at the
last value transmitted.
Do not use the virtual input and forced local mode in the same configuration.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in death or serious injury.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
The parameter can be accessed if [Torque ref. assign.] (tAA) is not [No] (nO).
YES v [Yes] (YES): The limitation depends on the input assigned by [Torque ref. assign.] (tAA).
LI1 v [LI1] (LI1)
- :
- :
- v [...] (...): See the assignment conditions on page 116.
If the assigned input or bit is at 0:
• The limit is specified by the [Motoring torque lim] (tLIM) and [Gen. torque lim] (tLIG) parameters if
[Torque limit. activ.] (tLA) is not [No] (nO).
• No limitation if [Torque limit. activ.] (tLA) = [No] (nO).
If the assigned input or bit is at 1:
• The limitation depends on the input assigned by [Torque ref. assign.] (tAA).
Note: If [Torque limitation] (tLA) and [Torque ref. assign.] (tAA) are enabled at the same time, the lowest
value will be taken into account.
CL2 M [I Limit. 2 value] (1) 0 to 1.1 or 1.2 In (2) 1.1 or 1.2 In (2)
Note: If the setting is less than 0.25 In, the drive may lock in [Output Phase Loss] (OPF) fault mode
if this has been enabled (see page 194). If it is less than the no-load motor current, the limitation no
longer has any effect.
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current, particularly in the case of permanent magnet
synchronous motors, which are susceptible to demagnetization.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
Note: If the setting is less than 0.25 In, the drive may lock in [Output Phase Loss] (OPF) fault mode
if this has been enabled (see page 194). If it is less than the no-load motor current, the limitation no
longer has any effect.
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current, particularly in the case of permanent magnet
synchronous motors, which are susceptible to demagnetization.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual and on the drive nameplate.
K10
K11
KM1
L1 L2 L3
ATV 71
U V W 0 LIp P24 LIn LO/Rp
0V 24 V
24 V power supply
The drive control power supply must be provided via an external 24 V source.
CAUTION
This function can only be used for a small number of consecutive operations with a cycle time longer than 60 s (in order
to avoid premature aging of the filter capacitor charging circuit).
Note: The line contactor closes every time a run command (forward or reverse) is sent and opens after every stop.
Monitoring time for closing of line contactor. If, once this time has elapsed, there is no voltage on the drive
power circuit, the drive will lock with an [input contactor] (LCF) fault.
CAUTION
If a DC injection braking function has been configured it should not be left operating too long in stop mode, as the contactor only
opens at the end of braking.
Note:
Fault FCF2 (contactor failing to close) can be reset by the run command changing state from 1 to 0 (0 --> 1 --> 0 in 3-wire control).
K20 KM2
KM2
K20
KM2
M
3
The [Out. contactor ass.] (OCC) and [Output contact. fdbk] (rCA) functions can be used individually or together.
T Time delay for output contactor opening command following motor stop.
This parameter can be accessed if [Output contact. fdbk] (rCA) is assigned.
The time delay must be greater than the opening time of the output contactor. If it is set to 0, the fault will
not be monitored.
If the contactor fails to open at the end of the set time, the drive will lock in FCF1 fault mode.
Damper control
This function applies to the ventilation ducts. The aim is to control the opening of the duct (shutter device called a "damper") when the fan
starts up.
Damper
ATV 61
Control Feedback
U V W 0 LOp/Rp P24 LIp
Flow of air
Damper Fan
open contact
Damper opening
M
3
Fan speed
0
t
1
Run command
0
t
1
Opening command
Rx/LOx 0
t
Open
Position of damper
t
Closed
tOd tCd
1
T Opening fault monitoring time delay. If the damper does not open at the end of the set time, the drive will
lock in [Damper stuck] (Fd1) fault mode.
The time delay must be greater than the normal opening time of the damper.
T Closing fault monitoring time delay. If the damper does not close at the end of the set time, the drive will
lock in [Damper open.] (Fd1) fault mode.
If this parameter is at 0.00, the [Damper open.] (Fd2) fault is monitored only at the run command before
activation of the relay or the control logic output.
The time delay must be greater than the normal closing time of the damper.
This parameter defines the positive or negative logic of the input or bit assigned by [Damper feedback]
(dFb).
SHUt v [Active at 0] (SHUt): The motor starts up when the assigned input or bit changes to 0.
OPEn v [Active at 1] (OPEn): The motor starts up when the assigned input or bit changes to 1.
Note: Do not modify the parameters in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu, because any modifications made in this menu will be lost
on the next power-up. The parameters can be adjusted during operation in the [PARAM. SET SWITCHING] (MLP-) menu, on the
active configuration.
Note: Parameter set switching cannot be configured from the integrated display terminal.
Parameters can only be adjusted on the integrated display terminal if the function has been configured previously via the graphic display
terminal, by PowerSuite or via the bus or communication network. If the function has not been configured, the MLP- menu and the PS1-,
PS2-, PS3- submenus do not appear.
M [PARAMETER SELECTION]
The parameter can only be accessed on the graphic display terminal if [2 Parameter sets] is not [No].
Making an entry in this parameter opens a window containing all the adjustment parameters that can be
accessed.
Select 1 to 15 parameters using ENT (a tick then appears next to the parameter). Parameter(s) can also be
deselected using ENT.
Example:
PARAMETER SELECTION
1.3 SETTINGS
Ramp increment
---------
---------
---------
PS1- M [SET 1]
The parameter can be accessed if one or more parameters have been selected in [PARAMETER
SELECTION].
Making an entry in this parameter opens a settings window containing the selected parameters in the order
in which they were selected.
With the graphic display terminal:
PS3- M [SET 3]
The parameter can be accessed if [3 parameter sets] is not [No] and if one or more parameters have been
selected in [PARAMETER SELECTION].
Procedure identical to [SET 1] (PS1-).
Note: We recommend that a parameter set switching test is carried out on stopping and a check is made to ensure
that it has been performed correctly.
Some parameters are interdependent and in this case may be restricted at the time of switching.
Example: The highest [Low speed] (LSP) must be below the lowest [High speed] (HSP).
Transfer of a drive configuration to another one, with graphic display terminal, when
the drive uses [MULTIMOTORS/CONFIG.] function
Let A be the source drive and B the drive addressed. In this example, switching are controled by logic input.
Nota: Steps 6, 7, 14 et 15 are necessary only if [MULTIMOTORS/CONFIG.] function is used with 3 configurations or 3 motors.
Graphic display
terminal
Current
configuration
Network
Modbus
CANopen
[2 Configurations] (CnF1)
Terminal
[3 Configurations] (CnF2)
Switching command
Depending on the number of motors or selected configuration (2 or 3), the switching command is sent using one or two logic inputs.
The table below lists the possible combinations.
LI LI Number of configuration
2 motors or configurations 3 motors or configurations or active motor
0 0 0
1 0 1
0 1 2
1 1 2
ATV 71
Configuration 0 LO or R
LI
Configuration 1
Configuration 0
LO or R
if the 2 contacts + 24 V Configuration 1
are open. Configuration 2
LO or R
LI Configuration 2
M0 M1 M2
Note: As the [1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-) menu is switched, these outputs must be assigned in all configurations in which
information is required.
MMC- b [MULTIMOTORS/CONFIG.]
CHM M [Multimotors] [No] (nO)
Note: In order to obtain 3 motors or 3 configurations, [2 Configurations] (CnF1) must also be configured.
The function uses a fluid sensor assigned to a logic input or a bit, which can be configured for positive or negative logic by [Conf.sensor
flow] (LnS).
The fault is triggered if the frequency exceeds an adjustable threshold [Freq.Th.Sensor. Act.] (nFFt) and the input or bit assigned to the
sensor changes to 0 or 1 depending on its configuration.
The fault is ignored on startup for an adjustably time delay [Flow Times Ctrl] (nFSt) in order to avoid untimely triggering due to a transient
state.
Run command
Flow sensor
(example where
0 = zero flow)
Frequency
HSP
nFSt
This parameter can be accessed if zero flow detection has been assigned to a logic input or a bit. It defines
the positive or negative logic of the input or bit assigned to this detection.
LO v [Active low] (LO): Detection on falling edge (change from 1 to 0) of the assigned input or bit.
HIG v [Active high] (HIG): Detection on rising edge (change from 0 to 1) of the assigned input or bit.
nFFt M [Freq.Th.Sensor. Act.] (1) 0 to 500 or 1,000 Hz
according to rating
0 Hz
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
Flow limitation
This function can be used to limit the flow of a fluid, in the case of a pump, for example.
The function uses a flow sensor assigned to an analog input, the “pulse in” input or the encoder input. It limits the frequency reference. In the
case of regulation with PID, it affects the PID regulator output reference.
Flow input A B C D E F
CHt
Hysteresis
Hysteresis for CHt
rCHt
0
Frequency reference
LSP
0
Frequency
Ramp
dFL
Ramp
dFL
0
Flow limitation active
• Before A – The signal on the input assigned to the flow measurement has not reached the activation threshold [Flow.Lim.Th.Active]
(CHt): Flow limitation is not activated and the input reference is applied.
• A – The signal on the input assigned to the flow measurement has reached the threshold [Flow.Lim.Th.Active] (CHt): Flow limitation
is activated, the reference is limited to [Low speed] (LSP) and the frequency decelerates along the ramp [Dec. Flow. limit] (dFL).
• B – The signal on the input assigned to the flow measurement has fallen below the hysteresis of the threshold [Flow.Lim.Th.Active]
(CHt): The current frequency is copied and applied as the reference.
• C – The input reference has fallen below the reference B and is continuing to fall: It is applied.
• D – The input reference starts to rise again: The current frequency is copied and applied as the reference.
• E – The signal on the input assigned to the flow measurement has reached the threshold [Flow.Lim.Th.Active] (CHt): The reference
is limited to [Low speed] (LSP) and the frequency decelerates along the ramp [Dec. Flow. limit] (dFL).
• F – The signal on the input assigned to the flow measurement has fallen below the hysteresis of the threshold [Flow.Lim.Th.Active]
(CHt): The current frequency is copied and applied as the reference.
• After F – The signal on the input assigned to the flow measurement has fallen below the deactivation threshold [Flo.Lim.Thres. Inact.]
(rCHt): Flow limitation is no longer active and the input reference is applied.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) Range 0.01 to 99.99 s or 0.1 to 999.9 s or 1 to 9,000 s according to [Ramp increment] (Inr) page 129.
Direct power supply via the DC bus requires a protected direct current source with adequate power and voltage as well as a suitably
dimensioned resistor and capacitor precharging contactor. Consult Schneider Electric for information about dimensioning these
components.
The “direct power supply via DC bus” function can be used to control the precharging contactor via a relay or a logic input on the drive.
DC power
supply
- +
Contactor power
supply
A1
- KM1
A2
A1
R2A
R2C
PA /+
P0
PC /-
ATV61ppp
W / T3
U / T1
V / T2
W1
U1
V1
M
3a
Direct power supply via Active Front End (AFE) reduces the mains current harmonics to less than 4% and gives enables the drive to
feedback the generative energy to the mains supply.
Semiconductor fuses
PA/+ PC/-
ATV61
U V W
M
3
CAUTION
DAMAGED EQUIPMENT
It is absolutely necessary to carry out further parameter setting on all ATV61 drive connnected to Active Front End (AFE).
Check the list of parameter on next page.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
• Parameter [Mains voltage] (UrES) : Same setting as the active front end (Thereby the internal voltage levels of the frequency inverter
are adapted).
• Parameter for operation with active front end [Regen. Connection] (AFE) has to be set to [Yes] (YES) (Thereby the undervoltage level
of the frequency inverter is adapted to the operation with the active front end).
• Parameter [Dec ramp adapt.] (brA) is set to [nO] to inactivate this function.
• Parameter [Brake res. fault Mgt] (bUb) has to be set to [ignore] (nO) (for HHP range only).
• Parameter [Deceleration] (dEC) has to be increased for applications with high inertia to avoid overload of Active Front End. This can
be prevented also by rounding the deceleration ramp with parameter [Begin Dec round] (tA3).
• Parameter [2 wire type] (tCt) has to be set on [Level] (LEL) to ensure an automatic restart after undervoltage detection of the Active
Front End. An automatic restart is only possible on 2 wire control.
• The integrated RFI filter has to be always deactivated (position IT, non-grounded mains) for all ATV 61 inverter and also for the Active
Infeed Converter (AIC) because there exists no direct mains connection.
AFE
HS
LFC PA/+ PA/+
NH 3L1 U
Mains voltage
L1 1L1 2L1
3L2 V
L2 1L2 2L2 M
3L3 W
L3 1L3 2L3
PC/- PC/-
PE PE PE PE PE PE PE
IT
ESC
tHt- [MOTOR THERMAL PROT.] 194
SIM- OPL- [OUTPUT PHASE LOSS] 194
IPL- [INPUT PHASE LOSS] 195
OHL- [DRIVE OVERHEAT] 195
SAt- [THERMAL ALARM STOP] 196
ESC
ESC
ENT USb- [UNDERVOLTAGE MGT] 198
FLt- FAULT MANAGEMENT tIt- [IGBT TESTS] 199
ESC
The parameters in the [1.8 FAULT MANAGEMENT] (FLt-) menu can only be modified when the drive is stopped and there is no run
command, except for parameters with a T symbol in the code column, which can be modified with the drive running or stopped.
PTC probes
3 sets of PTC probes can be managed by the drive in order to protect the motors:
• 1 on logic input LI6 converted for this use by switch “SW2” on the control card.
• 1 on each of the 2 option cards VW3A3201 and VW3A3202.
Each of these sets of PTC probes is monitored for the following faults:
• Motor overheating
• Sensor break fault
• Sensor short-circuit fault
Protection via PTC probes does not disable protection via I2t calculation performed by the drive (the two types of protection can be
combined).
CAUTION
Make sure that the cause of the fault that led to the drive locking has been removed before
reinitializing.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
CAUTION
Make sure that the cause of the fault that led to the drive locking has been removed before
reinitializing.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Check that an automatic restart will not endanger personnel or equipment in any way.
If the restart has not taken place once the configurable time tAr has elapsed, the procedure is aborted and
the drive remains locked until it is turned off and then on again.
The faults which permit this function are listed on page 243:
Used to enable a smooth restart if the run command is maintained after the following events:
• Loss of line supply or disconnection
• Reset of current fault or automatic restart
• Freewheel stop
The speed given by the drive resumes from the estimated speed of the motor at the time of the restart,
then follows the ramp to the reference speed.
This function requires 2-wire level control.
nO v [No] (nO): Function inactive
YES v [Yes] (YES): Function active
When the function is operational, it activates at each run command, resulting in a slight delay of the current
(0.5 s max.).
[Catch on the fly] (FLr) is forced to [No] (nO) if [Auto DC injection] (AdC) page 135 = [Continuous] (Ct)
Note: The memory of the motor thermal state is saved when the drive is switched off. The power-off time is used to recalculate the
thermal state the next time the drive is switched on.
• Naturally-cooled motors:
The tripping curves depend on the motor frequency.
• Force-cooled motors:
Only the 50 Hz tripping curve needs to be considered, regardless of the motor frequency.
1 Hz 3 Hz 5 Hz
10 Hz 20 Hz 50 Hz
10 000
1 000
100
0,7 0,8 0,9 1 1,1 1,2 1,3 1,4 1,5 1,6
Motor current/ItH
T Time delay for taking the [Output Phase Loss] (OPL) fault into account, or for taking management of the
output voltage into account if [Output Phase Loss] (OPL) = [Ouptut cut] (OAC).
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(2) Because, in this case, the fault does not trigger a stop, it is essential to assign a relay or logic output to its indication.
CAUTION
RISK OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
Inhibiting faults results in the drive not being protected. This invalidates the warranty.
Check that the possible consequences do not present any risk.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
(1) Because, in this case, the fault does not trigger a stop, it is essential to assign a relay or logic output to its indication.
nO v [No] (nO): Function inactive (in this case, the following parameters cannot be accessed)
YES v [Yes] (YES): Freewheel stop on drive or motor thermal alarm
CAUTION
The drive and motor are no longer protected in the event of thermal alarm stops. This
invalidates the warranty.
Check that the possible consequences do not present any risk.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
Parameter can be accessed if the external fault has been assigned to a logic input. It defines the positive
or negative logic of the input assigned to the fault.
LO v [Active low] (LO): Fault on falling edge (change from 1 to 0) of the assigned input
HIG v [Active high] (HIG): Fault on rising edge (change from 0 to 1) of the assigned input
(1) Because, in this case, the fault does not trigger a stop, it is essential to assign a relay or logic output to its indication.
Behavior in the event of the undervoltage fault prevention level being reached
nO v [No] (nO): No action
MMS v [DC Maintain] (MMS): This stop mode uses the inertia to maintain the DC bus voltage as long
as possible.
rMP v [Ramp stop] (rMP): Stop following an adjustable ramp [Max stop time] (StM).
LnF v [Lock-out] (LnF): Lock (freewheel stop) without fault
T Time delay before authorizing the restart after a complete stop for [UnderV. prevention] (StP) = [Ramp stop]
(rMP), if the voltage has returned to normal.
nO v [Ignore] (nO): Fault ignored. This configuration is the only one possible if [AI2 min. value] (CrL2) page 86
is not greater than 3 mA or if [AI2 Type] (AI2t) page 86 = [Voltage] (10U).
YES v [Freewheel] (YES): Freewheel stop.
Stt v [Per STT] (Stt): Stop according to configuration of [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133, without fault tripping.
In this case the fault relay does not open and the drive is ready to restart as soon as the fault disappears,
according to the restart conditions of the active command channel (e.g., according to [2/3 wire control]
(tCC) and [2 wire type] (tCt) page 80 if control is via the terminals). Configuring an alarm for this fault is
recommended (assigned to a logic output, for example) in order to indicate the cause of the stop.
LFF v [fallback spd] (LFF): Switch to fallback speed, maintained as long as the fault is present and the
run command is not disabled (1).
rLS v [Spd maint.] (rLS): The drive maintains the speed being applied when the fault occurred, as long as
the fault is present and the run command is not disabled (1).
rMP v [Ramp stop] (rMP): Stop on ramp
FSt v [Fast stop] (FSt): Fast stop
dCI v [DC injection] (dCI): DC injection stop. This type of stop cannot be used with certain other functions.
See table on page 122.
LFL3 M [AI3 4-20mA loss] Can be accessed if a VW3A3202 option card has been inserted. [Ignore] (nO)
nO v [Ignore] (nO): Fault ignored. This configuration is the only one possible if [AI3 min. value] (CrL3) page 87
is not greater than 3 mA.
YES v [Freewheel] (YES): Freewheel stop.
Stt v [Per STT] (Stt): Stop according to configuration of [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133, without fault tripping.
In this case the fault relay does not open and the drive is ready to restart as soon as the fault disappears,
according to the restart conditions of the active command channel (e.g., according to [2/3 wire control]
(tCC) and [2 wire type] (tCt) page 80 if control is via the terminals). Configuring an alarm for this fault is
recommended (assigned to a logic output, for example) in order to indicate the cause of the stop.
LFF v [fallback spd] (LFF): Switch to fallback speed, maintained as long as the fault is present and the
run command is not disabled (1).
rLS v [Spd maint.] (rLS): The drive maintains the speed being applied when the fault occurred, as long as
the fault is present and the run command is not disabled (1).
rMP v [Ramp stop] (rMP): Stop on ramp
FSt v [Fast stop] (FSt): Fast stop
dCI v [DC injection] (dCI): DC injection stop. This type of stop cannot be used with certain other functions.
See table on page 122.
LFL4 M [AI4 4-20mA loss] Can be accessed if a VW3A3202 option card has been inserted. [Ignore] (nO)
nO v [Ignore] (nO): Fault ignored. This configuration is the only one possible if [AI4 min. value] (CrL4) page 88
is not greater than 3 mA or if [AI4 Type] (AI4t) page 88 = [Voltage] (10U).
YES v [Freewheel] (YES): Freewheel stop.
Stt v [Per STT] (Stt): Stop according to configuration of [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133, without fault tripping.
In this case the fault relay does not open and the drive is ready to restart as soon as the fault disappears,
according to the restart conditions of the active command channel (e.g., according to [2/3 wire control]
(tCC) and [2 wire type] (tCt) page 80 if control is via the terminals). Configuring an alarm for this fault is
recommended (assigned to a logic output, for example) in order to indicate the cause of the stop.
LFF v [fallback spd] (LFF): Switch to fallback speed, maintained as long as the fault is present and the
run command is not disabled (1).
rLS v [Spd maint.] (rLS): The drive maintains the speed being applied when the fault occurred, as long as
the fault is present and the run command is not disabled (1).
rMP v [Ramp stop] (rMP): Stop on ramp
FSt v [Fast stop] (FSt): Fast stop
dCI v [DC injection] (dCI): DC injection stop. This type of stop cannot be used with certain other functions.
See table on page 122.
(1) Because, in this case, the fault does not trigger a stop, it is essential to assign a relay or logic output to its indication.
CAUTION
Inhibiting faults results in the drive not being protected. This invalidates the warranty.
Check that the possible consequences do not present any risk.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
nO v [No] (nO): Function inactive, thereby preventing access to other function parameters.
LI1 v [LI1] (LI1)
- :
- :
- v [...] (...): See the assignment conditions on page 116.
If the assigned input or bit is at 0, fault monitoring is active. If the assigned input or bit is at 1, fault monitoring
is inactive. Active faults are reset on a rising edge (change from 0 to 1) of the assigned input or bit.
Note: The “Power Removal” function and any faults that prevent any form of operation are not affected by
this function.
A list of faults affected by this function appears on pages 240 to 245.
This parameter causes the run command to be forced in a specific direction when the input or bit for
fault inhibition is at 1, with priority over all other commands with the exception of “Power Removal”.
To assign forced run, press and hold down the “ENT” key for 2 s.
nO v [No] (nO): Function inactive
Frd v [Fw.For.Run] (Frd): Forced forward run.
rrS v [Rev.For.Run] (rrS): Forced reverse run.
DANGER
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Check that it is safe to force the run command.
The parameter can be accessed if [Forced Run] (InHS) is not [No] (nO)
This parameter causes the reference to be forced to the configured value when the input or bit for
fault inhibition is at 1, with priority over all other references. Value 0 = function inactive.
The factory setting changes to 60 Hz if [Standard mot. freq] (bFr) = [60 Hz NEMA] (60).
Behavior of the drive in the event of a communication fault with a communication card
nO v [Ignore] (nO): Fault ignored
YES v [Freewheel] (YES): Freewheel stop.
Stt v [Per STT] (Stt): Stop according to configuration of [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133, without fault tripping.
In this case the fault relay does not open and the drive is ready to restart as soon as the fault disappears,
according to the restart conditions of the active command channel (e.g., according to [2/3 wire control]
(tCC) and [2 wire type] (tCt) page 80 if control is via the terminals). Configuring an alarm for this fault
is recommended (assigned to a logic output, for example) in order to indicate the cause of the stop.
LFF v [fallback spd] (LFF): Switch to fallback speed, maintained as long as the fault is present and the
run command is not disabled (1).
rLS v [Spd maint.] (rLS): The drive maintains the speed being applied when the fault occurred, as long as
the fault is present and the run command is not disabled (1).
rMP v [Ramp stop] (rMP): Stop on ramp
FSt v [Fast stop] (FSt): Fast stop
dCI v [DC injection] (dCI): DC injection stop. This type of stop cannot be used with certain other functions.
See table on page 122.
Behavior of the drive in the event of a communication fault with integrated CANopen
nO v [Ignore] (nO): Fault ignored
YES v [Freewheel] (YES): Freewheel stop.
Stt v [Per STT] (Stt): Stop according to configuration of [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133, without fault tripping.
In this case the fault relay does not open and the drive is ready to restart as soon as the fault disappears,
according to the restart conditions of the active command channel (e.g., according to [2/3 wire control]
(tCC) and [2 wire type] (tCt) page 80 if control is via the terminals). Configuring an alarm for this fault is
recommended (assigned to a logic output, for example) in order to indicate the cause of the stop.
LFF v [fallback spd] (LFF): Switch to fallback speed, maintained as long as the fault is present and the
run command is not disabled (1).
rLS v [Spd maint.] (rLS): The drive maintains the speed being applied when the fault occurred, as long as
the fault is present and the run command is not disabled (1).
rMP v [Ramp stop] (rMP): Stop on ramp
FSt v [Fast stop] (FSt): Fast stop
dCI v [DC injection] (dCI): DC injection stop. This type of stop cannot be used with certain other functions.
See table on page 122.
Behavior of the drive in the event of a communication fault with integrated Modbus
nO v [Ignore] (nO): Fault ignored
YES v [Freewheel] (YES): Freewheel stop.
Stt v [Per STT] (Stt): Stop according to configuration of [Type of stop] (Stt) page 133, without fault tripping.
In this case the fault relay does not open and the drive is ready to restart as soon as the fault disappears,
according to the restart conditions of the active command channel (e.g., according to [2/3 wire control]
(tCC) and [2 wire type] (tCt) page 80 if control is via the terminals). Configuring an alarm for this fault is
recommended (assigned to a logic output, for example) in order to indicate the cause of the stop.
LFF v [fallback spd] (LFF): Switch to fallback speed, maintained as long as the fault is present and the run
command is not disabled (1).
rLS v [Spd maint.] (rLS): The drive maintains the speed being applied when the fault occurred, as long as the
fault is present and the run command is not disabled (1).
rMP v [Ramp stop] (rMP): Stop on ramp
FSt v [Fast stop] (FSt): Fast stop
dCI v [DC injection] (dCI): DC injection stop. This type of stop cannot be used with certain other functions.
See table on page 122.
(1) Because, in this case, the fault does not trigger a stop, it is essential to assign a relay or logic output to its indication.
(1) Because, in this case, the fault does not trigger a stop, it is essential to assign a relay or logic output to its indication.
Use of the "Pulse input" to measure the speed of rotation of the motor
This function uses the "Pulse input" from the VW3A3202 extension card and can, therefore, only be used if this card has been inserted and
if the "Pulse input" is not being used for another function.
Example of use
A notched disc driven by the motor and connected to a proximity sensor can be used to generate a frequency signal that is proportional to
the speed of rotation of the motor.
Time, in seconds
Scaling factor for the "Pulse input" (divisor). The frequency measured is displayed by means of the [Pulse
in. work. freq.] (FqS) parameter, page 44 or 46.
Activation and adjustment of monitoring for the Pulse input (speed feedback): [Speed fdback loss] (SPF)
fault
nO v [No] (nO): No monitoring of speed feedback
- v 0.1 Hz to 500.0 Hz: Adjustment of the motor frequency threshold for tripping a speed feedback fault
(difference between the estimated frequency and the measured speed)
nO v [No] (nO): No braking resistor protection (thereby preventing access to the other function parameters).
v [Alarm] (YES): Alarm. The alarm may be assigned to a logic output or a relay (see page 94).
YES v [Fault] (FLt) : Switch to fault (bOF) with locking of drive (freewheel stop).
FLt
Note: The thermal state of the resistor can be displayed on the graphic display terminal.
It is calculated for as long as the drive control remains connected to the power supply.
T The parameter can be accessed if [DB res. protection] (brO) is not [No] (nO).
Rated power of the resistor used.
T The parameter can be accessed if [DB res. protection] (brO) is not [No] (nO).
Rated value of the braking resistor in Ohms.
Management of short-circuit [DB unit sh. circuit] (bUF) and overheating [Internal- th. sensor] (InFb) faults in
the braking unit.
nO v [Ignore] (nO): Fault ignored. Configuration to be used if there is no braking unit or resistor
connected to the drive.
YES v [Freewheel] (YES): Freewheel stop
Card pairing
Function can only be accessed in [Expert] mode.
This function is used to detect whenever a card has been replaced or the software has been modified in any way.
When a pairing password is entered, the parameters of the cards currently inserted are stored. On every subsequent power-up these
parameters are verified and in the event of a discrepancy the drive locks in HCF fault mode. Before the drive can be restarted you must
revert to the original situation or re-enter the pairing password.
The [OFF] (OFF) value signifies that the card pairing function is inactive.
The [ON] (On) value signifies that card pairing is active and that an access code must be entered in order to
start the drive in the event of a card pairing fault.
As soon as the code has been entered the drive is unlocked and the code changes to [ON] (On).
- The PPI code is an unlock code known only to Schneider Electric Product Support.
The motor is in steady state when the offset between the frequency reference and motor frequency falls below the configurable
threshold (Srb).
.
Torque as a % of
the rated torque
Between zero frequency and the rated frequency,
the curve reflects the following equation:
LUn (LUn - LUL) x (frequency)2
torque = LUL +
(rated frequency)2
The underload function is not active for frequencies
below rMUd.
Underload
zone
LUL
Frequency
0 rMUd FrS
A relay or a logic output can be assigned to the signaling of this fault in the [1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-) menu.
T Underload threshold at rated motor frequency ([Rated motor freq.] (FrS) page 35), as a % of the rated motor
torque.
(LUn)
T Maximum deviation between the frequency reference and the motor frequency, which defines steady state
operation.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
T Overload detection threshold, as a % of the rated motor current [Rated mot. current] (nCr). This value must
be less than the limit current in order for the function to work.
T Maximum deviation between the frequency reference and the motor frequency, which defines steady state
operation.
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu.
(1) Because, in this case, the fault does not trigger a stop, it is essential to assign a relay or logic output to its indication.
T The ramp that is enabled (dEC or dE2) is then divided by this coefficient when stop requests are sent.
Value 0 corresponds to a minimum ramp time.
T Level of DC injection braking current activated via logic input or selected as stop mode.
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
T Maximum current injection time [DC inject. level 1] (IdC). After this time the injection current becomes
[DC inject. level 2] (IdC2).
IdC2 M [DC inject. level 2] (1) (3) 0.1 In (2) to [DC inject.
level 1] (IdC)
0.5 In (2)
T Injection current activated by logic input or selected as stop mode, once period of time [DC injection time 1] (tdI)
has elapsed.
CAUTION
Check that the motor will withstand this current without overheating.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
T Maximum injection time [DC inject. level 2] (IdC2) for injection, selected as stop mode only.
(Can be accessed if [Type of stop] (Stt) = [DC injection] (dCI)).
(1) The parameter can also be accessed in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) and [1.7 APPLICATION FUNCT.] (FUn-) menus.
(2) In corresponds to the rated drive current indicated in the Installation Manual and on the drive nameplate.
(3) Warning: These settings are independent of the [AUTO DC INJECTION] (AdC-) function.
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ESC
FLt-
ENT
ESC
CON- COMMUNICATION
ESC
ESC
FCS-
ESC
LAC-
OFF to 247
0.1 to 30 s
CnO- b [CANopen]
AdCO M [CANopen address] OFF
OFF to 127
- b [COMMUNICATION CARD]
See the specific documentation for the card used.
nO v [No] (nO): Not assigned (control via the terminals with zero reference).
AI1 v [AI1] (AI1): Analog input
AI2 v [AI2] (AI2): Analog input
AI3 v [AI3] (AI3): Analog input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
AI4 v [AI4] (AI4): Analog input, if VW3A3202 extension card has been inserted
LCC v [HMI] (LCC): Assignment of the reference and command to the graphic display terminal.
Reference: [HMI Frequency ref.] (LFr), page 44, control: RUN/STOP/FWD/REV buttons.
PI v [RP] (PI): Frequency input, if VW3A3202 card has been inserted
If the reference is assigned to an analog input, or [RP] (PI), the command is automatically assigned to the
terminals as well (logic inputs).
0.1 to 30 s
The parameter can be accessed if [Forced local assign.] (FLO) is not [No] (nO).
Time delay before communication monitoring is resumed on leaving forced local mode.
This menu can only be accessed with the graphic display terminal:
RUN Term +0.00 Hz REM RUN Term +0.00 Hz REM This screen indicates the state of the drive at the
FAULT HISTORY ENT internal com. link moment the selected fault occurred.
internal com. link Drive state RDY
----- ETA status word ...
----- ETI status word ...
----- Cmd word ...
----- Motor current ...
Code T/K HELP T/K
Output frequency ...
Elapsed time ...
RUN Term +0.00 Hz REM Mains voltage ...
CURRENT FAULT LIST ENT Motor thermal state ...
internal com. link Command Channel ...
----- Channel ref. active ...
-----
-----
-----
Code T/K
Code T/K
[TEST THYRISTORS] is only accessible for ATV61pppM3 u 18.5 kW, ATV61pppN4 drives > 18.5 kW, and all ratings of ATV61pppY drives.
RDY Term +50.00 Hz REM RDY Term +50.00 Hz REM RDY Term +50.00 Hz REM
TEST PROCEDURES ENT THYRISTORS TEST TEST IN PROGRESS
THYRISTORS TEST
ENT
TRANSISTOR TEST 2s
ENT to perform the test
ESC to cancel
T/K
Note: To start the tests, press and hold down (2 s) the ENT key.
(1) Test results for Thyristor 4...12 and IGBT 1B ... 6B are only accessible for ATV61EC90N4 to M14N4 and ATV61EM15Y to M24Y
The [1.11 IDENTIFICATION] menu can only be accessed on the graphic display terminal.
This is a read-only menu that cannot be configured. It enables the following information to be displayed:
• Drive reference, power rating and voltage
• Drive software version
• Drive serial number
• Type of options present, with their software version
Power-up
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ESC
CON-
ENT
ESC
ESC
LAC-
• Replace the current configuration with the factory configuration or a configuration saved previously.
All or part of the current configuration can be replaced: Select a group of parameters in order to select the menus you wish to load
with the selected source configuration.
RUN Term 1250A +50.00 Hz RUN Term 1250A +50.00 Hz Selection of source configuration
1.12 FACTORY SETTINGS Config. Source
Config. Source : Macro-Conf
ENT Macro-Conf
PARAMETER GROUP LIST Config 1
Goto FACTORY SETTINGS Config 2
Save config : No
ESC=abort ENT=validate
T/K
Code Name/Description
This menu contains the parameters selected in the [7 DISPLAY CONFIG.] menu on page 233.
Power-up
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ESC
FCS-
ENT
ESC
ESC
ESC
LAC-
This menu can only be accessed if a Controller Inside card has been inserted. Please refer to the documentation specific to this card.
Power-up
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ESC
USr-
ENT
ESC
ESC
COd-
ESC
LAC-
This menu can only be accessed with the graphic display terminal.
[OPEN]: To download one of the 4 files from the graphic display terminal to the drive.
[SAVE AS]: To download the current configuration from the drive to the graphic display terminal.
RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM
3. OPEN / SAVE AS OPEN DOWNLOAD GROUP
ENT ENT See details on
OPEN File 1 Used None
the next page
SAVE AS File 2 Empty All
File 3 Empty Drive menu
File 4 Empty Motor parameters
Communication
Code << >> T/K Code << >> T/K Code T/K
Prog. control. inside card
Note: Opening an empty
file has no effect. ENT
Code T/K
ENT
ENT
ENT
Saving to a used file
deletes and replaces the RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM
configuration contained in DOWNLOAD
this file.
DONE
Code T/K
• [IN PROGRESS]
• [DONE]
• Error messages if download not possible
• [Motor parameters are NOT COMPATIBLE. Do you want to continue?]: In this case the download is possible, but the parameters will
be restricted.
[DOWNLOAD GROUP]
[None]: No parameters
[All]: All parameters in all menus
[Drive menu]: The entire [1 DRIVE MENU] without [1.9 COMMUNICATION]
and [1.14 PROGRAMMABLE CARD].
[Motor parameters]: [Rated motor power] (nPr) in the [1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-) menu
[Rated motor volt.] (UnS)
[Rated mot. current] (nCr)
[Rated motor freq.] (FrS)
[Rated motor speed] (nSP)
[Auto tuning] (tUn)
[Auto tuning status] (tUS)
[U/F Profile] (PFL)
[U0] (U0) to [U5] (U5)
[F1] (F1) to [F5] (F5)
[V. constant power] (UCP)
[Freq. Const Power] (FCP)
[Nominal I sync.] (nCrS)
[Nom motor spdsync] (nSPS)
[Pole pairs] (PPnS)
[Syn. EMF constant] (PHS)
[Autotune L d-axis] (LdS)
[Autotune L q-axis] (LqS)
[Cust. stator R syn] (rSAS)
[IR compensation] (UFr)
[Slip compensation] (SLP)
The motor parameters that can
be accessed in [Expert] mode,
page 72
[Mot. therm. current] (ItH) in the [1.3 SETTINGS] (SEt-) menu
[Communication]: All the parameters in the [1.9 COMMUNICATION] menu
[Prog. control. inside card]: All the parameters in the [1.14 PROGRAMMABLE CARD] menu
Power-up
ENT
ESC
SIM-
ENT
ESC
COd- PASSWORD
ESC
ESC
LAC-
Enables the configuration to be protected with an access code or a password to be entered in order to access a protected configuration.
• The drive is unlocked when the PIN codes are set to [Unlocked] (OFF) (no password) or when the correct code has been entered. All
menus are visible.
• Before protecting the configuration with an access code, you must:
- Define the [Upload rights] (ULr) and [Download rights] (dLr).
- Make a careful note of the code and keep it in a safe place where you will always be able to find it.
• The drive has 2 access codes, enabling 2 access levels to be set up.
- PIN code 1 is a public unlock code: 6969.
- PIN code 2 is an unlock code known only to Schneider Electric Product Support. It can only be accessed in [Expert] mode.
- Only one PIN1 or PIN2 code can be used – the other must remain set to [OFF] (OFF).
Note: When the unlock code is entered, the user access code appears.
1st access code. The value [OFF] (OFF) indicates that no password has been set [Unlocked]. The value
[ON] (On) indicates that the drive is protected and an access code must be entered in order to unlock it. Once
the correct code has been entered, it remains on the display and the drive is unlocked until the next time the
power supply is disconnected.
- PIN code 1 is a public unlock code: 6969.
When [PIN code 2] (COd2) is not set to OFF, the [1.2 MONITORING] (SUP-) menu is the only one visible. Then
if [PIN code 2] (COd2) is set to OFF (drive unlocked), all menus are visible.
If the display settings are modified in [7 DISPLAY CONFIG.] menu, and if [PIN code 2] (COd2) is not set to
OFF, the visibility configured is kept. Then if [PIN code 2] (COd2) is set to OFF (drive unlocked), the visibility
configured in [7 DISPLAY CONFIG.] menu is kept.
Writes the current configuration to the drive or downloads a configuration to the drive
dLr0 v [Locked drv] (dLr0): A configuration file can only be downloaded to the drive if the drive is protected by an
access code, which is the same as the access code for the configuration to be downloaded.
dLr1 v [Unlock. drv] (dLr1): A configuration file can be downloaded to the drive or a configuration in the drive can
be modified if the drive is unlocked (access code entered) or is not protected by an access code.
v [not allowed] (dLr2): Download not authorized.
dLr2 v [Lock/unlock] (dLr3): Combination of [Locked drv] (dLr0) and [Unlock. drv] (dLr1).
dLr3
This menu can only be accessed with the graphic display terminal.
This can be used to configure the information displayed on the graphic display screen during operation.
[6.1 PARAM. BAR SELECT]: Selection of 1 to 2 parameters displayed on the top line (the first 2 cannot be modified).
[6.2. MONITOR SCREEN TYPE]: Selection of parameters displayed in the centre of the screen and the display mode (values in digita
or bar graph format).
[6.3. COM. MAP CONFIG.]: Selection of the words displayed and their format.
Name/Description
Select the parameter using ENT (a then appears next to the parameter). Parameter(s) can also be deselected using ENT.
1 or 2 parameters can be selected.
Example:
Name/Description
Select the parameter(s) using ENT (a then appears next to the parameter). Parameter(s) can also be deselected using ENT.
PARAMETER SELECTION
MONITORING
---------
---------
---------
---------
Examples:
RUN Term +35.00 Hz REM RUN Term +35.00 Hz REM RUN Term +35.00 Hz REM
Motor speed Min Motor speed max MONITORING
0 1,250 rpm 1,500 Frequency ref. : 50.1 Hz
1,250 rpm Motor current : 80 A
Motor current Min Motor current max Motor speed : 1,250 rpm
0 80 A 150 Motor thermal state : 80%
80 A Drv thermal state : 80%
T/K T/K T/K
Name/Description
M [Format word 1]
Format of word 1.
v [Hex]: Hexadecimal
v [Signed]: Decimal with sign
v [Unsigned]: Decimal without sign
M [Word 2 add. select.]
Select the address of the word to be displayed by pressing the <<, >> (F2 and F3) keys and rotating the navigation button.
M [Format word 2]
Format of word 2.
v [Hex]: Hexadecimal
v [Signed]: Decimal with sign
v [Unsigned]: Decimal without sign
M [Word 3 add. select.]
Select the address of the word to be displayed by pressing the <<, >> (F2 and F3) keys and rotating the navigation button.
M [Format word 3]
Format of word 3.
v [Hex]: Hexadecimal
v [Signed]: Decimal with sign
v [Unsigned]: Decimal without sign
M [Word 4 add. select.]
Select the address of the word to be displayed by pressing the <<, >> (F2 and F3) keys and rotating the navigation button.
M [Format word 4]
Format of word 4.
v [Hex]: Hexadecimal
v [Signed]: Decimal with sign
v [Unsigned]: Decimal without sign
It will then be possible to view the selected words in the [COMMUNICATION MAP] submenu of the [1.2 MONITORING] menu.
Example:
This menu can only be accessed with the graphic display terminal. It can be used to customize parameters or a menu and to access
parameters.
7.3 PARAMETER ACCESS: Customization of the visibility and protection mechanisms of menus and parameters.
7.4 KEYPAD PARAMETERS: Adjustment of the contrast and stand-by mode of the graphic display terminal (parameters stored in the
terminal rather than in the drive). Choice of the menu displayed on power up.
If [Return std name] = [Yes] the display reverts to standard but the custom settings remain stored.
Delete
ENT
RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM If no custom settings have
Ramp increment ENT User name been made, the
User name 1. DRIVE MENU standard value appears
Unit FLOW REFERENCE
(names, units, etc.).
Multiplier
Divisor
Offset Nb characters max. 13
Display on 1 or 2 lines of
ABC << >> characters
Offsets and coefficients are Use F1 to change to ABC, abc, 123, *[-.
numerical values. Do not Use the navigation selector button to increment the character
use too high a multiplier (alphabetical order) and << and >> (F2 and F3) to switch to the
(99,999 – max display). next or previous character respectively.
Once you have entered the unit, if you press ENT, the Ramp
increment screen will re-appear in order to display the name.
Press ESC to return to Unit.
Names (USER MENU NAME, DRIVE NAME, configuration, serial no., lines of messages,
RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM names of units, etc.) are customized as in the example of the parameter name shown opposite.
USER MENU NAME If no custom settings have been made, the standard value appears (names, units, etc.).
1. DRIVE MENU Display on 1 or 2 lines of characters.
FLOW REFERENCE
Use F1 to change to ABC, abc, 123, *[-.
Use the navigation selector button to increment the character (alphabetical order) and << and >>
Nb characters max. 18
(F2 and F3) to switch to the next or previous character respectively.
ABC << >> T/K
RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM PARAMETER SELECTION PARAMETER SELECTION Selection of parameters
7.2 USER MENU ENT 1 DRIVE MENU 1.3 SETTINGS included in the user menu
PARAMETER SELECTION 1.1 SIMPLY START Ramp increment
SELECTED LIST 1.2 MONITORING ENT Acceleration
1.3 SETTINGS Deceleration
1.4 MOTOR CONTROL Acceleration 2
1.5 INPUTS / OUTPUTS CFG Deceleration 2
Code << >> T/K Code << >> T/K List
Delete Up Down
Delete Up Down
RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM RDY Term +0.00 Hz REM IMPORTANT: The protected channel (or channels) must be
PROTECTION PROTECTED CHANNELS
selected, as a protected parameter on a selected channel
PROTECTED CHANNELS HMI
ENT remains accessible on the channels that are not selected.
PROTECTED PARAMS POWERSUITE
MODBUS
CANopen
COM. CARD
Code T/K Code T/K
PROG. CARD
PROTECTED PARAMS
1.7 APPLICATION FUNCT.
REF. OPERATIONS
RAMP
STOP CONFIGURATION
AUTO DC INJECTION PROTECTED PARAMS
ENT
JOG JOG
JOG
Jog frequency
Jog delay
Note: The protected parameters are no longer accessible and are not, therefore, displayed for the selected channels.
Configures and adjusts the stand-by mode of the graphic display unit.
v [No]: No stand-by mode.
v [1] to [10]: Adjusts the time during which the terminal is to remain idle before stand-by mode is triggered, in minutes.
After this idle time, the display backlight turns off and the contrast is reduced. The screen returns to normal operation when a
key or the navigation button is pressed. It also returns to normal operation if the terminal exits the normal display mode, for
example, if a fault occurs.
Communication is possible between a graphic display terminal and a number of drives connected on the same bus. The addresses of the
drives must be configured in advance in the [1.9 COMMUNICATION] menu using the [Modbus Address] (Add) parameter, page 215.
When a number of drives are connected to the same display terminal, the terminal automatically displays the following screens:
CONNECTION IN PROGRESS
Vxxxxxx
ENT
MULTI-POINT ADDRESSES Selection of drives for multipoint dialog (select each address and check it by pressing
Address 1 ENT).
Address 2 This screen only appears when making a connection for the first time or if the "Cfg
Address 3
Add" button is pressed in the MULTIPOINT SCREEN below.
Address 4
Address 5
Address 6
ESC
MULTIPOINT SCREEN
ESC
RUN +952 Rpm 101 A 3
Rdy 0 Rpm 0A 2 Motor speed Selection of a drive for multipoint dialog.
ENT
RUN +952 Rpm 101 A 3
NLP +1500 Rpm 1250 A 4 +952 rpm
Not connected 5 Motor current
Rdy + 0 Rpm 0A 6
101 A
Cfg Add HOME T/K
Cfg Add
All menus can be accessed in multipoint mode. Only drive control via the graphic display terminal is not authorized, apart from
the Stop key, which locks all the drives.
If there is a fault on a drive, this drive is displayed.
Servicing
The Altivar 61 does not require any preventive maintenance. It is nevertheless advisable to perform the following regularly:
• Check the condition and tightness of the connections.
• Ensure that the temperature around the unit remains at an acceptable level and that ventilation is effective (average service life of
fans: 3 to 5 years depending on the operating conditions).
• Remove any dust from the drive.
The first fault detected is saved and displayed, and the drive locks.
The drive switching to fault mode can be indicated remotely via a logic output or a relay, which can be configured in the [1.5 INPUTS /
OUTPUTS CFG] (I-O-) menu, see, for example, [R1 CONFIGURATION] (r1-) page 94.
AI2F [AI2 input] • Non-conforming signal on analog • Check the wiring of analog input AI2 and the value of the
input AI2 signal
• If necessary, modify the fault configuration via [AI2 4-20mA
loss] (LFL2), page 200
bOF [DBR overload] • The braking resistor is under excessive • Check the size of the resistor and wait for it to cool down
stress • Check the [DB Resistor Power] (brP) and [DB Resistor value]
(brU) parameters, page 206.
bUF [DB unit sh. Circuit] • Short-circuit output from braking unit • Check the wiring of the braking unit and the resistor
• Braking unit not connected • Check the braking resistor
• The monitoring of this fault must be disabled by the [Brake
res. fault Mgt] (bUb) parameter, page 206 if there is no
braking unit or resistor connected to the drive, at and above
55 kW (75 HP) for ATV61HpppM3X and at and above 90 kW
(120 HP) for ATV61HpppN4.
CrF1 [Precharge] • Load relay control fault or charging • Switch the drive off and then back on again
resistor damaged • Check the internal connections
• DC bus charging fault (thyristors) • Inspect/repair the drive
CrF2 [Thyr. soft charge]
[Differential curent • Current difference between power • Check thyristor with [TEST THYRISTORS]
dCF Fault] block A and B (ATV61EC60 ... M14N4 • Check IGBT with [TRANSISTOR TEST]
or ATVEM15...M24Y only) • Check current transformer
EEF1 [Control Eeprom] • Internal memory fault, control card • Check the environment (electromagnetic compatibility)
• Turn off, reset, return to factory settings
• Inspect/repair the drive
EEF2 [Power Eeprom] • Internal memory fault, power card
EnF [Encoder] • Encoder feedback fault • Check [Number of pulses] (PGI) and [Encoder type] (EnS)
page 73
• Check that the encoder's mechanical and electrical
operation, its power supply and connections are all correct
• If necessary, reverse the direction of rotation of the motor
([Output Ph rotation] (PHr) parameter, page 66) or the
encoder signals
FCF1 [Out. contact. • The output contactor remains closed • Check the contactor and its wiring
stuck] although the opening conditions have • Check the feedback circuit
been met
Fd2 [Damper open] • The damper remains open although • Check the damper and its wiring
the closing conditions have been met • Check the feedback circuit
• Check the time delay for the function, page 172
HdF [IGBT • Short-circuit or grounding at the drive • Check the cables connecting the drive to the motor, and the
desaturation] output insulation of the motor
• Perform the diagnostic tests via the [1.10 DIAGNOSTICS]
menu.
InF4 [Internal MFG area] • Internal data inconsistent • Recalibrate the drive (performed by Schneider Electric
Product Support)
InF6 [Internal-option] • The option installed in the drive is not • Check the reference and compatibility of the option
recognized
InF7 [Internal-hard init.] • Initialization of the drive is incomplete • Turn off and reset
InF8 [Internal-ctrl • The control power supply is incorrect • Check the control section power supply
supply]
InF9 [Internal- • The current measurements are incorrect • Replace the current sensors or the power card
I measure] • Inspect/repair the drive
InFA [Internal-mains • The input stage is not operating • Perform the diagnostic tests via the [1.10 DIAGNOSTICS]
circuit] correctly menu.
• Inspect/repair the drive
InFb [Internal- th. • The drive temperature sensor is not • Replace the temperature sensor
sensor] operating correctly • Inspect/repair the drive
• The braking unit's temperature sensor • Replace the braking unit's temperature sensor
is not operating correctly • Inspect/repair the braking unit
• The monitoring of this fault must be disabled by the [Brake
res. fault Mgt] (bUb) parameter, page 206 if there is no
braking unit connected to the drive
InFC [Internal-time • Fault on the electronic time • Inspect/repair the drive
meas.] measurement component
InFE [internal- CPU] • Internal microprocessor fault • Turn off and reset. Inspect/repair the drive
OCF [Overcurrent] • Parameters in the [SETTINGS] (SEt-) • Check the parameters
and [1.4 MOTOR CONTROL] (drC-) • Check the size of the motor/drive/load
menus are not correct • Check the state of the mechanism
• Inertia or load too high
• Mechanical locking
PrF [Power removal] • Fault with the drive’s “Power removal” • Inspect/repair the drive
safety function
SCF1 [Motor short circuit] • Short-circuit or grounding at the drive • Check the cables connecting the drive to the motor, and the
output insulation of the motor
SCF2 [Impedant sh. • Perform the diagnostic tests via the [1.10 DIAGNOSTICS]
circuit] menu.
SCF3 [Ground short • Significant earth leakage current at • Reduce the switching frequency
circuit] the drive output if several motors are • Connect chokes in series with the motor
connected in parallel • Check the adjustment of speed loop and brake
SOF [Overspeed] • Instability or driving load too high • Check the motor, gain and stability parameters
• Add a braking resistor
• Check the size of the motor/drive/load
• Check the parameter settings for the [FREQUENCY
METER] (FqF-) function, page 205, if it is configured
SPF [Speed fdback • Encoder feedback signal missing • Check the wiring between the encoder and the drive
loss] • Check the encoder
• No signal on "Pulse input", if the input is • Check the wiring of the input and the detector used
used for speed measurement
tnF [Auto-tuning] • Special motor or motor whose power • Check that the motor/drive are compatible
is not suitable for the drive •
• Motor not connected to the drive • Check that the motor is present during auto-tuning
• If an output contactor is being used, close it during auto-
tuning
Faults that can be reset with the automatic restart function, after the cause has disappeared
These faults can also be reset by turning on and off or by means of a logic input or control bit ([Fault reset] (rSF) parameter, page 190).
APF, CnF, COF, EPF1, EPF2, FCF2, Fd1, LFF2, LFF3, LFF4, nFF, ObF, OHF, OLC, OLF, OPF1, OPF2, OSF, OtF1, OtF2, OtFL, PHF,
PtF1, PtF2, PtFL, SLF1, SLF2, SLF3, SPIF, SSF, tJF, and ULF faults can be inhibited and cleared remotely by means of a logic input or
control bit ([Fault inhibit assign.] (InH) parameter, page 201).
APF [Application fault] • Controller Inside card fault • Please refer to the card documentation
CnF [Com. network] • Communication fault on • Check the environment (electromagnetic compatibility)
communication card • Check the wiring
• Check the time-out
• Replace the option card
• Inspect/repair the drive
COF [CAN com.] • Interruption in communication on the • Check the communication bus
CANopen bus • Check the time-out
• Refer to the CANopen User's Manual
EPF1 [External flt-LI/Bit] • Fault triggered by an external device, • Check the device, which caused the fault, and reset
depending on user
EPF2 [External fault • Fault triggered by a communication • Check for the cause of the fault and reset
com.] network
FCF2 [Out. contact. • The output contactor remains open • Check the contactor and its wiring
open.] although the closing conditions have • Check the feedback circuit
been met.
Fd1 [Damper stuck] • The damper remains closed although • Check the damper and its wiring
the opening conditions have been met • Check the feedback circuit
• Check the time delay for the function, page 172
LCF [input contactor] • The drive is not turned on even though • Check the contactor and its wiring
[Mains V. time out] (LCt) has elapsed. • Check the time-out
• Check the line/contactor/drive connection
LFF2 [AI2 4-20mA loss] • Loss of the 4-20 mA reference on • Check the connection on the analog inputs
analog input AI2, AI3 or AI4 • If necessary, modify the fault configuration via [AIx 4-20mA
LFF3 [AI3 4-20mA loss] loss] (LFLx), page 200
Faults that can be reset with the automatic restart function, after the cause has disappeared
(continued)
OPF2 [3 motor phase loss] • Motor not connected or motor • Check the connections from the drive to the motor
power too low • If an output contactor is being used, parameterize [Output
• Output contactor open Phase Loss] (OPL) = [Output cut] (OAC), page 194
• Instantaneous instability in the • Test on a low power motor or without a motor: In factory
motor current settings mode, motor phase loss detection is active [Output
Phase Loss] (OPL) = [Yes] (YES). To check the drive in
a test or maintenance environment, without having to use
a motor with the same rating as the drive (in particular for high
power drives), deactivate motor phase loss detection [Output
Phase Loss] (OPL) = [No] (nO)
• Check and optimize the [IR compensation] (UFr) page 71,
[Rated motor volt.] (UnS) and [Rated mot. current] (nCr)
parameters, page 64, and perform [Auto tuning] (tUn),
page 66.
OSF [Mains overvoltage] • Line voltage too high • Check the line voltage
• Disturbed line supply
OtF1 [PTC1 overheat] • Overheating of the PTC1 probes • Check the motor load and motor size
detected • Check the motor ventilation
• Overheating of the PTC2 probes • Wait for the motor to cool before restarting
OtF2 [PTC2 overheat]
detected • Check the type and state of the PTC probes
The USF fault can be inhibited and cleared remotely by means of a logic input or control bit ([Fault inhibit assign.] (InH) parameter,
page 201).
CFF [Incorrect config.] • changed or removed • Check that there are no card errors.
• In the event of the option card being changed/removed
deliberately, see the remarks below
• The current configuration is
inconsistent • Return to factory settings or retrieve the backup
configuration, if it is valid (see page 222)
CFI [Invalid config.] • Invalid configuration • Check the configuration loaded previously
The configuration loaded in the drive • Load a compatible configuration
via the bus or communication network
is inconsistent.
HCF [Cards pairing] • The [CARDS PAIRING] (PPI-) • In the event of a card error, reinsert the original card
function, page 207, has been • Confirm the configuration by entering the [Pairing password]
configured and a drive card has (PPI) if the card was changed deliberately
been changed
PHF [Input phase loss] • Drive incorrectly supplied or a fuse • Check the power connection and the fuses.
blown
• Failure of one phase
• 3-phase ATV61 used on a single- • Use a 3-phase line.
phase line supply
• Unbalanced load • Disable the fault by [Input phase loss] (IPL) = [No] (nO).
This protection only operates with the (page 195)
drive on load
PrtF [Power Ident] • The [Power Identification] (Prt) • Enter the correct parameter (reserved for Schneider Electric
parameter, page 72, is incorrect. product support).
• Control card replaced by a control • Check that there are no card errors.
card configured on a drive with • In the event of the control card being changed deliberately,
a different rating see the remarks below
USF [Undervoltage] • Line supply too low • Check the voltage and the parameters of
• Transient voltage dip [UNDERVOLTAGE MGT] (USb-), page 198
• Damaged pre-charge resistor • Replace the pre-charge resistor
• Inspect/repair the drive
Code Page
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
[1.2 MONITORING]
[1.6 COMMAND]
[4 PASSWORD]
[1.3 SETTINGS]
(SIM-)
(SUP-)
(SEt-)
(drC-)
(I-O-)
(CtL-)
(FUn-)
(FLt-)
(COM-)
(FCS-)
(COd-)
A1C- 107
A2C- 107
A3C- 107
AC2 48 131 144
153
ACC 37 48 129
AdC 135
AdCO 215
Add 215
AI1A 45 85
AI1E 85
AI1F 85
AI1S 85
AI1t 85
AI2A 45 86
AI2E 86
AI2F 86
AI2L 86
AI2S 86
AI2t 86
AI3A 45 87
AI3E 87
AI3F 87
AI3L 87
AI3S 87
AI3t 87
AI4A 45 88
AI4E 88
AI4F 88
AI4L 88
AI4S 88
AI4t 88
AICI 89 151
AFE 185
ALGr 46
AMOA 215
Code Page
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
[1.2 MONITORING]
[1.6 COMMAND]
[4 PASSWORD]
[1.3 SETTINGS]
(SIM-)
(SUP-)
(SEt-)
(drC-)
(I-O-)
(CtL-)
(FUn-)
(FLt-)
(COM-)
(FCS-)
(COd-)
AMOC 215
AO1 103
AO1F 104
AO1t 103
AO2 105
AO2F 105
AO2t 105
AO3 106
AO3F 106
AO3t 106
AOH1 103
AOH2 105
AOH3 106
AOL1 103
AOL2 105
AOL3 106
ASH1 104
ASH2 105
ASH3 106
ASL1 104
ASL2 105
ASL3 106
Atr 191
AUt 66
bbA 78
bdCO 215
bFr 35 64
brA 132
brO 206
brP 206
brU 206
bSP 83
bUb 206
CCFG 34
CCS 118
Cd1 118
Code Page
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
[1.2 MONITORING]
[1.6 COMMAND]
[4 PASSWORD]
[1.3 SETTINGS]
(SIM-)
(SUP-)
(SEt-)
(drC-)
(I-O-)
(CtL-)
(FUn-)
(FLt-)
(COM-)
(FCS-)
(COd-)
Cd2 118
CFG 34
CFPS 46
CHA1 174
CHA2 174
CHCF 117
CHI 183
CHM 179
CHt 62 183
CL2 54 166
CLI 54 75 166
CLL 202
CLO- 46
CnF1 179
CnF2 179
CnFS 46
COd 228
COd2 228
COL 202
COP 119
CrH2 86
CrH3 87
CrH4 88
CrL2 86
CrL3 87
CrL4 88
CSt 228
Ctd 59
CtdL 59
Ctt 67
dA2 128
dA3 128
dAM 172
dAS 170
dbS 170
dCF 52 133 212
FFd
Fdt
FdL
FCP
F2d
EtF
EPL
EnU
EnS
EnC
EIL
EFr
EFI
dSP
dSI
dO1
dLr
dFL
dFb
dEC
dE2
dCO
dCI
FCSI
Fbtd
F2dL
ErCO
dO1S
dO1H
dO1d
Code
37
(SIM-)
[1.2 MONITORING]
(SUP-)
[1.3 SETTINGS]
62
59
59
62
48
48
Index of parameter codes
(SEt-)
69
69
69
68
68
68
74
73
74
(drC-)
93
92
92
93
93
93
100
100
100
100
(I-O-)
[1.6 COMMAND]
(CtL-)
Page
162
172
142
144
183
172
129
144
184
134
131,
(FUn-)
205
211
197
197
(FLt-)
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
215
(COM-)
222
(FCS-)
[4 PASSWORD]
228
(COd-)
1760649 12/2009
Index of parameter codes
Code Page
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
[1.2 MONITORING]
[1.6 COMMAND]
[4 PASSWORD]
[1.3 SETTINGS]
(SIM-)
(SUP-)
(SEt-)
(drC-)
(I-O-)
(CtL-)
(FUn-)
(FLt-)
(COM-)
(FCS-)
(COd-)
FFt 60 133
FLI 146
FLO 216
FLOC 216
FLOt 216
FLr 192
FLU 55 146
FPI 153
FqA 205
FqC 205
FqF 205
FqL 59
FqS 44, 46
Fr1 117
Fr1b 127
Fr2 118
FrH 46
FrS 35 64
FrSS 70
Frt 131
FrY- 222
FSt 133
Ftd 59
FtdL 59
FtO 62 210
FtU 61 209
GFS 222
HSP 37 49
IdA 72
IdC 52 134 212
IdC2 52 134 212
IdM 72
InH 201
InHr 201
InHS 201
Inr 48 129
Code Page
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
[1.2 MONITORING]
[1.6 COMMAND]
[4 PASSWORD]
[1.3 SETTINGS]
(SIM-)
(SUP-)
(SEt-)
(drC-)
(I-O-)
(CtL-)
(FUn-)
(FLt-)
(COM-)
(FCS-)
(COd-)
IntP 164
IPHr 46
IPL 35 195
IPr 46
ItH 37 49
JF2 61
JF3 61
JFH 61
JGF 55 137
JGt 55 137
JOG 137
JPF 61
L1A to L14A 45 81
L1d to L14d 81
LC2 166
LCr 46
LCt 168
LdS 70
LES 168
LEt 197
LFA 72
LFd 62 162
LFF 155 212
LFL2 200
LFL3
LFL4
LFM 72
LIS1 45
LIS2 45
LLC 168
LnS 181
LO1 98
LO1d 98
LO1H 98
LO1S 98
LO2 98
Code Page
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
[1.2 MONITORING]
[1.6 COMMAND]
[4 PASSWORD]
[1.3 SETTINGS]
(SIM-)
(SUP-)
(SEt-)
(drC-)
(I-O-)
(CtL-)
(FUn-)
(FLt-)
(COM-)
(FCS-)
(COd-)
LO2d 98
LO2H 98
LO2S 98
LO3 99
LO3d 99
LO3H 99
LO3S 99
LO4 99
LO4d 99
LO4H 99
LO4S 99
LOC 62 210
LPI 58 155
LqS 70
LSP 37 49 158
LUL 61 209
LUn 61 209
MA2 128
MA3 128
MFr 46
MMF 44, 46
MPI 155
nCA1 214
nCA2 214
nCA3 214
nCA4 214
nCA5 214
nCA6 214
nCA7 214
nCA8 214
nCr 35 64
nCrS 70
nFd 162
nFFt 62 181
nFS 181
nFSt 62 181
nSPS
nMA8
nMA7
nMA6
nMA5
nMA4
nMA3
nMA2
nMA1
Code
35
35
(SIM-)
[1.2 MONITORING]
46
46
46
46
46
46
46
46
(SUP-)
[1.3 SETTINGS]
58
57
57
65
64
Index of parameter codes
(SEt-)
68
75
70
72
76
(drC-)
90
90
(I-O-)
[1.6 COMMAND]
(CtL-)
Page
152
153
152
152
170
133
(FUn-)
194
194
195
194
210
(FLt-)
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
214
214
214
214
214
214
214
214
(COM-)
[4 PASSWORD]
(COd-)
1760649 12/2009
Index of parameter codes
Code Page
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
[1.2 MONITORING]
[1.6 COMMAND]
[4 PASSWORD]
[1.3 SETTINGS]
(SIM-)
(SUP-)
(SEt-)
(drC-)
(I-O-)
(CtL-)
(FUn-)
(FLt-)
(COM-)
(FCS-)
(COd-)
PGA 93
PGI 73 93
PHS 70
PHr 36 66
PIA 90
PIC 152
PIF 151
PIF1 151
PIF2 151
PII 151
PIL 90
PIM 153
PIP1 151
PIP2 151
PIS 152
POH 57 152
POL 57 152
PPI 207
PPn 72
PPnS 70
Pr2 156
Pr4 156
PrP 57 152
Prt 72
PS1- 174
PS2- 175
PS3- 175
PS2 139
PS4 139
PS8 139
PSr 58 153
PSt 117
PtC1 189
PtC2 189
PtCL 189
PtH 46
rPO
rPI
rPG
rPF
rPE
rPC
rPA
rP4
rP3
rP2
rIn
rIG
rFr
rFC
rdG
rCb
rCA
r4S
r4H
r4d
r3S
r3H
r3d
r2S
r2H
r2d
r1S
r1H
r1d
rMUd
rCHt
Code
[1.2 MONITORING]
46
46
46
46
46
(SUP-)
[1.3 SETTINGS]
57
58
58
58
61
57
57
62
Index of parameter codes
(SEt-)
97
97
97
97
97
97
97
97
96
96
96
96
96
96
96
94
(I-O-)
[1.6 COMMAND]
117
118
(CtL-)
Page
151
151
156
156
156
152
152
183
127
170
(FUn-)
190
190
209
(FLt-)
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
(COM-)
[4 PASSWORD]
(COd-)
1760649 12/2009
Index of parameter codes
Code Page
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
[1.2 MONITORING]
[1.6 COMMAND]
[4 PASSWORD]
[1.3 SETTINGS]
(SIM-)
(SUP-)
(SEt-)
(drC-)
(I-O-)
(CtL-)
(FUn-)
(FLt-)
(COM-)
(FCS-)
(COd-)
rPS 131
rPt 129
rrS 80
rSA 72
rSAS 70
rSF 190
rSL 158
rSM 72
rSMS 70
rtd 60
rtdL 60
rtH 46
SA2 128
SA3 128
SAt 196
SCSI 222
SdC1 53 135
SdC2 53 135
SFC 49
SFr 54 75
SIt 49
SLE 55 158
SLL 202
SLP 52 71
SOP 76
SP2 56 140
SP3 56 140
SP4 56 140
SP5 56 140
SP6 56 140
SP7 56 140
SP8 56 140
SPd 46
SPG 49
SPM 145
Code Page
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
[1.2 MONITORING]
[1.6 COMMAND]
[4 PASSWORD]
[1.3 SETTINGS]
(SIM-)
(SUP-)
(SEt-)
(drC-)
(I-O-)
(CtL-)
(FUn-)
(FLt-)
(COM-)
(FCS-)
(COd-)
Srb 61 209,
210
SrP 57 144
SSb 203
StM 199
StO 203
StP 198
Str 142
Strt 199
Stt 133
SUL 76
tA1 48 130
tA2 48 130
tA3 48 130
tA4 49 130
tAA 164
tAC 46
tAr 191
tbr 215
tbr2 215
tbS 199
tCC 34 80
tCd 172
tCt 80
tdI 52 134 212
tdC 52 134 212
tdC1 53 135
tdC2 53 136
tdS 205
tFO 215
tFO2 215
tFr 35 65
tHA 195,
196
tHb 46
tHd 46
UFr
UCP
UdL
UCb
UC2
Ubr
tUS
tUn
tUL
ttO
ttL
ttH
ttd
tSM
trM
trA
tPI
tOL
tOd
tLS
tLC
tLA
tHt
tHr
ttd3
ttd2
tLIM
tLIG
Code
1760649 12/2009
[1.1 SIMPLY START]
36
36
(SIM-)
[1.2 MONITORING]
46
(SUP-)
[1.3 SETTINGS]
52
59
59
60
58
55
59
59
Index of parameter codes
(SEt-)
71
69
69
78
69
69
68
68
68
68
66
66
72
72
(drC-)
[1.6 COMMAND]
(CtL-)
Page
179
155
172
158
164
164
165
164
(FUn-)
209
192
215
196
196
196
199
210
194
194,
194,
194,
(FLt-)
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
(COM-)
[4 PASSWORD]
(COd-)
261
262
USt
USP
USL
USI
USb
UPP
UPL
UOP
UnS
ULt
ULr
ULn
UrES
UOL3
UOL2
UOL1
UOH3
UOH2
UOH1
UIL4
UIL2
UIL1
UIH4
UIH2
UIH1
Code
35
(SIM-)
[1.2 MONITORING]
46
46
(SUP-)
[1.3 SETTINGS]
64
Index of parameter codes
(SEt-)
88
86
85
88
86
85
106
105
103
106
105
103
(I-O-)
[1.6 COMMAND]
(CtL-)
Page
142
144
159
(FUn-)
198
198
198
198
199
209
(FLt-)
[1.9 COMMUNICATION]
(COM-)
[4 PASSWORD]
228
(COd-)
1760649 12/2009
ATV61_programming_manual_EN_1760649_07
1760649 12/2009
Product Data Sheet VW3A1102
REMOTE MOUNTING KIT FOR LCD
KEYPAD:ATV61/71
Technical
Characteristics
As standards, specifications, and designs change from time to time, please ask for confirmation of the information given in this document.
The Type T units are designed for the global market and are the best choice when size and cost are of concern. This is
our most popular and complete offering of industrial control transformers, and includes the following features:
• 50/60 Hz rated
Customer installed accessories (finger-safe covers, fuse blocks, fuse clips)
• Type T transformers are designed with the various temperature classes:
50–150 VA with a 55° C temperature rise, 105° C insulation
200–350 VA with a 80° C temperature rise, 130° C insulation
500–5000 VA with a 115° C temperature rise, 180° C insulation
Square D manufactures a wide variety of voltage combinations for control transformers. The voltage combinations are
expressed as “Voltage Codes” and these codes are embedded within the catalog number of the transformer. Standard
codes are listed, if the voltage combination you require is not listed, call your Square D Distributor for assistance.
Key to Price Column
Headings Type T
Voltage Code D1 D31 D5 D37 D24 D55 D3 D4 D51 D60
UL/CSA/
Primary Voltages NOM CE VA Type 240 x 480 240 x 480 600 600 120 120 x 240 208 277 208/277 277
Secondary Voltages VA 120 120/240 120 120/240 120 120/240 120 120 120 120/240
Key for Dimensions & Accessory I I I I I I I I I I
25 25 T25 $ 34.70 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a
50 50 T50 36.50 $ 59.00 $ 42.40 $147.00 $147.00 $147.00 $ 42.40 $ 42.40 $147.00 $147.00
75 75 T75 43.30 62.00 51.00 153.00 153.00 153.00 51.00 51.00 153.00 153.00
100 100 T100 48.50 65.00 57.00 154.00 154.00 154.00 57.00 57.00 154.00 154.00
150 150 T150 52.00 86.00 72.00 164.00 164.00 164.00 72.00 72.00 164.00 164.00
200 200 T200 64.00 111.00 92.00 224.00 224.00 224.00 92.00 92.00 224.00 224.00
250 160 T250 75.00 117.00 114.00 225.00 225.00 225.00 114.00 114.00 225.00 225.00
300 200 T300 83.00 137.00 117.00 227.00 227.00 227.00 117.00 117.00 227.00 227.00
350 250 T350 88.00 143.00 136.00 228.00 228.00 228.00 136.00 136.00 228.00 228.00
500 300 T500 110.00 160.00 148.00 235.00 235.00 235.00 148.00 148.00 235.00 235.00
750 500 T750 152.00 223.00 209.00 264.00 264.00 264.00 209.00 209.00 264.00 264.00
1000 630 T1000 184.00 263.00 263.00 280.00 280.00 280.00 263.00 263.00 280.00 280.00
1500 1000 T1500 263.00 385.00 368.00 404.00 404.00 404.00 368.00 368.00 404.00 404.00
2000 1500 T2000 320.00 427.00 427.00 438.00 438.00 438.00 427.00 427.00 438.00 438.00
3000 2000 T3000 444.00 701.00 602.00 749.00 749.00 749.00 602.00 602.00 749.00 749.00
5000 3000 T5000 746.00 948.00 948.00 948.00 948.00 948.00 948.00 948.00 948.00 948.00
Type T
UL/CSA/ D2 D59 D13 D23 D54 D14 D25 D36
NOM CE VA Type 240 x 480 240 x 480 120 120/240 120/240 208 277 600
VA 24 12/24 12/24 24 12/24 24 24 12/24
I I I I I I I I
50 50 T50 $ 42.40 $147.00 $ 42.40 $ 42.40 $147.00 $ 42.40 $147.00 $147.00
75 75 T75 51.00 153.00 51.00 51.00 153.00 51.00 153.00 153.00
100 100 T100 57.00 154.00 57.00 57.00 154.00 57.00 154.00 154.00
150 150 T150 72.00 164.00 72.00 72.00 164.00 72.00 164.00 164.00
200 200 T200 92.00 224.00 92.00 92.00 224.00 92.00 224.00 224.00
250 160 T250 114.00 225.00 114.00 114.00 225.00 114.00 225.00 225.00
300 200 T300 117.00 227.00 117.00 117.00 227.00 117.00 227.00 227.00
350 250 T350 136.00 228.00 136.00 136.00 228.00 136.00 228.00 228.00
500 300 T500 148.00 235.00 148.00 148.00 235.00 148.00 235.00 235.00
750 500 T750 a 209.00 264.00 209.00 209.00 264.00 209.00 264.00 264.00
1000 630 T1000 a 263.00 280.00 263.00 263.00 280.00 263.00 280.00 280.00
Type T
D15 D12 D22 D62
UL/CSA/NOM CE VA Type 240 x 480 480 480 600
VA 24/120 240 277 240
I I I I
50 50 T50 $ 42.40 $ 42.40 $147.00 $147.00
75 75 T75 51.00 153.00 153.00 153.00
100 100 T100 65.00 57.00 154.00 154.00
150 150 T150 72.00 72.00 164.00 164.00
200 200 T200 92.00 92.00 224.00 224.00
250 160 T250 117.00 114.00 225.00 225.00
300 200 T300 137.00 117.00 227.00 227.00
350 250 T350 143.00 136.00 228.00 228.00
500 300 T500 160.00 148.00 235.00 235.00
750 500 T750 223.00 209.00 264.00 264.00
1000 630 T1000 263.00 263.00 280.00 280.00
1500 1000 T1500 385.00 368.00 404.00 404.00
2000 1500 T2000 427.00 427.00 438.00 438.00
TRANSFORMERS
OPERATOR INTERFACE
Legend plate and contact block not included unless noted.
17
KA2 #2
KA2
Side 2
#2 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1
Side 1
KA3
KA3
#1 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 1
Operator Locating KA1
or KA1 or
Notch #1
KA2
Top View KA2
#1 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 0
Contact blocks and legend plate not included unless otherwise noted.
PUSH BUTTONS AND
Full Guard
Black SKR3BH13 54.00 SKR3BH5 SKR3BH6 39.90 SKR3B 25.70
Red SKR3RH13 54.00 SKR3RH5 SKR3RH6 39.90 SKR3R 25.70
Green SKR3GH13 54.00 SKR3GH5 SKR3GH6 39.90 SKR3G 25.70
Universal a SKR3UH13 54.00 SKR3UH5 SKR3UH6 39.90 SKR3U 25.70
9001SKR3B
No Guard Other b SKR3bH13 54.00 SKR3bH5 SKR3bH6 39.90 SKR3b 25.70
Push-To-Test 220–240 V, 50–60 Hz Transformer SKT7R31 SKT7G31 SKT7b 131. SKT7 123.
Pilot Light
(Non-metallic 24–28 Vac/dc Full Voltage SKT35R31 SKT35G31 SKT35b 111. SKT35 105.
fresnel color Transformer, Flashing or LEDc SKTaR31 SKTaG31 SKTab 131. SKTa 123.
cap shown) For other voltages
see Table a Full Voltage, Neon or Resistord SKTaR31 SKTaG31 SKTab 111. SKTa 105.
9001SKT1
120 Vac Only Resistor SKTR38R31 SKTR38G31 SKTR38b 131. SKTR38 123.
Remote Test
Pilot Light 24–28 Vac Only Full Voltage SKTR35R31 SKTR35G31 SKTR35b 131. SKTR35 123.
(Non-metallic
fresnel color For other voltages
cap shown) Full Voltage or Resistor e SKTRaR31 SKTRaG31 SKTRab 131. SKTRa 123.
see Tables abe
9001SKTR38
Intrinsically safe equipment must not release electrical or thermal energy capable
of igniting certain explosive or combustible hazardous atmospheres, for which the
equipment has been tested.
These pilot lights are intrinsically safe when used with suitable approved barrier or
barrier relay. These pilot lights are Factory Mutual (FM) approved. Consult your
local Square D sales office for further details. KP44Y
These pilot lights are fully encapsulated—there are no replaceable parts—except KP44R KP44G (Yellow 119. ... ...
for the SK40 ring nut. Use KN100 series plastic legend plates as shown on Pages Color Cap)
17-81 and 17-82.
Pilot Light For Intrinsically Nominal
Safe Circuits Operating Voltage Range Current V max = 32 V
(NEMA 4X) I max = 165 mA
20–30 Vac/dc 25 mA
a Add the voltage assembly code as chosen from table, page 17-77.
EXAMPLE: SKTqR31 with 60 Vac red LED voltage = SKT37LRR31.
b Add the color code as chosen from the color cap table below.
EXAMPLE: SKP1c with a blue fresnel cap = SKP1L31.
c The cap must be the same color as the LED light module chosen, e.g., for green LED, use green color cap.
d On neon light modules, use clear color caps only.
e Use only full voltage or resistor voltage assembly codes on remote test pilot lights. Do not choose LED, neon or transformer codes. For AC use only.
Color Caps
b Plastic b Plastic
Fresnel Domed
Color
Amber A31 A9
Blue L31 L9
Clear C31 C9
Green G31 G9
Red R31 R9
White W31 W9
Yellow Y31 Y9
(TEST) C L2
M L2
LSI
L1 M2
(SIG)
R
C (TEST) C L2
Test L1
M3 CR
L1 (SIG)
Miniature relays with lockable test button, without LED (sold in lots of 100)
Number and type of contacts - Thermal current (Ith)
DPDT - 12 A 4PDT - 6 A
Weight Weight
Coil Voltage Catalog Number Catalog Number
lb. kg lb. kg
12 Vdc — — — RXM4AB1JDTQ 0.080 0.036
24 Vdc RXM2AB1BDTQ 0.082 0.037 RXM4AB1BDTQ 0.080 0.036
48 Vdc — — — RXM4AB1EDTQ 0.080 0.036
110 Vdc — — — RXM4AB1FDTQ 0.080 0.036
220 Vdc — — — RXM4AB1MDTQ 0.080 0.036
24 Vac RXM2AB1B7TQ 0.082 0.037 RXM4AB1B7TQ 0.080 0.036
48 Vac — — — RXM4AB1E7TQ 0.080 0.036
RXZ E2M114M with
120 Vac RXM2AB1F7TQ 0.082 0.037 RXM4AB1F7TQ 0.080 0.036
relay RXM4AB2P7TQ
230 Vac RXM2AB1P7TQ 0.082 0.037 RXM4AB1P7TQ 0.080 0.036
Miniature relays with LED (sold in lots of 100)
24 Vdc — — — RXM4AB2BDTQ 0.080 0.036
24 Vac RXM2AB2B7TQ 0.082 0.037 RXM4AB2B7TQ 0.080 0.036
230 Vac RXM2AB2P7TQ 0.082 0.037 RXM4AB2P7TQ 0.080 0.036
Timing relays
Weight
Description For use with Catalog Number
lb. kg
2 timed DPDT contacts
REXL2pp 4 0.09 0.042
(function A—On-delay)
Sockets RXZ Eppppp
4 timed 4PDT contacts 4
REXL4pp 0.09 0.042
(function A—On-delay)
REXL4pp 4 ®
Please refer to the Zelio Time - Timers catalog (9050CT0001R2/05).
3 12/04
Quick Start
The IS Super Cell can operate as an intrinsically safe pump control for
eight different pumping configurations. Duplex, Triplex, Quadplex and
Duplex SPS (Separate Pump Stop) pumping modes are possible for
either Pump Up or Pump Down applications. Refer to page 21 for the
full description of five-channel relay operation.
Read 1. Pumping Modes, page 6, for details of the features and mode
descriptions of the unit.
Mode Selector
Switch Mode Description Page
Position
0 5-Channel Relay – Mode 0 22
1 Duplex Pump Down – Mode 1 11
2 Triplex Pump Down – Mode 2 12
3 Quadplex Pump Down – Mode 3 13
4 Duplex SPS Pump Down – Mode 4 14
5 Duplex Pump Up – Mode 5 15
6 Triplex Pump Up – Mode 6 16
7 Quadplex Pump Up – Mode 7 17
8 Duplex SPS Pump Up – Mode 8 18
Table 1. Mode Selector
4 12/04
Model Description
The ISS-105 has three adjustable controls to set the mode of operation:
1. Mode Selector
2. Option Selector
3. Time Delay
5 12/04
Option Selector
Table 2 describes the Option Selector for all pumping modes.
(· Indicates the function is available for the pump mode)
1 High Alarm · *· ·
2 Low Alarm · *· ·
3 Pump 1 · · · ·
4 Pump 2 · · · ·
5 Pump 3 · ·
6 Pump 4 ·
Audible Alarm Relay
7 · · · ·
State/Fail Safe
Alternator Select 0,
8 · · · ·
(ALS-0, see Table 4)
Alternator Select 1,
9 · · · ·
(ALS-1, see Table 4)
Alternator Select 2,
10 · · · ·
(ALS-2, see Table 4)
Table 3. Option Selector
* On a Triplex pump system, either a High or Low Alarm is available, but not both.
See Triplex Mode description for more details.
1. Pumping Modes
Duplex
In a Duplex mode, two pumps are used with one Stop Float and High
and Low Alarms.
Triplex: High/Low Alarm
In a Triplex mode, three pumps are used with one Stop Float.
In a Triplex Pump Down mode, a High Alarm is the typical
configuration with the Option Selector switches 1=ON (High Alarm) and
2=OFF (Low Alarm).
If a Low Alarm is desired, the alarm float must be moved to the position
in the tank below the Stop Float and Option Selector switches must be
1=OFF and 2=ON.
In a Triplex Pump Up mode, a Low Alarm is the typical configuration
with the Option Selector switches 1=OFF (High Alarm) and 2=ON (Low
Alarm).
If a High Alarm is desired, the alarm float must be moved to the position
in the tank above the Stop Float and Option Selector switches must be
1=ON and 2=OFF
Quadplex
In a Quadplex mode, four pumps are used with one Stop Float and no
alarms floats.
6 12/04
Separate Pump Stop (SPS)
In the Duplex SPS mode, both the Lead and Lag pumps have their own
stop floats.
In an SPS Pump Down mode, a High Alarm is the typical configuration with
Option Selector switches 1=ON (High Alarm) and 2=OFF (Low Alarm).
If a Low Alarm is desired, the alarm float must be moved to the position
in the tank below the Lead Stop Float, and Option Selector switches
must be 1=OFF, and 2=ON.
In an SPS Pump Up mode, a Low Alarm is the typical configuration with
Option Selector switches 1=OFF (High Alarm) and 2=ON (Low Alarm).
If a High Alarm is desired, the alarm float must be moved to the
position in the tank above the Lead Stop Float, and Option Selector
switches must be 1=ON and 2=OFF.
7 12/04
is reset or power is cycled. An out-of-sequence condition has to exist for
10 seconds before the ISS-105 will alarm. When the stop float fails open
in pump down mode or closed in pump up mode, an Out-of-Sequence
Alarm will NOT occur and pumps will not turn on with floats. In this case,
all pumps will turn on when the High/Low Alarm is activated. Thus, in
Quadplex mode, pumps will never turn on if the Stop Float malfunctions.
Audible Alarm
The Audible Alarm is activated when a High, Low or Out-of Sequence
Alarm occurs. The Audible Alarm will turn off when there is no longer
high or low alarms or if the unit is silenced.
Audible Alarm Logic/Fail-Safe
The Audible Alarm relay can be configured to operate in either a Fail-
Safe mode (position 7=ON), or a Non Fail-Safe mode (position 7=OFF).
In Fail-Safe mode, the NC (Normally Closed) contacts will be open
during normal operation and closed during an alarm. In Non Fail-Safe
mode, the NC contacts will be closed during normal operation and open
during an alarm.
Clearing Alarms
The external Silence / Alarm Reset button will clear the Audible Alarm.
The Reset button or cycling power will clear Out-of-Sequence Alarms.
Alternation
The ISS-105 is equipped with a built-in alternator that determines which
pump will start each pumping cycle. This alternator is configured using
switches ALS-0, ALS-1 and ALS-2 of the Option Selector.
ALS-0 ALS-1 ALS-2
Function
Position 8 Position 9 Position 10
Alternation On ON ON ON
Alternation On OFF ON ON
Alternation On, Non-
*ON OFF OFF
Alternating Pump Enabled (1)
Alternation On, Non-
**OFF OFF OFF
Alternating Pump Enabled (1)
Alternation Off, Force Pump 1
OFF ON OFF
as Lead
Alternation Off, Force Pump 2
OFF OFF ON
as Lead
Alternation Off, Force Pump 3
ON ON OFF
as Lead (2)
Alternation Off, Force Pump 4
ON OFF ON
as Lead (3)
Table 4. Alternator Options
Note (1) In Duplex Mode, this setting is the same as Alternation On.
Note (2) In Duplex Mode, this will force Pump 1 as lead and will cycle Pump 2 every 50
cycles of the lead pump
Note (3) In Duplex Mode, this will force Pump 2 as lead and will cycle Pump 1 every 50
cycles of the lead pump
* If ALS-0 is ON in this mode, the Non-Alternating Pump will cycle when the Non-
Alternating Float changes state, or after 50 cycles of the Lead Float.
** If ALS-0 is OFF the Non-Alternating Pump will cycle only when the Non-Alternating
Float changes state.
8 12/04
Alternation On
When the alternator is on, each pump will be alternated as the
Lead Pump (see Table 5).
Cycle 1 Cycle 2 Cycle 3 Cycle 4 Cycle 5
Pump 1 Lead Lag 3 Lag 2 Lag 1 Lead
Pump 2 Lag 1 Lead Lag 3 Lag 2 Lag 1
Pump 3 Lag 2 Lag 1 Lead Lag 3 Lag 2
Pump 4 Lag 3 Lag 2 Lag 1 Lead Lag 3
Table 5. Pump Sequence
Alternation On, Non-Alternating Pump Enabled
The Triplex and Quadplex pump modes are equipped with an
optional Non-Alternating Pump. This pump will not be included in
the normal pump alternation sequence when ALS-1 and ALS-2
(positions 9 and 10) are both OFF. If ALS-0 (position 8) is ON, the
Non-Alternating Pump will cycle when the Non-Alternating Float
changes state or after every 50 cycles of the Lead Float. If ALS-0
is OFF, the Non-Alternating Pump will only cycle if the Non-
Alternating Float changes state.
The last pump in the float sequence (highest #) is the Non-
Alternating Pump and can be used as either a jockey or emergency
pump. (See Table 2, page 5 for Non-Alternating Pump and Float
details for each pumping mode.)
A Jockey Pump is typically a smaller pump that will always be
used first in the pump sequence. In order to implement a
jockey pump; the Non-Alternating Pump Float must be moved
in the tank to just above the Stop Float in a Pump Down
system, and to just below the Stop Float in a Pump Up system.
See Figure 9 (page 19), an example wiring diagram using a
Jockey Pump in a Duplex Pump Down system.
An Emergency Pump is usually a larger pump that is always
used last. In order to implement an emergency pump; the
Non-Alternating Pump is already the last pump in the
sequence so there is no need to move the float. See Figure 10
(page 20), an example wiring diagram using an Emergency
Pump in a Duplex Pump Down system.
Alternation Off
When the alternator is off, a Lead Pump can be forced by setting ALS-0,
1 & 2 (see Table 4). The remaining pumps will start in a sequential
order as each float opens/closes.
Disabling Pumps
Using the built-in DIP switches, individual pumps can be disabled, when
taken out of service for repair or maintenance.
9 12/04
External Inputs
A five-pin connector is provided for optional external inputs.
· External Silence / Alarm Reset
This input allows for an external NO (Normally Open) pushbutton
that will silence audible alarms and clear flashing alarm lights.
· External Power Reset
This input allows for an external NO pushbutton to reset the IS
Super Cell, causing the same effect as a power cycle.
· External Alternation Configuration
For Duplex Mode, a SPDT (Single Pole Double Throw) switch can
be connected to close RTCL1 or RTCL2 (remote controls) to force
Pump 1 or 2 as the Lead Pump. Option Selector Positions 8, 9 &
10 must be OFF. If the switch is in the middle position, pumps will
be in alternation mode.
For Triplex and Quadplex Modes two SPST (Single Pole Single
Throw) switches can be connected to force Pump 1,2,3 or 4 to be
the Lead Pump. Option Selector Positions 9 & 10 must be OFF.
To force Pump 1 or 2 as Lead, Position 8 must be OFF.
To force Pump 3 or 4 as Lead, Position 8 must be ON.
For alternation mode, close both RTCL1 and RTCL2.
3. Wiring Diagrams
The following Figures 1-10, show typical wiring diagrams for all pumping
modes available for the IS Super Cell.
10 12/04
Figure 2. Typical Wiring for Triplex Pump Down - Mode 2
Switch State
Mode Selector Switch 2
Time Delay Adjustment MIN
Option Selector Switch
1 High Alarm ON
2 Low Alarm OFF
3 Pump 1 ON
4 Pump 2 ON
5 Pump 3 ON
6 Pump 4 NA
7 Fail-Safe OFF
8 ALS-0 ON
9 ALS-1 ON
10 ALS-2 ON
Table 7. Typical Triplex Pump Down Setup
12 12/04
Model ISS-105 Specifications
Control Voltage 108–132VAC
Frequency 50/60 Hz
Power 4 Watts (max.)
Adjustments
Time Delay/Lag Pump Delay 2–255 sec.
Mode Selector 0–8 (9–F: force mode 0)
Option Selector 1–10, ON/OFF
Silence Button dry input only / non IS
Reset Button dry input only / non IS
External Alternation Configuration ALS-1
External Alternation Configuration ALS-2
Pumping Modes Available
Duplex Pump Down 2 pumps w/ high and low alarms
Triplex Pump Down 3 pumps w/ high alarm (typical)
Quadplex Pump Down 4 pumps
Duplex Pump Down SPS 2 pumps w/ high alarm (typical)
(Separate Pump Stop) 2 stop floats
Duplex Pump Up 2 pumps w/ high and low alarms
Triplex Pump Up 3 pumps w/ low alarm (typical)
Quadplex Pump Up 4 pumps
Duplex Pump Up SPS 2 pumps w/ low alarm (typical)
(Separate Pump Stop) 2 stop floats
5-Channel Relay Mode
5-Channel 1 relay latched / time delay output
Operating Temperature -20 to 55°C
Terminals
Wire AWG 12–20 AW G
Torque 6 in.-lbs.
Relay Contacts
B 300 or 480VA @ 240VAC, Pilot Duty
240 VAC, 7A (max.), General Purpose
Pump Inrush Delay 2 sec.
Entity Parameters
Voc=16.8 V
Isc=1.2 mA
La=100mH
Ca=0.39mF
Po = Voc * Isc
4
Class I, Divisions I & II, Groups A, B, C & D;
Provides Intrinsically Safe Circuits in Class II, Divisions I & II, Groups E, F & G;
the Following Locations: and Class III locations
Standards Passed
23 12/04
CONTROL DRAWING ISS-105
ASSOCIATED APPARATUS / APPAREILLAGE CONNEXE
Non-Hazardous Location
Supply Voltage
120VAC
Hazardous Location
See Notes 1 & 2
Class I, Divisions I & II, Groups A, B, C & D;
Class II, Divisions I & II, Groups E, F & G; and
Class III locations
NOTES:
1. Maximum distance between unit and switch contact is
10,000 feet.
2. All non-intrinsically safe wiring shall be separated from
intrinsically safe wiring. Description of special wiring
methods can be found in the National Electrical Code
ANSI/NFPA 70, Article 504 Intrinsically Safe Systems.
Check your state and local codes for additional
requirements.
3. All switch contacts shall be non-energy storing,
containing no inductance or capacitance.
4. Entity Parameters:
Voc = 16.8V Ca = 0.39mF
See Note 3 Isc = 1.2mA Po = Voc * Isc
La = 100mH 4
5. Entity Parameter Relationships:
IS Equipment Associated Apparatus
Vmax (or Ui) ³ Voc or Vt (or Uo)
Imax (or Ii) ³ Isc or It (or Io)
Pmax, Pi ³ Po
Ci + Ccable £ Ca (or Co)
Li + Lcable £ La (or Lo)
Capacitance and inductance of the field wiring from the intrinsically safe equipment to the associated apparatus
shall be calculated and must be included in the system calculations as shown in the table above. Cable
capacitance, Ccable, plus intrinsically safe equipment capacitance, Ci, must be less than the marked capacitance,
Ca (or Co), shown on any associated apparatus used. The same applies for inductance (Lcable, Li and La or Lo,
respectively). W here the cable capacitance and inductance per foot are not known, the following values shall be
used: Ccable = 60pF/ft., Lcable = 0.2mH/ft.
2880 North Plaza Drive, Rapid City, South Dakota 57702
(800) 843-8848 · (605) 348-5580 · fax (605) 348-5685
www.symcom.com
Accessories
Barriers and Isolators
Specifications
Environmental
Certifications UL, FM, CSA PTB, and CE Marked for all applicable directives
Operating Temperature [C (F)] +20…+60° (-- 4…+140°)
Vibration 55 Hz (1.5 mm amplitude)
Shock 20 g
Relative Humidity 0…95% (noncondensation)
Electrical
Leakage Current ≤1 μA
Protection Type Reverse polarity (protected by replaceable fuse), over-voltage
(protected by replaceable fuse), and short-circuit (incorporated)
Features
Replaceable Fuse Rating 160 A
• Replaceable fuse
Operating Frequency ≤100 kHz @ Isc > 50 mA; ≤50 kHz @ Isc ≤0.50 mA
• Low internal resistance
Short Circuit Protection Incorporated
• Short-circuit protected
Mechanical
• Reverse polarity protection
Material Polyamide
• Slim 1/2 inch wide housing
• UL Listed, FM, CSA and PTB Mounting Location Nonhazardous or Class 1, Division 2 or Zone 2/Zone 22 locations
Certified, and CE Marked for all I.S. Connections for Class I, II, III; Div 1 and 2; Groups A-- G and Zones 0, 1, 2, 20, 21, 22;
applicable Directives Group IIC and IIB
Enclosure Rating IP40 (IEC529)
Compatible Sensors
Photoelectrics
Connection
Cat. No. Approximate Dimensions
Sensor Style Sensing Mode Type Sensor Barriers Used{ [mm (in.)
2 m Cable 42GRL-- 9540
1 2
Emitter 4-Pin Micro 42GRL-- 9540-- QD 897H-- S120
9000 160mA
2.75
Through 4-Pin Mini 42GRL-- 9540-- QD1 (70)
Beam 2 m Cable 42GRR-- 9500
160mA
Proximities
Cat. No.
Sensor Style Barrel Diameter Shielding Sensor Barriers Used{
Shielded 871TM-- DR2ENE12-- ⊗
12 mm
Stainless Unshielded 871TM-- DR4ENE12-- ⊗
Steel Face Shielded 871TM-- DR2ENE18-- ⊗ 897H-- S214
and Barrel 18 mm or
Proximity Unshielded 871TM-- DR4ENE18-- ⊗ 897H-- S120
Sensor Shielded 871TM-- DR2ENE30-- ⊗
30 mm
Unshielded 871TM-- DR4ENE30-- ⊗
⊗ Replace symbol with desired termination. A2 for 2 meter PVC cable and D4 for 4-pin micro QD.
Product Selection
FM Entity Parameters
Supply Permissible Permissible
Rated Internal Classifica- Voltage, Current, Power, External External ATEX Certified Stahl
Voltage Resistance tion Max. Max. Max. Capacity Inductance, Max. Part No. Cat. No.
286…319 A, B, E 0.083 μF 1.6 mH
9001/01-- 280-- 100-- 101 897H- S120
ohms D, F, G 0.65 μF 11 mH
A, B, E 0.083 μF 1.6 mH
0 ohms 9001/03-- 280-- 000-- 101 897H- S140
D, F, G 0.65 μF 230 mH
The relay is energized when the phase sequence and all voltages are correct.
Any one of five fault conditions will de-energize the relay. As standard, re-
u Universal voltage range of 208- energization is automatic upon correction of the fault condition. Manual reset is
480V on PMPU provides the available if a momentary N.C. switch is wired to the appropriate terminals. A
flexibility to cover a variety of multi-color LED indicates normal condition and also provides specific fault
applications with one unit indication to simplify troubleshooting.
u Protects against phase loss,
phase reversal, phase
The PMP Series offers a variety of user-adjustable settings. The percent phase
unbalance, undervoltage and unbalance is adjustable from 2-10%, and also has a Disable setting for those
overvoltage applications where poor voltage conditions could cause nuisance tripping. The
undervoltage drop-out can be set at 80-95% of operating voltage (overvoltage
u Variety of user-selectable and setting is fixed at 110% of nominal). The adjustable time delay drop-out on
adjustable settings for the undervoltage (0.1-20 seconds) eliminates nuisance tripping caused by momentary
ultimate in three-phase voltage fluctuations. There is also an adjustable time delay (1-300 seconds) on
protection
both power up and restart after a fault has been cleared.
u Automatic & Manual Reset in
Same Unit
u Multi-Color LED indicates
normal condition and provides
specific fault indication to
simplify troubleshooting NOMINAL
PROTECTS VOLTAGEp PRODUCT
u Compact plug-in case utilizing
AGAINST 50/60 Hz NUMBER WIRING/SOCKET n
industry-standard 8 pin octal
socket Phase Loss, 120V PMP120 8 Pin Octal
Phase Reversal, 70169-D
u 10A SPDT output contacts
Phase Unbalance, 208-480V PMPU *
u Undervoltage
& Overvoltage
(with appropriate socket)
DIAGRAM 104
p Phase-to-Phase (Line-to-Line).
* Requires a 600V-rated socket when used on system voltages above 300V.
n See Pages 80 & 81 for Sockets & Accessories.
800-238-7474
www.macromatic.com
sales@macromatic.com
10 8/11
PHASE MONITOR RELAYS
Phase Loss, Phase Reversal, Phase
Unbalance, and Under/Over Voltage
PMP Series Plug-in
Application Data & Dimensions
Application Data
Phase Loss: Hysteresis: 2 - 3%
Unit trips on loss of any Phase A, B or C.
Load (Burden): Less than 3VA
Phase Reversal:
Temperature: -28o to 65oC (-18o to 149oF)
Unit trips if rotation (sequence) of the three phases is anything
other than A-B-C. Mounting:
Uses an 8 pin octal socket. Requires a 600V-rated socket
Undervoltage:
when used on system voltages greater than 300V (Macromatic
Adjustable from 80-95% of nominal voltage. Unit trips when the
Product Number 70169-D--see Page 80).
average of all three lines is less than the adjusted set point for
a period longer than the adjustable time delay drop-out. Indicator LED:
Overvoltage: LED Status Indicator
Fixed at 110% of nominal voltage. Unit trips when the average
of all three lines is greater than the fixed set point for a period Green Steady Normal / Relay ON
longer than the time delay drop-out. Green Flashing Power Up / Restart Delay
Phase Unbalance: Red Steady Unbalance
Adjustable from 2 - 10% unbalance. Unit trips when any one of
the three lines deviates from the average of all three lines by Red Flashing Undervoltage / Overvoltage
more than the adjusted set point. There is also a Disable Amber Steady Reversal
setting adjustment that will turn off the Phase Unbalance
Protection if nuisance tripping is a problem. Amber Flashing Loss
Undervoltage / Overvoltage
Output Contacts: Green / Red Alternating
Trip Pending
SPDT: 10A @ 240V AC/30V DC, 1/2HP @ 240V AC
Red / Amber Alternating * Nominal Voltage Set Error
Life:
* Applies to 208-480V units only.
Mechanical: 10,000,000 operations
Full Load: 100,000 operations Reset:
As standard, reset is automatic upon correction of fault. When
Response Times:
a momentary-contact N.C. switch is wired across the Manual
Power Up & Restart After Fault: 1 - 300 seconds adjustable
Reset terminals (6 & 7), the unit switches to manual reset
Drop-out Due to Fault:
mode and remote manual reset is available.
Phase Loss & Reversal 100ms fixed
Phase Unbalance 2 seconds fixed Approvals:
Undervoltage 0.1 - 20 seconds adjustable
Overvoltage Fixed Time Based on Inverse
Time Curve File #E109466
with
appropriate
socket
Low Voltage & EMC Directives File #E109466
EN60947-1, EN60947-5-1
Dimensions
2.4
(60) All Dimensions in
Inches (Millimeters)
2.9
(74)
1.7 3.0
(43) (77)
8/11 11
SDSA3650 SPDs
Square D Type 1
Surge Protective Devices
Square DTM brand SurgelogicTM SDSA3650 products are compact
and affordable Surge Protective Devices (SPDs). SDSA3650 SPDs
offer a simple means to bring down initial surges to manageable
levels and can offer addtional value in a cascaded SPD system.
Their compact design allows surge suppression to be installed
adjacent to power panels or directly on sensitive equipment.
TM
2
SDSA3650 SPDs
Features
The SDSA3650 is a four-wire surge suppressor designed for use on all solidly grounded systems up to 600Y/347 Vac. The SDSA3650D is a
© 2011 Schneider Electric. All rights reserved.
600V Delta2 40kA 3 3 Ø, 3-wire SDSA3650D 1500V L-L 200kA 10kA N/A N/A 4000V N/A
Schneider Electric USA, Inc. 1751 S. 4800 W., Salt Lake City, UT 84104, USA Telephone: (801)-977-9009 Fax: (801)-977-0200 www.surgelogic.com
Appearance
5
ON-delay ON-delay ON-delay
Interval
Interval OFF-delay Interval
OFF-delay One-shot One-shot
Mode of Operation One-shot Cycle (off first) One-shot ON delay True OFF-delay
Cycle Cycle (on first) Cycle
Signal OFF delay Signal OFF delay
Signal ON/OFF delay Signal OFF delay Signal ON/OFF delay
Signal ON/OFF delay
Time Range 0.1 second to 600 hrs 0.05 second to 180 hrs 0.01 second to 99.9 hrs 0.05 to 600 seconds
Contact Configuration DPDT SPDT, DPDT SPDT, DPDT SPDT, DPDT
Repeat Accuracy ±0.25% maximum ±0.2% maximum ±0.3% maximum ±0.4% maximum
Contact Load Rating SPDT: 3A, 250V AC SPDT: 3A, 250V AC
10A, 240V AC DPDT: 5A, 240V AC DPDT: 5A, 240V AC 5A, 250V AC
(resistive)
120-240V AC 100 to 240V AC 100 to 240V AC 100 to 240V AC
Available Operating Voltage 12V DC 12V DC 12V DC 24V AC/DC
24V AC/DC 24V AC/DC 24V AC/DC
UL Listed UL recognized UL recognized UL recognized
TUV TUV TUV TUV
Approvals CSA CSA CSA CSA
CE CE CE CE
Series Model GT3S GT3W GE1A GT5P GT5Y
Appearance
Sequential start
ON-delay
Recycler &
instantaneous
Mode of Operation Star-Delta Recycler OFF start ON-delay ON-delay ON-delay
Recycler ON start
Interval
Interval ON delay
Sequential interval
Star side: 0.05s to 100s
Time Range Star-delta Switching Time: 0.1s to 6 hrs 0.1s to 10 hrs 0.1s to 10 minutes 0.1s to 1 hour
0.05, 0.1, 0.25, 0.5 seconds
Contact Configuration SPST-NO DPDT SPDT, DPDT SPDT DPDT, 4PDT
Repeat Accuracy ±0.2% maximum ±0.2% maximum ±0.2% maximum ±0.2% maximum ±0.2% maximum
Contact Load Rating 3A, 250V AC 5A, DPDT: 250V AC
5A, 250V AC/30VDC 5A, 120V AC/30V DC 5A, 240V AC 5A, 250V AC 3A, 4PDT: 250V AC
(resistive)
www.a-aelectric.com
AC and DC Hour Meters
Hour meters show run time
of machines, equipment, and
other devices. When you need
accurate information for testing,
maintenance or warranty
purposes, choose from a wide
range of Control Dynamics AC,
DC or Vibration hour meters.
Voltages 24, 120, 240, 400VAC 24, 120, 240, 400VAC 24, 120, 240VAC
Operating Temperature –12° to 176°F (–25° to 80°C) –12° to 176°F (–25° to 80°C) –12° to 158°F (–25° to 70°C)
Operating Temperature –2° to 158°F (–20° to 70°C) –2° to 158°F (–20° to 70°C) 12° to 131°F (–10° to 55°C)
Connection 1/4” spade, screw clamp 1/4” spade, screw clamp 1/4” spade, screw clamp
Flush with retainer bracket Flush with metal clamp or 3 screw Flush with retainer clamp
Mounting Options or metal clamp front Ø2.83” and Ø3.14” Cutout 1/3”x0.84” (33x22mm)
DIN rail (Ø72 and 80mm) or 3 screw front Ø2.83” (Ø72mm)
Comprehensive diagnostics
Installation ease
Heavy Duty Commercial GFCI Receptacles with Auto Grounding
GF15ILA
Hospital Grade
Circuit Guard® GFCI Receptacles
îðß ïîëÊ
ÒÛÓß ëóïëÎ ÒÛÓß ëóîðÎ
Construction Installation
Heaters
• Attractive and durable housing is
brushed aluminum
CAUTION
• Thermostat, standard on all units, is
adjustable from 0°F to 100°F (-18°C to
38°C) These electric heaters are not designed
for use in dusty, dirty, corrosive, or
• Fan draws cool air from the bottom of hazardous locations.
the enclosure and passes this air across
the thermostat and heating elements Portions of the heater can get hot.
before being released into enclosure Adequate protection must be taken to
cavity protect people from potential burns,
• Heated air is discharged through the top and to protect other components from
of the heater unit this heat.
• Four 10-32 x self-tapping screws are This heater can only be installed in a
included with each heater totally enclosed metal enclosure.
• Ball bearing fan runs continuously for
even temperature distribution
• Terminal strip with clamp connector that Hoffman electric heaters should be
accepts both solid and stranded wire centered as low as possible on an interior
enclosure panel.This permits the unit to
Finish heat the cool air located at the bottom of
the enclosure. For maximum efficiency and
Brushed aluminum. longevity, the heater should be mounted in
Application
a vertical position with the terminal block
Designed to protect sensitive mechanical, Industry Standards to the bottom and the air outlet openings
electrical, and electronic equipment from at the top in a sealed enclosure free from
Electric Heaters
the harmful effects of condensation, UL Component Recognized dust or debris. However, the unit will also
corrosion, and low temperatures. CSA Listed effectively distribute heat if turned 90
Thermostatically controlled fan-driven CE degrees with the terminal block out the
heater units maintain a stable temperature bottom and the air outlet at the side.
within enclosures so critical components Although enclosure panels are preferable,
can perform more reliably over heaters may be installed on any flat sheet
a longer period of time. metal surface. Do not install heaters on
wood panels.
Heat sensitive components should not be
placed near the heater discharge area since
this air can be quite warm.The clearance
range defines the space that must be kept
free of these components for proper and
safe operation of the heater.
Data subject to change without notice ☎ 763 422 2211 FAX 763 422 2600 © 2003 Hoffman Enclosures Inc.
Thermostat Serie FLZ
ELECTRO-TECHNOLOGY FOR INDUSTRY
IP 20 AC DC
Level of suitable for both
protection 50 Hz and 60 Hz
Technical data: FLZ 510 FLZ 520 FLZ 530 FLZ 550 AS-i
change over switch
Type of contact with spring contact NCC with spring contact NOC with spring contact integrated AS-i bus slave
- 20 °C (- 4 °F) ... + 40 °C (+ 104 °F)
Available setting ranges 0 °C (+32 °F) ... + 60 °C (+ 140 °F) -10°C (+14°F) ... +60°C (+140°F)
+ 20 °C (+ 68 °F) ... + 80 °C (+ 176 °F)
Max. breaking capacity, value in brackets NCC: 100-250V AC/10(2)A 240V AC / 10(2) A < 20 mA
inductive load at cos(phi) = 0,6 NOC: 100-250V AC/5(2)A 120V AC / 15(2) A 26,5 V ... 31,6 V
DC: max. 30W DC: max. 30W AS-i profile: S-BA
1K: thermal return
Breaking temperature difference 3K: without thermal return < 7K 1 - 4K
7K: capillary sensor
Tolerance for switching point +/- 3K +/- 4K +/- 2K
Sensor bimetal or remote sensor bimetal NTC
with 1,5 m capillary
Connection 0,5 - 2,5 mm2 screw clamps 1,3 mm DC Jack
Colour RAL 7035 - light grey
Weight 75 g 50 g 50 g 55 g
System of protection IP20
Working / storage temperature range – 20 °C (- 4 °F) ... + 80 °C (+ 176 °F) -25°C (-13°F) ... +80°C (+176°F)
Mounting method snap fastening for 35 mm profile bars in accordance with EN 60715 (FLZ 520/530: for Pfannenberg Exhaust Filter PFA 3000 too)
FLZ 550 AS-i not for headfirst mounting
Approvals UL approval applied for UL approval AS-i
FLZ 510 FLZ 510 FLZ 520 / FLZ 530 / FLZ 550-AS-i
capillary sensor
We reserve the right to technical alterations.Subject to correction. 075000031
3 3
4 1 2 1 2
RF
L L
L N LOAD LOAD
L N N
N
113
SITRANS LUT400
The world’s most accurate ultrasonic level controller
Advanced Diagnostics
Echo profile and trend views on the display
New Figure of Merit (FOM) parameter evaluates extended
performance, not just point in time
False Echo Suppression tunes echo thresholds to ignore obstructions
Integrated datalogger allows you to review historic performance
SITRANS
Safety Guidelines: Warning notices must be observed to ensure personal safety as well as that of
others, and to protect the product and the connected equipment. These warning notices are
accompanied by a clarification of the level of caution to be observed.
Qualified Personnel: This device/system may only be set up and operated in conjunction with this
manual. Qualified personnel are only authorized to install and operate this equipment in accordance with
established safety practices and standards.
Unit Repair and Excluded Liability:
The user is responsible for all changes and repairs made to the device by the user or the user’s
agent.
All new components are to be provided by Siemens Milltronics Process Instruments.
Restrict repair to faulty components only.
Do not reuse faulty components.
Warning: Cardboard shipping package provides limited humidity and moisture protection. This product
can only function properly and safely if it is correctly transported, stored, installed, set up, operated, and
maintained.
This product is intended for use in industrial areas. Operation of this equipment in a residential area
may cause interference to several frequency based communications.
© Siemens AG 2012
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Table of Contents ...............................................................................................................i
mmmmm
Introduction ........................................................................................................................1
The Manual ............................................................................................................................................1
Manual symbols ..........................................................................................................................1
Application examples .................................................................................................................1
Change History ......................................................................................................................................2
Sensor node ....................................................................................................................... 2
LUI ......................................................................................................................................... 2
Safety Notes .......................................................................................................................3
Safety marking symbols ............................................................................................................3
FCC Conformity ......................................................................................................................................4
CE Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) Conformity ...................................................................4
Description .........................................................................................................................7
Overview .................................................................................................................................................7
Features ..................................................................................................................................................7
Models .....................................................................................................................................................8
Applications ............................................................................................................................................8
Approvals and Certificates .................................................................................................................8
Installing and Mounting ...................................................................................................9
Mounting locations ...............................................................................................................................9
Mounting instructions ........................................................................................................................10
Wall or panel mount .................................................................................................................10
Remote mounted lid........................................................................................................ 12
Pipe mount ..................................................................................................................................13
DIN-rail mount ...........................................................................................................................15
Preparation for cable entry ....................................................................................................16
Cable routed through conduit....................................................................................... 16
Cable exposed and entering through the cable glands......................................... 17
SITRANS LUT400 wiring compartment ..........................................................................................17
The Battery ...........................................................................................................................................17
Connecting .......................................................................................................................19
Safety notes for connection ...................................................................................................19
Connecting SITRANS LUT400 ..........................................................................................................20
Wiring compartment ................................................................................................................20
Power ...........................................................................................................................................21
Cables ..........................................................................................................................................22
Transducers ...............................................................................................................................23
Temperature sensor .................................................................................................................23
Relays ...........................................................................................................................................24
Communications ........................................................................................................................24
Connecting via USB........................................................................................................ 25
Connecting HART .......................................................................................................... 26
Level system synchronization ................................................................................................27
Discrete inputs ...........................................................................................................................28
i
Remote mounted lid with extension cable ..........................................................................29
Extension cable .........................................................................................................................30
Connecting in hazardous area installations .................................................................................31
Table of Contents
Commissioning ................................................................................................................33
Local Commissioning .........................................................................................................................33
mmmmm
ii
Vessel Shape and Dimensions ..............................................................................................73
Characterization chart .............................................................................................................73
Alarms ....................................................................................................................................................76
Table of Contents
Level .............................................................................................................................................76
In-bounds/ Out-of-bounds Range .........................................................................................77
mmmmm
Temperature ...............................................................................................................................78
Switch (Discrete Input) Alarm ................................................................................................78
Fail-safe Fault Alarm ................................................................................................................79
Flowrate .......................................................................................................................................79
Pump Control .......................................................................................................................................79
Pump Control options ...............................................................................................................80
Pump Control algorithms............................................................................................... 80
Setting a pump down (wet well) group ...............................................................................80
Other Pump Control algorithms .............................................................................................82
Setting a pump up (reservoir) group ....................................................................................85
Pump Control Interlocks ..........................................................................................................87
Other Pump Controls ................................................................................................................87
Totalizing pumped volume ............................................................................................ 88
Setting a pump to run-on............................................................................................... 88
Setting the pump start delays ...................................................................................... 89
Reducing wall cling......................................................................................................... 90
Saving energy .................................................................................................................. 91
Tracking pump usage..................................................................................................... 92
Other controls ......................................................................................................................................92
Relays controlled by time .............................................................................................. 92
Flow ........................................................................................................................................................93
Flow calculation ........................................................................................................................93
Totalizing flow ............................................................................................................................93
External Totalizers and Flow Samplers .........................................................................................93
Relay contacts ...........................................................................................................................94
Totalizer .......................................................................................................................................95
Flow Sampler .............................................................................................................................96
Open Channel Monitoring (OCM) ...................................................................................................97
Method of Flow Calculation ...................................................................................................98
Common parameters ................................................................................................................98
Setting Zero Head .....................................................................................................................99
PMDs with Exponential Flow to Head function ...............................................................100
Applicable weir profiles.............................................................................................. 100
Parshall Flume............................................................................................................... 101
Leopold Lagco Flume................................................................................................... 102
Cut Throat Flume .......................................................................................................... 103
Khafagi Venturi ............................................................................................................. 104
Universal calculation support ................................................................................... 116
Typical flow characterization .................................................................................... 116
Example flumes............................................................................................................. 117
Example weirs............................................................................................................... 118
Trends ..................................................................................................................................................118
Data logging .......................................................................................................................................119
Viewing the Data Log .............................................................................................................119
Simulation ...........................................................................................................................................120
Pump relay behaviour during simulation................................................................ 121
iii
Fail-safe and Simulation ............................................................................................. 122
HART status ................................................................................................................... 122
Simulation process ...................................................................................................... 122
Table of Contents
iv
Transferring parameters using LUT400 display lid ...................................................................225
Replacing the Battery ......................................................................................................................226
Decontamination Declaration ........................................................................................................227
Table of Contents
Diagnosing and Troubleshooting ...............................................................................229
Communication Troubleshooting ..................................................................................................229
mmmmm
Device Status Icons .........................................................................................................................230
General Fault Codes .........................................................................................................................231
Common Problems Chart ................................................................................................................234
Noise Problems .................................................................................................................................240
Determine the Noise Source ................................................................................................240
Non-Transducer Noise Sources .........................................................................................241
Common Wiring Problems ....................................................................................................241
Reducing Electrical Noise .....................................................................................................241
Reducing Acoustical Noise ..................................................................................................242
Measurement Difficulties ...............................................................................................................242
Loss of Echo (LOE) ..................................................................................................................242
Adjust Transducer Aiming.......................................................................................... 242
Increase Fail-safe Timer Value................................................................................. 243
Install a Transducer with a Narrower Beam......................................................... 243
Fixed Reading ....................................................................................................................................243
Obstructions in the Sound Beam ........................................................................................243
Nozzle Mountings ...................................................................................................................243
Set the SITRANS LUT400 to Ignore the Bad Echo ..........................................................244
Wrong Reading ..................................................................................................................................244
Types of Wrong Readings .....................................................................................................244
Liquid Splashing ......................................................................................................................244
Adjust the Echo Algorithm ....................................................................................................244
Transducer Ringing ..........................................................................................................................245
Echo Profile Display .........................................................................................................................245
Trend Display .....................................................................................................................................245
Technical Data ...............................................................................................................247
Power .........................................................................................................................................247
Performance .............................................................................................................................247
Interface ....................................................................................................................................248
Mechanical ...............................................................................................................................250
Environmental ..........................................................................................................................250
Approvals ..................................................................................................................................251
Dimension Drawings ....................................................................................................253
Appendix A - Technical Reference ............................................................................255
Principles of Operation ....................................................................................................................255
Process Variables ...................................................................................................................255
Transmit Pulse .........................................................................................................................255
Echo Processing ...............................................................................................................................255
Echo Selection .........................................................................................................................256
Time Varying Threshold (TVT)................................................................................... 256
Algorithm ........................................................................................................................ 257
Confidence ..................................................................................................................... 257
Echo Threshold ............................................................................................................. 257
Figure of Merit............................................................................................................... 258
v
Shaper Mode and Auto False Echo Suppression ................................................ 258
Measurement Range .............................................................................................................259
Measurement Response .......................................................................................................260
Table of Contents
Damping.......................................................................................................................... 260
Analog Output ....................................................................................................................................261
mmmmm
vi
Introduction
The Manual
Notes:
• This product is intended for use in industrial areas. Operation of this equipment in a
residential area may cause interference to several frequency based
communications.
• Please follow the installation and operating procedures for a quick, trouble-free
installation and to ensure the maximum accuracy and reliability of your SITRANS
LUT400.
SITRANS LUT400
• This manual applies to the SITRANS LUT400 series only.
This manual will help you set up your SITRANS LUT400 for optimum performance. We
mmmmm
always welcome suggestions and comments about manual content, design, and
accessibility. Please direct your comments to techpubs.smpi@siemens.com.
For other Siemens level measurement manuals, go to:
www.siemens.com/level, and look under Level Measurement.
Manual symbols
Please note their use carefully.
Alternating Current
Direct Current
Application examples
The application examples used in this manual illustrate typical installations using
SITRANS LUT400. As there is often a range of ways to approach an application, other
configurations may also apply.
In all examples, substitute your own application details. If the examples do not apply to
your application, check the applicable parameter reference for the available options.
LUI
Firmware
Date Changes
Rev.
SITRANS LUT400
Safety Notes
Protective Conductor Terminal
mmmmm
Dispose of in an environmentally safe manner, and
according to local regulations.
1. This symbol is used when there is no corresponding caution symbol on the product.
Safety Notes
mmmmm
Features
• Small 1/2 DIN enclosure footprint with standard universal mounting bracket for wall,
pipe, and DIN rail, plus an optional panel mount
• Easy to use LUI display with local four-button programming, menu-driven Description
parameters, and Wizard support for key applications
• Level, Volume, High Accuracy OCM Flow monitoring
mmmmm
• Three relays combined with a suite of pump, alarm, and relay control features
• HART Communications
• EDDs for SIMATIC PDM, AMS Device Manager, and Field Communicator 375/475,
plus DTMs for FDTs (Field Device Tools)
• Integrated web browser for local programming from an intuitive web-based
interface
• Two discrete inputs for backup level override and pump interlock functions
• Echo profile and trend views from the local display
• Patented digital receiver for improved performance in electrically noisy applications
(close proximity to VSDs)
• Real time clock with daylight savings time supporting an integrated datalogger and
energy saving algorithms for minimizing pump operation during high cost energy
periods
• Removable terminal blocks for ease of wiring
Applications
• Liquids, solids and slurry monitoring in small to large process and storage vessels or
outdoor applications (open air)
• Environmental, Mining/Aggregates/Cement, Food & Beverage, and Chemical market
applications primarily
• Key sample applications include: wet wells, reservoirs, flumes/weirs, chemical
storage, liquid storage, hoppers, crusher bins, dry solids storage
Note: The device nameplate lists the approvals that apply to your device.
Application LUT400
Approval Approval Rating Valid for:
Type Version
N. America,
Non-hazardous General Purpose CSAUS/C, CE, FM, UL listed, C-TICK Europe,
Australia
Description
a.
Not available for devices with remote display.
Mounting locations
Recommended
• Ambient temperature is always within -20 to +50 °C (-4 to +122 °F)
• SITRANS LUT400 display window is at shoulder level, unless most interaction is
through a SCADA system
• Easy access to local push buttons is provided
• Cable length requirements are minimized
• Mounting surface is free from vibration
• Sufficient room to swing device lid open and have clear access.
• A place for a laptop computer is provided for on-site configuration (optional, as
laptop not required for configuration).
Avoid
• Exposure to direct sunlight. (Provide a sun shield to avoid direct sunlight.)
Installing and Mounting
Note: When routing cable through a conduit, please follow the Cable Routing
instructions on page 16 before mounting the SITRANS LUT400.
clips (2 places)
clips (2 places)
back of enclosure
slotted features
For a more detailed dimension drawing, see SITRANS LUT400 Dimensions on page
253.
gasket
remote display lid
4 panel mount
fasteners provided
extension cable
SITRANS LUT400
For a more detailed dimension drawing, see SITRANS LUT400 Dimensions on page 253
and Cutout Dimensions (for Remote Panel Mount) on page 254.
Installing and Mounting
mmmmm
Note: Remote mounted lid can be mounted up to 5 m from the device using two
optional cable extensions (each 2.5 m in length). For instructions on how to con-
nect an extension cable, see Remote mounted lid with extension cable on page
29.
1. Using the template provided, cut out the necessary hole for the remote LUI display
lid. Place the gasket inside the lid, aligning the mounting holes. Align the back of the
remote display lid with the panel hole cut-out. Mark and drill four holes in the
mounting surface for the four screws (provided).
2. Fasten with a screwdriver and wrench.
Please note:
• Recommended mounting: mount to panel, up to 5 m from the device. If alternate
mounting surface is used, it MUST be able to support four times the weight of the
device.
Note: Fasteners included: M5 screw, seal washer, M5 flat washer and nut. These
fasteners are required to maintain IP65 rating on remote lid.
Pipe mount
saddle
clamp
pipe
For a more detailed dimension drawing, see SITRANS LUT400 Dimensions on page 253.
Please note:
• Recommended mounting: directly to horizontal or vertical pipe. If alternate mounting
surface is used, it MUST be able to support four times the weight of the device.
• Recommended pipe dimensions: maximum: 3" pipe, minimum: 3/4" pipe
• Recommended fastener sizes:
• U-Bolts:
maximum: 3" pipe size with M8 or 3/8" thread
minimum: 3/4" pipe size with M6 or 1/4" thread
• Hex Nuts:
M6 or 1/4" to M8 or 3/8"
• Washer:
maximum: 16 mm or 13/16" outside diameter.
Installing and Mounting
mmmmm
DIN-rail
clips (2)
slot
DIN-rail slide
For a more detailed dimension drawing, see SITRANS LUT400 Dimensions on page 253.
Mounting the enclosure
1. Angle top of enclosure toward DIN-rail, and position slightly above top of rail.
2. Move enclosure downward against DIN-rail to hook clips on back of enclosure to
top of DIN-rail.
3. Press device flush against DIN-rail to engage DIN-rail slide, which will fasten
enclosure securely to DIN-rail.
Please note:
• Recommended mounting: directly to horizontal DIN-rail.
Installing and Mounting
1. From the front of the device, place screwdriver in slot at bottom of DIN-rail slide and
pry downward. This will unclip slide from bottom of DIN-rail.
2. While holding slide down, push upward on enclosure to release clips from top of
DIN-rail.
SITRANS LUT400
For a more detailed dimension drawing, see SITRANS LUT400 Dimensions on page 253.
.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 DC SYNC L1 L2/N
0.25 A, 250 V
SLOW BLOW 100 - 230 V battery
SHLD
WHT
WHT
terminal blocks
BLK
BLK
DISPLAY USB
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
connection
RLY 1 RLY 2 RLY 3
PAS
ACT
SERVICE
The Battery
The SITRANS LUT400 is supplied with one battery installed. The battery (BR2032) has a
Installing and Mounting
life expectancy of ten years, and is affected by ambient temperature. If the LUT400 loses
input power, the battery will maintain operation of the device’s real time clock until power
has been restored.
mmmmm
When the battery reaches its end of life, refer to Replacing the Battery on page 226.
Connecting
Safety notes for connection
mmmmm
• Verify that all system components are installed in accordance with instructions.
• Connect all cable shields to the LUT400 shield terminals (denoted on device with
symbol ). To avoid differential ground potentials ensure cable shields are
properly connected to ground.
• Keep exposed conductors on shielded cables as short as possible to reduce noise
on the line caused by stray transmissions and noise pickup.
SITRANS LUT400
SITRANS LUT400
Siemens
Transducer
Siemens TS-3
Temperature Sensor
Customer Alarm,
Pump, or Control
Device
WARNINGS:
mmmmm
•
Check the device label on your instrument, to verify the approval
rating.
• Use appropriate conduit seals to maintain IP or NEMA rating.
Notes:
• Separate cables and conduits may be required to conform to standard
instrumentation wiring practices or electrical codes.
Wiring compartment
The terminal board on the LUT400 allows all inputs and outputs to be connected
simultaneously. Terminal strips can be removed to improve ease of wiring.
Connecting
The DC input terminals shall be supplied from a source providing
electrical isolation between the input and output, in order to meet
mmmmm
the applicable safety requirements of IEC 61010-1.
All field wiring must have insulation ratings suitable for the
application.
Important!
Before applying power to the SITRANS LUT400 for the first time, ensure any
connected alarm/control equipment is disabled until satisfactory system operation
and performance is verified.
INPUT
ground POWER
L2/N
L1 12 13 14
L1 L2/N
0.25 A, 250 V
SLOW BLOW 100 - 230V
INPUT
TS-3 TRANSDUCER DISCRETE INPUTS POWER
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 DC SYNC L1 L2/N
0.25 A, 250 V
SLOW BLOW 100 - 230V
SHLD
WHT
WHT
BLK
BLK
DISPLAY
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
cable gland
(or NPT cable entry)
POWER POWER
mmmmm
12 13 14 12 13 14
L1 L2/N
100 - 230 V 10 - 32 V
AC: 100-230 V AC 15%, 50/60 Hz, 36 VA (10W) DC: 10-32 V DC, 10W
1. To wire for power, strip the cable jacket for approximately 70 mm (2.75") from the end
of the cable, and thread the wires through the gland1.
2. Connect the wires to the terminals as shown: the polarity is identified below the
terminal block.
3. Ground the device according to local regulations.
Cables
The SITRANS LUT400 is designed to work with two conductor shielded transducer
cables.
Connection Cable Type
mA output, sync, 2 copper conductors, twisted, with shielda/drain wire, 300V 0.324 -
Temperature sensor,
0.823 mm2 (22 - 18 AWG).
discrete input
Maximum length: 365 m
Transducer Shielded two-wire.
Warning: Do not use a coaxial transducer cable
extension with the SITRANS LUT400. High voltage
transmitted on shield of coaxial cable could result in
personal injury, damage to equipment, or poor device
performance.
Relay output Copper conductors per local requirements.
AC input
a. Preferred shielding is braided shield.
1. If cable is routed through conduit, use only approved suitable-size hubs for waterproof
applications.
Connecting
Run the transducer cable in a grounded metal conduit, separate from other
mmmmm
wiring (except TS-3 temperature sensor wiring, if applicable).
Notes:
• Do not use coaxial cable with SITRANS LUT400 due to high voltage transmitted
on shield of coaxial cable
• Do not connect the LUT400 shield and white transducer wires together; wire to
separate terminals
Di d ld d l h d h i
TS-3 TRANSDUCER
1 2 3 4 5
SHLD
WHT
WHT
BLK
BLK
Temperature sensor
The speed of sound changes as temperature changes. To ensure accurate level
measurement, the SITRANS LUT400 compensates via an external temperature input. All
Siemens EchoMax transducers have an internal temperature sensor for this purpose,
and for the fastest temperature response, Siemens also offers a dedicated temperature
sensor, the TS-3.
If the following conditions apply, a separate TS-3 temperature sensor will ensure
optimum accuracy:
• the transducer is exposed to direct sunlight (or other radiant heat source)
• the temperature of the atmosphere between the transducer face and monitored
surface differs from the temperature of the transducer
• faster response to temperature changes is required.
Note: Use a TS-3 Temperature Sensor only. Leave terminals open (unused) if TS-3
is not deployed.
Communications
The USB port and the 4 to 20 mA HART terminal block (terminal numbers 22, 23, and 24)
are located inside the enclosure of the device.
INPUT
TS-3 TRANSDUCER DISCRETE INPUTS POWER
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 DC SYNC L1 L2/N
0.25 A, 250 V TO OTHER
SLOW BLOW 100 - 230V SIEMENS
SHLD
WHT
WHT
BLK
BLK
UNIT
TO TRANSDUCER
RELAYS mA OUT/HART BATTERY
BR2032
DISPLAY
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Connecting
Computer system
mmmmm
SITRANS LUT400
SITRANS LUT400
USB cable
USB connection
INPUT
TS-3 TRANSDUCER DISCRETE INPUTS POWER
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 DC SYNC L1 L2/N
0.25 A, 250 V
SLOW BLOW 100 - 230V
SHLD
WHT
WHT
BLK
BLK
DISPLAY USB
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
cable
RLY 1 RLY 2 RLY 3
PAS
ACT
SERVICE
Use 5-pin USB Mini-B cable. The cable should not exceed 3 m (9.8 ft.).
Notes:
• No data logs are written while device is connected to a PC via USB.
(See 2.10. Data Logging on page 173 and 3.2.6. View Logs on page 201.)
Connect USB cable for device configuration, and when configuration is
complete, disconnect the USB cable to allow Data Logging to occur. (It is good
practice to use MS Windows Safely Remove Hardware feature before
unplugging any USB cable from your computer.)
• Do not use a USB extension cable with the LUT400. Data Logging may not
occur, even after extension cable has been disconnected. (If a USB extension
cable has been used in error, a power reset of the device is required to restart
Data Logging.)
PLC1
power supply
R = 250
HART
communicator
PLC1
R = 250
HART
communicator
For more information, consult the mA output parameters (2.5. Current Output) in the
parameter reference section.
1. Depending on the system design, the power supply may be separate from the PLC, or integral to
it.
2. The nominal value for the HART resistor is 250 Ohm. For more information see application guide
Working with HART, which can be downloaded from the product page of our website. Go to:
www.siemens.com/sitransLUT400 under Support and click on Application Guides.
Connecting
the original HydroRanger, or the OCMIII.
mmmmm
When using multiple ultrasonic level monitors, be sure to run the transducer cables in
separate grounded metal conduits.
When separate conduits are not possible, synchronize the level monitors so that no
device transmits while another is waiting for echo reception. If more than one ultrasonic
device is being installed in the same application, the devices must be synchronized to
prevent cross-talk.
DISCRETE INPUTS
6 7 8 9 10 11 Other Siemens
Transceiver
1 2 DC SYNC
DISCRETE INPUTS
6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2 DC SYNC
Common Neg. for DIs
(ground to terminal 6)
Bias supply for Pos. DIs
6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2 DC SYNC
6 7 8 9 10 11
1 2 DC SYNC
Connecting
mmmmm
1. Remove display lid from the enclosure.
2. Carefully disconnect the existing display cable from the terminal board.
3. Separate from the device, knock out cable entry tab on blank lid:
a. With gasket in place, use snips to cut into lid on both sides of the cable entry
knockout. Use cutting guideline to cut from bottom of lid, up to bottom of groove
(as shown below).
b. Once both sides of knockout have been cut through all layers of the lid (including
the gasket), pry upward with pliers on knockout to snap off plastic and uncover
cable entry hole.
blank lid
groove
bottom of groove
cable entry
knockout
cutting guideline
bottom of lid
WARNINGS:
• Ingress protection of the enclosure is reduced to IP20, and Type 4X /
NEMA 4X rating is void when cable entry knock-out in the blank lid is
removed.
• An enclosure reduced to an IP20 rating and intended for use in non-
hazardous locations must be installed in an indoor location free of dust
and moisture, or be installed in a suitably rated field enclosure IP54 or
better.
4. Connect the extension cable to the display connector on the terminal board. (If
desired, attach second extension cable to the other end of the first extension cable.)
5. Feed the free end of the extension cable through cable entry hole on blank lid.
6. Connect extension cable to display cable on remote lid.
INPUT
TS-3 TRANSDUCER DISCRETE INPUTS POWER
blank lid
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 DC SYNC L1 L2/N
0.25 A, 250 V
SLOW BLOW 100 - 230V
SHLD
WHT
WHT
BLK
BLK
RELAYS mA OUT/HART BATTERY
knock-out DISPLAY
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
extension cable
(2.5 or 5 m in
length), to be
connected to display cable
remote display lid extension cable
connector
Extension cable
Optional extension cables (2.5 m cables) are available to be used with remote mounted
lid. Two cables can be connected together for an extension of up to 5 meters.
Connecting
The following wiring options are available for hazardous area installations:
mmmmm
• Non-incendive wiring (Canada)
In all cases, check the device label on your instrument, and confirm the approval rating.
Class I, Div.2, Gr. A, B, C & D T3C Class I, Div.2, Gr. A, B, C & D T3C Class I, Div.2, Gr. A, B, C & D T3C
Class II, Div. 2, Gr. F & G Class II, Div. 2, Gr. F & G Class II, Div. 2, Gr. F & G
Class III Class III Class III
159134 Per Drawing A5E03936871 159134 Per Drawing A5E03936871 159134 Per Drawing A5E03936871
Siemens Milltronics Process Instruments, Peterborough Siemens Milltronics Process Instruments, Peterborough Siemens Milltronics Process Instruments, Peterborough
Assembled in Canada with domestic and imported parts Assembled in Canada with domestic and imported parts Assembled in Canada with domestic and imported parts
Class I, Div.2, Gr. A, B, C & D T3C Class I, Div.2, Gr. A, B, C & D T3C Class I, Div.2, Gr. A, B, C & D T3C
Class II, Div. 2, Gr. F & G Class II, Div. 2, Gr. F & G Class II, Div. 2, Gr. F & G
Class III Class III Class III
159134 Per DWG. A5E03936871 159134 Per DWG. A5E03936871 159134 Per DWG. A5E03936871
Siemens Milltronics Process Instruments, Peterborough Siemens Milltronics Process Instruments, Peterborough Siemens Milltronics Process Instruments, Peterborough
Assembled in Canada with domestic and imported parts Assembled in Canada with domestic and imported parts Assembled in Canada with domestic and imported parts
CSA Class I, Div 2 connection drawing number A5E03936871 can be downloaded from the
product page of our website at www.siemens.com/sitransLUT400.
SITRANS LUT400
Commissioning
mmmmm
local push buttons
A Quick Start Wizard provides an easy step-by-step procedure to help you configure the
device for a simple application. We recommend that you configure your application in the
following order:
• First, run the appropriate Quick Start Wizard for your application (Level, Volume,
Flow).
• Next, setup pumps via the Pump Control Wizard (if applicable).
• Lastly, configure alarms, or other controls, totalizers and samplers, referencing the
respective parameters [see Parameter reference (LUI) on page 137]. It is important
that alarms, and other controls are configured last to avoid pump relay assignments
being overridden by the Quick Start Wizard.
There are two ways to access the Quick Start wizards:
• locally (see Quick Start Wizards via LUI on page 38)
• from a remote location (see Other Quick Start Wizards (QSW): on page 38)
See Level Application Example on page 58, or Flow application example on page 59 for
illustrations, and for the complete range of parameters, see Parameter reference (LUI) on
page 137.
Level
1 2 3 4
1 – tag
mmmmm
1 2 3
18.91 1 2
6
3 – value being displayed [Primary Variable
(PV)=1 of 2, Secondary Variable (SV)=2 of 2]
4 – toggle indicator1 for PV or SV
5 SAVING PARAMETERS
5 – units
9 8 7
6 – bar graph indicates level
7 – secondary region indicates configured
Flow relays (left) and discrete inputs (right)
1 2 3 4 8 – text area displays status messages
9 – device status indicator
10 SITRANS LUT400 1/2 5
FLOW 500313.. 10 – selected (primary) sensor mode: level,
11 L/S
6 space, distance, volume, head, or flow
HEAD 60.000 M
12
DAILY TOTAL,... 999999.99 11 – secondary sensor mode = head when
1 2 3 1 2
primary sensor mode = flow
5 SAVING PARAMETERS 12 – totalizer values: display alternates between
9 8 7 daily totalizer and running totalizer
Fault present
8 – text area displays a fault code and an error message
0 LOE 9 – service required icon appears
1.
Press UP or DOWN arrow to switch
Commissioning
list. A band filled halfway down the menu bar indicates the current item is halfway down
the list.
mmmmm
Parameter view Edit view
menu in SENSOR 2.1.6 TRANSDUCER 2.1.6
which UNITS parameter NO TRANSDUCER
parameter SENSOR MODE number XRS-5
is located SENSOR MODE SECONDARY XPS-10
TRANSDUCER XPS-15
XRS-5
XCT-8
parameter FREQUENCY
parameter XCT-12
name value/selection XPS-30
UP or DOWN arrow
LCD displays primary or secondary value.
toggles between PV and SV.
Change parameter settings and set operating conditions to suit your specific application.
(For remote operation, see Operation via SIMATIC PDM 6 (HART) on page 127 or
Operation via AMS Device Manager (HART) on page 131.)
Note: For the complete list of parameters with instructions, see Parameter reference
(LUI) on page 137.
Parameters are identified by name and organized into function groups, then arranged in a
5-level menu structure, as in the example below. (For full menu see LCD Menu Structure
on page 273.)
1. WIZARDS
2. SETUP
2.1 SENSOR
......
2.7 PUMPS
2.7.1 BASIC SETUP
Commissioning
2.7.2 MODIFIERS
2.7.2.1 WALL CLING REDUCTION
mmmmm
2.7.2.1.1 ENABLE
Notes:
• In Navigation view, ARROW keys move to the next menu item in the direction of the
arrow.
• Press and hold any arrow key to scroll through a list of options or menus (in the
direction of the arrow).
highlighted. parameter
FREQUENCY
current
c. Scroll to a new selection. name value
Commissioning
XPS-30
mmmmm
a. Navigate to the desired parameter. CALIBRATION
LOW CALIB. PT.
2.2.1
A Wizard provides an easy step-by-step Quick Start (QS) procedure that configures the
device for a simple application. To configure the SITRANS LUT400 for applications of level,
volume (standard vessel shapes), or flow, use the Quick Start Wizards via LUI on page 38 of
this chapter.
Wizards for applications employing more complex vessel shapes are available via
SIMATIC PDM. See Quick Start (Volume - Linearization) in the LUT400 Communications
manual1.
Note: Device continues to measure while in Program Mode. If you wish to disable the
device while it is configured, see 3.3.1. Transducer Enable on page 203.
1. Communications for SITRANS LUT400 (HART) Manual (7ML19985NE01). (See DVD shipped with
device or download manual from our website.)
Notes:
• The Quick Start Wizard settings are inter-related and changes apply only after you
choose Finish in the final step.
• Perform customization for your application only after the Quick Start has been
completed.
Commissioning
mmmmm
1. Wizards
1.1. Quick Start
1.1.1. QS Level
Use this wizard to configure simple level applications.
a. Press RIGHT arrow to activate PROGRAM mode and open menu level 1: MAIN
MENU.
b. Press RIGHT arrow two times to navigate to menu item 1.1.1.
c. Press RIGHT arrow to open QS Level.
d. At each step, press DOWN arrow to QUICK START LEVEL
- Transducer - Operation
Note: The introduction screen is displayed only on the device when using the local
push buttons. This screen is not part of the Quick Start when using SIMATIC PDM.
Transducer
Specifies the Siemens transducer connected to the device.
NO TRANSDUCER, XRS-5, XPS-10, XPS-15, XCT-8, XCT-12, XPS-30, XPS-40,
Options XLT-30, XLT-60, STH
Default: NO TRANSDUCER
Operation
Sets the type of measurement (and the corresponding mA output) required for the
application.
sensor reference point
level
Commissioning
The operation mode must be set to
LEVEL, SPACE, or DISTANCE to pro-
ceed with the QS Level Wizard.
mmmmm
Temperature Source
Source of the temperature reading used to adjust the speed of sound.
TRANSDUCER, FIXED TEMPERATURE, EXTERNAL TS-3, AVERAGE OF SEN-
Options SORS
Default: TRANSDUCER
Note: For the purpose of this example, all values are assumed to be in meters (m).
Response Rate
Sets the reaction speed of the device to measurement changes in the target range.
Notes:
• Response Rate can only be set through the Quick Start Wizard, and any
changes made to Fill Rate per Minute (2.3.1.), Empty Rate per Minute (2.3.2.), or
Damping Filter (2.3.3.) parameters following the completion of the wizard will
Commissioning
Use a setting just faster than the maximum filling or emptying rate (whichever is
greater). Slower settings provide higher accuracy, faster settings allow for more
rapid level fluctuations.
End of QS Level Wizard
For QS to be successful, all changes must be applied.
BACK, CANCEL, FINISH
(Display returns to 1.1 Quick Start menu when Quick Start is successfully com-
Options pleted or cancelled. If CANCEL is selected, no changes are written to the
device.)
To transfer Quick Start values to the device and return to Program menu, press
DOWN arrow (Finish). Then press LEFT arrow three times to return to
Measurement mode.
a. Press RIGHT arrow to activate PROGRAM mode and open menu level 1: MAIN
MENU.
b. Press RIGHT arrow two times to navigate to menu item 1.1.1.
c. Press DOWN arrow and RIGHT arrow to open QS Volume.
d. At each step, press DOWN arrow to accept QUICK START VOLUME
default values and move directly to the next item, TRANSDUCER
XRS-5
or RIGHT arrow to open Edit mode: the BACK
Commissioning
e. Scroll to desired item and press RIGHT arrow QUICK START VOLUME
TRANSDUCER
mmmmm
XRS-5
to continue. XPS-10
XPS-15
XCT-8
f. At any time, you can press UP arrow to go XCT-12
- Volume Units
- Maximum Volume
Transducer
Specifies the Siemens transducer connected to the device.
NO TRANSDUCER, XRS-5, XPS-10, XPS-15, XCT-8, XCT-12, XPS-30, XPS-40,
Options XLT-30, XLT-60, STH
Default: NO TRANSDUCER
Commissioning
Temperature Source
Source of the temperature reading used to adjust the speed of sound.
mmmmm
See Vessel Shape on page 147 for illustration. If CURVE TABLE or LINEAR TABLE
selected, enter values for level and volume breakpoints after completing the wizard
(see 2.6.7. Table 1-8 on page 150).
Units
Sensor measurement units.
M, CM, MM, FT, IN
Options
Default: M
Note: For the purpose of this example, all values are assumed to be in meters (m).
Response Rate
Commissioning
Sets the reaction speed of the device to measurement changes in the target range.
mmmmm
Notes:
• Response Rate can only be set through the Quick Start Wizard, and any
changes made to Fill Rate per Minute (2.3.1.) or Empty Rate per Minute (2.3.2.)
parameters following the completion of the wizard will supersede the Response
Rate setting.
• Response Rate always displays in m/minute.
SLOW (0.1 M/MIN)
MEDIUM (1.0 M/MIN)
Options
FAST (10 M/MIN)
Default: SLOW (0.1 M/MIN)
Use a setting just faster than the maximum filling or emptying rate (whichever is
greater). Slower settings provide higher accuracy, faster settings allow for more level
fluctuations.
Dimension A
The height of the vessel bottom when the bottom is conical, pyramidal, parabolic,
spherical, or flat -sloped..
Range: 0.000 to 99.999
Value
Default: 0.000
Dimension L
Length of the cylindrical section of a horizontal parabolic end vessel.
Range: 0.000 to 99.999
Value
Default: 0.000
Volume Units
Determines volume measurement units.
L, USGAL, IMPGAL, CUM, USER DEFINED *
Options
Default: L
* If USER DEFINED option selected, the value must be set after completing the
wizard. See 2.6.6. User Defined Unit on page 149.
To transfer Quick Start values to the device and return to Program menu, press
mmmmm
DOWN arrow (Finish). Then press LEFT arrow three times to return to
Measurement mode.
a. Press RIGHT arrow to activate PROGRAM mode and open menu level 1: MAIN
MENU.
b. Press RIGHT arrow two times to navigate to menu item 1.1.1.
c. Press DOWN arrow two times and RIGHT arrow to open QS Flow.
d. At each step, press DOWN arrow to QUICK START FLOW
BACK
Commissioning
NEXT
mmmmm
TRANSDUCER
NO TRANSDUCER
Transducer
Specifies the Siemens transducer connected to the device.
NO TRANSDUCER, XRS-5, XPS-10, XPS-15, XCT-8, XCT-12, XPS-30, XPS-40,
Options XLT-30, XLT-60, STH
Default: NO TRANSDUCER
Commissioning
Temperature Source
Source of the temperature reading used to adjust the speed of sound.
mmmmm
* Option will be set to OTHER if the wizard was run previously via HART software tool
(such as SIMATIC PDM), and the device was set to OFF or UNIVERSAL HEAD VS.
FLOW. If this is initial configuration, the PMD can only be set for no calculation (OFF),
or for linearization (UNIVERSAL HEAD VS. FLOW) via HART software tools (SIMATIC
PDM, AMS, FC375/475).
Method of Flow Calculation
Sets the method of flow calculation.
ABSOLUTE, RATIOMETRIC
Options
Default: ABSOLUTE
Note: For the purpose of this example, all values are assumed to be in meters (m).
Commissioning
Low Calibration Point
mmmmm
Distance from Sensor Reference Point to Low Calibration Point: usually process
empty level.
Range: 0.000 to 60.000
Value
Default: 60.000
Response Rate
Sets the reaction speed of the device to measurement changes in the target range.
Notes:
• Response Rate can only be set through the Quick Start Wizard, and any
changes made to Fill Rate per Minute (2.3.1.) or Empty Rate per Minute (2.3.2.)
parameters following the completion of the wizard will supersede the Response
Rate setting.
• Response Rate always displays in m/minute.
SLOW (0.1 M/MIN)
MEDIUM (1.0 M/MIN)
Options
FAST (10 M/MIN)
Default: SLOW (0.1 M/MIN)
Use a setting just faster than the maximum filling or emptying rate (whichever is
greater). Slower settings provide higher accuracy, faster settings allow for more level
fluctuations.
Notes:
• The following five parameters will display in the wizard based on the PMD
selected above.
• These parameters are used in the flow calculation formula (see Method of Flow
Calculation on page 266).
Flow Exponent
(PMD = EXPONENTIAL DEVICES)
The exponent for the flow calculation formula. (See Method of Flow Calculation on
page 266.)
Commissioning
K Factor
(PMD = EXPONENTIAL DEVICES)
The constant used in the flow calculation formula for absolute calculation of an
exponential device only.
Range: -999.000 to 9999.000
Value
Default: 1.000
V-Notch Angle
(PMD = THIN PLATE V-NOTCH WEIR)
The V-Notch angle used in the flow calculation formula.
Range: 25.000 to 95.000
Value
Default: 25.000
Slope
(PMD = TRAPEZOIDAL FLUME or ROUND PIPE)
The Flow Slope used in the flow calculation formula.
Range: -999.000 to 9999.000
Value
Default: 0.000
Roughness Coefficient
(PMD = ROUND PIPE)
The Flow Roughness Coefficient used in the flow calculation formula.
Range: -999.000 to 9999.000
Value
Default: 0.000
Notes:
• For each PMD excluding Exponential Devices, and Other, you must enter up to
four dimensions.
• In the wizard, you will be prompted for each dimension required for the PMD
selected, and the respective PMD dimension name will be displayed.
Commissioning
HUMP HEIGHT P (2.15.4.7. OCM Dimension 3)
THROAT LENGTH L (2.15.4.8. OCM Dimension 4)
mmmmm
Round Nose Horizontal Crest Weir BS-3680
CREST WIDTH B (2.15.4.5. OCM Dimension 1)
CREST HEIGHT P (2.15.4.6. OCM Dimension 2)
CREST LENGTH L (2.15.4.7. OCM Dimension 3)
Trapezoidal Flume BS-3680
APPROACH WIDTH B (2.15.4.5. OCM Dimension 1)
THROAT WIDTH B (2.15.4.6. OCM Dimension 2)
HUMP HEIGHT P (2.15.4.7. OCM Dimension 3)
THROAT LENGTH L (2.15.4.8. OCM Dimension 4)
U-Flume BS-3680
APPROACH DIAMETER DA (2.15.4.5. OCM Dimension 1)
THROAT DIAMETER D (2.15.4.6. OCM Dimension 2)
HUMP HEIGHT P (2.15.4.7. OCM Dimension 3)
THROAT LENGTH L (2.15.4.8. OCM Dimension 4)
Finite Crest Weir BS-3680
CREST WIDTH B (2.15.4.5. OCM Dimension 1)
CREST HEIGHT P (2.15.4.6. OCM Dimension 2)
CREST LENGTH L (2.15.4.7. OCM Dimension 3)
Thin Plate Rectangular Weir BS-3680
APPROACH WIDTH B (2.15.4.5. OCM Dimension 1)
CREST WIDTH B (2.15.4.6. OCM Dimension 2)
CREST HEIGHT P (2.15.4.7. OCM Dimension 3)
Rectangular Weir Contracted
CREST WIDTH B (2.15.4.5. OCM Dimension 1)
Round Pipe
PIPE INSIDE DIAMETER D (2.15.4.5. OCM Dimension 1)
The difference (positive or negative) between Low Calibration Point and zero head
(level at zero flow).
mmmmm
Flowrate Units
The volume units used to display total flow.
L/S, L/MIN, CUFT/S, CUFT/D, GAL/MIN, GAL/D, IMPGAL/MIN, IMPGAL/D,
Options CUM/H, CUM/D, USER DEFINED *
Default: L/S
* If USER DEFINED option selected, the value must be set after completing the
wizard. See 2.15.3.8. User Defined Unit on page 193.
Maximum Flow at 20 mA
The maximum flowrate.
Range: -999 to 9999999
Value
Default: 100
Flowrate Decimal
The maximum number of decimal units to be displayed.
NO DIGITS, 1 DIGIT, 2 DIGITS, 3 DIGITS
Options
Default: NO DIGITS
To transfer Quick Start values to the device and return to Program menu, press
DOWN arrow (Finish). Then press LEFT arrow three times to return to
Measurement mode.
Commissioning
mmmmm
a. Press RIGHT arrow to activate PROGRAM mode and open menu level 1: MAIN
MENU.
b. Press RIGHT arrow to navigate to menu item 1.1.
c. Press DOWN arrow and RIGHT arrow to open Pump Control.
d. At each step, press DOWN arrow to accept default values and move directly to
the next item,
or RIGHT arrow to open Edit mode: the current selection is highlighted.
Commissioning
e. Scroll to desired item and press RIGHT arrow to store the change, then press
DOWN arrow to continue.
mmmmm
f. At any time, you can press UP arrow to go back, or LEFT arrow to cancel
the wizard.
Start of Wizard - Pump Control
Note: The introduction screen is displayed only on the device when using the local
push buttons. This screen is not part of the Quick Start when using SIMATIC PDM.
Number of Pumps
Select the number of pumps to be used with pump control.
NONE, 2
Options
Default: NONE
Relay Pump 2
View only. Automatically sets the relay assigned to Pump 2 based on relay selected
for Pump 1 in previous step.
Options If Relay Pump 1 = RELAY 2, then Relay Pump 2 = RELAY 3
(view only) If Relay Pump 1 = RELAY 3, then Relay Pump 2 = RELAY 2
Commissioning
Default (all models): ALTERNATE DUTY ASSIST
See Pump Control Mode 2.7.1.4. on page 151 for descriptions of each.
mmmmm
Service Ratio Pump 1
Selects pump usage based on the RUN time ratio rather than last used.
Range: 0 to 255
Value
Default: 1
This parameter displays only if a Service Ratio algorithm is selected for Pump Control
Mode.
Service Ratio Pump 2
Selects pump usage based on the RUN time ratio rather than last used.
Range: 0 to 255
Value
Default: 1
This parameter displays only if a Service Ratio algorithm is selected for Pump Control
Mode.
Run Time Relay 2
Set the amount of time that pump Relay 2 has run, defined in hours.
Range: 0 to 999999
Value
Default: 0
Use the default value for new pumps, or set this value for existing pumps with
accumulated run time. (This parameter displays only if a Service Ratio algorithm is
selected for Pump Control Mode.)
Run Time Relay 3
Set the amount of time that pump Relay 3 has run, defined in hours.
Range: 0 to 999999
Value
Default: 0
Use the default value for new pumps, or set this value for existing pumps with
accumulated run time. (This parameter displays only if a Service Ratio algorithm is
selected for Pump Control Mode.)
ON Setpoint Pump 2
The level at which Pump 2 turns ON, defined in 2.1.1. Units.
Range: 0.000 to 99999.000
Value
Default: 0.000
To transfer values to the device and return to Program menu, press DOWN arrow
(Finish). Then press LEFT arrow two times to return to Measurement mode.
C: 38 A: BLF D: 9.00
pan left/right - selected
Echo amplitude (in dB)
DB
pan up/down
echo zoom
100 TVT measure
Commissioning
exit
50
mmmmm
0
0 2.0 4.0 6.0
1. See Confidence (3.2.9.2.) on page 202.
2. See Algorithm (2.12.2.1.) on page 181.
Device Address
Setting a device address is not necessary for local operation, but must be set if
configuring the SITRANS LUT400 for use on a HART network. See Device Address 4.1. on
page 215.
level
6.5 m
a.
See Fill Rate per Minute 2.3.1. on page 142.
The application is a vessel that takes an average 3 hours (180 minutes) to fill and 3 weeks
to empty.
Fill rate = (Low Cal Pt. – High Cal Pt.) / fastest of fill or empty time
= (15.5 m – 1 m) / 180 min.
= 14.5 m /180 min. = 0.08 m/min.
Commissioning
approximately 0.12 m/minute. The application also calls for a flow sampler to be activated
every 1000 m3, or 24 hours (whichever comes first), and for a fail-safe alarm to activate in
mmmmm
the event of a loss of echo or cable fault.
Plan View C
2
/3 C
C = Converging dimension
Front View Side View
transducer
Zero
Head
TS-3 XRS-5
High Cal.
= 1.0 m
Low Cal.
= 1.6 m
Head
= 0.6 m
Commissioning
activation after a defined number of hours. In
this example, activation should occur every 24
mmmmm
hours.
Duration of time in seconds that the relay will
Relay Duration (2.11.4.4.) 0.2
energize or "tick".
Relay 2 has been selected for control in this
Assigned Relay (2.11.4.5.) Relay 2 example as relay 1 has been allocated to the
Fail-safe alarm.
Default for control relay functions is Normally
Normally
Relay Logic (2.11.4.6.) Open. In this example, relay 2’s coil will be Nor-
Open
mally Open, and will close for 0.2 seconds.
Starting measurement
The SITRANS LUT400 is a single point device. The device starts in LEVEL mode with a
preset of no transducer and a low calibration point of 60 meters. Change the following
common parameters to reflect your application.
General Operation
Measurement conditions
The following information will help you configure your SITRANS LUT400 for optimal
mmmmm
performance and reliability.
Response Rate
The response rate of the device influences the measurement reliability. Use the slowest
rate possible with the application requirements.
Note: Changes to fill and empty rate parameters can override Response Rate
setting. See “Response Rate” on page 42.
Dimensions
Dimensions of the vessel, wet well, or reservoir (other than low and high calibration
points) are only important if you require volume readings. In this case, all dimensions are
used to calculate the volume value in terms of level. They are also used to calculate
pumped volume.
Fail-safe
The fail-safe parameters ensure that the devices controlled by the SITRANS LUT400
default to an appropriate state when a valid level reading is not available. (See list of
faults that result in fail-safe in General Fault Codes on page 231.)
Relays
Relays are the primary controls of external devices such as pumps or alarms. The
SITRANS LUT400 comes with extensive control and alarm functions described below.
General introduction
Three relays are provided on the SITRANS LUT400. Each relay may be independently
assigned to one function (one or more functions for alarms), and has a corresponding
status icon on the LCD.
18.91
General Operation
Relay 1 active
Relay 3 inactive
mmmmm
1 3 1 2
5 SAVING PARAMETERS
Discrete Input icons:
DI 1, 2 programmed
DI 1 off
DI 2 on
*Icon will not display for relay or DI that is not programmed.
Relay contact operation is NORMALLY CLOSED for alarms and NORMALLY OPEN for controls.
Default Alarm Contact Pump or Control Contact
Options * Normally Closed Normally Open
Normally Open Normally Closed
In software, all relays are programmed the same way, with ON setpoints indicating when to
change the relay contact state (open or closed). Some parameters allow the reversal of the
operation so that relay contacts can be NORMALLY CLOSED or NORMALLY OPEN (for
example, when assigned to an alarm).
In-bounds
The relay alarm becomes active if the level is inside a user-defined range.
Out-of-bounds
The relay alarm becomes active if the level is outside a user-defined range.
Temperature
In high alarm, the alarm state becomes active when the temperature rises to High
Temperature Value ON and inactive when the temperature falls below High Temperature
Value OFF. In low alarm, the alarm state becomes active when the temperature falls to
Low Temperature Value ON and inactive when the temperature rises above Low
Temperature Value OFF.
General Operation
Switch (Discrete Input)
mmmmm
The relay alarm state associated with the discrete input becomes active when the
discrete input is in a user-defined state.
Fail-safe fault
The relay alarm state becomes active when a fault that has caused a fail-safe condition
is present. The relay alarm state becomes inactive when no faults that cause fail-safe are
present.
Flowrate
Available for LUT440 (OCM) model only.
In high alarm, the alarm state becomes active when the flowrate exceeds High Flowrate
Value ON and inactive when the flowrate falls below High Flowrate Value OFF. In low
alarm, the alarm state becomes active when the flowrate falls below Low Flowrate Value
ON and inactive when the flowrate rises above Low Flowrate Value OFF.
Pump
Setpoint - ON / OFF
If the ON setpoint is higher than the OFF setpoint, the relay operates as:
• pump down control
If the ON setpoint is lower than the OFF setpoint, the relay operates as:
• pump up control
Alarm relays
Any alarm that is based on level, or a reading derived from level such as flow rate, will not
activate if there is a fail-safe condition. If the fail-safe condition occurs and the alarm is
already active, the alarm will de-activate.
The following alarm types will de-activate during a fail-safe condition:
• High Level
• Low Level
• In-bounds Level
• Out-of-bounds Level
General Operation
Note: A dedicated alarm exists for fail-safe condition as described above. See Fail-
safe fault on page 65.
Pump relays
If a pump cycle is in progress at the time the fail-safe condition occurs, then the pump cycle
will end prematurely (as if the 'off' setpoints were reached). This has the effect of turning off all
pumps immediately. If a pump run-on occurrence was scheduled for the pump cycle, it will not
occur. However, if a pump run-on occurrence has already begun at the time the fail-safe
condition occurs, then the run-on will complete.
If no pump cycle is in progress at the time the fail-safe condition occurs, then subsequent
pump cycles will not occur (the fail-safe condition will prevent pumps from starting), until the
fail-safe condition is cleared.
Miscellaneous relays
External Totalizer relay
If the external totalizer is in the process of recording volume (i.e. the relay is clicking) when a
fail-safe condition occurs, then the current series of clicks will be allowed to complete.
When totalizing volume:
Since pumps do not run when in fail-safe, then the external totalizer will in general not
operate either. If a fail-safe condition occurs during a pump cycle then the volume
pumped for that cycle will not be totalized.
Relay states
The relays on the SITRANS LUT400 are programmable, allowing for many control
schemes.
Relay Types
Relay 1 – NO / NC (Form C)
Relay 2,3 – NO (Form A)
General Operation
versa). Relay logic can be modified separately for alarms, and controls. (Logic for pumps
cannot be reversed.)
mmmmm
Function Parameter
2.8.11.1. Relay 1 Logic
2.8.11. Relay Logic for 2.8. Alarms 2.8.11.2. Relay 2 Logic
2.8.11.3. Relay 3 Logic
2.11.1. Elapsed Time Relay 2.11.1.5. Relay Logic
2.11.2. Time of Day Relay 2.11.2.5. Relay Logic
2.11. Other Control
2.11.3. External Totalizer 2.11.3.5. Relay Logic
2.11.4. External Sampler 2.11.4.6. Relay Logic
Setpoints
When a setpoint is reached, the corresponding action is taken. The setpoint can be an
ON or OFF setpoint related to a process variable, or a timed setpoint based on interval
and duration.
Function Parameter
2.7.1.6. ON Setpoint Pump 1
2.7.1.7. OFF Setpoint Pump 1
2.7. Pumps 2.7.1. Basic Setup
2.7.1.8. ON Setpoint Pump 2
2.7.1.9. OFF Setpoint Pump 2
2.7.2.2.13. Peak ON Setpoint Pump 1
2.7.2. Modifiers 2.7.2.2.14. Peak OFF Setpoint Pump 1
2.7.2.2. Energy Savings
(for 2.7. Pumps) 2.7.2.2.15. Peak ON Setpoint Pump 2
2.7.2.2.16. Peak OFF Setpoint Pump 2
2.8.1.2. High Level Value ON
2.8.1. High Level Alarm
2.8.1.3. High Level Value OFF
2.8.2.2. Low Level Value ON
2.8.2. Low Level Alarm
2.8.2.3. Low Level Value OFF
2.8.4. In-bounds Level 2.8.4.2. High Level Value
Alarm 2.8.4.3. Low Level Value
2.8.5. Out-of-bounds 2.8.5.2. High Level Value
Level Alarm 2.8.5.3. Low Level Value
2.8. Alarms
2.8.6. Low Temperature 2.8.6.2. Low Temperature Value ON
Alarm 2.8.6.3. Low Temperature Value OFF
General Operation
2. Timed Setpoints
Timed setpoints are based on interval, duration, or time of day. These setpoints are set
separately for each pump within each pump control, and for each non-pump control
function:
Function Parameter
2.7.2.3.2. Run-On Interval
2.7.2.3. Pump Run-On 2.7.2.3.3. Run-On Duration Pump 1
2.7.2. Modifiers
2.7.2.3.4. Run-On Duration Pump 2
(for 2.7. Pumps)
2.7.2.4. Pump Start 2.7.2.4.1. Delay Between Starts
Delays 2.7.2.4.2. Power Resumption Delay
2.11.1. Elapsed Time 2.11.1.2. Interval
Relay 2.11.1.3. Relay Duration
2.11.2. Time of Day 2.11.2.2. Activation Time
2.11. Other Control Relay 2.11.2.3. Relay Duration
2.11.3. External Totalizer 2.11.3.3. Relay Duration
2.11.4.3. Interval
2.11.4. External Sampler
2.11.4.4. Relay Duration
Discrete Inputs
SITRANS LUT400 has two discrete inputs to trigger or alter the way SITRANS LUT400 controls
devices. A Backup Level Override, Pump Interlock, or a Switch (DI) Alarm can be configured
using discrete inputs, and discrete input logic can be reversed if necessary for the application.
General Operation
Note: A backup level override will prevent a fail-safe condition from occurring.
Backup Level Override functionality is particularly useful in wet-wells and reservoirs that
mmmmm
use pumps:
• place a backup level switch high in a vessel to indicate when it is about to overflow
• place a backup level switch low in a vessel, to indicate when it is almost empty.
Basic operation
Configuring Backup Level Override involves three steps (see 2.9.1. Backup Level Override).
1. Select a level override value. This will be the Level output produced by the
instrument when the backup level override condition is present.
2. Select the discrete input that is connected to the point-level device.
3. Enable the Backup Level Override function.
It may also be necessary to invert the logic of the discrete input, which is possible through the
LUT400 discrete input logic parameters (see 2.9.2. Discrete Input Logic).
When the level rises to 4.3 m and the switch is activated, the reading is forced to 4.3 m
where it stays until the switch is de-activated.
Additional considerations
A Backup Level Override condition will prevent a fail-safe condition from occurring: when a
backup level override condition is present, a fail-safe response will never occur. This allows
pumps and other controls such as level alarms to be active even during the backup level
override condition.
Pump Interlocks
Discrete inputs can be used to supply pump information to the SITRANS LUT400 to set
actions that will occur when a pump is determined to be in a failed state.
For an example of how to configure a pump interlock, see Pump Control Interlocks on
page 87.
Function Parameter
2.9.2. Discrete Input Logic 2.9.2.1. Discrete Input 1 Logic
2.9. Discrete Inputs
2.9.2.3. Discrete Input 2 Logic
Read the current state of discrete input 1 in 2.9.2.2. Discrete Input 1 Scaled State and the
current state of discrete input 2 in 2.9.2.4. Discrete Input 2 Scaled State.
See Discrete inputs on page 28 for complete details on wiring the discrete inputs. To
override a level using a discrete input, see 2.9.1. Backup Level Override on page 171.
General Operation
mmmmm
Sample
Parameter Description
Value
2.5.1. Current Output LEVEL send mA proportional to level reading
Function or 2.5.2. Cur-
rent Output Function
2.5.3. 4 mA Setpoint 6 set 4 mA at process level equal to 10% of maximum
(Low Cal minus High Cal)a
2.5.4. 20 mA Setpoint 54 set 20 mA at process level equal to 90% of maxi-
mum (Low Cal minus High Cal)b
2.5.5. Minimum mA 3.5 set minimum mA level below 4 mA
Limit
2.5.6. Maximum mA 22.8 set maximum mA level above 20 mA
General Operation
Limit
a. If the level reading drops below 6 m, the mA output drops below 4 mA.
mmmmm
b. If the level reading rises above 54 m, the mA output rises above 20 mA.
Note: If default values (4 and 20 mA) are used for the minimum and maximum mA
limits, the mA output (shown in 2.5.8. Current Output Value) will remain at the set
mA limit, even if the level reading falls below/rises above the mA setpoints.
Readings
When using volume, readings are given in units specified in 2.6.2. Volume Units.
General Operation
To configure volume for a vessel with a half-sphere bottom, set
Dimension A the following:
mmmmm
Sample
Parameter Description
Value
2.6.1. Vessel Shape HALF SPHERE selects the correct vessel shape
BOTTOM
2.6.3. Maximum Volume 100 sets maximum volume at 100 (defined in
2.6.2. Volume Units)
2.6.4. Dimension A 1.3 sets dimension A to 1.3 m
Notes:
• The default reading changes to a range from 0 to 100
• The process empty value is still measured to the bottom of the vessel (2.2.1.
Low Calibration Point plus any 2.2.5. Far Range value), not the top of
Dimension A.
Characterization chart
If you cannot use a pre-defined vessel, then use one of the universal vessel shapes and
program the characterization curve.
1. Plot a volume to height chart. Usually a vessel supplier will provide this chart.
However, if you have a custom-built vessel, then you will need access to complete
drawings of the well or accurate measurements.
3. Ensure extra points are added around sharp transitions in the vessel volume (e.g:
steps in a well wall).
Note: The end points in the curve are 0,0 (fixed) and the point defined by
Maximum Level and Maximum Volume.
General Operation
mmmmm
sensor
0.4 m reference point
High Level
Value High Cal. Point
material level
reading 1.8 m
level
Low Level Value Low Cal. Point
Prerequisite: You must know the details of your application and substitute the values for
the sample values provided. If you are bench testing the device, then set your test values
to be the same as the sample values.
Note: When configuring alarms, more than one alarm can be assigned to the
same relay.
Level
The level alarm is the most common. Use this alarm to warn you when your process is in
danger of being upset due to high or low levels.
High level and low level alarms can be set to activate when the material level rises above
or falls below a set level. (See 2.8.1. High Level Alarm, 2.8.2. Low Level Alarm.)
Example: Setting a High Level Alarm
To assign Relay 3 to a high level alarm that activates when the level rises above 10 m:
1. Enable the High Level Alarm (set 2.8.1.1. Enable = Enabled)
2. Set 2.8.1.2. High Level Value ON = 10 m
General Operation
Results:
mmmmm
• Activates alarm assigned to relay 3 when level is within range 0.3 to 1.3 m
• Resets alarm above 1.3 m or below 0.3 m
Use 2.8.4.5. Alarm State to view the current state of the In-bounds Level Alarm.
Flowrate
Flowrate alarms are available on LUT440 (OCM) model only. They can activate an alarm if
the OCM flowrate is above or below a given setpoint.
Example: Setting a High Flowrate Alarm
To assign Relay 3 to a high flowrate alarm that activates when the flowrate rises above
10 l/s:
1. Enable the High Flowrate Alarm (set 2.8.9.1. Enable = Enabled).
2. Set 2.8.9.2. High Flowrate Value ON = 10
3. Set 2.8.9.3. High Flowrate Value OFF = 8
Set 2.8.9.4. Assigned Relay to Relay 3
General Operation
4.
Example: Setting a Low Flowrate Alarm
mmmmm
To assign Relay 3 to a low level alarm that activates when the flowrate falls below 2 l/s:
1. Enable the Low Flowrate Alarm (set 2.8.10.1. Enable = Enabled)
2. Set 2.8.10.2. Low Flowrate Value ON = 2
3. Set 2.8.10.3. Low Flowrate Value OFF = 4
4. Set 2.8.10.4. Assigned Relay to Relay 3
Pump Control
The SITRANS LUT400 has the pump control functionality to solve nearly any water /
wastewater application.
To set up pump control for simple applications, see Pump Control Wizard in LUT400
Communications manual1.
Fixed: Starts pumps based on individual setpoints and always starts the same pumps in
the same sequence [Fixed Duty Assist (FDA), and Fixed Duty Backup (FDB)].
Alternate: Starts pumps based on the duty schedule and always leads with a new
pump [Alternate Duty Assist (ADA), and Alternate Duty Backup (ADB)].
Service Ratio: Starts pumps based on user-defined ratio of running time [Service Ratio
General Operation
SITRANS LUT400
SITRANS LUT400
aaaaaaaaa aaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaa aaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaaaaa
High Cal. Pt.
aaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaa aaaaaaaaaaaa
outflow
aaaaaaaaa * aaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaa
inflow aaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaaaaa
** level
Low Cal. Pt.
General Operation
Sample
Parameter Description
Valuea
mmmmm
2.7.1.6. ON Setpoint Pump 1 1.0 m * Sets the level at which pump 1 turns on. The
first cycle will use this setpoint. Subsequent
cycles rotate the setpoint among the pumps.
For example: In cycle 1, pump 1 turns on at 1 m.
In the next cycle, pump 2 will turn on at 1 m.
2.7.1.8. ON Setpoint Pump 2 1.1 m * Sets the level at which pump 2 turns on.
a. Sample values denoted by asterisks in illustration on page 80.
2.7.1.7. OFF Setpoint Pump 1 0.4 m Sets the level at which pump 1 turns off. The
first cycle will use this setpoint. Subsequent
cycles rotate the setpoint among the pumps.
mmmmm
2.7.1.9. OFF Setpoint Pump 2 0.3 m Sets the level at which pump 2 turns off.
General Operation
Parameter Value Description
2.7.1.5. Pump Control Mode SRA Sets the control algorithm used to trip the
pump relay to SERVICE RATIO DUTY ASSIST.
mmmmm
Multiple pumps can run simultaneously. Pump
usage is based on RUN time rather than last
used.
2.7.1.10. Service Ratio Pump 1 25 Sets the ratio to: 25% for pump 1, i.e. pump 1
will run 25% of the time.
2.7.1.11. Service Ratio Pump 2 75 Sets the ratio to: 75% for pump 2, i.e pump 2
will run 75% of the time
Sample
Parameter Description
Value
2.7.1.7. OFF Setpoint Pump 1 0.4 m Sets the level at which the first pump turns off.
2.7.1.9. OFF Setpoint Pump 2 0.3 m Sets the level at which the second pump turns
off.
Notes:
• The SITRANS LUT400 will not sacrifice other pumping strategies to ensure that
the service ratio is held true
• If the pump ratios are set to the same value, then the ratio equals 1:1 and all
pumps are used equally (default)
When a pump start is required (ON Setpoint), the pump with the fewest running hours (with
respect to the assigned ratio values) starts.
Conversely, when a pump stop is required (OFF Setpoint), if multiple pumps are running
simultaneously, the pump with the most running hours (as compared to the assigned ratio
values) stops.
SITRANS LUT400
SITRANS LUT400
level
* Low Cal. Pt.
aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa
outflow
Setpoint sample values: * ON Setpoint Pump 1 / Pump 2
(see tables below) ** OFF Setpoint Pump 1 / Pump 2
General Operation
Set the common parameters
Prerequisite: Substitute the details of your application in place of the sample values
provided. If you are bench testing the device, set your test values to be the same as the
mmmmm
sample values.
1.3 m.
2.7.1.9. OFF Setpoint Pump 2 1.2 m** Sets the level at which pump 2 turns off.
mmmmm
aaaaaaaaa aaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaa aaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaa aaaaaaaaaaaa
High Cal. Pt. aaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaa outflow
aaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaa
inflow aaaaaaaaaaaa
aaaaaaaaaaaa
discrete input
Low Cal. Pt. level
relay output
Sample
Parameter Description
Value
2.7.1.4. Pump Control Mode ADA Sets the control algorithm used to trip the
or pump relay to ALTERNATE DUTY ASSIST.
2.7.1.5. Pump Control Mode
2.9.3.1. Enable Pump 1 ON Enables pump start interlock for Pump 1.
General Operation
2.9.3.2. Pump 1 Discrete Discrete Sets the discrete input to use for pump start
Input Input 1 interlock on Pump 1.
mmmmm
2.9.3.3. Enable Pump 2 ON Enables pump start interlock for Pump 2.
2.9.3.4. Pump 2 Discrete Discrete Sets the discrete input to use for pump start
Input Input 2 interlock on Pump 2.
2.9.2.1. Discrete Input 1 Normally Use if necessary to reverse logic for Discrete
Logic Closed Input 1.
2.9.2.3. Discrete Input 2 Normally Use if necessary to reverse logic for Discrete
Logic Closed Input 2.
These values will ensure that any pump reporting a failure is removed from the pumping
rotation. For more information on pump interlocks and discrete inputs, see Discrete
Inputs on page 69.
Sample
Parameter Description
Value
2.6.1. Vessel Shape LINEAR Vessel shape is linear (flat bottom)
2.6.3. Maximum Volume 17.6 Max volume is 17.6m3 or 17,600 liters.
2.7.1.4. Pump Control Mode ADA Sets the control algorithm used to trip the
or pump relay to ALTERNATE DUTY ASSIST.
2.7.1.5. Pump Control Mode
2.7.1.6. ON Setpoint Pump 1 1.0 m Sets the level at which pump 1 turns on. The
first cycle will use this setpoint. Subsequent
cycles rotate the setpoint among the
pumps.
2.7.1.8. ON Setpoint Pump 2 1.2 m Sets the level at which pump 2 turns on.
2.7.1.7. OFF Setpoint Pump 1 0.2 m Sets the level at which pump 1 turns off. The
first cycle will use this setpoint. Subsequent
cycles rotate the setpoint among the
pumps.
2.7.1.9. OFF Setpoint Pump 2 0.3 m Sets the level at which pump 2 turns off.
General Operation
Pump 1 is set to pump for an extra 60 seconds every 5 hours, pump 2 should not run-on.
Sample
Parameter Description
Value
2.7.2.3.2. Run-On Interval 5 Five hours between pump run-on occurrences.
2.7.2.3.3. Run-On Duration 60 The pump will run-on for 60 seconds.
Pump 1
2.7.2.3.4. Run-On Duration 0 Pump 2 will never run-on.
Pump 2
General Operation
Sample
Parameter Description
Value
2.7.2.4.1. Delay Between 20 Wait at least 20 seconds between pump starts.
mmmmm
Starts
2.7.2.4.2. Power Resumption 60 Wait for 60 seconds when power is restored for
Delay the first pump to activate.
ON Setpoint
OFF Setpoint
mmmmm
8 m (ON setpt.)
15:30 Normal Operation
(3:30 pm) Uses the standard ON and OFF setpoints (2.7.1.6.
2 m (OFF setpt.) ON Setpoint Pump 1 / 2.7.1.7. OFF Setpoint Pump 1).
Energy cost is at minimum.
General Operation
Peak OFF Setpoint Pump 1).
Energy cost is at maximum.
9 m (Peak ON) 2.7.2.2.4. Peak 1 End Time = 21:30.
mmmmm
8 m (ON setpt.)
21:30
6 m (Peak OFF) Returns to normal setpoints (2.7.1.6. ON Setpoint
(9:30 pm) Pump 1 / 2.7.1.7. OFF Setpoint Pump 1).
2 m (OFF setpt.) Energy cost returns to minimum.
Generally, you would cascade the timing of the pump downs so that the wells farthest
from the treatment facility would begin first and the entire system would push material
through during the low cost period.
Note: When the Peak ON Setpoint is not reached, no energy is used during the high
cost period. If the Peak ON Setpoint is reached, the Wet Well is only pumped down to
6 m, thereby minimizing high cost energy usage.
Other controls
Relays controlled by time
A relay can be controlled by time setpoints using Time of Day or Elapsed Time.
Set Time of Day Relay
Parameter Value Description
2.11.2.1. Enable Enabled Enables Time of Day Relay
2.11.2.2. Activation Time 17:30 Activates the relay at 5:30 pm
2.11.2.3. Relay Duration 60 Activates the relay for 60 seconds
2.11.2.4. Assigned Relay Relay 1 Sets relay 1 to be controlled by time of day
Use (if necessary) to change the behaviour of
General Operation
Normally
2.11.2.5. Relay Logic the relay assigned to the time of day control.
Closed
Default: Normally Open
mmmmm
Totalizing flow
Totalizing of the calculated flow is ongoing. Daily and running totalizers can be viewed in 2.16.
Totalizers. The daily totalizer resets automatically every 24 hours at 23:59:59, and both can be
reset by the user.
In order to adjust the rate of filling of the totalizer, the 2.7.3.3. Totalizer Multiplier can be set to
an appropriate value. Totalizing that is specific to a time and date can be viewed under View
General Operation
Logs for flow (see 3.2.6.2. OCM on page 201).
The SITRANS LUT400 can be programmed to operate a remote totalizer by assigning any of
mmmmm
the relays to act as a totalizer contact. Under this function, the maximum rate of contact
closure is 5/s with a closure duration of 100 ms.1
1. Typically the totalizer should be set for 300 to 3000 counts per day at maximum flow.
Counter Formula
1 contact every x units, where x = value set in 2.11.3.2. Multiplier is preset to 1 so
2.11.3.2. Multiplier the default number of contacts is
Example: one contact per unit of volume.
To click once every 4310 units, set 2.11.3.2. Multiplier
to 4310.
The totalizer source, and units depend on the volume configuration:
Units
Volume Configuration Totalizer Source
Source
2.6.1. Vessel Shape = NONE 2.16. Totalizers (OCM 2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
flow totalizer)
2.6.1. Vessel Shape = any setting 2.7.3. Totalizers (pumped 2.6.2. Volume Units
other than NONE volume totalizer)
Sample
Parameter Description
Value
General Operation
2.11.3.1. Enable Enabled Enables External Totalizer Relay
2.11.3.2. Multiplier 4310 Click once every 4310 units
mmmmm
2.11.3.3. Relay Duration 0.2 Activates the relay for 0.2 seconds
Sets relay 1 to be controlled by external
2.11.3.4. Assigned Relay Relay 1
totalizer
Use (if necessary) to change the
Normally behaviour of the relay assigned to the
2.11.3.5. Relay Logic
Closed totalizer.
Default: Normally Open
Counter Formula
1 contact every x units, where x = value set in 2.11.4.2. Multiplier is preset to 1 so
2.11.4.2. Multiplier the default number of contacts for
Example: a pumped volume cycle is one
To click once every 4310 units, set 2.11.4.2. Multiplier contact per unit of volume.
to 4310.
The totalizer source, and units depend on the volume configuration:
Units
Volume Configuration Totalizer Source
Source
2.6.1. Vessel Shape = NONE 2.16. Totalizers (OCM 2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
flow totalizer)
2.6.1. Vessel Shape = any setting 2.7.3. Totalizers (pumped 2.6.2. Volume Units
other than NONE volume totalizer)
By using 2.11.4.2. Multiplier, the relay contacts can be based on a volume other than a
multiple of ten.
Sample
General Operation
Parameter Description
Value
2.11.4.1. Enable Enabled Enables Flow Sampler Relay
mmmmm
1. Dimensional
For some common weir and flume types. PMD dimensions (2.15.4. PMD Dimensions) are
entered directly.
Vessel Type See page:
BS- 3680 Rectangular Flume 105
BS- 3680 Round Nose Horizontal Crest Weir 106
BS- 3680 Trapezoidal Flume 107
BS- 3680 U-Flume 108
BS- 3680 Finite Crest Weir 109
BS- 3680 Thin Plate Rectangular Weir 110
BS- 3680 Thin Plate V-Notch Weir 111
Rectangular Weir Contracted 112
Round Pipe 113
Palmer Bowlus Flume 114
H-Flume 115
General Operation
2. Exponential
For most other weir and flume types. PMD exponents provided by the manufacturer are
mmmmm
entered. Flow is calculated using the exponent (2.15.3.2. Flow Exponent) and the
maximum values (2.15.3.3. Maximum Head and 2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA).
3. Universal
For all other PMDs, the head-to-flow curve can be plotted based on known breakpoints,
usually supplied by the PMD manufacturer.
Common parameters
These common parameters are required for all installations.
Parameter Sample Value
Flow
Response Rate MEDIUM
2.1.6. Transducer XRS-5
2.1.1. Units M
2.2.1. Low Calibration Point 1.8
2.2.2. High Calibration Point 0.4
2.2.5. Far Range 0.8
General Operation
mmmmm
General Operation
far
range
mmmmm
2. Use 2.2.5. Far Range where the empty level is set to the bottom of the weir, and
above the bottom of the channel. It should be used if the surface monitored can fall
past the 2.2.1. Low Calibration Point level in normal operation without reporting an
LOE. The value is added to 2.2.1. Low Calibration Point and can be greater than the
range of the transducer.
The examples on the following pages show both methods.
Standard Weirs
transducer
3 to 4 x hmax
weir profile
General Operation
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) Exponential Devices
2.15.3.2. Flow Exponent Weir Type Valuea
V-notch 2.50
Suppressed rectangular 1.50
Cipolletti or trapezoidal 1.50
Sutro or proportional 1.00
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.2.5. Far Range
2.15.4.1. K Factorb
a.
Values are samples only. Consult weir manufacturer’s documentation for cor-
rect flow exponent.
b.
Required for exponential device absolute calculation only.
Plan View C
2/ C
3
flow
Q
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Application information
General Operation
• Sized by throat width
• Set on solid foundation
For rated flows under free flow conditions, the head is measured at 2/3 the length of
mmmmm
•
the converging section from the beginning of the throat section
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) Exponential Devices
2.15.3.2. Flow Exponent 1.522–1.607a
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
2.15.4.1. K Factorb
a. Typical Flow Exponent range for Parshall Flume; consult your flume documen-
tation.
b.
Required for exponential device absolute calculation only.
flow
Front View
converging diverging
transducer*
point of measurement
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
General Operation
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) Exponential Devices
2.15.3.2. Flow Exponent 1.547a
mmmmm
Application information
• Designed to be installed directly into pipelines and manholes
• Leopold Lagco may be classed as a rectangular Palmer-Bowlus flume
• Sized by pipe (sewer) diameter
• For rated flows under free flow conditions, the head is measured at a point
upstream referenced to the beginning of the converging section. Refer to the
following table:
Flume Size Point of Measurement
(pipe diameter in inches) cm inches
4-12 2.5 1
15 3.2 1.25
18 4.4 1.75
21 5.1 2
General Operation
mmmmm
Application information
• Similar to Parshall flume except that the floor is flat bottomed and throat has no
virtual length.
• Refer to manufacturer’s specifications for flow equation and point of head
measurement.
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) Exponential Devices
2.15.3.2. Flow Exponent 1.56 - 2.00a
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.4.1. K Factorb
a.
Typical Flow Exponent range for Cut Throat Flume; consult your flume docu-
mentation.
b.
Required for exponential device absolute calculation only.
channel
width
transducer* 1x
channel
Front View Side View width
flow
Zero
Head
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Application information
• Similar to Parshall flume except that the floor is flat bottomed and the sidewalls are
curved.
General Operation
• For rated flows under free flow conditions, the head is measured 1 x (channel width)
upstream from the beginning of the converging section.
mmmmm
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) Exponential Devices
2.15.3.2. Flow Exponent 1.55 (Consult your flume documentation.)
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.4.1. K Factora
a. Required for exponential device absolute calculation only.
Diagonal View
Plan View
3 to 4 x hmax L
Flow
B b
General Operation
transducer*
Zero
mmmmm
Head h
flow
p
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) BS-3680 Rectangular Flume
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Approach width (B)
Throat width (b)
Hump Height (p)
Throat length (L)
2.15.3.5. Zero Head Offset
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
Diagonal View
transducer*
b
h
3 to 4 x hmax
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
General Operation
Parameter Value
mmmmm
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) BS-3680 Round Nose Horizontal Crest Weir
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Crest Width b
Crest Height p
Crest Length L
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.2.5. Far Range
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
transducer*
Front View Side View 3 to 4 x hmax
L flow
1
b m
Zero Head
h
p
B
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Parameter Value
General Operation
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) BS-3680 Trapezoidal Flume
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Slope m
Approach Width B
mmmmm
Throat Width b
Hump Height p
Throat length L
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.2.5. Far Range
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
Plan View
D
Da
General Operation
transducer*
mmmmm
3 to 4 x hmax
Front View Side View L flow
Zero Head
h
p
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) BS-3680 U-Flume
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Approach Diameter Da
Throat Diameter D
Hump Height p
Throat Length L
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.2.5. Far Range
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
transducer* 3 to 4 x hmax
Front View
General Operation
Side View L
flow
Zero Head
mmmmm
h
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) BS-3680 Finite Crest Weir
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Crest Width b
Crest Height p
Crest Length L
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.2.5. Far Range
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
3 to 4 x hmax
Side View b
Zero Head
flow h
mmmmm
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) BS-3680 Thin Plate Rectangular Weir
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Approach Width B
Crest Width b
Crest Height p
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.2.5. Far Range
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
4 to 5 x hmax
Front View
General Operation
transducer* a
mmmmm
flow h
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) BS-3680 Thin Plate V-Notch Weir
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Notch angle (a)
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.2.5. Far Range
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
4 to 5 x hmax
Side View b
Zero Head
mmmmm
flow h
p
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) Rectangular Weir Contracted
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Crest Width b
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.2.5. Far Range
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
*
**
h
D
* This dimension should be at least 15 cm (6") shorter than the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
** The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value.
General Operation
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) Round Pipe
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Pipe Inside Diameter D
mmmmm
Slope (fall/run) s
Roughness Coefficient n
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.2.5. Far Range
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
Flow
Zero
Head
Parameter Value
mmmmm
Note: Palmer Bowlus Flume can only be setup using ratiometric calculations
Application information
• Sized by pipe diameter D
• Flume relief is trapezoidal
• Designed to install directly into pipelines and manholes
• Head is referenced to bottom of the throat, not bottom of the pipe
• For rated flows under free flow conditions, the head is measured at a distance of
D/2 upstream from the beginning of the converging section
flow
point of measurement
* The transducer must be above the maximum head by at least the blanking value (see 2.2.4. Near
Range).
Parameter Value
2.15.1. Primary Measuring Device (PMD) H-Flume
General Operation
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions Flume height (D)
2.15.3.3. Maximum Head
2.15.3.4. Maximum Flow at 20 mA
mmmmm
2.15.3.7. Flowrate Units
2.15.3.1. Method of Flow Calculation Ratiometric
Flow Breakpoints
Curved
mmmmm
Head Breakpoints
Flow Breakpoints
Zero Flow
Max. Head
Head Breakpoints
Zero Head
Example flumes
These example flumes would both require a universal calculation.
Trapezoidal
General Operation
mmmmm
Dual Range (nested) Parshall
Trends
To view trend lines, navigate to 3. Maintenance and Diagnostics > 3.2. Diagnostics > 3.2.2.
Trend. The PV (in percentage) is logged at five minute intervals and trend displays up to 3000
data points since last power up.
cross-hairs
current measurement
pan left/right icon - selec
General Operation
zoom icon
measurement percentage
exit icon
mmmmm
100
50
0
0
-3 -2 -1
hours
Notes:
• When a fail-safe condition has occurred, it will appear as a gap in the Trend line.
• Trend view will not timeout. This view will display on LUI until the exit icon is
selected.
General Operation
flowrate units). Truncation of flows to 110% does not apply to daily totalization.
mmmmm
To view the data log, navigate to 3. Maintenance and Diagnostics > 3.2. Diagnostics >
3.2.6. View Logs and select the desired log; Alarms, OCM, PV, or Daily Totals.
The log can be examined locally via LUI, or via USB. On LUI, viewing of the log is done by
task and by method. The viewing tasks are: Alarms, OCM, Daily Totals, or Primary
Variable (PV). The viewing methods are: by first entry, by last entry and by specified date.
The scrolling keys are used to maneuver through the tasks, methods and time of day.
Simulation
The SITRANS LUT400 supports simulation from the LUI. Level and discrete inputs can be
simulated, separately or concurrently.
Level simulation
In level simulation, the LCD reacts to the simulated level changes, and activates
relays based on the setpoints programmed. The material level can be set to
continuously sweep through the measurement range, from Low Calibration Point to
High Calibration Point and back again (using 3.4.1.3. Ramp, 3.4.1.4. Ramp Rate), or the
material level can be held at a specific value (using 3.4.1.2. Level Value).
General Operation
General Operation
Enabled: Pump relays are activated in simulation
If 3.4.3. Pump Activations is Disabled, only the LCD indicators are affected (the
mmmmm
corresponding relay icons will turn ON, but the relays will not energize). If 3.4.3. Pump
Activations is Enabled, the relay icons will turn ON, and the relays will energize.
Notes:
• If the pump relays are configured to physically activate in simulation mode, then any
time activated will be recorded in the pump Run Time parameter (see Pump Records
on page 202.).
• If a pump start delay has been programmed for the device (2.7.2.4.1. Delay Between
Starts), it will be respected in Simulation mode.
Note: As fail-safe will not be reported during simulation, a bench simulation of the
LUT400 can be run without a transducer connected.
HART status
When using HART communications via software tools such as PDM, AMS, FDT, and
FC375/475, the Level value and the readings derived from level will display simulated
values (when level or discrete input simulation is enabled on LUI). (See Process Variables
within PDM, AMS, FDT, and FC375/475.) Device status conditions within each tool will also
indicate that the device is in simulation mode (see Diagnostics).
Simulation process
Simulation is an iterative process whereby parameters are adjusted and corresponding
results are viewed in Measurement Mode. Level and Discrete Inputs can be simulated
separately, or concurrently. When either simulation is enabled, the LCD displays
Simulation Enabled in the text area for status messages (see Measurement mode
General Operation
Note: Simulation Enabled status will display on LCD even if other faults are present.
To stop simulation at any time, set the parameter for the function being simulated (3.4.1.1.
Level Simulation Enable, 3.4.2.1. Discrete Input 1, 3.4.2.2. Discrete Input 2) to Disabled.
In general, to run a simulation:
1. Select the function to be simulated: Level or Discrete Input (can be simulated
concurrently).
2. Set simulation parameters if performing a Level simulation.
3. Decide if pumps will be active during simulation (see Pump relay behaviour during
simulation on page 121).
4. Start simulation.
General Operation
Simulation timeout
mmmmm
Simulation will automatically be disabled and the LUT400 will return to normal
measurement and control ten minutes after changing (editing) any simulation parameter
(except Level Value ). When the timeout occurs, parameters used to enable simulation
(Level Simulation Enable , Discrete Input 1 , Discrete Input 2 ), as well as Pump
Activations will switch to Disabled, and the message Simulation Enabled will no longer
display on the LCD. (Device status conditions will also reset in PDM, AMS, FDT, and
FC375/475.)
Application test
You can test the application by varying the actual material level (the preferred test
method), or by simulating level changes.
If you are testing the application via simulation mode, decide if control devices, such as
pumps, are to be operational during simulation by setting the Pump Activations
parameter (see Pump relay behaviour during simulation on page 121).
While the level is being cycled, check the results of the discrete inputs either by closing
the circuit externally (preferred), or by setting DI simulation parameter to force the input
ON or OFF. Try all possible combinations to thoroughly test the setup. When simulating a
SITRANS LUT400
General Operation
mmmmm
HART Version
SITRANS LUT400 conforms to HART rev. 7.2.
SIMATIC PDM
This software package is designed to permit easy configuration, monitoring, and
troubleshooting of HART devices. The HART EDD for SITRANS LUT400 was written with
SIMATIC PDM in mind and has been extensively tested with this software.
For more information, see Operation via SIMATIC PDM 6 (HART) on page 127.
General Operation
You can download the HART EDD for SITRANS LUT400 from the product page of our
website. Go to: www.siemens.com/sitransLUT400 and click on Support>Software
Downloads.
mmmmm
Older versions of the library will have to be updated in order to use all the features of
SITRANS LUT400.
HART Status
Information on HART Status is outlined in an application guide Working with HART, which
can be downloaded from the product page of our website. Go to:
www.siemens.com/sitransLUT400 under Support and click on Application Guides.
Device Address
The unique identifier of the SITRANS LUT400 on a HART network.
disabled, a low fixed current is used, allowing for multiple devices to be connected.
mmmmm
Note: Loop current mode can not be disabled via LUI or Web Browser.
USB cable
See Communications on page 24 for typical setup via USB, then follow instructions under
Installing the USB driver in the LUT400 Communications manual1.
Communication troubleshooting
See Communication Troubleshooting on page 229 of Diagnosing and Troubleshooting .
This section of the manual covers basic information required to use these tools with your
SITRANS LUT400. Further details for each are available in the Communications for SITRANS
LUT400 (HART) Manual (7ML19985NE01). (See DVD shipped with device or download
manual from product page of our website: Go to www.siemens.com/sitransLUT400 >
Technical Info > Manuals/Operating instructions.)
Structure on page 273 for a chart. For a complete list of parameters, see Parameter
reference (LUI) on page 137.
matching
Firmware
and EDD
revisions
Installing a new version of SIMATIC PDM requires the most recent Service Pack (SP) and
the most recent hot fix (HF).
To install a new EDD
• Go to www.siemens.com/sitransLUT400 > Support > Software Downloads to
download the most up-to-date EDD from the product page of our website.
• Save the files to your computer and extract the zipped file to an easily accessed
location.
• Launch SIMATIC PDM – Manage Device Catalog, browse to and select the folder
which contains the unzipped EDD file.
Operation - PDM
mmmmm
Operation - Browser
mmmmm
Operation - AMS
(SITRANS LUT400 compatible with AMS version 10.5 and higher)
mmmmm
Features and Functions
AMS Device Manager is a software package used to commission and maintain SITRANS
LUT400 and other process devices. AMS Device Manager monitors the process values,
alarms and status signals of the device. It allows you to display, compare, adjust, verify, and
simulate process device data. The graphic interface in SITRANS LUT400 makes monitoring
and adjustments easy. Please consult the operating instructions or online help for details on
using AMS Device Manager. (You can find more information at:
http://www.emersonprocess.com/AMS/.)
AMS Device Manager features four Quick Start Wizards (Level, Volume, Volume-Linearization,
and Flow) to easily configure the SITRANS LUT400. A Pump Control Wizard is also available.
Other features include Echo Profile viewing, TVT setup, Process Variables monitoring, and
Security.
Parameters organized into three main function groups allow you to configure and monitor the
device:
• Configure/Setup
• Device Diagnostics (read only)
• Process Variables (read only)
For a chart1 of the AMS Menu Structure , see LUT400 Communications manual2.
1.
The menu structure for AMS Device Manager is almost identical to that of the LCD.
2. Communications for SITRANS LUT400 (HART) Manual (7ML19985NE01).
Operation - FC375
of AMS Device Manager.
mmmmm
Startup and Configuration
In order to configure this HART device, just as with AMS, the configuration software
requires the HART Electronic Device Description (EDD) for the instrument. Once the EDD
is installed, you can configure the device using the Quick Start Wizards within FC375/475.
For instructions on how to install the EDD, and how to configure a new device using
FC375/475, refer to the LUT400 Communications manual2.
mmmmm
A DTM is a type of software that ’plugs into’ FDT. It contains the same information as an EDD
but an EDD is independent of the operating system.
Parameters are identified by name and organized into function groups. See LCD Menu
Structure on page 273 for a chart.
Parameters accessible via the local push buttons are preceded by a number. Parameters
not preceded by a number are accessible only via remote operation.
Based on model configuration (LUT420, LUT430, LUT440), some parameters will not
appear on LUI. Exceptions are noted by parameter. Parameters
Where the same parameter exists for more than one model, but is represented by a mmmmm
different menu number, both parameters are listed together (separated by "OR"), and the
details are noted under the second of the two parameters.
For more details see:
• Operation via SIMATIC PDM 6 (HART) on page 127
• Operation via AMS Device Manager (HART) on page 131
1. Wizards
Several Wizards are available with the SITRANS LUT400. Wizards group together all the
settings needed for a particular feature. All Wizards are available via the local push
buttons, and many are also available via SIMATIC PDM under the Device menu.
For details on the Wizards listed below, see Quick Start Wizards on page 38 of
Commissioning.
2. Setup
Notes:
• See Local Commissioning on page 33 or Operation via SIMATIC PDM 6 (HART) on
page 127 for instructions.
• Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk (*) unless
explicitly stated.
• Values shown in the following tables can be entered via the local push buttons.
2.1. Sensor
2.1.1. Units
Determines sensor measurement units used when 2.1.2.Sensor Mode set to
Level, Space, Distance, or Head.
M, CM, MM, FT, IN
Options
Default: M
level
Notes:
• When Transducer (2.1.6.) is set to NO TRANSDUCER, the LOE fault will
display immediately.
• An Echo Profile (3.2.1.) cannot be requested from LUI when Transducer
(2.1.6.) is set to NO TRANSDUCER. The local push button will not operate.
2.1.7. Frequency
Adjust the shot transmit pulse frequency (in kHz).
Range: 10.000 to 52.000
Values
Default: Depends on transducer selected in Transducer (2.1.6.).
Adjust the duration of the short shot transmit pulse (in s).
mmmmm
2.2. Calibration
2.2.1. Low Calibration Point
Distance from sensor reference point 1 to Low Calibration Point defined in Units
(2.1.1.).
Range: 0.000 to 60.000
Values
Default: 60.000
1. The point from which level measurement is referenced (see Sensor Mode on page 138 for illus-
tration).
When setting the High Calibration Point value, note that echoes are ignored
within 2.2.4.Near Range.
2.2.3. Sensor Offset
The value altered when an Auto Sensor Offset (2.2.6.) is performed, defined in
Units (2.1.1.).
Range: -99.999 to 99.999
Values
Default: 0.000
Alternatively, if amount of Sensor Offset is known, enter the constant that can
be added to or subtracted from sensor value1 to compensate if the sensor
reference point has shifted.
2.2.4. Near Range
The range in front of the device (measured from the sensor reference point)
within which any echoes will be ignored. This is sometimes referred to as
blanking or a dead zone. Defined in Units (2.1.1.).
Range: 0.000 to 60.000
Values
Default: 0.300
Note: Far Range can extend beyond the bottom of the vessel.
Allows the material level to drop below Low Calibration Point without
generating a Loss of Echo (LOE) state. See Sensor Mode (2.1.2.) on page 138 for
an illustration. Defined in Units (2.1.1.).
Range: Min. = Low Calibration Point
Parameters
Values Max. = 61.000 M (200.13 FT) mmmmm
Use this feature if the measured surface can drop below the Low Calibration
Point in normal operation.
1. The value produced by the echo processing which represents the distance from sensor refer-
ence point to the target (see Sensor Mode on page 138 for illustration).
Before using this feature, verify the following parameters are correct:
• 2.2.1.Low Calibration Point (or 2.15.3.5.Zero Head Offset, if using OCM)
• 2.12.1.2.Process Temperature
• 2.2.3.Sensor Offset
A correction to any one of these parameters may resolve the issue and an Auto
Sensor Offset calibration may not be necessary.
Using Auto Sensor Offset:
Begin with a steady distance at a known low distance value (low distance value
equates to a high level value).
1. Review the distance measurement via LUI for approximately 30 seconds to
verify repeatability.
2. Measure the actual distance (for example, with a tape measure).
3. Enter the actual distance, defined in Units (2.1.1.)
The deviation between the calculated and the actual distance value is stored in
2.2.3.Sensor Offset.
2.3. Rate
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk (*)
unless explicitly stated.
Notes:
• The following three rate parameters work in conjunction, and are affected by
Response Rate (set in the Quick Start wizard).
Parameters
• Fill Rate per Minute, Empty Rate per Minute, and Damping Filter automatically
update when Response Rate is altered, but any change to these parameters
mmmmm
Enter a value slightly greater than the vessel’s maximum filling rate, in units per
minute.
Enter a value slightly greater than the vessel’s maximum emptying rate, in units
per minute.
2.4. Fail-Safe
The fail-safe parameters ensure that the devices controlled by the SITRANS LUT400
default to an appropriate state when a valid level reading is not available. The PV
region on LUI will display dashes (– – – – – – –) until the fail-safe fault has been
cleared. (See General Fault Codes on page 231 for a list of faults that will cause fail-
safe.)
Note: When a Loss of Echo occurs Material Level (2.4.1.) determines the material
level to be reported when the Fail-safe timer expires. See Loss of Echo (LOE) on
page 261 for more detail.
Note: The default is a factory setting and depends whether or not your device
was ordered as NAMUR NE43-compliant for Fail-safe.
Defines the mA output to use (shown in Current Output Value) when the Fail- Parameters
safe Timer expires and the device is still in an error condition. mmmmm
low 4 mA 20 mA 20 mA
cal. 0% 100 % 100 %
point
Head
sensor ref. point
Max. Head
(20 mA or 100%)1 High Cal. Point
liquid level
Parameters
head
Low Cal. Point
mmmmm
Zero Head
(4 mA or 0%) Far
Range
1.
Refer to PMD supplier documentation for maximum head.
Values Default:
Level, Space, Distance, Head: 60.000
Volume: Max. Volume
Flow: Max Flow
(set to value corresponding to 100% as defined by Current Out-
put Function and associated units)
level value.
mmmmm
2.6. Volume
Carries out a volume conversion from a level value.
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk (*)
unless explicitly stated.
required
LINEAR/ maximum
Upright, linear (flat bottom) volume
CYLINDER/ maximum
Flat end horizontal cylinder volume
maximum
PARABOLIC BOTTOM volume,
A dimension A
maximum
volume,
HALF SPHERE BOTTOM
dimension A
A
maximum
FLAT SLOPED BOTTOM volume,
A dimension A
maximum
PARABOLIC ENDS/
volume,
Parabolic end horizontal cyl-
dimension A,
inder
A L dimension L
maximum
SPHERE
volume
maximum
CURVE TABLEa/
volume, tables
Linearization table
1-32 level and
(level/volume breakpoints)
volume break-
points
maximum
LINEAR TABLEa/ volume, tables
Linearization table 1-32 level and
(level/volume breakpoints) volume break-
points
a.
Linearization Table must be selected in order for level/volume values [see
Table 1-8 (2.6.7.)] to be transferred.
2.6.4. Dimension A
The height of the vessel bottom when the bottom is conical, pyramidal,
parabolic, spherical, or flat -sloped. If the vessel is horizontal with parabolic
ends, the depth of the end. See Vessel Shape (2.6.1.) for an illustration.
Range: 0.000 to 99.999
Values
Default: 0.000
Defined in 2.1.1.Units.
2.6.5. Dimension L
Length of the cylindrical section of a horizontal parabolic end vessel. See
Vessel Shape (2.6.1.) for an illustration.
Range: 0.000 to 99.999
Values
Default: 0.000
Defined in 2.1.1.Units.
Parameters
mmmmm
2.6.6. User Defined Unit
Set the unit text to display for current volume when 2.6.2.Volume Units set to
user-defined. Limited to 16 ASCII characters.
Note: The text entered is simply for display purposes. No unit conversion
occurs.
2.6.7.1. Level 1
mmmmm
For details on relay behaviour under fail-safe conditions, see Pump relays on page
66.
ENABLED
Options
* DISABLED
Default: 0.000
mmmmm
This parameter is set according to level even when another reading, such
as volume, is shown on the LCD.
2.7.1.8. ON Setpoint Pump 2
The level at which Pump 2 turns ON, defined in 2.1.1. Units.
Range: 0.000 to 99999.000
Values
Default: 0.000
This parameter is set according to level even when another reading, such
as volume, is shown on the LCD.
Notes:
• The SITRANS LUT400 will not sacrifice other pumping strategies to
ensure that the ratio is held true.
• If the pump relays are set to the same value then the ratio equals 1:1
and all pumps are used equally (default).
Notes:
• The SITRANS LUT400 will not sacrifice other pumping strategies to
ensure that the ratio is held true.
• If the pump relays are set to the same value then the ratio equals 1:1
and all pumps are used equally (default).
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk
(*) unless explicitly stated.
This value is the range in which the setpoints are allowed to deviate.
The pump ON and OFF Setpoint values are randomly varied inside
the range to ensure that the material level does not consistently
stop at the same point.
level setpoint ON
To stop the pump(s) before the normal relay OFF Setpoint and
reduce pump-running time. Enter the value to be used for the high
cost period.
2.7.2.2.15. Peak ON Setpoint Pump 2
Sets the process point at which Pump 2 will turn on when in a peak
period.
Range: 0.000 to 99999.000
Values
Default: 0.000
Values
Default: 0.000
mmmmm
To stop the pump(s) before the normal relay OFF Setpoint and
reduce pump-running time. Enter the value to be used for the high
cost period.
To clear sediment in a pump-down wet well, run the pump after the
normal OFF setpoint is reached to force some solid material through.
This parameter sets the time between such events. Only the last
pump running can run-on.
2.7.2.3.3. Run-On Duration Pump 1
The number of seconds that the pump will run-on.
Range: 0 to 65535
Values
Default: 0
Each pump capacity will determine the amount of material that can
be removed. Choose a value long enough to clean out the vessel
bottom, yet short enough not to run the pump dry. Also be sure that
this value does not overlap with Run-On Interval (2.7.2.3.2.).
2.7.2.3.4. Run-On Duration Pump 2
The number of seconds that the pump will run-on.
Range: 0 to 65535
Parameters
Values
Default: 0 mmmmm
Each pump capacity will determine the amount of material that can
be removed. Choose a value long enough to clean out the vessel
bottom, yet short enough not to run the pump dry. Also be sure that
this value does not overlap with Run-On Interval (2.7.2.3.2.).
Use this feature to reduce a power surge from all pumps starting at
the same time. This delay determines when the next pump is
permitted to start.
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk
(*) unless explicitly stated.
Default: 0.00
Pumped volume is automatically calculated whenever both Volume and
Pumps are configured.
2.7.3.2. Totalizer Decimal Position
Sets the maximum number of decimal places to be displayed on the LCD.
NO DIGITS No digits after the decimal position
1 DIGIT 1 digit after the decimal point
Options
* 2 DIGITS 2 digits after the decimal point
3 DIGITS 3 digits after the decimal point
Values
Default: 0.000
mmmmm
Values
Default: 0.000
mmmmm
RELAY 3
mmmmm
Range: 0 to 9999999
Values
mmmmm
Default: 0
2.8.9.4. Assigned Relay
Determines which relay (if any) will be activated when the High Flowrate
Alarm activates.
* NO RELAY
RELAY 1
Options
RELAY 2
RELAY 3
RELAY 3
2.8.10.5. Alarm State
Read only. Used to view the current state of the Low Flowrate Alarm.
ACTIVE
Options
INACTIVE
by the LUT400 based on the material level and the rate of change of the
mmmmm
material level. If the High Level alarm is not tripped, or the material level is
falling, then the estimated time to spill will display as zero.
2.9. Discrete Inputs
Discrete inputs are used to trigger or alter the way SITRANS LUT400 controls devices
such as pumps and alarms. Discrete inputs can be used for the following:
• as a backup level override
• allowing the device to be more flexible by interlocking control functions with
external conditions.
For more detail see Discrete Inputs on page 69.
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk (*)
unless explicitly stated.
Value is defined in current 2.1.1.Units, and is valid only for level (and head
when 2.1.2.Sensor Mode set to Flow). (Volume is calculated based on the
Backup level.)
2.9.1.3. Discrete Input Number
Sets the discrete input to act as the source for a level reading override
when enabled.
* DISCRETE INPUT 1
Options
DISCRETE INPUT 2
Parameters
mmmmm
For example:
When discrete input logic is set to Normally Open and discrete input has no
voltage applied on the terminal block, the discrete input will be inactive (OFF).
2.9.2.1. Discrete Input 1 Logic
Use to change the behaviour of the Discrete Input 1.
* NORMALLY OPEN
Options
NORMALLY CLOSED
Use data logging to keep track of a parameter value on regular intervals or when an
event is triggered. Up to 3 data logs can be configured, and collectively the logs can
hold approximately 30,000 entries. [To view these data logs, see View Logs (3.2.6.).]
Notes:
• No data logs are written while device is connected to a PC via USB.
• Always disable Data Logging before removing log files (when log memory
becomes full). See Viewing the Data Log on page 119.
FIXED RATE
mmmmm
This value must be greater than the 2.11.1.3.Relay Duration or the relay will
never reset. The first activation occurs when the device is powered on.
2.11.1.3. Relay Duration
The time in seconds from one change of state in the relay to the next.
Range: 1 to 9999
Values
Default: 10
This value must be less than the 2.11.1.2.Interval or the relay will never
reset.
For instructions on how to edit parameters with a string editor, see Using
mmmmm
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk
(*) unless explicitly stated.
2.11.3.1. Enable
Enables/disables external totalizer relay control.
ENABLED
Options
* DISABLED
2.11.3.2. Multiplier
Use to scale the external totalizer up or down as required.
Range: 0.0000001 to 99999.000
Values
Default: 1.000
This allows the totalizer relay to click for different values of volume. Parameters
Example: mmmmm
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk
(*) unless explicitly stated.
2.11.4.1. Enable
Enables/disables flow sampler relay control.
ENABLED
Options
* DISABLED
2.11.4.2. Multiplier
Use to scale the external sampler up or down as required.
Range: 0.0000001 to 99999.000
Values
Default: 1.000
Parameters
This allows the sampler relay to click for different values of volume.
mmmmm
Example:
To click once every 4310 flow units, set 2.11.4.2. Multiplier to 4310.
2.11.4.3. Interval
The time in hours from the activation of the relay until the next activation.
Range: 0.10 to 99999.00
Values
Default: 1.00
This value must be less than the 2.11.4.3.Interval or the relay will never
reset.
2.11.4.5. Assigned Relay
Determines the relay assigned to flow sampler control.
* RELAY 1
Options RELAY 2
RELAY 3
2.11.4.6. Relay Logic
Use to change the behaviour of the relay assigned to flow sampler control.
* NORMALLY OPEN
Options
NORMALLY CLOSED
Relay contact operation is NORMALLY CLOSED for alarms and NORMALLY
OPEN for controls.
By default a control contact is Normally Open. For 2.11.4.3.Interval the
corresponding relay coil is energized. By setting this parameter to Normally
Closed, the relay coil will be de-energized for the activation phase.
2.12. Signal Processing
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk (*)
unless explicitly stated.
Values
Default: 344.130 m/s
With this default, the SITRANS LUT400 uses the transducer’s internal
temperature sensor (standard in all Siemens EchoMax Transducers).
If the transducer does not have an internal temperature sensor, Fixed
Temperature value, or an External TS-3 temperature sensor can be used.
If the acoustic beam atmosphere temperature varies with distance from
the transducer, connect a TS-3 Temperature Sensor and Ultrasonic/
Temperature Transducer, and select Average of Sensors (Transducer and
TS-3).
In gasses other than air, the temperature variation may not correspond
with the speed of sound variation. In these cases, turn off the temperature
sensor, select value Fixed Temperature, and set a fixed temperature [see
Fixed Temperature (2.12.1.4.)].
If Ultrasonic/Temperature Transducer, TS-3 Temperature Sensor, or
Average of Sensors value is selected, faults on the temperature sensors
will be displayed if the sensor appears open or short.
When a transducer temperature sensor fault occurs, Temperature Source
can be set to FIXED. This allows the device to continue measuring (and no
cable fault will display), until the transducer is replaced. Once replaced, set
Temperature Source back to its original setting.
2.12.1.4. Fixed Temperature
Use this feature if a temperature sensing device is not used.
Range: -100.0 to +150.0 °C
Values
Parameters
Default: +20.0 °C
mmmmm
Enter the temperature (in °C) of the atmosphere within the transducer
acoustic beam. If the temperature varies with distance from the
transducer, enter the average temperature.
2.12.1.5. Sound Velocity at 20 degrees C
This value is used to automatically calculate sound velocity.
Range: 125.000 to 20000.000 m/s
Values
Default: 344.13 m/s
If the acoustic beam atmosphere sound velocity at 20°C (68 °F) is known,
and the sound velocity vs. temperature characteristics are similar to that
of air (344.1 m/s), enter the sound velocity. Units displayed in meters per
second (m/s).
Note: In gasses other than air, the temperature variation may not
correspond with the speed of sound variation. Turn off temperature
sensor and use a fixed temperature.
echo.
TF TRUE FIRST True First echo
TR TRACKER TRacker
L LARGEST ECHO Largest echo
Options
Best of First and Largest
* BLF BEST F-L
echo
ALF AREA LARGEST FIRST Area, Largest and First
Use this feature when monitoring solids if the reported level fluctuates
slightly though the monitored surface is still. Enter the amount (in ms) of
Echo Profile smoothing required. When a value is keyed in, the nearest
acceptable value is entered.
2.12.2.4. Narrow Echo Filter
Filters out echoes of a specific width.
Range: 0 to 14 intervalsa (greater = wider)
Values
Default: 2
a.
one interval = span of 24.5 micro seconds
Use this for transducer acoustic beam interference (e.g. ladder rungs).
Enter the width of false echoes (in groups of 25 ms), to be removed from
the Echo Profile. [For example, select value of 3 to remove 75 ms (3 x 25
ms) of false echos from the profile.]
When a value is keyed in, the nearest acceptable value is entered.
Parameters
(For more detailed instructions see Auto False Echo Suppression in LUT400
Communications manual1.)
c) Navigate to Setup (2.) > Signal Processing (2.12.) > TVT Setup (2.12.3.)
> Auto False Echo Suppression Range (2.12.3.2.), and enter the value
calculated in step b).
d) Navigate to Setup (2.) > Signal Processing (2.12.) > TVT Setup (2.12.3.)
> Auto False Echo Suppression (2.12.3.1.), and press RIGHT arrow to
open Edit Mode
e) Select Learn. The device will automatically revert to On (Use
Learned TVT) after a few seconds.
2.12.3.2. Auto False Echo Suppression Range
Specifies the range within which Learned TVT is used (see Auto False Echo
Suppression on page 183 for more detail).
Range: 0.000 to 60.000 m
Values
Default: 1.000
a) Calculate range according to Auto False Echo Suppression (2.12.3.1.)
steps a) and b).
b) Press RIGHT arrow to open Edit mode.
c) Enter the new value and press RIGHT arrow to accept it.
d) Navigate to Setup (2.) > Signal Processing (2.12.) > TVT Setup (2.12.3.)
> Auto False Echo Suppression (2.12.3.1.), and set value.
2.12.3.3. Hover Level
Defines how high the TVT (Time Varying Threshold) is placed above the
noise floor of the echo profile, as a percentage of the difference between
the peak of the largest echo in the profile and the noise floor. See Example
before Auto False Echo Suppression on page 259 for an illustration.
Range: 0 to 100
Values
Default: 40
Parameters
When the device is located in the center of the vessel, the TVT hover level
may be lowered to increase the confidence level of the largest echo.
mmmmm
Turn TVT Shaper Mode ON before using 2.12.4.TVT Shaper. Turn the TVT
Shaper ON and OFF while monitoring the effect to pick up the true echo.
2.12.4. TVT Shaper
Adjusts the TVT (Time Varying Threshold) at a specified range (breakpoint on
the TVT). This allows you to reshape the TVT to avoid unwanted echoes. There
are 40 breakpoints arranged in 5 groups. (We recommend using SIMATIC PDM
to access this feature.)
Note: These parameters will display the simulated value when in simulation
mode (see Simulation process on page 122).
ESC. 2011-02-2 5 OK
MNOPQRSTUVWXYZ:/-_01234
Otherwise, when new parameter value is correct, press RIGHT arrow continually
until OK is highlighted.
d) Press RIGHT arrow to accept the new value. The LCD returns to parameter view
and displays the new selection. Review for accuracy.
Special Characters:
Character Description Function
: colon enters colon in text string
space enters space in text string
/ slash enters slash in text string
- hyphen enters hyphen in text string
_ underscore enters underscore in text string
2.14.1. Date
Date is the current date in the format: YYYY-MM-DD.
Values Range: 1900-01-01 to 2155-12-31
2.14.2. Time
Time is the current time in 24-hour format: HH:MM[:SS].
Values Range: 00:00:00 to 23:59:59
A value for seconds [:SS] is optional. If a value is not entered, the clock will
default to 0 seconds.
2.14.3. Daylight Saving
Use the following parameters to enable and define start/end dates for daylight
saving. (Start/end time of day is always 2:00am.)
Example:
Set the start of daylight saving to the second Sunday in February, and the end
of daylight saving to the first Sunday in November:
Starting Ordinal = Second
Starting Day = Sunday
Starting Month = February
Ending Ordinal = First
Ending Day = Sunday
Ending Month = November
2.14.3.1. Enable
Parameters
ENABLED
Options
* DISABLED
2.14.3.2. Starting Ordinal
The order of the day within the month when daylight saving will begin.
FIRST, SECOND, THIRD, FOURTH
Options
* FIRST
2.15. Flow
Available only on LUT430 (Pump and Flow model) and LUT440 (OCM model).
Parameters
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk (*) mmmmm
EXPONENTIAL DEVICES
U-FLUME BS-3680
ROUND PIPE
H-FLUME
Use this parameter when the reported head is consistently high or low by a
mmmmm
fixed amount.
Before using this feature, verify the following parameters are correct:
• 2.2.1.Low Calibration Point
• 2.12.1.2.Process Temperature
With HEAD steady...
a) Measure the actual head (e.g. with a tape measure or solid rule)
b) Enter the actual head value
The deviation between the entered head value and the calibrated value, is
stored in 2.15.3.5.Zero Head Offset.
Max. Flow
(2.15.3.4.)
Exponents
2.15.3.5.
2.15.3.3.
Offset
transducer
mmmmm
Material level
at zero flow
PMD base
zero head
Zero Head Offset
Low Calibration Point
Enter the minimum head in 2.1.1.Units where totalizer activity should cease.
2.15.4. PMD Dimensions
The dimensions of the Primary Measuring Device (PMD). (The dimensions of
the vessel, wet well, or reservoir are only important if you require volume.)
Exponential Devices
2.15.4.1. K Factor
2.15.4.3. Slope
Parameters
U-Flume BS-3680
mmmmm
Round Pipe
2.15.4.3. Slope
H-Flume
In the following table, enter Head and Flow Breakpoints for universal
PMDs.
mmmmm
Enter the factor (powers of 10 only) by which actual flow is divided, prior to
display on LCD. Use a value such that the eight-digit totalizer doesn’t roll over
between readings.
Example: For an LCD Total display in 1000s of flow units, enter 1000.
2.16.5. Reset Daily Totalizer
Select YES to reset daily totalizer value to zero.
* NO
Options
YES
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk (*) unless
mmmmm
explicitly stated.
3.1. Identification
To edit parameters with a string editor (3.1.1. to 3.1.5.), see Using the string editor: on
page 187.
3.1.1. TAG
Text that can be used in any way. A recommended use is as a unique label for
a field device in a plant. Limited to 32 alphanumeric characters (8 characters via
HART). Appears in top left corner of display in measurement mode (see The LCD
Display on page 34).
To perform a reset to factory defaults via SIMATIC PDM, open the menu Device
– Master Reset.
3.2.4. Power-on Resets
The number of power cycles that have occurred since manufacture.
In SIMATIC PDM, open the menu Device – Wear.
3.2.5. Power-on Time
Displays the number of days the device has been powered on since
manufacture.
In SIMATIC PDM, open the menu Device – Wear.
3.2.6. View Logs
View various log types with entries (to a collective maximum of approximately
30,000) listed by day. For a list of field names that coincide with the comma
delimited log file on the PC, see Data Logging on page 267.
Notes:
• No data logs are written while device is connected to a PC via USB.
• To clear entries when log memory becomes full, see Viewing the Data Log
on page 119.
3.2.6.1. Alarms
History of alarms. Displays type of alarm, value at which alarm triggered,
state of alarm.
3.2.6.2. OCM
Flow logs. Displays head and flow values.
3.2.6.3. Daily Totals
Daily totals for both totalizers. Displays maximum and minimum values for
flow and temperature, average flow, and daily totalizer (DT) and running
totalizer (RT) values.
Parameters
3.2.6.4. PV
mmmmm
This value measures the quality of the reported echo value: higher values
mmmmm
represent better quality. This measure combines the noise level, quality of
tracking, and signal strength. (For more details see Echo Processing on
page 255.)
Values (view only) Range: 0 to 100 %
3.2.9.2. Confidence
Indicates echo reliability: higher values represent better echo quality. The
display shows the echo confidence of the last measurement. Echo
Threshold (2.12.2.2.) defines the minimum criterion for echo confidence.
Values (view only) Range: -20 to 128
In SIMATIC PDM, open the menu Device – Echo Profile Utilities and click
on the tab Echo Profile.
In SIMATIC PDM, open the menu Device – Echo Profile Utilities and click
on the tab Echo Profile.
3.2.9.4. Noise Average
Displays the average ambient noise (in dB above 1 μV rms) of a noise profile
after each measurement.
The noise level is a combination of transient acoustic noise and electrical
noise (induced into the transducer cable or receiving circuitry). See Noise
Problems on page 240.
3.2.9.5. Noise Peak
Displays the peak ambient noise (in dB above 1 μV rms) of a noise profile
after each measurement.
3.3. Maintenance
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk (*)
unless explicitly stated.
Notes:
• An Echo Profile (3.2.1.) cannot be requested from LUI when Transducer
Enable (3.3.1.) is set to DISABLED. The local push button will not operate.
Parameters
• When Transducer Enable (3.3.1.) is set to DISABLED, the LOE fault will mmmmm
display immediately.
• If Transducer Enable (3.3.1.) is set to DISABLED and power to the device is
turned off, Transducer Enable (3.3.1.) will be reset to ENABLED when
power is restored.
When sensor unit has been replaced, fault code 132 is displayed to note that LUI
backup file does not match configuration file in sensor. To clear fault, set
Backup Control option to location from where parameter configuration should
be read; from the LUI backup file or from the new sensor.
3.3.3. Remaining Device Life
Notes:
• Four sets of parameters allow you to monitor the Device/Sensor Lifetimes
and set up Maintenance/Service schedules, based on operating hours
instead of a calendar-based schedule. See also Remaining Sensor Life
(3.3.4.), Service Schedule (3.3.5.), and Calibration Schedule (3.3.6.).
• Performing a reset to Factory Defaults will reset all the Maintenance
Schedule parameters to their factory defaults.
• The device operates in years. To view Remaining Device Lifetime
parameters in hours or days (only via SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and
AMS) see Lifetime Expected (3.3.3.1.).
The device tracks itself based on operating hours and monitors its predicted
lifetime. You can modify the expected device lifetime, set up schedules for
maintenance reminders, and acknowledge them.
The maintenance warnings and reminders are available through HART
communications. This information can be integrated into an Asset
Management system. For optimal use, we recommend that you use SIMATIC
PCS7 Asset Management Software in conjunction with SIMATIC PDM.
Parameters
• Open the menu Device – Maintenance and select the Remaining Device
Lifetime tab. (For more details see Maintenance in LUT400
Communications manual.1)
a. Units are selectable only via SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
3.3.3.1. Lifetime Expected
Note: The device always operates in years. Changing the Time Units
affects only the parameter view of the Remaining Device Lifetime
parameters in SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
a. Units are selectable only via SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
3.3.3.2. Time in Operation
Read only. The amount of time the device has been operating.
3.3.3.3. Remaining Lifetime
Read only. Lifetime Expected (3.3.3.1.) less Time in Operation (3.3.3.2.).
3.3.3.4. Reminder Activation
Notes:
• Four sets of parameters allow you to monitor the Device/Sensor Lifetimes
Parameters
The device monitors the predicted lifetime of the sensor (the components
exposed to the vessel environment). You can modify the expected sensor
lifetime, set up schedules for maintenance reminders, and acknowledge them.
a.
Units are selectable only via SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
3.3.4.1. Lifetime Expected
Note: The device always operates in years. Changing the Time Units
affects only the parameter view of Remaining Sensor Life parameters in
SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
Notes:
• Four sets of parameters allow you to monitor the Device/Sensor Lifetimes
and set up Maintenance/Service schedules, based on operating hours
instead of a calendar-based schedule. See also Remaining Device Life
(3.3.3.), Remaining Sensor Life (3.3.4.), and Calibration Schedule (3.3.6.).
• Performing a reset to Factory Defaults will reset all the Maintenance
Schedule parameters to their factory defaults.
• The device operates in years. To view Service Interval parameters in hours
or days (only via SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS) see Service
Interval (3.3.5.1.).
The device tracks service intervals based on operating hours and monitors the
predicted lifetime to the next service. You can modify the Total Service Interval,
set schedules for maintenance reminders, and acknowledge them.
The maintenance warnings and reminders are communicated to the end user
through status information. This information can be integrated into any Asset
Management system. For optimal use, we recommend that you use SIMATIC
PCS7 Asset Management Software in conjunction with SIMATIC PDM.
To access these parameters via SIMATIC PDM:
• Open the menu Device – Maintenance and select the Service Schedule
tab. (For more details see Maintenance in LUT400 Communications
manual.1)
Time Units
Allows you to set the desired units.
HOURS
Optionsa DAYS
Parameters
* YEARS
mmmmm
a.
Units are selectable only via SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
Note: The device always operates in years. Changing the Time Units
affects only the parameter view of the Service Interval parameters in
SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
a.
Units are selectable only via SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
3.3.5.2. Time Last Service
Time elapsed since last service. Can be reset to zero after performing a
service.
To reset to zero:
• In SIMATIC PDM, open the menu Device – Maintenance, click on the
Service Schedule tab, and click on Service Performed to restart the
timer and clear any fault messages.
• Navigate to Maintenance and Diagnostics (3.) > Maintenance (3.3.) >
Service Schedule (3.3.5.) > Time Last Service (3.3.5.2.), and set to zero.
3.3.5.3. Time Next Service
Read only. Time Next Service (3.3.5.3.) less Time Last Service (3.3.5.2.).
3.3.5.4. Reminder Activation
Note: To modify this parameter via SIMATIC PDM it must be accessed via
the pull-down menu Device – Maintenance.
Notes:
Parameters
• Four sets of parameters allow you to monitor the Device/Sensor Lifetimes mmmmm
The device tracks calibration intervals based on operating hours and monitors the
predicted lifetime to the next calibration. You can modify the Total Calibration
Interval, set schedules for maintenance reminders, and acknowledge them.
a.
Units are selectable only via SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
3.3.6.1. Calibration Interval
Note: The device always operates in years. Changing the units affects
only the parameter view of the Calibration Interval parameters in
SIMATIC PDM, PACTware FDT, and AMS.
(3.) > Maintenance (3.3.) > Calibration Schedule (3.3.6.) > Time Last
Calibration (3.3.6.2.), and set to zero.
mmmmm
3.4. Simulation
Use simulation to test your application. For further details, see Application examples
on page 58.
3.4.1. Level
Simulates level changes, and activates relays based on the setpoints
programmed.
3.4.1.1. Level Simulation Enable
Enables/disables level simulation.
* DISABLED
Options
ENABLED
4. Communication
4.1. Device Address
Sets the device address or poll ID on a HART network.
Range: 0 to 63 (Set within range of 0 to 15 if HART 5 master used.)
Values
Default: 0
• Go to Object Properties and open the Connection tab to access the field Short
Address.
Note: The following list of parameters are available in PDM. Unless otherwise
stated, the options are displayed in integer format (as required by HART
communications).
Manufacturer’s ID
Read only. Numerical code that refers to the manufacturer of the device (e.g. 42, which
refers to Siemens).
Device Id
Read only. Unique identification of the device by manufacturer and device type.
Read only. Revision of the Universal Device Description associated with the device.
Protocol
Read only. Revision of the set of HART common practice commands supported by the
device.
Configuration Change Counter
Read only. Indicates the number of times the device’s configuration or calibration has
been changed by a host application or from a local operator interface.
5. Security
Note: Default settings in the parameter tables are indicated with an asterisk (*) unless
explicitly stated.
Range: 0 to 65535
Values * Unlock value (2457) Lock Off
Any other value Lock On
• To turn Lock On, key in any value other than the Unlock Value.
• To turn Lock Off, key in the Unlock Value (2457).
* ENGLISH
DEUTSCH
Options FRANCAIS
ESPANOL
Characteristics
Certificates & Approvals
Device Certification
The approvals certificates applicable to the device.
Parameters
mmmmm
Firmware updates
To update the LUT400 firmware, please contact your Siemens representative to obtain
the installer (self-executable .exe file). For a complete list of representatives, go to
www.siemens.com/processautomation.
Two installers are available: one to update the firmware in the Local User Interface (LUI)
node, and one for the sensor node. One or both may be required, depending on the
reason for the update.
To complete an update, follow steps in the installer:
1. Connect your computer to the SITRANS LUT400 USB port.
2. Before running the .exe installer received from your Siemens representative, note
the computer COM port to which the LUT400 is connected.
3. From your computer, double-click the .exe, and follow the installer steps. The first
step will prompt for Communication Options. These options are set to factory
defaults. Ensure the COM Port is set to that noted in step 2 above. No other changes
are required.
4. Follow remaining installer steps.
5. Once complete, verify the update was successful by checking the current firmware
revision:
• If updating the LUI node, recycle the power on the LUT400. On power-up, you will
see the current LUI firmware revision on the LUT400 display.
• If updating the sensor node, view parameter Firmware Revision (3.1.11.) to see
the current sensor node firmware revision.
Complete a Master Reset (3.2.3.) to factory defaults after a successful upgrade of the
sensor node, before re-entering parameters.
on page 187.)
mmmmm
Maintenance
mmmmm
Troubleshooting
Notes:
• Many of the parameters referenced and techniques described here require a good
mmmmm
understanding of ultrasonic technologies and Siemens echo processing software. Use
this information with caution.
• If the setup becomes too confusing do a 3.2.3. Master Reset and start again.
• As a further resource, Understanding Ultrasonic Level Measurement is available on our
website. Go to www.siemens.com/level.
Communication Troubleshooting
Generally
1. Check the following:
• There is power at the device
• The optional LCD is showing the relevant data
• The device can be programmed using the local push buttons.
• If any fault codes are being displayed, see “General Fault Codes” on page 231
for a detailed list.
2. Verify that the wiring connections are correct.
Specifically
1. The SITRANS LUT400 is set to communicate via a HART modem but no
communication is returning to the master.
• Check that the device address is set correctly for the HART network.
2. A SITRANS LUT400 parameter is set via remote communications, but the parameter
remains unchanged.
• Try setting the parameter from the local push buttons. If it can not be set using
the buttons, ensure 5.1. Write Protection is set to the unlock value.
• Maintenance alarm
1
• Measurement values are not valid
• Maintenance required
3
• Measured signal still valid
• Configuration error
1 • Device will not work because one or more parameters/compo-
(red) nents is incorrectly configured
• Configuration warning
2 • Device can work but one or more parameters/components is
(yellow) incorrectly configured
• Configuration changed
3 • Device parameterization not consistent with parameterization
(green) in project. Look for info text.
• Out of operation
3
• Communication is good; device is out of action.
Troubleshooting
• Data exchanged
mmmmm
• No data exchange
Code / Code /
LUI PDM Meaning Corrective Action
Icon Icon
Loss of echo (LOE).
• Ensure installation details are correct.
The device was unable to get a
• Adjust process conditions to minimize
0 0 measurement within the Fail-safe
adverse conditions.
* LOE Timer period. Possible causes:
• Correct range calibration.
faulty installation, foaming/other
• If fault persists, contact your local Sie-
adverse process conditions, invalid
mens representative.
calibration range.
Inspect attached cabling and any termi-
1 1 nation points to ensure no disconnec-
Cable fault.
* tion or damage; repair/replace if
Broken cable.
necessary. If no issue with cabling, con-
tact your local Siemens representative.
3 3 Device is nearing its lifetime limit
according to the value set in Main- Replacement is recommended.
tenance Required Limit.
Code / Code /
LUI PDM Meaning Corrective Action
mmmmm
Icon Icon
4 4 Device is nearing its lifetime limit
according to the value set in Main- Replacement is recommended.
tenance Demanded Limit.
Saving Parameters.
5
(LUI fault only.)
Wait for completion.
Saving is in progress. Do not turn off
the device.
6 6 Sensor is nearing its lifetime limit
according to the value set in Main- Replacement is recommended.
tenance Required Limit.
7 7 Sensor is nearing its lifetime limit
according to the value set in Main- Replacement is recommended.
tenance Demanded Limit.
8 8
Service interval as defined in Main-
Perform service.
tenance Required Limit has expired.
Troubleshooting
Code / Code /
LUI PDM Meaning Corrective Action
mmmmm
Icon Icon
26 26
Submergence detected.
* Correct the installation.
The transducer appears submerged.
121 121 Flow calculations are not config- Reconfigure the unit. Check the configu-
ured properly. Incorrect parameter ration. If fault persists, do a master
settings. reset.
(red)
122 122 Reconfigure the unit. Check the break-
Flow calculations encountered an
points. If fault persists, do a master
error.
reset.
123 123 Reconfigure the unit. Check the flow log
Flow log could not restore the
settings. If fault persists, do a master
settings.
reset.
124 124
Reconfigure the unit. Check the flow log
Flow log is not configured properly. settings. If fault persists, do a master
reset.
(red)
125 125 Verify that the drive where the log file
Flow log error.
resides is not full. Copy the log file to a
Log failed.
computer and delete it from the device.
126 126 Verify that the drive where the log file
Failed to open log file. resides is not full. Copy the log file to a
computer and delete it from the device.
Code / Code /
LUI PDM Meaning Corrective Action
mmmmm
Icon Icon
127 127 Verify that the drive where the log file
Failed to close log file. resides is not full. Copy the log file to a
computer and delete it from the device.
128 128 Verify that the drive where the log file
Log file read error.
resides is not full. Copy the log file to a
Error reading file. Unexpected error.
computer and delete it from the device.
129 129 Log file write error. Copy the log file to a computer and
Error writing file. The file could not delete it from the device.
be written; the disk is full.
130 130
Configuration error. Adjust/correct relay assignments or
One or more settings invalid. setpoints.
(red)
131 131 Parameter backup did not succeed.
Repair required. Contact your local
Communication or file system
Siemens representative.
problems.
132 132
User input required. Manually force recovery.
Serial numbers mismatch. (Set parameter 3.3.2. Backup Control.)
(red)
Simulation is active.
133 133 Enable or disable simulation via LUI
Simulation Enabled. (3.4.1.1. Level Simulation Enable, 3.4.2.1.
Discrete Input 1, 3.4.2.2. Discrete Input
2).
Troubleshooting
while material level is Strong false echoes Determine source of false echoes;
still Relocate transducer to avoid
source.
mmmmm
Incorrect damping Adjust damping. See Damping Fil-
ter (2.3.3.) on page 143.
Improper echo Algorithm selec- Set algorithm to default. If no
tion improvement, try a different algo-
rithm. See Algorithm (2.12.2.1.) on
page 181.
High noise levels Verify source and minimize. See
“Noise Problems” on page 240.
Weak echo Determine cause;
Check noise, confidence, FOM,
and echo strength. See Echo
Quality (3.2.9.) on page 202.
Foam on surface of material Eliminate source of foaming;
Use stilling well.
Rapid temperature changes Use an external temperature sen-
sor. See Temperature Source
(2.12.1.3.) on page 180.
Faulty temperature sensor Verify operation;
Replace if required, or use fixed
temperature. See Temperature
Source (2.12.1.3.) on page 180.
Vapours If fluctuation is unacceptable, con-
sider an alternative technology.
Contact your Siemens representa-
tive.
Troubleshooting
temperature. See Temperature
Source (2.12.1.3.) on page 180.
mmmmm
Vapours present in varying con- Eliminate vapours or consider a
centrations different technology. Contact your
Siemens representative.
Thermal gradients Insulate vessel;
Consider external temperature
sensor.
Calibration required If accuracy is better when level is
close to transducer, and worse
when level is far from transducer,
perform calibration [see Auto
Sound Velocity (2.12.1.6.) on page
181].
If accuracy is consistently incor-
rect, use Sensor Offset (2.2.3.) on
page 141 or perform calibration
[see Auto Sensor Offset (2.2.6.)
on page 142].
Reading erratic Transducer mounting: wrong Ensure beam has a clear path to
location or incorrectly mounted material surface;
Verify transducer is not too tight;
Use an isolation coupling.
Unavoidable false echoes from Use Auto False Echo Suppression.
obstructions See Auto False Echo Suppres-
sion (2.12.3.1.) on page 183.
Confidence too low Check Noise, Echo Strength, Con-
fidence. See Echo Quality (3.2.9.)
on page 202.
Check LOE Timer is not set too
short. See LOE Timer (2.4.2.) on
page 144.
Multiple echoes Check mounting location;
Verify material is not entering
Near Range zone. See Near
Range (2.2.4.) on page 141.
Noise in the application Verify source and minimize. See
“Noise Problems” on page 240.
Troubleshooting
echo profile requested page 203 to ENABLED, then
via LUI (3.2.1. Echo Pro- request an echo profile.
file)
mmmmm
Configuration error 130 Relay/pump configuration
displayed errors - possible causes
include:
• A relay is assigned to more • Verify that each relay is
than one function (e.g. relay 2 assigned to one function only.
is assigned to both an Review relay assignments
external totalizer and a under Pump Control (page 151)
pump). and Other Control functions
(page 175).
• Pump setpoints are out of • Verify that all ’ON’ setpoints are
order. greater than their respective
’OFF’ setpoints for pump down
applications (or vica versa for
pump up applications).
• Wall Cling adjustment range • Ensure range set in Level
is too large. Setpoint Variation (2.7.2.1.2.) on
page 154 has not caused ’ON’ or
’OFF’ setpoints to overlap.
Echo profile request Another external communica- Wait for several seconds and then
results in an error icon tion is trying to access an echo retry the echo profile request, or
that displays for 5 sec- profile at the same time. disconnect / disable any external
onds before returning communications that may be
to the echo profile requesting an echo profile.
request menu.
Data log files are empty • Data Logging is not enabled. • Verify that Data Logging is
or logging has stopped. enabled. See Data Logging
(2.10.) on page 173.
• USB cable is connected. • Disconnect USB cable, as no
data logs are written while
device is connected to a PC via
USB.
• USB extension cable has • If a USB extension cable has
been used (although may not been used (remove if currently
currently be connected). connected), a power reset of
the device is required to restart
Data Logging.
application.
mmmmm
The noise present at the input to the ultrasonic receiver can be determined by viewing the
echo profile locally via the LUI, or alternatively, using remote software such as SIMATIC
PDM, AMS Device Manager, FC375/475, or DTM. View also parameters 3.2.9.4. Noise
Average and 3.2.9.5. Noise Peak. In general, the most useful value is the average noise.
With no transducer attached the noise is under 5 dB. This is often called the noise floor. If
the value with a transducer attached is greater than 5 dB, signal processing problems
can occur. High noise decreases the maximum distance that can be measured. The exact
relationship between noise and maximum distance is dependent on the transducer type
and the material being measured. An average noise level greater than 30 dB may be
cause for concern if the installed transducers maximum operation range matches the
range of the application (e.g. 8 m application using an 8 m XRS-5). Using a larger
transducer with greater transmitted energy should help to improve performance in a
noise condition.
Troubleshooting
of the transducer. If the noise is reduced, the noise is definitely acoustical.
mmmmm
Non-Transducer Noise Sources
Remove all input and output cables from the SITRANS LUT400 individually while
monitoring the noise. If removing a cable reduces the noise, that cable may be picking up
noise from adjacent electrical equipment. Check that low voltage cables are not being
run adjacent to high voltage cables or near to electrical noise generators such as variable
speed drives.
Filtering cables is an option but is not recommended unless all other options have been
exhausted.
The SITRANS LUT400 is designed to work near heavy industrial equipment such as
variable speed drives. Even so, it should not be located near high voltage wires or switch
gear.
Try moving the electronics to a different location. Often moving the electronics a few
meters farther from the source of noise will fix the problem. Shielding the electronics is
also an option, but it should be a last resort. Proper shielding is expensive and is difficult
to install properly–the shielding box must enclose the SITRANS LUT400 electronics
completely, and all wires must be brought to the box through grounded metal conduit.
mounting surface.
• Relocate or insulate the noise source.
• Change the frequency of the noise. Ultrasonic devices are sensitive to noise in the
frequency range of the transducer employed.
• Check that transducer is not mounted too tightly; only hand-tight.
Measurement Difficulties
If the 2.4.2. LOE Timer expires due to a measurement difficulty, the 2.4.3. Fail-Safe mA
Value displays. In rare cases, the SITRANS LUT400 may lock on to a false echo and report
a fixed or wrong reading.
Troubleshooting
Try this only if LOE exists for short periods of time.
mmmmm
Install a Transducer with a Narrower Beam
A consistent, incorrect level reading may result due to interference echoes from the sides
of a vessel. If this occurs, try installing a longer range (narrower beam) transducer, enter
the new 2.1.6. Transducer model, and (if necessary) optimize aiming and frequency again.
Always contact Siemens service personnel before selecting a transducer to solve this
type of problem.
Fixed Reading
If the Reading is a fixed value, regardless of the transducer to material surface distance,
ensure the:
1. Transducer acoustic beam is free from obstruction.
2. Transducer is properly aimed
3. Transducer is not in contact with any metal object.
4. Material mixer (if used) is operating while the SITRANS LUT400 is operating. If it is
stopped, ensure that the mixer blade is not stopped under the transducer.
Nozzle Mountings
If the transducer is mounted on or in a nozzle, grind smooth any burrs or welds on the
inside or open end (the end that opens into the vessel). If the problem persists, install a
larger diameter or shorter length nozzle, bevel the inside of the bottom end, or cut the
open end of the nozzle at a 45° angle.
See the transducer manual for complete mounting instructions.
If the mounting hardware is over tightened, loosen it. Over tightening changes the
resonance characteristics of the transducer and can cause problems.
probably something reflecting a strong echo back to the transducer. If the material level
never reaches that point extend the 2.2.4. Near Range to a distance to just past the
obstruction.
Adjust the TVT to Ignore the Echo
Use 2.12.3.1. Auto False Echo Suppression. If this does not correct the problem, use 2.12.4.
TVT Shaper to manually shape around false echoes.
Wrong Reading
If the Reading is erratic, or jumps to some incorrect value periodically, ensure the:
1. Surface monitored is not beyond the SITRANS LUT400’s programmed range or the
transducer’s maximum range.
2. Material is not falling into the transducer’s acoustic beam.
3. Material is not inside the blanking distance (near range) of the transducer.
Liquid Splashing
If the material monitored is a liquid, check for splashing in the vessel. Enter a lower
Response Rate value (see page 42) to stabilize the Reading, or install a stilling well.
(Contact Siemens representative.)
Troubleshooting
something (such as a vessel wall, or standpipe), its resonance characteristics change
and this can cause problems. Hand tighten only. PTFE tape is not recommended as it
mmmmm
reduces friction resulting in a tighter connection that can lead to ringing.
Normal Ring Down
ring down
echo profile
TVT curve
Ring down times that extend past the near range area can be interpreted by the SITRANS
LUT400 as the material level and are characterized by a steady high level being reported.
Trend Display
A trend display is available with pan and zoom options. See “Trends” on page 118.
Power
AC model
• 100-230 V AC 15%, 50 / 60 Hz, 36 VA (10W)1
• Fuse: 5 x 20 mm, Slow Blow, 0.25A, 250V
DC model
Technical Data
• 10-32 V DC, 10W 1
• Fuse: 5 x 20 mm, Slow Blow, 1.6A, 125V
mmmmm
Performance
Range
• 0.3 to 60 m (1 to 196 ft), dependent on transducer
Temperature Compensation
• Range: -40 to +150 °C (-40 to +300 °F)
1.
Power consumption is listed at maximum.
2. A high accuracy configuration consists of the LUT440 (OCM) model using XRS-5 transducer, TS-3
temperature sensor, and a Low Calibration Point of 3 m or less.
Under severe EMI/EMC environments per IEC 61326-1 the DC powered device may have an
additional error increase of up to 0.5 mm.
Temperature Error
Fixed
• 0.17 % per °C deviation from programmed value
Memory
Technical Data
Interface
Outputs
Transducer drive
• 315 V peak
mA Analog
• 4-20 mA
• 600 ohms maximum in ACTIVE mode, 750 ohms maximum in PASSIVE mode
• Resolution of 0.1%
• Isolated
Relays1 (3)
• 2 control
• 1 alarm control
Control Relays
• 2 Form A (SPST), NO relays
• Rated 5A at 250 V AC, non-inductive
• Rated 3A at 30 V DC
1. All relays are certified only for use with equipment that fails in a state at or under the rated
maximums of the relays.
Inputs
Discrete (2)
• 0-50 V DC maximum switching level
• Logical 0 = < 10 V DC
• Logical 1 = 10 to 50 V DC
• 3 mA maximum draw
Technical Data
mmmmm
Programming
Primary
• Local push buttons
Secondary
• PC running SIMATIC PDM
• PC running Emerson AMS Device Manager
• PC running a web browser
• PC running a Field Device Tool (FDT)
• Field Communicator 375/475 (FC375/FC475)
Compatible Transducers
• EchoMax series and STH series
Transducer Frequency
• 10 to 52 kHz
Communication
• HART 7.0
• USB
Display
• Back-lit LCD
• Dimensions:
• 60 x 40 mm (2.36 x 1.57")
• Resolution:
• 240 x 160 pixels
• Removable display, operational up to 5 m from enclosure base
Note: Use only approved, suitable size hubs in the enclosure’s conduit holes that
maintain the applicable IP / Type / NEMA rating.
• Polycarbonate
• Operational up to 5 m from enclosure base
Blank Lid
• 144 mm (5.7") x 144 mm (5.7") x 22 mm (0.87")
• IP65 / Type 4X / NEMA 4X
• Polycarbonate
WARNINGS:
• Ingress protection of the enclosure is reduced to IP20, and Type 4X /
NEMA 4X rating is void when cable entry knock-out in the blank lid is
removed.
• An enclosure reduced to an IP20 rating and intended for use in non-
hazardous locations must be installed in an indoor location free of dust
and moisture, or be installed in a suitably rated field enclosure IP54 or
better.
Weight
• Enclosure with display lid: 1.3 kg (2.87 lbs)
• Enclosure with blank lid: 1.2 kg (2.65 lbs)
Environmental
Location
• Indoor / outdoor
(only suitable for outdoor use with IP65 / Type 4X / NEMA 4X Enclosure)
Ambient temperature
• -20 to +50 °C (-4 to +122 °F)
Relative humidity
• Suitable for outdoors
(only with IP65 / Type 4X / NEMA 4X Enclosure)
Installation category
Technical Data
• II
mmmmm
Pollution degree
• 4
Approvals
Note: The device nameplate lists the approvals that apply to your device.
• General
CSAUS/C, CE, FM, UL listed, C-TICK
• Hazardous
Non-incendive (Canada) CSA Class I, Div. 2, Groups A, B, C, D; Class II,
Div 2, Groups F, G; Class III
back
mount
bracket
enclosure
SITRANS LUT400
198 mm
(7.8 ")
Dimensions
190 mm
(7.5 ")
mmmmm
144 mm
(5.7 ")
34 mm
22 mm (1.34")
(0.87 ") 34 mm
(1.34")
cable entry
(3 places)
155 mm
(6.10 ")
146 mm
(5.75 ")
110.00 ± 1.00
1.80 ± 1.00
13.50 ± 1.00 5.50 DIA.
(4 PLACES)
6.25 RAD.
(4 PLACES)
Dimensions
125.00
mmmmm
97.00 ± 1.00
125.00
Note: Cut-out template (printed to scale) shipped with remote panel mount model.
Principles of Operation
The SITRANS LUT400 is a high quality ultrasonic controller, configured to meet the needs
of different applications, from medium range solids applications to liquids management
with open channel measurement capability. The LUT400 features our next generation of
Sonic Intelligence® advanced echo-processing software for increased reading reliability.
Process Variables
The Primary Variable (PV) is one of six process variables, and is set in 2.5.1.Current Output
Function:
• Level (difference between material level and Low Calibration Point),
• Space (difference between material level and High Calibration Point),
• Distance (difference between material level and sensor reference point),
• Head (difference between liquid level and Zero Head),
• Volume (volume of material based on level),
• Flow (flowrate in an open channel, based on head).
Transmit Pulse
The transmit pulse consists of one or more electrical “shot” pulses, which are supplied to
the transducer connected to the SITRANS LUT400 terminals. The transducer fires an
acoustic “shot” for each electrical pulse supplied. After each shot is fired, sufficient time
is provided for echo (shot reflection) reception before the next (if applicable) shot is fired.
Echo Processing
SITRANS LUT400 uses next generation Sonic Intelligence® for echo processing.
Next generation Sonic Intelligence provides adaptive digital filtering of the transducer
signal. For example, when noise levels are high, filters are adjusted to maximize the
signal to noise ratio. This advanced Sonic Intelligence not only allows for better filtering,
but provides improved tracking of echos, and more sophisticated echo positioning
algorithms.
Echo processing consists of echo enhancement, true echo selection, and selected echo
verification.
Echo enhancement is achieved by filtering (2.12.2.4. Narrow Echo Filter) and reforming
(2.12.2.3. Reform Echo) the echo profile.
Echo Selection
Time Varying Threshold (TVT)
A TVT curve describes a threshold below which any echoes will be ignored. The default
TVT curve is used, until 2.12.3.1. Auto False Echo Suppression and 2.12.3.2. Auto False Echo
Suppression Range are used to create a new ’learned TVT curve’.
A TVT hovers above the echo profile to
screen out unwanted reflections (false
App. A - Technical Ref.
TVT. material
In a vessel with obstructions, a false level
echo may occur. See Shaper Mode and
Auto False Echo Suppression below for echo marker
more details.
The device characterizes all echoes that rise above the TVT as potential good echoes.
Each peak is assigned a rating based on its strength, area, height above the TVT, and
reliability, amongst other characteristics.
Confidence
mmmmm
Confidence (3.2.9.2.) describes the quality of an echo. Higher values represent higher
quality.
Echo Threshold
Echo Threshold (2.12.2.2.) defines the minimum confidence value required for an echo to
be accepted as valid and evaluated.
Example:
FOM greater than 75% = good quality,
FOM less than 50% = poor quality.
Various things contribute to the FOM:
• success of the tracking (how closely can the next level vs. the actual next level be
predicted)
• level of noise
• confidence of the last echo
• time interval since last valid echo
• speed at which the process is moving
• quality of the echo shape and how it helps the calculation of the echo position
If FOM is low, reduce the noise in the process, or check the installation to increase signal
quality.
ladders, chains). Such false echoes may rise above the default TVT curve.
Auto False Echo Suppression Range (2.12.3.2.) specifies the range within which the
learned TVT is applied. Default TVT is applied over the remainder of the range.
mmmmm
The material level should be below all known obstructions at the moment when Auto
False Echo Suppression learns the echo profile. Ideally the vessel should be empty or
almost empty.
The device learns the echo profile over the whole measurement range and the TVT is
shaped around all echoes present at that moment.
default
TVT material level at 31 m
false
echo
material
echo
Low Cal. Pt. = 45 m
0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0
Measurement Range
mmmmm
Near Range
Near Range (2.2.4.) programs SITRANS LUT400 to ignore the area in front of the
transducer. The default blanking distance is 27.8 cm (0.91 ft) from the sensor reference
point.
Near Range allows you to increase the blanking value from its factory default. But Shaper
Mode (2.12.3.4.) is generally recommended in preference to extending the blanking
distance from factory values.
Far Range
Far Range (2.2.5.) can be used in applications where the base of the vessel is conical or
parabolic. A reliable echo may be available below the vessel empty distance, due to an
indirect reflection path.
Increasing Far Range by 30% or 40% can provide stable empty vessel readings.
Response Rate limits the maximum rate at which the display and output respond to
changes in the measurement. There are three preset options: slow, medium, and fast.
Once the real process fill/empty rate (m/min by default) is established, a response rate
can be selected that is slightly higher than the application rate. Response Rate
automatically adjusts the three rate parameters that affect the output response rate.
Fill Rate per Minute (2.3.1.)/ Damping Filter
When Response
Empty Rate per Minute (2.3.2.) (2.3.3.) automatically
Rate set to:
automatically adjust to: adjusts to:
* Slow 0.1 m/min 100.0 s
Medium 1.0 m/min 10.0 s
Fast 10.0 m/min 0.0 s
Damping
Damping Filter (2.2.3.) smooths out the response to a sudden change in level. This is an
exponential filter and the engineering unit is always in seconds.
In 5 time constants, the output rises exponentially: from 63.2% of the change in the first
time constant, to almost 100% of the change by the end of the 5th time constant.
Damping example
time constant = 2 seconds
input (level) change = 2 m
Level (m)
Time (s)
App. A - Technical Ref.
Note: Damping Filter can be set to 0 in order to display measurement readings as fast
mmmmm
as fill/empty rates permit. Fill Rate per Minute, and Empty Rate per Minute work in
conjunction with Damping Filter, therefore, if readings are slow to respond to changes,
check that Fill and Empty Rates are set to values greater than or equal to the desired
Response Rate.
Fail-safe Mode
The purpose of the Fail-safe setting is to put the process into a safe mode of operation in
App. A - Technical Ref.
the event of a fault or failure. The value to be reported in the event of a fault (as displayed
in 2.5.8. Current Output Value) is selected so that a loss of power or loss of signal triggers
the same response as an unsafe level. mmmmm
LOE Timer (2.4.2.) determines the length of time a Loss of Echo (LOE) condition will persist
before a Fail-safe state is activated. The default setting is 100 seconds.
Material Level (2.4.1.) determines the mA value (corresponding to the selected PV) to be
reported when LOE Timer (2.4.2.) expires. The default setting is device dependent
(standard or NAMUR NE 43-compliant).
Upon receiving a reliable echo, the loss of echo condition is aborted, the Maintenance
Required icon and error message are cleared, and the mA output return to the current
material level. [The PV region on the LUI display will show dashes (– – – – – – –) when a
fault that causes fail-safe is present, and will return to the current reading when the fault
is cleared.]
Sound Velocity
The sound velocity of the transmission medium is affected by the type, temperature, and
vapor pressure of the gas or vapor present. As preset, the SITRANS LUT400 assumes the
vessel atmosphere is air at +20 °C (+68 °F). Unless altered, the sound velocity used for the
distance calculation is 344.1 m / s (1129 ft / s).
Variable air temperature is automatically compensated when a Siemens ultrasonic /
temperature transducer is used. If the transducer is exposed to direct sunlight, use a
sunshield or a separate TS-3 temperature sensor.
Also, if the temperature varies between the transducer face and the liquid monitored, use
a TS-3 temperature sensor in combination with an ultrasonic / temperature transducer.
The TS-3 must be installed as close to the material as possible to ensure best
performance. It is acceptable to submerge the TS-3 if necessary. Set 2.12.1.3. Temperature
Source for Average of Sensors, to average the transducer and TS-3 measurements.
Atmosphere composition other than air can pose a challenge for ultrasonic level
App. A - Technical Ref.
mmmmm
Select at least enough breakpoints from the curve to satisfy the following:
• two breakpoints very near the minimum level
• one breakpoint at the tangent points of each arc
• one breakpoint at each arc apex
• two breakpoints very near the maximum level
For combination curves, enter at least two breakpoints immediately before and after any
sharp angle (as well as one breakpoint exactly at the angle) on the curve.
Inflow estimation = L
Level
T
Time
Set option Based on pump cycle to calculate the inflow based on the change of volume
between the end of the last pump cycle and the start of the next one, and the time period
between the last cycle and the current one.
pump down well refills
Inflow estimation = L2–L1
L2
T2–T1
App. A - Technical Ref.
Level L2–L1
mmmmm
L1
T2–T1
T1 T2
Time
Select at least enough breakpoints from the curve to satisfy the following:
• two breakpoints very near the minimum head
• one breakpoint at the tangent points of each arc
App. A - Technical Ref.
• one breakpoint at each arc apex
• two breakpoints very near the maximum head
For combination curves, enter at least 2 breakpoints immediately before and after any
sharp angle (as well as 1 breakpoint exactly at the angle) on the curve.
mmmmm
Note: No data logs are written while device is connected to a PC via USB.
Log files written to a local computer drive via USB, are comma-delimited files, and a list of
file headings for each type of log is shown below.
Log type Headings
Alarms Current Date (YYYY/MM/DD)
Current Time (HH:MM:SS)
Alarm Name
Alarm Value
Alarm State
OCM Current Date (YYYY/MM/DD)
Current Time (HH:MM:SS)
Current Head Value (in level units)
Current Flow Value (in flowrate units)
Daily Totals Current Date (YYYY/MM/DD)
Maximum Daily Flow (in flowrate units)
Minimum Daily Flow (in flowrate units)
Daily Average Flow (in flowrate units)
Daily Totalized Volume (in volume units)
Daily Running Totalized Volume (in volume units)
Daily Maximum Temperature (in temperature units)
Daily Minimum Temperature (in temperature units)
PV Current Date (YYYY/MM/DD) App. A - Technical Ref.
Current Time (HH:MM:SS)
PV (in Device Variable Code) mmmmm
0 = Level
1 = Space
2 = Distance
3 = Volume
4 = Flow
5 = Head
PV Value (in PV units)
Temperature Value (in temperature units)
To clear entries when log memory becomes full, see Viewing the Data Log on page 119.
Technical Support
If you have any technical questions about the device described in these Operating
Instructions and do not find the answers, you can contact Customer Support:
• Via the Internet using the Support Request:
Support request (http://www.siemens.com/automation/support-request)
• Via Phone:
• Europe: +49 (0) 911 895 7222
• America: +1 423 262 5710
• Asia-Pacific: +86 10 6475 7575
Additional Support
Please contact your local Siemens representative and offices if you have additional
questions about the device.
Find your contact partner at:
App. B - Certs & Support
List of Abbreviations
Short form Long Form Description Units
mmmmm
AC Alternating Current power source
AFES Auto False Echo Suppression
Conformité Européene / Factory
CE / FM / CSA Mutual / Canadian Standards safety approval
Association
BS-3680 Flow standard from the British Standards Institute
DC Direct Current power source
DTM Device Type Manager
EDD Electronic Device Description
EMC Electromagnetic Compatibility
ESD Electrostatic Discharge
FCC Federal Communications Commission
FDT Field Device Tool
measurement of
FOM Figure of Merit
echo quality
Highway Addressable Remote
HART
Transducer
HCF Hart Communication Foundation
International Electrotechnical
IEC
Commission
IP Ingress Protection
IS Intrinsically Safe safety approval
LCD Liquid Crystal Display
LOE Loss of Echo
view outputs via LCD display;
LUI Local User Interface make modifications via local
push buttons
s microsecond 10-6 Second
V microvolt 10-6 Volt
mA Milliamp unit of electric current
Nm Newton meter unit of torque
SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL Page 273 SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7ML19985MV01
LCD Menu Structure 1. WIZARDS (cont’d)
Appendix C: menu chart
Page 274 SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7ML19985MV01
2. SETUP - VOLUME (cont’d) 2. SETUP - ALARMS (cont’d)
Appendix C: menu chart
7ML19985MV01 SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL Page 275
2. SETUP - ALARMS (cont’d) 2. SETUP - OTHER CONTROL (cont’d)
Appendix C: menu chart
2.8.10 LOW FLOWRATE ALARM (LUT440 only) 2.11.3 EXTERNAL TOTALIZER (LUT430, 440 only)
2.8.10.1 ENABLE 2.11.3.1 ENABLE
2.8.10.2 LOW FLOWRATE VALUE ON 2.11.3.2 MULTIPLIER
2.8.10.3 LOW FLOWRATE VALUE OFF 2.11.3.3 RELAY DURATION
2.8.10.4 ASSIGNED RELAY 2.11.3.4 ASSIGNED RELAY
2.8.10.5 ALARM STATE 2.11.3.5 RELAY LOGIC
2.8.11 RELAY LOGIC 2.11.4 EXTERNAL SAMPLER (LUT430, 440 only)
2.8.11.1 RELAY 1 LOGIC 2.11.4.1 ENABLE
2.8.11.2 RELAY 2 LOGIC 2.11.4.2 MULTIPLIER
2.8.11.3 RELAY 3 LOGIC 2.11.4.3 INTERVAL
2.8.12 TIME TO SPILL 2.11.4.4 RELAY DURATION
2.8.12.1 LEVEL TO SPILL 2.11.4.5 ASSIGNED RELAY
2.8.12.2 MINUTES LEFT TO SPILL 2.11.4.6 RELAY LOGIC
2.9 DISCRETE INPUTS 2.12 SIGNAL PROCESSING
2.9.1 BACKUP LEVEL OVERRIDE 2.12.1 TEMPERATURE AND VELOCITY
2.9.1.1 ENABLE 2.12.1.1 SOUND VELOCITY
2.9.1.2 LEVEL OVERRIDE VALUE 2.12.1.2 PROCESS TEMPERATURE
2.9.1.3 DISCRETE INPUT NUMBER 2.12.1.3 TEMPERATURE SOURCE
2.9.2 DISCRETE INPUT LOGIC 2.12.1.4 FIXED TEMPERATURE
2.9.2.1 DISCRETE INPUT 1 LOGIC 2.12.1.5 SOUND VELOCITY AT 20 DEGREES C
2.9.2.2 DISCRETE INPUT 1 SCALED STATE 2.12.1.6 AUTO SOUND VELOCITY
2.9.2.3 DISCRETE INPUT 2 LOGIC 2.12.2 ECHO SELECT
2.9.2.4 DISCRETE INPUT 2 SCALED STATE 2.12.2.1 ALGORITHM
2.9.3 PUMP INTERLOCK (LUT430, 440 only) 2.12.2.2 ECHO THRESHOLD
2.9.3.1 ENABLE PUMP 1 2.12.2.3 REFORM ECHO
2.9.3.2 PUMP 1 DISCRETE INPUT 2.12.2.4 NARROW ECHO FILTER
2.9.3.3 ENABLE PUMP 2 2.12.2.5 SUBMERGENCE DETECTION
2.9.3.4 PUMP 2 DISCRETE INPUT 2.12.3 TVT SETUP
2.10 DATA LOGGING 2.12.3.1 AUTO FALSE ECHO SUPPRESSION
2.10.1 PROCESS VALUE LOG 2.12.3.2 AUTO SUPP RANGE
2.10.1.1 ENABLE 2.12.3.3 HOVER LEVEL
2.10.1.2 PROCESS VALUES LOG RATE 2.12.3.4 SHAPER MODE
2.10.2 ALARM LOG 2.12.4 TVT SHAPER
2.10.2.1 ENABLE 2.12.4.1 BRKPT. 1-8
2.10.3 FLOW LOG (LUT430, 440 only) 2.12.4.2 BRKPT. 9-16
2.10.3.1 FLOW LOG MODE (LUT430) 2.12.4.3 BRKPT. 17-24
2.10.3.2 FLOW LOG MODE (LUT440) 2.12.4.4 BRKPT. 25-32
2.10.3.3 STANDARD FLOW LOG INTERVAL 2.12.4.5 BRKPT. 33-40
2.10.3.4 STANDARD FLOW LOG SETPOINT 2.12.5 MEAS. VALUES
2.10.3.5 RAPID FLOW LOG INTERVAL 2.12.5.1 LEVEL MEAS.
2.10.3.6 RAPID FLOW LOG SETPOINT 2.12.5.2 SPACE MEAS.
2.11 OTHER CONTROL 2.12.5.3 DISTANCE MEAS.
2.11.1 ELAPSED TIME RELAY 2.12.5.4 VOLUME MEAS.
2.11.1.1 ENABLE 2.12.5.5 HEAD MEAS.
2.11.1.2 INTERVAL 2.12.5.6 FLOW MEAS. (LUT430, 440 only)
2.11.1.3 RELAY DURATION 2.13 DISPLAY
2.11.1.4 ASSIGNED RELAY 2.13.1 LOCAL DISPLAY BACKLIGHT
2.11.1.5 RELAY LOGIC 2.13.2 LCD CONTRAST
2.11.2 TIME OF DAY RELAY 2.14 DATE AND TIME
2.11.2.1 ENABLE 2.14.1 DATE
2.11.2.2 ACTIVATION TIME 2.14.2 TIME
2.11.2.3 RELAY DURATION
2.11.2.4 ASSIGNED RELAY
2.11.2.5 RELAY LOGIC
Page 276 SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7ML19985MV01
2. SETUP - DATE AND TIME (cont’d)
Appendix C: menu chart
7ML19985MV01 SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL Page 277
3. MAINTENANCE (cont’d)
Appendix C: menu chart
7ML19985MV01 SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL Page 278 SITRANS LUT400 (HART) – INSTRUCTION MANUAL 7ML19985MV01
Glossary
accuracy: degree of conformity of a measure to a standard or a true value.
algorithm: a prescribed set of well-defined rules or processes for the solution of a problem in a
finite number of steps.
ambient temperature: the temperature of the surrounding air that comes in contact with the
enclosure of the device.
Auto False-Echo Suppression: a technique used to adjust the level of a TVT curve to avoid the
reading of false echoes. (See TVT.)
Auto False-Echo Suppression Range: defines the endpoint of the TVT distance. (See TVT.) This
is used in conjunction with auto false echo suppression.
blanking: a blind zone extending away from the reference point plus any additional shield
length.The device is programmed to ignore this zone.
confidence: describes the quality of an echo. HIgher values represent higher quality.
Confidence threshold defines the minimum value.
damping: term applied to the performance of a device to denote the manner in which the
measurement settles to its steady indication after a change in the value of the level.
Glossary
mmmmm
derating: to decrease a rating suitable for normal conditions according to guidelines specified
for different conditions.
echo: a signal that has been reflected with sufficient magnitude and delay to be perceived in
some manner as a signal distinct from that directly transmitted. Echoes are frequently
measured in decibels relative to the directly transmitted signal.
echo confidence: the recognition of the validity of the echo. A measure of echo reliability.
echo lock window: a window centered on an echo in order to locate and display the echo’s
position and true reading. Echoes outside the window are not immediately processed.
Echo Strength: describes the strength of the selected echo in dB referred to 1 V rms.
false echo: any echo which is not the echo from the desired target. Generally, false echoes are
created by vessel obstructions.
far range: the distance below the zero percent or empty point in a vessel.
figure of merit: combines noise level, tracking quality, and signal strength to measure the
quality of the reported echo value.
Hertz (Hz): unit of frequency, one cycle per second. 1 Gigahertz (GHz) is equal to 109 Hz.
multiple echoes: secondary echoes that appear as double, triple, or quadruple echoes in the
distance from the target echo.
parameters: in programming, variables that are given constant values for specific purposes or
processes.
speed of sound: the speed at which sound is propagated through some medium under
specified conditions.
stillpipe: a pipe that is mounted inside a vessel parallel to the vessel wall, and is open to the
vessel at the bottom.
TVT (time varying threshold): a time-varying curve that determines the threshold level above
which echoes are determined to be valid.
Glossary
mmmmm
pump strategies 79
mmmmm
common parameters 98
cut throat 103, 104 Q
flow characterization chart 116 quick start 63
flow exponent support 100 R
H flume 115 randomize setpoints 90
Leopold Lagco flume 102 range 247
Palmer Bowlus flume 114 relay
Parshall flume 101 modifiers 67
rectangular flume 105 parameters 67
universal calculation 116 programming 64
universal Parshall flume 117 totalizer 94
universal trapezoidal flume 117 resolution 247
V-Notch weir 106, 107, 109, 110, 111, Response Rate
112 explanation 260
Notes
IQ300IX.fm Page 5 Tuesday, October 2, 2001 1:43 PM
www.siemens.com/processautomation
www.siemens.com/continuous-weighing
ACE3600 RTU ab
6802979C45-D
Draft 2
OTPUTS
INPUTS
RTUs that collect data from on-site sensors,
add data from off-site sources, and use this
data aggregate to make decisions regarding
how the process is operating. Changes to the
local process may be made; messages may
be initiated that send data elsewhere to
influence the operation of off-site equipment
or to advise the SCADA Manager of some Communication
Communication
important change. System
System
• Communications:
1
ACE3600 System Overview
The Front End Processor is used at the central site(s) to provide a two-way path to the
communication system and the distant RTUs from the SCADA Manager hardware and
software. The FEP converts MDLC protocol data from the RTUs to a protocol used by
the SCADA Manager vendor: when the OPC or ModBus protocol is used, the FEP will
maintain a local database of all the data from the multiple in-field sites; when TCP/IP
gateway is used, the FEP is simply a gateway between the two different protocols. The
FEP always acknowledges all RTU-initiated messages. The FEP can also provide a two-
way path between the ACE3600 STS and the field RTUs for those functions unique to
ACE3600 that are not provided by the SCADA Manager software (over-the-air
programming download, diagnostics upload, and more.)
• SCADA Manager:
The SCADA Manager provides the operator with the display and report tools necessary
to view and manage the associated process(es). The SCADA Manager obtains data from
the FEP according to its needs and typically presents that data on custom-created display
formats; control messages may also be initiated from these custom screens. Security is
typically implemented via permission levels activated by the operator’s sign-on
password. Microsoft Windows is becoming the operating system of choice because it
easily supports the desired graphic symbols used on the custom screens. The report
capability may be provided by the SCADA software or a data export to Microsoft Excel
or equivalent may be utilized. The end result is an easy to use pictorially-described
representation of the field status of key equipment items plus the means to make changes
in how those pieces of equipment operate.
The ACE3600 STS is a software program that allows the system engineer to set up and
maintain the ACE3600 system in accordance with system-specific requirements. The
STS computer (PC) may be connected to any RTU/FEP or to the other network points in
the system and have connectivity established with any other site through the store-&-
forward capability of the MDLC protocol; all the capabilities available during a local
connection may then be enjoyed by the remotely-connected system engineer: the
communication network topography may be defined; the application(s) for each site may
be created and downloaded into the RTUs; run-time and diagnostic data may be
uploaded.
2
ACE3600 RTU Construction
The ACE3600 RTU is a universal device that may serve as an RTU, a Programmable
Logic Controller (PLC), or as the system FEP. It is placed at the system’s field sites to
collect data from on-site sensors, add data from off-site sources, and use this data
aggregate to make decisions regarding how some process is operating. The RTU may
make changes to the local process; messages may be initiated that send data elsewhere to
influence the operation of off-site equipment or to advise the SCADA Manager of some
important change.
Plastic slots which accommodate the power supply, CPU and I/O modules, and
backplane bus motherboard
Mounting plate for attaching the plastic slots together and mounting the frame on
a wall
Backplane bus motherboard which connects the modules to each other via the
signal buses and connects the modules with operating voltages
Power junction box for AC or DC power source and ground connections
A frame can be mounted on the wall or installed in a 19" rack or customer enclosure.
3
Application of Current transducer:
Current transducer measure power and monitor filling and pumping
operations as well as monitoring changing process
variables.
Specifications:
FCS521/FCS2151
Power Supply15-42 Vdc at sensor (loop powered) Operating Temperature -30C to +70°C(32 to 104 ° F)
Input Current RangesThree field selectable ranges, 0-10/0-20/0-50 Amps
or 0-50/0-100/0-200 Amps
Operating Humidity0 to 95% RH, non-condensing
Maximum Input&XUUHQW
Page 1of
Page 2 of
Attention:0-5V,0-10V output are do not need power supply.
Disconnect and lock-out all power sources during installation as severe injury or death can result from electrical shock
due to contact with high voltage conductors. Ensure all installations are in compliance with applicable electrical codes
and that the installation is completed by qualified installers familiar with the standards and proper safety procedures
for high-voltage installation. Never rely on status indicating devices only to determine if power is present in a conductor.
Insure the range selection jumper is installed in the correct position for the current being monitored. Excessive
current can damage the sensor. See below for information on setting the jumpers.
Install the Split-Core over the conductor to be monitored and close the sensor until it latches, ensuring that the two halves
are properly aligned. Operation of the sensor will be impaired if any dirt particles prevents good contact between the
core pieces when the device is closed, keep the sensor clean when it is opened.
Mount the switch in a suitable location using the two mounting holes in the base of the unit.
The conductor may be looped more than once through the sensor to multiply the sensitivity but this also divides the
maximum
currents. For example, on the 0-200 amp scale, if the conductor is looped through twice, the maximum current will
now be 100 amps.
Connect the output circuit to the two screw terminals using ring or fork type terminals. Typical connections are shown
in the wiring examples. Note polarity as indicated on the device label.
To allow field calibration, all devices have easily accessible calibration pots.
Page 3 of
Owner’s Manual
ACE3600 RTU
ab
6802979C35-B
The Motorola products described in this instruction manual may include copyrighted Motorola computer programs stored in
semi conductor memories or other media. Laws in the United States and other countries preserve for Motorola certain
exclusive rights for copyrighted computer programs including the exclusive right to copy or reproduce in any form the
copyrighted computer program. Accordingly, any copyrighted Motorola computer programs contained in the Motorola
products described in this manual may not be copied or reproduced in any manner without the express written permission of
Motorola Inc.. Furthermore, the purchase of Motorola products shall not be deemed to grant either directly or by implication,
estoppel, or otherwise, any license under the copyrights, patents or patent applications of Motorola, except for the normal
non-exclusive, royalty free license to use that arises by operation of law in the sale of a product.
Hereby, Motorola declares that these products comply with RoHS European Directive no. 2002/95/EC (Restriction of the use
of Hazardous Substances) and WEEE Directive no. 2002/96/EC (Strategy of Waste management), with the exception of
models listed in Appendix B.
Motorola, Inc.
1301 E. Algonquin Road,
Schaumburg, IL 60196 U.S.A.
CONTENTS
GLOSSARY ............................................................................................................................................................ III
i
Contents
ii
Contents
iii
Contents
iv
GLOSSARY
iii
Glossary
iv
Glossary
v
DESCRIPTION
Product Overview
The ACE3600 is a programmable Remote Terminal Unit (RTU). Almost any automation task
can be implemented with a suitable choice of ACE3600 components. Typically the RTU
monitors and controls local equipment and communicates with a control center and with other
RTUs in the system. The ACE3600 is the newest Motorola SCADA (MOSCAD) RTU, a
member of MOSCAD family of RTUs and Control Center Front End Processors.
The ACE3600 System Tools Suite (STS) can be run on a local or remote PC to perform all the
setup, programming and monitoring operations such as RTU configuration, system/application,
download, monitoring, etc.
General Description
The ACE3600 RTU is a modular unit, comprised of removable modules installed in a multi-
slot frame. These modules include
• Power supply
• CPU
• I/O modules
1-1
Description
The basic (default) model includes one power supply and one CPU module. The number of
I/O modules is selected as an option of the base model.
Figure 1-1 provides a general view of the ACE3600 RTU with five I/O modules.
POWER MOUNTING
SUPPLY PLATE
MODULE
• Mixed I/O
• Mixed Analog
Communication Interfaces
The ACE3600 CPU includes the following serial ports:
1-2
Description
Two additional plug-in ports can be added to the CPU. The following types of communication
modules are available for the plug-in ports:
• RS232
• RS485
• General radio interface (Conventional or Trunking, DPSK 1200, FSK 2400, DFM 4800,
Duo-binary 9600)
• Ethernet 10 Mb/s
• Metal chassis which accommodates the frame, and optional radios, backup battery and
communication interfaces
• Protective housing which accommodates the frame, and optional radios, backup battery
and communication interfaces (suitable for outdoor installation)
• Plastic slots which accommodate the power supply, CPU and I/O modules, and
backplane bus motherboard
• Mounting plate for attaching the plastic slots together and mounting the frame on a
wall
• Backplane bus motherboard which connect the modules to each other via the signal
buses and connects the modules with operating voltages
A frame can be mounted on the wall or installed in a 19” rack or customer enclosure. For more
information, see the Installation chapter below
The ACE3600 frame can include wide or narrow plastic slot units:
• Wide slot unit - can hold a power supply and a CPU or up to three I/O modules
1-3
Description
RTU Options
Each RTU can include a number of options, including portable and mobile radios, and plastic
boxes with interface card for communication, etc.
1-4
Description
For installation instructions of each housing/mounting type, see the Installation chapter.
For the dimensions and weight of each combination, see Appendix A: General Specifications.
For a detailed list of all ACE3600 options, see the ACE3600 price pages and ordering
information.
For a detailed description of the individual modules, see the appropriate chapter below.
1-5
Description
RTU Components
The ACE3600 RTU can include the following components.
1-6
Description
The full list of ACE3600 options and accessories are listed in the ACE3600 System Planner.
1-7
INSTALLATION
General
The ACE3600 RTU is shipped from the factory with the modules and plug-in ports assembled.
The RTU frame is ready for mounting directly on a wall or in a customer's enclosure. The eight
I/O frame can be installed on a 19" rack.
Modules can be added to the slots in a frame before or after mounting the RTU on a
wall/enclosure.
If the I/O connections are powered by a safety extra low voltage (SELV)
(<60VDC or <42Vpeak), all inputs should be defined SELV.
INSTALLATION CODES
INTERCONNECTION OF UNITS
Cables for connecting RS232 and Ethernet Interfaces to the unit must be
UL-certified type DP-1 or DP-2. (Note- when residing in a non LPS circuit.)
OVERCURRENT PROTECTION
2-1
Installation
After removing the power supply module, allow the metal parts to cool
down before servicing the unit.
Before drilling holes for mounting the frame, make sure there are no
electrical wires installed inside the wall at the holes’ location.
Four holes are provided, one in each corner of the RTU frame, for wall mounting the RTU.
Figure 2-1, Figure 2-2, and Figure 2-3 show the dimensions of the various frames/metal chassis
and the distances between the holes. For convenient installation of the ACE3600 RTU on a
wall, allow an additional 6 cm (2.4") (in W, H) and 7 cm (2.75") (in D) around the plate.
410 mm
295 mm
443 mm
330 mm
117 mm 234 mm
82 mm
199.6 mm
124 mm
244 mm
209 mm
124 mm
Figure 2-2 No I/O and 3 I/O Frame Installation Dimensions and Screw Holes for
Installation
314 mm
278.5 mm 391 mm
356.9 mm
244 mm
124 mm
244 mm
124 mm
Figure 2-3 5 I/O and 7 I/O Frame Installation Dimensions and Screw Holes for
Installation
The following screw mount installation procedure should be used to install all ACE3600
frames (with or without a metal chassis) on a wall, except the 8 I/O (19") frames.
1) Drill four holes in the wall at the horizontal and vertical distances shown in Figure 2-1 and
Figure 2-2.
2) Insert M4 screws (not supplied) with head size DIN 7981C/ST4, 2x38mm into the holes.
4) Lift the RTU frame and hang over the four screws.
2-3
Installation
6) Tighten all four screws with a screwdriver to secure the frame firmly against the wall.
Note: The brackets for 19" rack installation are not provided with the RTU and should be
ordered separately.
1) Press the small metal bracket into the slot of the larger bracket. See Figure 2-4.
2) Secure the two brackets together with two M5 screws (supplied), according to the desired
depth of the unit on the rack. See Figure 2-4.
4) Using the supplied two screws, attach the combined brackets to the metal pole of a 19"
rack unit. See Figure 2-4. Repeat on other side.
Metal Pole
Large Bracket
Small Bracket
Bracket Groove
2-4
Installation
5) Hang the 19'' metal chassis on the brackets, so that the two teeth on the back of the metal
chassis hook onto the groove of the larger bracket.
6) From the standard rack unit, remove the two modules from the leftmost slots and the two
modules from the rightmost slots. For the 19" accessories metal chassis, no accessories
need to be removed. (See Figure 2-6.)
7) Using two supplied M5 (X6) screws and a 16 cm (6.3") long screwdriver, from inside the
slot secure the 19" metal chassis to the small bracket. Repeat on the second side. See
Figure 2-5.
2-5
Installation
Portable Radio
Plastic Boxes
Mobile Radio
Battery
Figure 2-6 Installation of ACE3600 RTU 19" Rack Accessories - General View
450 mm
128 mm
93 mm
The following installation procedure should be used to install the 8 I/O (19") frame on a wall,
using the special wall mount brackets provided with the RTU.
1) Remove the CPU, Power Supply and I/O modules from the RTU rack.
2) Drill four holes into the wall at the horizontal and vertical distances shown in Figure 2-7.
3) Using two supplied screws, secure the rectangular wall mounting bracket to the wall.
Repeat for the second bracket.
2-6
Installation
4) Hang the metal chassis on brackets so that the 2 teeth of the metal chassis hook onto the
groove of the brackets. (See Figure 2-8.)
5) Using two M4 screws (not supplied) with head size DIN 7981C/ST4, 2x38mm screws,
secure the top and bottom of the rack to the left bracket. Repeat for the right bracket.
For convenient installation of the ACE3600 RTU with the NEMA4 housing, allow an
additional 6 cm (2.4") (in W, H) and 7 cm (2.75") (in D) around the housing.
Four mounting brackets are provided, one in each corner of the RTU, for wall mounting the
RTU housing (see Figure 2-9 through Figure 2-11). Figure 2-9 and Figure 2-10 show the
distances between the bracket holes.
2-7
Installation
20.86" 17.40"
(53.0 cm) (44.2 cm)
16.2" 12.6"
(41.2 cm) (32.0 cm)
1) Drill four holes in the wall at the horizontal and vertical distances shown in Figure 2-9 (for
the large housing) and in Figure 2-10 (for the small housing.)
2) Using the brackets and the screws supplied in the plastic bag, fasten the mounting brackets,
either horizontally or vertically, onto the four back corners of the housing. See Figure 2-
11.
3) Mount the RTU onto the wall and secure with M4 screws (not supplied) with head size
DIN 7981C/ST4, 2x38mm through the bracket hole. See Figure 2-11.
2-8
Installation
MOUNTING
BRACKET
PRE±INSTALLED
(WELDED) ON SOME
HOUSING BRANDS
The procedures for the main power, ground and battery connections are provided below.
Per UL 60950 / EN 60950, for all I/O modules connections, the maximum
voltage should not exceed 60V DC or 30 V AC unless it is specifically
written otherwise.
2-9
Installation
Make sure that the ground wire on the user cable is long enough to reach the
grounding strip.
Safety standards require that the power cable be attached to the unit at two anchor
points:
• Anchor point 1 for all units is inside the power junction box. (See Figure 2-12
below.)
• Anchor point 2 for the basic model (No I/O Slots Frame) is located on the right of
the power junction box. (See Figure 2-12 below.)
Anchor point 2 for all units with housing (other than No I/O Slots) is in the
housing power cable gland. (See Figure 2-16 below.)
Anchor point 2 for all other units without housing (other than No I/O Slots) is
near the unit’s ground strip. (See Figure 2-13 below.)
2-10
Installation
Procedure 2-5 How to Connect the RTU to Main Power Source (Units with Frames and Metal
Chassis)
1) Using a screwdriver, open the power junction box cover (save the screws) and unscrew the
power terminals screws inside the power junction box.
2) Thread the user's main power cable through the two supplied clamps.
3) Attach the wires of the user cable, according to the labels (~/0 for AC and +/- for DC.) For
the No I/O Frame, connect the ground cable to the lower wire terminals (third pair). Figure
2-14 and Figure 2-15.
0
Wire ~
Terminals
0 ~
Anchor Point 1
Figure 2-14 RTU Power and Ground Connections - No I/O Frame Installation
2-11
Installation
Figure 2-15 RTU Power and Ground Connections – All Other Installations
4) Pass the power cable to the right of the wire terminals inside the junction box, over the
horizontal ridge.
5) Close the first clamp around the user cable and screw it onto the junction box, into the hole
next to wire terminals (anchor point #1).
6) Close the second clamp and screw it onto the anchor point near the grounding strip (or on
the bottom of the plastic to the right of the junction box in case of the No I/O Slots frame.)
9) For all installations except the No I/O frame, loosen the two screws on the grounding strip
at the bottom of the metal chassis/housing and connect the ground cable to the protective
ground. Tighten the screws firmly.
10) Open the door of the power supply module and press in the cable holder downwards.
11) Plug the connector of the power supply cable (3089004V64 for DC, 3089004V65 for AC)
into the cable inlet on the power supply module (on the bottom of the front panel.) and
rotate the cable holder upwards to secure.
2-12
Installation
Procedure 2-6 How to Connect the RTU to Main Power Source (Units with Housing)
1) Using a screwdriver, open the power junction box cover (save the screws) and unscrew the
power terminals screws inside the power junction box.
2) Insert the rubber grommet (supplied) into the threaded plastic cable gland, and place it into
the hole on the bottom of the housing (from the outside.) (See Figure 2-16.)
3) Place the nut into the same hole from inside the housing and screw the nut onto the cable
gland. (See Figure 2-16.)
4) Thread the user's main power cable (110/220VAC or 24-48VDC) through the cable gland
cover from below, through the cable gland, and into the housing. (See Figure 2-16.)
RTU Housing
Power
Grommet
Cable
5) Attach the wires of the user cable, according to labels (~/0 for AC and +/- for DC.) See
Figure 2-14 and Figure 2-15. For the No I/O frame, connect the ground cable to the lower
wire terminals (third pair).
6) Tighten the screws of the wire terminals and screw the wire terminals onto the junction
box.
7) Pass the power cable into the right side of the junction box, over the horizontal ridge.
8) Place the user cable into the clamp, close the clamp and screw it onto the junction box, into
the hole next to wire terminals (anchor point #1).
2-13
Installation
10) Secure the junction box cover with the two saved screws.
11) For all installations except the No I/O frame, loosen two screws on the grounding strip at
the bottom of the metal chassis/housing and connect the ground cable to the protective
ground. Tighten the screws firmly.
12) Screw the top of the cable gland tightly to the cable gland to secure the cable (anchor point
#2).
13) Open the door of the power supply module and release the cable holder (press downward).
14) Plug the connector of the power supply cable (3089004V64 for DC, 3089004V65 for AC)
into the cable inlet on the power supply module (on the bottom of the front panel.) and
close the cable holder.
Before using the Lead Acid backup battery, it is strongly recommended to read the
information on the battery provided in the Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
chapter.
Lead acid batteries will self-discharge if they are stored without charging. Self-
discharge below the manufacturer's recommended voltage will result in internal
permanent damage to the battery rendering it inoperable. When this occurs, if
connected to a power supply/charger, the battery may produce excessive internal heat
and therefore deform and/or leak.
1) Check the battery visually. If the battery looks deformed and / or you notice corrosion on
the battery terminals and / or the battery leaks, DO NOT use the battery and replace it with
a new battery.
2-14
Installation
2) Check the battery terminal voltage level before connecting it. If the battery voltage is less
than 10V DC, DO NOT use the battery and replace it with a charged battery that measures
at least 10V DC.
3) If the battery passes a visual inspection and the terminal voltage is correct, plug the battery
cable (3089927V10) into the Battery In/Out connector on the power supply module.
1) Identify the PGND pin(s) on the I/O module using the Module Block Diagram or
Connection Charts in the relevant chapter for the I/O module type. See the symbol
next to the Protective Ground in the Module Block Diagrams.
2) If user-supplied cables are used, connect the ground wire(s) to the PGND pin(s) on the I/O
module and to the grounding strip at the bottom of the RTU. (See grounding strip in
Figure 2-13 above.)
3) If the wired cable braid is used, identify the ground wire(s) based on the pin number
printed on the wire label.
Connect the ground wire(s) from the cable braid to the PGND pin(s) on the I/O module and
to the grounding strip at the bottom of the RTU. (See grounding strip in Figure 2-13
above.)
4) Repeat steps 1-3 for the PGND wires on all I/O modules.
1) To open a small RTU housing equipped with a door latch, turn the latch clockwise. The
door will open.
To open a small RTU housing equipped with the padlock accessory, remove the user-
supplied padlock (if one exists) and turn the padlock accessory clockwise. The door will
open.
2-15
Installation
To open a large RTU housing equipped with two door latches, turn both latches clockwise.
The door will open.
To open a large RTU housing equipped with the padlock accessory and a latch, remove the
user-supplied padlock (if one exists) and turn the padlock accessory and latch clockwise.
The door will open.
2) To close a small RTU housing equipped with a door latch, turn the latch counterclockwise
and push the door closed until the latch clicks.
To close a small RTU housing equipped with the padlock accessory, turn the padlock
accessory counterclockwise and push the door closed until the latch clicks. Add the user-
supplied padlock (if one exists) to lock the door.
To close a large RTU housing equipped with two door latches, turn both latches
counterclockwise and push the door closed until the latch clicks.
To close a large RTU housing equipped with the padlock accessory and a latch, turn the
padlock accessory and latch counterclockwise and push the door closed until the latch
clicks. Add the user-supplied padlock (if one exists) to the padlock accessory to lock the
door.
2-16
Installation
Procedure 2-10 How to Install the Plastic Box Interface on the Metal Chassis
1) To connect the plastic box interface to the metal chassis, place the box on the metal plate
and click the two pegs on the back of the plastic box into the desired holes on the metal
chassis. See Figure 2-19.
Note: This figure is for illustration purposes only. It is not possible to install all
accessories on the same metal chassis.
Portable Radio
Plastic Boxes
Mobile Radio
Battery
Figure 2-19 Accessories Installed on a Metal Chassis
2) To remove the plastic box interface from the metal chassis, insert a screwdriver into the
notch located in the snap securing the unit to the chassis. Slightly bend the snap outwards
to release it from the slot, and carefully pull out the unit.
2-17
POWER SUPPLY MODULE AND BACKUP BATTERY
Common characteristics of all power supply modules (not including the DC power supply low-
tier):
• Controlled power line enables centralized disabling of Electrically Energized relay outputs
in selectable DO modules.
Note: The DC power supply low-tier does not support radios that require input power other
than 10.8-16V. Do not use portable radios which require 7.5V input with this option.
Note: The low limit of the DC power supply (10.8-16V) can be configured to 10.5V. The
default is 10.8.
3-1
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
• Over-charging protection
• Over-discharge protection
P WR
AUX1
AUX2
DO
BATT
ON
OFF
1A
AUX
1B
AUX
2A
AUX
2B
AUX
_ DO
12V
p
k Ex
Rac
e ry
Batt
Tem
p
This converter
er In
Pow 2
18-7
VDC
exists only in AC
or 18-72V DC PS
3-2
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
Figure 3-2 below depicts a detailed view of the power supply front panel.
PWR
AUX1
AUX2
Indication LEDs
DO
BATT
On/Off Switch
Auxiliary Output 1A
Auxiliary Output 1B
Auxiliary Output 2A
Auxiliary Output 2B
12V DO Control
12V Out (Reserved)
Battery In/Out
Temperature Sensor
AC/DC Main Power Input
DC Main Power Input
ON/OFF Switch
The front panel of the power supply module includes an ON/OFF switch for the module. In the
OFF (down) position, all the power outputs except Battery In/Out are disabled. A mechanism
is provided to prevent accidentally changing the switch position.
In power supply modules equipped with a battery charger, if the ON/OFF switch is in
the OFF position, and the RTU main power is connected, the Battery In/Out is not
disabled to ensure battery charging.
3-3
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
Input/Output Connectors
The front panel of the power supply module (not including DC power supply low-tier) includes
the following connectors.
Caution: Auxiliary Output 1A and 1B are ON by default with 13.8V DC. Do NOT plug in a
radio which requires less voltage or the radio may be damaged.
Caution: If both 2A and 2B are ON, they must have the same output level. If cables are
connected to Auxiliary Output 2A and 2B, they must use the same voltage.
3-4
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
Battery In/Out Battery charger output when the The charging voltage level is
(only in power supply main power exists. controlled by the battery
with charger) charger and is a function of the
Backup power input from battery temperature.
when the main power fails.
Temperature Sensor Sensor for battery temperature to (In modules with power supply
control charging level. and charger only)
For more information, see the
Backup Battery section below.
AC/DC Main Power Cable inlet for main power cable The cable is part of the RTU
Input (AC or DC) frame (connected to the power
junction box.
The front panel of the DC power supply low-tier includes the following connectors.
3-5
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
LEDs
The front panel of the power supply module (not including the DC power supply low-tier)
includes five indication LEDs.
3-6
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
Battery Charger
Power supply modules with a battery option support a 6.5 or 10 Ah Lead-Acid battery. The
power supply automatically switches to the backup battery as a 12V DC power source for the
RTU and communications when the main AC or DC power source fails.
Power supply modules with a 12 VDC smart battery charger option charge the backup battery
when not in use, and protect the battery from over-discharge. The charger performs battery
tests/diagnostics, including controlled battery discharge, when requested by the user. If the
battery is failed, the charger will not charge it and will send a failed status signal to the CPU.
If the battery is remotely located, long battery cables can be used.
Diagnostics
A battery test can be performed on the Lead-Acid battery, either from the ACE3600 STS
Hardware Test utility or from the user application program. The battery test includes disabling
the battery charger, discharging the battery and measuring the capacitance. For more
3-7
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
information, see the Hardware Test section or the Creating a User Application section of the
ACE3600 STS User Guide.
It is recommended to run a battery capacity test once per month (for more exact results
perform at +10˚ to +30˚C), and a charge level test once per day. The capacity test
discharges the battery for 20 seconds and then measures the output. If the capacity is
below the manufacturer recommended level, the battery should be replaced with a new
one. (See Replacing the Backup Battery below.) Note that the capacity test is only
available for the battery types supplied by Motorola.
• Battery OK
The battery capacity test will be blocked under the following conditions:
For instructions on connecting the power supply to a power source, see the Power and Ground
Connections section of the Installation chapter above.
All power and ground connections must be in accordance with local standards and
laws.
3-8
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
3-9
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
3-10
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
3-11
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
Backup Battery
Overview
The ACE3600 backup 12V Lead-Acid battery provides backup for the main input power. The
battery is available in two capacities: 6.5 Ah and 10 Ah. Switching from main input power to
the battery and charging of the battery is performed by the ACE3600 power supply module.
Sealed Lead Acid technology batteries can be recharged and discharged at a temperature range
of -30º to +60ºC. Storage and operating temperatures affect the battery capacity and lifespan.
ACE3600 power supply modules include a special charging power supply designed to fit the
specific temperature-compensated float-voltage-charging curve of the battery.
Lead Acid batteries will self-discharge if they are stored without charging. Self-
discharge below the manufacturer's recommended voltage will result in internal
permanent damage to the battery rendering it inoperable. When this occurs, if
connected to a power supply/charger, the battery may produce excessive internal heat
and therefore deform and / or leak.
The batteries are shipped disconnected from the power supply/charger. To ensure that
there are no battery problems on your ACE3600 project, each Lead Acid battery
MUST be fully charged and checked before connecting it to the ACE3600 power
supply/charger. To verify that the battery is fit for use, measure the BATTERY OPEN
CIRCUIT voltage (when the battery is not connected to the power supply/charger)
with a digital voltmeter. If the battery voltage is less than 12.5 V DC, DO NOT use
the battery and replace it with a new ACE3600 battery that measures more than 12.5 V
DC.
Before transporting the battery, read and follow all safety information located on the
battery case.
ACE3600 batteries are shipped from the factory tested, fully charged and with a label
stating the next time it should be recharged when stored at temperatures of 30ºC or
less.
Motorola battery warranty is valid only when the battery is charged with the original
Motorola ACE3600 charging power supplies. Use of any other power supply/charger
will void the battery warranty.
3-12
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
Under various state or local laws, the batteries must be recycled or disposed of
properly and cannot be disposed of in landfills or incinerators. Environmental
protection regulations classify used Lead Acid batteries as hazardous waste, unless
certain exemptions apply. Consideration should be given to the methods of collecting,
labeling, handling and shipping used Lead Acid batteries. Please consult the
environmental protection authority for specific legal requirements and for recycling
options in your country/area.
• Transportation:
Batteries must be handled with care to prevent falls, impact, short circuit or exposure
to high temperatures and fire.
• Battery Storage:
Storage of batteries in a warehouse requires a periodic recharge. The time between
these recharge cycles depends upon the storage temperature. The minimum open
circuit voltage allowed on the battery before recharging is 12.42 V, which represents
remaining capacity of approximately 30%. Therefore it is recommended to perform a
full charging cycle every few months depending upon the storage temperature of the
battery. Please refer to Table 3-1 to determine the suggested maximal period between
recharge cycles that suits the actual storage conditions. Improper storage may cause
deep discharge of the battery, which might cause degradation of the battery operating
life and lower the actual delivered capacity. Motorola performs a periodic full charge
cycle procedure on stored batteries and a final full charge operation prior to shipment.
• Lifespan:
The average temperature of the battery environment affects the lifespan of batteries
installed in the field. Please refer to the battery vendor information at the following
website:
3-13
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
Table 3-1: Recommended Time between Periodic Battery Recharge vs. Storage Temperature
Average Storage Recharge Interval
Temp (°C) (Months)
25 12
45 4
60 1
A battery contains diluted sulfuric acid, a toxic and corrosive substance. Avoid any
bodily contact with the leaking liquid when handling leaking batteries and affected
parts. If the battery leaks and the liquid inside touch the skin or clothing, immediately
wash it off with plenty of clean water. If the liquid splashes into eyes, immediately
flush the eyes with plenty of clean water and consult a doctor. Sulfuric acid in the eyes
may cause loss of eyesight and acid on the skin will cause burns.
1) Disconnect the battery cable from the Battery connector of the power supply (see
Figure 3-2) and from the battery.
2) Unscrew the battery holders (two screws in the small battery and four screws in the
large battery) with the attached battery temperature sensor. (See Figure 3-3 below.)
3-14
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery
4) Check the replacement battery visually. If the battery looks deformed, if you notice
corrosion on the battery terminals, or the battery leaks, DO NOT use the replacement
battery; get another replacement battery.
5) Check the replacement battery terminal voltage level before connecting it. If the
battery voltage is less than 12.42V DC, DO NOT use the battery and replace it.
6) If the replacement battery passed the visual inspection and the terminal voltage is
satisfactory, put the battery into place on the RTU and screw in the battery holders.
7) Connect the battery cable to the battery terminals in the correct polarity.
8) Connect the battery cable to the Battery In/Out connector on the front panel of the
power supply module.
3-15
CPU MODULE
General Description
The main element of the ACE3600 is the CPU module. It controls the I/O modules, processes
the gathered data and communicates with the outside world.
The core of the module is Freescale’s MPC8270 32-bit microprocessor which has extended
communication capabilities, high speed core, DMA and floating point calculation support. The
module includes on-board memory, communication ports, I/O bus interface and other circuits.
The firmware is based on Wind River’s VxWorks operating system.
Module Location: The CPU is a removable module located in a dedicated slot in the RTU rack.
The CPU module must be plugged into the wide slot to the right of the Power Supply module.
(Inserting the module in the wrong slot will not cause any damage to the CPU.)
Figure 4-1 provides a general view of the ACE3600 CPU (Models 3610 and 3640).
PWR
ERR
RST
APPL
CONF
P1
Tx
Rx
CM
S1
Tx
Rx
CM
S2
Tx
Rx
CM
P2
Tx
Rx
CM
USR1
USR2
USR3
USR4
The CPU panel includes status LEDs, user LEDs, communication port LEDs, two pushbuttons,
and communication ports. The panel is covered by the module door.
4-1
CPU Module
PWR
Pushbuttons
ERR
RST
CPU Status
APPL
CONF
LEDs A1
U2B
Tx
Rx
CM Plug-in 1 *
S1
Serial 1
Tx
Rx
Port
CM
S2
Serial 2
Tx
Rx
LEDs CM
Rx
E2
LNK
A2
Tx
Plug-in 2 *
Rx
CM
LNK
User USR1
USR2
USB 1.1 (Models 3630 and abo
LEDs USR3
USR4
*Optional
Figure 4-2 ACE3600 CPU (Model 3610/3640) – Front Panel
Front Panel
Communication Ports
The CPU module includes several communication ports:
On Board ports:
• Plug-in 2 (PI2) – fits RS232, RS485, 10 MB Ethernet, or Radio Modem Plug-in port
option.
For the detailed specifications of each port, see CPU 3610/CPU 3640 Module Specifications
below. For information on the cables and connectors, see Appendix C.
4-2
CPU Module
Buzzer
The CPU module includes a buzzer (audio indication), which is used to indicate task
completion (such as end of download/upload, restart etc.) and can also be controlled from the
user application program.
Pushbuttons
The CPU includes two pushbuttons on the front panel, PB1 and PB2.
These pushbuttons are used for activating and testing the modules LED, restarting the unit,
erasing the user Flash memory and activating memory test. Table 4-2 describes the
pushbuttons functionality.
The pushbuttons can also be monitored by the user application program (when it is running) for
the application purposes.
LEDs
The CPU includes CPU status LEDs, port status LEDs, and user LEDs. Some of the LEDs are
single color (green) and some are bicolor LEDs (red, green or orange).
Status LEDS indicate the CPU status in startup (boot), run-time or when there is a failure. The
communication LEDs are used to indicate the communication port status. The user LEDs can
be used by the user application program. Note that during startup or failure, the communication
and user LEDs are used to indicate various situations. Table 4-4 details the LEDs functionality.
CPU Memory
The ACE3600 CPU includes Flash, SDRAM, and optional SRAM Plug-in memory.
The Flash stores the firmware, the user application program, and the user data.
The optional SRAM memory expansion is used for logging user data. The SRAM data is
retained using an on-board rechargeable lithium battery. See Backup Battery for SRAM and
RTC for more information.
The size of the CPU memory is determined by the model as shown in the table below.
4-3
CPU Module
Model Model
3610 3640
Flash memory 16 MB 16 MB
SDRAM 32 MB 32 MB
memory:
User Flash: 3 MB 3 MB
User SDRAM: 10 MB 10 MB
SRAM Plug-In 4 MB 4 MB
The CPU date and time can be set using the ACE3600 STS. The CPU can also be
synchronized with other RTUs in the system, using the system clock. For more information,
see the Setting/Getting a Site’s Date and Time section or the Creating a User Application
section of the ACE3600 STS User Guide.
The lithium battery is located on the CPU board and cannot be replaced.
Typically, the battery will retain the SRAM data and RTC for 60 continuous days without
power and no Lead-Acid backup battery. When the SRAM option is not used, the Lithium
battery will keep the Real Time Clock running for a longer period of time.
4-4
CPU Module
If the startup fails, the RTU will freeze (boot sequence stops), the PWR LED will blink and the
four indicator LEDs (see LEDs Location in Table 4-3) will blink seven times. The four LEDs
will then display the failure error in binary code, as described in Table 4-3.
If the RTU fails to restart after the user-defined site configuration was downloaded, a unique
LED display (in the range of the PI1-TX and SI2-RX LEDs) and a series of buzzer tones will
follow. The RST LED will turn RED and the RTU will restart itself with the previous “good”
configuration. The following message will appear in the RTU Error Logger “Configuration
file was deleted due to failure in startup. Rolling back to the last configuration file”. Errors can
be retrieved from the RTU using the ACE3600 STS Error Logger utility.
If the startup succeeds after configuration download but has errors, these errors are reported in
the RTU Error Logger. It is, therefore, recommended to check for errors after downloading a
configuration file to the RTU. Errors can be retrieved from the RTU using the ACE3600 STS
Error Logger utility.
For information on retrieving errors from the RTU Error Logger, see the Operation chapter of
the ACE3600 STS User Guide.
Power-down
When the voltage provided to the CPU module drops below the minimum level, the CPU will
shut down in an orderly fashion. This level is configurable for all power supply modules other
4-5
CPU Module
than the 12V DC power supply low-tier. See the ‘Minimum DC operation voltage’ parameter
in Appendix A: Site Configuration Parameters of the ACE3600 STS User Guide.
The CPU error logger information can be retrieved using the STS Error Logger utility. For
more details, see the Error Logger section of the ACE3600 STS User Guide.
4-6
CPU Module
Figure 4-3 depicts a plug-in port board attached to the ACE3600 CPU module.
Supporting
Pins
Plug-in 1
Supporting
Pins
Plug-in 2
2) Remove the cover from the desired opening on the front panel.
4) Place the plug-in board with the RJ-45 connector facing the panel. Carefully insert the
plug-in board connector into the appropriate connector on the CPU board.
For Ethernet 10/100 MB, use the J14 connector on the CPU (Plug-in 1 only.)
For all other plug-in ports, use the J5 (Plug-in 1) or J6 (plug-in 2) connector.
5) Connect the two supporting pins with screws to the other side of the CPU board.
4-7
CPU Module
Figure 4-4 depicts the user SRAM Plug-in memory in the ACE3600 CPU module.
Procedure 4-3 describes how to connect a plug-in SRAM memory card to the CPU.
Procedure 4-2 How to Connect a Plug-in SRAM Memory Card to the CPU
2) Remove the cover from the connector marked P12 on the CPU board.
3) Place the plug-in SRAM memory card with the connector facing the panel. Carefully
insert the plug-in board connector into the connector on the CPU board.
4) Secure the memory card to the CPU board with the supplied screw.
4-8
CPU Module
Pushbutton Functionality
The table below describes the use of the two pushbuttons in various scenarios, during power-up
and run-time. To press a pushbutton during startup, first press the pushbutton(s), then turn on
the RTU using the On/Off switch on the front panel. Keep the pushbutton(s) depressed for the
required number of seconds, as specified in the scenarios below.
Table 4-2 ACE3600 Pushbutton Functionality
4-9
CPU Module
Ethernet LEDs ERR Code 6 -ERR Code 6 = Low voltage under 12V
in ACE 3640
Where OFF LED = '0';
On CPU 3640, the ON LED = '1' (very fast blink, almost
four LEDs begin continuous);
with the group The highest LED is the most significant.
marked E1, as
above.
On CPU 3610, the
four LEDs are
unmarked, but can
be found after the
S2 group.
4-10
CPU Module
4-11
CPU Module
4-12
CPU Module
4-13
I/O MODULES
General Description
The ACE3600 RTU can include up to eight I/O modules, depending on the frame size. A
variety of I/O modules are available.
The I/O modules can be positioned in the slots to the right of the CPU. As with all ACE3600
modules, the I/O modules can be replaced while the power is on (hot swap.)
ERR ERR
1 UF 1 UF
OF OF
2 UF 2 UF
OF OF
3 UF 3 UF
OF OF
4 UF 4 UF
OF OF
5 UF 5 UF
OF OF
6 UF 6 UF
OF OF
7 UF 7 UF
OF OF
8 UF 8 UF
OF OF
24V 24V
9 UF
OF
10 UF
OF
11 UF
OF
12 UF
OF
13 UF
OF
14 UF
OF
15 UF
OF
16 UF
OF
24V
I/O Module with Two TBs I/O Module with Expanded TBs
Figure 5-1 ACE3600 I/O Module – General View
Each I/O module includes an ERR status LED, individual I/O status LEDs, an array of I/O
connectors, and a coding mechanism for the terminal cable connector or TB holder option.
5-1
I/O Modules
ERR ERR
1 UF 1 UF
OF OF
2 UF 2 UF
OF OF
3 UF 3 UF
OF OF
4 UF 4 UF
OF OF
5 UF 5 UF
OF OF
6 UF 6 UF
OF OF
7 UF 7 UF
OF OF
8 UF 8 UF
OF OF
24V 24V
9 UF
OF
10 UF
OF
11 UF
OF
12 UF
OF
13 UF
OF
14 UF
OF
15 UF
OF
16 UF
OF
24V
The I/O status LEDs in Digital Input (DI) and Digital Output (DO) modules indicate ON and
OFF (LED lit when the I/O is ON.) In Analog Input (AI) modules, each input has two LEDs,
indicating Overflow (OF) and Underflow (UF). In Analog Output (AO) modules, each output
has three LEDs, indicating voltage output (Vout), current output (Iout), and calibration (Cal).
The I/O module LEDs can be tested using the STS Hardware Test utility– all the LEDS are lit
for a number of seconds, and then turned back to their previous state.
5-2
I/O Modules
1) Open the door of the I/O module to expose the TB connectors (2-4).
2) Position the TB extractor over the desired TB connector, with the small notch facing to the
right. (See Figure 5-4.)
3) Press the center of the TB extractor from both sides to open the two sides of the clamp end.
4) Clamp the open TB extractor over the desired TB connector and pull on the back handle to
extract the TB connector from the I/O module.
5-3
I/O Modules
A TB holder kit is available to enable self-assembly of cables. User assembled cables should
use wires of up to 0.4mm (26 AWG). The TB holder kit does not include a cable.
Note that a TORX screwdriver is required for assembling the TB holder and a flat screwdriver
is required for setting the code key pin.
5-4
I/O Modules
If the TB holder kit is ordered, follow the procedure below: (See Figure 5-6)
1) Prepare the cable by cutting the wires to fit the TBs. Connect the wires of the user-
assembled cables to the TBs, following the pin descriptions on the module panel label
(where pin 1 is at the top of first TB and so on downwards.)
2) Place the TBs onto the left part of the TB holder plastic.
3) Add the top ejector handle, the code key and the positioner.
4) Close the right side of the plastic TB holder over the left side.
5) Screw together the assembly using the three screws provided in the kit.
Note the lower screw holds the positioner into place.)
7) Slide the metal axis into lower ejector handle from the side.
5-5
I/O Modules
Figure 5-6 Terminal Block (TB) Holder Assembly – Exploded View with Coding
5-6
I/O Modules
2) Using the supplied screw, attach the TB holder clip to the bottom of the I/O module. (see
Figure 5-7)
I/O Module
TB Holder TB Holder
Clip Screw Clip
Cable Pipe
Figure 5-7 I/O Module with Terminal Block (TB) Holder Clip
2) On the TB holder, loosen the screw and turn the positioner so that the arrow points to
either A or B.
4) With a flat screwdriver, set the code key pin to a number from 1 to 6.
5) On the I/O module, using a flat screwdriver, set the pin to the same number (from 1 to 6.)
This ensures that the TB holder will not be accidentally connected to the wrong I/O
module.
6) Slide the plastic lip on the bottom of the I/O module to either A (up) or B (down) (as in
Step 2).
7) Align the plastic lip with the flat edge of positioner on the TB holder and snap the TB
holder into the I/O module, (see Figure 5-8), fitting the code key pin into the code key.
8) If the ejector handles are extended, push them inwards, against the TB holder (see Figure
5-8.)
9) If a TB holder clip was attached to the I/O module, slide the cable between the two edges
of the clip, and press the clip closed to secure the TB holder to the module. See Figure 5-7.
5-7
I/O Modules
10) Label the TBs wires with any desired user notes. The wires are numbered 1-20 or 1-40
depending on the model. The wire numbers correspond to the module pins.
11) To extract the TB holder from the I/O module front panel, extend the ejector handles
outward away from the module and pull on the handles.
Figure 5-8 provides a general view of the TB holder and an I/O module.
Ejector Terminal
Handles Blocks (TB)
16
UF
OF
24V
Figure 5-8 Terminal Block (TB) Holder on I/O Module – General View with Coding
User Label
Each I/O module is provided with a blank label on the module door for user notes.
5-8
I/O Modules
Automatic Module ID
Each I/O module has a unique module type ID number. When the RTU is powered up or when
an I/O module is inserted into a slot (hot-swap), the CPU automatically identifies the module
type.
The module ID can be viewed from the STS Hardware Test utility. For more information, see
the Hardware Test section of the ACE STS User Guide.
Before installing the 24V DC floating plug-in power supply card on the I/O module, please
verify that the FPGA version of the I/O module is as follows:
5-9
I/O Modules
Use the ACE36000 STS Hardware Test utility to retrieve the FPGA version from the unit. If
the FPGA version listed in the Module Diagnostics is lower than the version in the chart above,
you must upgrade the I/O version by downloading a higher version FPGA file using the STS.
Contact your local support team for the updated FPGA file.
Attach the power supply to the I/O module using the following procedure. Note that a TORX
screwdriver is required.
1) Remove the cap from the 40-pin connector on the power supply plug-in.
2) Place the plug-in onto the board with the connector attached and the spacers over the holes
on the board.
3) Screw the four supplied metals screws into the spacers to secure the plug-in.
The RTU will automatically recognize the 24V power supply.
Each plug-in power supply output is controlled by the CPU module. By default, the plug-in
power supply is ON and can supply up to 150mA. The power supply plug-in can be turned
ON/OFF via the user application program or Hardware Test utility.
Figure 5-9 provides a general view of an I/O module with one plug-in.
Spacers
Optional 24V
Floating
ERR
1 UF
OF
Power Supply
2 UF
OF
Plug-In
3 UF
OF
Motherboard
4 UF
OF
5 UF
OF
6 UF
Location PIN
OF
7 UF
OF
8 UF
OF Motherboard
24V
9 UF
Connector
OF
10 UF
OF
11 UF
OF
12 UF
OF
13 UF
OF
14 UF
OF
15 UF
OF
16 UF
OF
24V
Figure 5-9 ACE3600 I/O Module with a 24V Floating Power Supply Plug-In
5-10
I/O Modules
5-11
DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
General Description
The ACE3600 Digital Input (DI) module can have 16 or 32 inputs.
• 16 DI Fast 24V
• 32 DI Fast 24V
Two types of voltage (“wet”) inputs are supported, IEC 61131-2 Type II compliant inputs and
24V “MOSCAD compatible” inputs. In the 32 DI module, the first 20 inputs can function as
fast counters. In the 16 DI module, all inputs can function as fast counters. A counter's
maximum rate is dependent on the module type (see the specifications below.)
All the inputs are optically isolated. The DI modules support optional 24V DC floating plug-in
power supplies (for contact “wetting” or other purposes).
Each DI can be an event trigger (interrupt-driven) to a high priority fast process. The high
priority fast process enables very fast activation of an output in response to an input trigger and
logical conditions. This high priority fast process is not dependent on the I/O scan (refer to the
STS Application Programmer manual.)
For a description of I/O module construction, location, LEDs, TBs, and other common I/O
module features, see the I/O Modules chapter above.
6-1
Digital Input Module
16 DI Module 32 DI Module
Figure 6-1 ACE3600 DI Module – General View
Figure 6-2 provides a detailed view of the ACE3600 DI module front panel.
6-2
Digital Input Module
16 DI Module 32 DI Module
Figure 6-2 ACE3600 DI Module – Front Panel
DI Module Configuration
The 16 DI Fast 24V and 32 DI Fast 24V modules can handle AC and DC input signals. The
user can select DC or AC operation per module. When AC configuration is selected, the Fast
Capture, Counter Function and Input Filters (see below) are disabled.
6-3
Digital Input Module
Sleep Mode
Each DI module can be switched by the user application program to Sleep Mode. In Sleep
Mode, the module does not function and the power consumption is minimized. During Sleep
mode, the user application program will get the predefined values (PDV) for each I/O.
∗
in Fast 24V IEC TYPE II modules –only DC
6-4
Digital Input Module
The DI module can be diagnosed and monitored using the STS Hardware Test utility. This test
verifies that the module is operational, presents the module configuration and shows the actual
value of each input. It is also possible to change the input filter setup temporarily for the
duration of the Hardware Test.
In the Hardware Test utility, it is possible to set the DI module to Freeze Mode. In this mode
the user application program will get the predefined value of each input in the module, instead
of the actual input value. Freeze mode enables testing the inputs while the user application
program is running.
For details on configuring the DI modules, see the Site Configuration section, and the
Application Programming section of the STS User Guide.
6-5
Digital Input Module
6-6
Digital Input Module
32 DI
6-7
Digital Input Module
Connection Charts
16 DI 32 DI
Pin Function Pin Function Pin Function Pin Function
1 DI1 11 DI11 1 DI1 21 DI17
2 DI2 12 DI12 2 DI2 22 DI18
3 DI3 13 DI13 3 DI3 23 DI19
4 DI4 14 DI14 4 DI4 24 DI20
5 DI5 15 DI15 5 DI5 25 DI21
6 DI6 16 DI16 6 DI6 26 DI22
7 DI7 17 +24V 7 DI7 27 DI23
8 DI8 18 COM1 8 DI8 28 DI24
9 DI9 19 PGND1 9 DI9 29 DI25
10 DI10 20 PGND1 10 DI10 30 DI26
11 DI11 31 DI27
12 DI12 32 DI28
13 DI13 33 DI29
14 DI14 34 DI30
15 DI15 35 DI31
16 DI16 36 DI32
17 +24V 37 +24V
18 COM1 38 COM2
19 PGND1 39 PGND2
20 PGND1 40 PGND2
6-8
Digital Input Module
DI Module Specifications
16/32 DI FAST 24V Module
Total Number of Inputs 16 DI; 32 DI
Input Arrangement Isolated groups of 16 inputs with shared common
Fast Counter Inputs Inputs that can be used as fast counters:
- All inputs in 16 DI module; - First 20 inputs in 32 DI module
AC Input Frequency 45 – 65 Hz
AC Input Delay Maximum 0.2 mS
Fast Counter Input Frequency 0 - 12.5 KHz, minimum pulse width 40 µS
Max. DC Input Voltage Max. ±40 V DC (relative to input common)
“ON” DC Voltage Range +9 to +30 V DC, -30 to -9 V DC
“OFF” DC Voltage Range -3 to +3 V DC
“ON” AC Voltage Range 10 to 27 V AC (RMS)
“OFF” AC Voltage Range 0 to 5 V AC (RMS)
Input Current Max. 2.5 mA
Fast Capture Resolution 1 mS (Interrupt upon change of state)
Event Time Tagging Resolution 1 mS (Interrupt upon change of state)
Input Filtering 0 to 50.8 mS (DC, programmable in 0.2 mSec steps)
Counter Input Filtering 0 to 12.75 mS (programmable in 0.05 mSec steps for inputs configured as
high speed counters)
24 V DC Output Supports optional isolated 24 V plug-in “Wetting” Power Supply
(one in 16 DI, two in 32 DI)
Diagnostic LEDs Status LED per each input, module error LED, 24V plug-in status LED
User Connection 2 or 4 Terminal Blocks (3.5mm pitch), Maximum 18 AWG
Cable and TB Holder 20 or 40 Wire Cable with TB Holder connector, 26 AWG wires
Module Replacement Hot swap replacement – module extraction/insertion under voltage
Input Isolation 2.5 kV DC/AC between input and module logic per IEC255-5
Input Insulation Insulation resistance 100 MΩ @ 500 V DC,
Insulation impulse 5 kV per IEC255-5
Operating Voltage 10.8-16 V DC and 3.3 V DC (from the motherboard connector)
Power Consumption 16 DI: 0.32 W typical with all LEDs on (23 mA @ 13.8 VDC)
(measured at power supply in) 32 DI: 0.55 W typical with all LEDs on (40 mA @ 13.8 VDC)
(Not including 24 V DC Plug-in Power Supply power consumption)
Dimensions 37 mm W x 225 mm H x 180 mm D, (1.5“ W x 8.7“ H x 7.1“ D)
Weight 16 DI: approx. 0.28 Kg (0.62 Lb); 32 DI: approx. 0.29 Kg (0.63 Lb)
6-9
Digital Input Module
6-10
DIGITAL OUTPUT/DIGITAL INPUT FET MODULE
General Description
The Digital Output/Digital Input (DO/DI) FET module has 16 or 32 configurable user
connections, organized in four groups. Each group can be configured as an 8 DO group or as
an 8 DI group.
The following Digital Output/Digital Input (DO/DI) FET modules are available.
• 16 (DO/DI) FET
• 32 (DO/DI) FET
The outputs are optically isolated current sink FET type with back indication. The inputs are
optically isolated Dry Contact type with internal “wetting” voltage.
For a description of I/O module construction, location, LEDs, TBs, and other common I/O
module features, see the I/O Modules chapter above.
Figure 7-1 provides a general view of the ACE3600 DO/DI FET module.
7-1
Digital Output/Digital Input FET Module
Figure 7-2 provides a detailed view of the ACE3600 DO/DI FET module front panel.
Module Configuration
Input/Output
The following combinations can be configured in the STS site configuration (16 DO/DI).
The following combinations can be configured in the STS site configuration (32 DO/DI).
7-2
Digital Output/Digital Input FET Module
The appropriate combination is selected as the I/O module type, when configuring the I/Os in
the ACE3600 STS site configuration.
DI Fast Capture
Each DI can be configured as Fast Capture DI in the STS advanced I/O configuration. Fast
capture causes the SCAN ladder output operation to get the first change that occurred since the
previous scan. When fast capture is disabled (default), the scan gets the current value of the DI
(in this case DI changes between scans are missed).
DI Input Filters
Each inputs has a hardware input filter to make sure that the input reading is stable. The
hardware DI filter range is 0 to 50.8 mS (in 0.2 mS steps). Counter DI filter range is 0 to 12.75
mS (in 0.05 mS steps). The DI filter can be set in the STS advanced I/O configuration.
7-3
Digital Output/Digital Input FET Module
Sleep Mode
Each DO/DI module can be switched by the user application program to Sleep Mode. In Sleep
Mode, the module does not function and the power consumption is minimized. During Sleep
mode, the user application program will get the KLV or PDV per each DI.
The DO/DI module can be diagnosed and monitored using the STS Hardware Test utility. The
Hardware Test verifies that the module is operational, presents the module configuration and
7-4
Digital Output/Digital Input FET Module
shows the actual value of each input and output. It is also possible to change the input filter
setup for the duration of the Hardware test and change the value of the DOs.
In the Hardware Test utility, it is possible to set the module to Freeze Mode. In this mode the
user application program will get the KLV/PDV of each input in the module instead of the
actual input value. The DO values will keep the last value they had when the module was
switched to Freeze Mode. Freeze mode enables testing the inputs and outputs while the user
application program is running.
7-5
Digital Output/Digital Input FET Module
32 DO/DI FET
7-6
Digital Output/Digital Input FET Module
Connection Charts
16 DO/DI FET 32 DO/DI FET
Pin Function Pin Function Pin Function Pin Function
1 DO/DI1 11 DO/DI9 1 DO/DI1 21 DO/DI17
2 DO/DI2 12 DO/DI10 2 DO/DI2 22 DO/DI18
3 DO/DI3 13 DO/DI11 3 DO/DI3 23 DO/DI19
4 DO/DI4 14 DO/DI12 4 DO/DI4 24 DO/DI20
5 DO/DI5 15 DO/DI13 5 DO/DI5 25 DO/DI21
6 DO/DI6 16 DO/DI14 6 DO/DI6 26 DO/DI22
7 DO/DI7 17 DO/DI15 7 DO/DI7 27 DO/DI23
8 DO/DI8 18 DO/DI16 8 DO/DI8 28 DO/DI24
9 COM1 19 COM2 9 COM1 29 COM3
10 PGND1 20 PGND2 10 PGND1 30 PGND3
11 DO/DI9 31 DO/DI25
12 DO/DI10 32 DO/DI26
13 DO/DI11 33 DO/DI27
14 DO/DI12 34 DO/DI28
15 DO/DI13 35 DO/DI29
16 DO/DI14 36 DO/DI30
17 DO/DI15 37 DO/DI31
18 DO/DI16 38 DO/DI32
19 COM2 39 COM4
20 PGND2 40 PGND4
7-7
Digital Output/Digital Input FET Module
7-8
Digital Output/Digital Input FET Module
7-9
DIGITAL OUTPUT RELAY MODULE
General Description
The DO Relay modules have 8 or 16 outputs.
• Electrically Energized (EE) - the outputs return to the non-energized state in case of power
off or module failure.
• Magnetically Latched (ML) - Relay outputs are magnetically latched, the outputs maintain
their state in case of power off or module failure.
• 8 DO EE Relay 2A
• 16 DO EE Relay 2A
• 8 DO ML Relay 2A
• 16 DO ML Relay 2A
For a description of I/O module construction, location, LEDs, TBs, and other common I/O
module features, see the I/O Modules chapter above.
8-1
Digital Output Relay Module
Figure 8-2 provides a detailed view of the ACE3600 DO Relay Module front panel.
8-2
Digital Output Relay Module
In the 8 DO modules, the relays of outputs 1 through 5 are Single Pole Single Throw (SPST)
normally open (NO) and are referred to as the “Form A” relays. The relays of outputs 6
through 8 are Single Pole Double Throw (SPDT) and are referred to as the “Form C” relays.
In the 16 DO modules, the relays of outputs 1 through 5 and 9 through 13 are Single Pole
Single Throw (SPST) normally open (NO) “Form A” relays. The relays of outputs 6 through 8
and 14 through 16 are Single Pole Double Throw (SPDT) “Form C” relays.
The physical position of each relay is monitored by the module logic, using a back indication
signal which is connected to the relay’s second contact set. Any contradiction between the
required position and the back indication signal is reported to the CPU and is available to the
user program.
In some applications it is necessary to inhibit relay output operation when attending the site for
safety reasons. In all DO relay modules, it is possible to inhibit all relays per DO module.
When a module is configured to enable relay inhibiting, the power to the relays is provided
from the power supply via a dedicated power line (12V DO), controlled from the “12V DO”
input (TB located on the power supply module panel). When the input’s terminals are shorted,
the relays are operational. When the input’s terminals are open, the relays are inhibited (EE
relays in 0 position and ML relays do not change state.)
The user program can monitor the relay inhibiting status and act accordingly. Also, when the
module’s relays are inhibited, any mismatch between the relay position and the output logical
state is ignored.
Module Configuration
Relay Inhibiting
When the dipswitch is set to 12V DO, the position of the 2-pin 12V DO
Control connector on the front panel of the power supply module (see
Power Supply Module chapter above) acts as a safety mechanism. When
the 2-pin TB is unplugged from the 12V DO Control (e.g. for maintenance),
power is not supplied via the motherboard to the relays and the relays are
disabled. The 12V DO affects all relays in the system that are programmed
to work from the 12V DO and not the (default) 12V Main.
EE relays that are programmed for 12V DO operation will disconnect when
12V DO power is shut down and cannot be changed in this state.
ML relays that are programmed for 12V DO operation will freeze in their
current state when 12V DO power is shut down and cannot be changed.
Therefore, setting the dipswitch for ML will not necessarily inhibit them.
8-3
Digital Output Relay Module
A dual selector dipswitch (S3) on the DO Relay module has 4 selectable positions as described
in the following table:
Table 8-1 DO Relay Module- Dipswitch Settings
S3 S3 Configuration mode
SW 1 SW 2
OFF OFF 12V_DO – Relay inhibiting enabled
ON OFF Software selectable – inhibiting is set in site configuration
OFF ON 12V_DO – Relay inhibiting enabled
ON ON 12 V – (factory default) Relay inhibiting disabled
OFF
O N
Figure 8-3 12V DO Dipswitch
When S3 is set to Software Selectable mode, the inhibiting configuration is set using the
module configuration in the STS Site Configuration (see Table 8-2 below).
Procedure 8-1 describes how to set the 12V DO dipswitch to enable relay inhibiting.
Procedure 8-1 How to Set the 12V DO Dipswitch to Enable Relay Inhibiting.
1) If the 2-pin TB is plugged into the 12V DO Control on the front panel of the power supply
module, unplug it.
2) Remove the DO module from the slot in the rack.
3) Carefully remove the plastic wrap covering from the S3 dipswitch (see Figure 8-3) on the
DO module board. Note: Ignore text on the board that OFF/OFF is the factory default.
4) Set the S3 dipswitch to the desired position, according to the legend in Table 8-1.
5) Replace the DO module in the rack.
6) If the new dipswitch position causes DO relay power to be drawn from the 12VDO, plug
the 2-pin TB back into the 12V DO Control on the front panel of the power supply module.
8-4
Digital Output Relay Module
Reset DO at Startup
It is possible to configure the module to reset all the ML relays positions on startup. This is set
in the STS site configuration.
Table 8-2 ACE3600 DO Relay Module Configurable Features
Sleep Mode
Each DO module can be switched by the user program to Sleep Mode. In Sleep Mode, the
module is not functioning and the power consumption is minimized.
The DO module can be diagnosed and monitored using the STS Hardware Test utility. This test
verifies that the module is operational, presents the module configuration and shows the actual
value of each output. It is also possible to change the DO’s value.
In the Hardware Test utility, it is possible to set the module to Freeze Mode. In this mode, the
DOs will keep the last value they had at the time they were frozen. Freeze mode enables
testing the inputs and outputs while the user program is running.
For details on configuring the DO modules, see the Configuring a Site section and the
Application Programmer section of the ACE3600 STS User Guide.
8-5
Digital Output Relay Module
8-6
Digital Output Relay Module
16 DO
8-7
Digital Output Relay Module
Connection Charts
8 DO 16 DO
Pin Function Pin Function Pin Function Pin Function
1 NO1 11 NO6 1 NO1 21 NO9
2 COM1 12 COM6 2 COM1 22 COM9
3 NO2 13 NC6 3 NO2 23 NO10
4 COM2 14 NO7 4 COM2 24 COM10
5 NO3 15 COM7 5 NO3 25 NO11
6 COM3 16 NC7 6 COM3 26 COM11
7 NO4 17 NO8 7 NO4 27 NO12
8 COM4 18 COM8 8 COM4 28 COM12
9 NO5 19 NC8 9 NO5 29 NO13
10 COM5 20 PGND1 10 COM5 30 COM13
11 NO6 31 NO14
12 COM6 32 COM14
13 NC6 33 NC14
14 NO7 34 NO15
15 COM7 35 COM15
16 NC7 36 NC15
17 NO8 37 NO16
18 COM8 38 COM16
19 NC8 39 NC16
20 PGND1 40 PGND2
8-8
Digital Output Relay Module
8-9
ANALOG INPUT MODULE
General Description
The Analog Input (AI) modules have 8 or 16 inputs. The modules sample and convert analog
data into digital format and transfer the digital data to the CPU module.
The module’s analog-to-digital conversion resolution is 16 bit (including sign). Each input is
fully isolated from the other inputs on the module and also optically isolated from the module
internal circuits. The modules are fully calibrated and can be tested and recalibrated in the
field.
The measured values are digitally filtered to reduce the 50 or 60 Hz noise. The user can select
the filtering frequency per module.
The user can select how the analog values are represented to the user application program as
unit-less numeric values or as scaled values that represent certain Engineering Units (EGU).
Each AI module can include an optional plug-in floating 24V DC power supply to power
external devices.
For a description of I/O module construction, location, LEDs, TB holder, and other common
I/O module features, see the I/O Modules chapter above.
For details on specific AI parameters and configuration, see AI Module Configuration below.
9-1
Analog Input Module
ERR
1 UF
ERR
1 UF OF
OF 2 UF
2 UF OF
OF 3 UF
3 UF OF
OF 4 UF
4 UF
OF
OF 5 UF
5 UF
OF
OF 6 UF
6 UF
OF
OF 7 UF
7 UF
OF
OF
8 UF
8 UF
OF
OF
24V
24V
9 UF
OF
10 UF
OF
11 UF
OF
12 UF
OF
13 UF
OF
14 UF
OF
15 UF
OF
16 UF
OF
24V
8 AI Module 16 AI Module
Figure 9-1 ACE3600 AI Module – General View
9-2
Analog Input Module
ERR ERR
1 UF 1 UF
OF OF
2 UF 2 UF
OF OF
3 UF 3 UF
OF OF
4 UF 4 UF
OF OF
5 UF 5 UF
OF OF
6 UF 6 UF
OF OF
7 UF 7 UF
OF OF
8 UF 8 UF
OF OF
24V 24V
9 UF
OF
10 UF
OF
11 UF
OF
12 UF
OF
13 UF
OF
14 UF
OF
15 UF
OF
16 UF
OF
24V
8 AI Module 16 AI Module
Figure 9-2 ACE3600 AI Module – Front Panel
AI Module Configuration
50/60 Hz Filtering
This parameter enables the user to configure the module to use 50 or 60 Hz filter on all inputs.
AI Filter (Smoothing)
This parameter enables the user to configure the level smoothing (averaging) on all inputs. It
can be set to 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64,128 samples.
Input Range
This parameter sets the overflow and underflow limits (refer to AI Module value representation
below.)
9-3
Analog Input Module
In the current input modules, the ranges that can be selected are: ±20 mA (default) and 4-20
mA.
In voltage input modules, the ranges that can be selected are ± 5V (default), 0-5 V and 1-5 V.
For values and restrictions, see Appendix A: Site Configuration Parameters in the ACE3600
STS User Guide.
9-4
Analog Input Module
Sleep Mode
Each AI module can be switched by the user application program to Sleep Mode. In Sleep
Mode, the module does not function and the power consumption is minimized. During Sleep
mode the user application program will get the predefined values for each I/O.
In addition to the ERR LED, the module includes an Underflow (UDF) and Overflow (OVF)
LED for each input.
• When the UDF LED is lit, it indicates that the signal level in the corresponding input is below
the nominal range.
• When the OVF LED is lit, this indicates that the signal level in the corresponding AI is above
the nominal range.
• If both the UDF and OVF LEDs of the same channel are lit, the channel is uncalibrated.
The AI module can be diagnosed and monitored using the STS Hardware Test utility. The
Hardware Test verifies that the module is operational, presents the module configuration and
shows the actual value of each input, including overflow and underflow. It is also possible to
change the input filter setup for the duration of the Hardware test.
In the HW Test utility, it is possible to set the AI module to Freeze Mode. In this mode the
program user will get the KLV or PDV of each input in the module instead of the actual input
value. Freeze mode enables testing the inputs while the user application program is running.
9-5
Analog Input Module
9-6
Analog Input Module
9-7
Analog Input Module
9-8
Analog Input Module
16 AI
9-9
Analog Input Module
Connection Charts
8 AI 16 AI
Pin Function Pin Function Pin Function Pin Function
1 AI1+ 11 AI5+ 1 AI1+ 21 AI9+
2 AI1- 12 AI5- 2 AI1- 22 AI9-
3 AI2+ 13 AI6+ 3 AI2+ 23 AI10+
4 AI2- 14 AI6- 4 AI2- 24 AI10-
5 AI3+ 15 AI7+ 5 AI3+ 25 AI11+
6 AI3- 16 AI7- 6 AI3- 26 AI11-
7 AI4+ 17 AI8+ 7 AI4+ 27 AI12+
8 AI4- 18 AI8- 8 AI4- 28 AI12-
9 PGND 19 +24V 9 PGND 29 GND
10 PGND 20 -24V 10 PGND 30 PGND
11 AI5+ 31 AI13+
12 AI5- 32 AI13-
13 AI6+ 33 AI14+
14 AI6- 34 AI14-
15 AI7+ 35 AI15+
16 AI7- 36 AI15-
17 AI8+ 37 AI16+
18 AI8- 38 AI16-
19 +24V 39
20 -24V 40
9-10
Analog Input Module
AI Module Specifications
Total Number of Inputs 8 AI ±20 mA (4-20 mA)
16 AI ±20 mA (4-20 mA)
8 AI ±5 V (0-5 V, 1-5 V)
16 AI ±5 V (0-5 V, 1-5 V)
Input Configuration Isolated (floating) analog inputs
A to D Resolution 16 bit (including sign)
Input Accuracy ±0.1% of full scale @ -40ºC to +70ºC
Input Sampling Time 10 mSec @ 50 Hz filtering; 8.33 mSec @ 60 Hz filtering
Smoothing Selectable input averaging:1,2,4,8,16,32,64,128 samples (x10 mS)
Permitted Potential Between 75 V DC, 60 V AC (RMS)
Inputs
Input Impedance ±20 mA input: Rin < 250 Ω
±5 V input: Rin > 1 MΩ
Crosstalk Rejection Better than 80 dB between any pair of inputs
Temperature Stability 25 PPM/ºC
Interference Suppression Selectable 50 or 60 Hz filtering,
Common mode rejection > 80 dB,
Differential mode rejection > 50 dB
24 V DC Output Supports optional isolated 24V Plug-in Power Supply (one in 16 DI,
two in 32 DI)
Diagnostic LEDs Overflow and Underflow LED per each input status, Module error
LED, 24V Plug-in status LED
The module Overflow and Underflow levels can be configured to:
Current inputs: ±20mA / 4-20 mA
Voltage inputs: ±5 V / 0-5 V /1-5 V
User Connection 2 or 4 Terminal Blocks (3.5mm pitch), Maximum 18 AWG
Cable and TB Holder 20 or 40 Wire Cable with TB Holder connector, 26 AWG
Module Replacement Hot swap replacement– module extraction/insertion under voltage
Input Isolation 1.5 kV between input and module logic
Input Insulation Insulation resistance 100 MΩ @ 500 V DC, per IEC255-5
Operating Voltage 10.8-16 V DC and 3.3 V DC (from the motherboard connector)
Power Consumption 8 AI: 0.9 W typical with all LEDs on (65 mA @ 13.8 VDC)
(measured at power supply in) 16 AI: 1.3W typical with all LEDs on (95 mA @ 13.8 VDC)
(Not including 24 V Plug-in Power Supply)
Dimensions 37 mm W x 225 mm H x 180 mm D, (1.5" W x 8.7" H x 7.1" D)
Weight 8 AI : approx.032 Kg (0.71 Lb)
16 AI: approx. 0.34 Kg (0.75 Lb)
Specifications subject to change without notice.
9-11
ANALOG OUTPUT MODULE
General Description
The Analog Output (AO) modules have four optically-isolated analog output channels for
controlling user devices (see Figure 10-1). Each channel has two possible outputs: 0-20 mA
Interface industry standard current output and 0-10 V Interface industry standard voltage
output. Only one of the outputs can be enabled in a particular channel - either current or
voltage.
The module’s digital to analog converter resolution is 14 bit. The Analog Output channels are
optically isolated from the module internal logic circuits. The modules are fully calibrated and
can be tested and recalibrated in the field.
Each analog output has three status LEDs, Vout, Iout, and CAL which represent the calibration
status of each output for voltage/current. See Module Status and Diagnostics below for the
LEDs behavior.
For a description of I/O module construction, location, LEDs, TBs, and other common I/O
module features, see the I/O Modules chapter above.
For details on specific AO parameters and configuration, see AO Module Configuration below.
10-1
Analog Output Module
ERR
1 Vout
Iout
Cal
2 Vout
Iout
Cal
3 Vout
Iout
Cal
4 Vout
Iout
Cal
10-2
Analog Output Module
ERR
1 Vout
Iout
CAL
2 Vout
Iout
CAL
3 Vout
Iout
CAL
4 Vout
Iout
CAL
AO Module Configuration
AO Type
The analog outputs can be set to voltage, current, or raw data. See Module Status and
Diagnostics for details.
AO Value
The analog outputs can be set to a numeric value (in the range of 0 to 16000) or either in
voltage or current according to the output type. The values for voltage are 0 to 10 V and the
values for current are 0 to 20 mA. See Module Status and Diagnostics for details.
10-3
Analog Output Module
AO Calibration
The upper and lower limits of analog outputs can be calibrated - either as current (20mA upper
limit and 4mA lower limit) or voltage (10V upper limit and 2V lower limit). Default upper and
lower calibration limits are provided from the factory. See Module Status and Diagnostics for
details.
The predefined value can also be used during normal operation to force a value that masks the
actual output value.
For values and restrictions, see Appendix A: Site Configuration Parameters in the ACE3600
STS User Guide.
10-4
Analog Output Module
Sleep Mode
Each AO module can be switched by the user application program to Sleep Mode. In Sleep
Mode, the module does not function and the power consumption is minimized. During Sleep
mode the user application program will get the predefined values for each output.
10-5
Analog Output Module
In addition to the ERR LED, the module includes a voltage output (Vout), current output
(Iout), and calibration (CAL) LED for each output.
The AO module can be diagnosed and monitored using the STS Hardware Test utility. The
Hardware Test verifies that the module is operational, shows the type and actual value of each
output, enables calibration, and presents the ROM data calibration factors. The AO type can be
set either in the user application program or in the Hardware Test. To set the output value in
the Hardware test, the user application program must be stopped or the AO module frozen. To
calibrate the output in the Hardware test, the user application program must be stopped or the
AO module frozen.
In the Hardware Test utility, it is possible to set the AO module to Freeze Mode. In this mode,
the AOs will keep the last value they had at the time they were frozen. Freeze mode enables
testing the inputs and outputs while the user program is running.
10-6
Analog Output Module
10-7
Analog Output Module
Connection Charts
4 AO
Pin Function Pin Function
1 Vout1 11 Vout3
2 Ret1 12 Ret3
3 Iout1 13 Iout3
4 PGND1 14 PGND1
5 PGND1 15 PGND1
6 Vout2 16 Vout4
7 Ret2 17 Ret4
8 Iout2 18 Iout4
9 PGND1 19 PGND1
10 PGND1 20 PGND1
10-8
Analog Output Module
AO Module Specifications
Total Number of Outputs 4 AO current (0-20 mA) or voltage (0-10 V)
Output Arrangement Isolated floating channels, each channel can be connected as
0-20 mA or 0-10 V DC voltage
D to A Resolution 14 bit
Output Accuracy ±0.1% full scale @ 25ºC
Temperature Stability 25 PPM/ºC
Internal Settling Time Max. 1.0 msec
Output Load Voltage: > 1.0 kΩ, < 1.0 µf
Current: < 750 Ω (internal power source)
Crosstalk Rejection Better than 50 dB between any pair of outputs
Interference Suppression Common mode rejection > 60 dB
Output Protection Voltage output: short circuit current, max. 30 mA
Current output: No-load voltage max. 22 V DC
Diagnostic LEDs Module error LED, Voltage mode LED, Current mode LED,
Calibration LED per channel
User Connection 2 Terminal Blocks (3.5mm pitch), Maximum 18 AWG
Cable and TB Holder 20 Wire Cable with TB Holder connector, 26 AWG
Module Replacement Hot swap replacement– module extraction/insertion under voltage
Isolation 1.5 kV between output and module logic
Insulation Insulation resistance 100 MΩ @ 500 V DC, per IEC255-5
Operating Voltage 10.8-16 V DC and 3.3 V DC (from the motherboard connector)
Power Consumption 1.8 W typical with all LEDs on/all outputs off (130 mA @ 13.8 VDC)
(measured at power supply in) 3.4 W typical with all LEDs on/all outputs 20 mA (250 mA @ 13.8
VDC)
Dimensions 37 mm W x 225 mm H x 180 mm D, (1.5" W x 8.7" H x 7.1" D)
Weight Approx. 0.29 Kg (0.64 Lb)
Specifications subject to change without notice.
10-9
MIXED I/O MODULE
General Description
The ACE3600 Mixed I/O modules include a mixture of Digital Inputs, Relay Outputs and
Analog Inputs on the same module.
Figure 11-1 provides a general view of the ACE3600 Mixed I/O module.
ERR
D
I
D
O
AI
1 UF
OF
2 UF
OF
3 UF
OF
4 UF
OF
Another type of mixed I/O is found on the Digital Output/Digital Input (DO/DI) FET module.
See the Digital Output/Digital Input (DO/DI) FET module chapter above for more information.
11-1
Mixed I/O Module
Figure 11-2 provides a detailed view of the Mixed I/O module front panel.
ERR
D
I
D
O
AI
1 UF
OF
2 UF
OF
3 UF
OF
4 UF
OF
The Digital Input (DIs) on the Mixed I/O modules are voltage (“wet”) inputs IEC 61131-2
Type II compliant. All DIs can function as fast counters. All DIs are optically isolated.
Each DI can be an event trigger (by interrupt) to a high priority fast process. A high priority
fast process enables very fast activation of an output in response to an input trigger and logical
conditions. This high priority fast process is independent of the I/O scan (refer to the STS
Application Programmer manual).
All four relay outputs are Single Pole Double Throw (SPDT) and are referred to as the “Form
C” relays. The physical position of each relay is monitored by the module logic, by using a
back indication signal which is connected to the relay’s second contact set. Any contradiction
between the required position and the back indication signal, is reported to the CPU and is
available to the user application program.
In some applications, it is necessary to inhibit relay output operation when attending the site
for safety reasons. In all DO relay modules; it is possible to inhibit all relays per DO module.
When a module is configured to enable relay inhibiting, the power to the relays is provided
from the power supply via a dedicated power line (12V DO), controlled from the “12V DO”
input (TB located on the power supply module panel). When the input’s terminals are shorted,
the relays are operational. When the input’s terminals are open, the relays are inhibited (EE
relays in the OFF (0) position and ML relays do not change state.)
The user application program can monitor the relay inhibiting status and act accordingly. Also,
when the module’s relays are inhibited, any mismatch between the relay position and the
output logical state is ignored.
11-2
Mixed I/O Module
The Mixed I/O modules Analog-to-Digital conversion resolution is 16 Bit (including sign).
Each input is fully isolated from the other inputs on the module and also optically isolated from
the module internal circuits. The modules are fully calibrated. It is possible to test and re-
calibrate the module in the field.
The measured values are digitally filtered to reduce the 50 or 60 Hz noise. The user can select
the filtering frequency per module.
The user can select how the analog values are represented to the user application program, as
unitless numeric values or as scaled values that represent certain Engineering Units (EGU).
Each AI module can include an optional plug-in floating 24V DC power supply to power
external devices.
The Mixed I/O modules support an optional 24V DC floating plug-in power supply (for
contact “wetting” or other purposes).
For a description of I/O module construction, location, LEDs, TB holder, and other common
I/O module features, see the I/O Modules chapter above. For details on Mixed I/O Module
specific parameters and configuration, see the Mixed I/O Module Configuration section below.
For configuration of the DOs, refer to the DO/DI FET Module or DO Relay Module chapter.
Sleep Mode
Each Mixed I/O module can be switched by the user application program to Sleep Mode. In
Sleep Mode, the module does not function and the power consumption is minimized. During
Sleep mode the user application program will get the predefined values per each I/O.
11-3
Mixed I/O Module
The Mixed I/O module can be diagnosed and monitored using the STS Hardware Test utility.
For Hardware Test of the DOs, refer to the DO/DI FET Module or DO Relay Module chapter.
11-4
Mixed I/O Module
11-5
Mixed I/O Module
Connection Charts
Mixed I/O
Pin Function Pin Function
1 DI1 21 COM1
2 DI2 22 NC1
3 DI3 23 NO2
4 DI4 24 COM2
5 DI5 25 NC2
6 DI6 26 NO3
7 DI7 27 COM3
8 DI8 28 NC3
9 DI9 29 NO4
10 DI10 30 COM4
11 DI11 31 NC4
12 DI12 32 AI1+
13 DI13 33 AI1-
14 DI14 34 AI2+
15 DI15 35 AI2-
16 DI16 36 AI3+
17 24V+ 37 AI3-
18 COM1 38 AI4+
19 PGND1 39 AI4-
20 NO1 40 PGND
11-6
Mixed I/O Module
11-7
Mixed I/O Module
11-8
MIXED ANALOG MODULE
General Description
The ACE3600 Mixed Analog modules include a mixture of Analog Inputs and Analog Outputs
on the same module.
Figure 12-1 provides a general view of the ACE3600 Mixed Analog module.
ERR
1 Vout
Iout
Cal
2 Vout
Iout
Cal
3 Vout
Iout
Cal
4 Vout
Iout
Cal
24V
1 UF
OF
2 UF
OF
3 UF
OF
4 UF
OF
5 UF
OF
6 UF
OF
7 UF
OF
8 UF
OF
24V
12-1
Mixed Analog Module
Figure 12-2 provides a detailed view of the Mixed Analog module front panel.
ERR
1 Vout
Iout
CAL
2 Vout
Iout
CAL
3 Vout
Iout
CAL
4 Vout
Iout
CAL
24V
1 UF
OF
2 UF
OF
3 UF
OF
4 UF
OF
5 UF
OF
6 UF
OF
7 UF
OF
8 UF
OF
24V
For a description of the AIs in the Mixed Analog modules, see the Analog Input Module
chapter. For a description of the AOs in the Mixed Analog modules, see the Analog Output
Module chapter.
The Mixed Analog modules support an optional 24V DC floating plug-in power supply to
power external devices.
For a description of I/O module construction, location, LEDs, TB holder, and other common
I/O module features, see the I/O Modules chapter above. For details on Mixed Analog Module
specific parameters and configuration, see the Mixed Analog Module Configuration section
below.
Sleep Mode
Each Mixed Analog module can be switched by the user application program to Sleep Mode.
In Sleep Mode, the module does not function and the power consumption is minimized. During
Sleep mode the user application program will get/set the predefined values per each I/O.
12-2
Mixed Analog Module
The Mixed Analog module can be diagnosed and monitored using the STS Hardware Test
utility.
12-3
Mixed Analog Module
12-4
Mixed Analog Module
Connection Charts
4AO/8AI
Pin Function Pin Function
1 Vout1 21 AI1+
2 Ret1 22 AI1-
3 Iout1+ 23 AI2+
4 PGND1 24 AI2-
5 PGND1 25 AI3+
6 Vout2 26 AI3-
7 Ret2 27 AI4+
8 Iout2 28 AI4-
9 PGND1 29 PGND2
10 PGND1 30 PGND2
11 Vout3 31 AI5+
12 Ret3 32 AI5-
13 Iout3 33 AI6+
14 PGND1 34 AI6-
15 PGND1 35 AI7+
16 Vout4 36 AI7-
17 Ret4 37 AI8+
18 Iout4 38 AI8-
19 PGND1 39 +24V
20 PGND1 40 -24V
12-5
Mixed Analog Module
12-6
Mixed Analog Module
Diagnostic LEDs AO - Voltage mode LED, Current mode LED, Calibration LED
per channel
AI - Overflow and Underflow LED per each input, 24V Plug-in
status LED
The module Overflow and Underflow levels can be configured to:
Current inputs: ±20mA / 4-20 mA
Voltage inputs: ±5 V / 0-5 V /1-5 V
General - Module error LED
AI Input Isolation 1.5 kV between input and module logic
AI Input Insulation Insulation resistance 100 MΩ @ 500 V DC per IEC255-5
User Connection 4 Terminal Blocks (3.5mm pitch), Maximum 18 AWG
Cable and TB Holder 40 wire cable with Terminal Block Holder connector, 26 AWG
Module Replacement Hot swap replacement– module extraction/insertion under voltage
Operating Voltage 10.8-16 V DC and 3.3 V DC (from the motherboard connector)
Power Consumption 1.9 W typical with all LEDs on/outputs off (140 mA @ 13.8
(measured at power supply in) VDC)
3.4 W typical with all LEDs on/all outputs 20 mA (250 mA @
13.8 VDC)
Dimensions 37 mm W x 225 mm H x 180 mm D (1.5" W x 8.7" H x 7.1" D)
Weight Approx. 0.34 Kg (0.75 Lb)
12-7
RADIO TYPES AND INSTALLATION KITS
Note that the operating temperature range of ACE3600 RTU models that
include a radio is from -30 ºC to +60 ºC (-22 ºF to +140 ºF). (The operating
temperature range of the ACE3600 RTU models without a radio is from -40
ºC to +70 ºC (-40 ºF to +158 ºF)).
The ACE3600 RTU supports conventional, analog trunked radios and digital trunked radios. It
also supports data radios and various wireless modems. Conventional and analog trunked
radios are connected to a plug-in radio modem port. Digital trunked radios and wireless
modems are connected to an RS232 port. For information on configuring CPU ports for
various radios/modems, see the ACE3600 STS User Guide. For information on IP
communications over such modems, see the ACE3600 STS Advanced Features manual.
The following conventional/trunked mobile analog and digital radios and conventional portable
analog and digital radios can be used with the ACE3600 RTU:
The following table lists all the ACE3600 models that include radios.
*
TransNET 900 and iNET 900 are trademarks of GE MDS.
13-1
Radio Types and Installation Kits
For a list of the radio models and regional options for the CM/EM/GM radios, see CM/EM/GM
Radio Models and Regional Options for ACE3600 below. For a list of the radio models and
regional options for the GP/HT/PRO radios, see GP/HT/PRO Radio Models and Regional
Options for ACE3600 below.
IMPORTANT: Only model F7509A and all its options, including radio installation kits, may
be shipped to European Union (EU) countries. The installer must confirm that there are no
emissions or harmful interference to the spectrum due integrating the radio into this model.
The radios in the models listed in the table above are installed on the RTU using the
installation radio kits described below.
13-2
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Option/Kit
Conventional CDM750 V143AH/
Mobile Radios FLN3638A
MDS 9810, MDS 4710, MDS 9710 V152AK/
FLN3853A
TransNET 900 OEM VA00225AA/
FLN3852A
iNET 900 V680AH/
FLN3854A
NA EMEA APAC LA
For instructions on mounting the radio on the ACE3600 frame, see the desired installation
instructions below.
For general instructions on mounting a radio on the wall, see Mounting the ACE3600 Radios
on a Wall below.
13-3
Radio Types and Installation Kits
• Digital mode (ACE3600 option V681AT) - suitable for Astro 6.x/7.x system trunked
ASTRO IV&D only
• Analog mode (ACE3600 option V157AB) - suitable for SmartNet 3.x system or Astro
4.x system (on the analog part only)
• Radio firmware version 6.3E and above for digital trunked ASTRO IV&D. (For 6.3E,
HOST R04.51.01 DSP R04.50.00; for 6.5 HOST R05.00.00 and DSP R05.00.00)
• Radio firmware version 6.5E and above for analog trunked system (DSP version
R06.00.00 for radio firmware R06.01.00)
• ASTRO Infrastructure version SR6.3 and above for trunked ASTRO IV&D
• Smartnet version 3.x or Astro version 4.x for analog trunked system
IMPORTANT: The XTL5000/XTL2500 radio control head must be radio option O5 for
revolving power button control head.
Installation
The XTL5000/XTL2500 radio can be mounted on the ACE3600 RTU using the metal bracket
and cables as follows:
Procedure 13-1 How to Install the XTL5000/XTL2500 Radio on the Metal Chassis
1. Attach the radio plug-in port from the installation kit (FLN3696A) to the desired opening
on the ACE3600 CPU module. For instructions on attaching plug-in ports, see
Connecting Plug-In Ports to the CPU Module in the CPU Module chapter above.
3. Connect the 26-pin connector of the signal cable (FKN8432A for digital mode or
FKN8438A for analog mode) to the Accessory connector on the radio. In analog mode
only, place one Fair-Rite soft ferrite (#7683477X01 from the supplied ferrite kit
13-4
Radio Types and Installation Kits
FHN7007A) on the signal cable (FKN8438A) near the bottom of the CPU door, loop the
cable one turn around it, and clamp the ferrite on the cable.
Connect the other end of the communication cable to the ACE3600 CPU module port
configured for the radio. (See Figure 13-2 and Figure 13-4.) For digital mode use any of
the serial on-board or plug-in ports. For analog mode only the plug-in ports may be used.
See RTU Port Configuration for the Astro IV&D Digital Radio and RTU Port
Configuration for the Astro IV&D Analog Trunked Radio below.
4. Connect the DC power cable (FKN8436A) to the Power connector on the radio and the
free red wire to the ignition pin on the FKN8432A/FKN8438A cable. Connect the
opposite end of the power cable to the AUX2A or AUX2B connector on the ACE3600
power supply unit. (See Figure 13-2 and Figure 13-4.)
XTL5000/ Radio
XTL2500 Mounting
Radio Screws
(#031096A67)
13-5
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Antenna Cable
(FKN8437A)
Power Cable
(FKN8436A)
Signal Cable
(FKN8432A/
FKN8438A)
Figure 13-2 XTL5000/XTL2500 Radio Cable Connections- Rear View
5. Mount the bracket on the RTU chassis above the CPU and I/O modules, using the four
built-in screws. (See Figure 13-4.) The wider side of the bracket is attached to the
chassis.
6. Connect the antenna cable (FKN8437A) to the Antenna connector on the radio. Run the
cable through the small white clips along the edge of the chassis and attach the connector
to the opening on the bottom of the ACE3600 RTU housing. (See Figure 13-2 and
Figure 13-4.)
Bracket
Radio Mounting
Bracket Screws
(#0789422V41)
Figure 13-3 XTL5000/XTL2500 Radio Bracket with Four Bracket Mounting Screws
13-6
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Signal
Cable
(FKN8432A/
FKN8438A)
The following figures show the port configuration and advanced parameter configuration.
Although these show Port SI1, the same values can be applied to other ports, where relevant.
13-7
Radio Types and Installation Kits
1. In the ACE3600 STS click on the desired site, and open the site view.
2. In the Port Tab, click on the on-board or plug-in port through which the RTU will
communicate with the XTL5000/XTL2500 radio.
3. Confirm that the port parameters and data speed are as shown in the screen below.
5. If you plan to synchronize the RTU time from the Front End Processor (FEP) in the
Customer Enterprise Network (CEN), specify the IP address of the FEP in the NTP field.
This IP address information is provided by your ASTRO IV&D system operator.
Figure 13-5 RTU Site Configuration for MDLC over ASTRO IV&D – Port Type Parameters
Figure 13-6 RTU Site Configuration for MDLC over ASTRO IV&D – Advanced Parameters
13-8
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Generally no other changes are required to Advanced Physical or Link Layer parameters. For
information on these parameters, see the MDLC over IP chapter of the ACE3600 STS
Advanced Features manual.
Procedure 13-3 How to Configure the Advanced Parameters of the ACE3600 Port for the Astro
IV&D Digital Radio
1. (ASTRO System 6.3-6.5 only) Make sure that the Advanced Link parameter
Registration life time to 28800 seconds (default) in order to restart the radio periodically.
2. If any changes are required, click on the appropriate screen in the Port Tab.
Note that an IP address is obtained from the radio once it is connected to the RTU port over
PPP. The IP address obtained from the radio is not the real IP address set by the infrastructure,
but rather a dummy address. This dummy is configured in the radio via the CPS Mobile
Computer IP address parameter (by default 192.168.128.2).
When device LINxL level 0 is retrieved using the ACE3600 STS Software Diagnostics tool,
the IP Address displayed is this dummy address and not the actual IP address assigned by the
infrastructure operator.
1. The first is downloaded to the FIU or IP Gateway on the LAN and includes the site and
IP information for each RTU.
2. The second is downloaded to all RTUs which are connected to the infrastructure with
ASTRO IV&D radios, and includes the site and IP information for the FIU and IP
Gateway.
For detailed instructions on preparing the IP conversion table, refer to the IP Communications
chapter of the ACE3600 STS Advanced Features manual.
13-9
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Radio Connections
To program the XTL5000/XTL2500 radio with Customer Programming Software (CPS), the
radio must be connected to a PC.
1. Connect one end of the programming cable (HKN6155) to the microphone connector on
the front of the radio. This cable is not supplied and must be ordered separately.
2. Connect the other end to the serial port of a PC on which the ASTRO CPS software
(RVN4185) is installed.
Radio Disassembly
If the XTL5000/XTL2500 radio is to be programmed outside of the ACE3600 housing,
disassemble the radio as follows:
Procedure 13-5 How to Disassemble the XTL5000/XTL2500 Radio from the ACE3600 Metal
Chassis
1. Disconnect the antenna cable (FKN8437A) from the Antenna connector on the radio.
2. Remove the radio/bracket unit from the RTU chassis by unscrewing the four built-in
screws.
3. Disconnect the DC power cable (FKN8436A) from the Power connector on the radio.
4. Disconnect the 26-pin connector of the signal cable (FKN8432A/FKN8438A) from the
Accessory connector on the radio.
5. Detach the metal bracket (#0789422V41 from FHN6895A) by unscrewing the four radio
screws (#0310906A67), two on each side. (See Figure 13-1.)
1. In the CPS, click on the codeplug in the tree view to view and select the items below or
select them from the Feature menu.
a. In the Transmit Power Levels tab, reduce the radio power level to low: Change
TX Power Level Low for Freq. Range A from 16.5 to 10. (Range A 700Mhz
UHF and VHF).
1) Change TX Power Level Low for Freq. Range B from 19.0 to 10. (Range B
800Mhz and UHFR2 (470-520Mhz).
13-10
Radio Types and Installation Kits
2) Change TX Power Level High for Freq. Range A from 33.0 to 15.
3) Change TX Power Level High for Freq. Range B from 38.5 to 15.
b. In the General tab, set the Out of Range Indicator and Imbalanced Coverage
Indicator to Alert & Display.
c. (Recommended) In the Data tab, enable SNMP Traps. (You can disable it, but
the RTU will only detect a loss of context activation the next time it polls the
radio (every 10 seconds by default).
e. (CPS R05.00.00 only) In the Advanced tab, make sure that "MOSCAD Data
Enable" is not enabled (not checked.) (For IV&D only. For communication over
analog ASTRO Trunking, leave it enabled.) Set Extended DEK to Enable and
Ignition Switch to Soft Power Off.
4) The Mobile Computer address should match the Mobile Computer IP Address
assigned on the Radio Configuration>Radio Wide>Data tab in Step 2 above.
a. In the General tab, set the Type to ASTRO 25. If the proper system key was
loaded, the System Key field should already be enabled.
b. Set the ASTRO 25 Home System ID, Home WACN ID and Unit ID to values
obtained from the radio system administrator.
f. In the Data tab, enable Packet Data Capable System (PDS), and Terminal Data
and disable (uncheck) Rx Voice Interrupts Data.
13-11
Radio Types and Installation Kits
a. In the General tab, set the Protocol Type to ASTRO 25 and set the System & ID
to 1.
b. In the 700/800 Failsoft tab, data only subscribers should set Failsoft Type to
disabled. (There is no data service unless the subscriber is affiliated to a wide-
area trunking site.)
c. In the Talkgroup tab, set the radio talkgroup value in hexadecimal. Consult your
radio system administrator for the talkgroup information.
d. (Recommended) In the Preferred Sites tab, set the status of the first record to
None. (This means that data only subscribers are not locked into preferred sites.)
a. In the Zone tab, set the Zone to the desired zone name (e.g. ZONE1).
b. In the Channels tab, set the Channel to the name which will be displayed on the
radio screen (if the radio is Model II or III).
7. From the Tools menu, select the Change Control Head command. Make sure the Control
Head Type is set to O5(M5) for new models and to W4 for old models, and click OK.
8. From the File Menu, select Save to save changes to the radio.
9. From the File Menu, select Write Device to download the configuration to the radio.
Note: If configuring a border router or any firewall within the CEN (Customer Enterprise
network), make sure that the ACE3600’s MDLC over IP UDP port number 2002 is enabled for
inbound and outbound messages.
Note: In the UCM Radio User Data Settings tab, be sure to set the IP address as Static, to
enable Generate ICMP and Source Address Checking, and the Ready timer set to 10 seconds.
RTU Port Configuration for the Astro IV&D Analog Trunked Radio
To enable MDLC communication using Astro XTL5000/XTL2500 radios, use the ACE3600
STS site configuration utility to configure the ACE3600 RTU port (either on-board serial or
plug-in port) connected to the radio. For more information, refer to the IP Communications
chapter of the ACE3600 STS Advanced Features manual.
13-12
Radio Types and Installation Kits
1. In the ACE3600 STS click on the desired site, and open the site view.
2. In the Port Tab, click on the plug-in port through which the RTU will communicate with
the XTL5000/XTL2500 radio.
3. Set the port parameters as shown in the screen below. The Trunk system parameter
should reflect the type of trunking system (e.g. SmartNet, SmartZone.)
Figure 13-7 RTU Site Configuration for MDLC over Analog Trunked System – Port Type
Parameters
Radio Connections
Follow the Radio Connections instructions described under Radio Programming using CPS for
the Astro IV&D Digital above.
Radio Disassembly
Follow the Radio Disassembly instructions described under Radio Programming using CPS for
the Astro IV&D Digital above.
1. In the CPS, click on the codeplug in the tree view to view and select the items below or
select them from the Feature menu.
a. In the Transmit Power Levels tab, reduce the radio power level to low: Change
TX Power Level Low for Freq. Range A from 28.0 to 10.
1) Change TX Power Level High for Freq. Range A from 53.5 to 15.
13-13
Radio Types and Installation Kits
b. In the Advanced tab, make sure that "MOSCAD Data Enable" is enabled. Set
Extended DEK to Enable and Ignition Switch to Soft Power Off.
c. In the Time Out Timer tab, make sure the Time # is set to 3 (for 60 sec).
3. Double-click on Controls.
b. Make sure the Control Head is O5(M5) for new models and W4 for old models.
d. In the Tx Options tab, make sure that the Time Out Timer is set to 3 (for 60 sec).
a. In the General tab, if the proper system key was loaded, the System Key field
should already be enabled.
c. Set the Type II System ID, and Connect Tone to values obtained from the radio
system administrator for the site.
e. In the Type II tab, set the Individual ID to the value obtained from the radio
system administrator for the site.
g. In the Channel Assignment tab, enter the Rx and Tx channel ranges. Consult
your radio system administrator for the list of values.
13-14
Radio Types and Installation Kits
h. In the OBT Control Channels tab, set the RX Frequency and TX Frequency of
each control channel with which the data subscriber should be able to affiliate.
Consult your radio system administrator for the list of control channels.
a. In the General tab, set the Protocol Type to II and set the System ID to the value
obtained from the radio system administrator for the site. Make sure that the
Time Out Timer is set to 3 (for 60 sec). Check that the Type II Individual ID is
set to the value obtained from the radio system administrator for the site.
b. In the Talkgroup tab, set the radio talkgroup value in hexadecimal. Consult your
radio system administrator for the talkgroup information. (Note: Talkgroup for
voice in analog trunking is the same for voice and data on analog trunk.
7. From the File Menu, select Save to save changes to the radio.
8. From the File Menu, select Write Device to download the configuration to the radio.
All of the following options may be ordered with the XTL5000/XTL2500 radio:
13-15
Radio Types and Installation Kits
13-16
Radio Types and Installation Kits
The installation kit includes brackets, cables, screws and installation instructions.
After the XTS2500 radio is installed in the RTU, the RTU port is configured, the IP address
information is downloaded, the radio is context activated and finally, communication from the
RTU over the air is verified. For more information on MDLC over ASTRO IV&D (Integrated
Voice & Data), refer to the MDLC over IP chapter of the ACE3600 STS Advanced Features
Manual.
Installation
Before installing the XTS2500 radio on the RTU, configure the power supply AUX2A/B
connector to 7.5V DC in the ACE3600 STS site configuration (using the Power Supply <n>
Auxiliary 2 voltage parameter.) Download the updated site configuration to the RTU. Failure
to do so might damage the radio.
The installation kit includes a radio bracket, metal bracket with built-in screws, power cables,
communication cable, antenna cable and plastic strips. The XTS2500 can be mounted on the
ACE3600 RTU using the kit as follows:
Procedure 13-9 How to Install the XTS2500 Radio on the Metal Chassis
1. Attach the XTS 2500 radio to the radio bracket (from FHN6674A). (See Figure 13-8.)
2. Connect the programming cable (RKN4106A) provided with the radio to the Accessory
connector on the radio. (See Figure 13-10.) Connect the other end of the programming cable
to the 9-pin D-type (Radio) connector on the communication cable (FKN8516A) and tighten
the screws attached to the programming cable. Do not use the 25-pin connector; it is for
programming only.
3. Connect the other end of the communication cable (RJ45 connector) to the plug-in port of
the ACE3600 CPU.
4. Connect the 7.5V DC power cable (FKN8515A) to the AUX2A or AUX2B auxiliary
power output connector on the RTU power supply. Connect the other end of the power cable
to the DC adapter on the radio bracket (FHN6674A). (See Figure 13-9 and Figure 13-10.)
13-17
Radio Types and Installation Kits
5. Add the BNC adapter (#5871143Y04) to the XTS2500 radio antenna connector. (See
Figure 13-9.)
6. Attach the BNC connector of the antenna cable (FKN8434A) to the radio's BNC adapter.
Route the antenna cable through the small wire clamps along the left side edge of the RTU
chassis, according to the placement of the radio on the chassis. Attach the N-type connector at
the other end to the opening on the bottom of the RTU housing using the supplied locking
washer and nut. (See Figure 13-9.)
7. Mount the radio/bracket unit on the metal bracket (#0789422V40 from FHN6674A)
using the four supplied screws.
8. Mount the metal bracket on the RTU chassis above the I/O modules, using the three built-
in screws, with the bottom of the radio towards the chassis. (See Figure 13-9.)
9. Attach all cables to the chassis using the supplied wire clamps.
13-18
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Metal
Bracket
Radio (FHN6674A)
Power CPU
Supply
Figure 13-9 XTS2500 Radio Installed on ACE3600 Chassis
13-19
Radio Types and Installation Kits
BNC Programmin
Adapter g Cable
(RKN4106A)
Antenna
Radio Cable
(FKN8434A)
Data Cable
(FKN8516A)
Power Cable
(FKN8515A)
The following figures show the port configuration and advanced parameter configuration.
Although these show Port SI1, the same values can be applied to other ports, where relevant.
Port Type
Procedure 13-10 How to Configure the ACE3600 Port for the Astro XTS2500 Digital Radio
1. In the ACE3600 STS click on the desired site, and open the site view.
2. In the Port Tab, click on the on-board or plug-in port through which the RTU will
communicate with the XTS2500 radio.
3. Confirm that the port parameters and data speed are as shown in the screen below.
5. If you plan to synchronize the RTU time from the Front End Processor (FEP) in the
Customer Enterprise Network (CEN), specify the IP address of the FEP in the NTP field.
This IP address information is provided by your ASTRO IV&D system operator.
13-20
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Figure 13-11 RTU Site Configuration for MDLC over ASTRO IV&D – Port Type Parameters
Figure 13-12 RTU Site Configuration for MDLC over ASTRO IV&D – Advanced Parameters
Generally no other changes are required to Advanced Physical or Link Layer parameters. For
information on these parameters, see the MDLC over IP chapter of the ACE3600 STS
Advanced Features manual.
Procedure 13-11 How to Configure the Advanced Parameters of the ACE3600 Port for the
Astro XTS2500 IV&D Digital Radio
1. (ASTRO System 6.3-6.5 only) Make sure that the Advanced Link parameter Registration
life time to 28800 seconds (default) in order to restart the radio periodically.
2. If any changes are required, click on the appropriate screen in the Port Tab.
13-21
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Note that an IP address is obtained from the radio once it is connected to the RTU port over
PPP. The IP address obtained from the radio is not the real IP address set by the infrastructure,
but rather a dummy address. This dummy is configured in the radio via the CPS Mobile
Computer IP address parameter (by default 192.168.128.2).
When device LINxL level 0 is retrieved using the ACE3600 STS Software Diagnostics tool,
the IP Address displayed is this dummy address and not the actual IP address assigned by the
infrastructure operator.
1. The first is downloaded to the FIU or IP Gateway on the LAN and includes the site and
IP information for each RTU.
2. The second is downloaded to all RTUs which are connected to the infrastructure with
ASTRO IV&D radios, and includes the site and IP information for the FIU and IP
Gateway.
For detailed instructions on preparing the IP conversion table, refer to the IP Communications
chapter of the ACE3600 STS Advanced Features manual.
Radio Programming using CPS for the Astro XTS2500 IV&D Digital
The XTS2500 radio is programmed for ACE3600 in the factory and is ready for ASTRO
IV&D communication. For user programming of site-specific parameters, the radio should be
brought to the Motorola Service Center.
Radio Connections
To program the XTS2500 radio with Customer Programming Software (CPS), the radio must
be connected to a PC.
2. Disconnect the programming cable (RKN4106A) from the 9-pin D-type (Radio)
connector on the data cable (FKN8516A).
3. Connect the D-type connector of the programming cable (RKN4106A) to the serial port
of a PC on which the ASTRO CPS software is installed.
4. Program the radio using the CPS, as described in CPS Programming Settings below.
13-22
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Radio Disassembly
If the XTS2500 radio is to be programmed outside of the ACE3600 housing, disassemble the
radio as follows:
Procedure 13-13 How to Disassemble the XTS2500 Radio from the ACE3600 Metal Chassis
1. Disconnect the antenna cable (FKN8434A) from the Antenna connector on the radio.
2. Remove the radio/bracket unit from the RTU chassis by unscrewing the three built-in
screws.
3. Disconnect the DC power cable (FKN8515A) from the Power connector on the radio.
4. Disconnect the 13-pin connector of the programming cable (RKN4106A) from the
Accessory connector on the radio.
5. Detach the metal bracket (#0789422V40 from FHN6674A) by unscrewing the four radio
screws (#0310906A67), two on each side. (See Figure 13-9.)
1. In the CPS, click on the codeplug in the tree view to open the items below.
a. In the General tab, set the Out of Range Indicator and Imbalanced Coverage
Indicator to Alert & Display.
b. (Recommended) In the Data tab, enable SNMP Traps. (You can disable it, but
the RTU will only detect a loss of context activation the next time it polls the
radio (every 10 seconds by default).
13-23
Radio Types and Installation Kits
The Mobile Computer address should match the Mobile Computer IP Address
assigned on the Radio Configuration>Radio Wide>Data tab in Step 2 above.
a. In the General tab, set the Type to ASTRO 25. If the proper system key was
loaded, the System Key field should already be enabled.
b. Set the ASTRO 25 Home System ID, Home WACN ID and Unit ID to values
obtained from the radio system administrator.
f. In the Data tab, enable Packet Data Capable System (PDS), and Terminal Data
and disable (uncheck) Rx Voice Interrupts Data.
a. In the General tab, set the Protocol Type to ASTRO 25 and set the System & ID
to 1.
b. In the 700/800 Failsoft tab, data only subscribers should set Failsoft Type to
disabled. (There is no data service unless the subscriber is affiliated to a wide-
area trunking site.)
c. In the Talkgroup tab, set the radio talkgroup value in hexadecimal. Consult your
radio system administrator for the talkgroup information.
d. (Recommended) In the Preferred Sites tab, set the status of the first record to
None. (This means that data only subscribers are not locked into preferred sites.)
a. In the Zone tab, set the Zone to the desired zone name (e.g. ZONE1).
b. In the Channels tab, set the Channel to the name which will be displayed on the
radio screen (if the radio is Model II or III).
7. From the File Menu, select Save to save changes to the radio.
8. From the File Menu, select Write Device to download the configuration to the radio.
13-24
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Note: If configuring a border router or any firewall within the CEN (Customer Enterprise
network), make sure that the ACE3600’s MDLC over IP UDP port number 2002 is enabled for
inbound and outbound messages.
Note: In the UCM Radio User Data Settings tab, be sure to set the IP address as Static, to
enable Generate ICMP and Source Address Checking, and the Ready timer set to 10 seconds.
All of the following options may be ordered with the XTS2500 radio:
13-25
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Installation
The CDM750 radio can be mounted on the ACE3600 RTU as follows:
Procedure 13-15 How to Install the CDM750 Radio on the Metal Chassis
1. Attach the radio plug-in port from the installation kit (FLN3696A) to the desired opening
on the ACE3600 CPU module. For instructions on attaching plug-in ports, see
Connecting Plug-In Ports to the CPU Module in the CPU Module chapter above.
2. Connect the radio adapter (FLN3639A) 16-pin connector to the radio Accessory
connector (See Figure 13-13.)
3. Connect the power cable (FKN8436A) to the radio power connector, and the opposite
end of the cable to the AUX1A or AUX1B connector on the ACE3600 power supply
module.
4. Connect the communication cable (FKN8427A) to the rear connector (8-pin RJ45
connector) of FLN3639A. Place one Fair-Rite soft ferrite (#7683477X01 from the
supplied ferrite kit FHN7007A) on the cable near the bottom of the CPU door, loop the
cable one turn around it, and clamp the ferrite on the cable.
Connect the other end of the communication cable to the plug-in port of the ACE3600
CPU module.
13-26
Radio Types and Installation Kits
4. Connect the antenna cable (FKN8437A) to the Antenna connector on the radio and to the
opening on the bottom of the ACE3600 RTU housing, using the four supplied screws.
See Figure 13-13 and Figure 13-15.)
5. Attach the radio to the bracket (0789422V45 from FHN6898A) by using screws and
washers from kit FHN6898A. See Figure 13-14 below.
CDM750 Radio
Figure 13-14 CDM750 Radio and Metal Bracket
6. Attach the complex (radio + bracket) using the four supplied screws to the ACE3600
chassis. See Figure 13-15 below.
13-27
Radio Types and Installation Kits
13-28
Radio Types and Installation Kits
The following figures show the port configuration and advanced parameter configuration.
Although these show Port PI1, the same values can be applied to port PI2 as well, where
relevant.
Port Type
Procedure 13-16 How to Configure the ACE3600 Port for the CDM750 Radio
1. In the ACE3600 STS click on the desired site, and open the site view.
2. In the Port Tab, click on the plug-in port through which the RTU will communicate with
the radio.
3. Confirm that the port parameters and data speed are as shown in the screen below.
5. Save the changes. Generally no other changes are required to Advanced Physical or Link
Layer parameters.
Figure 13-16 RTU Site Configuration for MDLC over CDM750 Radio – Port Type Parameters
Radio Connections
To program the CDM750 radio with Customer Programming Software (CPS), the radio is
connected to a PC using the standard Radio Interface Box (RIB).
1. Connect one end of the programming cable (PMKN4004) to the radio Accessory
connector and the other end to the 25-pin connector on the RIB (RLN4008). The RIB
and cable are not supplied and must be ordered separately.
2. Using the 9-pin interface cable (3080369B72), connect the RIB to the serial port of a PC
on which the CDM750 CPS software (HVN9025) is installed.
13-29
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Radio Disassembly
If the CDM750 radio is to be programmed outside of the ACE3600 housing, disassemble the
radio as follows:
Procedure 13-18 How to Disassemble the CDM750 Radio from the ACE3600 Metal Chassis
2. Remove the radio/bracket unit from the RTU chassis by unscrewing the four built-in
screws.
3. Disconnect the DC power cable (FKN8436A) from the radio Power connector.
4. Disconnect the radio adapter (FLN3639A) 16-pin connector from the radio Accessory
connector.
5. Detach the metal bracket (FHN6898A) by unscrewing the two radio screws
(#0387839V89), one on each side. (See Figure 13-14.)
1. Before programming the radio, read the codeplug file from the radio and save it to your
PC using the File >Read Device command in the CPS.
2. Open the codeplug file in the CPS. Click on the codeplug in the tree view to view and
select the items below or select them from the Feature menu.
3. Under Radio Configuration, change the settings on the Basic, Tx Power, Accessory
Configuration, and Accessory Pins tabs, as shown in the screens below.
4. Under Controls and Menus->Conventional Buttons, change the settings to the Mobile
Key Buttons and Programmable Buttons tabs, as shown in the screens below.
5. Under Conventional Personality 1, change the settings to the Basic, Options and
Advanced tabs, as shown in the screens below.
6. Under Personality Assignment to Zone 1, make sure that the desired channel(s) appear on
the list on the Channels tab. If not all the assigned channels are required, remove them
from the assignment list.
7. From the File Menu, select Save to save changes to the radio.
8. From the File Menu, select Write Device to download the configuration to the radio.
13-30
Radio Types and Installation Kits
13-31
Radio Types and Installation Kits
13-32
Radio Types and Installation Kits
13-33
Radio Types and Installation Kits
13-34
Radio Types and Installation Kits
13-35
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Procedure 13-20 How to Attach the Volume Knob Retainer for the GP/HT/PRO Radio
1. Remove the original plastic volume knob cover from the radio by pulling it out with
pliers, as shown in Figure 13-27.
Volume Knob
2. Place the hole of the volume knob retainer (shown in Figure 13-28) over the exposed
metal volume rod on the radio (shown in Figure 13-29.)
3. Fasten the bottom of the volume knob retainer to the radio body. (See Figure 13-29.)
13-36
Radio Types and Installation Kits
GP/HT/PRO Metal
Radio Body Volume
Rod
Volume Knob
Retainer
(Motorola P/N
0787502V66)
Installation
Before installing the GP/HT/PRO radio on the RTU, configure the power supply AUX2A/B
connector to 7.5V DC in the ACE3600 STS site configuration (using the Power Supply <n>
Auxiliary 2 voltage parameter.) Download the updated site configuration to the RTU. Failure
to do this might damage the radio.
1. Attach the radio plug-in port from the installation kit (FLN3696A) to the desired opening
on the ACE3600 CPU module. For instructions on attaching plug-in ports, see Connecting
Plug-In Ports to the CPU Module in the CPU Module chapter above.
2. Connect the audio accessory adapter (HLN9716) (Item 1) to the radio. See Figure 13-30.
3. Insert the communication cable (FKN8431A) (Item 2) into the audio accessory adapter.
4. Insert the BNC antenna adapter (FTN6045B) into the radio antenna connector (Item 3).
6. Insert the 7.5V DC power cable (FKN8515A) into the DC connector of the DC adapter
(Item 5).
13-37
Radio Types and Installation Kits
4
1 5
7. Using the two screws, attach the radio assembly to the radio bracket (FHN6899A).
8. Using the three screws on the bracket, attach the bracket with the radio to the chassis of the
ACE3600. (See Figure 13-31.)
9. Connect the audio communication cable (FKN8431A) to the audio adapter (attached to the
radio). Place one Fair-Rite soft ferrite (#7683477X01 from the supplied ferrite kit
FHN7007A) on the cable near the bottom of the CPU door, loop the cable one turn around
it, and clamp the ferrite on the cable. Connect the other end of the communication cable to
the plug-in port on the front panel of the CPU module.
10. Connect the DC power cable (FKN8515A) from the DC adapter (attached to the radio) to
the AUX2A or AUX2B connector of the power supply module.
11. Route the antenna cable (FKN8434A) from the bottom of the RTU box to the BNC adapter
on the radio.
12. Use the clamps provided in the kit to route and secure the audio communication and DC
power cables. (See Figure 13-31.)
13-38
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Power Radio
Cable
(FKN8515A) Radio
Bracket
(FHN6899A)
Signal
Cable Antenna
(FKN8431) Cable
(FKN8434A)
The following figures show the port configuration and advanced parameter configuration.
Although these show Port PI1, the same values can be applied to port PI2 as well, where
relevant.
Port Type
Procedure 13-21 How to Configure the ACE3600 Port for the GP/HT/PRO Radio
1. In the ACE3600 STS click on the desired site, and open the site view.
2. In the Port Tab, click on the plug-in port through which the RTU will communicate with
the radio.
3. Confirm that the port parameters and data speed are as shown in the screen below.
13-39
Radio Types and Installation Kits
5. Save the changes. Generally no other changes are required to Advanced Physical or Link
Layer parameters.
Figure 13-32 RTU Site Configuration for MDLC over GP320/GP328/HT750/PRO5150 Radio –
Port Type Parameters
Note:
1. When ordering ACE3600 model with a GP/HT/PRO radio, a V95x option must be added.
3. Orders to EMEA should be placed as model without radio and radio as a kit
13-40
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Installation
The CM/EM/GM can be mounted on the ACE3600 RTU as follows:
Procedure 13-22 How to Install the CM/EM/GM Radio on the Metal Chassis
1. Attach the radio plug-in port from the installation kit (FLN3696A) to the desired opening
on the ACE3600 CPU module. For instructions on attaching plug-in ports, see Connecting
Plug-In Ports to the CPU Module in the CPU Module chapter above.
2. Connect the 16-pin connector radio adapter (FLN3636A) to the accessory connector on the
radio. (See Figure 13-33.)
3. Connect the power cable (FKN8428A) to the radio’s power connector. (See Figure 13-33
and Figure 13-34.) Connect the other end of the power cable to the AUX1A or AUX1B
connector on the ACE3600 RTU Power Supply unit. (See Figure 13-35.)
13-41
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Radio Communication
Adapter Cable
(FKN8427A)
Power
Connector
Power Cable
Radio (FKN8428A)
Antenna
Antenna Cable
Connector
(FKN8429A/
*
FKN8430A )
Figure 13-34 CM/EM/GM Radio Cable Connections
4. Connect the communication cable (FKN8427A) to the back of the radio adapter
(FLN3636A) connector (10-pin RJ45 connector). (See Figure 13-34.) Place one Fair-Rite
soft ferrite (#7683477X01 from the supplied ferrite kit FHN7007A) on the cable near the
bottom of the CPU door, loop the cable one turn around it, and clamp the ferrite on the
cable. Connect the other end of the communication cable to the plug-in port of the
ACE3600 CPU.
5. Mount the CM/EM/GM radio onto the metal bracket (#0789422V45) using the two
supplied radio mounting screws from kit FHN6894A, # 0387839V89 on the top and
bottom of the radio. (See Figure 13-33, Figure 13-34 and Figure 13-35.)
6. Connect the antenna cable (FKN8429A/FKN8430A*) to the antenna connector on the radio
and to the opening on the bottom of the ACE3600 housing using the four supplied screws.
(See Figure 13-34 and.) Mount the complex (bracket and radio) on the RTU chassis above
the CPU and I/O modules, using the four built-in screws. (See Figure 13-35.)
*
Antenna Cable FKN8429A with UHF connector is for Latin and North America.
Antenna Cable FKN8430A with BNC connector is for Asia and Europe.
13-42
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Follow the instructions for RTU Port Configuration for the CDM750 Radio above.
13-43
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Radio Information
The picture below shows the radio model information screen in the CPS.
13-44
Radio Types and Installation Kits
13-45
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Note: The Power Level should be set according to the power output.
13-46
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Note:
1. When ordering an ACE3600 model with a CM/EM/GM radio, a V95x option must be
added.
*
Antenna Cable FKN8429A with UHF connector is for Latin and North America.
Antenna Cable FKN8430A with BNC connector is for Asia and Europe.
13-47
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Installation
The TransNET 900 radio modem is housed in a plastic housing, as shown below:
Procedure 13-23 How to Install the TransNET 900 Radio on the Metal Chassis
1. Attach the TransNET 900 radio modem to the metal bracket (#0789971V39 from
FHN7067A) using the four supplied screws, inserting the screws from above. (See Figure
13-41 below.)
13-48
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Figure 13-41 TransNET 900 Radio Modem Mounted on Metal Bracket - Front and Rear View
2. Mount the bracket on the RTU chassis above the I/O modules, using the four built-in
screws. (See Figure 13-42 and Figure 13-43 below.)
3. Connect one end of the power cable (FKN8508A) to the TransNET’s PWR (9-30VDC)
connector and tighten the attached screws. Connect the other end of the cable to the
AUX1A connector on the RTU’s power supply module.
4. Connect one end of the data cable (FKN8514A) to the TransNET’s DATA connector
using the attached screws. Connect the other end of the communication cable to the
ACE3600 CPU module port configured for the radio.
5. Connect the small end of the antenna cable (FKN8511A) to the TransNET’s ANT
(Antenna) connector.
Unscrew the nut and locking washer from the other end of the antenna cable.
If the RTU is inside an enclosure, thread the end of the cable through the opening on the
bottom of the enclosure and screw on the nut and locking washer from outside the
enclosure.
13-49
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Radio
Radio
Bracket
(FHN7067A)
Power
Cable
(FKN8508A)
Signal
Radio Cable
(FKN8514A)
Antenna
Cable
(FKN8511A)
Figure 13-43 TransNET 900 Radio Modem Installed on ACE3600 Chassis – Cable Connections
13-50
Radio Types and Installation Kits
• The radio address ADDR = xx, where xx is the same number for all radios in the
system The address appears on the radio itself.
• Mode - either MASTER or REMOTE (Slave). The mode setting appears on the radio
itself.
These radio settings are determined in the MDS factory and are not generally changed by the
user. If it is necessary to change these settings, refer to the TransNET 900 radio
documentation.
RTU Configuration
The RTU port is configured using the ACE3600 STS as follows:
Procedure 13-24 How to Configure the ACE3600 Port for the TransNET 900 Radio
1. In the ACE3600 STS click on the desired site, and open the site view.
2. In the Port Tab, click on the on-board or plug-in port through which the RTU will
communicate with the TransNET radio.
3. Confirm that the port parameters and data speed are as shown in the screen below.
Note: If the baud rate of the radio is not the default value (9600), the baud rate of the port
should be configured accordingly.
Figure 13-44 RTU Site Configuration for TransNET Radio– Port Type Parameters
13-51
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Installation
The iNET 900 radio modem is housed in a plastic housing, as shown below:
Procedure 13-25 How to Install the iNET 900 Radio on the Metal Chassis
1. Attach the iNET 900 radio modem to the metal bracket (#0789971V39 from FHN7067A)
using the four supplied screws, inserting the screws from below. (See Figure 13-46 below.)
Note: The radio must be placed in the bracket with the connectors to the left side, so that
the bracket can be mounted on the RTU chassis and the cables can reach the CPU.
Figure 13-46 iNET 900 Radio Modem Mounted on Metal Bracket – Front and Rear View
2. Mount the bracket on the RTU chassis above the I/O modules, using the four built-in
screws. (See Figure 13-47 below.)
13-52
Radio Types and Installation Kits
3. Connect one end of the power cable (FKN8508A) to the iNET’s PWR connector and
tighten the attached screws. Connect the other end of the cable to the AUX1A connector
on the RTU’s power supply module. See Figure 13-47 and Figure 13-48 below.)
4. Connect one end of the data cable (FKN8512A) to the iNET’s COM2 connector using the
attached screws. Connect the other end of the communication cable to the ACE3600 CPU
module port configured for the radio.
5. Connect the small end of the antenna cable (FKN8511A) to the iNET’s ANT (Antenna)
connector.
Unscrew the nut and locking washer from the other end of the antenna cable.
If the RTU is inside an enclosure, thread the end of the cable through the opening on the
bottom of the enclosure and screw on the nut and locking washer from outside the
enclosure.
Radio
Bracket
(FHN7067A)
13-53
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Antenna
Cable
(FKN8511A)
Radio
Power
Signal Cable
Cable
(FKN8512A)
(FKN8508A)
Figure 13-48 iNET 900 Radio Modem Installed on ACE3600 Chassis – Cable Connections
With iNET radios (firmware version ≥ V4.4.0) any remote can communicate with any other
remote. An MDLC network (with zones) is no longer needed. The iNET should be set in
Multipoint to Multipoint topology, in order to enable communication between RTUs with no
zones.
Notes:
• An RTU configured for MDLC over IP cannot communicate with an RTU configured
for External Modem over the iNET network. If both exist, they should be allocated
different Link IDs.
13-54
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Configuration 1
iNET
LAN IP Gateway External Modem/ Com2/ Access
Line2 RS232 UDP Point
SCADA
Configuration 2
IP Gateway
SCADA LAN
IP Cloud LAN
13-55
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Configuration 3
iNET
RS232 MCP-M RS232 Com2/UDP
Access
SCADA Modbus External Modem/Line2 Point
Configuration 4
SCADA Ethernet/
169.254.0.12
IP Gateway
169.254.0.14
iNET
Ethernet
Access
MDLC over IP/Line1 Point
PPP/
169.254.1.13 iNET IP Cloud
Ethernet/
169.254.2.12
169.254.2.13
Ethernet iNET
RTU 2
Remote
MDLC over IP/
Line1
13-56
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Configuration 5
STS
SCADA Ethernet/
169.254.0.12
IP Gateway
169.254.0.14 169.254.0.13
iNET
Ethernet
Access
MDLC over IP/Line1 Point
CPU420 PPP/
Firmware >=9.10 169.254.1.13 iNET IP Cloud
169.254. xxx . xxx
RTU 1 MDLC over IP Com2 iNET
Line1 RS232 PPP Remote
Line 1
Ethernet/
Ethernet/ 169.254.2.12
169.254.3.13 169.254.3.12 169.254.2.13
Configuration 6
IP Gateway
LAN
SCADA LAN
IP Cloud
169.252.XXX.XXX
169.253.XXX.XXX
LAN
iNET
169.254.XXX.XXX Access
iNET Point
Access
Point iNET IP Cloud
169.253. xxx . xxx
iNET IP Cloud
169.254. xxx . xxx
Line 1
Line 1
iNET iNET
iNET iNET Remote Remote
Remote Remote
MDLC Com2/ MDLC
over IP/ PPP Ethernet
MDLC Com2/ MDLC over IP/
Ethernet Line1 169.254.2.12
over IP/ PPP over IP/ 169.253.1.13 Line1
Line1 169.254.1.13 169.254.2.12
Line1 RTU 3 RTU 4
RTU 1 RTU 2
13-57
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Configuration 7
RS232 MCP-M EPIB LAN
Modbus LAN
SCADA 169.252.XXX.XXX IP Cloud
169.253.XXX.XXX
LAN
iNET
169.254.XXX.XXX Access
iNET Point
Access
Point iNET IP Cloud
169.253. xxx . xxx
iNET IP Cloud
Line 1
169.254. xxx . xxx
Line 1
iNET iNET
iNET iNET Remote Remote
Remote Remote
MDLC Com2/ MDLC
over IP/ PPP Ethernet
MDLC Com2/ MDLC over IP/
Ethernet Line1 169.254.2.12
over IP/ PPP over IP/ 169.253.1.13 Line1
Line1 169.254.1.13 169.254.2.12
Line1 RTU 3 RTU 4
RTU 1 RTU 2
13-58
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Radio Configuration
External Modem Port
iNET radios can be configured to work with the External Modem port on ACE3600 RTUs (see
Configurations 1, 2 and 3 above.)
Use the iNET radio programming software to program the AP (Access Point) and then the
remote with the following settings.
Note:
• IP Address refers to the Ethernet port IP and not the “over the air” IP.
IP Address: 169.254.0.12
2. Press 'D' and the Serial Gateway Configuration Menu will be displayed.
3. Press 'D' to enable COM2 (if it is not enabled). Use the SPACE bar to cycle between
Enabled and Disabled. COM2 should be Enabled and COM1 Disabled. Press ENTER
once Enabled is shown.
4. Press 'E' and the Serial Configuration Wizard will be displayed. This wizard will assist
you in the configuration of your available Serial Data Ports.
13-59
Radio Types and Installation Kits
6. Select the IP Protocol you would like to use. The following modes are supported:
• PPP – to be used for MDLC over IP (Not relevant for External Modem.)
7. If you selected UDP above, you will be prompted to select the Topology. You have the
following choices:
• Point to Point is used if you have a single AP and a single remote unit.
• Point to MultiPoint is used if you transmit to a single radio. This radio is the point, and
all radios are the multipoint. For example: An FNE is a point, and all other RTUs are
multipoint. No RTU to RTU is provided.
• MultiPoint to MultiPoint works like a real radio where any radio (RTU) can
communicate with another.
Press 'C' (Multipoint to MultiPoint) to enable routing between any RTU to any RTU.
8. Next, set the values for the Multicast IP Address and Multicast Port. These are the
addresses used when transmitting and receiving. They should be the same on all radios.
Press 'A' and enter “224.254.1.1” for the Multicast IP Address.
10. Press 'C' to continue the wizard until the final screen, or abort it by pressing 'Q'.
11. When the final wizard screen appears prompting you to “Change values (if necessary)
for UDP Data Connection Settings”, do not change any values. Press 'Q' to quit wizard.
12. The COM2 Serial Data Port values will be displayed. Press 'G' and set the appropriate
Baud Rate (from 1200 bps to 115200 bps.)
13. The Hardware Configuration values will be displayed. Press 'G' to select the 8N1
hardware configuration for the port.
14. It is recommended to have Hardware Flow Control on the serial port enabled. When
prompted, press 'A' to enable Hardware Flow Control.
15. When prompted to select the Serial Packet Mode, press 'A' to use the default value
(Seamless Mode.) Press Q to exit wizard.
13-60
Radio Types and Installation Kits
The settings for the COM2 Serial Data Port should appear as follows:
AP Demo Set I
Serial Configuration Wizard
-==================================================================-
A) Status enabled
B) IP Protocol UDP Multipoint to Multipoint
C) Multicast IP Address 224.254.1.1
D) Multicast Port 30011
E) Time to Live 1
F) Packet Redundancy Mode Single Packet Mode
G) Data Baud Rate 9600
H) Configuration 8N1
I) Flow Control enabled
J) Serial Mode Seamless
K) Seamless Inter-Frame Delay 4
16. Press 'X' to save the changes and exit the wizard. When prompted with "These changes
will take effect immediately... Are you sure (y/n)?", press 'y' and ENTER. There is no
need to power up the iNET radio. Note that these settings are saved and you do not need
to reset them when powering up the radio unit again.
18. From the Main Menu, press 'B' to select Network Configuration. This is needed if you
want to set an IP connection to the radio unit (recommended). Ethernet port is needed if
you are using an IP Interface on RTUs and Ethernet port on IP Gateway (MDLC over
IP). In any case, it is recommended that you set it.
20. In the IP Address Configuration Menu, press 'B' to set the Static IP Address to
169.254.0.12.
21. Next press 'C' to set the Static IP subnet mask to 255.255.0.0. It is recommended that all
units having the same AP (Access Point) be on the same subnet mask.
23. Finally press 'D' and enter the maximum number of remotes. By default this value is 50.
If the AP has more than that, you must change the value.
13-61
Radio Types and Installation Kits
24. Your configuration of the AP is complete. Return to the Starting Information screen
(Step 1 above) and repeat all steps with the remote unit. All of the settings/values are the
same.
• ACE3600 RTU RS232 port configured as MDLC over IP over PPP connected to
Standard modem.
When using an RTU with EP Ethernet port, connect the RTU Ethernet port to the iNET
Ethernet port. The IP Port should be on the same subnet as the iNET. Its Subnet mask and IP
Gateway should be the same. The rest of the configuration should be the same as an MDLC
over IP port (i.e. configuring the port and setting the appropriate baud rate and Link ID, and
downloading the IP Conversion Table.) The P Conversion Table is needed to communicate
with other RTUs connected over PPP or Ethernet.
The rest of the configuration should be the same as an MDLC over IP port (as above). All IP
settings are obtained dynamically from the modem when connecting to it. The RTU PPP port
should be connected to COM2 on the iNET radio using a computer adapter. The following
describes how to configure iNET COM2 modem for PPP.
After configuring the IP Gateway, EPIB for Ethernet, and RTU (for PPP) with MDLC over IP
port, they can all communicate on the iNET network as if they all reside on a LAN. All routing
between them is done via the iNET network, and if a LAN is involved, using other routers as
well. Any RTU can communicate with any other RTU or IP Gateway. A single Link ID should
be set for all RTUs/ IP Gateways on these ports.
Note however, that if the MDS radio was connected via External Modem port (serial), or via a
Terminal Server (e.g. Equinox) over serial port, it is a completely different MDLC
link/protocol. A different Link ID should be set in the RTU/IP Gateway when using this
configuration. If both coexist on the same iNET network, each should have its own Link ID
with MDLC network configuration downloaded to all units.
Use the iNET radio programming software to program the AP (Access Point) and then the
remote with the following settings.
Note:
• IP Address refers to the Ethernet port IP and not the “over the air” IP.
The following shows Access point configuration for MDLC over IP but it is exactly the same
for Remote.
13-62
Radio Types and Installation Kits
IP Address: 169.254.0.12
4. In the IP Address Configuration Menu, press 'B' to set the Static IP Address to
169.254.0.12.
5. Next press 'C' to set the Static IP subnet mask to 255.255.0.0. It is recommended that all
units having the same AP (Access Point) be on the same subnet mask.
Note that the Static (sub)Net Mask and Static IP Gateway addresses should be the same
as those of the IP Gateway and EPIB. Their IP Address should be on the same subnet.
For example 169.254.0.100 for an IP Gateway address of 169.254.0.012 is suitable.
Also note that when using PPP it is recommended to have the IP Address of PPP on the
same subnet, for example 169.254.0.13. See Configuring for PPP below.
6. Press 'E' to commit changes. Press ESC to return to the Network Configuration Menu.
7. Finally press 'D' and enter the maximum number of remotes. By default this value is 50.
If the AP has more than that, you must change the value.
13-63
Radio Types and Installation Kits
10. Press 'D' to enable COM2 (if not enabled). SPACE to cycle between Enabled and
Disabled. COM2 should be Enabled and COM1 Disabled. Press ENTER once Enabled is
shown.
11. Press 'E' and the Serial Configuration Wizard will be displayed. This wizard will assist
you in the configuration of your available Serial Data Ports.
12. Press 'A' to begin the Wizard and the IP Protocol selection menu will appear.
13. Select the IP Protocol you would like to use. The following modes are supported:
• TCP - to be used as a Terminal Server. (IP Gateway does not support this option.)
14. The wizard will prompt you to change the value of the IP Address. Press 'A' and enter
the Remote IP Address. This is the address that is uniquely assigned to the RTU. It
should be different from the other addresses used in the iNET network and in the LAN (if
connected to LAN).
A good scheme is to add 1 to the Static IP Address set in the Network Configuration
screen above. For example, if the address 169.254.0.12 was assigned to the iNET
Ethernet port, the PPP would be assigned 169.254.0.13. Both addresses reside in the
same subnet 255.255.0.0 as was set in the Network Configuration. When using a PPP
port, two IP addresses are set for iNET, one for the Ethernet port, and another (on the
same subnet) for PPP. It is recommended to make those addresses consecutive where
possible.
15. Press 'B' and the Data Baud Rate screen is displayed.
16. Select the baud rate according to the RTU, e.g. 'D' for 9600.
18. It is recommended to have Hardware Flow Control on the serial port enabled. When
prompted, press 'A' to enable Hardware Flow Control.
19. When prompted to select the Serial Packet Mode, press 'A' to use the default value
(Seamless Mode.)
The settings for the COM2 Serial Data Port should appear as follows:
13-64
Radio Types and Installation Kits
A) Status enabled
B) IP Protocol Point to Point Protocol (PPP)
C) Device IP Address 169.254.0.13
D) Data Baud Rate 9600
E) Configuration 8N1
F) Flow Control enabled
G) Serial Mode Custom
H) Custom Inter-Frame Delay 4
I) Custom Data Buffer Size 64
Select a letter to choose item, <ESC> for the prev menu, 'Q' to quit wizard
20. Press 'X' to save the changes and exit the wizard. There is no need to power up the iNET
radio. Note that these settings are saved and you do not need to reset them when
powering up the radio unit again.
21. From the Serial Gateway Configuration, press ESC to return to the Main Menu.
RTU Configuration
The RTU port is configured using the ACE3600 STS.
Site Configuration
Procedure 13-26 How to Configure the ACE3600 Port for the iNET 900 Radio
In the ACE3600 STS click on the desired site, and open the site view.
2. In the Port Tab, click on the on-board or plug-in port through which the RTU will
communicate with the iNET radio.
3. Confirm that the port parameters and data speed are as shown in the screen below.
Note: If the baud rate of the radio is not the default value (9600), the baud rate of the port
should be configured accordingly.
13-65
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Figure 13-49 RTU Site Configuration for iNET Radio– External Modem Port
Port Type Parameters
Figure 13-50 RTU Site Configuration for iNET Radio– MDLC over IP Port
Port Type Parameters
Figure 13-51 RTU Site Configuration for iNET Radio– MDLC over IP Port
Advanced Link Layer Parameters
IP Conversion Table
Prepare an IP Conversion Table and download it to the RTU. The IP Address of the RTU is the
one assigned by the iNET 900 to the RTU, referred to as Remote IP Address in Configuring for
PPP above. This IP address can be retrieved using the ACE3600 STS SW Diagnostics &
Loggers utility in Device LIN1L, level 0.
Verify that the connection succeeded using the SW Diagnostics & Loggers utility. In Device
LIN1L, level 101, make sure that the "State of configuration task" field is set to "connected and
registered". This may take between 30-60 seconds.
13-66
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Installation
The MDS radio can be mounted on the ACE3600 RTU as follows:
Procedure 13-27 How to Install the MDS 900 Radio on the Metal Chassis
1. Connect the radio to the bracket provided in the Hardware Kit (#0789971V39 from
FHN7066A) using the four screws, supplied with the bracket. (See Figure 13-52 below.)
Figure 13-52 MDS Radio Mounted on Metal Bracket - Front and Rear View
2. Connect the communication cable (FKN8513A) to the 25-pin connector on the side of the
radio and tighten the screws.
13-67
Radio Types and Installation Kits
3. Insert the DC power cable (FKN8510A) connector into the DC power connector on the
radio.
4. If the RTU is to be installed inside an enclosure, screw the antenna cable (FKN8509A)
into the antenna connector on the radio. Otherwise, an external antenna can be connected
directly to the antenna connector on the radio.
5. Mount the bracket (#0789971V39 from FHN7066A) on the RTU chassis above the I/O
modules, using the four built-in screws. (See Figure 13-53 below.)
6. Route the antenna cable (FKN8509A) cable through the small wire clamps along the left
side edge of the RTU chassis, according to the placement of the radio on the chassis, as in
Figure 13-53 and Figure 13-54.
7. Unscrew the nut and locking washer from the N-type connector at the other end of the
antenna cable. Thread the end of the cable through the opening on the bottom of the
enclosure and screw on the nut and locking washer from outside the enclosure.
8. Connect the other end of the DC power cable (FKN8510A) to the AUX1A/B connector
on the RTU’s power supply module.
9. Connect the other end of the communication cable (FKN8513A) to the ACE3600 CPU
module port configured for the radio. See RTU Configuration below.
13-68
Radio Types and Installation Kits
Radio Radio
Bracket
(FHN7066A)
Radio
Power Antenna
Cable Cable
(FKN8510A) (FKN8509A)
Signal
Cable
(FKN8513A)
Figure 13-54 MDS Radio Modem Installed on ACE3600 Chassis – Cable Connections
13-69
Radio Types and Installation Kits
RTU Configuration
The RTU port is configured using the ACE3600 STS as follows:
Procedure 13-28 How to Configure the ACE3600 Port for the MDS Radio
1. In the ACE3600 STS click on the desired site, and open the site view.
2. In the Port Tab, click on the on-board or plug-in port through which the RTU will
communicate with the MDS radio.
3. Confirm that the port parameters and data speed are as shown in the relevant screen
below.
Note: If the baud rate of the radio is not the default value (9600), the baud rate of the port
should be configured accordingly.
Figure 13-55 RTU Site Configuration for MDS 9810 Spread Spectrum/4710 UHF Transceiver
Radio– Port Type Parameters
Figure 13-56 RTU Site Configuration for MDS 9710A- 900 MHz Radio– Port Type Parameters
13-70
Radio Types and Installation Kits
223 145
80 80
182.5
75
P/N:0789422V41
179.8
P/N:0789422V45
75
250
GP/HT/PRO Bracket
Figure 13-57 Radio Wall Mount Brackets
The following installation procedure should be followed to install radios on a wall near the
ACE36000 frame. A special wall mount bracket is provided with the radio installation kit,
which can be ordered separately from the frame. Allow extra space around the bracket for the
radio and wires.
1. Drill four holes in the wall at the horizontal and vertical distances (in mm) shown in
Figure 13-57 for the desired radio wall mount bracket, at the desired angle/orientation.
2. Place the bracket on the wall, lining up the bracket holes with the drilled holes.
13-71
Radio Types and Installation Kits
3. Insert four M3 Phillips 10mm screws (not supplied) into the holes and tighten with a
screwdriver to secure the bracket firmly against the wall.
13-72
RS485 CONNECTION BOX
General Description
The RS485 Connection Box (V186AD/FLN3641A) provides an interface to up to seven RS485
connections. (See Figure 14-1.)
RS485 HUB
RS485 Port 1
RS485 Port 2
RS485 Port 3
RS485 Port 4
RS485 Port 5
RS485 Port 6
RS485 Port 7
MOTOROLA
14-1
RS485 Connection Box
Installation
The RS485 Connection Box can be easily installed on the RTU chassis.
Wire Connections
1) To interface to an RTU, connect the communication cable (FKN8427A) between the
connection box input port and the ACE3600 RS485 port.
B
RS485 HU
MOTOROLA
2
AUDIO CONTROL AND TONE (ACT) MODULE
Introduction
The Audio Control and Tone (ACT) module (V155AE/FLN3851A) serves as a player of
recorded voice and alarm sounds in ACE3600 based alert systems. The ACT module also
routes low-level sound signals to high-level amplifiers. The high-level sound can be directed to
specified alert speakers in a set of six speakers, mounted in different locations.
The ACT module contains an internal audio memory that allows custom tones or audio sounds
to be recorded and stored in the ACT module. Recording of audio may be done directly from a
low-level output source (tape recorder, laptop or radio output).
15-1
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
• Controlled by the RTU via an RS232 serial port using a simple instruction set.
• Interface to an external low-level audio signal source (microphone, radio audio out,
etc.).
• Interface to input of one audio amplifier and up to two outputs of audio amplifiers.
• Routes the audio signals from the amplifier(s) output to selected speakers.
• Routes data coming from the RTU to a serial printer to allow printing of information
by alternative use of the RTU serial port.
15-2
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
ACT Unit
DIGITAL AUDIO
RECORD / PLAY
DEVICE
RECORD PLAY LOW-LEVEL
OUTPUT AUDIO OUTPUT
INPUT
LOW-LEVEL
AUDIO INPUT
AUDIO Isolation
Transformer
SOURCE FCN6294
POWER
AMPLIFIER
1
HIGH-LEVEL
AUDIO INPUT 1
HIGH-LEVEL
AUDIO INPUT 2 LOW-LEVEL
POWER
AMPLIFIER AUDIO INPUT
2
HIGH-LEVEL
OUTPUT 1
SPEAKER1
HIGH-LEVEL
OUTPUT 2
SPEAKER2
µC
HIGH-LEVEL
OUTPUT 3
SPEAKER3
HIGH-LEVEL
OUTPUT 4
SPEAKER4
HIGH-LEVEL
OUTPUT 5
SPEAKER5
HIGH-LEVEL
OUTPUT 6
SPEAKER6
COM IN
Control of RTU via
RS-232 line
RTU COM OUT
PRINTER
15-3
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
To facilitate the recording process, audio signals may be formed or saved in "WAV" file format
on a PC (or on any other audio format provided it can be played by a PC) and then downloaded
to the module through the PC audio out.
The module’s total recording capacity is 240 seconds. As default, the recording space is
divided into eight "cells” (each of which holds up to 30 seconds). The number of cells is
configurable and can be set to 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 30 and 60.
NOTE: Recording will automatically terminate 2 seconds after the module detects silence.
Recording will also be stopped when the "cell" has run out of recording capacity.
The module’s low-level audio input also enables the connection of an external low-level audio
source (such as a radio audio output) for direct routing to an audio amplifier. Thus the audio
routed to this output can be either a pre-recorded audio signal or an external source, connected
to the low-level audio input.
Two high-level audio inputs are used to route amplified audio signals into the module. The
ACT module has six high-level audio outputs that can be routed to selected speakers.
The ACT module also enables the RTU to have more than one use for its RS232 port. The
application on board the RTU may select its serial port connected to COM IN to control the
ACT module or to send data to COM OUT. This is very useful for connecting a dot matrix
printer to the RTU without requiring an additional serial port which could necessitate the
another CPU.
The destination of the serial data sent to the COM IN port is selected via the following
mechanism:
The ACT module operates on 9 to 16 VDC, usually supplied by the RTU's auxiliary power
supply.
An RTU application program controls the ACT module via a user port using an 8-bit
instruction set.
15-4
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
• Play
• Stop - Play
• Record
• Report Status
• Connect/Disconnect Speakers
For the ACT module instruction set, see ACT Instruction Set below.
15-5
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
Note: Connect the ACT to the High Power Audio Amplifier only via the Isolation Board -
FCN6294A (connected to the SIG IN/SIG OUT connector).
1) Place the ACT module on the metal plate and click the two pegs on the back of the plastic
box into the desired holes on the metal chassis.
2) Connect one end of the power cable (FKN8433A) to the PWR connector on the ACT
module. Connect the other end of the cable to the one of the AUX connectors (configured
to 12V) on the ACE3600 power supply module.
3) Connect one end of the communication cable (FKN8427A) to the COM IN port on the
ACT module. Connect the other end of the cable to the RS232 port on the ACE3600 CPU.
4) To use high-level audio speakers, connect up to six speakers to the High-Level Audio Out
(1-6) relays on the top of the ACT module front panel. See Figure 15-3 below.
5) To enable playing prerecorded tones, connect the input of the first high power audio
amplifier to the SIG OUT/GND connectors, using the Isolation Board (FCN6294A).
Connect the output of the amplifier to the Normally Open connector on the top left corner
of the ACT module front panel. See Figure 15-3 below.
6) To enable radio voice channel audio (low level signal), connect the external speaker of the
voice radio to the SIG IN/GND connectors, using a simple wire cable (can be shielded).
See Figure 15-3 below.
7) To add a second high power audio amplifier for local microphone, connect the output of
the second amplifier Normally Closed (C) connector on the top of the ACT module front
panel. Also connect the output of the second amplifier to the output of the first amplifier.
See the warning in Figure 15-3 below.
8) To use a local microphone (low-level audio signal), connect the microphone to the second
amplifier.
9) To attach a dot matrix printer or other serial device, connect the device to the COM OUT
connector on the ACT module using a data cable (with connector adaptors as necessary.)
See Figure 15-3 below.
15-6
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
6
4
2
Low-level audio
signal from radio
15-7
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
CD - In 6 RTS
Not Used 7 Not Used
CTS - In 8 DTR
Procedure 15-2 How to Configure the ACE3600 Port for the ACT Module
1) In the ACE3600 STS click on the desired site, and open the site view.
2) In the Port Tab, click on the on-board or plug-in port through which the RTU will
communicate with the ACT Module.
3) Set Media to RS-232, Operation Mode to Async, Connection Type to User Port (Ladder
Controlled).
Generally no other changes are required to Advanced Physical or Link Layer parameters. For
information on the RTU port parameters, see Appendix A: Site Configuration Parameters of
the ACE3600 STS User Guide.
15-8
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
The ACT is operated using a simple instruction set. Each instruction must be sent twice. If the
second instruction sent does not correspond to the first, that instruction is rejected. When the
ACT recognizes a valid instruction, it echoes an acknowledgement. While the module is
playing a stored audio signal, the instructions should be sent only once.
15-9
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
module status:
Byte 1: Instruction Echo (“01000000”)
Byte 2:
Bit 0-5 = Speaker status (0=disconnect)
Bit 6 = Play status (1 = play)
Bit 7 = Low-level Audio Output status
(1= Low-level Input routed to Low-level Out)
Byte 3: Possible number of recorded signals
Byte 4: The number of recorded audio signal that is
currently playing (will be reported only when a signal
is played.)
Response to Instructions
The ACT acknowledgements are the 8-bit codes described below:
1) Connect the "Speaker Out” of the PC/Laptop/Recorder to the "Audio In” port (Use Mono
adapter if needed).
2) Pause the audio and tune the volume to approximately ¾ of full scale.
3) Press the PB for more than two seconds; all four LEDs will light up.
15-10
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
4) Press the PB to select the audio cell (from a selection of eight) to which you want to
record. (The audio signal number is displayed as a binary number represented by four
LEDs).
5) Start playing the audio. The unit will identify the input as audio and start recording.
The LEDs will start to blink and will stop when audio input ceases (or when the maximum
recording time has elapsed).
15-11
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) Module
*
The ACT module is not compliant with ROHS European Directive no. 2002/95/EC.
15-12
CONFIGURATION
General
For information on setting the 12V DO dipswitch in the DO relay module board, see the
Digital Output Relay chapter above.
16-1
OPTIMIZATION
General
No optimization is required for the ACE3600 units.
17-1
OPERATION
General
The operational functions of the ACE3600 unit are performed using the ACE3600 System
Tools Suite (STS). These are administrative and diagnostic tasks, generally performed by
technicians and administrators. The functions available depend on the specific software
applications installed in the unit.
18-1
MAINTENANCE
General
The following maintenance procedures are recommended for the ACE3600 RTU.
• Once per month - run a full battery test (battery capacity) of the lead acid battery.
• Once per day - read the charge level of the lead acid battery.
If the capacity is below the manufacturer recommended level, replace the battery. See the
Power Supply Module and Backup Battery chapter above.
19-1
TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Action
The PWR LED on the CPU module Check power connections to the unit.
front panel is not lit. If all connections are correct, check cables.
The Power LED on the CPU The CPU has received an error from the power
module front panel is red. supply (AC fail, Bat Error etc.) Check the AC power
supply, backup battery, etc.
The ERR LED on the CPU module The unit has a problem. Check the Error Logger to
front panel is red. read error message.
The ERR LED on the CPU module The unit has a warning. Check the Error Logger to
front panel is orange. read warning.
The ERR LED on the CPU module The unit has a message. Check the Error Logger to
front panel is green. read message.
The APPL LED on the CPU The user application is not running. Check the Error
module front panel is red. Logger to read error.
The CONF LED on the CPU There is a configuration error (such as an
module front panel is red. incompatible plug-in.) Check the Error Logger to
read error.
The PWR LED on the CPU module The boot did not complete and the FPGA is not
front panel is flashing red. loaded. Download a new system to the unit.
The PWR LED on the CPU module The boot did not complete and the FPGA is not
front panel is flashing red. loaded. Download a new system to the unit.
The power supply is connected to Check if the AUX connectors are off due to STS
power sources and there is no Hardware Test.
power in AUX1 and/or AUX2.
If not, check if the fuse associated with the AUX is
burned out and should be replaced. (One fuse for
AUX 1A/1B and another fuse for AUX 2A/2B.) See
Break-Fix Procedures chapter.
No communication with WAN, IP Check the unit's connection to the Ethernet.
Gateway.
20-1
BREAK-FIX PROCEDURES
General
For information on installation of the frame/housing on the wall, see the Installation chapter
above.
The ACE3600 has a hot swap capability, which means that the modules can be removed from
their slots and inserted without powering down the unit. The only exception to this rule is the
main power supply module, which cannot be removed during normal operation. See
Replacing a Power Supply Module below for details.
If a module is inserted once the system is running, the system will recognize the module, but
will not operate it using the application until the unit has been rebooted.
1. To replace a CPU module, open the door of the CPU module and press the cable holder
downward.
2. Disconnect all cables from the connectors.
3. Simultaneously press on the tabs on the top and bottom of the plastic front of the old
module, and pull the module from its slot. See Figure 21-1.
21-1
Break/Fix Procedures
Press Down on
Module Release Tab
Press Up on Module
Release Tab
4. Remove any SRAM plug-in memory from the old CPU module and plug in to the new
CPU module.
5. Slide the new module all the way into the slot until the tabs click into place.
6. Reconnect the cables and press the cable holder back up into place.
21-2
Break/Fix Procedures
1. To replace the second power supply module in a site with redundant power supplies, open
the door of the power supply module and press the cable holder downward.
3. Simultaneously press on the tabs on the top and bottom of the plastic front of the old
module, and pull the module from its slot.
4. Slide the new module all the way into the slot until the tabs click into place.
5. Reconnect the cables and press the cable holder back up into place.
The main power supply cannot be removed under power and a safeguard is added in order to
prevent unplanned removal.
1. To replace the main power supply module, open the door of the power supply module.
2. Press down on the top of the main power cable connector to disconnect the user’s main
power cable from the cable inlet on the bottom of the power supply module front panel.
3. Follow steps 1-5 in Procedure 21-2 to replace the power supply.
1. If the I/O module includes a TB holder, remove TB holder by pulling on the extractor
handles.
If the I/O module does not include a TB holder, remove the TBs by hand or using the TB
extractor.
2. Simultaneously press on the tabs on the top and bottom of the plastic front of the old
module, and pull the module from its slot.
3. Remove any plug-in 24V power supplies from the old I/O module and plug-in to the new
I/O module.
4. For DO relay modules, reset the 12VDO dipswitch, if necessary. See the Configuration
chapter.
5. Slide the new module all the way into the slot until the tabs click into place.
6. If the I/O module includes a TB holder, reconnect the TB holder as described in the I/O
Module section.
If the I/O module does not include a TB holder, replace the TBs on the connectors on the
front of the I/O module by hand.
21-3
Break/Fix Procedures
1. To replace a plug-in port on the CPU module, remove the CPU module from the RTU.
2. Unscrew the two supporting pins on the other side of the CPU board. Save the screws.
3. Unscrew the two supporting pins on the plug-in port. Save the screws.
4. Connect the two supporting pins with screws to the new plug-in port.
5. Replace the plug-in board with the RJ-45 connector facing the panel. Carefully insert the
plug-in board connector into the appropriate connector on the CPU board.
For Ethernet 10/100 MB, use the J14 connector on the CPU (Plug-in 1 only.)
For all other plug-in ports, use the J5 (Plug-in 1) or J6 (plug-in 2) connector.
6. Connect the two supporting pins with screws to the other side of the CPU board.
1. To replace an SRAM memory card on the CPU module, remove the CPU module from the
RTU.
2. Remove the old plug-in SRAM memory card from the board.
3. Place the new plug-in SRAM memory card with the connector facing the panel. Carefully
insert the plug-in board connector into the connector marked P12 on the CPU board.
4. Secure the memory card to the CPU board with the supplied screw.
5. Replace the CPU module in the slot.
For more information, see Connecting SRAM Expansion Memory to the CPU Module in the
CPU Module chapter.
1. If the unit is installed in a NEMA4 housing, unscrew the four large screws and remove the
metal chassis from the housing.
2. Remove all modules from the outermost slots, generally the power supply module from the
leftmost slot and I/O module from the rightmost slot.
3. Unscrew the M5 screws on each side which secure the motherboard to the metal chassis.
Save the screws. See Figure 21-2.
21-4
Break/Fix Procedures
4. From inside the cage, push out the small cover on the side of the RTU rack/cage. Save the
cover.
5. Slide the damaged motherboard out of the cage, through the opening on the side of the
RTU rack/cage.
6. Slide the new motherboard into the rack, through the opening on the side of the RTU
rack/cage.
7. Secure the motherboard to the rack/cage and metal chassis using the M5 screws saved in
step 3.
8. Replace the cover on the cage.
9. If the unit was installed in a NEMA4 housing, replace the metal chassis in the housing and
screw the four large screws from the metal chassis into the housing.
10. Replace the modules in their respective slots.
11. Make sure that the ground is reconnected.
1. To replace a fuse for AUX1 1A/1B or AUX2 2A/2B on the power supply module,
2. Disconnect cables … from the connectors. If the faulty fuses are attached to the main
power supply, press down on the top of the main power cable connector to disconnect the
user’s main power cable from the cable inlet on the bottom of the power supply module
front panel.
3. Simultaneously press on the tabs on the top and bottom of the plastic front of the old
module, and pull the module from its slot.
21-5
Break/Fix Procedures
4. Using narrow pliers, remove the faulty fuse from its groove on the board.
5. Press the new fuse into the groove on the board.
6. Slide the power supply module all the way into the slot until the tabs click into place.
7. Reconnect cables as in installation…
Interconnection Diagrams
All internal electrical connections except for the main power, ground and battery are performed
in the factory and supplied with the RTU. The electrical interconnection diagrams are
provided below.
21-6
Break/Fix Procedures
21-7
APPENDIX A: GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications
The specifications below are for the RTU as a whole. For the individual technical and
performance specifications of each module in the RTU, see the specific module chapter.
8 I/O slots - PS , CPU and 8 I/O modules, wall mount or 19" rack,
Dimensions (WxHxD): 435 x 244 x 198* mm (17" x 9.61" x 7.80"*),
Weight: approx. 3.3 Kg (7.3 lb)
* Depth including Module panel
Metal Chassis Large - for PS, CPU and up to 7 I/O slot frame, two radios and 6.5 or 10
Ah backup battery, wall mount ,
Dimensions (WxHxD): 448 x 468 x 200* mm (17.64"x 18.43" x 7.88"*)
Small - for PS, CPU and up to 3 I/O slot frame, one radio and 6.5 Ah
backup battery, wall mount,
Dimensions (WxHxD): 335 x 355 x 198* mm (13.19" x 13.98" x 7.8"*)
* Depth including Frame and Module
A-1
Appendix A: Specifications
Housing Large Nema 4X / IP65 painted metal - up to 7 I/O slot frame, two radios
and 6.5 or 10 Ah, backup battery,
Dimensions (WxHxD): 500 x 500 x 210 mm (19.7" x19.7" x 8.26" )
Small Nema 4X / IP65 painted metal - up to 3 I/O slot frame one radio and
6.5 Ah backup battery,
Dimensions (WxHxD): 380 x380 x 210 mm (15" x 15" x 8.26")
Power Supply 10.8-16 V DC low-tier
10.8-16 V DC (default)
18-72 V DC
18-72 V DC with 12V smart battery charger
90-264 V AC, 50-60 Hz
90-264 V AC, 50-60 Hz, with 12V smart battery charger
Backup Battery 6.5 Ah - Sealed Lead-Acid
10 Ah - Sealed Lead-Acid
Operating Temperature -40 ºC to +70 ºC (-40 ºF to 158 ºF)
Notes: 1) When using a metal housing option, the maximum operating
temperature outside the housing is +60 ºC (140 ºF).
2) ACT module and Motorola radios operating temperature range is:
-30 ºC to +60 ºC (-22 ºF to 140 ºF).
Storage Temperature -55 ºC to +85 ºC (-67 ºF to 185 ºF)
Operating Humidity 5% to 95% RH @ 50 ºC without condensation
Mechanical Vibrations Per EIA / TIA 603 Base-station, Sinusoidal 0.07mm @ 10 to 30 Hz, 0.0035
mm @ 30-60 Hz
Operating Altitude -400m to +4000 meter (-1312 ft to + 13120 ft) above sea level
Note: When using 18-72V DC or 90-264 VAC Power supply the operating
altitude is -400 to +2000m
Regulatory Standards
Safety UL 60950-1 (UL listed), CSA 22.2-950-1, EN60950-1, IEC 60950-1,
AS/NZS 60950
FM??
Emission Emission standards for industrial environments
CFR 47 FCC part 15, subpart B (class A);
CE EMC: EN50081-2/EN61000-6-4
(CISPER 11 / EN55011 class A)
Immunity Immunity standards for industrial environments
Per EN50082-2 /IEC 61000-6-2
A-2
Appendix A: Specifications
Communications
Communication Ports Up to 5 Ports per CPU
Serial - up to 4 x RS232 ports
Multi-drop – up to 3 x RS485 port
Ethernet - up to 2 x 10/100 MB ports and 1 x 10 MB
Two-way radio / analog trunked radio - up 2 x modem ports
Motorola Radio Support Mobile conventional two-way radios – CM 200 , CM 340, GM 3188, EM
200, CDM750
Portable conventional two-way radios – HT750, GP320, GP328, PRO5150
Analog trunked radios – XTL5000, XTL2500, XTS2500
Digital trunked radios – XTL5000, XTL2500, XTS2500, MTM800
(TETRA)
Third Party Radio Support Two-way radios, Data radios, TETRA radios (PD)
Modem Support Dial-up modems, Cellular modems (dial mode and PD)
Protocols MDLC, TCP, UDP, IP, PPP, NTP, DHCP
Third Party Protocol MODBUS RTU: master on RS232/RS485,
Support slave on RS232/RS485/Ethernet
DF1 (Allen Bradley): master on RS232
DNP 3.0: master/slave on RS232/RS485/Ethernet
IEC 60870-5-101: slave on RS232
User Protocol (user Possible on RS232, RS485 and Ethernet ports
program)
A-3
APPENDIX B: ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
Disposal of Components
All components of the ACE3600 should be properly disposed of, in accordance with local
regulatory standards and laws.
All ACE3600 models comply with RoHS European Directive no. 2002/95/EC (Restriction of
the use of Hazardous Substances) and WEEE Directive no. 2002/96/EC (Strategy of Waste
management), with the exception of parts:
Note: The ACE3600 RTU is categorized as Monitoring and Control Equipment. Currently
(December 2007) Monitoring and Control Equipment are exempt from RoHS compliance.
This exemption may be cancelled in the future.
B-1
APPENDIX C: RS232/RS485 ADAPTOR AND ETHERNET
CABLES
General
Note: On all of the Motorola RJ45 connector heads (except for Ethernet crossover),
the numbering of the pins is different than the standard, as shown in the figure below.
Pin 1-8 are left to right rather than right to left, as shown below. Therefore, only
original Motorola cables should be used.
This appendix provides the information required for connecting an RTU RS232 port to various
units, as detailed below:
• Connection to a computer/terminal (MDLC protocol or User port)
• Connection to a modem (MDLC protocol or User port)
• Connection to the GPS receiver (MDLC protocol)
• Connecting a User port to a printer
• Connecting a User port to an external unit
• Connection to a radio (MDLC protocol)
• RTU-to-RTU connection using MDLC protocol through RS232 ports (RS-Link)
• ACE3600 RTU-to-ACE3600 RTU connection using MDLC protocol through RS485 ports
(RS-Link)
• ACE3600 RTU-to-MOSCAD RTU connection using MDLC protocol through RS485 ports
(RS-Link)
• ACE3600 RTU-to-PC Ethernet port connection without a hub
C-1
Appendix C: RS232/RS485 Adaptor Cables
To extend the cable, you may use any extension cable with male and female D-type connectors
(connected pin-to-pin, not crossed).
Note: When a User port is defined as Computer/Terminal with DTR support:
The RTU will not transmit unless it receives DTR=ON from the computer/terminal.
The RTU will not receive unless it receives RTS=ON from the computer/terminal.
Connection to a Modem
To connect one of the RTU RS232 ports to an RS232 modem, use one of the adaptors provided
in kit FLN6458B (option V213AE):
• 9-pin adaptor for Async (#0189968V32)
• RS232-E adaptor (#0189968V33) as in Connection to IDEN Radio below.
• RS232-E+ adaptor (#0189968V34) as in Connection to TETRA Radio below.
The asynchronous adaptor (#0189968V32) ends with the male 9-pin D-type connector. The
port may be defined either as a MDLC protocol port or as a User port.
The signals that appear on the male 9-pin D-type (or 25-pin) connector are according to the
RS232 standard – see the following table. In this case, the RTU serves as DTE (Data Terminal
Equipment).
RS232 Function 8-pin 25-pin Male 9-pin Male Direction
Connector(on
RTU)
TX-DATA 1→ 2 3 from RTU
RX-DATA 2← 3 2 to RTU
RTS 6→ 4 7 from RTU
CTS 3← 5 8 to RTU
GND 4 7 5 -
C-2
Appendix C: RS232/RS485 Adaptor Cables
To extend the cable, you may use any extension cable with male and female D-type connectors
(connected pin-to-pin, not crossed).
Before transmitting, the RTU sends RTS=ON to the modem, and waits for CTS=ON from the
modem as a condition for transmitting.
The RTU will receive data from the modem only when DCD=ON.
When using a modem in auto-answer mode (connected to a Computer port) for remote service,
the RTU does not support RTS/CTS protocol since the port is designated to operate with a
local computer as well as with a modem.
For modems which support RS232-E, use either the RS232-E adaptor (#0189968V33) as in
Connection to IDEN Radio below, or the RS232-E+ adaptor (#0189968V34), as in Connection
to TETRA Radio below.
C-3
Appendix C: RS232/RS485 Adaptor Cables
If the FLN6457B adaptor (with the female 9-pin, D-type connector) is used, refer to the
following table.
RS232 Function 9-pin Female Used as Direction
RX-DATA 2 Printer Rx-Data to Printer
DTR 4 Printer Ready from Printer
GND 5 GND -
Connection to a Radio
For detailed instructions on connecting a radio to the ACE3600 RTU, see the Radio Types and
Installation Kits chapter above.
Connection to IDEN Radio
To connect the RTU (via onboard serial or plug-in port) to an IDEN radio, use an adaptor
which ends with the male 9-pin, D-type connector. The port should be defined as RS-232,
Async, PPP, iDEN, MDLC over IP.
RS232 Function 8-pin Connector(on 9-pin Male Direction
RTU)
TX-DATA 1→ 3 from RTU
RX-DATA 2← 2 to RTU
CTS 3← 8 to RTU
GND 4 5 -
CD (Rec line) 5← 1 to RTU
RTS 6→ Not used
7→ 4 from RTU
DTR 8→ 7 from RTU
C-4
Appendix C: RS232/RS485 Adaptor Cables
Do not connect between RTUs without the adaptor cables. A direct connection will cause a
short circuit between the pins that have the same function.
C-5
Appendix C: RS232/RS485 Adaptor Cables
Do not connect between RTUs without the adaptor cables. A direct connection will
cause a short circuit between the pins that have the same function.
C-6
Appendix C: RS232/RS485 Adaptor Cables
Note: The RJ45 connector head for this connection is standard. The numbering of the
pins is according to the standard, as shown in the figure below. Pin 1-8 are right to
left, as shown below. Therefore, any standard Ethernet crossover cable may be used.
To establish a link between an ACE3600 unit and the Ethernet port of a PC, without using a
hub, the RTU port should be defined as an IP port (10/100 BT, Static, Ethernet LAN) with an
IP address. The ports should be connected using an Ethernet crossover cable.
IP Function 8-pin 8-pin
Connector Connector
(Plug 1) (Plug 2)
TX-DATA + 1→ 3←
TX-DATA - 2→ 6←
RX-DATA + 3← 1→
N/A 4 7
N/A 5 8
RX-DATA - 6← 2→
N/A 7 4
N/A 8 5
C-7
APPENDIX D: ACE3600 MAXIMUM POWER RATINGS
Table D-1 Maximum Peak Power Allowed for Fully Loaded RTU
Housing Description Maximum Input Power into Power Supply Module
(in watts)
19" Rack (w/out metal enclosure) 120w
Large NEMA metal housing (50x50 cm) 120w
Small NEMA metal housing (40x40 cm) 105w
D-1
Appendix D: ACE3600 Maximum Power Ratings
Plastic Box Interface Typical Power Power when all I/Os are on
(in watts) (in watts)
Audio Control and Tone (ACT) 0.6 2.2
Module
D-2
Power Supplies PS5R Slim Line Series
Power Supplies
of the rated voltage. 1% peak to peak, the 120W and 240W
power supplies are some of the best in
the industry. The output comes with
overload protection that avoids damag-
ing the power supply. The 240W power
supply also has the convenience of two
output sets of output screws for wiring.
Part Numbers
Part Rated Rated
Item Watts
Number Voltage Current
30
File # E234997
L-4 www.idec.com USA: (800) 262-IDEC or (408) 747-0550, Canada: (888) 317-IDEC
Power Supplies PS5R Slim Line Series
Specifications
Power Supplies
Approvals EN50178:1997, UL 1604, UL 508, UL1310 (PS5R-SC, -SD), c-UL (CSA 22.2 No. 14)
– SEMI F47
Harmonic Directive (EN61000-3-2) N/A EN61000-3-2 A14 class A
Weight (approx.) 250g 285g 440g 630g 1000g
Terminal Screw M3.5 slotted-Phillips head screw (screw terminal type)
IP protection IP20 fingersafe
Dimensions H x W x D (mm) 95 x 36 x 108 115 x 46 x 121 115 x 50 x 129 125 x 80 x 149.5
Dimensions H x W x D (inches) 3.74 x 1.42 x 4.25 4.53 x 1.81 x 4.76 4.53 x 1.97 x 5.08 4.92 x 3.15 x 5.89
1. For dimensional drawings, see page L-7.
2. *Between input and output: 3000VAC, 1 minute; Between output and ground: 500VAC, 1 minute
www.idec.com USA: (800) 262-IDEC or (408) 747-0550, Canada: (888) 317-IDEC L-5
Sunlight Visible LED Alarm Light INGRAM
P R O D U C T S, I N C.
2 1/8"
2 7/8"
Ø 1 1/16"
4"
or 3/4" knockout
3/4" NPT
S C F
FRONT
2"
1"
S C F
TWO WIRE HOOKUP:
S + C = STEADY
F + C = FLASHING
FOR DC APPLICATIONS Dimensions Hole Pattern for Mounting
C = NEGATIVE BOTTOM
8725 Youngerman Court, Ste 206, Jacksonville, FL 32244 888-875-2221 ph (904)778-2444 fax Website:www.ingramproducts.com e-mail: info@ingramproducts.com
NEMA Type Terminal Blocks
Box Lug Termination
High Density Block Without Test Probe Adapter With Test Probe Adapter
Maximum Voltage Rating 600 600 600
UL 30 60 60
Maximum Amperage Ratingv ✬
CSA 30 60 60
Wire Range #22 to #10 AWG #22 to #8 AWG #22 to #8 AWG
1 - #10 1 or 2 - #18 1 - #8 1 to 4 - #16 1 - #8 1 to 4 - #16
1 - #12 1 to 5 - #20 1 - #10 1 to 5 - #18 1 - #10 1 to 5 - #18
Maximum Wire Combination 1 - #14 1 to 8 - #22 1 to 3 - #12 1 to 8 - #20 1 to 3 - #12 1 to 8 - #20
1 or 2 - #16 1 to 4 - #14 1 to 10 - #22 1 to 4 - #14 1 to 10 - #22
Wire Type Solid or Stranded Copper Wire Solid or Stranded Copper Wire Solid or Stranded Copper Wire
Density - Sections per foot 51 34 34
1.72 x 1.82 x .235 inches 1.72 x 1.82 x .35 inches 1.72 x 1.82 x .35 inches
Approx. Dimensions (D)x(H)x(W) 44 x 46 x 6 mm 44 x 46 x 9 mm 44 x 46 x 9 mm
Block Material Nylon
Busbar Material Tin Plated Brass N/A N/A
Screw Material Steel with Zinc Plating and Chromate Film
Box Lug Material Zinc Plated Steel Copper
-40 to 257° F -40 to 257° F -40 to 257° F
Temperature Rating -40 to 125° C -40 to 125° C -40 to 125° C
Flammability Rating UL94V2 UL94V2 UL94V2
Recommended Screw 7-8 lbf-in 18-20 lbf-in 18-20 lbf-in
Tightening Torque 0.8-0.9 N-m 2.1-2.3 N-m 2.1-2.3 N-m
2
Mini–CAS 120 PART NO. 14-407129
Features:
• Plug in replacement for existing MiniCAS / FUS unit
• 120 VAC, 24 VAC, or 24 VDC powered
• Durable plastic enclosure with flange for mounting on door of pump control
enclosure
• Highly visible red LEDs for indication of Leakage and Temperature alarms
• Green LED for indication power is applied
• Temperature alarm reset mode select switch, for selection of Manual or Auto
reset modes
• Temperature alarm reset push-button on front of unit
• Input power transient protected
• Sensor input circuit transient protected
• Sensor input circuit short circuit protected
• Noise Filter on Sensor Input
• Sensor circuit supply voltage regulated to 12 VDC
• Detailed connection diagram on side of unit
ITT FLYGT CORPORATION
35 Nutmeg Drive
Trunbull, Connecticut 06611
Phone (203) 380-4700
FAX (203) 380-4705
Mini–CAS 120 PART NO. 14-407129
Specifications:
• Input Power: 120 VAC ±10%, 7.0 VA max
24 VAC ±10%, 3.5 VA max
24 VDC ±10%, 125 mA max
• Input Power Transient Protection: Metal Oxide Varistor
• Sensor Input Transient Protection: Metal Oxide Varistor
• Relay Contact Rating: 10A @ 250 VAC
• Relay Contact Material: Silver Cadmium Oxide (AgCdO)
• Ambient Operating Temperature: –20°C to +65°C (– 4°F to +149°F)
• Agency Approvals: UL 508, CAN/CSA (Pending)
• Alarm Indicators: Super Bright Red LED
• Power On Indicator: Green LED
• Enclosure: Blue Lexan (141R) or Noryl (PX9406)
• Faceplate Overlay: Silver Lexan with Black Text
• Side Label: Silver Lexan with Black Text
• Sensor Circuit Supply Voltage: Regulated 12 VDC ±10%,
• Weight 11.75 oz (334 grams)
• Temperature Alarm Trip Point: Sensor Current ≤3 mA ±5%
• Leak Alarm Trip Point: Sensor Current ≥22 mA ±5%
Let us design a control solution using an ARC ARMOR® Enclosure for your application.
ARC ARMOR 06/12
Onsite damages caused by an arc flash incident include: OSHA citations or fines, down time,
loss of revenue and equipment damage. In worst case scenarios, arc flash may result in long
term disability or even death thereby having a significant impact on the liability of the municipal-
ity. Arc flash events usually occur in less than 0.2 seconds and can create:
AA-666026 (Free Standing)
• Intense heat overall dimensions 66”H x 60”W x 26”D
• Thermo-acoustic shock wave
• Molten metal 24” 36” 10” 16” 60”
• Shrapnel
• Blinding light
• Toxic smoke
• Contact with energized components
48”
The multiple compartment design of the ARC ARMOR Enclosure will limit access to electrical
®
equipment capable of producing arc flash incidents. Electrical control equipment is segregated 66”
High energy circuits, such as Motor Controls are located in the MCC compartment, while
low energy circuits, such as controllers and low voltage controls, are located in the Control 18”
Compartment. This allows the maintenance staff to safely work on control circuits with minimum
Personal Protective Equipment (PPE).
typical installation
APPLICATIONS & customization
Your Control Solutions Provider can
engineer a customized control solution
using the Arc Armor® enclosure to meet
your individual specifications. Common
applications including multiple pump
control for:
zone 4 - Skirt Compartment (does not apply to AA-363020 Pole Mount Enclosure)
• Gas Isolation Zone: Provides gas isolation from wet well in wastewater lift station applications
• Can be used to house the control transformer
• Vented space for sealing cable penetrations
zone 4 - Skirt Compartment (does not apply to AA-363020 Pole Mount Enclosure)
• Gas Isolation Zone: Provides gas isolation from wet well in wastewater lift station applications
• Can be used to house the control transformer
• Vented space for sealing cable penetrations
typical installation
APPLICATIONS & customization
Your Control Solutions Provider can
engineer a customized control solution
using the Arc Armor® enclosure to meet
your individual specifications. Common
applications including multiple pump
control for:
Onsite damages caused by an arc flash incident include: OSHA citations or fines, down time,
loss of revenue and equipment damage. In worst case scenarios, arc flash may result in long
term disability or even death thereby having a significant impact on the liability of the municipal-
ity. Arc flash events usually occur in less than 0.2 seconds and can create:
AA-666026 (Free Standing)
• Intense heat overall dimensions 66”H x 60”W x 26”D
• Thermo-acoustic shock wave
• Molten metal 24” 36” 10” 16” 60”
• Shrapnel
• Blinding light
• Toxic smoke
• Contact with energized components
48”
The multiple compartment design of the ARC ARMOR Enclosure will limit access to electrical
®
equipment capable of producing arc flash incidents. Electrical control equipment is segregated 66”
High energy circuits, such as Motor Controls are located in the MCC compartment, while
low energy circuits, such as controllers and low voltage controls, are located in the Control 18”
Compartment. This allows the maintenance staff to safely work on control circuits with minimum
Personal Protective Equipment (PPE).
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic flowmeter
Transmitter
Introduction
WaterMaster™ is a range of high performance For a comprehensive overview of publications available
electromagnetic flowmeters for the measurement of for the WaterMaster transmitter, refer to the inside cover
electrically-conductive fluids and systems are normally of this publication. Web links, QR code and reference
supplied factory-configured and calibrated. numbers are also included.
This User Guide provides installation, connection,
security, start-up and basic setup details. For
programming and configuration information refer to the
Programming Guide – IM/WMP.
The Company
We are an established world force in the design and manufacture of instrumentation for industrial process control,
flow measurement, gas and liquid analysis and environmental applications.
As a part of ABB, a world leader in process automation technology, we offer customers application expertise, service
and support worldwide.
We are committed to teamwork, high quality manufacturing, advanced technology and unrivalled service and
support.
The quality, accuracy and performance of the Company’s products result from over 100 years experience, combined
with a continuous program of innovative design and development to incorporate the latest technology.
Quality Control
The UKAS Calibration Laboratory No. 0255 is just one of the ten flow calibration plants operated by the Company
and is indicative of our dedication to quality and accuracy.
1 Safety ............................................................................................................................................... 2
1.1 Electrical Safety ............................................................................................................................................. 2
1.2 Symbols ........................................................................................................................................................ 2
1.3 Health & Safety ............................................................................................................................................. 3
5 Specification .................................................................................................................................. 31
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 1
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 1 Safety
1 Safety
Information in this manual is intended only to assist our customers in the efficient operation of our
equipment. Use of this manual for any other purpose is specifically prohibited and its contents are not to be
reproduced in full or part without prior approval of the Technical Publications Department.
1.2 Symbols
One or more of the following symbols may appear on the equipment labeling:
Warning – Refer to the manual for instructions Direct current supply only
Protective earth (ground) terminal Both direct and alternating current supply
2 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 1 Safety
Safety advice concerning the use of the equipment described in this manual or any relevant hazard
data sheets (where applicable) may be obtained from the Company address on the back cover,
together with servicing and spares information.
Warning.
System configuration must be carried out only by users or personnel with approved access rights
(user privileges).
Read all relevant sections of this guide before configuring the system or modifying system
parameters.
Install and use associated equipment in accordance with the relevant national and local
standards.
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 3
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 2 Mechanical Installation
2 Mechanical Installation
2.1 Installation Conditions
Allow room
to read display
60 °C
(140 °F) Max.
–20 °C
(–4 °F)
Min.
4 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 2 Mechanical Installation
Transmitter Submersion:
1 m (3.3 ft) <12 hours
Accrued time
Position to enable
access to display and
communication connector
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 5
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 2 Mechanical Installation
2.2 Dimensions
Dimensions in mm (in).
201 (7.9)
118 (4.6)
6 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 2 Mechanical Installation
Note. Fix remote transmitter to a secure surface using 3 x M5 screws (not supplied).
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 7
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
3 Electrical Installation
3.1 Remote Transmitter / Sensor Arrangement
Note. For bonding connections use 4mm2 (< 10AWG) cable.
Power Supply
8 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
Power Supply
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 9
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
Warning. If the power indicator LED B is lit, the transmitter is still powered up. Before
continuing, isolate the transmitter power supply.
4. If screws C are not visible, access them by gently pulling the rotation lock D back and rotating the
cartridge E until the cartridge screw access holes align with the cartridge screw heads.
5. Slacken the three cartridge screws and lift the cartridge F away from the housing.
10 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
Output
Connections
Terminal
Backplane
Internal Earth
Internal Earth (Alternative PE)
(Alternative PE)
External Earth
Power Cable Output Connections Output Connections Sensor Cable
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 11
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
M1 M2 D1/TFE D2 3 S2 E2 E1 S1
Brown Red Orange Yellow Green Blue Blue Violet Violet
(Sleeve) (Screen) (*Signal) (*Signal) (Screen)
SCR
Screen
**Drain Wire
(Twisted with
Screen from
D1/TFE – Orange
and D2 – Yellow)
*Inner wire
**For cathodically protected systems (or if the transmitter enclosure does not have an earth screw) connect
the drain wire to terminal SCR.
Fig. 3.5 Sensor Cable Connections at Transmitter Terminal Block – Standard System
12 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
PLC or Datalogger
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
52
62
Note. Digital outputs DO1 and DO2 are polarity sensitive. The common (negative) connection for these
outputs is designated 'COM'.
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 13
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
and / or
14 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
COM DO3
Terminal connection IDs are
HART- /
PROFIBUS- / MODBUS-
variant dependent
Bell
Alarm 1
DC Supply
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
–
52
+
62
and / or Horn
COM DO1 DO2 DO3
Alarm 2
Note.
Normal alarm / logic output is from DO3 (terminal 61). DO1 (41) and DO2 (51) can also be
configured as alarms if required but are then NOT available as frequency / pulse outputs as shown
in Figs 3.7 and 3.8).
Bell and horn shown for example only. Any suitable alarm device may be used (for example, lamp,
siren, buzzer etc.).
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 15
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
Alarm 1
Timer Switch DC Supply
–
+
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
52 R
62
Alarm 2
and / or
Relay
Note. Relay and timer switch shown for example only. Connect as required.
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
52
62
16 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
24 V
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
52 Typically
PLC
62 1k 1W
+
Fwd +
DC Supply
Rev + –
Com
+
XX XX XX XX 42 41 51 61
52
62 DC Supply
Note.
WaterMaster digital outputs are NPN optocoupled transistors used as switches.
Maximum allowed voltage at collector is 30 V DC
Maximum allowed current across transistor is 220 mA.
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 17
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
+ –
Refer to IM/WMP for
HART-Protocol
communication details
PROFIBUS / MODBUS
RS485
A1 / B1 – In
A2 / B2 – Out
Screen Clamp
Note. A typical DVM probe can access (fit) the PCB's test holes.
18 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
4 to 20 mA
IC+*
IC–*
Not Used
*These 2 test points are connected on the HART FEX100 backplane only
(they are present on the PROFIBUS FEX100-DP / MODBUS FEX100-MB backplane but are not
connected)
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 19
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
Internal Earth
Screws**
**Can be used as a
Protective Earth (PE)
if required by
Brown national standards
Blue
Green / Yellow
20 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
Internal Earth
Screws
Red
Black
Green / Yellow External Earth
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 21
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
For MID-compliant flowmeters set the read-only / MID protection switch to 'ON' to ensure the meter is
secure from tampering.
For HART software versions prior to 01.02.XX, this switch (set after commissioning) prevents login via the
keypad or bus at any security level.
From HART software version 01.03.XX onwards and for all PROFIBUS software versions, on MID meters,
all metrological-related parameters are locked and inaccessible at the Service level. Standard and
Advanced user level parameters can still be modified via the HMI or bus.
ON
SW3 SW2 SW1
Caution.
The communications bus type is HART FEX100 if not specified on the
cartridge label. An example of the PROFIBUS FEX100-DP variant cartridge
label is shown on the right.
The cartridge communications type must match the PROFIBUS variant
cartridge label
communications type of the transmitter backplane PCB.
To avoid damaging the cartridge during refitting, do not overtighten the cartridge screws.
22 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 3 Electrical Installation
2. Align the three cartridge screws B with the cartridge housing pillars and tighten the screws carefully
until the cartridge is held in position.
3. If necessary, rotate the cartridge to the required orientation before refitting the cover – see Fig. 3.3,
page 10 for details.
4. For high integrity / security installations, set DIP switch SW1 to the 'ON' (Read-only) position – see
Fig. 3.20, page 22.
5. Align the transmitter cover with the housing and tighten the four cover screws C carefully.
6. For high integrity / security installations or where MID is required, fit anti-tamper seals to the security
fixtures D.
C D
A D Red Label
B B On DC (and
Low Voltage
24V AC) Cartridge
Model
HW Rev
Model
HW Rev
24V Rear Plate
Manufactur ed Manufacture
d
C
Red Label on DC
Black Label on
D C (and Low Voltage AC)
AC Cartridge
Cartridge
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 23
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 4 Start-up and Operation
Menu
Easy Setup
C
B
Exit Select
D E
F H
Item Description
F Left key – used for parameter navigation and to enter editable parameters
G Up / Down keys – used to scroll through menu options and to increase / decrease values
in editable parameters
H Right key – used to accept / select parameter values / selections and exit sub-levels
24 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 4 Start-up and Operation
System Start-up
System Startup
At system start-up, a progress bar is displayed for the duration
LOADING SYSTEM DATA of the start-up period.
After this period, one of the four following screens is displayed
according to the current status of the system.
No Sensor Connected
System Startup
If no sensor is detected during start-up, an auto-recovery
NO SENSOR DETECTED routine is run to look for the sensor. If no sensor is detected,
Device Resetting this routine continues until it is stopped manually.
If 'Offline' is selected during auto-recovery (by pressing the
Offline key) the transmitter ceases to operate as a flowmeter and
the following conditions apply at the transmitter:
Plant and transmitter data can be configured.
Sensor data cannot be configured.
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 25
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 4 Start-up and Operation
Installation Changed
System Startup
If the sensor data stored in the transmitter memory does not
INSTALLATION CHANGED match the data of the connected sensor, the warning
Identify Changed Item 'INSTALLATION CHANGED' is displayed.
The changed item(s) (transmitter or sensor) can be identified
Transmitter Sensor
and data copied as follows:
Transmitter
Selecting this option copies plant and stack data from the
sensor memory to the transmitter memory and loads the
totalizer from the sensor memory.
It is used to make the following changes:
Remote or integral cartridge change
Remote Tx change
New installation
Sensor
Selecting this option copies data from the transmitter memory
to the sensor and loads the totalizer from the sensor memory.
It is used to make the following changes:
Integral backplane change
Sensor change
Integral transmitter change
Process Display (Operator Page)
Drain Water*
When the 'Process Display' (Operator Page) is displayed,
123.45 l/s normal operation is assumed.
To access menus at a permitted access level, press the
key to display the 'Access Level' screen – see Section 4.3,
page 27.
*Example legend only
26 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 4 Start-up and Operation
Enter Password
Enter Password
Enter the password and press the key to display menus
available at the permitted access level.
Note. If a time-out occurs (5 minutes of no activity), enter the
password again to access the menus.
Next OK
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 27
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 4 Start-up and Operation
Note. When allocating passwords, record a copy of each password and store in a safe location. It is not
possible to interrogate the transmitter to 'recover' passwords once they have been set.
28 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 4 Start-up and Operation
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 29
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 4 Start-up and Operation
30 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 5 Specification
5 Specification
Functional Specification
Power supply
OI/FET100–EN Rev. D 31
WaterMaster FET100
Electromagnetic floweter | Transmitter 5 Specification
Environmental protection
Humidity: 0 to 100 %
Rating: IP67 (NEMA 4X) to 1m (3.3 ft) depth
Tamper-proof security
Write access prevented by internal switch combined with
external security seals for MID applications
Languages
English, French, German, Italian, Spanish, Polish
Infrared service port
USB adapter (accessory), USB 1.1. and 2.0 compatible
Driver software for Windows 2000, XP, 7 (32-bit) and Vista
Housing material
Powder-coated aluminium with glass window
Hazardous approvals (HART variant only)
FM & FMc Class 1 Div 2
(FM listing NI / 1 / 2 / ABCD / T4, S / II, III / 2 / FG /T4,
Ta=60C; Type 4X, IP67 – for transmitter and integral mounting
Ta=70C, Type 6P, IP68 – for remote sensor type,
IP67 on DN10 to 32)
(FMc listing NI / 1 / 2 / ABCD / T4, DIP / II, III / 2 / FG /T4,
Ta=60C; Type 4X, IP67 – for transmitter and integral mounting
Ta=70C, Type 6P, IP68 – for remote sensor type, IP67 on
DN10 to 32)
FET, FEV, FEW and FEF DN700 to 2200 (27/28* to 84) only
*Size is dependent on flange specification
Declaration of Conformance
Copies of CE and PED certification will be available on request.
WaterMaster has OIML R49 Certificate of Conformity to accuracy class 1 and 2 (FEV DN40 to 200). Copies of accuracy
certification are available on request.
WaterMaster (FEV DN40 to 200) has been type examined under directive MID 2004/22/EC, Annex MI-001. Copies of
this certificate are available on request.
DS/WM–EN Rev. K
32 OI/FET100–EN Rev. D
Products and customer support
Automation Systems Customer support
For the following industries: We provide a comprehensive after sales service via a
— Chemical & Pharmaceutical Worldwide Service Organization. Contact one of the
— Food & Beverage following offices for details on your nearest Service and
— Manufacturing Repair Centre.
— Metals and Minerals
— Oil, Gas & Petrochemical UK
— Pulp and Paper ABB Limited
Tel: +44 (0)1453 826661
Drives and Motors Fax: +44 (0)1453 829671
— AC and 6 Drives, AC and DC Machines, AC Motors to
1kV USA
— Drive Systems ABB Inc.
— Force Measurement Tel: +1 215 674 6000
— Servo Drives Fax: +1 215 674 7183
Controllers & Recorders
— Single and Multi-loop Controllers
— Circular Chart and Strip Chart Recorders
— Paperless Recorders
— Process Indicators
Flexible Automation
— Industrial Robots and Robot Systems
Flow Measurement
— Electromagnetic Flowmeters
— Mass Flowmeters
— Turbine Flowmeters
— Wedge Flow Elements
Process Analytics
— Process Gas Analysis
— Systems Integration
Transmitters
— Pressure
— Temperature
— Level
— Interface Modules
www.abb.com
Microsoft is a registered trademark of
Microsoft Corporation in the United States
and / or other countries
MODBUS is a registered trademark of the
MODBUS-IDA organization
HART is a registered trademark of the
HART Communication Foundation
PROFIBUS is a registered trademark of
PROFIBUS organization.
4.04 INSTRUCTIONS FOR CONDUIT ENTRY
Rev. 4-28-14
4.05 GENERATOR
Bay Meadows
1
Table of Contents
Material Summary ......................................................................................................................................................
Pre-Start-Up Check List .............................................................................................................................................
Genset Warranty .........................................................................................................................................................
ATS Warranty .............................................................................................................................................................
Generator
Specification Sheet .....................................................................................................................................................
Generator Data Sheet ..................................................................................................................................................
Power Command Digital Generator Set Control ........................................................................................................
Certificate of Compliance ...........................................................................................................................................
Exhaust Emission Data Sheet .....................................................................................................................................
Exhaust Compliance Data Sheet .................................................................................................................................
Sound Data Sheet ........................................................................................................................................................
Prototype Test Report ..................................................................................................................................................
Alternator Data Sheet .................................................................................................................................................
Generator Outline Drawings ........................................................................................................................................
Circuit Breaker Outline Drawing ................................................................................................................................
Accessories
Battery Specifications ................................................................................................................................................
Fuel Tank Accessories ................................................................................................................................................
Quotation
Quotation: 2220000000122133
NOTES:
1. THIS QUOTATION IS SUBJECT TO CUMMINS NORTHWEST, LLC STANDARD TERMS &
CONDITIONS - SEE ATTACHMENT
2. THIS UNIT MEETS NATIONAL EPA AND CARB REQUIREMENTS. CONTRACTOR TO VERIFY IF
ANY LOCAL EMISSIONS REQUIEMENTS ARE NECESSARY.
3. REGARDING SELECTIVE COORDINATION FOR NEC ARTICLE 700 AND 701 LOADS. CUMMINS
GENERATORS ARE EQUIPPED WITH THE MANUFACTURERS RECOMMENDED THERMAL
MAGNETIC CIRCUIT BREAKER. INFORMATION REGARDING THIS DEVICE CAN BE SUPPLIED
UPON REQUEST. THIS QUOTATION IS NOT VALID IF ANY CHANGES TO THIS CIRCUIT
BREAKER(S) IS REQUIRED TO COORDINATE WITH OTHER DEVICES IN THE ELECTRICAL
DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM. IF CHANGES ARE REQUIRED, THE CUSTOMER MUST PROVIDE A COPY
OF THE COORDINATION STUDY LISTING THE MANUFACTURERS PART NUMBER OF THE
DISCONNECT DEVICE TO BE SUPPLIED WITH THE GENERATOR AND A REVISED QUOTATION
WILL BE ISSUED.
Submitted by
___________________________________________
Matt Chapman , Oregon Power Generation Sales
matt.chapman@Cummins.com
Direct: 503-972-6615
Cummins Northwest, LLC
Attachment to Quotation
-Exclusions-
Exhaust System: All off-engine piping, hangers, flanges, gaskets, bolts, insulation, and other materials associated with
exhaust system installation unless specifically listed in the preceding quotation.
Fuel System: All off-engine fuel piping for supply, return, venting, valves, coolers, filters, pumps, fittings, fuel storage tank
& senders, all fuel for testing and initial fill of fuel.
Cooling System: Intake louvers, exhaust louvers, air dampers, sheet metal ducting, flex adapters, sound attenuators/baffles.
All off engine piping, flexible connections, secondary loop coolant, labor to install coolant for remote cooling
systems unless specifically listed in the preceding quotation.
Electrical: All off-engine wiring, field terminations of wiring, and lugs other than those detailed in our submittal.
Mounting: Generator mounting bolts and anchors. Vibration isolators (if included) for the generator will be shipped
loose for installation at the jobsite by others.
Testing: All electrical testing, including but not limited to NETA, infrared scanning, harmonic content or other
independent agency testing of switchgear, switchboards, protective relays or any other electrical component
unless specifically listed in the preceding quotation. All environmental testing, including but not limited to
EPA, local air quality district or other unless specifically listed in the preceding quotation. Calculations and
Engineering Services - all electrical coordination studies, arc flash studies, seismic engineering calculations
and seismic anchorage calculations unless specifically included in the preceding quotation. Programming -
all protective relay settings, breaker settings, PLC programming or other user configurable device
programming unless specifically included in the preceding quotation
Documentation: Unless stated otherwise, electronic submittals and O&M manuals will be provided. Printed copies are
available upon request, additional charges may apply.
Bonds Any bid bond, payment or performance bond, or other type of bond unless specifically listed in the proposal.
Cost for any required bond will be reimbursed to CNW by the buyer.
All items listed are excluded and will only be supplied by Cummins Northwest, LLC if agreed upon, in writing, by a sales representative
for Cummins Northwest, LLC.
120204 rev.
12/12
Cummins Northwest, LLC
4711 N. Basin Ave. (97217)
PO Box 2710
Project Name:
Portland, OR 97208-2710
Phone (503) 289-0900
Project Number:
Fax (503) 240-5553
Please review your installation and respond to the check list below: YES NO
*1. Utility power available and connected to ATS / MTS (Don't connect door plug to harness)
2. Owner / Tenant has been notified of the start-up date.
3. Can emergency loads be transferred to generator at start-up?
*4. Generator mainline circuit breaker connected to ATS / MTS
*5. All DC and data interconnect wires run and terminated per submittal specifications.
6. Fuel supply connected to engine with approved flexible lines.
7. Fuel available on-site and ready for testing.
8. Gas plumbing and sizing completed in accordance with submittal specifications.
9. Natural Gas and / or Propane plumbing requires a minimum 7"-13" of water column.
10. Propane tank set up for liquid or vapor withdrawal.
11. Exhaust system installation complete including all piping and insulation. N/A
*12. Fuel day tank power connected. (Do Not Energize Circuit) N/A
13. Remote radiator, piping, expansion tanks installed flushed, filled with coolant. N/A
*14. Engine coolant heater connected to utility (Do Not Energize Circuit)
15. Generator and isolators mounted to pad properly.
16. Radiator discharge air exhaust duct installed. N/A
17. Intake and exhaust louvers installed and operational. N/A
18. Generator battery / batteries on site. (Do Not Energize Circuit)
*19. Battery charger power connected (Do Not Energize Circuit)
20. Other:
* Items 1, 4, 5, 12, 14 & 19 - Referenced wiring must be terminated without exception . CNW is not allowed by RCW 19.28 ,
WAC 296-46A & WAC 296-401B to initially terminate this wiring. Once terminated, CNW can change or correct the wiring.
Interconnect Wiring:
All interconnect wiring must be installed per Cummins Power Generation interconnect wiring drawing recommendations.
Fuel Plumbing:
Recommended fuel line material for diesel systems is schedule 40 black iron pipe.
Exhaust Piping:
Recommended exhaust pipe material is schedule 40 black iron pipe.
The undersigned confirms equipment is ready for startup:
Return to CNW Project
/ / Manager:
Printed Name Signature Date
Phone:
Company: Fax:
Phone #: Email Address:
Fax #:
Feature Codes
G004
G006
G007
G008
G013
www.cumminspower.com
Diesel
Generator set
QSB7 series
engine
100-200 kW 60 Hz
Description
®
Cummins Power Generation commercial Control system - The PowerCommand 1.1
generator sets are fully integrated power electronic control is standard equipment and
generation systems providing optimum provides total genset system integration including
performance, reliability and versatility for automatic remote starting/stopping, precise
stationary standby and prime power frequency and voltage regulation, alarm and status
applications. message display, output metering, auto-shutdown
at fault detection and NFPA 110 Level 1
Features compliance. The optional PowerCommand 2.2
® ™
Cummins heavy-duty engine - Rugged 4- control is UL 508 Listed and provides AmpSentry
cycle, industrial diesel delivers reliable power, protection.
low emissions and fast response to load Cooling system - Standard integral set-mounted
changes. radiator system, designed and tested for rated
Alternator - Several alternator sizes offer ambient temperatures, simplifies facility design
selectable motor starting capability with low requirements for rejected heat.
reactance 2/3 pitch windings, low waveform Enclosures - Optional weather protective and
distortion with non-linear loads and fault sound attenuated enclosures are available.
clearing short-circuit capability.
NFPA - The genset accepts full rated load in a
single step in accordance with NFPA 110 for Level
1 systems.
Warranty and service - Backed by a
comprehensive warranty and worldwide distributor
network.
cumminspower.com
©2013 Cummins Power Generation Inc. | S-1544m (3/13)
Generator set specifications
Governor regulation class ISO 8528 Part 1 Class G3
Voltage regulation, no load to full load ± 1%
Random voltage variation ± 0.5%
Frequency regulation Isochronous
Random frequency variation ± 0.25%
Radio frequency emissions compliance Meets requirements of most industrial and commercial applications
Engine specifications
Bore 107 mm (4.21 in)
Stroke 124.0 mm (4.88 in)
Displacement 6.69 L (408 in3)
Configuration Cast iron, in-line, 6 cylinder
1100 amps minimum at ambient temperature of -18 °C to 0 °C
Battery capacity
(0 °F to 32 °F)
Battery charging alternator 100 amps
Starting voltage 12 volt, negative ground
Direct injection: number 2 diesel fuel, fuel filter, automatic electric
Fuel system
fuel shutoff
Single element, 10 micron filtration, spin-on fuel filter with water
Fuel filter
separator
Air cleaner type Dry replaceable element
Lube oil filter type(s) Spin-on, full flow
Standard cooling system High ambient radiator
Alternator specifications
Design Brushless, 4 pole, drip proof, revolving field
Stator 2/3 pitch
Rotor Single bearing, flexible discs
Insulation system Class H
Standard temperature rise 150 ºC standby at 40 °C ambient
Exciter type Torque match (shunt) standard, PMG optional
Phase rotation A (U), B (V), C (W)
Alternator cooling Direct drive centrifugal blower fan
AC waveform total harmonic distortion < 5% no load to full linear load, < 3% for any single harmonic
Telephone influence factor (TIF) < 50 per NEMA MG1-22.43
Telephone harmonic factor (THF) <3
Available voltages
60 Hz Three phase line-neutral/line-line 60 Hz Single phase line-neutral/line-line
• 110/190 • 115/230 Delta • 127/220 • 240/416 • 110/220 • 115/230 • 120/240
• 110/220 • 120/208 • 139/240 • 255/440
• 115/200 • 120/240 Delta • 220/380 • 277/480
• 230/400 • 347/600
Note: Some options may not be available on all models - consult factory for availability.
cumminspower.com
©2013 Cummins Power Generation Inc. | S-1544m (3/13)
Control system PowerCommand 1.1 Alternator data
• Line-to-line and line-to-neutral AC volts
• 3-phase AC current
• Frequency
• Total kVA
Engine data
• DC voltage
• Lube oil pressure
• Coolant temperature
• Engine speed
PowerCommand control is an integrated generator Other data
set control system providing voltage regulation, engine • Genset model data
protection, operator interface and isochronous • Start attempts, starts, running hours
governing (optional). Major features include: • Fault history
• Battery monitoring and testing features and smart ®
• RS485 Modbus interface
starting control system. • Data logging and fault simulation (requires InPower
• Standard PCCNet interface to devices such as service tool)
remote annunciator for NFPA 110 applications.
• Control boards potted for environmental protection. Digital governing (optional)
• Control suitable for operation in ambient • Integrated digital electronic isochronous governor
temperatures from -40 °C to +70 °C (-40 °F to • Temperature dynamic governing
+158 °F) and altitudes to 5000 meters (13,000 feet). Digital voltage regulation
• Prototype tested; UL, CSA, and CE compliant.
™
• InPower PC-based service tool available for • Integrated digital electronic voltage regulator
detailed diagnostics. • 2-phase line-to-line sensing
• Configurable torque matching
Operator/display panel
Control functions
• Manual off switch
• Alpha-numeric display with pushbutton access for • Time delay start and cooldown
viewing engine and alternator data and providing • Cycle cranking
setup, controls and adjustments (English or • PCCNet interface
international symbols) • (2) Configurable inputs
• LED lamps indicating genset running, not in auto, • (2) Configurable outputs
common warning, common shutdown, manual run • Remote emergency stop
mode and remote start • Glow plug control (some models)
• Suitable for operation in ambient temperatures from Options
-20 °C to +70 °C Auxiliary output relays (2)
• Bargraph display (optional) 120/240 V, 100 W anti-condensation heater
AC protection Remote annunciator with (3) configurable inputs and
• Over current warning and shutdown (4) configurable outputs
PMG alternator excitation
• Over and under voltage shutdown
PowerCommand iWatch web server for remote
• Over and under frequency shutdown
• Over excitation (loss of sensing) fault monitoring and alarm notification (loose)
Auxiliary, configurable signal inputs (8) and
• Field overload
configurable relay outputs (8)
Engine protection Digital governing
• Overspeed shutdown AC output analog meters (bargraph)
• Low oil pressure warning and shutdown - Color-coded graphical display of:
• High coolant temperature warning and shutdown - 3-phase AC voltage
• Low coolant level warning or shutdown - 3-phase current
• Low coolant temperature warning - Frequency
• High, low and weak battery voltage warning
- kVa
• Fail to start (overcrank) shutdown
• Fail to crank shutdown Remote operator panel
• Redundant start disconnect PowerCommand 2.2 control with AmpSentry
• Cranking lockout protection
• Sensor failure indication
• Low fuel level warning or shutdown For further detail see document S-1531.
• Fuel-in-rupture-basin warning or shutdown
cumminspower.com
©2013 Cummins Power Generation Inc. | S-1544m (3/13)
Ratings definitions
Emergency standby power (ESP):
Applicable for supplying power to varying electrical
load for the duration of power interruption of a reliable
utility source. Emergency Standby Power (ESP) is in
accordance with ISO 8528. Fuel Stop power in
accordance with ISO 3046, AS 2789, DIN 6271 and
BS 5514.
Limited-time running power (LTP):
Applicable for supplying power to a constant electrical
load for limited hours. Limited Time Running Power
(LTP) is in accordance with ISO 8528.
Prime power (PRP):
Applicable for supplying power to varying electrical
load for unlimited hours. Prime Power (PRP) is in
accordance with ISO 8528. Ten percent overload
capability is available in accordance with ISO 3046, AS
2789, DIN 6271 and BS 5514.
Base load (continuous) power (COP): This outline drawing is for reference only. See respective model
Applicable for supplying power continuously to a data sheet for specific model outline drawing number.
constant electrical load for unlimited hours. Continuous
Power (COP) in accordance with ISO 8528, ISO 3046, Do not use for installation design
AS 2789, DIN 6271 and BS 5514.
Dim “A” Dim “B” Dim “C” Set Weight* Set Weight*
Model mm (in.) mm (in.) mm (in.) dry kg (lbs) wet kg (lbs)
DSGAA 2656 (104.6) 1100 (43.3) 1549 (61) 1180 (2602)
DSGAB 2656 (104.6) 1100 (43.3) 1549 (61) 1225 (2700)
DSGAC 2656 (104.6) 1100 (43.3) 1549 (61) 1263 (2784)
DSGAD 2656 (104.6) 1100 (43.3) 1549 (61) 1361 (3000)
DSGAE 2656 (104.6) 1100 (43.3) 1549 (61) 1361 (3000)
* Note: Weights represent a set with standard features. See outline drawings for weights of other configurations.
Codes and standards
Codes or standards compliance may not be available with all model configurations – consult factory for availability.
This generator set is designed in facilities The generator set is available Listed to UL
certified to ISO 9001 and manufactured in 2200, Stationary Engine Generator Assemblies
facilities certified to ISO 9001 or ISO 9002. for all 60 Hz low voltage models.
Warning: Back feed to a utility system can cause electrocution and/or property damage. Do not connect to any building’s electrical system
except through an approved device or after building main switch is open.
North America
1400 73rd Avenue N.E.
Minneapolis, MN 55432
USA
Phone 763 574 5000
Fax 763 574 5298
Fuel flow
Maximum fuel flow, L/hr (US gph) 106 (28)
Maximum fuel flow with C174, L/hr (US gph)
Maximum fuel inlet restriction with clean filter, mm Hg (in Hg) 127 (5)
Maximum return restriction, mm Hg (in Hg) 152 (6)
2011 Cummins Power Generation Inc. All rights reserved. Cummins Power Generation and Cummins are registered trademarks of Cummins
Inc. “Our energy working for you.” is a trademark of Cummins Power Generation. Specifications are subject to change without notice.
D-3349e (8/11)
Standby Prime Continuous
Air rating rating rating
3
Combustion air, m /min (scfm) 13.7 (486) 12.9 (456)
Maximum air cleaner restriction with clean filter, kPa (in H2O) 3.7 (15)
3
Alternator cooling air, m /min (cfm) 37.0 (1308)
Exhaust
3
Exhaust flow at set rated load, m /min (cfm) 31.3 (1105) 28.9 (1021.5)
Exhaust temperature, C ( F) 430 (807) 420 (788)
Maximum back pressure, kPa (in H2O) 10 (40)
Weights2
Unit dry weight kgs (lbs.)
Unit wet weight kgs (lbs.) 1180 (2602)
Notes:
1
For non-standard remote installations contact your local Cummins Power Generation representative.
2
Weights represent a set with standard features. See outline drawing for weights of other configurations.
Derating factors
Engine power available up to 3048 m (10,000 ft) at ambient temperature up to 50° C (122° F). Consult your
Standby Cummins Power Generation distributor for temperature and ambient requirements outside these
parameters.
Engine power available up to 3048 m (10,000 ft) at ambient temperature up to 40° C (104° F) and 2226 m
Prime (7300 ft) at 50° C (122° F). Consult your Cummins Power Generation distributor for temperature and
ambient requirements outside these parameters.
Continuous
Ratings definitions
Emergency standby power Limited-time running power Prime power (PRP): Base load (continuous)
(ESP): (LTP): power (COP):
Applicable for supplying power to Applicable for supplying power Applicable for supplying power Applicable for supplying power
varying electrical load for the to a constant electrical load for to varying electrical load for continuously to a constant
duration of power interruption of a limited hours. Limited Time unlimited hours. Prime Power electrical load for unlimited
reliable utility source. Emergency Running Power (LTP) is in (PRP) is in accordance with ISO hours. Continuous Power (COP)
Standby Power (ESP) is in accordance with ISO 8528. 8528. Ten percent overload is in accordance with ISO 8528,
accordance with ISO 8528. Fuel capability is available in ISO 3046, AS 2789, DIN 6271
Stop power in accordance with accordance with ISO 3046, and BS 5514.
ISO 3046, AS 2789, DIN 6271 and AS 2789, DIN 6271 and BS 5514.
BS 5514.
Full Load Current - 120/208 127/220 139/240 220/380 240/416 254/440 277/480 347/600
Amps at Standby 347 328 301 190 174 164 151 120
Rating
Single Phase Table 105o C 105o C 105o C 125o C 125o C 125o C 150o C
Feature Code B418 B415 B268 B417 B414 B267 B413
Alternator Data Sheet 208 208 210 207 207 209 207
Number
Voltage Ranges 120/2402 120/2402 120/2403 120/2402 120/2402 120/2403 120/2402
Surge kW 149 152 153 149 149 152 149
Motor Starting kVA (at Shunt 250 250 330 215 215 305 215
90% sustained voltage)
PMG 290 290 385 250 250 360 250
2 3
Full Load Current - 120/240 120/240
Amps at Standby 278 417
Rating
1
Single phase power can be taken from a three phase generator set at up to 2/3 set rated 3-phase kW at 1.0 power factor. Also see Note 3
below.
2
The broad range alternators can supply single phase output up to 2/3 set rated 3-phase kW at 1.0 power factor.
3
The extended stack (full single phase output) and 4 lead alternators can supply single phase output up to full set rated 3-phase kW at 1.0
power factor.
Warning: Back feed to a utility system can cause electrocution and/or property damage. Do not connect to any building’s electrical system
except through an approved device or after building main switch is open.
©2008|Cummins Power Generation Inc.|All rights reserved|Specifications subject to change without notice|Cummins Power Generation
and Cummins are registered trademarks of Cummins Inc. PowerCommand, InPower and “Our energy working for you.” are trademarks of
Cummins Power Generation. Other company, product, or service names may be trademarks or service marks of others.
S-1566b (4/08) Page 1 of 6
designed for reliable operation in harsh environments.
PowerCommand digital The main control board is a fully encapsulated module
generator set control that is protected from the elements.
• Modbus interface - for interconnecting to customer
PCC 1302 equipment.
• Configurable inputs and outputs - Four discrete inputs
and two dry contact relay outputs.
• Warranty and service - Backed by a comprehensive
warranty and worldwide distributor service network.
• Certifications - Suitable for use on generator sets that
are designed, manufactured, tested and certified to
relevant UL, NFPA, ISO, IEC, Mil Std., CE and CSA
standards.
Features
• LED indicating lamps:
- remote start
- not in auto
- shutdown
- warning
- auto
- run
• 128 x 64 pixels graphic LED backlight LCD.
• Four tactile feel membrane switches for LCD defined
operation. The functions of these switches are defined
dynamically on the LCD.
• Two tactile feel membrane switches dedicated for off
and back.
• Allows for complete genset control setup.
• Certifications: Suitable for use on generator sets that
are designed, manufactured, tested and certified to
relevant UL, NFPA, ISO, IEC, Mil Std., CE and CSA
standards.
Certifications
PowerCommand meets or exceeds the requirements of
the following codes and standards:
- NFPA 110 for level 1 and 2 systems.
- ISO 8528-4: 1993 compliance, controls and
switchgear.
- CE marking: The control system is suitable for use on
generator sets to be CE-marked.
- EN 50081-1,2 residential/light industrial emissions or
industrial emissions.
- EN 50082-1,2 residential/light industrial or industrial
Software
susceptibility.
InPower (beyond 6.0 version) is a PC-based software - ISO 7637-2, level 2; DC supply surge voltage test.
service tool that is designed to directly communicate to - Mil Std 202C, Method 101 and ASTM B117: Salt fog
PowerCommand generator sets and transfer switches, to test.
facilitate service and monitoring of these products. - PowerCommand control systems and generator sets
are designed and manufactured in ISO 9001 certified
Environment facilities.
- UL 508 recognized or Listed and suitable for use on UL
The control is designed for proper operation without
2200 Listed generator sets.
recalibration in ambient temperatures from -40 ºC
- CSA C282-M1999 compliance.
(104 ºF) to +70º C (158 ºF), and for storage from -55 ºC
- CSA 22.2 No. 14 M91 industrial controls.
(131 ºF) to +80 ºC (176 ºF). Control will operate with
humidity up to 95%, non-condensing. Warranty
The HMI is designed for proper operation in ambient All components and subsystems are covered by an
temperatures from -20 ºC (-4 ºF) to +70 ºC (158 ºF), and express limited one year warranty. Other optional and
for storage from -30 ºC (-22 ºF) to +80 ºC (176 ºF). extended factory warranties and local distributor
maintenance agreements are available.
TEST CONDITIONS
Data is representative of steady-state engine speed (± 25 RPM) at designated genset loads. Pressures, temperatures,
and emission rates were stabilized.
Fuel Specification: ASTM D975 No. 2-D diesel fuel with 0.03-0.05% sulfur content (by weight), and 40-48 cetane
number.
Fuel Temperature: 99 ± 9 °F (at fuel pump inlet)
Intake Air Temperature: 77 ± 9 °F
Barometric Pressure: 29.6 ± 1 in. Hg
Humidity: NOx measurement corrected to 75 grains H2O/lb dry air
Reference Standard: ISO 8178
The NOx, HC, CO and PM emission data tabulated here are representative of test data taken from a single engine under the test conditions shown
above. Data for the other components are estimated. These data are subjected to instrumentation and engine-to-engine variability. Field emission test
data are not guaranteed to these levels. Actual field test results may vary due to test site conditions, installation, fuel specification, test procedures and
instrumentation. Engine operation with excessive air intake or exhaust restriction beyond published maximum limits or with improper maintenance,
may results in elevated emission levels.
Cummins Power Generation Data and Specifications Subject to Change Without Notice eds-1083b
2013 EPA Tier 3 Exhaust Emission
Compliance Statement
100DSGAA
Stationary Emergency
60 Hz Diesel Generator Set
Compliance Information:
The engine used in this generator set complies with Tier 3 emissions limit of U.S. EPA New Source Performance
Standards for stationary emergency engines under the provisions of 40 CFR 60 Subpart IIII when tested per
ISO8178 D2.
Engine Manufacturer: Cummins Inc
EPA Certificate Number: DCEXL0409AAD-008
Effective Date: 05/01/2012
Date Issued: 05/01/2012
EPA Engine Family (Cummins Emissions Family): DCEXL0409AAD (D313)
Engine Information:
Model: QSB6.7 / QSB7 / QSB7-G5 NR3 Bore: 4.21 in. (107 mm)
Engine Nameplate HP: 324 Stroke: 4.88 in. (124 mm)
Type: 4 Cycle, In-line, 6 Cylinder Diesel Displacement: 408 cu. in. (6.7 liters)
Aspiration: Turbocharged and CAC Compression Ratio: 17.2:1
Emission Control Device: Exhaust Stack Diameter: 4 in.
The CARB emission values are based on CARB approved calculations for converting EPA (500 ppm) fuel to CARB (15 ppm) fuel.
Test Methods: EPA/CARB Nonroad emissions recorded per 40CFR89 (ref. ISO8178-1) and weighted at load points prescribed in Subpart E,
Appendix A for Constant Speed Engines (ref. ISO8178-4, D2)
Diesel Fuel Specifications: Cetane Number: 40-48. Reference: ASTM D975 No. 2-D.
Reference Conditions: Air Inlet Temperature: 25°C (77°F), Fuel Inlet Temperature: 40°C (104°F). Barometric Pressure: 100 kPa (29.53 in Hg),
Humidity: 10.7 g/kg (75 grains H2O/lb) of dry air; required for NOx correction, Restrictions: Intake Restriction set to a maximum allowable limit for
clean filter; Exhaust Back Pressure set to a maximum allowable limit.
Tests conducted using alternate test methods, instrumentation, fuel or reference conditions can yield different results.
Engine operation with excessive air intake or exhaust restriction beyond published maximum limits, or with improper maintenance, may result in
elevated emission levels.
Cummins Power Generation Data and Specifications Subject to Change Without Notice EPA-1117g
Sound Data
100DSGAA 60Hz
Note:
1. Position 1 faces the engine front. The positions proceed around the generator set in a counter-clockwise direction in 45° increments. All
positions are at 7m (23 ft) from the surface of the generator set and 1.2m (48”) from floor level.
2. Sound levels are subject to instrumentation, measurement, installation and manufacturing variability.
3. Sound data with remote-cooled generator sets are based on rated loads without cooling fan noise.
4. Sound levels for aluminum enclosures are approximately 2 dB(A)s higher than listed sound levels for steel enclosures.
5. Sound data for generator set with infinite exhaust do not include exhaust noise.
6. Data is based on full rated load with standard radiator-cooling fan package
7. Sound Pressure Levels are measured per ANSI S1.13 and ANSI S12.18, as applicable.
8. Reference sound pressure is 20 µPa.
9. Sound Power Levels per ISO 3744 and ISO 8528-10, as applicable.
10. Reference power = 1 pw (10-12 W)
11. Exhaust Sound Pressure Levels are per ISO 6798, as applicable.
Cummins Power Generation Data and Specification Subject to Change Without Notice Bulletin msp-1055c
PROTOTYPE TEST SUPPORT (PTS)
60 HZ TEST SUMMARY
GENERATOR SET MODELS REPRESENTATIVE PROTOTYPE
100 DSGAA 125 DSGAB Model: 200 DSGAE
150 DSGAC 175 DSGAD Alternator: UCDI274J
200 DSGAE Engine: QSB7-G5 NR3
The following summarizes prototype testing conducted on the designated representative prototype of the specified
models. This testing is conducted to verify the complete generator set electrical and mechanical design integrity.
Prototype testing is conducted only on generator sets not sold as new equipment.
The generator set was evaluated to determine the stated The generator set was tested to verify steady state
maximum surge power. operating performance was within the specified maximum
limits.
Transient Performance:
Torsional Analysis and Testing:
The generator set was tested with the alternator listed to
The generator set was tested to verify that the design is verify single step loading capability as required by NFPA
not subjected to harmful torsional stresses. A spectrum 110. Voltage and frequency response on load addition or
analysis of the transducer output was conducted over the rejection were evaluated. The following results were
speed range of 1350 to 1950 RPM. recorded:
(0.8 power factor) Upper Broad Range LBR* 347/600 Broad Range
3 Ø RATINGS
(Based on specified temperature rise 120/208 139/240 190-208 110/190 120/208 127/220
at 40°C ambient temperature)
240/416 277/480 380-416 347/600 220/380 240/415 254/440
150°C Rise Ratings kW 150 170 148 170 136 136 128
kVA 188 213 185 213 170 170 160
125°C Rise Ratings kW 145 165 144 165 128 128 120
kVA 181 206 180 206 160 160 150
105°C Rise Ratings kW 130 150 128 150 116 116 108
kVA 163 188 160 188 145 145 135
80°C Rise Ratings kW 112 128 110 128 101 101 94
kVA 140 160 138 160 126 126 118
(per unit, ±10%)
3 Ø REACTANCES
(Based on full load at 105°C Rise Rating)
Synchronous 2.21 1.92 1.68 1.97 2.04 1.71 1.42
Transient 0.18 0.15 0.14 0.16 0.17 0.15 0.12
Subtransient 0.13 0.11 0.09 0.10 0.12 0.10 0.09
Negative Sequence 0.14 0.12 0.10 0.11 0.13 0.11 0.09
Zero Sequence 0.08 0.07 0.07 0.07 0.08 0.07 0.06
3 Ø MOTOR STARTING
Maximum kVA (Shunt) 516 516 516 367
(90% Sustained Voltage) (PMG) 607 607 607 458
TIME CONSTANTS (Sec)
Transient 0.035 0.035 0.035 0.035
Subtransient 0.011 0.011 0.011 0.011
Open circuit 0.900 0.900 0.900 0.900
DC 0.009 0.009 0.009 0.009
WINDINGS (@ 20°C )
Stator Resistance (Line to Line, Ohms) 0.0480 0.0400 0.0700 0.0480
Rotor Resistance ( Ohms) 0.0480 0.0400 0.0700 0.0480
Number of Leads 12 12 6 12
* Lower broad range 110/190 thru 120/208, 220/380 thru 240/416.
Cummins Power Generation Specification May change WIthout Notice. ADS - 209D
Drawing Name: A040K623 Revision: B
Part Name: A040K622 Revision: B
Sheet 1 of 7
Drawing Name: A040K623 Revision: B
Part Name: A040K622 Revision: B
Sheet 2 of 7
Drawing Name: A040K623 Revision: B
Part Name: A040K622 Revision: B
Sheet 3 of 7
Drawing Name: A040K623 Revision: B
Part Name: A040K622 Revision: B
Sheet 5 of 7
Drawing Name: A040K671 Revision: A
Part Name: A040K670 Revision: A
Sheet 1 of 4
Drawing Name: A040K671 Revision: A
Part Name: A040K670 Revision: A
Sheet 2 of 4
Drawing Name: A040K671 Revision: A
Part Name: A040K670 Revision: A
Sheet 3 of 4
Transfer switch OTEC
open transition
40 - 1200 Amp
Description Features
OTEC transfer switches are designed for operation and Microprocessor control - Easy-to-use, standard
switching of electrical loads between primary power and control. LEDs display transfer switch status; pushbuttons
standby generator sets. They are suitable for use in allow operator to activate control test, exercise timing
emergency, legally required, and optional standby and transfer mode.
applications. The switches monitor both power sources, Programmed transition – Open transition timing can
signal generator set startup, automatically transfer be adjusted to completely disconnect the load from both
power, and return the load to the primary power source sources for a programmed time period, as recommended
once a stable utility is available. by NEMA MG-1 for transfer of inductive loads.
The fully integrated controller is designed for practical Advanced transfer switch mechanism - Unique bi-
functionality, with LED indicators and digital pushbuttons directional linear actuator provides virtually friction-free,
for ease of operator use. constant force, straight-line transfer switch action during
automatic operation.
All switches are UL 1008 Listed with UL Type Manual operation - Manual operating handles,
Rated cabinets and UL Listed CU-AL
shielded termination, and over-center contact
terminals.
mechanisms allow effective manual operation under de-
All switches are certified to CSA 282 energized conditions.
Emergency Electrical Power Supply for Positive interlocking - Mechanical and electrical
Buildings, up to 600 VAC. interlocking prevent source-to-source connection
through the power or control wiring.
Equipment shall be suitable for use in systems
NEC compliant to 700, 701 and 702.
Main contacts - Heavy-duty silver alloy contacts with
multi-leaf arc chutes are rated for 100% load interruption.
They require no routine contact maintenance and provide
All switches comply with NFPA 70, 99 and
110. 100% continuous current ratings.
Easy service/access - Single-plug harness connection
and compatible terminal markings simplify servicing.
All switches comply with NEMA ICS 10. Access space is ample. Door-mounted controls are field-
programmable; no tool is required.
All switches comply with IEEE 446 Complete product line - Cummins Power Generation
Recommended Practice for Emergency and offers a wide range of equipment, accessories and
Standby Power Systems. services to suit virtually any backup power application.
Warranty and service - Products are backed by a
This transfer switch is designed and
manufactured in facilities certified to ISO9001.
comprehensive warranty and a worldwide network of
distributors with factory-trained service technicians.
2012 Cummins Power Generation Inc. All rights reserved. Cummins Power Generation and Cummins are registered trademarks of Cummins
Inc. PowerCommand and “Our energy working for you.” are trademarks of Cummins Power Generation. . Specifications are subject to change
without notice
S-1464o (5/12)
Transfer switch mechanism
• Transfer switch mechanism is electrically operated and mechanically held
in the Source 1 and Source 2 positions. The transfer switch incorporates
electrical and mechanical interlocks to prevent inadvertent
interconnection of the sources.
• Independent break-before-make action is used for both 3-pole and
4-pole/switched neutral switches. This design allows use of sync check
operation when required, or control of the operating speed of the transfer
switch for proper transfer of motor and rectifier-based loads
(programmed transition feature).
• True 4-pole switching allows for proper ground (earth) fault sensing and
consistent, reliable operation for the life of the transfer switch. The
neutral poles of the transfer switch have the same ratings as the phase
poles and are operated by a common crossbar mechanism, eliminating
the possibility of incorrect neutral operation at any point in the operating
cycle, or due to failure of a neutral operator.
• Electrical interlocks prevent simultaneous closing signals to normal and
emergency contacts and interconnection of normal and emergency
sources through the control wiring.
• High pressure silver alloy contacts resist burning and pitting. Separate
arcing surfaces further protect the main contacts. Contact wear is
reduced by multiple leaf arc chutes that cool and quench the arcs.
Barriers separate the phases to prevent interphase flashover. A
transparent protective cover allows visual inspection while inhibiting
inadvertent contact with energized components.
• Switch mechanism, including contact assemblies, is third-party certified
to verify suitability for applications requiring high endurance switching
capability for the life of the transfer switch. Withstand and closing ratings
are validated using the same set of contacts, further demonstrating the
robust nature of the design.
Specifications
Voltage rating Transfer switches rated from 40 A through 1200 A are rated up to 600 VAC, 50 or 60 Hz.
Arc interruption Multiple leaf arc chutes cool and quench the arcs. Barriers prevent interphase flashover.
Neutral bar A full current-rated neutral bar with lugs is standard on enclosed 3-pole transfer switches.
Two contacts (one for each source) are provided for customer use. Wired to terminal block for easy
Auxiliary contacts access. Rated at 10A continuous and 250 VAC maximum.
Operating temperature -22 oF (-30 oC) to 140 oF (60 oC)
Storage temperature -40 °F (-40 °C) to 140 °F (60 °C)
Humidity Up to 95% relative, non-condensing
Altitude Up to 10,000 ft (3,000 m) without derating
Total transfer time (source- Will not exceed 6 cycles at 60 Hz with normal voltage applied to the actuator and without delayed
to-source) transition enabled.
Transfer switches are equipped with permanently attached operating handles and quick-break, quick-
Manual operation handles make contact mechanisms suitable for manual operation under de-energized conditions.
Open transition/programmed – Controls the time required for the device to switch from source to source, so that the
load-generated voltages decay to a safe level before connecting to an energized source. Recommended by NEMA
MG-1 to prevent nuisance tripping breakers and load damage. Adjustable 0-60 seconds, default 0 seconds.
Open transition/in-phase – Initiates open transition transfer when in-phase monitor senses both sources are in
phase. Operates in a break-before-make sequence. Includes ability to enable programmed transition as a backup. If
sources are not in phase within 120 seconds, the system will transfer using programmed transition.
Control functions
Voltage sensing: All phases on the normal source and single phase on generator source. Normal Source Pickup:
adjustable 90-95%, Dropout: adjustable 70-90% of nominal voltage; Generator Source Pickup: 90%, dropout: 75% of
nominal voltage.
Frequency sensing: Generator Source Pickup: 90% of nominal frequency; Dropout: 75% of nominal frequency.
Exerciser clock: Switch is furnished with an integral engine exerciser configurable for operation on a 7, 14, 21, or 28-
day cycle with a fixed exercise period duration of 20 minutes. A 12-hr exerciser time offset allows for the convenient
setting of exercise time without the need to activate the timer at the exact time that you need to schedule the generator
exercise for. Software selectable capability allows for the exercising of the generator with or without load.
Time-delay functions
Engine start: Prevents nuisance genset starts due to momentary power system variation or loss. Adjustable: 0-10
seconds; default: 3 seconds.
Transfer normal to emergency: Allows genset to stabilize before application of load. Prevents power interruption if
normal source variation or loss is momentary. Allows staggered transfer of loads in multiple transfer switch systems.
Adjustable 0-300 seconds, default 5 seconds.
Retransfer emergency to normal: Allows the utility to stabilize before retransfer of load. Prevents needless power
interruption if return of normal source is momentary. Allows staggered transfer of loads in multiple transfer switch
systems. Adjustable 0-30 minutes, default 10 minutes.
Genset stop: Maintains availability of the genset for immediate reconnection in the event that the normal source fails
shortly after transfer. Allows gradual genset cool down by running unloaded. Adjustable 0-30 minutes, default 10
minutes.
Delayed (programmed) transition: Controls the speed of operation of the transfer switch power contacts to allow
load generated voltages from inductive devices to decay prior to connecting a live source. Adjustable 0-10 seconds,
default 0 seconds.
Elevator signal: Provides a relay output contact for the elevator signal relay (load disconnect). The signal can also be
configured to provide a post transfer delay of the same duration. Adjustable: 0-300 seconds (requires optional elevator
signal relay for use).
Options
Elevator signal relay: Provides a relay output contact for the signal relay function
Programmable exerciser clock: Provides a fully-programmable 7-day clock to provide greater flexibility in
scheduling exercise periods than standard integral exerciser. Time-of-day setting feature operates generator during
periods of high utility rates.
300, 400, 600 65,000 at 600 1200 A 098-6887 200,000 @ 600 1200 A 098-6920
65,000 at 480
800, 1000 1400 A 098-6888 200,000 @ 600 1400 A 098-6921
50,000 at 600
85,000 at 480
1200 1600 A A030U183 200,000 @ 600 1600 A A030U185
65,000 at 600
Fuse protection
WCR at volts
Transfer max. with
switch current limiting
ampere fuses Max fuse, size and type Drawing reference
40, 70, 125
200,000 at 600 200 A Class, J, RK1, RK5, T 098-6885
3- and 4-pole
150, 225, 260 200,000 at 600 1200 A Class L or T, or 600 A class J, RK1, RK5 098-6886
300, 400, 600 200,000 at 600 1200 A Class L or T, or 600 A Class, J, RK1, RK5 098-6887
800, 1000 200,000 at 600 2000 A Class L or 1200 A class T or 600 A class J, RK1, RK5 098-6888
1200 200,000 at 600 2000 A Class L or 1200 A class T or 600 A class J, RK1, RK5 A030U183
3-cycle ratings
Transfer WCR at volts
switch max 3-cycle
ampere rating Max MCCB rating Drawing reference
42,000 at 600
1200 1600 A A030U183
50,000 at 480
Battery Specifications
Cold Ship
cranking Reserve Group weight Qts
Part number Battery amps Voltage capacity Length Width Height size lbs electrolyte
0416-0439 Dry 1400 12 430 20.75 11.00 9.63 8D 110 16.0
0416-0579 Dry 525 12 90 10.25 6.63 8.75 24C-675 20 6.0
0416-0579-01 Wet 525 12 90 10.25 6.63 8.75 24C-675 36 6.0
0416-0796 Wet 725 12 150 13.00 6.88 9.63 31-4 62 4.2
0416-0823 Dry 725 12 150 13.00 6.88 9.63 31-4 42 4.2
0416-0848 Dry 1080 12 270 20.75 8.63 9.63 4D 85 13.0
0416-0980 Wet 1000 12 200 13.00 6.88 9.63 31-5 65 4.2
0416-1040 Dry 800 12 160 13.00 6.88 9.44 31 65 4.2
0416-1051 Wet 530 12 80 8.13 6.63 7.50 26-775 31 3.7
0416-1105 Wet 1400 12 430 20.75 11.00 9.63 8D 125 16.0
0416-1138 Sealed NA 12 NA 5.88 3.88 3.75 NP12-12 9 4.0
0416-1264 Dry 730 12 420 20.67 10.83 9.45 8D 110 16.0
0416-1291 Sealed 800 12 110 10.00 6.88 7.81 34 38 4.0
0416-1330 Wet 810 12 146 10.25 6.63 8.88 24XL 43 5.9
0416-1332 Dry 420 12 60 9.13 5.25 8.88 22NF 19 4.0
2013 Cummins Power Generation Inc. All rights reserved. Cummins Power Generation and Cummins are registered trademarks of
Cummins Inc. “Our energy working for you.” is a trademark of Cummins Power Generation. Specifications are subject to change without notice.
AC-150m (2/13) Page 1 of 5
Application
Listed below, by set model, is the specific battery designed to fit the skid mounted battery rack. (Larger batteries, if
required, may not fit the standard skid mounted rack.)
Begin Current Battery Begin Current Battery
Model spec spec P/N Quantity Model spec spec P/N Quantity
DFAA F H 0416-0439 2 DGGD A E 0416-0980 1
DFAB G N 0416-0439 2 DGHCA A A 0416-0980 1
DFAC F N 0416-0439 2 DGHCB A A 0416-0980 1
DFBF M Z 0416-0439 2 DGHCC A A 0416-0980 1
DFCB M Z 0416-0439 2 DGHDA A A 0416-0980 1
DFCC M Z 0416-0439 2 DGHDB A A 0416-0980 1
DFCE B J 0416-0439 2 DGHD A E 0416-0980 1
DFEB M T 0416-0439 2 DGHE A E 0416-0980 1
DFEC E L 0416-0439 2 DKAC A C 0416-0579 1
DFED B H 0416-0439 2 DKAE A D 0416-0796 1
DFEG A K 0416-0439 2 DKAF A E 0416-0796 1
DFEH A K 0416-0439 2 DNAA A B 0416-1040 1
DFEJ A K 0416-0439 2 DNAB A B 0416-1040 1
DFEK A K 0416-0439 2 DNAF A E 0416-1040 1
DFGA F H 0416-0439 4 DQAA A F 0416-0439 4
DFGB F L 0416-0439 4 DQAB A F 0416-0439 4
DFGE A D 0416-0439 4 DQAD A E 0416-0439 2
DFHA A J 0416-0439 2 DQAE A E 0416-0439 2
DFHB A J 0416-0439 2 DQAF A E 0416-0439 2
DFHC A H 0416-0439 2 DQBA B G 0416-0439 2
DFHD A H 0416-0439 2 DQBB B G 0416-0439 2
DFJA E M 0416-0439 4 DQCA A C 0416-0439 2
DFJB E M 0416-0439 4 DQCB A C 0416-0439 2
DFJC N R 0416-0439 4 DQCC A C 0416-0439 2
DFJD F H 0416-0439 4 DQDAA B F 0416-0848 2
DFLB M T 0416-0439 4 DQDAB B F 0416-0848 2
DFLC N W 0416-0439 4 DQDAC B E 0416-0848 2
DFLD E N 0416-0439 4 DQFAA A E 0416-0439 2
DFLE A F 0416-0439 4 DQFAB A E 0416-0439 2
DFMB E T 0416-0439 4 DQFAC A E 0416-0439 2
DGBB E M 0416-0848 1 DQFAD A E 0416-0439 2
DGBB E M 0416-0980 1 DQGAA A C 0416-0439 4
DGBC D L 0416-0848 1 DQGAB A C 0416-0439 4
DGBC D L 0416-0980 1 DQGAC A B 0416-0439 4
DGCA M V 0416-0848 1 DQGAE A A 0416-0439 4
DGCA M V 0416-0980 1 DQGAF A A 0416-0439 4
DGCB M V 0416-0848 1 DQHAA A E 0416-0439 2
DGCB M V 0416-0980 1 DQHAB A E 0416-0439 2
DGCG A C 0416-0848 1 DQKAA A D 0416-0439 4
DGCG A C 0416-0980 1 DQKAB A D 0416-0439 4
DGDA A C 0416-0848 1 DQKAD A A 0416-0439 4
DGDA A C 0416-0980 1 DQKAE A A 0416-0439 4
DGDB L S 0416-0848 1 DQKAF A A 0416-0439 4
DGDB L S 0416-0980 1 DQKB A G 0416-0439 4
DGDK L S 0416-0848 1 DQKC A G 0416-0439 4
DGEA L S 0416-0980 1 DQKD A A 0416-0439 4
DGFA A S 0416-0848 1 DQKH A E 0416-0439 4
DGFB K S 0416-0848 1 DQLA A A 0416-0439 6
DGFC K S 0416-0848 1 DQLB A A 0416-0439 6
DGFS K S 0416-0848 1 DQLC A B 0416-0439 6
Battery box
Part number Description
0416-1263 Battery box has approximate inside dimensions of 21.125" long X 11.75" wide X 10.5" high. Box is
constructed of black plastic with 4 mounting feet and a cover held on by 2 thumb screws. The box also
has 2 slots on each side to accommodate battery cables. (see drawing on page 3). Note: Box material
will become soft and pliable around 240 °F.
Image 1: 0333-0469
Specifications
200 Watts / 120 Volts
o
Preset to maintain 80 F
Image 2: 0333-0770
Specifications Notes
50 Watts / 120 Volts 1. All seams folded over onto Battery side are stitched.
288 Total OHMS; 274 Min OHMS; 317 Max OHMS 2. This area is unheated.
3. Two wire ties attach to the battery
Our energy working for you.™
www.cumminspower.com
2013 Cummins Power Generation Inc. All rights reserved. Cummins Power Generation and Cummins are registered trademarks of
Cummins Inc. “Our energy working for you.” is a trademark of Cummins Power Generation. Specifications are subject to change without notice.
AC-150m (2/13) Page 4 of 5
Image 3: 0541-0555
Specifications Components
Warning: Back feed to a utility system can cause electrocution and/or property damage. Do not connect generator sets to any building
electrical system except through an approved device or after building main switch is open.
Warning: For professional use only. Must be installed by a qualified service technician. Improper installation presents hazards of electrical
shock and improper operation, resulting in severe personal injury and/or property damage.
Emissions : No Preference
Running kVA : 95.3 Max. Step kVA : 136.0 In Step 2 Cumulative Step kVA : 166.5
Running NLL kVA : None Peak kVA : None Cumulative Peak kVA : None
Step1
Running kVA : 31.0 Starting kVA : 88.0 Cumulative Step kVA : 88.0
Category : Motor
Running Amps : 34.41 Max. % Voltage Dip : 20.0 Max. % Frequency Dip : 7.0
THDV % : 10
Running Amps : 2.41 Max. % Voltage Dip : 20.0 Max. % Frequency Dip : 7.0
Voltage : 480
Step2
Running kVA : 36.0 Starting kVA : 136.0 Cumulative Step kVA : 167.0
Category : Motor
Running Amps : 34.41 Max. % Voltage Dip : 20.0 Max. % Frequency Dip : 7.0
THDV % : 10
Category : Motor
Running Amps : 9.1 Max. % Voltage Dip : 20.0 Max. % Frequency Dip : 7.0
Voltage : 480
Step3
Running kVA : 29.0 Starting kVA : 86.0 Cumulative Step kVA : 152.0
Category : Motor
Running Amps : 34.41 Max. % Voltage Dip : 20.0 Max. % Frequency Dip : 7.0
THDV % : 10
1 20 11 0.1 7 2 0.1
2 20 17 0.1 7 3 0.1
3 20 11 0.1 7 2 0.1
Note: Please refer to the model Spec. sheet for bandwidths used to report recovery times. For products manufactured in the United
Kingdom it may be assumed that recovery times are based on ISO8528-5 G2 class bandwidths.
Value
0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0
Note:
1. Position 1 faces the engine front. The positions proceed around the generator set in a counter-clockwise direction in 45° increments. All
positions are at 7m (23 ft) from the surface of the generator set and 1.2m (48”) from floor level.
2. Sound levels are subject to instrumentation, measurement, installation and manufacturing variability.
3. Sound data with remote-cooled generator sets are based on rated loads without cooling fan noise.
4. Sound levels for aluminum enclosures are approximately 2 dB(A)s higher than listed sound levels for steel enclosures.
5. Sound data for generator set with infinite exhaust do not include exhaust noise.
6. Data is based on full rated load with standard radiator-cooling fan package
7. Sound Pressure Levels are measured per ANSI S1.13 and ANSI S12.18, as applicable.
8. Reference sound pressure is 20 µPa.
9. Sound Power Levels per ISO 3744 and ISO 8528-10, as applicable.
10. Reference power = 1 pw (10-12 W)
11. Exhaust Sound Pressure Levels are per ISO 6798, as applicable.
Cummins Power Generation Data and Specification Subject to Change Without Notice Bulletin msp-1055c